]> code.delx.au - gnu-emacs/blob - man/gnus.texi
b0642673d122644b56251b71cfbbbc0caf33c94e
[gnu-emacs] / man / gnus.texi
1 \input texinfo
2
3 @setfilename ../info/gnus
4 @settitle Gnus Manual
5 @syncodeindex fn cp
6 @syncodeindex vr cp
7 @syncodeindex pg cp
8
9 @copying
10 Copyright @copyright{} 1995, 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001,
11 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007, 2008 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12
13 @quotation
14 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
15 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
16 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
17 Invariant Sections, with the Front-Cover texts being ``A GNU
18 Manual'', and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below. A copy of the
19 license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation
20 License'' in the Emacs manual.
21
22 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have freedom to copy and modify
23 this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies published by the Free
24 Software Foundation raise funds for GNU development.''
25
26 This document is part of a collection distributed under the GNU Free
27 Documentation License. If you want to distribute this document
28 separately from the collection, you can do so by adding a copy of the
29 license to the document, as described in section 6 of the license.
30 @end quotation
31 @end copying
32
33 @iftex
34 @iflatex
35 \documentclass[twoside,a4paper,openright,11pt]{book}
36 \usepackage[latin1]{inputenc}
37 \usepackage{pagestyle}
38 \usepackage{epsfig}
39 \usepackage{pixidx}
40 \input{gnusconfig.tex}
41
42 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
43 \else
44 \usepackage[pdftex,bookmarks,colorlinks=true]{hyperref}
45 \usepackage{thumbpdf}
46 \pdfcompresslevel=9
47 \fi
48
49 \makeindex
50 \begin{document}
51
52 % Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
53 \newcommand{\gnusversionname}{Gnus v5.11}
54 \newcommand{\gnuschaptername}{}
55 \newcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
56
57 \newcommand{\gnusbackslash}{/}
58
59 \newcommand{\gnusref}[1]{``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
60 \ifx\pdfoutput\undefined
61 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
62 \else
63 \newcommand{\gnusuref}[1]{\href{#1}{\gnustt{#1}}}
64 \fi
65 \newcommand{\gnusxref}[1]{See ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
66 \newcommand{\gnuspxref}[1]{see ``#1'' on page \pageref{#1}}
67
68 \newcommand{\gnuskindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
69 \newcommand{\gnusindex}[1]{\index{#1}}
70
71 \newcommand{\gnustt}[1]{{\gnusselectttfont{}#1}}
72 \newcommand{\gnuscode}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
73 \newcommand{\gnusasis}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
74 \newcommand{\gnusurl}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
75 \newcommand{\gnuscommand}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
76 \newcommand{\gnusenv}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
77 \newcommand{\gnussamp}[1]{``{\fontencoding{OT1}\gnusselectttfont{}#1}''}
78 \newcommand{\gnuslisp}[1]{\gnustt{#1}}
79 \newcommand{\gnuskbd}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
80 \newcommand{\gnuskey}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
81 \newcommand{\gnusfile}[1]{`\gnustt{#1}'}
82 \newcommand{\gnusdfn}[1]{\textit{#1}}
83 \newcommand{\gnusi}[1]{\textit{#1}}
84 \newcommand{\gnusr}[1]{\textrm{#1}}
85 \newcommand{\gnusstrong}[1]{\textbf{#1}}
86 \newcommand{\gnusemph}[1]{\textit{#1}}
87 \newcommand{\gnusvar}[1]{{\fontsize{10pt}{10}\selectfont\textsl{\textsf{#1}}}}
88 \newcommand{\gnussc}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
89 \newcommand{\gnustitle}[1]{{\huge\textbf{#1}}}
90 \newcommand{\gnusversion}[1]{{\small\textit{#1}}}
91 \newcommand{\gnusauthor}[1]{{\large\textbf{#1}}}
92 \newcommand{\gnusresult}[1]{\gnustt{=> #1}}
93 \newcommand{\gnusacronym}[1]{\textsc{#1}}
94 \newcommand{\gnusemail}[1]{\textit{#1}}
95
96 \newcommand{\gnusbullet}{{${\bullet}$}}
97 \newcommand{\gnusdollar}{\$}
98 \newcommand{\gnusampersand}{\&}
99 \newcommand{\gnuspercent}{\%}
100 \newcommand{\gnushash}{\#}
101 \newcommand{\gnushat}{\symbol{"5E}}
102 \newcommand{\gnusunderline}{\symbol{"5F}}
103 \newcommand{\gnusnot}{$\neg$}
104 \newcommand{\gnustilde}{\symbol{"7E}}
105 \newcommand{\gnusless}{{$<$}}
106 \newcommand{\gnusgreater}{{$>$}}
107 \newcommand{\gnusbraceleft}{{$>$}}
108 \newcommand{\gnusbraceright}{{$>$}}
109
110 \newcommand{\gnushead}{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-head,height=1cm}}}
111 \newcommand{\gnusinteresting}{
112 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\gnushead]{\gnushead}
113 }
114
115 \newcommand{\gnuscleardoublepage}{\ifodd\count0\mbox{}\clearpage\thispagestyle{empty}\mbox{}\clearpage\else\clearpage\fi}
116
117 \newcommand{\gnuspagechapter}[1]{
118 {\mbox{}}
119 }
120
121 \newdimen{\gnusdimen}
122 \gnusdimen 0pt
123
124 \newcommand{\gnuschapter}[2]{
125 \gnuscleardoublepage
126 \ifdim \gnusdimen = 0pt\setcounter{page}{1}\pagestyle{gnus}\pagenumbering{arabic} \gnusdimen 1pt\fi
127 \chapter{#2}
128 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{}
129 \renewcommand{\gnuschaptername}{#2}
130 \thispagestyle{empty}
131 \hspace*{-2cm}
132 \begin{picture}(500,500)(0,0)
133 \put(480,350){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{#1}}
134 \put(40,300){\makebox(500,50)[bl]{{\Huge\bf{#2}}}}
135 \end{picture}
136 \clearpage
137 }
138
139 \newcommand{\gnusfigure}[3]{
140 \begin{figure}
141 \mbox{}\ifodd\count0\hspace*{-0.8cm}\else\hspace*{-3cm}\fi\begin{picture}(440,#2)
142 #3
143 \end{picture}
144 \caption{#1}
145 \end{figure}
146 }
147
148 \newcommand{\gnusicon}[1]{
149 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\raisebox{-1.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1.5cm}}]{\raisebox{-1cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/#1-up,height=1cm}}}
150 }
151
152 \newcommand{\gnuspicon}[1]{
153 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=2cm}}
154 }
155
156 \newcommand{\gnusxface}[2]{
157 \margindex{\epsfig{figure=#1,width=1cm}\epsfig{figure=#2,width=1cm}}
158 }
159
160 \newcommand{\gnussmiley}[2]{
161 \margindex{\makebox[2cm]{\hfill\epsfig{figure=#1,width=0.5cm}\hfill\epsfig{figure=#2,width=0.5cm}\hfill}}
162 }
163
164 \newcommand{\gnusitemx}[1]{\mbox{}\vspace*{-\itemsep}\vspace*{-\parsep}\item#1}
165
166 \newcommand{\gnussection}[1]{
167 \renewcommand{\gnussectionname}{#1}
168 \section{#1}
169 }
170
171 \newenvironment{codelist}%
172 {\begin{list}{}{
173 }
174 }{\end{list}}
175
176 \newenvironment{asislist}%
177 {\begin{list}{}{
178 }
179 }{\end{list}}
180
181 \newenvironment{kbdlist}%
182 {\begin{list}{}{
183 \labelwidth=0cm
184 }
185 }{\end{list}}
186
187 \newenvironment{dfnlist}%
188 {\begin{list}{}{
189 }
190 }{\end{list}}
191
192 \newenvironment{stronglist}%
193 {\begin{list}{}{
194 }
195 }{\end{list}}
196
197 \newenvironment{samplist}%
198 {\begin{list}{}{
199 }
200 }{\end{list}}
201
202 \newenvironment{varlist}%
203 {\begin{list}{}{
204 }
205 }{\end{list}}
206
207 \newenvironment{emphlist}%
208 {\begin{list}{}{
209 }
210 }{\end{list}}
211
212 \newlength\gnusheadtextwidth
213 \setlength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{\headtextwidth}
214 \addtolength{\gnusheadtextwidth}{1cm}
215
216 \newpagestyle{gnuspreamble}%
217 {
218 {
219 \ifodd\count0
220 {
221 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\mbox{}}\textbf{\hfill\roman{page}}}
222 }
223 \else
224 {
225 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\roman{page}\hfill\mbox{}}}
226 }
227 }
228 \fi
229 }
230 }
231 {
232 \ifodd\count0
233 \mbox{} \hfill
234 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
235 \else
236 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
237 \hfill \mbox{}
238 \fi
239 }
240
241 \newpagestyle{gnusindex}%
242 {
243 {
244 \ifodd\count0
245 {
246 \hspace*{-0.23cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\gnuschaptername\hfill\arabic{page}}}}
247 }
248 \else
249 {
250 \hspace*{-3.25cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}
251 }
252 \fi
253 }
254 }
255 {
256 \ifodd\count0
257 \mbox{} \hfill
258 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
259 \else
260 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
261 \hfill \mbox{}
262 \fi
263 }
264
265 \newpagestyle{gnus}%
266 {
267 {
268 \ifodd\count0
269 {
270 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{3.1cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{chapter}.\arabic{section}} \textbf{\gnussectionname\hfill\arabic{page}}}}}
271 }
272 \else
273 {
274 \makebox[12cm]{\hspace*{-2.95cm}\underline{\makebox[\gnusheadtextwidth]{\textbf{\arabic{page}\hfill\gnuschaptername}}}}
275 }
276 \fi
277 }
278 }
279 {
280 \ifodd\count0
281 \mbox{} \hfill
282 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
283 \else
284 \raisebox{-0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=1cm}}
285 \hfill \mbox{}
286 \fi
287 }
288
289 \pagenumbering{roman}
290 \pagestyle{gnuspreamble}
291
292 @end iflatex
293 @end iftex
294
295 @iftex
296 @iflatex
297
298 \begin{titlepage}
299 {
300
301 %\addtolength{\oddsidemargin}{-5cm}
302 %\addtolength{\evensidemargin}{-5cm}
303 \parindent=0cm
304 \addtolength{\textheight}{2cm}
305
306 \gnustitle{\gnustitlename}\hfill\gnusversion{\gnusversionname}\\
307 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
308 \vfill
309 \hspace*{0cm}\epsfig{figure=ps/gnus-big-logo,height=15cm}
310 \vfill
311 \rule{15cm}{1mm}\\
312 \gnusauthor{by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen}
313 \newpage
314 }
315
316 \mbox{}
317 \vfill
318
319 \thispagestyle{empty}
320
321 @c @insertcopying
322 \newpage
323 \end{titlepage}
324 @end iflatex
325 @end iftex
326
327 @ifnottex
328 @insertcopying
329 @end ifnottex
330
331 @dircategory Emacs
332 @direntry
333 * Gnus: (gnus). The newsreader Gnus.
334 @end direntry
335 @iftex
336 @finalout
337 @end iftex
338 @setchapternewpage odd
339
340
341
342 @titlepage
343 @title Gnus Manual
344
345 @author by Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen
346 @page
347 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
348 @insertcopying
349 @end titlepage
350
351
352 @node Top
353 @top The Gnus Newsreader
354
355 @ifinfo
356
357 You can read news (and mail) from within Emacs by using Gnus. The news
358 can be gotten by any nefarious means you can think of---@acronym{NNTP}, local
359 spool or your mbox file. All at the same time, if you want to push your
360 luck.
361
362 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
363 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
364 @c See also below in the iftex branch...
365
366 @end ifinfo
367
368 @iftex
369
370 @iflatex
371 \tableofcontents
372 \gnuscleardoublepage
373 @end iflatex
374
375 Gnus is the advanced, self-documenting, customizable, extensible
376 unreal-time newsreader for GNU Emacs.
377
378 Oops. That sounds oddly familiar, so let's start over again to avoid
379 being accused of plagiarism:
380
381 Gnus is a message-reading laboratory. It will let you look at just
382 about anything as if it were a newsgroup. You can read mail with it,
383 you can browse directories with it, you can @code{ftp} with it---you
384 can even read news with it!
385
386 Gnus tries to empower people who read news the same way Emacs empowers
387 people who edit text. Gnus sets no limits to what the user should be
388 allowed to do. Users are encouraged to extend Gnus to make it behave
389 like they want it to behave. A program should not control people;
390 people should be empowered to do what they want by using (or abusing)
391 the program.
392
393 @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change the following line:
394 This manual corresponds to Gnus v5.11.
395
396 @heading Other related manuals
397 @itemize
398 @item Message manual: Composing messages
399 @item Emacs-MIME: Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
400 @item Sieve: Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
401 @item PGG: @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
402 @end itemize
403
404 @end iftex
405
406 @menu
407 * Starting Up:: Finding news can be a pain.
408 * Group Buffer:: Selecting, subscribing and killing groups.
409 * Summary Buffer:: Reading, saving and posting articles.
410 * Article Buffer:: Displaying and handling articles.
411 * Composing Messages:: Information on sending mail and news.
412 * Select Methods:: Gnus reads all messages from various select methods.
413 * Scoring:: Assigning values to articles.
414 * Various:: General purpose settings.
415 * The End:: Farewell and goodbye.
416 * Appendices:: Terminology, Emacs intro, @acronym{FAQ}, History, Internals.
417 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation.
418 * Index:: Variable, function and concept index.
419 * Key Index:: Key Index.
420
421 Other related manuals
422
423 * Message:(message). Composing messages.
424 * Emacs-MIME:(emacs-mime). Composing messages; @acronym{MIME}-specific parts.
425 * Sieve:(sieve). Managing Sieve scripts in Emacs.
426 * PGG:(pgg). @acronym{PGP/MIME} with Gnus.
427
428 @detailmenu
429 --- The Detailed Node Listing ---
430
431 Starting Gnus
432
433 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
434 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
435 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
436 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
437 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
438 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
439 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
440 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
441 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
442 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
443 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
444
445 New Groups
446
447 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
448 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
449 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
450
451 Group Buffer
452
453 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
454 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
455 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
456 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
457 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
458 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
459 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
460 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
461 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
462 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
463 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
464 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
465 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
466 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
467 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
468 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
469 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
470
471 Group Buffer Format
472
473 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
474 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
475 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
476
477 Group Topics
478
479 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
480 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
481 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
482 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
483 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
484
485 Misc Group Stuff
486
487 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
488 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
489 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
490 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
491 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
492
493 Summary Buffer
494
495 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
496 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
497 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
498 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
499 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
500 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
501 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
502 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
503 * Threading:: How threads are made.
504 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
505 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
506 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
507 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
508 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
509 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
510 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
511 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
512 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
513 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
514 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
515 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
516 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
517 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
518 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
519 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
520 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
521 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
522 or reselecting the current group.
523 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
524 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
525 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
526 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
527
528 Summary Buffer Format
529
530 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
531 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
532 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
533 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
534
535 Choosing Articles
536
537 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
538 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
539
540 Reply, Followup and Post
541
542 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
543 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
544 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
545 * Canceling and Superseding::
546
547 Marking Articles
548
549 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
550 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
551 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
552 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
553 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
554 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
555
556 Threading
557
558 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
559 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
560
561 Customizing Threading
562
563 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
564 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
565 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
566 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
567
568 Decoding Articles
569
570 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
571 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
572 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
573 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
574 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
575 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
576
577 Decoding Variables
578
579 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
580 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
581 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
582
583 Article Treatment
584
585 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
586 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
587 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
588 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
589 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
590 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
591 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
592 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
593 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
594 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
595 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
596
597 Alternative Approaches
598
599 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
600 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
601
602 Various Summary Stuff
603
604 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
605 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
606 * Summary Generation Commands::
607 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
608
609 Article Buffer
610
611 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
612 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
613 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
614 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
615 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
616
617 Composing Messages
618
619 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
620 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
621 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
622 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
623 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
624 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
625 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
626 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
627 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
628
629 Select Methods
630
631 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
632 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
633 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
634 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
635 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
636 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
637 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
638 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
639 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
640
641 Server Buffer
642
643 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
644 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
645 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
646 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
647 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
648 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
649 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
650
651 Getting News
652
653 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
654 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
655
656 @acronym{NNTP}
657
658 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
659 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
660 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
661
662 Getting Mail
663
664 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
665 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
666 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
667 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
668 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
669 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
670 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
671 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
672 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
673 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
674 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
675 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
676 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
677
678 Mail Sources
679
680 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
681 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
682 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
683
684 Choosing a Mail Back End
685
686 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
687 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
688 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
689 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
690 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
691 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
692 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
693
694 Browsing the Web
695
696 * Archiving Mail::
697 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
698 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
699 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
700 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
701 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
702 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
703
704 @acronym{IMAP}
705
706 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
707 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
708 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
709 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
710 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
711 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
712
713 Other Sources
714
715 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
716 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
717 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
718 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
719 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
720
721 Document Groups
722
723 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
724
725 SOUP
726
727 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
728 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
729 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
730
731 Combined Groups
732
733 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
734 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
735
736 Email Based Diary
737
738 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
739 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
740 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
741
742 The NNDiary Back End
743
744 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
745 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
746 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
747
748 The Gnus Diary Library
749
750 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
751 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
752 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
753 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
754
755 Gnus Unplugged
756
757 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
758 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
759 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
760 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
761 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
762 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
763 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
764 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
765 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
766 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
767 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
768 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
769 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
770
771 Agent Categories
772
773 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
774 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
775 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
776
777 Agent Commands
778
779 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
780 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
781 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
782
783 Scoring
784
785 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
786 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
787 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
788 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
789 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
790 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
791 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
792 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
793 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
794 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
795 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
796 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
797 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
798 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
799 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
800 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
801 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
802
803 GroupLens
804
805 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
806 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
807 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
808 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
809
810 Advanced Scoring
811
812 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
813 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
814 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
815
816 Various
817
818 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
819 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
820 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
821 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
822 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
823 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
824 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
825 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
826 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
827 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
828 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
829 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
830 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
831 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
832 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
833 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
834 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
835 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
836 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
837 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
838 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
839
840 Formatting Variables
841
842 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
843 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
844 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
845 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
846 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
847 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
848 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
849 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
850
851 Image Enhancements
852
853 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
854 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
855 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were
856 meant to be shown.
857 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
858 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
859
860 Thwarting Email Spam
861
862 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
863 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
864 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
865 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
866
867 Spam Package
868
869 * Spam Package Introduction::
870 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
871 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
872 * Spam and Ham Processors::
873 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
874 * Spam Back Ends::
875 * Extending the Spam package::
876 * Spam Statistics Package::
877
878 Spam Statistics Package
879
880 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
881 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
882 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
883
884 Appendices
885
886 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
887 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
888 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
889 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
890 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
891 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
892 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
893 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
894 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
895
896 History
897
898 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
899 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
900 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
901 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
902 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
903 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
904 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
905 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
906 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
907
908 New Features
909
910 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
911 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
912 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
913 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
914 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
915 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
916
917 Customization
918
919 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
920 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
921 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
922 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
923
924 Gnus Reference Guide
925
926 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
927 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
928 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
929 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
930 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
931 * Group Info:: The group info format.
932 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
933 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
934 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
935
936 Back End Interface
937
938 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
939 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
940 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
941 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
942 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
943 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
944
945 Various File Formats
946
947 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
948 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
949
950 Emacs for Heathens
951
952 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
953 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
954
955 @end detailmenu
956 @end menu
957
958 @node Starting Up
959 @chapter Starting Gnus
960 @cindex starting up
961
962 If you haven't used Emacs much before using Gnus, read @ref{Emacs for
963 Heathens} first.
964
965 @kindex M-x gnus
966 @findex gnus
967 If your system administrator has set things up properly, starting Gnus
968 and reading news is extremely easy---you just type @kbd{M-x gnus} in
969 your Emacs. If not, you should customize the variable
970 @code{gnus-select-method} as described in @ref{Finding the News}. For a
971 minimal setup for posting should also customize the variables
972 @code{user-full-name} and @code{user-mail-address}.
973
974 @findex gnus-other-frame
975 @kindex M-x gnus-other-frame
976 If you want to start Gnus in a different frame, you can use the command
977 @kbd{M-x gnus-other-frame} instead.
978
979 If things do not go smoothly at startup, you have to twiddle some
980 variables in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file. This file is similar to
981 @file{~/.emacs}, but is read when Gnus starts.
982
983 If you puzzle at any terms used in this manual, please refer to the
984 terminology section (@pxref{Terminology}).
985
986 @menu
987 * Finding the News:: Choosing a method for getting news.
988 * The First Time:: What does Gnus do the first time you start it?
989 * The Server is Down:: How can I read my mail then?
990 * Slave Gnusae:: You can have more than one Gnus active at a time.
991 * New Groups:: What is Gnus supposed to do with new groups?
992 * Changing Servers:: You may want to move from one server to another.
993 * Startup Files:: Those pesky startup files---@file{.newsrc}.
994 * Auto Save:: Recovering from a crash.
995 * The Active File:: Reading the active file over a slow line Takes Time.
996 * Startup Variables:: Other variables you might change.
997 @end menu
998
999
1000 @node Finding the News
1001 @section Finding the News
1002 @cindex finding news
1003
1004 @vindex gnus-select-method
1005 @c @head
1006 The @code{gnus-select-method} variable says where Gnus should look for
1007 news. This variable should be a list where the first element says
1008 @dfn{how} and the second element says @dfn{where}. This method is your
1009 native method. All groups not fetched with this method are
1010 foreign groups.
1011
1012 For instance, if the @samp{news.somewhere.edu} @acronym{NNTP} server is where
1013 you want to get your daily dosage of news from, you'd say:
1014
1015 @lisp
1016 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.somewhere.edu"))
1017 @end lisp
1018
1019 If you want to read directly from the local spool, say:
1020
1021 @lisp
1022 (setq gnus-select-method '(nnspool ""))
1023 @end lisp
1024
1025 If you can use a local spool, you probably should, as it will almost
1026 certainly be much faster. But do not use the local spool if your
1027 server is running Leafnode (which is a simple, standalone private news
1028 server); in this case, use @code{(nntp "localhost")}.
1029
1030 @vindex gnus-nntpserver-file
1031 @cindex NNTPSERVER
1032 @cindex @acronym{NNTP} server
1033 If this variable is not set, Gnus will take a look at the
1034 @env{NNTPSERVER} environment variable. If that variable isn't set,
1035 Gnus will see whether @code{gnus-nntpserver-file}
1036 (@file{/etc/nntpserver} by default) has any opinions on the matter.
1037 If that fails as well, Gnus will try to use the machine running Emacs
1038 as an @acronym{NNTP} server. That's a long shot, though.
1039
1040 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1041 If @code{gnus-nntp-server} is set, this variable will override
1042 @code{gnus-select-method}. You should therefore set
1043 @code{gnus-nntp-server} to @code{nil}, which is what it is by default.
1044
1045 @vindex gnus-secondary-servers
1046 @vindex gnus-nntp-server
1047 You can also make Gnus prompt you interactively for the name of an
1048 @acronym{NNTP} server. If you give a non-numerical prefix to @code{gnus}
1049 (i.e., @kbd{C-u M-x gnus}), Gnus will let you choose between the servers
1050 in the @code{gnus-secondary-servers} list (if any). You can also just
1051 type in the name of any server you feel like visiting. (Note that this
1052 will set @code{gnus-nntp-server}, which means that if you then @kbd{M-x
1053 gnus} later in the same Emacs session, Gnus will contact the same
1054 server.)
1055
1056 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
1057 @kindex B (Group)
1058 However, if you use one @acronym{NNTP} server regularly and are just
1059 interested in a couple of groups from a different server, you would be
1060 better served by using the @kbd{B} command in the group buffer. It will
1061 let you have a look at what groups are available, and you can subscribe
1062 to any of the groups you want to. This also makes @file{.newsrc}
1063 maintenance much tidier. @xref{Foreign Groups}.
1064
1065 @vindex gnus-secondary-select-methods
1066 @c @head
1067 A slightly different approach to foreign groups is to set the
1068 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} variable. The select methods
1069 listed in this variable are in many ways just as native as the
1070 @code{gnus-select-method} server. They will also be queried for active
1071 files during startup (if that's required), and new newsgroups that
1072 appear on these servers will be subscribed (or not) just as native
1073 groups are.
1074
1075 For instance, if you use the @code{nnmbox} back end to read your mail,
1076 you would typically set this variable to
1077
1078 @lisp
1079 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnmbox "")))
1080 @end lisp
1081
1082
1083 @node The First Time
1084 @section The First Time
1085 @cindex first time usage
1086
1087 If no startup files exist (@pxref{Startup Files}), Gnus will try to
1088 determine what groups should be subscribed by default.
1089
1090 @vindex gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups
1091 If the variable @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is set, Gnus
1092 will subscribe you to just those groups in that list, leaving the rest
1093 killed. Your system administrator should have set this variable to
1094 something useful.
1095
1096 Since she hasn't, Gnus will just subscribe you to a few arbitrarily
1097 picked groups (i.e., @samp{*.newusers}). (@dfn{Arbitrary} is defined
1098 here as @dfn{whatever Lars thinks you should read}.)
1099
1100 You'll also be subscribed to the Gnus documentation group, which should
1101 help you with most common problems.
1102
1103 If @code{gnus-default-subscribed-newsgroups} is @code{t}, Gnus will just
1104 use the normal functions for handling new groups, and not do anything
1105 special.
1106
1107
1108 @node The Server is Down
1109 @section The Server is Down
1110 @cindex server errors
1111
1112 If the default server is down, Gnus will understandably have some
1113 problems starting. However, if you have some mail groups in addition to
1114 the news groups, you may want to start Gnus anyway.
1115
1116 Gnus, being the trusting sort of program, will ask whether to proceed
1117 without a native select method if that server can't be contacted. This
1118 will happen whether the server doesn't actually exist (i.e., you have
1119 given the wrong address) or the server has just momentarily taken ill
1120 for some reason or other. If you decide to continue and have no foreign
1121 groups, you'll find it difficult to actually do anything in the group
1122 buffer. But, hey, that's your problem. Blllrph!
1123
1124 @findex gnus-no-server
1125 @kindex M-x gnus-no-server
1126 @c @head
1127 If you know that the server is definitely down, or you just want to read
1128 your mail without bothering with the server at all, you can use the
1129 @code{gnus-no-server} command to start Gnus. That might come in handy
1130 if you're in a hurry as well. This command will not attempt to contact
1131 your primary server---instead, it will just activate all groups on level
1132 1 and 2. (You should preferably keep no native groups on those two
1133 levels.) Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
1134
1135
1136 @node Slave Gnusae
1137 @section Slave Gnusae
1138 @cindex slave
1139
1140 You might want to run more than one Emacs with more than one Gnus at the
1141 same time. If you are using different @file{.newsrc} files (e.g., if you
1142 are using the two different Gnusae to read from two different servers),
1143 that is no problem whatsoever. You just do it.
1144
1145 The problem appears when you want to run two Gnusae that use the same
1146 @file{.newsrc} file.
1147
1148 To work around that problem some, we here at the Think-Tank at the Gnus
1149 Towers have come up with a new concept: @dfn{Masters} and
1150 @dfn{slaves}. (We have applied for a patent on this concept, and have
1151 taken out a copyright on those words. If you wish to use those words in
1152 conjunction with each other, you have to send $1 per usage instance to
1153 me. Usage of the patent (@dfn{Master/Slave Relationships In Computer
1154 Applications}) will be much more expensive, of course.)
1155
1156 @findex gnus-slave
1157 Anyway, you start one Gnus up the normal way with @kbd{M-x gnus} (or
1158 however you do it). Each subsequent slave Gnusae should be started with
1159 @kbd{M-x gnus-slave}. These slaves won't save normal @file{.newsrc}
1160 files, but instead save @dfn{slave files} that contain information only
1161 on what groups have been read in the slave session. When a master Gnus
1162 starts, it will read (and delete) these slave files, incorporating all
1163 information from them. (The slave files will be read in the sequence
1164 they were created, so the latest changes will have precedence.)
1165
1166 Information from the slave files has, of course, precedence over the
1167 information in the normal (i.e., master) @file{.newsrc} file.
1168
1169 If the @file{.newsrc*} files have not been saved in the master when the
1170 slave starts, you may be prompted as to whether to read an auto-save
1171 file. If you answer ``yes'', the unsaved changes to the master will be
1172 incorporated into the slave. If you answer ``no'', the slave may see some
1173 messages as unread that have been read in the master.
1174
1175
1176
1177 @node New Groups
1178 @section New Groups
1179 @cindex new groups
1180 @cindex subscription
1181
1182 @vindex gnus-check-new-newsgroups
1183 If you are satisfied that you really never want to see any new groups,
1184 you can set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil}. This will
1185 also save you some time at startup. Even if this variable is
1186 @code{nil}, you can always subscribe to the new groups just by pressing
1187 @kbd{U} in the group buffer (@pxref{Group Maintenance}). This variable
1188 is @code{ask-server} by default. If you set this variable to
1189 @code{always}, then Gnus will query the back ends for new groups even
1190 when you do the @kbd{g} command (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
1191
1192 @menu
1193 * Checking New Groups:: Determining what groups are new.
1194 * Subscription Methods:: What Gnus should do with new groups.
1195 * Filtering New Groups:: Making Gnus ignore certain new groups.
1196 @end menu
1197
1198
1199 @node Checking New Groups
1200 @subsection Checking New Groups
1201
1202 Gnus normally determines whether a group is new or not by comparing the
1203 list of groups from the active file(s) with the lists of subscribed and
1204 dead groups. This isn't a particularly fast method. If
1205 @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} is @code{ask-server}, Gnus will ask the
1206 server for new groups since the last time. This is both faster and
1207 cheaper. This also means that you can get rid of the list of killed
1208 groups altogether, so you may set @code{gnus-save-killed-list} to
1209 @code{nil}, which will save time both at startup, at exit, and all over.
1210 Saves disk space, too. Why isn't this the default, then?
1211 Unfortunately, not all servers support this command.
1212
1213 I bet I know what you're thinking now: How do I find out whether my
1214 server supports @code{ask-server}? No? Good, because I don't have a
1215 fail-safe answer. I would suggest just setting this variable to
1216 @code{ask-server} and see whether any new groups appear within the next
1217 few days. If any do, then it works. If none do, then it doesn't
1218 work. I could write a function to make Gnus guess whether the server
1219 supports @code{ask-server}, but it would just be a guess. So I won't.
1220 You could @code{telnet} to the server and say @code{HELP} and see
1221 whether it lists @samp{NEWGROUPS} among the commands it understands. If
1222 it does, then it might work. (But there are servers that lists
1223 @samp{NEWGROUPS} without supporting the function properly.)
1224
1225 This variable can also be a list of select methods. If so, Gnus will
1226 issue an @code{ask-server} command to each of the select methods, and
1227 subscribe them (or not) using the normal methods. This might be handy
1228 if you are monitoring a few servers for new groups. A side effect is
1229 that startup will take much longer, so you can meditate while waiting.
1230 Use the mantra ``dingnusdingnusdingnus'' to achieve permanent bliss.
1231
1232
1233 @node Subscription Methods
1234 @subsection Subscription Methods
1235
1236 @vindex gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method
1237 What Gnus does when it encounters a new group is determined by the
1238 @code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} variable.
1239
1240 This variable should contain a function. This function will be called
1241 with the name of the new group as the only parameter.
1242
1243 Some handy pre-fab functions are:
1244
1245 @table @code
1246
1247 @item gnus-subscribe-zombies
1248 @vindex gnus-subscribe-zombies
1249 Make all new groups zombies. This is the default. You can browse the
1250 zombies later (with @kbd{A z}) and either kill them all off properly
1251 (with @kbd{S z}), or subscribe to them (with @kbd{u}).
1252
1253 @item gnus-subscribe-randomly
1254 @vindex gnus-subscribe-randomly
1255 Subscribe all new groups in arbitrary order. This really means that all
1256 new groups will be added at ``the top'' of the group buffer.
1257
1258 @item gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1259 @vindex gnus-subscribe-alphabetically
1260 Subscribe all new groups in alphabetical order.
1261
1262 @item gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1263 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchically
1264 Subscribe all new groups hierarchically. The difference between this
1265 function and @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} is slight.
1266 @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically} will subscribe new groups in a strictly
1267 alphabetical fashion, while this function will enter groups into its
1268 hierarchy. So if you want to have the @samp{rec} hierarchy before the
1269 @samp{comp} hierarchy, this function will not mess that configuration
1270 up. Or something like that.
1271
1272 @item gnus-subscribe-interactively
1273 @vindex gnus-subscribe-interactively
1274 Subscribe new groups interactively. This means that Gnus will ask
1275 you about @strong{all} new groups. The groups you choose to subscribe
1276 to will be subscribed hierarchically.
1277
1278 @item gnus-subscribe-killed
1279 @vindex gnus-subscribe-killed
1280 Kill all new groups.
1281
1282 @item gnus-subscribe-topics
1283 @vindex gnus-subscribe-topics
1284 Put the groups into the topic that has a matching @code{subscribe} topic
1285 parameter (@pxref{Topic Parameters}). For instance, a @code{subscribe}
1286 topic parameter that looks like
1287
1288 @example
1289 "nnslashdot"
1290 @end example
1291
1292 will mean that all groups that match that regex will be subscribed under
1293 that topic.
1294
1295 If no topics match the groups, the groups will be subscribed in the
1296 top-level topic.
1297
1298 @end table
1299
1300 @vindex gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive
1301 A closely related variable is
1302 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. (That's quite a
1303 mouthful.) If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you in a
1304 hierarchical fashion whether to subscribe to new groups or not. Gnus
1305 will ask you for each sub-hierarchy whether you want to descend the
1306 hierarchy or not.
1307
1308 One common mistake is to set the variable a few paragraphs above
1309 (@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method}) to
1310 @code{gnus-subscribe-hierarchical-interactive}. This is an error. This
1311 will not work. This is ga-ga. So don't do it.
1312
1313
1314 @node Filtering New Groups
1315 @subsection Filtering New Groups
1316
1317 A nice and portable way to control which new newsgroups should be
1318 subscribed (or ignored) is to put an @dfn{options} line at the start of
1319 the @file{.newsrc} file. Here's an example:
1320
1321 @example
1322 options -n !alt.all !rec.all sci.all
1323 @end example
1324
1325 @vindex gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method
1326 This line obviously belongs to a serious-minded intellectual scientific
1327 person (or she may just be plain old boring), because it says that all
1328 groups that have names beginning with @samp{alt} and @samp{rec} should
1329 be ignored, and all groups with names beginning with @samp{sci} should
1330 be subscribed. Gnus will not use the normal subscription method for
1331 subscribing these groups.
1332 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method} is used instead. This
1333 variable defaults to @code{gnus-subscribe-alphabetically}.
1334
1335 @vindex gnus-options-not-subscribe
1336 @vindex gnus-options-subscribe
1337 If you don't want to mess with your @file{.newsrc} file, you can just
1338 set the two variables @code{gnus-options-subscribe} and
1339 @code{gnus-options-not-subscribe}. These two variables do exactly the
1340 same as the @file{.newsrc} @samp{options -n} trick. Both are regexps,
1341 and if the new group matches the former, it will be unconditionally
1342 subscribed, and if it matches the latter, it will be ignored.
1343
1344 @vindex gnus-auto-subscribed-groups
1345 Yet another variable that meddles here is
1346 @code{gnus-auto-subscribed-groups}. It works exactly like
1347 @code{gnus-options-subscribe}, and is therefore really superfluous,
1348 but I thought it would be nice to have two of these. This variable is
1349 more meant for setting some ground rules, while the other variable is
1350 used more for user fiddling. By default this variable makes all new
1351 groups that come from mail back ends (@code{nnml}, @code{nnbabyl},
1352 @code{nnfolder}, @code{nnmbox}, @code{nnmh}, and @code{nnmaildir})
1353 subscribed. If you don't like that, just set this variable to
1354 @code{nil}.
1355
1356 New groups that match this regexp are subscribed using
1357 @code{gnus-subscribe-options-newsgroup-method}.
1358
1359
1360 @node Changing Servers
1361 @section Changing Servers
1362 @cindex changing servers
1363
1364 Sometimes it is necessary to move from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another.
1365 This happens very rarely, but perhaps you change jobs, or one server is
1366 very flaky and you want to use another.
1367
1368 Changing the server is pretty easy, right? You just change
1369 @code{gnus-select-method} to point to the new server?
1370
1371 @emph{Wrong!}
1372
1373 Article numbers are not (in any way) kept synchronized between different
1374 @acronym{NNTP} servers, and the only way Gnus keeps track of what articles
1375 you have read is by keeping track of article numbers. So when you
1376 change @code{gnus-select-method}, your @file{.newsrc} file becomes
1377 worthless.
1378
1379 Gnus provides a few functions to attempt to translate a @file{.newsrc}
1380 file from one server to another. They all have one thing in
1381 common---they take a looong time to run. You don't want to use these
1382 functions more than absolutely necessary.
1383
1384 @kindex M-x gnus-change-server
1385 @findex gnus-change-server
1386 If you have access to both servers, Gnus can request the headers for all
1387 the articles you have read and compare @code{Message-ID}s and map the
1388 article numbers of the read articles and article marks. The @kbd{M-x
1389 gnus-change-server} command will do this for all your native groups. It
1390 will prompt for the method you want to move to.
1391
1392 @kindex M-x gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1393 @findex gnus-group-move-group-to-server
1394 You can also move individual groups with the @kbd{M-x
1395 gnus-group-move-group-to-server} command. This is useful if you want to
1396 move a (foreign) group from one server to another.
1397
1398 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1399 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
1400 If you don't have access to both the old and new server, all your marks
1401 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use the @kbd{M-x
1402 gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} command to clear out all data
1403 that you have on your native groups. Use with caution.
1404
1405 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data
1406 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
1407 Clear the data from the current group only---nix out marks and the
1408 list of read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
1409
1410 After changing servers, you @strong{must} move the cache hierarchy away,
1411 since the cached articles will have wrong article numbers, which will
1412 affect which articles Gnus thinks are read.
1413 @code{gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups} will ask you if you want
1414 to have it done automatically; for @code{gnus-group-clear-data}, you
1415 can use @kbd{M-x gnus-cache-move-cache} (but beware, it will move the
1416 cache for all groups).
1417
1418
1419 @node Startup Files
1420 @section Startup Files
1421 @cindex startup files
1422 @cindex .newsrc
1423 @cindex .newsrc.el
1424 @cindex .newsrc.eld
1425
1426 Most common Unix news readers use a shared startup file called
1427 @file{.newsrc}. This file contains all the information about what
1428 groups are subscribed, and which articles in these groups have been
1429 read.
1430
1431 Things got a bit more complicated with @sc{gnus}. In addition to
1432 keeping the @file{.newsrc} file updated, it also used a file called
1433 @file{.newsrc.el} for storing all the information that didn't fit into
1434 the @file{.newsrc} file. (Actually, it also duplicated everything in
1435 the @file{.newsrc} file.) @sc{gnus} would read whichever one of these
1436 files was the most recently saved, which enabled people to swap between
1437 @sc{gnus} and other newsreaders.
1438
1439 That was kinda silly, so Gnus went one better: In addition to the
1440 @file{.newsrc} and @file{.newsrc.el} files, Gnus also has a file called
1441 @file{.newsrc.eld}. It will read whichever of these files that are most
1442 recent, but it will never write a @file{.newsrc.el} file. You should
1443 never delete the @file{.newsrc.eld} file---it contains much information
1444 not stored in the @file{.newsrc} file.
1445
1446 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-file
1447 @vindex gnus-read-newsrc-file
1448 You can turn off writing the @file{.newsrc} file by setting
1449 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-file} to @code{nil}, which means you can delete
1450 the file and save some space, as well as exiting from Gnus faster.
1451 However, this will make it impossible to use other newsreaders than
1452 Gnus. But hey, who would want to, right? Similarly, setting
1453 @code{gnus-read-newsrc-file} to @code{nil} makes Gnus ignore the
1454 @file{.newsrc} file and any @file{.newsrc-SERVER} files, which can be
1455 convenient if you use a different news reader occasionally, and you
1456 want to read a different subset of the available groups with that
1457 news reader.
1458
1459 @vindex gnus-save-killed-list
1460 If @code{gnus-save-killed-list} (default @code{t}) is @code{nil}, Gnus
1461 will not save the list of killed groups to the startup file. This will
1462 save both time (when starting and quitting) and space (on disk). It
1463 will also mean that Gnus has no record of what groups are new or old,
1464 so the automatic new groups subscription methods become meaningless.
1465 You should always set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{nil} or
1466 @code{ask-server} if you set this variable to @code{nil} (@pxref{New
1467 Groups}). This variable can also be a regular expression. If that's
1468 the case, remove all groups that do not match this regexp before
1469 saving. This can be useful in certain obscure situations that involve
1470 several servers where not all servers support @code{ask-server}.
1471
1472 @vindex gnus-startup-file
1473 @vindex gnus-backup-startup-file
1474 @vindex version-control
1475 The @code{gnus-startup-file} variable says where the startup files are.
1476 The default value is @file{~/.newsrc}, with the Gnus (El Dingo) startup
1477 file being whatever that one is, with a @samp{.eld} appended.
1478 If you want version control for this file, set
1479 @code{gnus-backup-startup-file}. It respects the same values as the
1480 @code{version-control} variable.
1481
1482 @vindex gnus-save-newsrc-hook
1483 @vindex gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook
1484 @vindex gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook
1485 @code{gnus-save-newsrc-hook} is called before saving any of the newsrc
1486 files, while @code{gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook} is called just before
1487 saving the @file{.newsrc.eld} file, and
1488 @code{gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook} is called just before saving the
1489 @file{.newsrc} file. The latter two are commonly used to turn version
1490 control on or off. Version control is on by default when saving the
1491 startup files. If you want to turn backup creation off, say something like:
1492
1493 @lisp
1494 (defun turn-off-backup ()
1495 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
1496
1497 (add-hook 'gnus-save-quick-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1498 (add-hook 'gnus-save-standard-newsrc-hook 'turn-off-backup)
1499 @end lisp
1500
1501 @vindex gnus-init-file
1502 @vindex gnus-site-init-file
1503 When Gnus starts, it will read the @code{gnus-site-init-file}
1504 (@file{.../site-lisp/gnus-init} by default) and @code{gnus-init-file}
1505 (@file{~/.gnus} by default) files. These are normal Emacs Lisp files
1506 and can be used to avoid cluttering your @file{~/.emacs} and
1507 @file{site-init} files with Gnus stuff. Gnus will also check for files
1508 with the same names as these, but with @file{.elc} and @file{.el}
1509 suffixes. In other words, if you have set @code{gnus-init-file} to
1510 @file{~/.gnus}, it will look for @file{~/.gnus.elc}, @file{~/.gnus.el},
1511 and finally @file{~/.gnus} (in this order). If Emacs was invoked with
1512 the @option{-q} or @option{--no-init-file} options (@pxref{Initial
1513 Options, ,Initial Options, emacs, The Emacs Manual}), Gnus doesn't read
1514 @code{gnus-init-file}.
1515
1516
1517 @node Auto Save
1518 @section Auto Save
1519 @cindex dribble file
1520 @cindex auto-save
1521
1522 Whenever you do something that changes the Gnus data (reading articles,
1523 catching up, killing/subscribing groups), the change is added to a
1524 special @dfn{dribble buffer}. This buffer is auto-saved the normal
1525 Emacs way. If your Emacs should crash before you have saved the
1526 @file{.newsrc} files, all changes you have made can be recovered from
1527 this file.
1528
1529 If Gnus detects this file at startup, it will ask the user whether to
1530 read it. The auto save file is deleted whenever the real startup file is
1531 saved.
1532
1533 @vindex gnus-use-dribble-file
1534 If @code{gnus-use-dribble-file} is @code{nil}, Gnus won't create and
1535 maintain a dribble buffer. The default is @code{t}.
1536
1537 @vindex gnus-dribble-directory
1538 Gnus will put the dribble file(s) in @code{gnus-dribble-directory}. If
1539 this variable is @code{nil}, which it is by default, Gnus will dribble
1540 into the directory where the @file{.newsrc} file is located. (This is
1541 normally the user's home directory.) The dribble file will get the same
1542 file permissions as the @file{.newsrc} file.
1543
1544 @vindex gnus-always-read-dribble-file
1545 If @code{gnus-always-read-dribble-file} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will
1546 read the dribble file on startup without querying the user.
1547
1548
1549 @node The Active File
1550 @section The Active File
1551 @cindex active file
1552 @cindex ignored groups
1553
1554 When Gnus starts, or indeed whenever it tries to determine whether new
1555 articles have arrived, it reads the active file. This is a very large
1556 file that lists all the active groups and articles on the server.
1557
1558 @vindex gnus-ignored-newsgroups
1559 Before examining the active file, Gnus deletes all lines that match the
1560 regexp @code{gnus-ignored-newsgroups}. This is done primarily to reject
1561 any groups with bogus names, but you can use this variable to make Gnus
1562 ignore hierarchies you aren't ever interested in. However, this is not
1563 recommended. In fact, it's highly discouraged. Instead, @pxref{New
1564 Groups} for an overview of other variables that can be used instead.
1565
1566 @c This variable is
1567 @c @code{nil} by default, and will slow down active file handling somewhat
1568 @c if you set it to anything else.
1569
1570 @vindex gnus-read-active-file
1571 @c @head
1572 The active file can be rather Huge, so if you have a slow network, you
1573 can set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{nil} to prevent Gnus from
1574 reading the active file. This variable is @code{some} by default.
1575
1576 Gnus will try to make do by getting information just on the groups that
1577 you actually subscribe to.
1578
1579 Note that if you subscribe to lots and lots of groups, setting this
1580 variable to @code{nil} will probably make Gnus slower, not faster. At
1581 present, having this variable @code{nil} will slow Gnus down
1582 considerably, unless you read news over a 2400 baud modem.
1583
1584 This variable can also have the value @code{some}. Gnus will then
1585 attempt to read active info only on the subscribed groups. On some
1586 servers this is quite fast (on sparkling, brand new INN servers that
1587 support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command), on others this isn't fast
1588 at all. In any case, @code{some} should be faster than @code{nil}, and
1589 is certainly faster than @code{t} over slow lines.
1590
1591 Some news servers (old versions of Leafnode and old versions of INN, for
1592 instance) do not support the @code{LIST ACTIVE group}. For these
1593 servers, @code{nil} is probably the most efficient value for this
1594 variable.
1595
1596 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will ask for group info in total
1597 lock-step, which isn't very fast. If it is @code{some} and you use an
1598 @acronym{NNTP} server, Gnus will pump out commands as fast as it can, and
1599 read all the replies in one swoop. This will normally result in better
1600 performance, but if the server does not support the aforementioned
1601 @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, this isn't very nice to the server.
1602
1603 If you think that starting up Gnus takes too long, try all the three
1604 different values for this variable and see what works best for you.
1605
1606 In any case, if you use @code{some} or @code{nil}, you should definitely
1607 kill all groups that you aren't interested in to speed things up.
1608
1609 Note that this variable also affects active file retrieval from
1610 secondary select methods.
1611
1612
1613 @node Startup Variables
1614 @section Startup Variables
1615
1616 @table @code
1617
1618 @item gnus-load-hook
1619 @vindex gnus-load-hook
1620 A hook run while Gnus is being loaded. Note that this hook will
1621 normally be run just once in each Emacs session, no matter how many
1622 times you start Gnus.
1623
1624 @item gnus-before-startup-hook
1625 @vindex gnus-before-startup-hook
1626 A hook run after starting up Gnus successfully.
1627
1628 @item gnus-startup-hook
1629 @vindex gnus-startup-hook
1630 A hook run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1631
1632 @item gnus-started-hook
1633 @vindex gnus-started-hook
1634 A hook that is run as the very last thing after starting up Gnus
1635 successfully.
1636
1637 @item gnus-setup-news-hook
1638 @vindex gnus-setup-news-hook
1639 A hook that is run after reading the @file{.newsrc} file(s), but before
1640 generating the group buffer.
1641
1642 @item gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1643 @vindex gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups
1644 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will check for and delete all bogus groups at
1645 startup. A @dfn{bogus group} is a group that you have in your
1646 @file{.newsrc} file, but doesn't exist on the news server. Checking for
1647 bogus groups can take quite a while, so to save time and resources it's
1648 best to leave this option off, and do the checking for bogus groups once
1649 in a while from the group buffer instead (@pxref{Group Maintenance}).
1650
1651 @item gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1652 @vindex gnus-inhibit-startup-message
1653 If non-@code{nil}, the startup message won't be displayed. That way,
1654 your boss might not notice as easily that you are reading news instead
1655 of doing your job. Note that this variable is used before
1656 @file{~/.gnus.el} is loaded, so it should be set in @file{.emacs} instead.
1657
1658 @item gnus-no-groups-message
1659 @vindex gnus-no-groups-message
1660 Message displayed by Gnus when no groups are available.
1661
1662 @item gnus-play-startup-jingle
1663 @vindex gnus-play-startup-jingle
1664 If non-@code{nil}, play the Gnus jingle at startup.
1665
1666 @item gnus-startup-jingle
1667 @vindex gnus-startup-jingle
1668 Jingle to be played if the above variable is non-@code{nil}. The
1669 default is @samp{Tuxedomoon.Jingle4.au}.
1670
1671 @end table
1672
1673
1674 @node Group Buffer
1675 @chapter Group Buffer
1676 @cindex group buffer
1677
1678 @c Alex Schroeder suggests to rearrange this as follows:
1679 @c
1680 @c <kensanata> ok, just save it for reference. I'll go to bed in a minute.
1681 @c 1. Selecting a Group, 2. (new) Finding a Group, 3. Group Levels,
1682 @c 4. Subscription Commands, 5. Group Maneuvering, 6. Group Data,
1683 @c 7. Group Score, 8. Group Buffer Format
1684 @c <kensanata> Group Levels should have more information on levels 5 to 9. I
1685 @c suggest to split the 4th paragraph ("Gnus considers groups...") as follows:
1686 @c <kensanata> First, "Gnus considers groups... (default 9)."
1687 @c <kensanata> New, a table summarizing what levels 1 to 9 mean.
1688 @c <kensanata> Third, "Gnus treats subscribed ... reasons of efficiency"
1689 @c <kensanata> Then expand the next paragraph or add some more to it.
1690 @c This short one sentence explains levels 1 and 2, therefore I understand
1691 @c that I should keep important news at 3 and boring news at 4.
1692 @c Say so! Then go on to explain why I should bother with levels 6 to 9.
1693 @c Maybe keep those that you don't want to read temporarily at 6,
1694 @c those that you never want to read at 8, those that offend your
1695 @c human rights at 9...
1696
1697
1698 The @dfn{group buffer} lists all (or parts) of the available groups. It
1699 is the first buffer shown when Gnus starts, and will never be killed as
1700 long as Gnus is active.
1701
1702 @iftex
1703 @iflatex
1704 \gnusfigure{The Group Buffer}{320}{
1705 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group,height=9cm}}
1706 \put(120,37){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Buffer name}}
1707 \put(120,38){\vector(1,2){10}}
1708 \put(40,60){\makebox(0,0)[r]{Mode line}}
1709 \put(40,58){\vector(1,0){30}}
1710 \put(200,28){\makebox(0,0)[t]{Native select method}}
1711 \put(200,26){\vector(-1,2){15}}
1712 }
1713 @end iflatex
1714 @end iftex
1715
1716 @menu
1717 * Group Buffer Format:: Information listed and how you can change it.
1718 * Group Maneuvering:: Commands for moving in the group buffer.
1719 * Selecting a Group:: Actually reading news.
1720 * Subscription Commands:: Unsubscribing, killing, subscribing.
1721 * Group Data:: Changing the info for a group.
1722 * Group Levels:: Levels? What are those, then?
1723 * Group Score:: A mechanism for finding out what groups you like.
1724 * Marking Groups:: You can mark groups for later processing.
1725 * Foreign Groups:: Creating and editing groups.
1726 * Group Parameters:: Each group may have different parameters set.
1727 * Listing Groups:: Gnus can list various subsets of the groups.
1728 * Sorting Groups:: Re-arrange the group order.
1729 * Group Maintenance:: Maintaining a tidy @file{.newsrc} file.
1730 * Browse Foreign Server:: You can browse a server. See what it has to offer.
1731 * Exiting Gnus:: Stop reading news and get some work done.
1732 * Group Topics:: A folding group mode divided into topics.
1733 * Misc Group Stuff:: Other stuff that you can to do.
1734 @end menu
1735
1736
1737 @node Group Buffer Format
1738 @section Group Buffer Format
1739
1740 @menu
1741 * Group Line Specification:: Deciding how the group buffer is to look.
1742 * Group Mode Line Specification:: The group buffer mode line.
1743 * Group Highlighting:: Having nice colors in the group buffer.
1744 @end menu
1745
1746 You can customize the Group Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
1747 customize-apropos RET gnus-group-tool-bar}. This feature is only
1748 available in Emacs.
1749
1750 The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly depending on the
1751 cursor position. Therefore, moving around in the Group Buffer is
1752 slower. You can disable this via the variable
1753 @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}. Its default value depends on your
1754 Emacs version.
1755
1756 @node Group Line Specification
1757 @subsection Group Line Specification
1758 @cindex group buffer format
1759
1760 The default format of the group buffer is nice and dull, but you can
1761 make it as exciting and ugly as you feel like.
1762
1763 Here's a couple of example group lines:
1764
1765 @example
1766 25: news.announce.newusers
1767 * 0: alt.fan.andrea-dworkin
1768 @end example
1769
1770 Quite simple, huh?
1771
1772 You can see that there are 25 unread articles in
1773 @samp{news.announce.newusers}. There are no unread articles, but some
1774 ticked articles, in @samp{alt.fan.andrea-dworkin} (see that little
1775 asterisk at the beginning of the line?).
1776
1777 @vindex gnus-group-line-format
1778 You can change that format to whatever you want by fiddling with the
1779 @code{gnus-group-line-format} variable. This variable works along the
1780 lines of a @code{format} specification, which is pretty much the same as
1781 a @code{printf} specifications, for those of you who use (feh!) C.
1782 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
1783
1784 @samp{%M%S%5y:%B%(%g%)\n} is the value that produced those lines above.
1785
1786 There should always be a colon on the line; the cursor always moves to
1787 the colon after performing an operation. @xref{Positioning
1788 Point}. Nothing else is required---not even the group name. All
1789 displayed text is just window dressing, and is never examined by Gnus.
1790 Gnus stores all real information it needs using text properties.
1791
1792 (Note that if you make a really strange, wonderful, spreadsheet-like
1793 layout, everybody will believe you are hard at work with the accounting
1794 instead of wasting time reading news.)
1795
1796 Here's a list of all available format characters:
1797
1798 @table @samp
1799
1800 @item M
1801 An asterisk if the group only has marked articles.
1802
1803 @item S
1804 Whether the group is subscribed.
1805
1806 @item L
1807 Level of subscribedness.
1808
1809 @item N
1810 Number of unread articles.
1811
1812 @item I
1813 Number of dormant articles.
1814
1815 @item T
1816 Number of ticked articles.
1817
1818 @item R
1819 Number of read articles.
1820
1821 @item U
1822 Number of unseen articles.
1823
1824 @item t
1825 Estimated total number of articles. (This is really @var{max-number}
1826 minus @var{min-number} plus 1.)
1827
1828 Gnus uses this estimation because the @acronym{NNTP} protocol provides
1829 efficient access to @var{max-number} and @var{min-number} but getting
1830 the true unread message count is not possible efficiently. For
1831 hysterical raisins, even the mail back ends, where the true number of
1832 unread messages might be available efficiently, use the same limited
1833 interface. To remove this restriction from Gnus means that the back
1834 end interface has to be changed, which is not an easy job. If you
1835 want to work on this, please contact the Gnus mailing list.
1836
1837 @item y
1838 Number of unread, unticked, non-dormant articles.
1839
1840 @item i
1841 Number of ticked and dormant articles.
1842
1843 @item g
1844 Full group name.
1845
1846 @item G
1847 Group name.
1848
1849 @item C
1850 Group comment (@pxref{Group Parameters}) or group name if there is no
1851 comment element in the group parameters.
1852
1853 @item D
1854 Newsgroup description. You need to read the group descriptions
1855 before these will appear, and to do that, you either have to set
1856 @code{gnus-read-active-file} or use the group buffer @kbd{M-d}
1857 command.
1858
1859 @item o
1860 @samp{m} if moderated.
1861
1862 @item O
1863 @samp{(m)} if moderated.
1864
1865 @item s
1866 Select method.
1867
1868 @item B
1869 If the summary buffer for the group is open or not.
1870
1871 @item n
1872 Select from where.
1873
1874 @item z
1875 A string that looks like @samp{<%s:%n>} if a foreign select method is
1876 used.
1877
1878 @item P
1879 Indentation based on the level of the topic (@pxref{Group Topics}).
1880
1881 @item c
1882 @vindex gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels
1883 Short (collapsed) group name. The @code{gnus-group-uncollapsed-levels}
1884 variable says how many levels to leave at the end of the group name.
1885 The default is 1---this will mean that group names like
1886 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} will be shortened to @samp{g.e.gnus}.
1887
1888 @item m
1889 @vindex gnus-new-mail-mark
1890 @cindex %
1891 @samp{%} (@code{gnus-new-mail-mark}) if there has arrived new mail to
1892 the group lately.
1893
1894 @item p
1895 @samp{#} (@code{gnus-process-mark}) if the group is process marked.
1896
1897 @item d
1898 A string that says when you last read the group (@pxref{Group
1899 Timestamp}).
1900
1901 @item u
1902 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
1903 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
1904 @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where @samp{X} is the letter
1905 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed a single dummy
1906 parameter as argument. The function should return a string, which will
1907 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
1908 specifier.
1909 @end table
1910
1911 @cindex *
1912 All the ``number-of'' specs will be filled with an asterisk (@samp{*})
1913 if no info is available---for instance, if it is a non-activated foreign
1914 group, or a bogus native group.
1915
1916
1917 @node Group Mode Line Specification
1918 @subsection Group Mode Line Specification
1919 @cindex group mode line
1920
1921 @vindex gnus-group-mode-line-format
1922 The mode line can be changed by setting
1923 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}). It
1924 doesn't understand that many format specifiers:
1925
1926 @table @samp
1927 @item S
1928 The native news server.
1929 @item M
1930 The native select method.
1931 @end table
1932
1933
1934 @node Group Highlighting
1935 @subsection Group Highlighting
1936 @cindex highlighting
1937 @cindex group highlighting
1938
1939 @vindex gnus-group-highlight
1940 Highlighting in the group buffer is controlled by the
1941 @code{gnus-group-highlight} variable. This is an alist with elements
1942 that look like @code{(@var{form} . @var{face})}. If @var{form} evaluates to
1943 something non-@code{nil}, the @var{face} will be used on the line.
1944
1945 Here's an example value for this variable that might look nice if the
1946 background is dark:
1947
1948 @lisp
1949 (cond (window-system
1950 (setq custom-background-mode 'light)
1951 (defface my-group-face-1
1952 '((t (:foreground "Red" :bold t))) "First group face")
1953 (defface my-group-face-2
1954 '((t (:foreground "DarkSeaGreen4" :bold t)))
1955 "Second group face")
1956 (defface my-group-face-3
1957 '((t (:foreground "Green4" :bold t))) "Third group face")
1958 (defface my-group-face-4
1959 '((t (:foreground "SteelBlue" :bold t))) "Fourth group face")
1960 (defface my-group-face-5
1961 '((t (:foreground "Blue" :bold t))) "Fifth group face")))
1962
1963 (setq gnus-group-highlight
1964 '(((> unread 200) . my-group-face-1)
1965 ((and (< level 3) (zerop unread)) . my-group-face-2)
1966 ((< level 3) . my-group-face-3)
1967 ((zerop unread) . my-group-face-4)
1968 (t . my-group-face-5)))
1969 @end lisp
1970
1971 Also @pxref{Faces and Fonts}.
1972
1973 Variables that are dynamically bound when the forms are evaluated
1974 include:
1975
1976 @table @code
1977 @item group
1978 The group name.
1979 @item unread
1980 The number of unread articles in the group.
1981 @item method
1982 The select method.
1983 @item mailp
1984 Whether the group is a mail group.
1985 @item level
1986 The level of the group.
1987 @item score
1988 The score of the group.
1989 @item ticked
1990 The number of ticked articles in the group.
1991 @item total
1992 The total number of articles in the group. Or rather,
1993 @var{max-number} minus @var{min-number} plus one.
1994 @item topic
1995 When using the topic minor mode, this variable is bound to the current
1996 topic being inserted.
1997 @end table
1998
1999 When the forms are @code{eval}ed, point is at the beginning of the line
2000 of the group in question, so you can use many of the normal Gnus
2001 functions for snarfing info on the group.
2002
2003 @vindex gnus-group-update-hook
2004 @findex gnus-group-highlight-line
2005 @code{gnus-group-update-hook} is called when a group line is changed.
2006 It will not be called when @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}. This hook
2007 calls @code{gnus-group-highlight-line} by default.
2008
2009
2010 @node Group Maneuvering
2011 @section Group Maneuvering
2012 @cindex group movement
2013
2014 All movement commands understand the numeric prefix and will behave as
2015 expected, hopefully.
2016
2017 @table @kbd
2018
2019 @item n
2020 @kindex n (Group)
2021 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group
2022 Go to the next group that has unread articles
2023 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group}).
2024
2025 @item p
2026 @itemx DEL
2027 @kindex DEL (Group)
2028 @kindex p (Group)
2029 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group
2030 Go to the previous group that has unread articles
2031 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group}).
2032
2033 @item N
2034 @kindex N (Group)
2035 @findex gnus-group-next-group
2036 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
2037
2038 @item P
2039 @kindex P (Group)
2040 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
2041 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
2042
2043 @item M-n
2044 @kindex M-n (Group)
2045 @findex gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level
2046 Go to the next unread group on the same (or lower) level
2047 (@code{gnus-group-next-unread-group-same-level}).
2048
2049 @item M-p
2050 @kindex M-p (Group)
2051 @findex gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level
2052 Go to the previous unread group on the same (or lower) level
2053 (@code{gnus-group-prev-unread-group-same-level}).
2054 @end table
2055
2056 Three commands for jumping to groups:
2057
2058 @table @kbd
2059
2060 @item j
2061 @kindex j (Group)
2062 @findex gnus-group-jump-to-group
2063 Jump to a group (and make it visible if it isn't already)
2064 (@code{gnus-group-jump-to-group}). Killed groups can be jumped to, just
2065 like living groups.
2066
2067 @item ,
2068 @kindex , (Group)
2069 @findex gnus-group-best-unread-group
2070 Jump to the unread group with the lowest level
2071 (@code{gnus-group-best-unread-group}).
2072
2073 @item .
2074 @kindex . (Group)
2075 @findex gnus-group-first-unread-group
2076 Jump to the first group with unread articles
2077 (@code{gnus-group-first-unread-group}).
2078 @end table
2079
2080 @vindex gnus-group-goto-unread
2081 If @code{gnus-group-goto-unread} is @code{nil}, all the movement
2082 commands will move to the next group, not the next unread group. Even
2083 the commands that say they move to the next unread group. The default
2084 is @code{t}.
2085
2086
2087 @node Selecting a Group
2088 @section Selecting a Group
2089 @cindex group selection
2090
2091 @table @kbd
2092
2093 @item SPACE
2094 @kindex SPACE (Group)
2095 @findex gnus-group-read-group
2096 Select the current group, switch to the summary buffer and display the
2097 first unread article (@code{gnus-group-read-group}). If there are no
2098 unread articles in the group, or if you give a non-numerical prefix to
2099 this command, Gnus will offer to fetch all the old articles in this
2100 group from the server. If you give a numerical prefix @var{n}, @var{n}
2101 determines the number of articles Gnus will fetch. If @var{n} is
2102 positive, Gnus fetches the @var{n} newest articles, if @var{n} is
2103 negative, Gnus fetches the @code{abs(@var{n})} oldest articles.
2104
2105 Thus, @kbd{SPC} enters the group normally, @kbd{C-u SPC} offers old
2106 articles, @kbd{C-u 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 newest articles, and @kbd{C-u
2107 - 4 2 SPC} fetches the 42 oldest ones.
2108
2109 When you are in the group (in the Summary buffer), you can type
2110 @kbd{M-g} to fetch new articles, or @kbd{C-u M-g} to also show the old
2111 ones.
2112
2113 @item RET
2114 @kindex RET (Group)
2115 @findex gnus-group-select-group
2116 Select the current group and switch to the summary buffer
2117 (@code{gnus-group-select-group}). Takes the same arguments as
2118 @code{gnus-group-read-group}---the only difference is that this command
2119 does not display the first unread article automatically upon group
2120 entry.
2121
2122 @item M-RET
2123 @kindex M-RET (Group)
2124 @findex gnus-group-quick-select-group
2125 This does the same as the command above, but tries to do it with the
2126 minimum amount of fuzz (@code{gnus-group-quick-select-group}). No
2127 scoring/killing will be performed, there will be no highlights and no
2128 expunging. This might be useful if you're in a real hurry and have to
2129 enter some humongous group. If you give a 0 prefix to this command
2130 (i.e., @kbd{0 M-RET}), Gnus won't even generate the summary buffer,
2131 which is useful if you want to toggle threading before generating the
2132 summary buffer (@pxref{Summary Generation Commands}).
2133
2134 @item M-SPACE
2135 @kindex M-SPACE (Group)
2136 @findex gnus-group-visible-select-group
2137 This is yet one more command that does the same as the @kbd{RET}
2138 command, but this one does it without expunging and hiding dormants
2139 (@code{gnus-group-visible-select-group}).
2140
2141 @item C-M-RET
2142 @kindex C-M-RET (Group)
2143 @findex gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally
2144 Finally, this command selects the current group ephemerally without
2145 doing any processing of its contents
2146 (@code{gnus-group-select-group-ephemerally}). Even threading has been
2147 turned off. Everything you do in the group after selecting it in this
2148 manner will have no permanent effects.
2149
2150 @end table
2151
2152 @vindex gnus-large-newsgroup
2153 The @code{gnus-large-newsgroup} variable says what Gnus should
2154 consider to be a big group. If it is @code{nil}, no groups are
2155 considered big. The default value is 200. If the group has more
2156 (unread and/or ticked) articles than this, Gnus will query the user
2157 before entering the group. The user can then specify how many
2158 articles should be fetched from the server. If the user specifies a
2159 negative number (@var{-n}), the @var{n} oldest articles will be
2160 fetched. If it is positive, the @var{n} articles that have arrived
2161 most recently will be fetched.
2162
2163 @vindex gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup
2164 @code{gnus-large-ephemeral-newsgroup} is the same as
2165 @code{gnus-large-newsgroup}, but is only used for ephemeral
2166 newsgroups.
2167
2168 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles
2169 In groups in some news servers, there might be a big gap between a few
2170 very old articles that will never be expired and the recent ones. In
2171 such a case, the server will return the data like @code{(1 . 30000000)}
2172 for the @code{LIST ACTIVE group} command, for example. Even if there
2173 are actually only the articles 1-10 and 29999900-30000000, Gnus doesn't
2174 know it at first and prepares for getting 30000000 articles. However,
2175 it will consume hundreds megabytes of memories and might make Emacs get
2176 stuck as the case may be. If you use such news servers, set the
2177 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} to a positive number.
2178 The value means that Gnus ignores articles other than this number of the
2179 latest ones in every group. For instance, the value 10000 makes Gnus
2180 get only the articles 29990001-30000000 (if the latest article number is
2181 30000000 in a group). Note that setting this variable to a number might
2182 prevent you from reading very old articles. The default value of the
2183 variable @code{gnus-newsgroup-maximum-articles} is @code{nil}, which
2184 means Gnus never ignores old articles.
2185
2186 @vindex gnus-select-group-hook
2187 @vindex gnus-auto-select-first
2188 @vindex gnus-auto-select-subject
2189 If @code{gnus-auto-select-first} is non-@code{nil}, select an article
2190 automatically when entering a group with the @kbd{SPACE} command.
2191 Which article this is is controlled by the
2192 @code{gnus-auto-select-subject} variable. Valid values for this
2193 variable are:
2194
2195 @table @code
2196
2197 @item unread
2198 Place point on the subject line of the first unread article.
2199
2200 @item first
2201 Place point on the subject line of the first article.
2202
2203 @item unseen
2204 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article.
2205
2206 @item unseen-or-unread
2207 Place point on the subject line of the first unseen article, and if
2208 there is no such article, place point on the subject line of the first
2209 unread article.
2210
2211 @item best
2212 Place point on the subject line of the highest-scored unread article.
2213
2214 @end table
2215
2216 This variable can also be a function. In that case, that function
2217 will be called to place point on a subject line.
2218
2219 If you want to prevent automatic selection in some group (say, in a
2220 binary group with Huge articles) you can set the
2221 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} variable to @code{nil} in
2222 @code{gnus-select-group-hook}, which is called when a group is
2223 selected.
2224
2225
2226 @node Subscription Commands
2227 @section Subscription Commands
2228 @cindex subscription
2229
2230 @table @kbd
2231
2232 @item S t
2233 @itemx u
2234 @kindex S t (Group)
2235 @kindex u (Group)
2236 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group
2237 @c @icon{gnus-group-unsubscribe}
2238 Toggle subscription to the current group
2239 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-current-group}).
2240
2241 @item S s
2242 @itemx U
2243 @kindex S s (Group)
2244 @kindex U (Group)
2245 @findex gnus-group-unsubscribe-group
2246 Prompt for a group to subscribe, and then subscribe it. If it was
2247 subscribed already, unsubscribe it instead
2248 (@code{gnus-group-unsubscribe-group}).
2249
2250 @item S k
2251 @itemx C-k
2252 @kindex S k (Group)
2253 @kindex C-k (Group)
2254 @findex gnus-group-kill-group
2255 @c @icon{gnus-group-kill-group}
2256 Kill the current group (@code{gnus-group-kill-group}).
2257
2258 @item S y
2259 @itemx C-y
2260 @kindex S y (Group)
2261 @kindex C-y (Group)
2262 @findex gnus-group-yank-group
2263 Yank the last killed group (@code{gnus-group-yank-group}).
2264
2265 @item C-x C-t
2266 @kindex C-x C-t (Group)
2267 @findex gnus-group-transpose-groups
2268 Transpose two groups (@code{gnus-group-transpose-groups}). This isn't
2269 really a subscription command, but you can use it instead of a
2270 kill-and-yank sequence sometimes.
2271
2272 @item S w
2273 @itemx C-w
2274 @kindex S w (Group)
2275 @kindex C-w (Group)
2276 @findex gnus-group-kill-region
2277 Kill all groups in the region (@code{gnus-group-kill-region}).
2278
2279 @item S z
2280 @kindex S z (Group)
2281 @findex gnus-group-kill-all-zombies
2282 Kill all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-kill-all-zombies}).
2283
2284 @item S C-k
2285 @kindex S C-k (Group)
2286 @findex gnus-group-kill-level
2287 Kill all groups on a certain level (@code{gnus-group-kill-level}).
2288 These groups can't be yanked back after killing, so this command should
2289 be used with some caution. The only time where this command comes in
2290 really handy is when you have a @file{.newsrc} with lots of unsubscribed
2291 groups that you want to get rid off. @kbd{S C-k} on level 7 will
2292 kill off all unsubscribed groups that do not have message numbers in the
2293 @file{.newsrc} file.
2294
2295 @end table
2296
2297 Also @pxref{Group Levels}.
2298
2299
2300 @node Group Data
2301 @section Group Data
2302
2303 @table @kbd
2304
2305 @item c
2306 @kindex c (Group)
2307 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current
2308 @vindex gnus-group-catchup-group-hook
2309 @c @icon{gnus-group-catchup-current}
2310 Mark all unticked articles in this group as read
2311 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current}).
2312 @code{gnus-group-catchup-group-hook} is called when catching up a group from
2313 the group buffer.
2314
2315 @item C
2316 @kindex C (Group)
2317 @findex gnus-group-catchup-current-all
2318 Mark all articles in this group, even the ticked ones, as read
2319 (@code{gnus-group-catchup-current-all}).
2320
2321 @item M-c
2322 @kindex M-c (Group)
2323 @findex gnus-group-clear-data
2324 Clear the data from the current group---nix out marks and the list of
2325 read articles (@code{gnus-group-clear-data}).
2326
2327 @item M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2328 @kindex M-x gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2329 @findex gnus-group-clear-data-on-native-groups
2330 If you have switched from one @acronym{NNTP} server to another, all your marks
2331 and read ranges have become worthless. You can use this command to
2332 clear out all data that you have on your native groups. Use with
2333 caution.
2334
2335 @end table
2336
2337
2338 @node Group Levels
2339 @section Group Levels
2340 @cindex group level
2341 @cindex level
2342
2343 All groups have a level of @dfn{subscribedness}. For instance, if a
2344 group is on level 2, it is more subscribed than a group on level 5. You
2345 can ask Gnus to just list groups on a given level or lower
2346 (@pxref{Listing Groups}), or to just check for new articles in groups on
2347 a given level or lower (@pxref{Scanning New Messages}).
2348
2349 Remember: The higher the level of the group, the less important it is.
2350
2351 @table @kbd
2352
2353 @item S l
2354 @kindex S l (Group)
2355 @findex gnus-group-set-current-level
2356 Set the level of the current group. If a numeric prefix is given, the
2357 next @var{n} groups will have their levels set. The user will be
2358 prompted for a level.
2359 @end table
2360
2361 @vindex gnus-level-killed
2362 @vindex gnus-level-zombie
2363 @vindex gnus-level-unsubscribed
2364 @vindex gnus-level-subscribed
2365 Gnus considers groups from levels 1 to
2366 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (inclusive) (default 5) to be subscribed,
2367 @code{gnus-level-subscribed} (exclusive) and
2368 @code{gnus-level-unsubscribed} (inclusive) (default 7) to be
2369 unsubscribed, @code{gnus-level-zombie} to be zombies (walking dead)
2370 (default 8) and @code{gnus-level-killed} to be killed (completely dead)
2371 (default 9). Gnus treats subscribed and unsubscribed groups exactly the
2372 same, but zombie and killed groups have no information on what articles
2373 you have read, etc, stored. This distinction between dead and living
2374 groups isn't done because it is nice or clever, it is done purely for
2375 reasons of efficiency.
2376
2377 It is recommended that you keep all your mail groups (if any) on quite
2378 low levels (e.g. 1 or 2).
2379
2380 Maybe the following description of the default behavior of Gnus helps to
2381 understand what these levels are all about. By default, Gnus shows you
2382 subscribed nonempty groups, but by hitting @kbd{L} you can have it show
2383 empty subscribed groups and unsubscribed groups, too. Type @kbd{l} to
2384 go back to showing nonempty subscribed groups again. Thus, unsubscribed
2385 groups are hidden, in a way.
2386
2387 Zombie and killed groups are similar to unsubscribed groups in that they
2388 are hidden by default. But they are different from subscribed and
2389 unsubscribed groups in that Gnus doesn't ask the news server for
2390 information (number of messages, number of unread messages) on zombie
2391 and killed groups. Normally, you use @kbd{C-k} to kill the groups you
2392 aren't interested in. If most groups are killed, Gnus is faster.
2393
2394 Why does Gnus distinguish between zombie and killed groups? Well, when
2395 a new group arrives on the server, Gnus by default makes it a zombie
2396 group. This means that you are normally not bothered with new groups,
2397 but you can type @kbd{A z} to get a list of all new groups. Subscribe
2398 the ones you like and kill the ones you don't want. (@kbd{A k} shows a
2399 list of killed groups.)
2400
2401 If you want to play with the level variables, you should show some care.
2402 Set them once, and don't touch them ever again. Better yet, don't touch
2403 them at all unless you know exactly what you're doing.
2404
2405 @vindex gnus-level-default-unsubscribed
2406 @vindex gnus-level-default-subscribed
2407 Two closely related variables are @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}
2408 (default 3) and @code{gnus-level-default-unsubscribed} (default 6),
2409 which are the levels that new groups will be put on if they are
2410 (un)subscribed. These two variables should, of course, be inside the
2411 relevant valid ranges.
2412
2413 @vindex gnus-keep-same-level
2414 If @code{gnus-keep-same-level} is non-@code{nil}, some movement commands
2415 will only move to groups of the same level (or lower). In
2416 particular, going from the last article in one group to the next group
2417 will go to the next group of the same level (or lower). This might be
2418 handy if you want to read the most important groups before you read the
2419 rest.
2420
2421 If this variable is @code{best}, Gnus will make the next newsgroup the
2422 one with the best level.
2423
2424 @vindex gnus-group-default-list-level
2425 All groups with a level less than or equal to
2426 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level} will be listed in the group buffer
2427 by default.
2428
2429 @vindex gnus-group-list-inactive-groups
2430 If @code{gnus-group-list-inactive-groups} is non-@code{nil}, non-active
2431 groups will be listed along with the unread groups. This variable is
2432 @code{t} by default. If it is @code{nil}, inactive groups won't be
2433 listed.
2434
2435 @vindex gnus-group-use-permanent-levels
2436 If @code{gnus-group-use-permanent-levels} is non-@code{nil}, once you
2437 give a level prefix to @kbd{g} or @kbd{l}, all subsequent commands will
2438 use this level as the ``work'' level.
2439
2440 @vindex gnus-activate-level
2441 Gnus will normally just activate (i. e., query the server about) groups
2442 on level @code{gnus-activate-level} or less. If you don't want to
2443 activate unsubscribed groups, for instance, you might set this variable
2444 to 5. The default is 6.
2445
2446
2447 @node Group Score
2448 @section Group Score
2449 @cindex group score
2450 @cindex group rank
2451 @cindex rank
2452
2453 You would normally keep important groups on high levels, but that scheme
2454 is somewhat restrictive. Don't you wish you could have Gnus sort the
2455 group buffer according to how often you read groups, perhaps? Within
2456 reason?
2457
2458 This is what @dfn{group score} is for. You can have Gnus assign a score
2459 to each group through the mechanism described below. You can then sort
2460 the group buffer based on this score. Alternatively, you can sort on
2461 score and then level. (Taken together, the level and the score is
2462 called the @dfn{rank} of the group. A group that is on level 4 and has
2463 a score of 1 has a higher rank than a group on level 5 that has a score
2464 of 300. (The level is the most significant part and the score is the
2465 least significant part.))
2466
2467 @findex gnus-summary-bubble-group
2468 If you want groups you read often to get higher scores than groups you
2469 read seldom you can add the @code{gnus-summary-bubble-group} function to
2470 the @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} hook. This will result (after
2471 sorting) in a bubbling sort of action. If you want to see that in
2472 action after each summary exit, you can add
2473 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank} or
2474 @code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score} to the same hook, but that will
2475 slow things down somewhat.
2476
2477
2478 @node Marking Groups
2479 @section Marking Groups
2480 @cindex marking groups
2481
2482 If you want to perform some command on several groups, and they appear
2483 subsequently in the group buffer, you would normally just give a
2484 numerical prefix to the command. Most group commands will then do your
2485 bidding on those groups.
2486
2487 However, if the groups are not in sequential order, you can still
2488 perform a command on several groups. You simply mark the groups first
2489 with the process mark and then execute the command.
2490
2491 @table @kbd
2492
2493 @item #
2494 @kindex # (Group)
2495 @itemx M m
2496 @kindex M m (Group)
2497 @findex gnus-group-mark-group
2498 Set the mark on the current group (@code{gnus-group-mark-group}).
2499
2500 @item M-#
2501 @kindex M-# (Group)
2502 @itemx M u
2503 @kindex M u (Group)
2504 @findex gnus-group-unmark-group
2505 Remove the mark from the current group
2506 (@code{gnus-group-unmark-group}).
2507
2508 @item M U
2509 @kindex M U (Group)
2510 @findex gnus-group-unmark-all-groups
2511 Remove the mark from all groups (@code{gnus-group-unmark-all-groups}).
2512
2513 @item M w
2514 @kindex M w (Group)
2515 @findex gnus-group-mark-region
2516 Mark all groups between point and mark (@code{gnus-group-mark-region}).
2517
2518 @item M b
2519 @kindex M b (Group)
2520 @findex gnus-group-mark-buffer
2521 Mark all groups in the buffer (@code{gnus-group-mark-buffer}).
2522
2523 @item M r
2524 @kindex M r (Group)
2525 @findex gnus-group-mark-regexp
2526 Mark all groups that match some regular expression
2527 (@code{gnus-group-mark-regexp}).
2528 @end table
2529
2530 Also @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
2531
2532 @findex gnus-group-universal-argument
2533 If you want to execute some command on all groups that have been marked
2534 with the process mark, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
2535 (@code{gnus-group-universal-argument}) command. It will prompt you for
2536 the command to be executed.
2537
2538
2539 @node Foreign Groups
2540 @section Foreign Groups
2541 @cindex foreign groups
2542
2543 Below are some group mode commands for making and editing general foreign
2544 groups, as well as commands to ease the creation of a few
2545 special-purpose groups. All these commands insert the newly created
2546 groups under point---@code{gnus-subscribe-newsgroup-method} is not
2547 consulted.
2548
2549 Changes from the group editing commands are stored in
2550 @file{~/.newsrc.eld} (@code{gnus-startup-file}). An alternative is the
2551 variable @code{gnus-parameters}, @xref{Group Parameters}.
2552
2553 @table @kbd
2554
2555 @item G m
2556 @kindex G m (Group)
2557 @findex gnus-group-make-group
2558 @cindex making groups
2559 Make a new group (@code{gnus-group-make-group}). Gnus will prompt you
2560 for a name, a method and possibly an @dfn{address}. For an easier way
2561 to subscribe to @acronym{NNTP} groups (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
2562
2563 @item G M
2564 @kindex G M (Group)
2565 @findex gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group
2566 Make an ephemeral group (@code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group}). Gnus
2567 will prompt you for a name, a method and an @dfn{address}.
2568
2569 @item G r
2570 @kindex G r (Group)
2571 @findex gnus-group-rename-group
2572 @cindex renaming groups
2573 Rename the current group to something else
2574 (@code{gnus-group-rename-group}). This is valid only on some
2575 groups---mail groups mostly. This command might very well be quite slow
2576 on some back ends.
2577
2578 @item G c
2579 @kindex G c (Group)
2580 @cindex customizing
2581 @findex gnus-group-customize
2582 Customize the group parameters (@code{gnus-group-customize}).
2583
2584 @item G e
2585 @kindex G e (Group)
2586 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-method
2587 @cindex renaming groups
2588 Enter a buffer where you can edit the select method of the current
2589 group (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method}).
2590
2591 @item G p
2592 @kindex G p (Group)
2593 @findex gnus-group-edit-group-parameters
2594 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group parameters
2595 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-parameters}).
2596
2597 @item G E
2598 @kindex G E (Group)
2599 @findex gnus-group-edit-group
2600 Enter a buffer where you can edit the group info
2601 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group}).
2602
2603 @item G d
2604 @kindex G d (Group)
2605 @findex gnus-group-make-directory-group
2606 @cindex nndir
2607 Make a directory group (@pxref{Directory Groups}). You will be prompted
2608 for a directory name (@code{gnus-group-make-directory-group}).
2609
2610 @item G h
2611 @kindex G h (Group)
2612 @cindex help group
2613 @findex gnus-group-make-help-group
2614 Make the Gnus help group (@code{gnus-group-make-help-group}).
2615
2616 @item G a
2617 @kindex G a (Group)
2618 @cindex (ding) archive
2619 @cindex archive group
2620 @findex gnus-group-make-archive-group
2621 @vindex gnus-group-archive-directory
2622 @vindex gnus-group-recent-archive-directory
2623 Make a Gnus archive group (@code{gnus-group-make-archive-group}). By
2624 default a group pointing to the most recent articles will be created
2625 (@code{gnus-group-recent-archive-directory}), but given a prefix, a full
2626 group will be created from @code{gnus-group-archive-directory}.
2627
2628 @item G k
2629 @kindex G k (Group)
2630 @findex gnus-group-make-kiboze-group
2631 @cindex nnkiboze
2632 Make a kiboze group. You will be prompted for a name, for a regexp to
2633 match groups to be ``included'' in the kiboze group, and a series of
2634 strings to match on headers (@code{gnus-group-make-kiboze-group}).
2635 @xref{Kibozed Groups}.
2636
2637 @item G D
2638 @kindex G D (Group)
2639 @findex gnus-group-enter-directory
2640 @cindex nneething
2641 Read an arbitrary directory as if it were a newsgroup with the
2642 @code{nneething} back end (@code{gnus-group-enter-directory}).
2643 @xref{Anything Groups}.
2644
2645 @item G f
2646 @kindex G f (Group)
2647 @findex gnus-group-make-doc-group
2648 @cindex ClariNet Briefs
2649 @cindex nndoc
2650 Make a group based on some file or other
2651 (@code{gnus-group-make-doc-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2652 command, you will be prompted for a file name and a file type.
2653 Currently supported types are @code{mbox}, @code{babyl},
2654 @code{digest}, @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward},
2655 @code{rfc934}, @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts},
2656 @code{standard-digest}, @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs},
2657 @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook}, @code{oe-dbx}, and @code{mailman}. If
2658 you run this command without a prefix, Gnus will guess at the file
2659 type. @xref{Document Groups}.
2660
2661 @item G u
2662 @kindex G u (Group)
2663 @vindex gnus-useful-groups
2664 @findex gnus-group-make-useful-group
2665 Create one of the groups mentioned in @code{gnus-useful-groups}
2666 (@code{gnus-group-make-useful-group}).
2667
2668 @item G w
2669 @kindex G w (Group)
2670 @findex gnus-group-make-web-group
2671 @cindex Google
2672 @cindex nnweb
2673 @cindex gmane
2674 Make an ephemeral group based on a web search
2675 (@code{gnus-group-make-web-group}). If you give a prefix to this
2676 command, make a solid group instead. You will be prompted for the
2677 search engine type and the search string. Valid search engine types
2678 include @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}.
2679 @xref{Web Searches}.
2680
2681 If you use the @code{google} search engine, you can limit the search
2682 to a particular group by using a match string like
2683 @samp{shaving group:alt.sysadmin.recovery}.
2684
2685 @item G R
2686 @kindex G R (Group)
2687 @findex gnus-group-make-rss-group
2688 Make a group based on an @acronym{RSS} feed
2689 (@code{gnus-group-make-rss-group}). You will be prompted for an URL.
2690 @xref{RSS}.
2691
2692 @item G DEL
2693 @kindex G DEL (Group)
2694 @findex gnus-group-delete-group
2695 This function will delete the current group
2696 (@code{gnus-group-delete-group}). If given a prefix, this function will
2697 actually delete all the articles in the group, and forcibly remove the
2698 group itself from the face of the Earth. Use a prefix only if you are
2699 absolutely sure of what you are doing. This command can't be used on
2700 read-only groups (like @code{nntp} groups), though.
2701
2702 @item G V
2703 @kindex G V (Group)
2704 @findex gnus-group-make-empty-virtual
2705 Make a new, fresh, empty @code{nnvirtual} group
2706 (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}). @xref{Virtual Groups}.
2707
2708 @item G v
2709 @kindex G v (Group)
2710 @findex gnus-group-add-to-virtual
2711 Add the current group to an @code{nnvirtual} group
2712 (@code{gnus-group-add-to-virtual}). Uses the process/prefix convention.
2713 @end table
2714
2715 @xref{Select Methods}, for more information on the various select
2716 methods.
2717
2718 @vindex gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups
2719 If @code{gnus-activate-foreign-newsgroups} is a positive number,
2720 Gnus will check all foreign groups with this level or lower at startup.
2721 This might take quite a while, especially if you subscribe to lots of
2722 groups from different @acronym{NNTP} servers. Also @pxref{Group Levels};
2723 @code{gnus-activate-level} also affects activation of foreign
2724 newsgroups.
2725
2726
2727 @node Group Parameters
2728 @section Group Parameters
2729 @cindex group parameters
2730
2731 The group parameters store information local to a particular group.
2732
2733 Use the @kbd{G p} or the @kbd{G c} command to edit group parameters of a
2734 group. (@kbd{G p} presents you with a Lisp-based interface, @kbd{G c}
2735 presents you with a Customize-like interface. The latter helps avoid
2736 silly Lisp errors.) You might also be interested in reading about topic
2737 parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}).
2738 Additionally, you can set group parameters via the
2739 @code{gnus-parameters} variable, see below.
2740
2741 Here's an example group parameter list:
2742
2743 @example
2744 ((to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")
2745 (auto-expire . t))
2746 @end example
2747
2748 We see that each element consists of a ``dotted pair''---the thing before
2749 the dot is the key, while the thing after the dot is the value. All the
2750 parameters have this form @emph{except} local variable specs, which are
2751 not dotted pairs, but proper lists.
2752
2753 Some parameters have correspondent customizable variables, each of which
2754 is an alist of regexps and values.
2755
2756 The following group parameters can be used:
2757
2758 @table @code
2759 @item to-address
2760 @cindex to-address
2761 Address used by when doing followups and new posts.
2762
2763 @example
2764 (to-address . "some@@where.com")
2765 @end example
2766
2767 This is primarily useful in mail groups that represent closed mailing
2768 lists---mailing lists where it's expected that everybody that writes to
2769 the mailing list is subscribed to it. Since using this parameter
2770 ensures that the mail only goes to the mailing list itself, it means
2771 that members won't receive two copies of your followups.
2772
2773 Using @code{to-address} will actually work whether the group is foreign
2774 or not. Let's say there's a group on the server that is called
2775 @samp{fa.4ad-l}. This is a real newsgroup, but the server has gotten
2776 the articles from a mail-to-news gateway. Posting directly to this
2777 group is therefore impossible---you have to send mail to the mailing
2778 list address instead.
2779
2780 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-address-alist}.
2781
2782 @item to-list
2783 @cindex to-list
2784 Address used when doing @kbd{a} in that group.
2785
2786 @example
2787 (to-list . "some@@where.com")
2788 @end example
2789
2790 It is totally ignored
2791 when doing a followup---except that if it is present in a news group,
2792 you'll get mail group semantics when doing @kbd{f}.
2793
2794 If you do an @kbd{a} command in a mail group and you have neither a
2795 @code{to-list} group parameter nor a @code{to-address} group parameter,
2796 then a @code{to-list} group parameter will be added automatically upon
2797 sending the message if @code{gnus-add-to-list} is set to @code{t}.
2798 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
2799
2800 @findex gnus-mailing-list-mode
2801 @cindex mail list groups
2802 If this variable is set, @code{gnus-mailing-list-mode} is turned on when
2803 entering summary buffer.
2804
2805 See also @code{gnus-parameter-to-list-alist}.
2806
2807 @anchor{subscribed}
2808 @item subscribed
2809 @cindex subscribed
2810 @cindex Mail-Followup-To
2811 @findex gnus-find-subscribed-addresses
2812 If this parameter is set to @code{t}, Gnus will consider the
2813 to-address and to-list parameters for this group as addresses of
2814 mailing lists you are subscribed to. Giving Gnus this information is
2815 (only) a first step in getting it to generate correct Mail-Followup-To
2816 headers for your posts to these lists. The second step is to put the
2817 following in your @file{.gnus.el}
2818
2819 @lisp
2820 (setq message-subscribed-address-functions
2821 '(gnus-find-subscribed-addresses))
2822 @end lisp
2823
2824 @xref{Mailing Lists, ,Mailing Lists, message, The Message Manual}, for
2825 a complete treatment of available MFT support.
2826
2827 @item visible
2828 @cindex visible
2829 If the group parameter list has the element @code{(visible . t)},
2830 that group will always be visible in the Group buffer, regardless
2831 of whether it has any unread articles.
2832
2833 This parameter cannot be set via @code{gnus-parameters}. See
2834 @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.
2835
2836 @item broken-reply-to
2837 @cindex broken-reply-to
2838 Elements like @code{(broken-reply-to . t)} signals that @code{Reply-To}
2839 headers in this group are to be ignored, and for the header to be hidden
2840 if @code{reply-to} is part of @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}. This
2841 can be useful if you're reading a mailing list group where the listserv
2842 has inserted @code{Reply-To} headers that point back to the listserv
2843 itself. That is broken behavior. So there!
2844
2845 @item to-group
2846 @cindex to-group
2847 Elements like @code{(to-group . "some.group.name")} means that all
2848 posts in that group will be sent to @code{some.group.name}.
2849
2850 @item newsgroup
2851 @cindex newsgroup
2852 If you have @code{(newsgroup . t)} in the group parameter list, Gnus
2853 will treat all responses as if they were responses to news articles.
2854 This can be useful if you have a mail group that's really a mirror of a
2855 news group.
2856
2857 @item gcc-self
2858 @cindex gcc-self
2859 If @code{(gcc-self . t)} is present in the group parameter list, newly
2860 composed messages will be @code{Gcc}'d to the current group. If
2861 @code{(gcc-self . none)} is present, no @code{Gcc:} header will be
2862 generated, if @code{(gcc-self . "string")} is present, this string will
2863 be inserted literally as a @code{gcc} header. This parameter takes
2864 precedence over any default @code{Gcc} rules as described later
2865 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
2866
2867 @strong{Caveat}: Adding @code{(gcc-self . t)} to the parameter list of
2868 @code{nntp} groups (or the like) isn't valid. An @code{nntp} server
2869 doesn't accept articles.
2870
2871 @item auto-expire
2872 @cindex auto-expire
2873 @cindex expiring mail
2874 If the group parameter has an element that looks like @code{(auto-expire
2875 . t)}, all articles read will be marked as expirable. For an
2876 alternative approach, @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
2877
2878 See also @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups}.
2879
2880 @item total-expire
2881 @cindex total-expire
2882 @cindex expiring mail
2883 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2884 @code{(total-expire . t)}, all read articles will be put through the
2885 expiry process, even if they are not marked as expirable. Use with
2886 caution. Unread, ticked and dormant articles are not eligible for
2887 expiry.
2888
2889 See also @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups}.
2890
2891 @item expiry-wait
2892 @cindex expiry-wait
2893 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
2894 If the group parameter has an element that looks like
2895 @code{(expiry-wait . 10)}, this value will override any
2896 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} and @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function}
2897 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}) when expiring expirable messages. The value
2898 can either be a number of days (not necessarily an integer) or the
2899 symbols @code{never} or @code{immediate}.
2900
2901 @item expiry-target
2902 @cindex expiry-target
2903 Where expired messages end up. This parameter overrides
2904 @code{nnmail-expiry-target}.
2905
2906 @item score-file
2907 @cindex score file group parameter
2908 Elements that look like @code{(score-file . "file")} will make
2909 @file{file} into the current score file for the group in question. All
2910 interactive score entries will be put into this file.
2911
2912 @item adapt-file
2913 @cindex adapt file group parameter
2914 Elements that look like @code{(adapt-file . "file")} will make
2915 @file{file} into the current adaptive file for the group in question.
2916 All adaptive score entries will be put into this file.
2917
2918 @item admin-address
2919 @cindex admin-address
2920 When unsubscribing from a mailing list you should never send the
2921 unsubscription notice to the mailing list itself. Instead, you'd send
2922 messages to the administrative address. This parameter allows you to
2923 put the admin address somewhere convenient.
2924
2925 @item display
2926 @cindex display
2927 Elements that look like @code{(display . MODE)} say which articles to
2928 display on entering the group. Valid values are:
2929
2930 @table @code
2931 @item all
2932 Display all articles, both read and unread.
2933
2934 @item an integer
2935 Display the last @var{integer} articles in the group. This is the same as
2936 entering the group with @kbd{C-u @var{integer}}.
2937
2938 @item default
2939 Display the default visible articles, which normally includes unread and
2940 ticked articles.
2941
2942 @item an array
2943 Display articles that satisfy a predicate.
2944
2945 Here are some examples:
2946
2947 @table @code
2948 @item [unread]
2949 Display only unread articles.
2950
2951 @item [not expire]
2952 Display everything except expirable articles.
2953
2954 @item [and (not reply) (not expire)]
2955 Display everything except expirable and articles you've already
2956 responded to.
2957 @end table
2958
2959 The available operators are @code{not}, @code{and} and @code{or}.
2960 Predicates include @code{tick}, @code{unsend}, @code{undownload},
2961 @code{unread}, @code{dormant}, @code{expire}, @code{reply},
2962 @code{killed}, @code{bookmark}, @code{score}, @code{save},
2963 @code{cache}, @code{forward}, @code{unseen} and @code{recent}.
2964
2965 @end table
2966
2967 The @code{display} parameter works by limiting the summary buffer to
2968 the subset specified. You can pop the limit by using the @kbd{/ w}
2969 command (@pxref{Limiting}).
2970
2971 @item comment
2972 @cindex comment
2973 Elements that look like @code{(comment . "This is a comment")} are
2974 arbitrary comments on the group. You can display comments in the
2975 group line (@pxref{Group Line Specification}).
2976
2977 @item charset
2978 @cindex charset
2979 Elements that look like @code{(charset . iso-8859-1)} will make
2980 @code{iso-8859-1} the default charset; that is, the charset that will be
2981 used for all articles that do not specify a charset.
2982
2983 See also @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}.
2984
2985 @item ignored-charsets
2986 @cindex ignored-charset
2987 Elements that look like @code{(ignored-charsets x-unknown iso-8859-1)}
2988 will make @code{iso-8859-1} and @code{x-unknown} ignored; that is, the
2989 default charset will be used for decoding articles.
2990
2991 See also @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
2992
2993 @item posting-style
2994 @cindex posting-style
2995 You can store additional posting style information for this group
2996 here (@pxref{Posting Styles}). The format is that of an entry in the
2997 @code{gnus-posting-styles} alist, except that there's no regexp matching
2998 the group name (of course). Style elements in this group parameter will
2999 take precedence over the ones found in @code{gnus-posting-styles}.
3000
3001 For instance, if you want a funky name and signature in this group only,
3002 instead of hacking @code{gnus-posting-styles}, you could put something
3003 like this in the group parameters:
3004
3005 @example
3006 (posting-style
3007 (name "Funky Name")
3008 ("X-My-Header" "Funky Value")
3009 (signature "Funky Signature"))
3010 @end example
3011
3012 @item post-method
3013 @cindex post-method
3014 If it is set, the value is used as the method for posting message
3015 instead of @code{gnus-post-method}.
3016
3017 @item banner
3018 @cindex banner
3019 An item like @code{(banner . @var{regexp})} causes any part of an article
3020 that matches the regular expression @var{regexp} to be stripped. Instead of
3021 @var{regexp}, you can also use the symbol @code{signature} which strips the
3022 last signature or any of the elements of the alist
3023 @code{gnus-article-banner-alist}.
3024
3025 @item sieve
3026 @cindex sieve
3027 This parameter contains a Sieve test that should match incoming mail
3028 that should be placed in this group. From this group parameter, a
3029 Sieve @samp{IF} control structure is generated, having the test as the
3030 condition and @samp{fileinto "group.name";} as the body.
3031
3032 For example, if the @samp{INBOX.list.sieve} group has the @code{(sieve
3033 address "sender" "sieve-admin@@extundo.com")} group parameter, when
3034 translating the group parameter into a Sieve script (@pxref{Sieve
3035 Commands}) the following Sieve code is generated:
3036
3037 @example
3038 if address \"sender\" \"sieve-admin@@extundo.com\" @{
3039 fileinto \"INBOX.list.sieve\";
3040 @}
3041 @end example
3042
3043 The Sieve language is described in RFC 3028. @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve,
3044 Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
3045
3046 @item (agent parameters)
3047 If the agent has been enabled, you can set any of the its parameters
3048 to control the behavior of the agent in individual groups. See Agent
3049 Parameters in @ref{Category Syntax}. Most users will choose to set
3050 agent parameters in either an agent category or group topic to
3051 minimize the configuration effort.
3052
3053 @item (@var{variable} @var{form})
3054 You can use the group parameters to set variables local to the group you
3055 are entering. If you want to turn threading off in @samp{news.answers},
3056 you could put @code{(gnus-show-threads nil)} in the group parameters of
3057 that group. @code{gnus-show-threads} will be made into a local variable
3058 in the summary buffer you enter, and the form @code{nil} will be
3059 @code{eval}ed there.
3060
3061 Note that this feature sets the variable locally to the summary buffer.
3062 But some variables are evaluated in the article buffer, or in the
3063 message buffer (of a reply or followup or otherwise newly created
3064 message). As a workaround, it might help to add the variable in
3065 question to @code{gnus-newsgroup-variables}. @xref{Various Summary
3066 Stuff}. So if you want to set @code{message-from-style} via the group
3067 parameters, then you may need the following statement elsewhere in your
3068 @file{~/.gnus} file:
3069
3070 @lisp
3071 (add-to-list 'gnus-newsgroup-variables 'message-from-style)
3072 @end lisp
3073
3074 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
3075 A use for this feature is to remove a mailing list identifier tag in
3076 the subject fields of articles. E.g. if the news group
3077
3078 @example
3079 nntp+news.gnus.org:gmane.text.docbook.apps
3080 @end example
3081
3082 has the tag @samp{DOC-BOOK-APPS:} in the subject of all articles, this
3083 tag can be removed from the article subjects in the summary buffer for
3084 the group by putting @code{(gnus-list-identifiers "DOCBOOK-APPS:")}
3085 into the group parameters for the group.
3086
3087 This can also be used as a group-specific hook function. If you want to
3088 hear a beep when you enter a group, you could put something like
3089 @code{(dummy-variable (ding))} in the parameters of that group.
3090 @code{dummy-variable} will be set to the (meaningless) result of the
3091 @code{(ding)} form.
3092
3093 Alternatively, since the VARIABLE becomes local to the group, this
3094 pattern can be used to temporarily change a hook. For example, if the
3095 following is added to a group parameter
3096
3097 @lisp
3098 (gnus-summary-prepared-hook
3099 '(lambda nil (local-set-key "d" (local-key-binding "n"))))
3100 @end lisp
3101
3102 when the group is entered, the 'd' key will not mark the article as
3103 expired.
3104
3105 @end table
3106
3107 @vindex gnus-parameters
3108 Group parameters can be set via the @code{gnus-parameters} variable too.
3109 But some variables, such as @code{visible}, have no effect (For this
3110 case see @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} as an alternative.).
3111 For example:
3112
3113 @lisp
3114 (setq gnus-parameters
3115 '(("mail\\..*"
3116 (gnus-show-threads nil)
3117 (gnus-use-scoring nil)
3118 (gnus-summary-line-format
3119 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%d:%ub%-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
3120 (gcc-self . t)
3121 (display . all))
3122
3123 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
3124 (to-group . "\\1"))
3125
3126 ("mail\\.me"
3127 (gnus-use-scoring t))
3128
3129 ("list\\..*"
3130 (total-expire . t)
3131 (broken-reply-to . t))))
3132 @end lisp
3133
3134 String value of parameters will be subjected to regexp substitution, as
3135 the @code{to-group} example shows.
3136
3137 @vindex gnus-parameters-case-fold-search
3138 By default, whether comparing the group name and one of those regexps
3139 specified in @code{gnus-parameters} is done in a case-sensitive manner
3140 or a case-insensitive manner depends on the value of
3141 @code{case-fold-search} at the time when the comparison is done. The
3142 value of @code{case-fold-search} is typically @code{t}; it means, for
3143 example, the element @code{("INBOX\\.FOO" (total-expire . t))} might be
3144 applied to both the @samp{INBOX.FOO} group and the @samp{INBOX.foo}
3145 group. If you want to make those regexps always case-sensitive, set the
3146 value of the @code{gnus-parameters-case-fold-search} variable to
3147 @code{nil}. Otherwise, set it to @code{t} if you want to compare them
3148 always in a case-insensitive manner.
3149
3150
3151 @node Listing Groups
3152 @section Listing Groups
3153 @cindex group listing
3154
3155 These commands all list various slices of the groups available.
3156
3157 @table @kbd
3158
3159 @item l
3160 @itemx A s
3161 @kindex A s (Group)
3162 @kindex l (Group)
3163 @findex gnus-group-list-groups
3164 List all groups that have unread articles
3165 (@code{gnus-group-list-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used, this
3166 command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default, it
3167 only lists groups of level five (i.e.,
3168 @code{gnus-group-default-list-level}) or lower (i.e., just subscribed
3169 groups).
3170
3171 @item L
3172 @itemx A u
3173 @kindex A u (Group)
3174 @kindex L (Group)
3175 @findex gnus-group-list-all-groups
3176 List all groups, whether they have unread articles or not
3177 (@code{gnus-group-list-all-groups}). If the numeric prefix is used,
3178 this command will list only groups of level ARG and lower. By default,
3179 it lists groups of level seven or lower (i.e., just subscribed and
3180 unsubscribed groups).
3181
3182 @item A l
3183 @kindex A l (Group)
3184 @findex gnus-group-list-level
3185 List all unread groups on a specific level
3186 (@code{gnus-group-list-level}). If given a prefix, also list the groups
3187 with no unread articles.
3188
3189 @item A k
3190 @kindex A k (Group)
3191 @findex gnus-group-list-killed
3192 List all killed groups (@code{gnus-group-list-killed}). If given a
3193 prefix argument, really list all groups that are available, but aren't
3194 currently (un)subscribed. This could entail reading the active file
3195 from the server.
3196
3197 @item A z
3198 @kindex A z (Group)
3199 @findex gnus-group-list-zombies
3200 List all zombie groups (@code{gnus-group-list-zombies}).
3201
3202 @item A m
3203 @kindex A m (Group)
3204 @findex gnus-group-list-matching
3205 List all unread, subscribed groups with names that match a regexp
3206 (@code{gnus-group-list-matching}).
3207
3208 @item A M
3209 @kindex A M (Group)
3210 @findex gnus-group-list-all-matching
3211 List groups that match a regexp (@code{gnus-group-list-all-matching}).
3212
3213 @item A A
3214 @kindex A A (Group)
3215 @findex gnus-group-list-active
3216 List absolutely all groups in the active file(s) of the
3217 server(s) you are connected to (@code{gnus-group-list-active}). This
3218 might very well take quite a while. It might actually be a better idea
3219 to do a @kbd{A M} to list all matching, and just give @samp{.} as the
3220 thing to match on. Also note that this command may list groups that
3221 don't exist (yet)---these will be listed as if they were killed groups.
3222 Take the output with some grains of salt.
3223
3224 @item A a
3225 @kindex A a (Group)
3226 @findex gnus-group-apropos
3227 List all groups that have names that match a regexp
3228 (@code{gnus-group-apropos}).
3229
3230 @item A d
3231 @kindex A d (Group)
3232 @findex gnus-group-description-apropos
3233 List all groups that have names or descriptions that match a regexp
3234 (@code{gnus-group-description-apropos}).
3235
3236 @item A c
3237 @kindex A c (Group)
3238 @findex gnus-group-list-cached
3239 List all groups with cached articles (@code{gnus-group-list-cached}).
3240
3241 @item A ?
3242 @kindex A ? (Group)
3243 @findex gnus-group-list-dormant
3244 List all groups with dormant articles (@code{gnus-group-list-dormant}).
3245
3246 @item A /
3247 @kindex A / (Group)
3248 @findex gnus-group-list-limit
3249 List groups limited within the current selection
3250 (@code{gnus-group-list-limit}).
3251
3252 @item A f
3253 @kindex A f (Group)
3254 @findex gnus-group-list-flush
3255 Flush groups from the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-flush}).
3256
3257 @item A p
3258 @kindex A p (Group)
3259 @findex gnus-group-list-plus
3260 List groups plus the current selection (@code{gnus-group-list-plus}).
3261
3262 @end table
3263
3264 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
3265 @cindex visible group parameter
3266 Groups that match the @code{gnus-permanently-visible-groups} regexp will
3267 always be shown, whether they have unread articles or not. You can also
3268 add the @code{visible} element to the group parameters in question to
3269 get the same effect.
3270
3271 @vindex gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles
3272 Groups that have just ticked articles in it are normally listed in the
3273 group buffer. If @code{gnus-list-groups-with-ticked-articles} is
3274 @code{nil}, these groups will be treated just like totally empty
3275 groups. It is @code{t} by default.
3276
3277
3278 @node Sorting Groups
3279 @section Sorting Groups
3280 @cindex sorting groups
3281
3282 @kindex C-c C-s (Group)
3283 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups
3284 @vindex gnus-group-sort-function
3285 The @kbd{C-c C-s} (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups}) command sorts the
3286 group buffer according to the function(s) given by the
3287 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable. Available sorting functions
3288 include:
3289
3290 @table @code
3291
3292 @item gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3293 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-alphabet
3294 Sort the group names alphabetically. This is the default.
3295
3296 @item gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3297 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-real-name
3298 Sort the group alphabetically on the real (unprefixed) group names.
3299
3300 @item gnus-group-sort-by-level
3301 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-level
3302 Sort by group level.
3303
3304 @item gnus-group-sort-by-score
3305 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-score
3306 Sort by group score. @xref{Group Score}.
3307
3308 @item gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3309 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-rank
3310 Sort by group score and then the group level. The level and the score
3311 are, when taken together, the group's @dfn{rank}. @xref{Group Score}.
3312
3313 @item gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3314 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-unread
3315 Sort by number of unread articles.
3316
3317 @item gnus-group-sort-by-method
3318 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-method
3319 Sort alphabetically on the select method.
3320
3321 @item gnus-group-sort-by-server
3322 @findex gnus-group-sort-by-server
3323 Sort alphabetically on the Gnus server name.
3324
3325
3326 @end table
3327
3328 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} can also be a list of sorting
3329 functions. In that case, the most significant sort key function must be
3330 the last one.
3331
3332
3333 There are also a number of commands for sorting directly according to
3334 some sorting criteria:
3335
3336 @table @kbd
3337 @item G S a
3338 @kindex G S a (Group)
3339 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3340 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by group name
3341 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3342
3343 @item G S u
3344 @kindex G S u (Group)
3345 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread
3346 Sort the group buffer by the number of unread articles
3347 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3348
3349 @item G S l
3350 @kindex G S l (Group)
3351 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level
3352 Sort the group buffer by group level
3353 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-level}).
3354
3355 @item G S v
3356 @kindex G S v (Group)
3357 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score
3358 Sort the group buffer by group score
3359 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3360
3361 @item G S r
3362 @kindex G S r (Group)
3363 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank
3364 Sort the group buffer by group rank
3365 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3366
3367 @item G S m
3368 @kindex G S m (Group)
3369 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method
3370 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by back end name@*
3371 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-method}).
3372
3373 @item G S n
3374 @kindex G S n (Group)
3375 @findex gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name
3376 Sort the group buffer alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3377 (@code{gnus-group-sort-groups-by-real-name}).
3378
3379 @end table
3380
3381 All the commands below obey the process/prefix convention
3382 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3383
3384 When given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), all these
3385 commands will sort in reverse order.
3386
3387 You can also sort a subset of the groups:
3388
3389 @table @kbd
3390 @item G P a
3391 @kindex G P a (Group)
3392 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet
3393 Sort the groups alphabetically by group name
3394 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-alphabet}).
3395
3396 @item G P u
3397 @kindex G P u (Group)
3398 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread
3399 Sort the groups by the number of unread articles
3400 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-unread}).
3401
3402 @item G P l
3403 @kindex G P l (Group)
3404 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level
3405 Sort the groups by group level
3406 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-level}).
3407
3408 @item G P v
3409 @kindex G P v (Group)
3410 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score
3411 Sort the groups by group score
3412 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3413
3414 @item G P r
3415 @kindex G P r (Group)
3416 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank
3417 Sort the groups by group rank
3418 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3419
3420 @item G P m
3421 @kindex G P m (Group)
3422 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method
3423 Sort the groups alphabetically by back end name@*
3424 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-method}).
3425
3426 @item G P n
3427 @kindex G P n (Group)
3428 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name
3429 Sort the groups alphabetically by real (unprefixed) group name
3430 (@code{gnus-group-sort-selected-groups-by-real-name}).
3431
3432 @item G P s
3433 @kindex G P s (Group)
3434 @findex gnus-group-sort-selected-groups
3435 Sort the groups according to @code{gnus-group-sort-function}.
3436
3437 @end table
3438
3439 And finally, note that you can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} to manually
3440 move groups around.
3441
3442
3443 @node Group Maintenance
3444 @section Group Maintenance
3445 @cindex bogus groups
3446
3447 @table @kbd
3448 @item b
3449 @kindex b (Group)
3450 @findex gnus-group-check-bogus-groups
3451 Find bogus groups and delete them
3452 (@code{gnus-group-check-bogus-groups}).
3453
3454 @item F
3455 @kindex F (Group)
3456 @findex gnus-group-find-new-groups
3457 Find new groups and process them (@code{gnus-group-find-new-groups}).
3458 With 1 @kbd{C-u}, use the @code{ask-server} method to query the server
3459 for new groups. With 2 @kbd{C-u}'s, use most complete method possible
3460 to query the server for new groups, and subscribe the new groups as
3461 zombies.
3462
3463 @item C-c C-x
3464 @kindex C-c C-x (Group)
3465 @findex gnus-group-expire-articles
3466 @cindex expiring mail
3467 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
3468 process (if any) (@code{gnus-group-expire-articles}). That is, delete
3469 all expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
3470 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3471
3472 @item C-c C-M-x
3473 @kindex C-c C-M-x (Group)
3474 @findex gnus-group-expire-all-groups
3475 @cindex expiring mail
3476 Run all expirable articles in all groups through the expiry process
3477 (@code{gnus-group-expire-all-groups}).
3478
3479 @end table
3480
3481
3482 @node Browse Foreign Server
3483 @section Browse Foreign Server
3484 @cindex foreign servers
3485 @cindex browsing servers
3486
3487 @table @kbd
3488 @item B
3489 @kindex B (Group)
3490 @findex gnus-group-browse-foreign-server
3491 You will be queried for a select method and a server name. Gnus will
3492 then attempt to contact this server and let you browse the groups there
3493 (@code{gnus-group-browse-foreign-server}).
3494 @end table
3495
3496 @findex gnus-browse-mode
3497 A new buffer with a list of available groups will appear. This buffer
3498 will use the @code{gnus-browse-mode}. This buffer looks a bit (well,
3499 a lot) like a normal group buffer.
3500
3501 Here's a list of keystrokes available in the browse mode:
3502
3503 @table @kbd
3504 @item n
3505 @kindex n (Browse)
3506 @findex gnus-group-next-group
3507 Go to the next group (@code{gnus-group-next-group}).
3508
3509 @item p
3510 @kindex p (Browse)
3511 @findex gnus-group-prev-group
3512 Go to the previous group (@code{gnus-group-prev-group}).
3513
3514 @item SPACE
3515 @kindex SPACE (Browse)
3516 @findex gnus-browse-read-group
3517 Enter the current group and display the first article
3518 (@code{gnus-browse-read-group}).
3519
3520 @item RET
3521 @kindex RET (Browse)
3522 @findex gnus-browse-select-group
3523 Enter the current group (@code{gnus-browse-select-group}).
3524
3525 @item u
3526 @kindex u (Browse)
3527 @findex gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group
3528 Unsubscribe to the current group, or, as will be the case here,
3529 subscribe to it (@code{gnus-browse-unsubscribe-current-group}).
3530
3531 @item l
3532 @itemx q
3533 @kindex q (Browse)
3534 @kindex l (Browse)
3535 @findex gnus-browse-exit
3536 Exit browse mode (@code{gnus-browse-exit}).
3537
3538 @item d
3539 @kindex d (Browse)
3540 @findex gnus-browse-describe-group
3541 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-browse-describe-group}).
3542
3543 @item ?
3544 @kindex ? (Browse)
3545 @findex gnus-browse-describe-briefly
3546 Describe browse mode briefly (well, there's not much to describe, is
3547 there) (@code{gnus-browse-describe-briefly}).
3548 @end table
3549
3550
3551 @node Exiting Gnus
3552 @section Exiting Gnus
3553 @cindex exiting Gnus
3554
3555 Yes, Gnus is ex(c)iting.
3556
3557 @table @kbd
3558 @item z
3559 @kindex z (Group)
3560 @findex gnus-group-suspend
3561 Suspend Gnus (@code{gnus-group-suspend}). This doesn't really exit Gnus,
3562 but it kills all buffers except the Group buffer. I'm not sure why this
3563 is a gain, but then who am I to judge?
3564
3565 @item q
3566 @kindex q (Group)
3567 @findex gnus-group-exit
3568 @c @icon{gnus-group-exit}
3569 Quit Gnus (@code{gnus-group-exit}).
3570
3571 @item Q
3572 @kindex Q (Group)
3573 @findex gnus-group-quit
3574 Quit Gnus without saving the @file{.newsrc} files (@code{gnus-group-quit}).
3575 The dribble file will be saved, though (@pxref{Auto Save}).
3576 @end table
3577
3578 @vindex gnus-exit-gnus-hook
3579 @vindex gnus-suspend-gnus-hook
3580 @vindex gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook
3581 @code{gnus-suspend-gnus-hook} is called when you suspend Gnus and
3582 @code{gnus-exit-gnus-hook} is called when you quit Gnus, while
3583 @code{gnus-after-exiting-gnus-hook} is called as the final item when
3584 exiting Gnus.
3585
3586 Note:
3587
3588 @quotation
3589 Miss Lisa Cannifax, while sitting in English class, felt her feet go
3590 numbly heavy and herself fall into a hazy trance as the boy sitting
3591 behind her drew repeated lines with his pencil across the back of her
3592 plastic chair.
3593 @end quotation
3594
3595
3596 @node Group Topics
3597 @section Group Topics
3598 @cindex topics
3599
3600 If you read lots and lots of groups, it might be convenient to group
3601 them hierarchically according to topics. You put your Emacs groups over
3602 here, your sex groups over there, and the rest (what, two groups or so?)
3603 you put in some misc section that you never bother with anyway. You can
3604 even group the Emacs sex groups as a sub-topic to either the Emacs
3605 groups or the sex groups---or both! Go wild!
3606
3607 @iftex
3608 @iflatex
3609 \gnusfigure{Group Topics}{400}{
3610 \put(75,50){\epsfig{figure=ps/group-topic,height=9cm}}
3611 }
3612 @end iflatex
3613 @end iftex
3614
3615 Here's an example:
3616
3617 @example
3618 Gnus
3619 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3620 3: comp.emacs
3621 2: alt.religion.emacs
3622 Naughty Emacs
3623 452: alt.sex.emacs
3624 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
3625 Misc
3626 8: comp.binaries.fractals
3627 13: comp.sources.unix
3628 @end example
3629
3630 @findex gnus-topic-mode
3631 @kindex t (Group)
3632 To get this @emph{fab} functionality you simply turn on (ooh!) the
3633 @code{gnus-topic} minor mode---type @kbd{t} in the group buffer. (This
3634 is a toggling command.)
3635
3636 Go ahead, just try it. I'll still be here when you get back. La de
3637 dum@dots{} Nice tune, that@dots{} la la la@dots{} What, you're back?
3638 Yes, and now press @kbd{l}. There. All your groups are now listed
3639 under @samp{misc}. Doesn't that make you feel all warm and fuzzy?
3640 Hot and bothered?
3641
3642 If you want this permanently enabled, you should add that minor mode to
3643 the hook for the group mode. Put the following line in your
3644 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
3645
3646 @lisp
3647 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
3648 @end lisp
3649
3650 @menu
3651 * Topic Commands:: Interactive E-Z commands.
3652 * Topic Variables:: How to customize the topics the Lisp Way.
3653 * Topic Sorting:: Sorting each topic individually.
3654 * Topic Topology:: A map of the world.
3655 * Topic Parameters:: Parameters that apply to all groups in a topic.
3656 @end menu
3657
3658
3659 @node Topic Commands
3660 @subsection Topic Commands
3661 @cindex topic commands
3662
3663 When the topic minor mode is turned on, a new @kbd{T} submap will be
3664 available. In addition, a few of the standard keys change their
3665 definitions slightly.
3666
3667 In general, the following kinds of operations are possible on topics.
3668 First of all, you want to create topics. Secondly, you want to put
3669 groups in topics and to move them around until you have an order you
3670 like. The third kind of operation is to show/hide parts of the whole
3671 shebang. You might want to hide a topic including its subtopics and
3672 groups, to get a better overview of the other groups.
3673
3674 Here is a list of the basic keys that you might need to set up topics
3675 the way you like.
3676
3677 @table @kbd
3678
3679 @item T n
3680 @kindex T n (Topic)
3681 @findex gnus-topic-create-topic
3682 Prompt for a new topic name and create it
3683 (@code{gnus-topic-create-topic}).
3684
3685 @item T TAB
3686 @itemx TAB
3687 @kindex T TAB (Topic)
3688 @kindex TAB (Topic)
3689 @findex gnus-topic-indent
3690 ``Indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3691 previous topic (@code{gnus-topic-indent}). If given a prefix,
3692 ``un-indent'' the topic instead.
3693
3694 @item M-TAB
3695 @kindex M-TAB (Topic)
3696 @findex gnus-topic-unindent
3697 ``Un-indent'' the current topic so that it becomes a sub-topic of the
3698 parent of its current parent (@code{gnus-topic-unindent}).
3699
3700 @end table
3701
3702 The following two keys can be used to move groups and topics around.
3703 They work like the well-known cut and paste. @kbd{C-k} is like cut and
3704 @kbd{C-y} is like paste. Of course, this being Emacs, we use the terms
3705 kill and yank rather than cut and paste.
3706
3707 @table @kbd
3708
3709 @item C-k
3710 @kindex C-k (Topic)
3711 @findex gnus-topic-kill-group
3712 Kill a group or topic (@code{gnus-topic-kill-group}). All groups in the
3713 topic will be removed along with the topic.
3714
3715 @item C-y
3716 @kindex C-y (Topic)
3717 @findex gnus-topic-yank-group
3718 Yank the previously killed group or topic
3719 (@code{gnus-topic-yank-group}). Note that all topics will be yanked
3720 before all groups.
3721
3722 So, to move a topic to the beginning of the list of topics, just hit
3723 @kbd{C-k} on it. This is like the ``cut'' part of cut and paste. Then,
3724 move the cursor to the beginning of the buffer (just below the ``Gnus''
3725 topic) and hit @kbd{C-y}. This is like the ``paste'' part of cut and
3726 paste. Like I said -- E-Z.
3727
3728 You can use @kbd{C-k} and @kbd{C-y} on groups as well as on topics. So
3729 you can move topics around as well as groups.
3730
3731 @end table
3732
3733 After setting up the topics the way you like them, you might wish to
3734 hide a topic, or to show it again. That's why we have the following
3735 key.
3736
3737 @table @kbd
3738
3739 @item RET
3740 @kindex RET (Topic)
3741 @findex gnus-topic-select-group
3742 @itemx SPACE
3743 Either select a group or fold a topic (@code{gnus-topic-select-group}).
3744 When you perform this command on a group, you'll enter the group, as
3745 usual. When done on a topic line, the topic will be folded (if it was
3746 visible) or unfolded (if it was folded already). So it's basically a
3747 toggling command on topics. In addition, if you give a numerical
3748 prefix, group on that level (and lower) will be displayed.
3749
3750 @end table
3751
3752 Now for a list of other commands, in no particular order.
3753
3754 @table @kbd
3755
3756 @item T m
3757 @kindex T m (Topic)
3758 @findex gnus-topic-move-group
3759 Move the current group to some other topic
3760 (@code{gnus-topic-move-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3761 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3762
3763 @item T j
3764 @kindex T j (Topic)
3765 @findex gnus-topic-jump-to-topic
3766 Go to a topic (@code{gnus-topic-jump-to-topic}).
3767
3768 @item T c
3769 @kindex T c (Topic)
3770 @findex gnus-topic-copy-group
3771 Copy the current group to some other topic
3772 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-group}). This command uses the process/prefix
3773 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3774
3775 @item T h
3776 @kindex T h (Topic)
3777 @findex gnus-topic-hide-topic
3778 Hide the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-hide-topic}). If given
3779 a prefix, hide the topic permanently.
3780
3781 @item T s
3782 @kindex T s (Topic)
3783 @findex gnus-topic-show-topic
3784 Show the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-show-topic}). If given
3785 a prefix, show the topic permanently.
3786
3787 @item T D
3788 @kindex T D (Topic)
3789 @findex gnus-topic-remove-group
3790 Remove a group from the current topic (@code{gnus-topic-remove-group}).
3791 This command is mainly useful if you have the same group in several
3792 topics and wish to remove it from one of the topics. You may also
3793 remove a group from all topics, but in that case, Gnus will add it to
3794 the root topic the next time you start Gnus. In fact, all new groups
3795 (which, naturally, don't belong to any topic) will show up in the root
3796 topic.
3797
3798 This command uses the process/prefix convention
3799 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
3800
3801 @item T M
3802 @kindex T M (Topic)
3803 @findex gnus-topic-move-matching
3804 Move all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3805 (@code{gnus-topic-move-matching}).
3806
3807 @item T C
3808 @kindex T C (Topic)
3809 @findex gnus-topic-copy-matching
3810 Copy all groups that match some regular expression to a topic
3811 (@code{gnus-topic-copy-matching}).
3812
3813 @item T H
3814 @kindex T H (Topic)
3815 @findex gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics
3816 Toggle hiding empty topics
3817 (@code{gnus-topic-toggle-display-empty-topics}).
3818
3819 @item T #
3820 @kindex T # (Topic)
3821 @findex gnus-topic-mark-topic
3822 Mark all groups in the current topic with the process mark
3823 (@code{gnus-topic-mark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3824 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3825
3826 @item T M-#
3827 @kindex T M-# (Topic)
3828 @findex gnus-topic-unmark-topic
3829 Remove the process mark from all groups in the current topic
3830 (@code{gnus-topic-unmark-topic}). This command works recursively on
3831 sub-topics unless given a prefix.
3832
3833 @item C-c C-x
3834 @kindex C-c C-x (Topic)
3835 @findex gnus-topic-expire-articles
3836 @cindex expiring mail
3837 Run all expirable articles in the current group or topic through the
3838 expiry process (if any)
3839 (@code{gnus-topic-expire-articles}). (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
3840
3841 @item T r
3842 @kindex T r (Topic)
3843 @findex gnus-topic-rename
3844 Rename a topic (@code{gnus-topic-rename}).
3845
3846 @item T DEL
3847 @kindex T DEL (Topic)
3848 @findex gnus-topic-delete
3849 Delete an empty topic (@code{gnus-topic-delete}).
3850
3851 @item A T
3852 @kindex A T (Topic)
3853 @findex gnus-topic-list-active
3854 List all groups that Gnus knows about in a topics-ified way
3855 (@code{gnus-topic-list-active}).
3856
3857 @item T M-n
3858 @kindex T M-n (Topic)
3859 @findex gnus-topic-goto-next-topic
3860 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-next-topic}).
3861
3862 @item T M-p
3863 @kindex T M-p (Topic)
3864 @findex gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic
3865 Go to the next topic (@code{gnus-topic-goto-previous-topic}).
3866
3867 @item G p
3868 @kindex G p (Topic)
3869 @findex gnus-topic-edit-parameters
3870 @cindex group parameters
3871 @cindex topic parameters
3872 @cindex parameters
3873 Edit the topic parameters (@code{gnus-topic-edit-parameters}).
3874 @xref{Topic Parameters}.
3875
3876 @end table
3877
3878
3879 @node Topic Variables
3880 @subsection Topic Variables
3881 @cindex topic variables
3882
3883 The previous section told you how to tell Gnus which topics to display.
3884 This section explains how to tell Gnus what to display about each topic.
3885
3886 @vindex gnus-topic-line-format
3887 The topic lines themselves are created according to the
3888 @code{gnus-topic-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
3889 Valid elements are:
3890
3891 @table @samp
3892 @item i
3893 Indentation.
3894 @item n
3895 Topic name.
3896 @item v
3897 Visibility.
3898 @item l
3899 Level.
3900 @item g
3901 Number of groups in the topic.
3902 @item a
3903 Number of unread articles in the topic.
3904 @item A
3905 Number of unread articles in the topic and all its subtopics.
3906 @end table
3907
3908 @vindex gnus-topic-indent-level
3909 Each sub-topic (and the groups in the sub-topics) will be indented with
3910 @code{gnus-topic-indent-level} times the topic level number of spaces.
3911 The default is 2.
3912
3913 @vindex gnus-topic-mode-hook
3914 @code{gnus-topic-mode-hook} is called in topic minor mode buffers.
3915
3916 @vindex gnus-topic-display-empty-topics
3917 The @code{gnus-topic-display-empty-topics} says whether to display even
3918 topics that have no unread articles in them. The default is @code{t}.
3919
3920
3921 @node Topic Sorting
3922 @subsection Topic Sorting
3923 @cindex topic sorting
3924
3925 You can sort the groups in each topic individually with the following
3926 commands:
3927
3928
3929 @table @kbd
3930 @item T S a
3931 @kindex T S a (Topic)
3932 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet
3933 Sort the current topic alphabetically by group name
3934 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-alphabet}).
3935
3936 @item T S u
3937 @kindex T S u (Topic)
3938 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread
3939 Sort the current topic by the number of unread articles
3940 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-unread}).
3941
3942 @item T S l
3943 @kindex T S l (Topic)
3944 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level
3945 Sort the current topic by group level
3946 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-level}).
3947
3948 @item T S v
3949 @kindex T S v (Topic)
3950 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score
3951 Sort the current topic by group score
3952 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-score}). @xref{Group Score}.
3953
3954 @item T S r
3955 @kindex T S r (Topic)
3956 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank
3957 Sort the current topic by group rank
3958 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-rank}). @xref{Group Score}.
3959
3960 @item T S m
3961 @kindex T S m (Topic)
3962 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method
3963 Sort the current topic alphabetically by back end name
3964 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-method}).
3965
3966 @item T S e
3967 @kindex T S e (Topic)
3968 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server
3969 Sort the current topic alphabetically by server name
3970 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups-by-server}).
3971
3972 @item T S s
3973 @kindex T S s (Topic)
3974 @findex gnus-topic-sort-groups
3975 Sort the current topic according to the function(s) given by the
3976 @code{gnus-group-sort-function} variable
3977 (@code{gnus-topic-sort-groups}).
3978
3979 @end table
3980
3981 When given a prefix argument, all these commands will sort in reverse
3982 order. @xref{Sorting Groups}, for more information about group
3983 sorting.
3984
3985
3986 @node Topic Topology
3987 @subsection Topic Topology
3988 @cindex topic topology
3989 @cindex topology
3990
3991 So, let's have a look at an example group buffer:
3992
3993 @example
3994 @group
3995 Gnus
3996 Emacs -- I wuw it!
3997 3: comp.emacs
3998 2: alt.religion.emacs
3999 Naughty Emacs
4000 452: alt.sex.emacs
4001 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4002 Misc
4003 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4004 13: comp.sources.unix
4005 @end group
4006 @end example
4007
4008 So, here we have one top-level topic (@samp{Gnus}), two topics under
4009 that, and one sub-topic under one of the sub-topics. (There is always
4010 just one (1) top-level topic). This topology can be expressed as
4011 follows:
4012
4013 @lisp
4014 (("Gnus" visible)
4015 (("Emacs -- I wuw it!" visible)
4016 (("Naughty Emacs" visible)))
4017 (("Misc" visible)))
4018 @end lisp
4019
4020 @vindex gnus-topic-topology
4021 This is in fact how the variable @code{gnus-topic-topology} would look
4022 for the display above. That variable is saved in the @file{.newsrc.eld}
4023 file, and shouldn't be messed with manually---unless you really want
4024 to. Since this variable is read from the @file{.newsrc.eld} file,
4025 setting it in any other startup files will have no effect.
4026
4027 This topology shows what topics are sub-topics of what topics (right),
4028 and which topics are visible. Two settings are currently
4029 allowed---@code{visible} and @code{invisible}.
4030
4031
4032 @node Topic Parameters
4033 @subsection Topic Parameters
4034 @cindex topic parameters
4035
4036 All groups in a topic will inherit group parameters from the parent
4037 (and ancestor) topic parameters. All valid group parameters are valid
4038 topic parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}). When the agent is
4039 enabled, all agent parameters (See Agent Parameters in @ref{Category
4040 Syntax}) are also valid topic parameters.
4041
4042 In addition, the following parameters are only valid as topic
4043 parameters:
4044
4045 @table @code
4046 @item subscribe
4047 When subscribing new groups by topic (@pxref{Subscription Methods}), the
4048 @code{subscribe} topic parameter says what groups go in what topic. Its
4049 value should be a regexp to match the groups that should go in that
4050 topic.
4051
4052 @item subscribe-level
4053 When subscribing new groups by topic (see the @code{subscribe} parameter),
4054 the group will be subscribed with the level specified in the
4055 @code{subscribe-level} instead of @code{gnus-level-default-subscribed}.
4056
4057 @end table
4058
4059 Group parameters (of course) override topic parameters, and topic
4060 parameters in sub-topics override topic parameters in super-topics. You
4061 know. Normal inheritance rules. (@dfn{Rules} is here a noun, not a
4062 verb, although you may feel free to disagree with me here.)
4063
4064 @example
4065 @group
4066 Gnus
4067 Emacs
4068 3: comp.emacs
4069 2: alt.religion.emacs
4070 452: alt.sex.emacs
4071 Relief
4072 452: alt.sex.emacs
4073 0: comp.talk.emacs.recovery
4074 Misc
4075 8: comp.binaries.fractals
4076 13: comp.sources.unix
4077 452: alt.sex.emacs
4078 @end group
4079 @end example
4080
4081 The @samp{Emacs} topic has the topic parameter @code{(score-file
4082 . "emacs.SCORE")}; the @samp{Relief} topic has the topic parameter
4083 @code{(score-file . "relief.SCORE")}; and the @samp{Misc} topic has the
4084 topic parameter @code{(score-file . "emacs.SCORE")}. In addition,
4085 @* @samp{alt.religion.emacs} has the group parameter @code{(score-file
4086 . "religion.SCORE")}.
4087
4088 Now, when you enter @samp{alt.sex.emacs} in the @samp{Relief} topic, you
4089 will get the @file{relief.SCORE} home score file. If you enter the same
4090 group in the @samp{Emacs} topic, you'll get the @file{emacs.SCORE} home
4091 score file. If you enter the group @samp{alt.religion.emacs}, you'll
4092 get the @file{religion.SCORE} home score file.
4093
4094 This seems rather simple and self-evident, doesn't it? Well, yes. But
4095 there are some problems, especially with the @code{total-expiry}
4096 parameter. Say you have a mail group in two topics; one with
4097 @code{total-expiry} and one without. What happens when you do @kbd{M-x
4098 gnus-expire-all-expirable-groups}? Gnus has no way of telling which one
4099 of these topics you mean to expire articles from, so anything may
4100 happen. In fact, I hereby declare that it is @dfn{undefined} what
4101 happens. You just have to be careful if you do stuff like that.
4102
4103
4104 @node Misc Group Stuff
4105 @section Misc Group Stuff
4106
4107 @menu
4108 * Scanning New Messages:: Asking Gnus to see whether new messages have arrived.
4109 * Group Information:: Information and help on groups and Gnus.
4110 * Group Timestamp:: Making Gnus keep track of when you last read a group.
4111 * File Commands:: Reading and writing the Gnus files.
4112 * Sieve Commands:: Managing Sieve scripts.
4113 @end menu
4114
4115 @table @kbd
4116
4117 @item v
4118 @kindex v (Group)
4119 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Group)
4120 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4121 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4122
4123 @lisp
4124 (define-key gnus-group-mode-map (kbd "v j d")
4125 (lambda ()
4126 (interactive)
4127 (gnus-group-jump-to-group "nndraft:drafts")))
4128 @end lisp
4129
4130 On keys reserved for users in Emacs and on keybindings in general
4131 @xref{Keymaps, Keymaps, , emacs, The Emacs Editor}.
4132
4133 @item ^
4134 @kindex ^ (Group)
4135 @findex gnus-group-enter-server-mode
4136 Enter the server buffer (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}).
4137 @xref{Server Buffer}.
4138
4139 @item a
4140 @kindex a (Group)
4141 @findex gnus-group-post-news
4142 Start composing a message (a news by default)
4143 (@code{gnus-group-post-news}). If given a prefix, post to the group
4144 under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
4145 Contrary to what the name of this function suggests, the prepared
4146 article might be a mail instead of a news, if a mail group is specified
4147 with the prefix argument. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4148
4149 @item m
4150 @kindex m (Group)
4151 @findex gnus-group-mail
4152 Mail a message somewhere (@code{gnus-group-mail}). If given a prefix,
4153 use the posting style of the group under the point. If the prefix is 1,
4154 prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
4155 @xref{Composing Messages}.
4156
4157 @item i
4158 @kindex i (Group)
4159 @findex gnus-group-news
4160 Start composing a news (@code{gnus-group-news}). If given a prefix,
4161 post to the group under the point. If the prefix is 1, prompt
4162 for group to post to. @xref{Composing Messages}.
4163
4164 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
4165 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
4166 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
4167 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
4168 for this to work though.
4169
4170 @end table
4171
4172 Variables for the group buffer:
4173
4174 @table @code
4175
4176 @item gnus-group-mode-hook
4177 @vindex gnus-group-mode-hook
4178 is called after the group buffer has been
4179 created.
4180
4181 @item gnus-group-prepare-hook
4182 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4183 is called after the group buffer is
4184 generated. It may be used to modify the buffer in some strange,
4185 unnatural way.
4186
4187 @item gnus-group-prepared-hook
4188 @vindex gnus-group-prepare-hook
4189 is called as the very last thing after the group buffer has been
4190 generated. It may be used to move point around, for instance.
4191
4192 @item gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4193 @vindex gnus-permanently-visible-groups
4194 Groups matching this regexp will always be listed in the group buffer,
4195 whether they are empty or not.
4196
4197 @item gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4198 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4199 An alist of method and the charset for group names. It is used to show
4200 non-@acronym{ASCII} group names.
4201
4202 For example:
4203 @lisp
4204 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist
4205 '(((nntp "news.com.cn") . cn-gb-2312)))
4206 @end lisp
4207
4208 @item gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4209 @cindex UTF-8 group names
4210 @vindex gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4211 An alist of regexp of group name and the charset for group names. It
4212 is used to show non-@acronym{ASCII} group names. @code{((".*"
4213 utf-8))} is the default value if UTF-8 is supported, otherwise the
4214 default is @code{nil}.
4215
4216 For example:
4217 @lisp
4218 (setq gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist
4219 '(("\\.com\\.cn:" . cn-gb-2312)))
4220 @end lisp
4221
4222 @end table
4223
4224 @node Scanning New Messages
4225 @subsection Scanning New Messages
4226 @cindex new messages
4227 @cindex scanning new news
4228
4229 @table @kbd
4230
4231 @item g
4232 @kindex g (Group)
4233 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news
4234 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news}
4235 Check the server(s) for new articles. If the numerical prefix is used,
4236 this command will check only groups of level @var{arg} and lower
4237 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news}). If given a non-numerical prefix, this
4238 command will force a total re-reading of the active file(s) from the
4239 back end(s).
4240
4241 @item M-g
4242 @kindex M-g (Group)
4243 @findex gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group
4244 @vindex gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating
4245 @c @icon{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}
4246 Check whether new articles have arrived in the current group
4247 (@code{gnus-group-get-new-news-this-group}).
4248 @code{gnus-goto-next-group-when-activating} says whether this command is
4249 to move point to the next group or not. It is @code{t} by default.
4250
4251 @findex gnus-activate-all-groups
4252 @cindex activating groups
4253 @item C-c M-g
4254 @kindex C-c M-g (Group)
4255 Activate absolutely all groups (@code{gnus-activate-all-groups}).
4256
4257 @item R
4258 @kindex R (Group)
4259 @cindex restarting
4260 @findex gnus-group-restart
4261 Restart Gnus (@code{gnus-group-restart}). This saves the @file{.newsrc}
4262 file(s), closes the connection to all servers, clears up all run-time
4263 Gnus variables, and then starts Gnus all over again.
4264
4265 @end table
4266
4267 @vindex gnus-get-new-news-hook
4268 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is run just before checking for new news.
4269
4270 @vindex gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook
4271 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook} is run after checking for new
4272 news.
4273
4274
4275 @node Group Information
4276 @subsection Group Information
4277 @cindex group information
4278 @cindex information on groups
4279
4280 @table @kbd
4281
4282
4283 @item H f
4284 @kindex H f (Group)
4285 @findex gnus-group-fetch-faq
4286 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
4287 @cindex FAQ
4288 @cindex ange-ftp
4289 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} for the current group
4290 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try to get the @acronym{FAQ}
4291 from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which is usually a directory on
4292 a remote machine. This variable can also be a list of directories.
4293 In that case, giving a prefix to this command will allow you to choose
4294 between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp} (or @code{efs}) will be
4295 used for fetching the file.
4296
4297 If fetching from the first site is unsuccessful, Gnus will attempt to go
4298 through @code{gnus-group-faq-directory} and try to open them one by one.
4299
4300 @item H c
4301 @kindex H c (Group)
4302 @findex gnus-group-fetch-charter
4303 @vindex gnus-group-charter-alist
4304 @cindex charter
4305 Try to open the charter for the current group in a web browser
4306 (@code{gnus-group-fetch-charter}). Query for a group if given a
4307 prefix argument.
4308
4309 Gnus will use @code{gnus-group-charter-alist} to find the location of
4310 the charter. If no location is known, Gnus will fetch the control
4311 messages for the group, which in some cases includes the charter.
4312
4313 @item H C
4314 @kindex H C (Group)
4315 @findex gnus-group-fetch-control
4316 @vindex gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url
4317 @cindex control message
4318 Fetch the control messages for the group from the archive at
4319 @code{ftp.isc.org} (@code{gnus-group-fetch-control}). Query for a
4320 group if given a prefix argument.
4321
4322 If @code{gnus-group-fetch-control-use-browse-url} is non-@code{nil},
4323 Gnus will open the control messages in a browser using
4324 @code{browse-url}. Otherwise they are fetched using @code{ange-ftp}
4325 and displayed in an ephemeral group.
4326
4327 Note that the control messages are compressed. To use this command
4328 you need to turn on @code{auto-compression-mode} (@pxref{Compressed
4329 Files, ,Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Manual}).
4330
4331 @item H d
4332 @itemx C-c C-d
4333 @c @icon{gnus-group-describe-group}
4334 @kindex H d (Group)
4335 @kindex C-c C-d (Group)
4336 @cindex describing groups
4337 @cindex group description
4338 @findex gnus-group-describe-group
4339 Describe the current group (@code{gnus-group-describe-group}). If given
4340 a prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description from the server.
4341
4342 @item M-d
4343 @kindex M-d (Group)
4344 @findex gnus-group-describe-all-groups
4345 Describe all groups (@code{gnus-group-describe-all-groups}). If given a
4346 prefix, force Gnus to re-read the description file from the server.
4347
4348 @item H v
4349 @itemx V
4350 @kindex V (Group)
4351 @kindex H v (Group)
4352 @cindex version
4353 @findex gnus-version
4354 Display current Gnus version numbers (@code{gnus-version}).
4355
4356 @item ?
4357 @kindex ? (Group)
4358 @findex gnus-group-describe-briefly
4359 Give a very short help message (@code{gnus-group-describe-briefly}).
4360
4361 @item C-c C-i
4362 @kindex C-c C-i (Group)
4363 @cindex info
4364 @cindex manual
4365 @findex gnus-info-find-node
4366 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
4367 @end table
4368
4369
4370 @node Group Timestamp
4371 @subsection Group Timestamp
4372 @cindex timestamps
4373 @cindex group timestamps
4374
4375 It can be convenient to let Gnus keep track of when you last read a
4376 group. To set the ball rolling, you should add
4377 @code{gnus-group-set-timestamp} to @code{gnus-select-group-hook}:
4378
4379 @lisp
4380 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook 'gnus-group-set-timestamp)
4381 @end lisp
4382
4383 After doing this, each time you enter a group, it'll be recorded.
4384
4385 This information can be displayed in various ways---the easiest is to
4386 use the @samp{%d} spec in the group line format:
4387
4388 @lisp
4389 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4390 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %d\n")
4391 @end lisp
4392
4393 This will result in lines looking like:
4394
4395 @example
4396 * 0: mail.ding 19961002T012943
4397 0: custom 19961002T012713
4398 @end example
4399
4400 As you can see, the date is displayed in compact ISO 8601 format. This
4401 may be a bit too much, so to just display the date, you could say
4402 something like:
4403
4404 @lisp
4405 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4406 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %6,6~(cut 2)d\n")
4407 @end lisp
4408
4409 If you would like greater control of the time format, you can use a
4410 user-defined format spec. Something like the following should do the
4411 trick:
4412
4413 @lisp
4414 (setq gnus-group-line-format
4415 "%M\%S\%p\%P\%5y: %(%-40,40g%) %ud\n")
4416 (defun gnus-user-format-function-d (headers)
4417 (let ((time (gnus-group-timestamp gnus-tmp-group)))
4418 (if time
4419 (format-time-string "%b %d %H:%M" time)
4420 "")))
4421 @end lisp
4422
4423
4424 @node File Commands
4425 @subsection File Commands
4426 @cindex file commands
4427
4428 @table @kbd
4429
4430 @item r
4431 @kindex r (Group)
4432 @findex gnus-group-read-init-file
4433 @vindex gnus-init-file
4434 @cindex reading init file
4435 Re-read the init file (@code{gnus-init-file}, which defaults to
4436 @file{~/.gnus.el}) (@code{gnus-group-read-init-file}).
4437
4438 @item s
4439 @kindex s (Group)
4440 @findex gnus-group-save-newsrc
4441 @cindex saving .newsrc
4442 Save the @file{.newsrc.eld} file (and @file{.newsrc} if wanted)
4443 (@code{gnus-group-save-newsrc}). If given a prefix, force saving the
4444 file(s) whether Gnus thinks it is necessary or not.
4445
4446 @c @item Z
4447 @c @kindex Z (Group)
4448 @c @findex gnus-group-clear-dribble
4449 @c Clear the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-group-clear-dribble}).
4450
4451 @end table
4452
4453
4454 @node Sieve Commands
4455 @subsection Sieve Commands
4456 @cindex group sieve commands
4457
4458 Sieve is a server-side mail filtering language. In Gnus you can use
4459 the @code{sieve} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to specify
4460 sieve rules that should apply to each group. Gnus provides two
4461 commands to translate all these group parameters into a proper Sieve
4462 script that can be transfered to the server somehow.
4463
4464 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4465 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-start
4466 @vindex gnus-sieve-region-end
4467 The generated Sieve script is placed in @code{gnus-sieve-file} (by
4468 default @file{~/.sieve}). The Sieve code that Gnus generate is placed
4469 between two delimiters, @code{gnus-sieve-region-start} and
4470 @code{gnus-sieve-region-end}, so you may write additional Sieve code
4471 outside these delimiters that will not be removed the next time you
4472 regenerate the Sieve script.
4473
4474 @vindex gnus-sieve-crosspost
4475 The variable @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} controls how the Sieve script
4476 is generated. If it is non-@code{nil} (the default) articles is
4477 placed in all groups that have matching rules, otherwise the article
4478 is only placed in the group with the first matching rule. For
4479 example, the group parameter @samp{(sieve address "sender"
4480 "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu")} will generate the following piece of Sieve
4481 code if @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is @code{nil}. (When
4482 @code{gnus-sieve-crosspost} is non-@code{nil}, it looks the same
4483 except that the line containing the call to @code{stop} is removed.)
4484
4485 @example
4486 if address "sender" "owner-ding@@hpc.uh.edu" @{
4487 fileinto "INBOX.ding";
4488 stop;
4489 @}
4490 @end example
4491
4492 @xref{Top, Emacs Sieve, Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
4493
4494 @table @kbd
4495
4496 @item D g
4497 @kindex D g (Group)
4498 @findex gnus-sieve-generate
4499 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4500 @cindex generating sieve script
4501 Regenerate a Sieve script from the @code{sieve} group parameters and
4502 put you into the @code{gnus-sieve-file} without saving it.
4503
4504 @item D u
4505 @kindex D u (Group)
4506 @findex gnus-sieve-update
4507 @vindex gnus-sieve-file
4508 @cindex updating sieve script
4509 Regenerates the Gnus managed part of @code{gnus-sieve-file} using the
4510 @code{sieve} group parameters, save the file and upload it to the
4511 server using the @code{sieveshell} program.
4512
4513 @end table
4514
4515
4516 @node Summary Buffer
4517 @chapter Summary Buffer
4518 @cindex summary buffer
4519
4520 A line for each article is displayed in the summary buffer. You can
4521 move around, read articles, post articles and reply to articles.
4522
4523 The most common way to a summary buffer is to select a group from the
4524 group buffer (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
4525
4526 You can have as many summary buffers open as you wish.
4527
4528 You can customize the Summary Mode tool bar, see @kbd{M-x
4529 customize-apropos RET gnus-summary-tool-bar}. This feature is only
4530 available in Emacs.
4531
4532 @kindex v (Summary)
4533 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Summary)
4534 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
4535 command or better use it as a prefix key. For example:
4536 @lisp
4537 (define-key gnus-summary-mode-map (kbd "v -") "LrS") ;; lower subthread
4538 @end lisp
4539
4540 @menu
4541 * Summary Buffer Format:: Deciding how the summary buffer is to look.
4542 * Summary Maneuvering:: Moving around the summary buffer.
4543 * Choosing Articles:: Reading articles.
4544 * Paging the Article:: Scrolling the current article.
4545 * Reply Followup and Post:: Posting articles.
4546 * Delayed Articles:: Send articles at a later time.
4547 * Marking Articles:: Marking articles as read, expirable, etc.
4548 * Limiting:: You can limit the summary buffer.
4549 * Threading:: How threads are made.
4550 * Sorting the Summary Buffer:: How articles and threads are sorted.
4551 * Asynchronous Fetching:: Gnus might be able to pre-fetch articles.
4552 * Article Caching:: You may store articles in a cache.
4553 * Persistent Articles:: Making articles expiry-resistant.
4554 * Article Backlog:: Having already read articles hang around.
4555 * Saving Articles:: Ways of customizing article saving.
4556 * Decoding Articles:: Gnus can treat series of (uu)encoded articles.
4557 * Article Treatment:: The article buffer can be mangled at will.
4558 * MIME Commands:: Doing MIMEy things with the articles.
4559 * Charsets:: Character set issues.
4560 * Article Commands:: Doing various things with the article buffer.
4561 * Summary Sorting:: Sorting the summary buffer in various ways.
4562 * Finding the Parent:: No child support? Get the parent.
4563 * Alternative Approaches:: Reading using non-default summaries.
4564 * Tree Display:: A more visual display of threads.
4565 * Mail Group Commands:: Some commands can only be used in mail groups.
4566 * Various Summary Stuff:: What didn't fit anywhere else.
4567 * Exiting the Summary Buffer:: Returning to the Group buffer,
4568 or reselecting the current group.
4569 * Crosspost Handling:: How crossposted articles are dealt with.
4570 * Duplicate Suppression:: An alternative when crosspost handling fails.
4571 * Security:: Decrypt and Verify.
4572 * Mailing List:: Mailing list minor mode.
4573 @end menu
4574
4575
4576 @node Summary Buffer Format
4577 @section Summary Buffer Format
4578 @cindex summary buffer format
4579
4580 @iftex
4581 @iflatex
4582 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{180}{
4583 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary,width=7.5cm}}
4584 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-article,width=7.5cm}}}
4585 }
4586 @end iflatex
4587 @end iftex
4588
4589 @menu
4590 * Summary Buffer Lines:: You can specify how summary lines should look.
4591 * To From Newsgroups:: How to not display your own name.
4592 * Summary Buffer Mode Line:: You can say how the mode line should look.
4593 * Summary Highlighting:: Making the summary buffer all pretty and nice.
4594 @end menu
4595
4596 @findex mail-extract-address-components
4597 @findex gnus-extract-address-components
4598 @vindex gnus-extract-address-components
4599 Gnus will use the value of the @code{gnus-extract-address-components}
4600 variable as a function for getting the name and address parts of a
4601 @code{From} header. Two pre-defined functions exist:
4602 @code{gnus-extract-address-components}, which is the default, quite
4603 fast, and too simplistic solution; and
4604 @code{mail-extract-address-components}, which works very nicely, but is
4605 slower. The default function will return the wrong answer in 5% of the
4606 cases. If this is unacceptable to you, use the other function instead:
4607
4608 @lisp
4609 (setq gnus-extract-address-components
4610 'mail-extract-address-components)
4611 @end lisp
4612
4613 @vindex gnus-summary-same-subject
4614 @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} is a string indicating that the current
4615 article has the same subject as the previous. This string will be used
4616 with those specs that require it. The default is @code{""}.
4617
4618
4619 @node Summary Buffer Lines
4620 @subsection Summary Buffer Lines
4621
4622 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4623 You can change the format of the lines in the summary buffer by changing
4624 the @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable. It works along the same
4625 lines as a normal @code{format} string, with some extensions
4626 (@pxref{Formatting Variables}).
4627
4628 There should always be a colon or a point position marker on the line;
4629 the cursor always moves to the point position marker or the colon after
4630 performing an operation. (Of course, Gnus wouldn't be Gnus if it wasn't
4631 possible to change this. Just write a new function
4632 @code{gnus-goto-colon} which does whatever you like with the cursor.)
4633 @xref{Positioning Point}.
4634
4635 The default string is @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n}.
4636
4637 The following format specification characters and extended format
4638 specification(s) are understood:
4639
4640 @table @samp
4641 @item N
4642 Article number.
4643 @item S
4644 Subject string. List identifiers stripped,
4645 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. @xref{Article Hiding}.
4646 @item s
4647 Subject if the article is the root of the thread or the previous article
4648 had a different subject, @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} otherwise.
4649 (@code{gnus-summary-same-subject} defaults to @code{""}.)
4650 @item F
4651 Full @code{From} header.
4652 @item n
4653 The name (from the @code{From} header).
4654 @item f
4655 The name, @code{To} header or the @code{Newsgroups} header (@pxref{To
4656 From Newsgroups}).
4657 @item a
4658 The name (from the @code{From} header). This differs from the @code{n}
4659 spec in that it uses the function designated by the
4660 @code{gnus-extract-address-components} variable, which is slower, but
4661 may be more thorough.
4662 @item A
4663 The address (from the @code{From} header). This works the same way as
4664 the @code{a} spec.
4665 @item L
4666 Number of lines in the article.
4667 @item c
4668 Number of characters in the article. This specifier is not supported
4669 in some methods (like nnfolder).
4670 @item k
4671 Pretty-printed version of the number of characters in the article;
4672 for example, @samp{1.2k} or @samp{0.4M}.
4673 @item I
4674 Indentation based on thread level (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4675 @item B
4676 A complex trn-style thread tree, showing response-connecting trace
4677 lines. A thread could be drawn like this:
4678
4679 @example
4680 >
4681 +->
4682 | +->
4683 | | \->
4684 | | \->
4685 | \->
4686 +->
4687 \->
4688 @end example
4689
4690 You can customize the appearance with the following options. Note
4691 that it is possible to make the thread display look really neat by
4692 replacing the default @acronym{ASCII} characters with graphic
4693 line-drawing glyphs.
4694 @table @code
4695 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4696 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-root
4697 Used for the root of a thread. If @code{nil}, use subject
4698 instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4699
4700 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4701 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-false-root
4702 Used for the false root of a thread (@pxref{Loose Threads}). If
4703 @code{nil}, use subject instead. The default is @samp{> }.
4704
4705 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4706 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-indent
4707 Used for a thread with just one message. If @code{nil}, use subject
4708 instead. The default is @samp{}.
4709
4710 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4711 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-vertical
4712 Used for drawing a vertical line. The default is @samp{| }.
4713
4714 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4715 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-indent
4716 Used for indenting. The default is @samp{ }.
4717
4718 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4719 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-leaf-with-other
4720 Used for a leaf with brothers. The default is @samp{+-> }.
4721
4722 @item gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4723 @vindex gnus-sum-thread-tree-single-leaf
4724 Used for a leaf without brothers. The default is @samp{\-> }
4725
4726 @end table
4727
4728 @item T
4729 Nothing if the article is a root and lots of spaces if it isn't (it
4730 pushes everything after it off the screen).
4731 @item [
4732 Opening bracket, which is normally @samp{[}, but can also be @samp{<}
4733 for adopted articles (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
4734 @item ]
4735 Closing bracket, which is normally @samp{]}, but can also be @samp{>}
4736 for adopted articles.
4737 @item >
4738 One space for each thread level.
4739 @item <
4740 Twenty minus thread level spaces.
4741 @item U
4742 Unread. @xref{Read Articles}.
4743
4744 @item R
4745 This misleadingly named specifier is the @dfn{secondary mark}. This
4746 mark will say whether the article has been replied to, has been cached,
4747 or has been saved. @xref{Other Marks}.
4748
4749 @item i
4750 Score as a number (@pxref{Scoring}).
4751 @item z
4752 @vindex gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz
4753 Zcore, @samp{+} if above the default level and @samp{-} if below the
4754 default level. If the difference between
4755 @code{gnus-summary-default-score} and the score is less than
4756 @code{gnus-summary-zcore-fuzz}, this spec will not be used.
4757 @item V
4758 Total thread score.
4759 @item x
4760 @code{Xref}.
4761 @item D
4762 @code{Date}.
4763 @item d
4764 The @code{Date} in @code{DD-MMM} format.
4765 @item o
4766 The @code{Date} in @var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS} format.
4767 @item M
4768 @code{Message-ID}.
4769 @item r
4770 @code{References}.
4771 @item t
4772 Number of articles in the current sub-thread. Using this spec will slow
4773 down summary buffer generation somewhat.
4774 @item e
4775 An @samp{=} (@code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark}) will be displayed if the
4776 article has any children.
4777 @item P
4778 The line number.
4779 @item O
4780 Download mark.
4781 @item *
4782 Desired cursor position (instead of after first colon).
4783 @item &user-date;
4784 Age sensitive date format. Various date format is defined in
4785 @code{gnus-user-date-format-alist}.
4786 @item u
4787 User defined specifier. The next character in the format string should
4788 be a letter. Gnus will call the function
4789 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{x}}, where @var{x} is the letter
4790 following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed the current header as
4791 argument. The function should return a string, which will be inserted
4792 into the summary just like information from any other summary specifier.
4793 @end table
4794
4795 Text between @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} will be highlighted with
4796 @code{gnus-mouse-face} when the mouse point is placed inside the area.
4797 There can only be one such area.
4798
4799 The @samp{%U} (status), @samp{%R} (replied) and @samp{%z} (zcore) specs
4800 have to be handled with care. For reasons of efficiency, Gnus will
4801 compute what column these characters will end up in, and ``hard-code''
4802 that. This means that it is invalid to have these specs after a
4803 variable-length spec. Well, you might not be arrested, but your summary
4804 buffer will look strange, which is bad enough.
4805
4806 The smart choice is to have these specs as far to the left as possible.
4807 (Isn't that the case with everything, though? But I digress.)
4808
4809 This restriction may disappear in later versions of Gnus.
4810
4811
4812 @node To From Newsgroups
4813 @subsection To From Newsgroups
4814 @cindex To
4815 @cindex Newsgroups
4816
4817 In some groups (particularly in archive groups), the @code{From} header
4818 isn't very interesting, since all the articles there are written by
4819 you. To display the information in the @code{To} or @code{Newsgroups}
4820 headers instead, you need to decide three things: What information to
4821 gather; where to display it; and when to display it.
4822
4823 @enumerate
4824 @item
4825 @vindex gnus-extra-headers
4826 The reading of extra header information is controlled by the
4827 @code{gnus-extra-headers}. This is a list of header symbols. For
4828 instance:
4829
4830 @lisp
4831 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4832 '(To Newsgroups X-Newsreader))
4833 @end lisp
4834
4835 This will result in Gnus trying to obtain these three headers, and
4836 storing it in header structures for later easy retrieval.
4837
4838 @item
4839 @findex gnus-extra-header
4840 The value of these extra headers can be accessed via the
4841 @code{gnus-extra-header} function. Here's a format line spec that will
4842 access the @code{X-Newsreader} header:
4843
4844 @example
4845 "%~(form (gnus-extra-header 'X-Newsreader))@@"
4846 @end example
4847
4848 @item
4849 @vindex gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4850 The @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses} variable says when the @samp{%f}
4851 summary line spec returns the @code{To}, @code{Newsreader} or
4852 @code{From} header. If this regexp matches the contents of the
4853 @code{From} header, the value of the @code{To} or @code{Newsreader}
4854 headers are used instead.
4855
4856 @end enumerate
4857
4858 @vindex nnmail-extra-headers
4859 A related variable is @code{nnmail-extra-headers}, which controls when
4860 to include extra headers when generating overview (@acronym{NOV}) files.
4861 If you have old overview files, you should regenerate them after
4862 changing this variable, by entering the server buffer using @kbd{^},
4863 and then @kbd{g} on the appropriate mail server (e.g. nnml) to cause
4864 regeneration.
4865
4866 @vindex gnus-summary-line-format
4867 You also have to instruct Gnus to display the data by changing the
4868 @code{%n} spec to the @code{%f} spec in the
4869 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} variable.
4870
4871 In summary, you'd typically put something like the following in
4872 @file{~/.gnus.el}:
4873
4874 @lisp
4875 (setq gnus-extra-headers
4876 '(To Newsgroups))
4877 (setq nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
4878 (setq gnus-summary-line-format
4879 "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%) %s\n")
4880 (setq gnus-ignored-from-addresses
4881 "Your Name Here")
4882 @end lisp
4883
4884 (The values listed above are the default values in Gnus. Alter them
4885 to fit your needs.)
4886
4887 A note for news server administrators, or for users who wish to try to
4888 convince their news server administrator to provide some additional
4889 support:
4890
4891 The above is mostly useful for mail groups, where you have control over
4892 the @acronym{NOV} files that are created. However, if you can persuade your
4893 nntp admin to add (in the usual implementation, notably INN):
4894
4895 @example
4896 Newsgroups:full
4897 @end example
4898
4899 to the end of her @file{overview.fmt} file, then you can use that just
4900 as you would the extra headers from the mail groups.
4901
4902
4903 @node Summary Buffer Mode Line
4904 @subsection Summary Buffer Mode Line
4905
4906 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-line-format
4907 You can also change the format of the summary mode bar (@pxref{Mode Line
4908 Formatting}). Set @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} to whatever you
4909 like. The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b [%A] %Z}.
4910
4911 Here are the elements you can play with:
4912
4913 @table @samp
4914 @item G
4915 Group name.
4916 @item p
4917 Unprefixed group name.
4918 @item A
4919 Current article number.
4920 @item z
4921 Current article score.
4922 @item V
4923 Gnus version.
4924 @item U
4925 Number of unread articles in this group.
4926 @item e
4927 Number of unread articles in this group that aren't displayed in the
4928 summary buffer.
4929 @item Z
4930 A string with the number of unread and unselected articles represented
4931 either as @samp{<%U(+%e) more>} if there are both unread and unselected
4932 articles, and just as @samp{<%U more>} if there are just unread articles
4933 and no unselected ones.
4934 @item g
4935 Shortish group name. For instance, @samp{rec.arts.anime} will be
4936 shortened to @samp{r.a.anime}.
4937 @item S
4938 Subject of the current article.
4939 @item u
4940 User-defined spec (@pxref{User-Defined Specs}).
4941 @item s
4942 Name of the current score file (@pxref{Scoring}).
4943 @item d
4944 Number of dormant articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4945 @item t
4946 Number of ticked articles (@pxref{Unread Articles}).
4947 @item r
4948 Number of articles that have been marked as read in this session.
4949 @item E
4950 Number of articles expunged by the score files.
4951 @end table
4952
4953
4954 @node Summary Highlighting
4955 @subsection Summary Highlighting
4956
4957 @table @code
4958
4959 @item gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4960 @vindex gnus-visual-mark-article-hook
4961 This hook is run after selecting an article. It is meant to be used for
4962 highlighting the article in some way. It is not run if
4963 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4964
4965 @item gnus-summary-update-hook
4966 @vindex gnus-summary-update-hook
4967 This hook is called when a summary line is changed. It is not run if
4968 @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
4969
4970 @item gnus-summary-selected-face
4971 @vindex gnus-summary-selected-face
4972 This is the face (or @dfn{font} as some people call it) used to
4973 highlight the current article in the summary buffer.
4974
4975 @item gnus-summary-highlight
4976 @vindex gnus-summary-highlight
4977 Summary lines are highlighted according to this variable, which is a
4978 list where the elements are of the format @code{(@var{form}
4979 . @var{face})}. If you would, for instance, like ticked articles to be
4980 italic and high-scored articles to be bold, you could set this variable
4981 to something like
4982 @lisp
4983 (((eq mark gnus-ticked-mark) . italic)
4984 ((> score default) . bold))
4985 @end lisp
4986 As you may have guessed, if @var{form} returns a non-@code{nil} value,
4987 @var{face} will be applied to the line.
4988 @end table
4989
4990
4991 @node Summary Maneuvering
4992 @section Summary Maneuvering
4993 @cindex summary movement
4994
4995 All the straight movement commands understand the numeric prefix and
4996 behave pretty much as you'd expect.
4997
4998 None of these commands select articles.
4999
5000 @table @kbd
5001 @item G M-n
5002 @itemx M-n
5003 @kindex M-n (Summary)
5004 @kindex G M-n (Summary)
5005 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-subject
5006 Go to the next summary line of an unread article
5007 (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-subject}).
5008
5009 @item G M-p
5010 @itemx M-p
5011 @kindex M-p (Summary)
5012 @kindex G M-p (Summary)
5013 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject
5014 Go to the previous summary line of an unread article
5015 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-subject}).
5016
5017 @item G g
5018 @kindex G g (Summary)
5019 @findex gnus-summary-goto-subject
5020 Ask for an article number and then go to the summary line of that article
5021 without displaying the article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-subject}).
5022 @end table
5023
5024 If Gnus asks you to press a key to confirm going to the next group, you
5025 can use the @kbd{C-n} and @kbd{C-p} keys to move around the group
5026 buffer, searching for the next group to read without actually returning
5027 to the group buffer.
5028
5029 Variables related to summary movement:
5030
5031 @table @code
5032
5033 @vindex gnus-auto-select-next
5034 @item gnus-auto-select-next
5035 If you issue one of the movement commands (like @kbd{n}) and there are
5036 no more unread articles after the current one, Gnus will offer to go to
5037 the next group. If this variable is @code{t} and the next group is
5038 empty, Gnus will exit summary mode and return to the group buffer. If
5039 this variable is neither @code{t} nor @code{nil}, Gnus will select the
5040 next group with unread articles. As a special case, if this variable
5041 is @code{quietly}, Gnus will select the next group without asking for
5042 confirmation. If this variable is @code{almost-quietly}, the same
5043 will happen only if you are located on the last article in the group.
5044 Finally, if this variable is @code{slightly-quietly}, the @kbd{Z n}
5045 command will go to the next group without confirmation. Also
5046 @pxref{Group Levels}.
5047
5048 @item gnus-auto-select-same
5049 @vindex gnus-auto-select-same
5050 If non-@code{nil}, all the movement commands will try to go to the next
5051 article with the same subject as the current. (@dfn{Same} here might
5052 mean @dfn{roughly equal}. See @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}
5053 for details (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).) If there are no more
5054 articles with the same subject, go to the first unread article.
5055
5056 This variable is not particularly useful if you use a threaded display.
5057
5058 @item gnus-summary-check-current
5059 @vindex gnus-summary-check-current
5060 If non-@code{nil}, all the ``unread'' movement commands will not proceed
5061 to the next (or previous) article if the current article is unread.
5062 Instead, they will choose the current article.
5063
5064 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
5065 @vindex gnus-auto-center-summary
5066 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will keep the point in the summary buffer
5067 centered at all times. This makes things quite tidy, but if you have a
5068 slow network connection, or simply do not like this un-Emacsism, you can
5069 set this variable to @code{nil} to get the normal Emacs scrolling
5070 action. This will also inhibit horizontal re-centering of the summary
5071 buffer, which might make it more inconvenient to read extremely long
5072 threads.
5073
5074 This variable can also be a number. In that case, center the window at
5075 the given number of lines from the top.
5076
5077 @end table
5078
5079
5080 @node Choosing Articles
5081 @section Choosing Articles
5082 @cindex selecting articles
5083
5084 @menu
5085 * Choosing Commands:: Commands for choosing articles.
5086 * Choosing Variables:: Variables that influence these commands.
5087 @end menu
5088
5089
5090 @node Choosing Commands
5091 @subsection Choosing Commands
5092
5093 None of the following movement commands understand the numeric prefix,
5094 and they all select and display an article.
5095
5096 If you want to fetch new articles or redisplay the group, see
5097 @ref{Exiting the Summary Buffer}.
5098
5099 @table @kbd
5100 @item SPACE
5101 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5102 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5103 Select the current article, or, if that one's read already, the next
5104 unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5105
5106 If you have an article window open already and you press @kbd{SPACE}
5107 again, the article will be scrolled. This lets you conveniently
5108 @kbd{SPACE} through an entire newsgroup. @xref{Paging the Article}.
5109
5110 @item G n
5111 @itemx n
5112 @kindex n (Summary)
5113 @kindex G n (Summary)
5114 @findex gnus-summary-next-unread-article
5115 @c @icon{gnus-summary-next-unread}
5116 Go to next unread article (@code{gnus-summary-next-unread-article}).
5117
5118 @item G p
5119 @itemx p
5120 @kindex p (Summary)
5121 @findex gnus-summary-prev-unread-article
5122 @c @icon{gnus-summary-prev-unread}
5123 Go to previous unread article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-unread-article}).
5124
5125 @item G N
5126 @itemx N
5127 @kindex N (Summary)
5128 @kindex G N (Summary)
5129 @findex gnus-summary-next-article
5130 Go to the next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-article}).
5131
5132 @item G P
5133 @itemx P
5134 @kindex P (Summary)
5135 @kindex G P (Summary)
5136 @findex gnus-summary-prev-article
5137 Go to the previous article (@code{gnus-summary-prev-article}).
5138
5139 @item G C-n
5140 @kindex G C-n (Summary)
5141 @findex gnus-summary-next-same-subject
5142 Go to the next article with the same subject
5143 (@code{gnus-summary-next-same-subject}).
5144
5145 @item G C-p
5146 @kindex G C-p (Summary)
5147 @findex gnus-summary-prev-same-subject
5148 Go to the previous article with the same subject
5149 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-same-subject}).
5150
5151 @item G f
5152 @itemx .
5153 @kindex G f (Summary)
5154 @kindex . (Summary)
5155 @findex gnus-summary-first-unread-article
5156 Go to the first unread article
5157 (@code{gnus-summary-first-unread-article}).
5158
5159 @item G b
5160 @itemx ,
5161 @kindex G b (Summary)
5162 @kindex , (Summary)
5163 @findex gnus-summary-best-unread-article
5164 Go to the unread article with the highest score
5165 (@code{gnus-summary-best-unread-article}). If given a prefix argument,
5166 go to the first unread article that has a score over the default score.
5167
5168 @item G l
5169 @itemx l
5170 @kindex l (Summary)
5171 @kindex G l (Summary)
5172 @findex gnus-summary-goto-last-article
5173 Go to the previous article read (@code{gnus-summary-goto-last-article}).
5174
5175 @item G o
5176 @kindex G o (Summary)
5177 @findex gnus-summary-pop-article
5178 @cindex history
5179 @cindex article history
5180 Pop an article off the summary history and go to this article
5181 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-article}). This command differs from the
5182 command above in that you can pop as many previous articles off the
5183 history as you like, while @kbd{l} toggles the two last read articles.
5184 For a somewhat related issue (if you use these commands a lot),
5185 @pxref{Article Backlog}.
5186
5187 @item G j
5188 @itemx j
5189 @kindex j (Summary)
5190 @kindex G j (Summary)
5191 @findex gnus-summary-goto-article
5192 Ask for an article number or @code{Message-ID}, and then go to that
5193 article (@code{gnus-summary-goto-article}).
5194
5195 @end table
5196
5197
5198 @node Choosing Variables
5199 @subsection Choosing Variables
5200
5201 Some variables relevant for moving and selecting articles:
5202
5203 @table @code
5204 @item gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5205 @vindex gnus-auto-extend-newsgroup
5206 All the movement commands will try to go to the previous (or next)
5207 article, even if that article isn't displayed in the Summary buffer if
5208 this variable is non-@code{nil}. Gnus will then fetch the article from
5209 the server and display it in the article buffer.
5210
5211 @item gnus-select-article-hook
5212 @vindex gnus-select-article-hook
5213 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. The default is
5214 @code{nil}. If you would like each article to be saved in the Agent as
5215 you read it, putting @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} on this
5216 hook will do so.
5217
5218 @item gnus-mark-article-hook
5219 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
5220 @findex gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read
5221 @findex gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read
5222 @findex gnus-unread-mark
5223 This hook is called whenever an article is selected. It is intended to
5224 be used for marking articles as read. The default value is
5225 @code{gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read}, and will change the
5226 mark of almost any article you read to @code{gnus-read-mark}. The only
5227 articles not affected by this function are ticked, dormant, and
5228 expirable articles. If you'd instead like to just have unread articles
5229 marked as read, you can use @code{gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read}
5230 instead. It will leave marks like @code{gnus-low-score-mark},
5231 @code{gnus-del-mark} (and so on) alone.
5232
5233 @end table
5234
5235
5236 @node Paging the Article
5237 @section Scrolling the Article
5238 @cindex article scrolling
5239
5240 @table @kbd
5241
5242 @item SPACE
5243 @kindex SPACE (Summary)
5244 @findex gnus-summary-next-page
5245 Pressing @kbd{SPACE} will scroll the current article forward one page,
5246 or, if you have come to the end of the current article, will choose the
5247 next article (@code{gnus-summary-next-page}).
5248
5249 @vindex gnus-article-boring-faces
5250 @vindex gnus-article-skip-boring
5251 If @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} is non-@code{nil} and the rest of
5252 the article consists only of citations and signature, then it will be
5253 skipped; the next article will be shown instead. You can customize
5254 what is considered uninteresting with
5255 @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}. You can manually view the article's
5256 pages, no matter how boring, using @kbd{C-M-v}.
5257
5258 @item DEL
5259 @kindex DEL (Summary)
5260 @findex gnus-summary-prev-page
5261 Scroll the current article back one page (@code{gnus-summary-prev-page}).
5262
5263 @item RET
5264 @kindex RET (Summary)
5265 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-up
5266 Scroll the current article one line forward
5267 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-up}).
5268
5269 @item M-RET
5270 @kindex M-RET (Summary)
5271 @findex gnus-summary-scroll-down
5272 Scroll the current article one line backward
5273 (@code{gnus-summary-scroll-down}).
5274
5275 @item A g
5276 @itemx g
5277 @kindex A g (Summary)
5278 @kindex g (Summary)
5279 @findex gnus-summary-show-article
5280 @vindex gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5281 (Re)fetch the current article (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). If
5282 given a prefix, fetch the current article, but don't run any of the
5283 article treatment functions. This will give you a ``raw'' article, just
5284 the way it came from the server.
5285
5286 If given a numerical prefix, you can do semi-manual charset stuff.
5287 @kbd{C-u 0 g cn-gb-2312 RET} will decode the message as if it were
5288 encoded in the @code{cn-gb-2312} charset. If you have
5289
5290 @lisp
5291 (setq gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist
5292 '((1 . cn-gb-2312)
5293 (2 . big5)))
5294 @end lisp
5295
5296 then you can say @kbd{C-u 1 g} to get the same effect.
5297
5298 @item A <
5299 @itemx <
5300 @kindex < (Summary)
5301 @kindex A < (Summary)
5302 @findex gnus-summary-beginning-of-article
5303 Scroll to the beginning of the article
5304 (@code{gnus-summary-beginning-of-article}).
5305
5306 @item A >
5307 @itemx >
5308 @kindex > (Summary)
5309 @kindex A > (Summary)
5310 @findex gnus-summary-end-of-article
5311 Scroll to the end of the article (@code{gnus-summary-end-of-article}).
5312
5313 @item A s
5314 @itemx s
5315 @kindex A s (Summary)
5316 @kindex s (Summary)
5317 @findex gnus-summary-isearch-article
5318 Perform an isearch in the article buffer
5319 (@code{gnus-summary-isearch-article}).
5320
5321 @item h
5322 @kindex h (Summary)
5323 @findex gnus-summary-select-article-buffer
5324 Select the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-select-article-buffer}).
5325
5326 @end table
5327
5328
5329 @node Reply Followup and Post
5330 @section Reply, Followup and Post
5331
5332 @menu
5333 * Summary Mail Commands:: Sending mail.
5334 * Summary Post Commands:: Sending news.
5335 * Summary Message Commands:: Other Message-related commands.
5336 * Canceling and Superseding::
5337 @end menu
5338
5339
5340 @node Summary Mail Commands
5341 @subsection Summary Mail Commands
5342 @cindex mail
5343 @cindex composing mail
5344
5345 Commands for composing a mail message:
5346
5347 @table @kbd
5348
5349 @item S r
5350 @itemx r
5351 @kindex S r (Summary)
5352 @kindex r (Summary)
5353 @findex gnus-summary-reply
5354 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-reply}
5355 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply}
5356 Mail a reply to the author of the current article
5357 (@code{gnus-summary-reply}).
5358
5359 @item S R
5360 @itemx R
5361 @kindex R (Summary)
5362 @kindex S R (Summary)
5363 @findex gnus-summary-reply-with-original
5364 @c @icon{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}
5365 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5366 original message (@code{gnus-summary-reply-with-original}). This
5367 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5368
5369 @item S w
5370 @kindex S w (Summary)
5371 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply
5372 Mail a wide reply to the author of the current article
5373 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{wide reply} is a reply that
5374 goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5375 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers. If @code{Mail-Followup-To} is
5376 present, that's used instead.
5377
5378 @item S W
5379 @kindex S W (Summary)
5380 @findex gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original
5381 Mail a wide reply to the current article and include the original
5382 message (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply-with-original}). This command uses
5383 the process/prefix convention.
5384
5385 @item S v
5386 @kindex S v (Summary)
5387 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply
5388 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article
5389 (@code{gnus-summary-wide-reply}). A @dfn{very wide reply} is a reply
5390 that goes out to all people listed in the @code{To}, @code{From} (or
5391 @code{Reply-to}) and @code{Cc} headers in all the process/prefixed
5392 articles. This command uses the process/prefix convention.
5393
5394 @item S V
5395 @kindex S V (Summary)
5396 @findex gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original
5397 Mail a very wide reply to the author of the current article and include the
5398 original message (@code{gnus-summary-very-wide-reply-with-original}). This
5399 command uses the process/prefix convention.
5400
5401 @item S B r
5402 @kindex S B r (Summary)
5403 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to
5404 Mail a reply to the author of the current article but ignore the
5405 @code{Reply-To} field (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to}).
5406 If you need this because a mailing list incorrectly sets a
5407 @code{Reply-To} header pointing to the list, you probably want to set
5408 the @code{broken-reply-to} group parameter instead, so things will work
5409 correctly. @xref{Group Parameters}.
5410
5411 @item S B R
5412 @kindex S B R (Summary)
5413 @findex gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original
5414 Mail a reply to the author of the current article and include the
5415 original message but ignore the @code{Reply-To} field
5416 (@code{gnus-summary-reply-broken-reply-to-with-original}).
5417
5418 @item S o m
5419 @itemx C-c C-f
5420 @kindex S o m (Summary)
5421 @kindex C-c C-f (Summary)
5422 @findex gnus-summary-mail-forward
5423 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-forward}
5424 Forward the current article to some other person
5425 (@code{gnus-summary-mail-forward}). If no prefix is given, the message
5426 is forwarded according to the value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime})
5427 and (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5428 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5429 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5430 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5431 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5432 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5433 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME}
5434 section.
5435
5436 @item S m
5437 @itemx m
5438 @kindex m (Summary)
5439 @kindex S m (Summary)
5440 @findex gnus-summary-mail-other-window
5441 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-originate}
5442 Prepare a mail (@code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}). By default, use
5443 the posting style of the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5444 If the prefix is 1, prompt for a group name to find the posting style.
5445
5446 @item S i
5447 @itemx i
5448 @kindex i (Summary)
5449 @kindex S i (Summary)
5450 @findex gnus-summary-news-other-window
5451 Prepare a news (@code{gnus-summary-news-other-window}). By default,
5452 post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that. If the
5453 prefix is 1, prompt for a group to post to.
5454
5455 This function actually prepares a news even when using mail groups.
5456 This is useful for ``posting'' messages to mail groups without actually
5457 sending them over the network: they're just saved directly to the group
5458 in question. The corresponding back end must have a request-post method
5459 for this to work though.
5460
5461 @item S D b
5462 @kindex S D b (Summary)
5463 @findex gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail
5464 @cindex bouncing mail
5465 If you have sent a mail, but the mail was bounced back to you for some
5466 reason (wrong address, transient failure), you can use this command to
5467 resend that bounced mail (@code{gnus-summary-resend-bounced-mail}). You
5468 will be popped into a mail buffer where you can edit the headers before
5469 sending the mail off again. If you give a prefix to this command, and
5470 the bounced mail is a reply to some other mail, Gnus will try to fetch
5471 that mail and display it for easy perusal of its headers. This might
5472 very well fail, though.
5473
5474 @item S D r
5475 @kindex S D r (Summary)
5476 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message
5477 Not to be confused with the previous command,
5478 @code{gnus-summary-resend-message} will prompt you for an address to
5479 send the current message off to, and then send it to that place. The
5480 headers of the message won't be altered---but lots of headers that say
5481 @code{Resent-To}, @code{Resent-From} and so on will be added. This
5482 means that you actually send a mail to someone that has a @code{To}
5483 header that (probably) points to yourself. This will confuse people.
5484 So, natcherly you'll only do that if you're really eVIl.
5485
5486 This command is mainly used if you have several accounts and want to
5487 ship a mail to a different account of yours. (If you're both
5488 @code{root} and @code{postmaster} and get a mail for @code{postmaster}
5489 to the @code{root} account, you may want to resend it to
5490 @code{postmaster}. Ordnung muss sein!
5491
5492 This command understands the process/prefix convention
5493 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5494
5495 @item S D e
5496 @kindex S D e (Summary)
5497 @findex gnus-summary-resend-message-edit
5498
5499 Like the previous command, but will allow you to edit the message as
5500 if it were a new message before resending.
5501
5502 @item S O m
5503 @kindex S O m (Summary)
5504 @findex gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward
5505 Digest the current series (@pxref{Decoding Articles}) and forward the
5506 result using mail (@code{gnus-uu-digest-mail-forward}). This command
5507 uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5508
5509 @item S M-c
5510 @kindex S M-c (Summary)
5511 @findex gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint
5512 @cindex crossposting
5513 @cindex excessive crossposting
5514 Send a complaint about excessive crossposting to the author of the
5515 current article (@code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint}).
5516
5517 @findex gnus-crosspost-complaint
5518 This command is provided as a way to fight back against the current
5519 crossposting pandemic that's sweeping Usenet. It will compose a reply
5520 using the @code{gnus-crosspost-complaint} variable as a preamble. This
5521 command understands the process/prefix convention
5522 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) and will prompt you before sending each mail.
5523
5524 @end table
5525
5526 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5527 Manual}, for more information.
5528
5529
5530 @node Summary Post Commands
5531 @subsection Summary Post Commands
5532 @cindex post
5533 @cindex composing news
5534
5535 Commands for posting a news article:
5536
5537 @table @kbd
5538 @item S p
5539 @itemx a
5540 @kindex a (Summary)
5541 @kindex S p (Summary)
5542 @findex gnus-summary-post-news
5543 @c @icon{gnus-summary-post-news}
5544 Prepare for posting an article (@code{gnus-summary-post-news}). By
5545 default, post to the current group. If given a prefix, disable that.
5546 If the prefix is 1, prompt for another group instead.
5547
5548 @item S f
5549 @itemx f
5550 @kindex f (Summary)
5551 @kindex S f (Summary)
5552 @findex gnus-summary-followup
5553 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup}
5554 Post a followup to the current article (@code{gnus-summary-followup}).
5555
5556 @item S F
5557 @itemx F
5558 @kindex S F (Summary)
5559 @kindex F (Summary)
5560 @c @icon{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}
5561 @findex gnus-summary-followup-with-original
5562 Post a followup to the current article and include the original message
5563 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-with-original}). This command uses the
5564 process/prefix convention.
5565
5566 @item S n
5567 @kindex S n (Summary)
5568 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail
5569 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5570 message through mail (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail}).
5571
5572 @item S N
5573 @kindex S N (Summary)
5574 @findex gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original
5575 Post a followup to the current article via news, even if you got the
5576 message through mail and include the original message
5577 (@code{gnus-summary-followup-to-mail-with-original}). This command uses
5578 the process/prefix convention.
5579
5580 @item S o p
5581 @kindex S o p (Summary)
5582 @findex gnus-summary-post-forward
5583 Forward the current article to a newsgroup
5584 (@code{gnus-summary-post-forward}).
5585 If no prefix is given, the message is forwarded according to the value
5586 of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}) and
5587 (@code{message-forward-show-mml}); if the prefix is 1, decode the
5588 message and forward directly inline; if the prefix is 2, forward message
5589 as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 3, decode message and
5590 forward as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section; if the prefix is 4, forward message
5591 directly inline; otherwise, the message is forwarded as no prefix given
5592 but use the flipped value of (@code{message-forward-as-mime}). By
5593 default, the message is decoded and forwarded as an rfc822 @acronym{MIME} section.
5594
5595 @item S O p
5596 @kindex S O p (Summary)
5597 @findex gnus-uu-digest-post-forward
5598 @cindex digests
5599 @cindex making digests
5600 Digest the current series and forward the result to a newsgroup
5601 (@code{gnus-uu-digest-post-forward}). This command uses the
5602 process/prefix convention.
5603
5604 @item S u
5605 @kindex S u (Summary)
5606 @findex gnus-uu-post-news
5607 @c @icon{gnus-uu-post-news}
5608 Uuencode a file, split it into parts, and post it as a series
5609 (@code{gnus-uu-post-news}). (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
5610 @end table
5611
5612 Also @xref{Header Commands, ,Header Commands, message, The Message
5613 Manual}, for more information.
5614
5615
5616 @node Summary Message Commands
5617 @subsection Summary Message Commands
5618
5619 @table @kbd
5620 @item S y
5621 @kindex S y (Summary)
5622 @findex gnus-summary-yank-message
5623 Yank the current article into an already existing Message composition
5624 buffer (@code{gnus-summary-yank-message}). This command prompts for
5625 what message buffer you want to yank into, and understands the
5626 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5627
5628 @end table
5629
5630
5631 @node Canceling and Superseding
5632 @subsection Canceling Articles
5633 @cindex canceling articles
5634 @cindex superseding articles
5635
5636 Have you ever written something, and then decided that you really,
5637 really, really wish you hadn't posted that?
5638
5639 Well, you can't cancel mail, but you can cancel posts.
5640
5641 @findex gnus-summary-cancel-article
5642 @kindex C (Summary)
5643 @c @icon{gnus-summary-cancel-article}
5644 Find the article you wish to cancel (you can only cancel your own
5645 articles, so don't try any funny stuff). Then press @kbd{C} or @kbd{S
5646 c} (@code{gnus-summary-cancel-article}). Your article will be
5647 canceled---machines all over the world will be deleting your article.
5648 This command uses the process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
5649
5650 Be aware, however, that not all sites honor cancels, so your article may
5651 live on here and there, while most sites will delete the article in
5652 question.
5653
5654 Gnus will use the ``current'' select method when canceling. If you
5655 want to use the standard posting method, use the @samp{a} symbolic
5656 prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}).
5657
5658 Gnus ensures that only you can cancel your own messages using a
5659 @code{Cancel-Lock} header (@pxref{Canceling News, Canceling News, ,
5660 message, Message Manual}).
5661
5662 If you discover that you have made some mistakes and want to do some
5663 corrections, you can post a @dfn{superseding} article that will replace
5664 your original article.
5665
5666 @findex gnus-summary-supersede-article
5667 @kindex S (Summary)
5668 Go to the original article and press @kbd{S s}
5669 (@code{gnus-summary-supersede-article}). You will be put in a buffer
5670 where you can edit the article all you want before sending it off the
5671 usual way.
5672
5673 The same goes for superseding as for canceling, only more so: Some
5674 sites do not honor superseding. On those sites, it will appear that you
5675 have posted almost the same article twice.
5676
5677 If you have just posted the article, and change your mind right away,
5678 there is a trick you can use to cancel/supersede the article without
5679 waiting for the article to appear on your site first. You simply return
5680 to the post buffer (which is called @code{*sent ...*}). There you will
5681 find the article you just posted, with all the headers intact. Change
5682 the @code{Message-ID} header to a @code{Cancel} or @code{Supersedes}
5683 header by substituting one of those words for the word
5684 @code{Message-ID}. Then just press @kbd{C-c C-c} to send the article as
5685 you would do normally. The previous article will be
5686 canceled/superseded.
5687
5688 Just remember, kids: There is no 'c' in 'supersede'.
5689
5690 @node Delayed Articles
5691 @section Delayed Articles
5692 @cindex delayed sending
5693 @cindex send delayed
5694
5695 Sometimes, you might wish to delay the sending of a message. For
5696 example, you might wish to arrange for a message to turn up just in time
5697 to remind your about the birthday of your Significant Other. For this,
5698 there is the @code{gnus-delay} package. Setup is simple:
5699
5700 @lisp
5701 (gnus-delay-initialize)
5702 @end lisp
5703
5704 @findex gnus-delay-article
5705 Normally, to send a message you use the @kbd{C-c C-c} command from
5706 Message mode. To delay a message, use @kbd{C-c C-j}
5707 (@code{gnus-delay-article}) instead. This will ask you for how long the
5708 message should be delayed. Possible answers are:
5709
5710 @itemize @bullet
5711 @item
5712 A time span. Consists of an integer and a letter. For example,
5713 @code{42d} means to delay for 42 days. Available letters are @code{m}
5714 (minutes), @code{h} (hours), @code{d} (days), @code{w} (weeks), @code{M}
5715 (months) and @code{Y} (years).
5716
5717 @item
5718 A specific date. Looks like @code{YYYY-MM-DD}. The message will be
5719 delayed until that day, at a specific time (eight o'clock by default).
5720 See also @code{gnus-delay-default-hour}.
5721
5722 @item
5723 A specific time of day. Given in @code{hh:mm} format, 24h, no am/pm
5724 stuff. The deadline will be at that time today, except if that time has
5725 already passed, then it's at the given time tomorrow. So if it's ten
5726 o'clock in the morning and you specify @code{11:15}, then the deadline
5727 is one hour and fifteen minutes hence. But if you specify @code{9:20},
5728 that means a time tomorrow.
5729 @end itemize
5730
5731 The action of the @code{gnus-delay-article} command is influenced by a
5732 couple of variables:
5733
5734 @table @code
5735 @item gnus-delay-default-hour
5736 @vindex gnus-delay-default-hour
5737 When you specify a specific date, the message will be due on that hour
5738 on the given date. Possible values are integers 0 through 23.
5739
5740 @item gnus-delay-default-delay
5741 @vindex gnus-delay-default-delay
5742 This is a string and gives the default delay. It can be of any of the
5743 formats described above.
5744
5745 @item gnus-delay-group
5746 @vindex gnus-delay-group
5747 Delayed articles will be kept in this group on the drafts server until
5748 they are due. You probably don't need to change this. The default
5749 value is @code{"delayed"}.
5750
5751 @item gnus-delay-header
5752 @vindex gnus-delay-header
5753 The deadline for each article will be stored in a header. This variable
5754 is a string and gives the header name. You probably don't need to
5755 change this. The default value is @code{"X-Gnus-Delayed"}.
5756 @end table
5757
5758 The way delaying works is like this: when you use the
5759 @code{gnus-delay-article} command, you give a certain delay. Gnus
5760 calculates the deadline of the message and stores it in the
5761 @code{X-Gnus-Delayed} header and puts the message in the
5762 @code{nndraft:delayed} group.
5763
5764 @findex gnus-delay-send-queue
5765 And whenever you get new news, Gnus looks through the group for articles
5766 which are due and sends them. It uses the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue}
5767 function for this. By default, this function is added to the hook
5768 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But of course, you can change this.
5769 Maybe you want to use the demon to send drafts? Just tell the demon to
5770 execute the @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} function.
5771
5772 @table @code
5773 @item gnus-delay-initialize
5774 @findex gnus-delay-initialize
5775 By default, this function installs @code{gnus-delay-send-queue} in
5776 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook}. But it accepts the optional second
5777 argument @code{no-check}. If it is non-@code{nil},
5778 @code{gnus-get-new-news-hook} is not changed. The optional first
5779 argument is ignored.
5780
5781 For example, @code{(gnus-delay-initialize nil t)} means to do nothing.
5782 Presumably, you want to use the demon for sending due delayed articles.
5783 Just don't forget to set that up :-)
5784 @end table
5785
5786
5787 @node Marking Articles
5788 @section Marking Articles
5789 @cindex article marking
5790 @cindex article ticking
5791 @cindex marks
5792
5793 There are several marks you can set on an article.
5794
5795 You have marks that decide the @dfn{readedness} (whoo, neato-keano
5796 neologism ohoy!) of the article. Alphabetic marks generally mean
5797 @dfn{read}, while non-alphabetic characters generally mean @dfn{unread}.
5798
5799 In addition, you also have marks that do not affect readedness.
5800
5801 @ifinfo
5802 There's a plethora of commands for manipulating these marks.
5803 @end ifinfo
5804
5805 @menu
5806 * Unread Articles:: Marks for unread articles.
5807 * Read Articles:: Marks for read articles.
5808 * Other Marks:: Marks that do not affect readedness.
5809 * Setting Marks:: How to set and remove marks.
5810 * Generic Marking Commands:: How to customize the marking.
5811 * Setting Process Marks:: How to mark articles for later processing.
5812 @end menu
5813
5814
5815 @node Unread Articles
5816 @subsection Unread Articles
5817
5818 The following marks mark articles as (kinda) unread, in one form or
5819 other.
5820
5821 @table @samp
5822 @item !
5823 @vindex gnus-ticked-mark
5824 Marked as ticked (@code{gnus-ticked-mark}).
5825
5826 @dfn{Ticked articles} are articles that will remain visible always. If
5827 you see an article that you find interesting, or you want to put off
5828 reading it, or replying to it, until sometime later, you'd typically
5829 tick it. However, articles can be expired (from news servers by the
5830 news server software, Gnus itself never expires ticked messages), so if
5831 you want to keep an article forever, you'll have to make it persistent
5832 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
5833
5834 @item ?
5835 @vindex gnus-dormant-mark
5836 Marked as dormant (@code{gnus-dormant-mark}).
5837
5838 @dfn{Dormant articles} will only appear in the summary buffer if there
5839 are followups to it. If you want to see them even if they don't have
5840 followups, you can use the @kbd{/ D} command (@pxref{Limiting}).
5841 Otherwise (except for the visibility issue), they are just like ticked
5842 messages.
5843
5844 @item SPACE
5845 @vindex gnus-unread-mark
5846 Marked as unread (@code{gnus-unread-mark}).
5847
5848 @dfn{Unread articles} are articles that haven't been read at all yet.
5849 @end table
5850
5851
5852 @node Read Articles
5853 @subsection Read Articles
5854 @cindex expirable mark
5855
5856 All the following marks mark articles as read.
5857
5858 @table @samp
5859
5860 @item r
5861 @vindex gnus-del-mark
5862 These are articles that the user has marked as read with the @kbd{d}
5863 command manually, more or less (@code{gnus-del-mark}).
5864
5865 @item R
5866 @vindex gnus-read-mark
5867 Articles that have actually been read (@code{gnus-read-mark}).
5868
5869 @item O
5870 @vindex gnus-ancient-mark
5871 Articles that were marked as read in previous sessions and are now
5872 @dfn{old} (@code{gnus-ancient-mark}).
5873
5874 @item K
5875 @vindex gnus-killed-mark
5876 Marked as killed (@code{gnus-killed-mark}).
5877
5878 @item X
5879 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mark
5880 Marked as killed by kill files (@code{gnus-kill-file-mark}).
5881
5882 @item Y
5883 @vindex gnus-low-score-mark
5884 Marked as read by having too low a score (@code{gnus-low-score-mark}).
5885
5886 @item C
5887 @vindex gnus-catchup-mark
5888 Marked as read by a catchup (@code{gnus-catchup-mark}).
5889
5890 @item G
5891 @vindex gnus-canceled-mark
5892 Canceled article (@code{gnus-canceled-mark})
5893
5894 @item F
5895 @vindex gnus-souped-mark
5896 @sc{soup}ed article (@code{gnus-souped-mark}). @xref{SOUP}.
5897
5898 @item Q
5899 @vindex gnus-sparse-mark
5900 Sparsely reffed article (@code{gnus-sparse-mark}). @xref{Customizing
5901 Threading}.
5902
5903 @item M
5904 @vindex gnus-duplicate-mark
5905 Article marked as read by duplicate suppression
5906 (@code{gnus-duplicate-mark}). @xref{Duplicate Suppression}.
5907
5908 @end table
5909
5910 All these marks just mean that the article is marked as read, really.
5911 They are interpreted differently when doing adaptive scoring, though.
5912
5913 One more special mark, though:
5914
5915 @table @samp
5916 @item E
5917 @vindex gnus-expirable-mark
5918 Marked as expirable (@code{gnus-expirable-mark}).
5919
5920 Marking articles as @dfn{expirable} (or have them marked as such
5921 automatically) doesn't make much sense in normal groups---a user doesn't
5922 control expiring of news articles, but in mail groups, for instance,
5923 articles marked as @dfn{expirable} can be deleted by Gnus at
5924 any time.
5925 @end table
5926
5927
5928 @node Other Marks
5929 @subsection Other Marks
5930 @cindex process mark
5931 @cindex bookmarks
5932
5933 There are some marks that have nothing to do with whether the article is
5934 read or not.
5935
5936 @itemize @bullet
5937
5938 @item
5939 You can set a bookmark in the current article. Say you are reading a
5940 long thesis on cats' urinary tracts, and have to go home for dinner
5941 before you've finished reading the thesis. You can then set a bookmark
5942 in the article, and Gnus will jump to this bookmark the next time it
5943 encounters the article. @xref{Setting Marks}.
5944
5945 @item
5946 @vindex gnus-replied-mark
5947 All articles that you have replied to or made a followup to (i.e., have
5948 answered) will be marked with an @samp{A} in the second column
5949 (@code{gnus-replied-mark}).
5950
5951 @item
5952 @vindex gnus-forwarded-mark
5953 All articles that you have forwarded will be marked with an @samp{F} in
5954 the second column (@code{gnus-forwarded-mark}).
5955
5956 @item
5957 @vindex gnus-cached-mark
5958 Articles stored in the article cache will be marked with an @samp{*} in
5959 the second column (@code{gnus-cached-mark}). @xref{Article Caching}.
5960
5961 @item
5962 @vindex gnus-saved-mark
5963 Articles ``saved'' (in some manner or other; not necessarily
5964 religiously) are marked with an @samp{S} in the second column
5965 (@code{gnus-saved-mark}).
5966
5967 @item
5968 @vindex gnus-recent-mark
5969 Articles that according to the server haven't been shown to the user
5970 before are marked with a @samp{N} in the second column
5971 (@code{gnus-recent-mark}). Note that not all servers support this
5972 mark, in which case it simply never appears. Compare with
5973 @code{gnus-unseen-mark}.
5974
5975 @item
5976 @vindex gnus-unseen-mark
5977 Articles that haven't been seen before in Gnus by the user are marked
5978 with a @samp{.} in the second column (@code{gnus-unseen-mark}).
5979 Compare with @code{gnus-recent-mark}.
5980
5981 @item
5982 @vindex gnus-downloaded-mark
5983 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), articles may be
5984 downloaded for unplugged (offline) viewing. If you are using the
5985 @samp{%O} spec, these articles get the @samp{+} mark in that spec.
5986 (The variable @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} controls which character to
5987 use.)
5988
5989 @item
5990 @vindex gnus-undownloaded-mark
5991 When using the Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}), some articles might
5992 not have been downloaded. Such articles cannot be viewed while you
5993 are unplugged (offline). If you are using the @samp{%O} spec, these
5994 articles get the @samp{-} mark in that spec. (The variable
5995 @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} controls which character to use.)
5996
5997 @item
5998 @vindex gnus-downloadable-mark
5999 The Gnus agent (@pxref{Agent Basics}) downloads some articles
6000 automatically, but it is also possible to explicitly mark articles for
6001 download, even if they would not be downloaded automatically. Such
6002 explicitly-marked articles get the @samp{%} mark in the first column.
6003 (The variable @code{gnus-downloadable-mark} controls which character to
6004 use.)
6005
6006 @item
6007 @vindex gnus-not-empty-thread-mark
6008 @vindex gnus-empty-thread-mark
6009 If the @samp{%e} spec is used, the presence of threads or not will be
6010 marked with @code{gnus-not-empty-thread-mark} and
6011 @code{gnus-empty-thread-mark} in the third column, respectively.
6012
6013 @item
6014 @vindex gnus-process-mark
6015 Finally we have the @dfn{process mark} (@code{gnus-process-mark}). A
6016 variety of commands react to the presence of the process mark. For
6017 instance, @kbd{X u} (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}) will uudecode and view
6018 all articles that have been marked with the process mark. Articles
6019 marked with the process mark have a @samp{#} in the second column.
6020
6021 @end itemize
6022
6023 You might have noticed that most of these ``non-readedness'' marks
6024 appear in the second column by default. So if you have a cached, saved,
6025 replied article that you have process-marked, what will that look like?
6026
6027 Nothing much. The precedence rules go as follows: process -> cache ->
6028 replied -> saved. So if the article is in the cache and is replied,
6029 you'll only see the cache mark and not the replied mark.
6030
6031
6032 @node Setting Marks
6033 @subsection Setting Marks
6034 @cindex setting marks
6035
6036 All the marking commands understand the numeric prefix.
6037
6038 @table @kbd
6039 @item M c
6040 @itemx M-u
6041 @kindex M c (Summary)
6042 @kindex M-u (Summary)
6043 @findex gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward
6044 @cindex mark as unread
6045 Clear all readedness-marks from the current article
6046 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-mark-forward}). In other words, mark the
6047 article as unread.
6048
6049 @item M t
6050 @itemx !
6051 @kindex ! (Summary)
6052 @kindex M t (Summary)
6053 @findex gnus-summary-tick-article-forward
6054 Tick the current article (@code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}).
6055 @xref{Article Caching}.
6056
6057 @item M ?
6058 @itemx ?
6059 @kindex ? (Summary)
6060 @kindex M ? (Summary)
6061 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant
6062 Mark the current article as dormant
6063 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-dormant}). @xref{Article Caching}.
6064
6065 @item M d
6066 @itemx d
6067 @kindex M d (Summary)
6068 @kindex d (Summary)
6069 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward
6070 Mark the current article as read
6071 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward}).
6072
6073 @item D
6074 @kindex D (Summary)
6075 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward
6076 Mark the current article as read and move point to the previous line
6077 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-read-backward}).
6078
6079 @item M k
6080 @itemx k
6081 @kindex k (Summary)
6082 @kindex M k (Summary)
6083 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select
6084 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read,
6085 and then select the next unread article
6086 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject-and-select}).
6087
6088 @item M K
6089 @itemx C-k
6090 @kindex M K (Summary)
6091 @kindex C-k (Summary)
6092 @findex gnus-summary-kill-same-subject
6093 Mark all articles that have the same subject as the current one as read
6094 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-same-subject}).
6095
6096 @item M C
6097 @kindex M C (Summary)
6098 @findex gnus-summary-catchup
6099 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup}
6100 Mark all unread articles as read (@code{gnus-summary-catchup}).
6101
6102 @item M C-c
6103 @kindex M C-c (Summary)
6104 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all
6105 Mark all articles in the group as read---even the ticked and dormant
6106 articles (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all}).
6107
6108 @item M H
6109 @kindex M H (Summary)
6110 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-to-here
6111 Catchup the current group to point (before the point)
6112 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-to-here}).
6113
6114 @item M h
6115 @kindex M h (Summary)
6116 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-from-here
6117 Catchup the current group from point (after the point)
6118 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-from-here}).
6119
6120 @item C-w
6121 @kindex C-w (Summary)
6122 @findex gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read
6123 Mark all articles between point and mark as read
6124 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-region-as-read}).
6125
6126 @item M V k
6127 @kindex M V k (Summary)
6128 @findex gnus-summary-kill-below
6129 Kill all articles with scores below the default score (or below the
6130 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-kill-below}).
6131
6132 @item M e
6133 @itemx E
6134 @kindex M e (Summary)
6135 @kindex E (Summary)
6136 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable
6137 Mark the current article as expirable
6138 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable}).
6139
6140 @item M b
6141 @kindex M b (Summary)
6142 @findex gnus-summary-set-bookmark
6143 Set a bookmark in the current article
6144 (@code{gnus-summary-set-bookmark}).
6145
6146 @item M B
6147 @kindex M B (Summary)
6148 @findex gnus-summary-remove-bookmark
6149 Remove the bookmark from the current article
6150 (@code{gnus-summary-remove-bookmark}).
6151
6152 @item M V c
6153 @kindex M V c (Summary)
6154 @findex gnus-summary-clear-above
6155 Clear all marks from articles with scores over the default score (or
6156 over the numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6157
6158 @item M V u
6159 @kindex M V u (Summary)
6160 @findex gnus-summary-tick-above
6161 Tick all articles with scores over the default score (or over the
6162 numeric prefix) (@code{gnus-summary-tick-above}).
6163
6164 @item M V m
6165 @kindex M V m (Summary)
6166 @findex gnus-summary-mark-above
6167 Prompt for a mark, and mark all articles with scores over the default
6168 score (or over the numeric prefix) with this mark
6169 (@code{gnus-summary-clear-above}).
6170 @end table
6171
6172 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
6173 The @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} variable controls what action should
6174 be taken after setting a mark. If non-@code{nil}, point will move to
6175 the next/previous unread article. If @code{nil}, point will just move
6176 one line up or down. As a special case, if this variable is
6177 @code{never}, all the marking commands as well as other commands (like
6178 @kbd{SPACE}) will move to the next article, whether it is unread or not.
6179 The default is @code{t}.
6180
6181
6182 @node Generic Marking Commands
6183 @subsection Generic Marking Commands
6184
6185 Some people would like the command that ticks an article (@kbd{!}) go to
6186 the next article. Others would like it to go to the next unread
6187 article. Yet others would like it to stay on the current article. And
6188 even though I haven't heard of anybody wanting it to go to the
6189 previous (unread) article, I'm sure there are people that want that as
6190 well.
6191
6192 Multiply these five behaviors with five different marking commands, and
6193 you get a potentially complex set of variable to control what each
6194 command should do.
6195
6196 To sidestep that mess, Gnus provides commands that do all these
6197 different things. They can be found on the @kbd{M M} map in the summary
6198 buffer. Type @kbd{M M C-h} to see them all---there are too many of them
6199 to list in this manual.
6200
6201 While you can use these commands directly, most users would prefer
6202 altering the summary mode keymap. For instance, if you would like the
6203 @kbd{!} command to go to the next article instead of the next unread
6204 article, you could say something like:
6205
6206 @lisp
6207 @group
6208 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'my-alter-summary-map)
6209 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6210 (local-set-key "!" 'gnus-summary-put-mark-as-ticked-next))
6211 @end group
6212 @end lisp
6213
6214 @noindent
6215 or
6216
6217 @lisp
6218 (defun my-alter-summary-map ()
6219 (local-set-key "!" "MM!n"))
6220 @end lisp
6221
6222
6223 @node Setting Process Marks
6224 @subsection Setting Process Marks
6225 @cindex setting process marks
6226
6227 Process marks are displayed as @code{#} in the summary buffer, and are
6228 used for marking articles in such a way that other commands will
6229 process these articles. For instance, if you process mark four
6230 articles and then use the @kbd{*} command, Gnus will enter these four
6231 articles into the cache. For more information,
6232 @pxref{Process/Prefix}.
6233
6234 @table @kbd
6235
6236 @item M P p
6237 @itemx #
6238 @kindex # (Summary)
6239 @kindex M P p (Summary)
6240 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-processable
6241 Mark the current article with the process mark
6242 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-processable}).
6243 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable
6244
6245 @item M P u
6246 @itemx M-#
6247 @kindex M P u (Summary)
6248 @kindex M-# (Summary)
6249 Remove the process mark, if any, from the current article
6250 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-as-processable}).
6251
6252 @item M P U
6253 @kindex M P U (Summary)
6254 @findex gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable
6255 Remove the process mark from all articles
6256 (@code{gnus-summary-unmark-all-processable}).
6257
6258 @item M P i
6259 @kindex M P i (Summary)
6260 @findex gnus-uu-invert-processable
6261 Invert the list of process marked articles
6262 (@code{gnus-uu-invert-processable}).
6263
6264 @item M P R
6265 @kindex M P R (Summary)
6266 @findex gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp
6267 Mark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6268 expression (@code{gnus-uu-mark-by-regexp}).
6269
6270 @item M P G
6271 @kindex M P G (Summary)
6272 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp
6273 Unmark articles that have a @code{Subject} header that matches a regular
6274 expression (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-by-regexp}).
6275
6276 @item M P r
6277 @kindex M P r (Summary)
6278 @findex gnus-uu-mark-region
6279 Mark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-mark-region}).
6280
6281 @item M P g
6282 @kindex M P g (Summary)
6283 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-region
6284 Unmark articles in region (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-region}).
6285
6286 @item M P t
6287 @kindex M P t (Summary)
6288 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6289 Mark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6290 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6291
6292 @item M P T
6293 @kindex M P T (Summary)
6294 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6295 Unmark all articles in the current (sub)thread
6296 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6297
6298 @item M P v
6299 @kindex M P v (Summary)
6300 @findex gnus-uu-mark-over
6301 Mark all articles that have a score above the prefix argument
6302 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-over}).
6303
6304 @item M P s
6305 @kindex M P s (Summary)
6306 @findex gnus-uu-mark-series
6307 Mark all articles in the current series (@code{gnus-uu-mark-series}).
6308
6309 @item M P S
6310 @kindex M P S (Summary)
6311 @findex gnus-uu-mark-sparse
6312 Mark all series that have already had some articles marked
6313 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-sparse}).
6314
6315 @item M P a
6316 @kindex M P a (Summary)
6317 @findex gnus-uu-mark-all
6318 Mark all articles in series order (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}).
6319
6320 @item M P b
6321 @kindex M P b (Summary)
6322 @findex gnus-uu-mark-buffer
6323 Mark all articles in the buffer in the order they appear
6324 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-buffer}).
6325
6326 @item M P k
6327 @kindex M P k (Summary)
6328 @findex gnus-summary-kill-process-mark
6329 Push the current process mark set onto the stack and unmark all articles
6330 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-process-mark}).
6331
6332 @item M P y
6333 @kindex M P y (Summary)
6334 @findex gnus-summary-yank-process-mark
6335 Pop the previous process mark set from the stack and restore it
6336 (@code{gnus-summary-yank-process-mark}).
6337
6338 @item M P w
6339 @kindex M P w (Summary)
6340 @findex gnus-summary-save-process-mark
6341 Push the current process mark set onto the stack
6342 (@code{gnus-summary-save-process-mark}).
6343
6344 @end table
6345
6346 Also see the @kbd{&} command in @ref{Searching for Articles}, for how to
6347 set process marks based on article body contents.
6348
6349
6350 @node Limiting
6351 @section Limiting
6352 @cindex limiting
6353
6354 It can be convenient to limit the summary buffer to just show some
6355 subset of the articles currently in the group. The effect most limit
6356 commands have is to remove a few (or many) articles from the summary
6357 buffer.
6358
6359 All limiting commands work on subsets of the articles already fetched
6360 from the servers. None of these commands query the server for
6361 additional articles.
6362
6363 @table @kbd
6364
6365 @item / /
6366 @itemx / s
6367 @kindex / / (Summary)
6368 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-subject
6369 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some subject
6370 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-subject}). If given a prefix, exclude
6371 matching articles.
6372
6373 @item / a
6374 @kindex / a (Summary)
6375 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-author
6376 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match some author
6377 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-author}). If given a prefix, exclude
6378 matching articles.
6379
6380 @item / x
6381 @kindex / x (Summary)
6382 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-extra
6383 Limit the summary buffer to articles that match one of the ``extra''
6384 headers (@pxref{To From Newsgroups})
6385 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-extra}). If given a prefix, exclude
6386 matching articles.
6387
6388 @item / u
6389 @itemx x
6390 @kindex / u (Summary)
6391 @kindex x (Summary)
6392 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unread
6393 Limit the summary buffer to articles not marked as read
6394 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unread}). If given a prefix, limit the
6395 buffer to articles strictly unread. This means that ticked and
6396 dormant articles will also be excluded.
6397
6398 @item / m
6399 @kindex / m (Summary)
6400 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-marks
6401 Ask for a mark and then limit to all articles that have been marked
6402 with that mark (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-marks}).
6403
6404 @item / t
6405 @kindex / t (Summary)
6406 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-age
6407 Ask for a number and then limit the summary buffer to articles older than (or equal to) that number of days
6408 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-age}). If given a prefix, limit to
6409 articles younger than that number of days.
6410
6411 @item / n
6412 @kindex / n (Summary)
6413 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-articles
6414 With prefix @samp{n}, limit the summary buffer to the next @samp{n}
6415 articles. If not given a prefix, use the process marked articles
6416 instead. (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-articles}).
6417
6418 @item / w
6419 @kindex / w (Summary)
6420 @findex gnus-summary-pop-limit
6421 Pop the previous limit off the stack and restore it
6422 (@code{gnus-summary-pop-limit}). If given a prefix, pop all limits off
6423 the stack.
6424
6425 @item / .
6426 @kindex / . (Summary)
6427 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen
6428 Limit the summary buffer to the unseen articles
6429 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-unseen}).
6430
6431 @item / v
6432 @kindex / v (Summary)
6433 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-score
6434 Limit the summary buffer to articles that have a score at or above some
6435 score (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-score}).
6436
6437 @item / p
6438 @kindex / p (Summary)
6439 @findex gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate
6440 Limit the summary buffer to articles that satisfy the @code{display}
6441 group parameter predicate
6442 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-display-predicate}). @xref{Group
6443 Parameters}, for more on this predicate.
6444
6445 @item / E
6446 @itemx M S
6447 @kindex M S (Summary)
6448 @kindex / E (Summary)
6449 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged
6450 Include all expunged articles in the limit
6451 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-expunged}).
6452
6453 @item / D
6454 @kindex / D (Summary)
6455 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant
6456 Include all dormant articles in the limit
6457 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-dormant}).
6458
6459 @item / *
6460 @kindex / * (Summary)
6461 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-cached
6462 Include all cached articles in the limit
6463 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}).
6464
6465 @item / d
6466 @kindex / d (Summary)
6467 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant
6468 Exclude all dormant articles from the limit
6469 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-dormant}).
6470
6471 @item / M
6472 @kindex / M (Summary)
6473 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks
6474 Exclude all marked articles (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-marks}).
6475
6476 @item / T
6477 @kindex / T (Summary)
6478 @findex gnus-summary-limit-include-thread
6479 Include all the articles in the current thread in the limit.
6480
6481 @item / c
6482 @kindex / c (Summary)
6483 @findex gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant
6484 Exclude all dormant articles that have no children from the limit@*
6485 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-exclude-childless-dormant}).
6486
6487 @item / C
6488 @kindex / C (Summary)
6489 @findex gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read
6490 Mark all excluded unread articles as read
6491 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-mark-excluded-as-read}). If given a prefix,
6492 also mark excluded ticked and dormant articles as read.
6493
6494 @item / N
6495 @kindex / N (Summary)
6496 @findex gnus-summary-insert-new-articles
6497 Insert all new articles in the summary buffer. It scans for new emails
6498 if @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} is non-@code{nil}.
6499
6500 @item / o
6501 @kindex / o (Summary)
6502 @findex gnus-summary-insert-old-articles
6503 Insert all old articles in the summary buffer. If given a numbered
6504 prefix, fetch this number of articles.
6505
6506 @end table
6507
6508
6509 @node Threading
6510 @section Threading
6511 @cindex threading
6512 @cindex article threading
6513
6514 Gnus threads articles by default. @dfn{To thread} is to put responses
6515 to articles directly after the articles they respond to---in a
6516 hierarchical fashion.
6517
6518 Threading is done by looking at the @code{References} headers of the
6519 articles. In a perfect world, this would be enough to build pretty
6520 trees, but unfortunately, the @code{References} header is often broken
6521 or simply missing. Weird news propagation exacerbates the problem,
6522 so one has to employ other heuristics to get pleasing results. A
6523 plethora of approaches exists, as detailed in horrible detail in
6524 @ref{Customizing Threading}.
6525
6526 First, a quick overview of the concepts:
6527
6528 @table @dfn
6529 @item root
6530 The top-most article in a thread; the first article in the thread.
6531
6532 @item thread
6533 A tree-like article structure.
6534
6535 @item sub-thread
6536 A small(er) section of this tree-like structure.
6537
6538 @item loose threads
6539 Threads often lose their roots due to article expiry, or due to the root
6540 already having been read in a previous session, and not displayed in the
6541 summary buffer. We then typically have many sub-threads that really
6542 belong to one thread, but are without connecting roots. These are
6543 called loose threads.
6544
6545 @item thread gathering
6546 An attempt to gather loose threads into bigger threads.
6547
6548 @item sparse threads
6549 A thread where the missing articles have been ``guessed'' at, and are
6550 displayed as empty lines in the summary buffer.
6551
6552 @end table
6553
6554
6555 @menu
6556 * Customizing Threading:: Variables you can change to affect the threading.
6557 * Thread Commands:: Thread based commands in the summary buffer.
6558 @end menu
6559
6560
6561 @node Customizing Threading
6562 @subsection Customizing Threading
6563 @cindex customizing threading
6564
6565 @menu
6566 * Loose Threads:: How Gnus gathers loose threads into bigger threads.
6567 * Filling In Threads:: Making the threads displayed look fuller.
6568 * More Threading:: Even more variables for fiddling with threads.
6569 * Low-Level Threading:: You thought it was over@dots{} but you were wrong!
6570 @end menu
6571
6572
6573 @node Loose Threads
6574 @subsubsection Loose Threads
6575 @cindex <
6576 @cindex >
6577 @cindex loose threads
6578
6579 @table @code
6580 @item gnus-summary-make-false-root
6581 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root
6582 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will gather all loose subtrees into one big tree
6583 and create a dummy root at the top. (Wait a minute. Root at the top?
6584 Yup.) Loose subtrees occur when the real root has expired, or you've
6585 read or killed the root in a previous session.
6586
6587 When there is no real root of a thread, Gnus will have to fudge
6588 something. This variable says what fudging method Gnus should use.
6589 There are four possible values:
6590
6591 @iftex
6592 @iflatex
6593 \gnusfigure{The Summary Buffer}{390}{
6594 \put(0,0){\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-adopt,width=7.5cm}}
6595 \put(445,0){\makebox(0,0)[br]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-empty,width=7.5cm}}}
6596 \put(0,400){\makebox(0,0)[tl]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-none,width=7.5cm}}}
6597 \put(445,400){\makebox(0,0)[tr]{\epsfig{figure=ps/summary-dummy,width=7.5cm}}}
6598 }
6599 @end iflatex
6600 @end iftex
6601
6602 @cindex adopting articles
6603
6604 @table @code
6605
6606 @item adopt
6607 Gnus will make the first of the orphaned articles the parent. This
6608 parent will adopt all the other articles. The adopted articles will be
6609 marked as such by pointy brackets (@samp{<>}) instead of the standard
6610 square brackets (@samp{[]}). This is the default method.
6611
6612 @item dummy
6613 @vindex gnus-summary-dummy-line-format
6614 @vindex gnus-summary-make-false-root-always
6615 Gnus will create a dummy summary line that will pretend to be the
6616 parent. This dummy line does not correspond to any real article, so
6617 selecting it will just select the first real article after the dummy
6618 article. @code{gnus-summary-dummy-line-format} is used to specify the
6619 format of the dummy roots. It accepts only one format spec: @samp{S},
6620 which is the subject of the article. @xref{Formatting Variables}.
6621 If you want all threads to have a dummy root, even the non-gathered
6622 ones, set @code{gnus-summary-make-false-root-always} to @code{t}.
6623
6624 @item empty
6625 Gnus won't actually make any article the parent, but simply leave the
6626 subject field of all orphans except the first empty. (Actually, it will
6627 use @code{gnus-summary-same-subject} as the subject (@pxref{Summary
6628 Buffer Format}).)
6629
6630 @item none
6631 Don't make any article parent at all. Just gather the threads and
6632 display them after one another.
6633
6634 @item nil
6635 Don't gather loose threads.
6636 @end table
6637
6638 @item gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6639 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit
6640 Loose threads are gathered by comparing subjects of articles. If this
6641 variable is @code{nil}, Gnus requires an exact match between the
6642 subjects of the loose threads before gathering them into one big
6643 super-thread. This might be too strict a requirement, what with the
6644 presence of stupid newsreaders that chop off long subject lines. If
6645 you think so, set this variable to, say, 20 to require that only the
6646 first 20 characters of the subjects have to match. If you set this
6647 variable to a really low number, you'll find that Gnus will gather
6648 everything in sight into one thread, which isn't very helpful.
6649
6650 @cindex fuzzy article gathering
6651 If you set this variable to the special value @code{fuzzy}, Gnus will
6652 use a fuzzy string comparison algorithm on the subjects (@pxref{Fuzzy
6653 Matching}).
6654
6655 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6656 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy-regexp
6657 This can either be a regular expression or list of regular expressions
6658 that match strings that will be removed from subjects if fuzzy subject
6659 simplification is used.
6660
6661 @item gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6662 @vindex gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6663 If you set @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit} to something as low
6664 as 10, you might consider setting this variable to something sensible:
6665
6666 @c Written by Michael Ernst <mernst@cs.rice.edu>
6667 @lisp
6668 (setq gnus-simplify-ignored-prefixes
6669 (concat
6670 "\\`\\[?\\("
6671 (mapconcat
6672 'identity
6673 '("looking"
6674 "wanted" "followup" "summary\\( of\\)?"
6675 "help" "query" "problem" "question"
6676 "answer" "reference" "announce"
6677 "How can I" "How to" "Comparison of"
6678 ;; ...
6679 )
6680 "\\|")
6681 "\\)\\s *\\("
6682 (mapconcat 'identity
6683 '("for" "for reference" "with" "about")
6684 "\\|")
6685 "\\)?\\]?:?[ \t]*"))
6686 @end lisp
6687
6688 All words that match this regexp will be removed before comparing two
6689 subjects.
6690
6691 @item gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6692 @vindex gnus-simplify-subject-functions
6693 If non-@code{nil}, this variable overrides
6694 @code{gnus-summary-gather-subject-limit}. This variable should be a
6695 list of functions to apply to the @code{Subject} string iteratively to
6696 arrive at the simplified version of the string.
6697
6698 Useful functions to put in this list include:
6699
6700 @table @code
6701 @item gnus-simplify-subject-re
6702 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-re
6703 Strip the leading @samp{Re:}.
6704
6705 @item gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6706 @findex gnus-simplify-subject-fuzzy
6707 Simplify fuzzily.
6708
6709 @item gnus-simplify-whitespace
6710 @findex gnus-simplify-whitespace
6711 Remove excessive whitespace.
6712
6713 @item gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6714 @findex gnus-simplify-all-whitespace
6715 Remove all whitespace.
6716 @end table
6717
6718 You may also write your own functions, of course.
6719
6720
6721 @item gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6722 @vindex gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject
6723 Since loose thread gathering is done on subjects only, that might lead
6724 to many false hits, especially with certain common subjects like
6725 @samp{} and @samp{(none)}. To make the situation slightly better,
6726 you can use the regexp @code{gnus-summary-gather-exclude-subject} to say
6727 what subjects should be excluded from the gathering process.@*
6728 The default is @samp{^ *$\\|^(none)$}.
6729
6730 @item gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6731 @vindex gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6732 Gnus gathers threads by looking at @code{Subject} headers. This means
6733 that totally unrelated articles may end up in the same ``thread'', which
6734 is confusing. An alternate approach is to look at all the
6735 @code{Message-ID}s in all the @code{References} headers to find matches.
6736 This will ensure that no gathered threads ever include unrelated
6737 articles, but it also means that people who have posted with broken
6738 newsreaders won't be gathered properly. The choice is yours---plague or
6739 cholera:
6740
6741 @table @code
6742 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6743 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-subject
6744 This function is the default gathering function and looks at
6745 @code{Subject}s exclusively.
6746
6747 @item gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6748 @findex gnus-gather-threads-by-references
6749 This function looks at @code{References} headers exclusively.
6750 @end table
6751
6752 If you want to test gathering by @code{References}, you could say
6753 something like:
6754
6755 @lisp
6756 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
6757 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
6758 @end lisp
6759
6760 @end table
6761
6762
6763 @node Filling In Threads
6764 @subsubsection Filling In Threads
6765
6766 @table @code
6767 @item gnus-fetch-old-headers
6768 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-headers
6769 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will attempt to build old threads by fetching
6770 more old headers---headers to articles marked as read. If you would
6771 like to display as few summary lines as possible, but still connect as
6772 many loose threads as possible, you should set this variable to
6773 @code{some} or a number. If you set it to a number, no more than that
6774 number of extra old headers will be fetched. In either case, fetching
6775 old headers only works if the back end you are using carries overview
6776 files---this would normally be @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool},
6777 @code{nnml}, and @code{nnmaildir}. Also remember that if the root of
6778 the thread has been expired by the server, there's not much Gnus can
6779 do about that.
6780
6781 This variable can also be set to @code{invisible}. This won't have any
6782 visible effects, but is useful if you use the @kbd{A T} command a lot
6783 (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
6784
6785 @item gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6786 @vindex gnus-fetch-old-ephemeral-headers
6787 Same as @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}, but only used for ephemeral
6788 newsgroups.
6789
6790 @item gnus-build-sparse-threads
6791 @vindex gnus-build-sparse-threads
6792 Fetching old headers can be slow. A low-rent similar effect can be
6793 gotten by setting this variable to @code{some}. Gnus will then look at
6794 the complete @code{References} headers of all articles and try to string
6795 together articles that belong in the same thread. This will leave
6796 @dfn{gaps} in the threading display where Gnus guesses that an article
6797 is missing from the thread. (These gaps appear like normal summary
6798 lines. If you select a gap, Gnus will try to fetch the article in
6799 question.) If this variable is @code{t}, Gnus will display all these
6800 ``gaps'' without regard for whether they are useful for completing the
6801 thread or not. Finally, if this variable is @code{more}, Gnus won't cut
6802 off sparse leaf nodes that don't lead anywhere. This variable is
6803 @code{nil} by default.
6804
6805 @item gnus-read-all-available-headers
6806 @vindex gnus-read-all-available-headers
6807 This is a rather obscure variable that few will find useful. It's
6808 intended for those non-news newsgroups where the back end has to fetch
6809 quite a lot to present the summary buffer, and where it's impossible to
6810 go back to parents of articles. This is mostly the case in the
6811 web-based groups, like the @code{nnultimate} groups.
6812
6813 If you don't use those, then it's safe to leave this as the default
6814 @code{nil}. If you want to use this variable, it should be a regexp
6815 that matches the group name, or @code{t} for all groups.
6816
6817 @end table
6818
6819
6820 @node More Threading
6821 @subsubsection More Threading
6822
6823 @table @code
6824 @item gnus-show-threads
6825 @vindex gnus-show-threads
6826 If this variable is @code{nil}, no threading will be done, and all of
6827 the rest of the variables here will have no effect. Turning threading
6828 off will speed group selection up a bit, but it is sure to make reading
6829 slower and more awkward.
6830
6831 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6832 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6833 If non-@code{nil}, all threads will be hidden when the summary buffer is
6834 generated.
6835
6836 This can also be a predicate specifier (@pxref{Predicate Specifiers}).
6837 Available predicates are @code{gnus-article-unread-p} and
6838 @code{gnus-article-unseen-p}.
6839
6840 Here's an example:
6841
6842 @lisp
6843 (setq gnus-thread-hide-subtree
6844 '(or gnus-article-unread-p
6845 gnus-article-unseen-p))
6846 @end lisp
6847
6848 (It's a pretty nonsensical example, since all unseen articles are also
6849 unread, but you get my drift.)
6850
6851
6852 @item gnus-thread-expunge-below
6853 @vindex gnus-thread-expunge-below
6854 All threads that have a total score (as defined by
6855 @code{gnus-thread-score-function}) less than this number will be
6856 expunged. This variable is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
6857 threads are expunged.
6858
6859 @item gnus-thread-hide-killed
6860 @vindex gnus-thread-hide-killed
6861 if you kill a thread and this variable is non-@code{nil}, the subtree
6862 will be hidden.
6863
6864 @item gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6865 @vindex gnus-thread-ignore-subject
6866 Sometimes somebody changes the subject in the middle of a thread. If
6867 this variable is non-@code{nil}, which is the default, the subject
6868 change is ignored. If it is @code{nil}, a change in the subject will
6869 result in a new thread.
6870
6871 @item gnus-thread-indent-level
6872 @vindex gnus-thread-indent-level
6873 This is a number that says how much each sub-thread should be indented.
6874 The default is 4.
6875
6876 @item gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6877 @vindex gnus-sort-gathered-threads-function
6878 Sometimes, particularly with mailing lists, the order in which mails
6879 arrive locally is not necessarily the same as the order in which they
6880 arrived on the mailing list. Consequently, when sorting sub-threads
6881 using the default @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number}, responses can end
6882 up appearing before the article to which they are responding to.
6883 Setting this variable to an alternate value
6884 (e.g. @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}), in a group's parameters or in an
6885 appropriate hook (e.g. @code{gnus-summary-generate-hook}) can produce a
6886 more logical sub-thread ordering in such instances.
6887
6888 @end table
6889
6890
6891 @node Low-Level Threading
6892 @subsubsection Low-Level Threading
6893
6894 @table @code
6895
6896 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
6897 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
6898 Hook run before parsing any headers.
6899
6900 @item gnus-alter-header-function
6901 @vindex gnus-alter-header-function
6902 If non-@code{nil}, this function will be called to allow alteration of
6903 article header structures. The function is called with one parameter,
6904 the article header vector, which it may alter in any way. For instance,
6905 if you have a mail-to-news gateway which alters the @code{Message-ID}s
6906 in systematic ways (by adding prefixes and such), you can use this
6907 variable to un-scramble the @code{Message-ID}s so that they are more
6908 meaningful. Here's one example:
6909
6910 @lisp
6911 (setq gnus-alter-header-function 'my-alter-message-id)
6912
6913 (defun my-alter-message-id (header)
6914 (let ((id (mail-header-id header)))
6915 (when (string-match
6916 "\\(<[^<>@@]*\\)\\.?cygnus\\..*@@\\([^<>@@]*>\\)" id)
6917 (mail-header-set-id
6918 (concat (match-string 1 id) "@@" (match-string 2 id))
6919 header))))
6920 @end lisp
6921
6922 @end table
6923
6924
6925 @node Thread Commands
6926 @subsection Thread Commands
6927 @cindex thread commands
6928
6929 @table @kbd
6930
6931 @item T k
6932 @itemx C-M-k
6933 @kindex T k (Summary)
6934 @kindex C-M-k (Summary)
6935 @findex gnus-summary-kill-thread
6936 Mark all articles in the current (sub-)thread as read
6937 (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}). If the prefix argument is positive,
6938 remove all marks instead. If the prefix argument is negative, tick
6939 articles instead.
6940
6941 @item T l
6942 @itemx C-M-l
6943 @kindex T l (Summary)
6944 @kindex C-M-l (Summary)
6945 @findex gnus-summary-lower-thread
6946 Lower the score of the current (sub-)thread
6947 (@code{gnus-summary-lower-thread}).
6948
6949 @item T i
6950 @kindex T i (Summary)
6951 @findex gnus-summary-raise-thread
6952 Increase the score of the current (sub-)thread
6953 (@code{gnus-summary-raise-thread}).
6954
6955 @item T #
6956 @kindex T # (Summary)
6957 @findex gnus-uu-mark-thread
6958 Set the process mark on the current (sub-)thread
6959 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-thread}).
6960
6961 @item T M-#
6962 @kindex T M-# (Summary)
6963 @findex gnus-uu-unmark-thread
6964 Remove the process mark from the current (sub-)thread
6965 (@code{gnus-uu-unmark-thread}).
6966
6967 @item T T
6968 @kindex T T (Summary)
6969 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-threads
6970 Toggle threading (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-threads}).
6971
6972 @item T s
6973 @kindex T s (Summary)
6974 @findex gnus-summary-show-thread
6975 Expose the (sub-)thread hidden under the current article, if any@*
6976 (@code{gnus-summary-show-thread}).
6977
6978 @item T h
6979 @kindex T h (Summary)
6980 @findex gnus-summary-hide-thread
6981 Hide the current (sub-)thread (@code{gnus-summary-hide-thread}).
6982
6983 @item T S
6984 @kindex T S (Summary)
6985 @findex gnus-summary-show-all-threads
6986 Expose all hidden threads (@code{gnus-summary-show-all-threads}).
6987
6988 @item T H
6989 @kindex T H (Summary)
6990 @findex gnus-summary-hide-all-threads
6991 Hide all threads (@code{gnus-summary-hide-all-threads}).
6992
6993 @item T t
6994 @kindex T t (Summary)
6995 @findex gnus-summary-rethread-current
6996 Re-thread the current article's thread
6997 (@code{gnus-summary-rethread-current}). This works even when the
6998 summary buffer is otherwise unthreaded.
6999
7000 @item T ^
7001 @kindex T ^ (Summary)
7002 @findex gnus-summary-reparent-thread
7003 Make the current article the child of the marked (or previous) article
7004 (@code{gnus-summary-reparent-thread}).
7005
7006 @end table
7007
7008 The following commands are thread movement commands. They all
7009 understand the numeric prefix.
7010
7011 @table @kbd
7012
7013 @item T n
7014 @kindex T n (Summary)
7015 @itemx C-M-f
7016 @kindex C-M-n (Summary)
7017 @itemx M-down
7018 @kindex M-down (Summary)
7019 @findex gnus-summary-next-thread
7020 Go to the next thread (@code{gnus-summary-next-thread}).
7021
7022 @item T p
7023 @kindex T p (Summary)
7024 @itemx C-M-b
7025 @kindex C-M-p (Summary)
7026 @itemx M-up
7027 @kindex M-up (Summary)
7028 @findex gnus-summary-prev-thread
7029 Go to the previous thread (@code{gnus-summary-prev-thread}).
7030
7031 @item T d
7032 @kindex T d (Summary)
7033 @findex gnus-summary-down-thread
7034 Descend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-down-thread}).
7035
7036 @item T u
7037 @kindex T u (Summary)
7038 @findex gnus-summary-up-thread
7039 Ascend the thread (@code{gnus-summary-up-thread}).
7040
7041 @item T o
7042 @kindex T o (Summary)
7043 @findex gnus-summary-top-thread
7044 Go to the top of the thread (@code{gnus-summary-top-thread}).
7045 @end table
7046
7047 @vindex gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject
7048 If you ignore subject while threading, you'll naturally end up with
7049 threads that have several different subjects in them. If you then issue
7050 a command like @kbd{T k} (@code{gnus-summary-kill-thread}) you might not
7051 wish to kill the entire thread, but just those parts of the thread that
7052 have the same subject as the current article. If you like this idea,
7053 you can fiddle with @code{gnus-thread-operation-ignore-subject}. If it
7054 is non-@code{nil} (which it is by default), subjects will be ignored
7055 when doing thread commands. If this variable is @code{nil}, articles in
7056 the same thread with different subjects will not be included in the
7057 operation in question. If this variable is @code{fuzzy}, only articles
7058 that have subjects fuzzily equal will be included (@pxref{Fuzzy
7059 Matching}).
7060
7061
7062 @node Sorting the Summary Buffer
7063 @section Sorting the Summary Buffer
7064
7065 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score
7066 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-date
7067 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-score
7068 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7069 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-author
7070 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7071 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-random
7072 @vindex gnus-thread-sort-functions
7073 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number
7074 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date
7075 If you are using a threaded summary display, you can sort the threads by
7076 setting @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, which can be either a single
7077 function, a list of functions, or a list containing functions and
7078 @code{(not some-function)} elements.
7079
7080 By default, sorting is done on article numbers. Ready-made sorting
7081 predicate functions include @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number},
7082 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-author}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-subject},
7083 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-date}, @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-score},
7084 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-number},
7085 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-most-recent-date},
7086 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-random} and
7087 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score}.
7088
7089 Each function takes two threads and returns non-@code{nil} if the first
7090 thread should be sorted before the other. Note that sorting really is
7091 normally done by looking only at the roots of each thread.
7092
7093 If you use more than one function, the primary sort key should be the
7094 last function in the list. You should probably always include
7095 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-number} in the list of sorting
7096 functions---preferably first. This will ensure that threads that are
7097 equal with respect to the other sort criteria will be displayed in
7098 ascending article order.
7099
7100 If you would like to sort by reverse score, then by subject, and finally
7101 by number, you could do something like:
7102
7103 @lisp
7104 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7105 '(gnus-thread-sort-by-number
7106 gnus-thread-sort-by-subject
7107 (not gnus-thread-sort-by-total-score)))
7108 @end lisp
7109
7110 The threads that have highest score will be displayed first in the
7111 summary buffer. When threads have the same score, they will be sorted
7112 alphabetically. The threads that have the same score and the same
7113 subject will be sorted by number, which is (normally) the sequence in
7114 which the articles arrived.
7115
7116 If you want to sort by score and then reverse arrival order, you could
7117 say something like:
7118
7119 @lisp
7120 (setq gnus-thread-sort-functions
7121 '((lambda (t1 t2)
7122 (not (gnus-thread-sort-by-number t1 t2)))
7123 gnus-thread-sort-by-score))
7124 @end lisp
7125
7126 @vindex gnus-thread-score-function
7127 The function in the @code{gnus-thread-score-function} variable (default
7128 @code{+}) is used for calculating the total score of a thread. Useful
7129 functions might be @code{max}, @code{min}, or squared means, or whatever
7130 tickles your fancy.
7131
7132 @findex gnus-article-sort-functions
7133 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-date
7134 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-score
7135 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-subject
7136 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-author
7137 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-random
7138 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-number
7139 If you are using an unthreaded display for some strange reason or
7140 other, you have to fiddle with the @code{gnus-article-sort-functions}
7141 variable. It is very similar to the
7142 @code{gnus-thread-sort-functions}, except that it uses slightly
7143 different functions for article comparison. Available sorting
7144 predicate functions are @code{gnus-article-sort-by-number},
7145 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-author},
7146 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-subject}, @code{gnus-article-sort-by-date},
7147 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-random}, and
7148 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-score}.
7149
7150 If you want to sort an unthreaded summary display by subject, you could
7151 say something like:
7152
7153 @lisp
7154 (setq gnus-article-sort-functions
7155 '(gnus-article-sort-by-number
7156 gnus-article-sort-by-subject))
7157 @end lisp
7158
7159
7160
7161 @node Asynchronous Fetching
7162 @section Asynchronous Article Fetching
7163 @cindex asynchronous article fetching
7164 @cindex article pre-fetch
7165 @cindex pre-fetch
7166
7167 If you read your news from an @acronym{NNTP} server that's far away, the
7168 network latencies may make reading articles a chore. You have to wait
7169 for a while after pressing @kbd{n} to go to the next article before the
7170 article appears. Why can't Gnus just go ahead and fetch the article
7171 while you are reading the previous one? Why not, indeed.
7172
7173 First, some caveats. There are some pitfalls to using asynchronous
7174 article fetching, especially the way Gnus does it.
7175
7176 Let's say you are reading article 1, which is short, and article 2 is
7177 quite long, and you are not interested in reading that. Gnus does not
7178 know this, so it goes ahead and fetches article 2. You decide to read
7179 article 3, but since Gnus is in the process of fetching article 2, the
7180 connection is blocked.
7181
7182 To avoid these situations, Gnus will open two (count 'em two)
7183 connections to the server. Some people may think this isn't a very nice
7184 thing to do, but I don't see any real alternatives. Setting up that
7185 extra connection takes some time, so Gnus startup will be slower.
7186
7187 Gnus will fetch more articles than you will read. This will mean that
7188 the link between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server will become more
7189 loaded than if you didn't use article pre-fetch. The server itself will
7190 also become more loaded---both with the extra article requests, and the
7191 extra connection.
7192
7193 Ok, so now you know that you shouldn't really use this thing@dots{} unless
7194 you really want to.
7195
7196 @vindex gnus-asynchronous
7197 Here's how: Set @code{gnus-asynchronous} to @code{t}. The rest should
7198 happen automatically.
7199
7200 @vindex gnus-use-article-prefetch
7201 You can control how many articles are to be pre-fetched by setting
7202 @code{gnus-use-article-prefetch}. This is 30 by default, which means
7203 that when you read an article in the group, the back end will pre-fetch
7204 the next 30 articles. If this variable is @code{t}, the back end will
7205 pre-fetch all the articles it can without bound. If it is
7206 @code{nil}, no pre-fetching will be done.
7207
7208 @vindex gnus-async-prefetch-article-p
7209 @findex gnus-async-unread-p
7210 There are probably some articles that you don't want to pre-fetch---read
7211 articles, for instance. The @code{gnus-async-prefetch-article-p}
7212 variable controls whether an article is to be pre-fetched. This
7213 function should return non-@code{nil} when the article in question is
7214 to be pre-fetched. The default is @code{gnus-async-unread-p}, which
7215 returns @code{nil} on read articles. The function is called with an
7216 article data structure as the only parameter.
7217
7218 If, for instance, you wish to pre-fetch only unread articles shorter
7219 than 100 lines, you could say something like:
7220
7221 @lisp
7222 (defun my-async-short-unread-p (data)
7223 "Return non-nil for short, unread articles."
7224 (and (gnus-data-unread-p data)
7225 (< (mail-header-lines (gnus-data-header data))
7226 100)))
7227
7228 (setq gnus-async-prefetch-article-p 'my-async-short-unread-p)
7229 @end lisp
7230
7231 These functions will be called many, many times, so they should
7232 preferably be short and sweet to avoid slowing down Gnus too much.
7233 It's probably a good idea to byte-compile things like this.
7234
7235 @vindex gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy
7236 Articles have to be removed from the asynch buffer sooner or later. The
7237 @code{gnus-prefetched-article-deletion-strategy} says when to remove
7238 articles. This is a list that may contain the following elements:
7239
7240 @table @code
7241 @item read
7242 Remove articles when they are read.
7243
7244 @item exit
7245 Remove articles when exiting the group.
7246 @end table
7247
7248 The default value is @code{(read exit)}.
7249
7250 @c @vindex gnus-use-header-prefetch
7251 @c If @code{gnus-use-header-prefetch} is non-@code{nil}, prefetch articles
7252 @c from the next group.
7253
7254
7255 @node Article Caching
7256 @section Article Caching
7257 @cindex article caching
7258 @cindex caching
7259
7260 If you have an @emph{extremely} slow @acronym{NNTP} connection, you may
7261 consider turning article caching on. Each article will then be stored
7262 locally under your home directory. As you may surmise, this could
7263 potentially use @emph{huge} amounts of disk space, as well as eat up all
7264 your inodes so fast it will make your head swim. In vodka.
7265
7266 Used carefully, though, it could be just an easier way to save articles.
7267
7268 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7269 @vindex gnus-cache-directory
7270 @vindex gnus-use-cache
7271 To turn caching on, set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{t}. By default,
7272 all articles ticked or marked as dormant will then be copied
7273 over to your local cache (@code{gnus-cache-directory}). Whether this
7274 cache is flat or hierarchical is controlled by the
7275 @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable, as usual.
7276
7277 When re-selecting a ticked or dormant article, it will be fetched from the
7278 cache instead of from the server. As articles in your cache will never
7279 expire, this might serve as a method of saving articles while still
7280 keeping them where they belong. Just mark all articles you want to save
7281 as dormant, and don't worry.
7282
7283 When an article is marked as read, is it removed from the cache.
7284
7285 @vindex gnus-cache-remove-articles
7286 @vindex gnus-cache-enter-articles
7287 The entering/removal of articles from the cache is controlled by the
7288 @code{gnus-cache-enter-articles} and @code{gnus-cache-remove-articles}
7289 variables. Both are lists of symbols. The first is @code{(ticked
7290 dormant)} by default, meaning that ticked and dormant articles will be
7291 put in the cache. The latter is @code{(read)} by default, meaning that
7292 articles marked as read are removed from the cache. Possibly
7293 symbols in these two lists are @code{ticked}, @code{dormant},
7294 @code{unread} and @code{read}.
7295
7296 @findex gnus-jog-cache
7297 So where does the massive article-fetching and storing come into the
7298 picture? The @code{gnus-jog-cache} command will go through all
7299 subscribed newsgroups, request all unread articles, score them, and
7300 store them in the cache. You should only ever, ever ever ever, use this
7301 command if 1) your connection to the @acronym{NNTP} server is really, really,
7302 really slow and 2) you have a really, really, really huge disk.
7303 Seriously. One way to cut down on the number of articles downloaded is
7304 to score unwanted articles down and have them marked as read. They will
7305 not then be downloaded by this command.
7306
7307 @vindex gnus-uncacheable-groups
7308 @vindex gnus-cacheable-groups
7309 It is likely that you do not want caching on all groups. For instance,
7310 if your @code{nnml} mail is located under your home directory, it makes no
7311 sense to cache it somewhere else under your home directory. Unless you
7312 feel that it's neat to use twice as much space.
7313
7314 To limit the caching, you could set @code{gnus-cacheable-groups} to a
7315 regexp of groups to cache, @samp{^nntp} for instance, or set the
7316 @code{gnus-uncacheable-groups} regexp to @samp{^nnml}, for instance.
7317 Both variables are @code{nil} by default. If a group matches both
7318 variables, the group is not cached.
7319
7320 @findex gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases
7321 @findex gnus-cache-generate-active
7322 @vindex gnus-cache-active-file
7323 The cache stores information on what articles it contains in its active
7324 file (@code{gnus-cache-active-file}). If this file (or any other parts
7325 of the cache) becomes all messed up for some reason or other, Gnus
7326 offers two functions that will try to set things right. @kbd{M-x
7327 gnus-cache-generate-nov-databases} will (re)build all the @acronym{NOV}
7328 files, and @kbd{gnus-cache-generate-active} will (re)generate the active
7329 file.
7330
7331 @findex gnus-cache-move-cache
7332 @code{gnus-cache-move-cache} will move your whole
7333 @code{gnus-cache-directory} to some other location. You get asked to
7334 where, isn't that cool?
7335
7336 @node Persistent Articles
7337 @section Persistent Articles
7338 @cindex persistent articles
7339
7340 Closely related to article caching, we have @dfn{persistent articles}.
7341 In fact, it's just a different way of looking at caching, and much more
7342 useful in my opinion.
7343
7344 Say you're reading a newsgroup, and you happen on to some valuable gem
7345 that you want to keep and treasure forever. You'd normally just save it
7346 (using one of the many saving commands) in some file. The problem with
7347 that is that it's just, well, yucky. Ideally you'd prefer just having
7348 the article remain in the group where you found it forever; untouched by
7349 the expiry going on at the news server.
7350
7351 This is what a @dfn{persistent article} is---an article that just won't
7352 be deleted. It's implemented using the normal cache functions, but
7353 you use two explicit commands for managing persistent articles:
7354
7355 @table @kbd
7356
7357 @item *
7358 @kindex * (Summary)
7359 @findex gnus-cache-enter-article
7360 Make the current article persistent (@code{gnus-cache-enter-article}).
7361
7362 @item M-*
7363 @kindex M-* (Summary)
7364 @findex gnus-cache-remove-article
7365 Remove the current article from the persistent articles
7366 (@code{gnus-cache-remove-article}). This will normally delete the
7367 article.
7368 @end table
7369
7370 Both these commands understand the process/prefix convention.
7371
7372 To avoid having all ticked articles (and stuff) entered into the cache,
7373 you should set @code{gnus-use-cache} to @code{passive} if you're just
7374 interested in persistent articles:
7375
7376 @lisp
7377 (setq gnus-use-cache 'passive)
7378 @end lisp
7379
7380
7381 @node Article Backlog
7382 @section Article Backlog
7383 @cindex backlog
7384 @cindex article backlog
7385
7386 If you have a slow connection, but the idea of using caching seems
7387 unappealing to you (and it is, really), you can help the situation some
7388 by switching on the @dfn{backlog}. This is where Gnus will buffer
7389 already read articles so that it doesn't have to re-fetch articles
7390 you've already read. This only helps if you are in the habit of
7391 re-selecting articles you've recently read, of course. If you never do
7392 that, turning the backlog on will slow Gnus down a little bit, and
7393 increase memory usage some.
7394
7395 @vindex gnus-keep-backlog
7396 If you set @code{gnus-keep-backlog} to a number @var{n}, Gnus will store
7397 at most @var{n} old articles in a buffer for later re-fetching. If this
7398 variable is non-@code{nil} and is not a number, Gnus will store
7399 @emph{all} read articles, which means that your Emacs will grow without
7400 bound before exploding and taking your machine down with you. I put
7401 that in there just to keep y'all on your toes.
7402
7403 The default value is 20.
7404
7405
7406 @node Saving Articles
7407 @section Saving Articles
7408 @cindex saving articles
7409
7410 Gnus can save articles in a number of ways. Below is the documentation
7411 for saving articles in a fairly straight-forward fashion (i.e., little
7412 processing of the article is done before it is saved). For a different
7413 approach (uudecoding, unsharing) you should use @code{gnus-uu}
7414 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
7415
7416 For the commands listed here, the target is a file. If you want to
7417 save to a group, see the @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article})
7418 command (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
7419
7420 @vindex gnus-save-all-headers
7421 If @code{gnus-save-all-headers} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will not delete
7422 unwanted headers before saving the article.
7423
7424 @vindex gnus-saved-headers
7425 If the preceding variable is @code{nil}, all headers that match the
7426 @code{gnus-saved-headers} regexp will be kept, while the rest will be
7427 deleted before saving.
7428
7429 @table @kbd
7430
7431 @item O o
7432 @itemx o
7433 @kindex O o (Summary)
7434 @kindex o (Summary)
7435 @findex gnus-summary-save-article
7436 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article}
7437 Save the current article using the default article saver
7438 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article}).
7439
7440 @item O m
7441 @kindex O m (Summary)
7442 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-mail
7443 Save the current article in a Unix mail box (mbox) file
7444 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-mail}).
7445
7446 @item O r
7447 @kindex O r (Summary)
7448 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-rmail
7449 Save the current article in Rmail format
7450 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-rmail}).
7451
7452 @item O f
7453 @kindex O f (Summary)
7454 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-file
7455 @c @icon{gnus-summary-save-article-file}
7456 Save the current article in plain file format
7457 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-file}).
7458
7459 @item O F
7460 @kindex O F (Summary)
7461 @findex gnus-summary-write-article-file
7462 Write the current article in plain file format, overwriting any previous
7463 file contents (@code{gnus-summary-write-article-file}).
7464
7465 @item O b
7466 @kindex O b (Summary)
7467 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-body-file
7468 Save the current article body in plain file format
7469 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-body-file}).
7470
7471 @item O h
7472 @kindex O h (Summary)
7473 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-folder
7474 Save the current article in mh folder format
7475 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-folder}).
7476
7477 @item O v
7478 @kindex O v (Summary)
7479 @findex gnus-summary-save-article-vm
7480 Save the current article in a VM folder
7481 (@code{gnus-summary-save-article-vm}).
7482
7483 @item O p
7484 @itemx |
7485 @kindex O p (Summary)
7486 @kindex | (Summary)
7487 @findex gnus-summary-pipe-output
7488 Save the current article in a pipe. Uhm, like, what I mean is---Pipe
7489 the current article to a process (@code{gnus-summary-pipe-output}).
7490 If given a symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}), include the
7491 complete headers in the piped output.
7492
7493 @item O P
7494 @kindex O P (Summary)
7495 @findex gnus-summary-muttprint
7496 @vindex gnus-summary-muttprint-program
7497 Save the current article into muttprint. That is, print it using the
7498 external program @uref{http://muttprint.sourceforge.net/,
7499 Muttprint}. The program name and options to use is controlled by the
7500 variable @code{gnus-summary-muttprint-program}.
7501 (@code{gnus-summary-muttprint}).
7502
7503 @end table
7504
7505 @vindex gnus-prompt-before-saving
7506 All these commands use the process/prefix convention
7507 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). If you save bunches of articles using these
7508 functions, you might get tired of being prompted for files to save each
7509 and every article in. The prompting action is controlled by
7510 the @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} variable, which is @code{always} by
7511 default, giving you that excessive prompting action you know and
7512 loathe. If you set this variable to @code{t} instead, you'll be prompted
7513 just once for each series of articles you save. If you like to really
7514 have Gnus do all your thinking for you, you can even set this variable
7515 to @code{nil}, which means that you will never be prompted for files to
7516 save articles in. Gnus will simply save all the articles in the default
7517 files.
7518
7519
7520 @vindex gnus-default-article-saver
7521 You can customize the @code{gnus-default-article-saver} variable to make
7522 Gnus do what you want it to. You can use any of the eight ready-made
7523 functions below, or you can create your own.
7524
7525 @table @code
7526
7527 @item gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7528 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-rmail
7529 @vindex gnus-rmail-save-name
7530 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7531 This is the default format, @dfn{Babyl}. Uses the function in the
7532 @code{gnus-rmail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7533 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7534
7535 @item gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7536 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-mail
7537 @vindex gnus-mail-save-name
7538 Save in a Unix mail (mbox) file. Uses the function in the
7539 @code{gnus-mail-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7540 article in. The default is @code{gnus-plain-save-name}.
7541
7542 @item gnus-summary-save-in-file
7543 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-file
7544 @vindex gnus-file-save-name
7545 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7546 Append the article straight to an ordinary file. Uses the function in
7547 the @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7548 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7549
7550 @item gnus-summary-write-to-file
7551 @findex gnus-summary-write-to-file
7552 Write the article straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7553 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7554 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7555 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7556
7557 @item gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7558 @findex gnus-summary-save-body-in-file
7559 Append the article body to an ordinary file. Uses the function in the
7560 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7561 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7562
7563 @item gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7564 @findex gnus-summary-write-body-to-file
7565 Write the article body straight to an ordinary file. The file is
7566 overwritten if it exists. Uses the function in the
7567 @code{gnus-file-save-name} variable to get a file name to save the
7568 article in. The default is @code{gnus-numeric-save-name}.
7569
7570 @item gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7571 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-folder
7572 @findex gnus-folder-save-name
7573 @findex gnus-Folder-save-name
7574 @vindex gnus-folder-save-name
7575 @cindex rcvstore
7576 @cindex MH folders
7577 Save the article to an MH folder using @code{rcvstore} from the MH
7578 library. Uses the function in the @code{gnus-folder-save-name} variable
7579 to get a file name to save the article in. The default is
7580 @code{gnus-folder-save-name}, but you can also use
7581 @code{gnus-Folder-save-name}, which creates capitalized names.
7582
7583 @item gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7584 @findex gnus-summary-save-in-vm
7585 Save the article in a VM folder. You have to have the VM mail
7586 reader to use this setting.
7587 @end table
7588
7589 The symbol of each function may have the following properties:
7590
7591 @table @code
7592 @item :decode
7593 The value non-@code{nil} means save decoded articles. This is
7594 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-save-in-file},
7595 @code{gnus-summary-save-body-in-file},
7596 @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file}, and
7597 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7598
7599 @item :function
7600 The value specifies an alternative function which appends, not
7601 overwrites, articles to a file. This implies that when saving many
7602 articles at a time, @code{gnus-prompt-before-saving} is bound to
7603 @code{t} and all articles are saved in a single file. This is
7604 meaningful only with @code{gnus-summary-write-to-file} and
7605 @code{gnus-summary-write-body-to-file}.
7606
7607 @item :headers
7608 The value specifies the symbol of a variable of which the value
7609 specifies headers to be saved. If it is omitted,
7610 @code{gnus-save-all-headers} and @code{gnus-saved-headers} control what
7611 headers should be saved.
7612 @end table
7613
7614 @vindex gnus-article-save-directory
7615 All of these functions, except for the last one, will save the article
7616 in the @code{gnus-article-save-directory}, which is initialized from the
7617 @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable. This is @file{~/News/} by
7618 default.
7619
7620 As you can see above, the functions use different functions to find a
7621 suitable name of a file to save the article in. Below is a list of
7622 available functions that generate names:
7623
7624 @table @code
7625
7626 @item gnus-Numeric-save-name
7627 @findex gnus-Numeric-save-name
7628 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7629
7630 @item gnus-numeric-save-name
7631 @findex gnus-numeric-save-name
7632 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin/45}.
7633
7634 @item gnus-Plain-save-name
7635 @findex gnus-Plain-save-name
7636 File names like @file{~/News/Alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7637
7638 @item gnus-plain-save-name
7639 @findex gnus-plain-save-name
7640 File names like @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.
7641
7642 @item gnus-sender-save-name
7643 @findex gnus-sender-save-name
7644 File names like @file{~/News/larsi}.
7645 @end table
7646
7647 @vindex gnus-split-methods
7648 You can have Gnus suggest where to save articles by plonking a regexp into
7649 the @code{gnus-split-methods} alist. For instance, if you would like to
7650 save articles related to Gnus in the file @file{gnus-stuff}, and articles
7651 related to VM in @file{vm-stuff}, you could set this variable to something
7652 like:
7653
7654 @lisp
7655 (("^Subject:.*gnus\\|^Newsgroups:.*gnus" "gnus-stuff")
7656 ("^Subject:.*vm\\|^Xref:.*vm" "vm-stuff")
7657 (my-choosing-function "../other-dir/my-stuff")
7658 ((equal gnus-newsgroup-name "mail.misc") "mail-stuff"))
7659 @end lisp
7660
7661 We see that this is a list where each element is a list that has two
7662 elements---the @dfn{match} and the @dfn{file}. The match can either be
7663 a string (in which case it is used as a regexp to match on the article
7664 head); it can be a symbol (which will be called as a function with the
7665 group name as a parameter); or it can be a list (which will be
7666 @code{eval}ed). If any of these actions have a non-@code{nil} result,
7667 the @dfn{file} will be used as a default prompt. In addition, the
7668 result of the operation itself will be used if the function or form
7669 called returns a string or a list of strings.
7670
7671 You basically end up with a list of file names that might be used when
7672 saving the current article. (All ``matches'' will be used.) You will
7673 then be prompted for what you really want to use as a name, with file
7674 name completion over the results from applying this variable.
7675
7676 This variable is @code{((gnus-article-archive-name))} by default, which
7677 means that Gnus will look at the articles it saves for an
7678 @code{Archive-name} line and use that as a suggestion for the file
7679 name.
7680
7681 Here's an example function to clean up file names somewhat. If you have
7682 lots of mail groups called things like
7683 @samp{nnml:mail.whatever}, you may want to chop off the beginning of
7684 these group names before creating the file name to save to. The
7685 following will do just that:
7686
7687 @lisp
7688 (defun my-save-name (group)
7689 (when (string-match "^nnml:mail." group)
7690 (substring group (match-end 0))))
7691
7692 (setq gnus-split-methods
7693 '((gnus-article-archive-name)
7694 (my-save-name)))
7695 @end lisp
7696
7697
7698 @vindex gnus-use-long-file-name
7699 Finally, you have the @code{gnus-use-long-file-name} variable. If it is
7700 @code{nil}, all the preceding functions will replace all periods
7701 (@samp{.}) in the group names with slashes (@samp{/})---which means that
7702 the functions will generate hierarchies of directories instead of having
7703 all the files in the top level directory
7704 (@file{~/News/alt/andrea-dworkin} instead of
7705 @file{~/News/alt.andrea-dworkin}.) This variable is @code{t} by default
7706 on most systems. However, for historical reasons, this is @code{nil} on
7707 Xenix and usg-unix-v machines by default.
7708
7709 This function also affects kill and score file names. If this variable
7710 is a list, and the list contains the element @code{not-score}, long file
7711 names will not be used for score files, if it contains the element
7712 @code{not-save}, long file names will not be used for saving, and if it
7713 contains the element @code{not-kill}, long file names will not be used
7714 for kill files.
7715
7716 If you'd like to save articles in a hierarchy that looks something like
7717 a spool, you could
7718
7719 @lisp
7720 (setq gnus-use-long-file-name '(not-save)) ; @r{to get a hierarchy}
7721 (setq gnus-default-article-saver
7722 'gnus-summary-save-in-file) ; @r{no encoding}
7723 @end lisp
7724
7725 Then just save with @kbd{o}. You'd then read this hierarchy with
7726 ephemeral @code{nneething} groups---@kbd{G D} in the group buffer, and
7727 the top level directory as the argument (@file{~/News/}). Then just walk
7728 around to the groups/directories with @code{nneething}.
7729
7730
7731 @node Decoding Articles
7732 @section Decoding Articles
7733 @cindex decoding articles
7734
7735 Sometime users post articles (or series of articles) that have been
7736 encoded in some way or other. Gnus can decode them for you.
7737
7738 @menu
7739 * Uuencoded Articles:: Uudecode articles.
7740 * Shell Archives:: Unshar articles.
7741 * PostScript Files:: Split PostScript.
7742 * Other Files:: Plain save and binhex.
7743 * Decoding Variables:: Variables for a happy decoding.
7744 * Viewing Files:: You want to look at the result of the decoding?
7745 @end menu
7746
7747 @cindex series
7748 @cindex article series
7749 All these functions use the process/prefix convention
7750 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}) for finding out what articles to work on, with
7751 the extension that a ``single article'' means ``a single series''. Gnus
7752 can find out by itself what articles belong to a series, decode all the
7753 articles and unpack/view/save the resulting file(s).
7754
7755 Gnus guesses what articles are in the series according to the following
7756 simplish rule: The subjects must be (nearly) identical, except for the
7757 last two numbers of the line. (Spaces are largely ignored, however.)
7758
7759 For example: If you choose a subject called @samp{cat.gif (2/3)}, Gnus
7760 will find all the articles that match the regexp @samp{^cat.gif
7761 ([0-9]+/[0-9]+).*$}.
7762
7763 Subjects that are non-standard, like @samp{cat.gif (2/3) Part 6 of a
7764 series}, will not be properly recognized by any of the automatic viewing
7765 commands, and you have to mark the articles manually with @kbd{#}.
7766
7767
7768 @node Uuencoded Articles
7769 @subsection Uuencoded Articles
7770 @cindex uudecode
7771 @cindex uuencoded articles
7772
7773 @table @kbd
7774
7775 @item X u
7776 @kindex X u (Summary)
7777 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu
7778 @c @icon{gnus-uu-decode-uu}
7779 Uudecodes the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu}).
7780
7781 @item X U
7782 @kindex X U (Summary)
7783 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save
7784 Uudecodes and saves the current series
7785 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7786
7787 @item X v u
7788 @kindex X v u (Summary)
7789 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-view
7790 Uudecodes and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-view}).
7791
7792 @item X v U
7793 @kindex X v U (Summary)
7794 @findex gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view
7795 Uudecodes, views and saves the current series
7796 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save-view}).
7797
7798 @end table
7799
7800 Remember that these all react to the presence of articles marked with
7801 the process mark. If, for instance, you'd like to decode and save an
7802 entire newsgroup, you'd typically do @kbd{M P a}
7803 (@code{gnus-uu-mark-all}) and then @kbd{X U}
7804 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-uu-and-save}).
7805
7806 All this is very much different from how @code{gnus-uu} worked with
7807 @sc{gnus 4.1}, where you had explicit keystrokes for everything under
7808 the sun. This version of @code{gnus-uu} generally assumes that you mark
7809 articles in some way (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}) and then press
7810 @kbd{X u}.
7811
7812 @vindex gnus-uu-notify-files
7813 Note: When trying to decode articles that have names matching
7814 @code{gnus-uu-notify-files}, which is hard-coded to
7815 @samp{[Cc][Ii][Nn][Dd][Yy][0-9]+.\\(gif\\|jpg\\)}, @code{gnus-uu} will
7816 automatically post an article on @samp{comp.unix.wizards} saying that
7817 you have just viewed the file in question. This feature can't be turned
7818 off.
7819
7820
7821 @node Shell Archives
7822 @subsection Shell Archives
7823 @cindex unshar
7824 @cindex shell archives
7825 @cindex shared articles
7826
7827 Shell archives (``shar files'') used to be a popular way to distribute
7828 sources, but it isn't used all that much today. In any case, we have
7829 some commands to deal with these:
7830
7831 @table @kbd
7832
7833 @item X s
7834 @kindex X s (Summary)
7835 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar
7836 Unshars the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar}).
7837
7838 @item X S
7839 @kindex X S (Summary)
7840 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save
7841 Unshars and saves the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save}).
7842
7843 @item X v s
7844 @kindex X v s (Summary)
7845 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view
7846 Unshars and views the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-view}).
7847
7848 @item X v S
7849 @kindex X v S (Summary)
7850 @findex gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view
7851 Unshars, views and saves the current series
7852 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-unshar-and-save-view}).
7853 @end table
7854
7855
7856 @node PostScript Files
7857 @subsection PostScript Files
7858 @cindex PostScript
7859
7860 @table @kbd
7861
7862 @item X p
7863 @kindex X p (Summary)
7864 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript
7865 Unpack the current PostScript series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript}).
7866
7867 @item X P
7868 @kindex X P (Summary)
7869 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save
7870 Unpack and save the current PostScript series
7871 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save}).
7872
7873 @item X v p
7874 @kindex X v p (Summary)
7875 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view
7876 View the current PostScript series
7877 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-view}).
7878
7879 @item X v P
7880 @kindex X v P (Summary)
7881 @findex gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view
7882 View and save the current PostScript series
7883 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-postscript-and-save-view}).
7884 @end table
7885
7886
7887 @node Other Files
7888 @subsection Other Files
7889
7890 @table @kbd
7891 @item X o
7892 @kindex X o (Summary)
7893 @findex gnus-uu-decode-save
7894 Save the current series
7895 (@code{gnus-uu-decode-save}).
7896
7897 @item X b
7898 @kindex X b (Summary)
7899 @findex gnus-uu-decode-binhex
7900 Unbinhex the current series (@code{gnus-uu-decode-binhex}). This
7901 doesn't really work yet.
7902 @end table
7903
7904
7905 @node Decoding Variables
7906 @subsection Decoding Variables
7907
7908 Adjective, not verb.
7909
7910 @menu
7911 * Rule Variables:: Variables that say how a file is to be viewed.
7912 * Other Decode Variables:: Other decode variables.
7913 * Uuencoding and Posting:: Variables for customizing uuencoding.
7914 @end menu
7915
7916
7917 @node Rule Variables
7918 @subsubsection Rule Variables
7919 @cindex rule variables
7920
7921 Gnus uses @dfn{rule variables} to decide how to view a file. All these
7922 variables are of the form
7923
7924 @lisp
7925 (list '(regexp1 command2)
7926 '(regexp2 command2)
7927 ...)
7928 @end lisp
7929
7930 @table @code
7931
7932 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7933 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7934 @cindex sox
7935 This variable is consulted first when viewing files. If you wish to use,
7936 for instance, @code{sox} to convert an @file{.au} sound file, you could
7937 say something like:
7938 @lisp
7939 (setq gnus-uu-user-view-rules
7940 (list '("\\\\.au$" "sox %s -t .aiff > /dev/audio")))
7941 @end lisp
7942
7943 @item gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7944 @vindex gnus-uu-user-view-rules-end
7945 This variable is consulted if Gnus couldn't make any matches from the
7946 user and default view rules.
7947
7948 @item gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7949 @vindex gnus-uu-user-archive-rules
7950 This variable can be used to say what commands should be used to unpack
7951 archives.
7952 @end table
7953
7954
7955 @node Other Decode Variables
7956 @subsubsection Other Decode Variables
7957
7958 @table @code
7959 @vindex gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7960
7961 @item gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions
7962 All functions in this list will be called right after each file has been
7963 successfully decoded---so that you can move or view files right away,
7964 and don't have to wait for all files to be decoded before you can do
7965 anything. Ready-made functions you can put in this list are:
7966
7967 @table @code
7968
7969 @item gnus-uu-grab-view
7970 @findex gnus-uu-grab-view
7971 View the file.
7972
7973 @item gnus-uu-grab-move
7974 @findex gnus-uu-grab-move
7975 Move the file (if you're using a saving function.)
7976 @end table
7977
7978 @item gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7979 @vindex gnus-uu-be-dangerous
7980 Specifies what to do if unusual situations arise during decoding. If
7981 @code{nil}, be as conservative as possible. If @code{t}, ignore things
7982 that didn't work, and overwrite existing files. Otherwise, ask each
7983 time.
7984
7985 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7986 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-name
7987 Files with name matching this regular expression won't be viewed.
7988
7989 @item gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7990 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-files-by-type
7991 Files with a @acronym{MIME} type matching this variable won't be viewed.
7992 Note that Gnus tries to guess what type the file is based on the name.
7993 @code{gnus-uu} is not a @acronym{MIME} package (yet), so this is slightly
7994 kludgey.
7995
7996 @item gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7997 @vindex gnus-uu-tmp-dir
7998 Where @code{gnus-uu} does its work.
7999
8000 @item gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8001 @vindex gnus-uu-do-not-unpack-archives
8002 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} won't peek inside archives
8003 looking for files to display.
8004
8005 @item gnus-uu-view-and-save
8006 @vindex gnus-uu-view-and-save
8007 Non-@code{nil} means that the user will always be asked to save a file
8008 after viewing it.
8009
8010 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8011 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-view-rules
8012 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default viewing
8013 rules.
8014
8015 @item gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8016 @vindex gnus-uu-ignore-default-archive-rules
8017 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the default archive
8018 unpacking commands.
8019
8020 @item gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8021 @vindex gnus-uu-kill-carriage-return
8022 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will strip all carriage returns
8023 from articles.
8024
8025 @item gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8026 @vindex gnus-uu-unmark-articles-not-decoded
8027 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will mark unsuccessfully
8028 decoded articles as unread.
8029
8030 @item gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8031 @vindex gnus-uu-correct-stripped-uucode
8032 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will @emph{try} to fix
8033 uuencoded files that have had trailing spaces deleted.
8034
8035 @item gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8036 @vindex gnus-uu-pre-uudecode-hook
8037 Hook run before sending a message to @code{uudecode}.
8038
8039 @item gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8040 @vindex gnus-uu-view-with-metamail
8041 @cindex metamail
8042 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ignore the viewing
8043 commands defined by the rule variables and just fudge a @acronym{MIME}
8044 content type based on the file name. The result will be fed to
8045 @code{metamail} for viewing.
8046
8047 @item gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8048 @vindex gnus-uu-save-in-digest
8049 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu}, when asked to save without
8050 decoding, will save in digests. If this variable is @code{nil},
8051 @code{gnus-uu} will just save everything in a file without any
8052 embellishments. The digesting almost conforms to RFC 1153---no easy way
8053 to specify any meaningful volume and issue numbers were found, so I
8054 simply dropped them.
8055
8056 @end table
8057
8058
8059 @node Uuencoding and Posting
8060 @subsubsection Uuencoding and Posting
8061
8062 @table @code
8063
8064 @item gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8065 @vindex gnus-uu-post-include-before-composing
8066 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will ask for a file to encode
8067 before you compose the article. If this variable is @code{t}, you can
8068 either include an encoded file with @kbd{C-c C-i} or have one included
8069 for you when you post the article.
8070
8071 @item gnus-uu-post-length
8072 @vindex gnus-uu-post-length
8073 Maximum length of an article. The encoded file will be split into how
8074 many articles it takes to post the entire file.
8075
8076 @item gnus-uu-post-threaded
8077 @vindex gnus-uu-post-threaded
8078 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{gnus-uu} will post the encoded file in a
8079 thread. This may not be smart, as no other decoder I have seen is able
8080 to follow threads when collecting uuencoded articles. (Well, I have
8081 seen one package that does that---@code{gnus-uu}, but somehow, I don't
8082 think that counts@dots{}) Default is @code{nil}.
8083
8084 @item gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8085 @vindex gnus-uu-post-separate-description
8086 Non-@code{nil} means that the description will be posted in a separate
8087 article. The first article will typically be numbered (0/x). If this
8088 variable is @code{nil}, the description the user enters will be included
8089 at the beginning of the first article, which will be numbered (1/x).
8090 Default is @code{t}.
8091
8092 @end table
8093
8094
8095 @node Viewing Files
8096 @subsection Viewing Files
8097 @cindex viewing files
8098 @cindex pseudo-articles
8099
8100 After decoding, if the file is some sort of archive, Gnus will attempt
8101 to unpack the archive and see if any of the files in the archive can be
8102 viewed. For instance, if you have a gzipped tar file @file{pics.tar.gz}
8103 containing the files @file{pic1.jpg} and @file{pic2.gif}, Gnus will
8104 uncompress and de-tar the main file, and then view the two pictures.
8105 This unpacking process is recursive, so if the archive contains archives
8106 of archives, it'll all be unpacked.
8107
8108 Finally, Gnus will normally insert a @dfn{pseudo-article} for each
8109 extracted file into the summary buffer. If you go to these
8110 ``articles'', you will be prompted for a command to run (usually Gnus
8111 will make a suggestion), and then the command will be run.
8112
8113 @vindex gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously
8114 If @code{gnus-view-pseudo-asynchronously} is @code{nil}, Emacs will wait
8115 until the viewing is done before proceeding.
8116
8117 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos
8118 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos} is @code{automatic}, Gnus will not insert
8119 the pseudo-articles into the summary buffer, but view them
8120 immediately. If this variable is @code{not-confirm}, the user won't even
8121 be asked for a confirmation before viewing is done.
8122
8123 @vindex gnus-view-pseudos-separately
8124 If @code{gnus-view-pseudos-separately} is non-@code{nil}, one
8125 pseudo-article will be created for each file to be viewed. If
8126 @code{nil}, all files that use the same viewing command will be given as
8127 a list of parameters to that command.
8128
8129 @vindex gnus-insert-pseudo-articles
8130 If @code{gnus-insert-pseudo-articles} is non-@code{nil}, insert
8131 pseudo-articles when decoding. It is @code{t} by default.
8132
8133 So; there you are, reading your @emph{pseudo-articles} in your
8134 @emph{virtual newsgroup} from the @emph{virtual server}; and you think:
8135 Why isn't anything real anymore? How did we get here?
8136
8137
8138 @node Article Treatment
8139 @section Article Treatment
8140
8141 Reading through this huge manual, you may have quite forgotten that the
8142 object of newsreaders is to actually, like, read what people have
8143 written. Reading articles. Unfortunately, people are quite bad at
8144 writing, so there are tons of functions and variables to make reading
8145 these articles easier.
8146
8147 @menu
8148 * Article Highlighting:: You want to make the article look like fruit salad.
8149 * Article Fontisizing:: Making emphasized text look nice.
8150 * Article Hiding:: You also want to make certain info go away.
8151 * Article Washing:: Lots of way-neat functions to make life better.
8152 * Article Header:: Doing various header transformations.
8153 * Article Buttons:: Click on URLs, Message-IDs, addresses and the like.
8154 * Article Button Levels:: Controlling appearance of buttons.
8155 * Article Date:: Grumble, UT!
8156 * Article Display:: Display various stuff---X-Face, Picons, Smileys
8157 * Article Signature:: What is a signature?
8158 * Article Miscellanea:: Various other stuff.
8159 @end menu
8160
8161
8162 @node Article Highlighting
8163 @subsection Article Highlighting
8164 @cindex highlighting
8165
8166 Not only do you want your article buffer to look like fruit salad, but
8167 you want it to look like technicolor fruit salad.
8168
8169 @table @kbd
8170
8171 @item W H a
8172 @kindex W H a (Summary)
8173 @findex gnus-article-highlight
8174 @findex gnus-article-maybe-highlight
8175 Do much highlighting of the current article
8176 (@code{gnus-article-highlight}). This function highlights header, cited
8177 text, the signature, and adds buttons to the body and the head.
8178
8179 @item W H h
8180 @kindex W H h (Summary)
8181 @findex gnus-article-highlight-headers
8182 @vindex gnus-header-face-alist
8183 Highlight the headers (@code{gnus-article-highlight-headers}). The
8184 highlighting will be done according to the @code{gnus-header-face-alist}
8185 variable, which is a list where each element has the form
8186 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{name} @var{content})}.
8187 @var{regexp} is a regular expression for matching the
8188 header, @var{name} is the face used for highlighting the header name
8189 (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}) and @var{content} is the face for highlighting
8190 the header value. The first match made will be used. Note that
8191 @var{regexp} shouldn't have @samp{^} prepended---Gnus will add one.
8192
8193 @item W H c
8194 @kindex W H c (Summary)
8195 @findex gnus-article-highlight-citation
8196 Highlight cited text (@code{gnus-article-highlight-citation}).
8197
8198 Some variables to customize the citation highlights:
8199
8200 @table @code
8201 @vindex gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8202
8203 @item gnus-cite-parse-max-size
8204 If the article size in bytes is bigger than this variable (which is
8205 25000 by default), no citation highlighting will be performed.
8206
8207 @item gnus-cite-max-prefix
8208 @vindex gnus-cite-max-prefix
8209 Maximum possible length for a citation prefix (default 20).
8210
8211 @item gnus-cite-face-list
8212 @vindex gnus-cite-face-list
8213 List of faces used for highlighting citations (@pxref{Faces and Fonts}).
8214 When there are citations from multiple articles in the same message,
8215 Gnus will try to give each citation from each article its own face.
8216 This should make it easier to see who wrote what.
8217
8218 @item gnus-supercite-regexp
8219 @vindex gnus-supercite-regexp
8220 Regexp matching normal Supercite attribution lines.
8221
8222 @item gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8223 @vindex gnus-supercite-secondary-regexp
8224 Regexp matching mangled Supercite attribution lines.
8225
8226 @item gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8227 @vindex gnus-cite-minimum-match-count
8228 Minimum number of identical prefixes we have to see before we believe
8229 that it's a citation.
8230
8231 @item gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8232 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-prefix
8233 Regexp matching the beginning of an attribution line.
8234
8235 @item gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8236 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-suffix
8237 Regexp matching the end of an attribution line.
8238
8239 @item gnus-cite-attribution-face
8240 @vindex gnus-cite-attribution-face
8241 Face used for attribution lines. It is merged with the face for the
8242 cited text belonging to the attribution.
8243
8244 @item gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8245 @vindex gnus-cite-ignore-quoted-from
8246 If non-@code{nil}, no citation highlighting will be performed on lines
8247 beginning with @samp{>From }. Those lines may have been quoted by MTAs
8248 in order not to mix up with the envelope From line. The default value
8249 is @code{t}.
8250
8251 @end table
8252
8253
8254 @item W H s
8255 @kindex W H s (Summary)
8256 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
8257 @vindex gnus-signature-face
8258 @findex gnus-article-highlight-signature
8259 Highlight the signature (@code{gnus-article-highlight-signature}).
8260 Everything after @code{gnus-signature-separator} (@pxref{Article
8261 Signature}) in an article will be considered a signature and will be
8262 highlighted with @code{gnus-signature-face}, which is @code{italic} by
8263 default.
8264
8265 @end table
8266
8267 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to highlight articles automatically.
8268
8269
8270 @node Article Fontisizing
8271 @subsection Article Fontisizing
8272 @cindex emphasis
8273 @cindex article emphasis
8274
8275 @findex gnus-article-emphasize
8276 @kindex W e (Summary)
8277 People commonly add emphasis to words in news articles by writing things
8278 like @samp{_this_} or @samp{*this*} or @samp{/this/}. Gnus can make
8279 this look nicer by running the article through the @kbd{W e}
8280 (@code{gnus-article-emphasize}) command.
8281
8282 @vindex gnus-emphasis-alist
8283 How the emphasis is computed is controlled by the
8284 @code{gnus-emphasis-alist} variable. This is an alist where the first
8285 element is a regular expression to be matched. The second is a number
8286 that says what regular expression grouping is used to find the entire
8287 emphasized word. The third is a number that says what regexp grouping
8288 should be displayed and highlighted. (The text between these two
8289 groupings will be hidden.) The fourth is the face used for
8290 highlighting.
8291
8292 @lisp
8293 (setq gnus-emphasis-alist
8294 '(("_\\(\\w+\\)_" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-underline)
8295 ("\\*\\(\\w+\\)\\*" 0 1 gnus-emphasis-bold)))
8296 @end lisp
8297
8298 @cindex slash
8299 @cindex asterisk
8300 @cindex underline
8301 @cindex /
8302 @cindex *
8303
8304 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline
8305 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold
8306 @vindex gnus-emphasis-italic
8307 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold
8308 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-italic
8309 @vindex gnus-emphasis-bold-italic
8310 @vindex gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic
8311 By default, there are seven rules, and they use the following faces:
8312 @code{gnus-emphasis-bold}, @code{gnus-emphasis-italic},
8313 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline}, @code{gnus-emphasis-bold-italic},
8314 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-italic},
8315 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold}, and
8316 @code{gnus-emphasis-underline-bold-italic}.
8317
8318 If you want to change these faces, you can either use @kbd{M-x
8319 customize}, or you can use @code{copy-face}. For instance, if you want
8320 to make @code{gnus-emphasis-italic} use a red face instead, you could
8321 say something like:
8322
8323 @lisp
8324 (copy-face 'red 'gnus-emphasis-italic)
8325 @end lisp
8326
8327 @vindex gnus-group-highlight-words-alist
8328
8329 If you want to highlight arbitrary words, you can use the
8330 @code{gnus-group-highlight-words-alist} variable, which uses the same
8331 syntax as @code{gnus-emphasis-alist}. The @code{highlight-words} group
8332 parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) can also be used.
8333
8334 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to fontize articles automatically.
8335
8336
8337 @node Article Hiding
8338 @subsection Article Hiding
8339 @cindex article hiding
8340
8341 Or rather, hiding certain things in each article. There usually is much
8342 too much cruft in most articles.
8343
8344 @table @kbd
8345
8346 @item W W a
8347 @kindex W W a (Summary)
8348 @findex gnus-article-hide
8349 Do quite a lot of hiding on the article buffer
8350 (@kbd{gnus-article-hide}). In particular, this function will hide
8351 headers, @acronym{PGP}, cited text and the signature.
8352
8353 @item W W h
8354 @kindex W W h (Summary)
8355 @findex gnus-article-hide-headers
8356 Hide headers (@code{gnus-article-hide-headers}). @xref{Hiding
8357 Headers}.
8358
8359 @item W W b
8360 @kindex W W b (Summary)
8361 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
8362 Hide headers that aren't particularly interesting
8363 (@code{gnus-article-hide-boring-headers}). @xref{Hiding Headers}.
8364
8365 @item W W s
8366 @kindex W W s (Summary)
8367 @findex gnus-article-hide-signature
8368 Hide signature (@code{gnus-article-hide-signature}). @xref{Article
8369 Signature}.
8370
8371 @item W W l
8372 @kindex W W l (Summary)
8373 @findex gnus-article-hide-list-identifiers
8374 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8375 Strip list identifiers specified in @code{gnus-list-identifiers}. These
8376 are strings some mailing list servers add to the beginning of all
8377 @code{Subject} headers---for example, @samp{[zebra 4711]}. Any leading
8378 @samp{Re: } is skipped before stripping. @code{gnus-list-identifiers}
8379 may not contain @code{\\(..\\)}.
8380
8381 @table @code
8382
8383 @item gnus-list-identifiers
8384 @vindex gnus-list-identifiers
8385 A regular expression that matches list identifiers to be removed from
8386 subject. This can also be a list of regular expressions.
8387
8388 @end table
8389
8390 @item W W P
8391 @kindex W W P (Summary)
8392 @findex gnus-article-hide-pem
8393 Hide @acronym{PEM} (privacy enhanced messages) cruft
8394 (@code{gnus-article-hide-pem}).
8395
8396 @item W W B
8397 @kindex W W B (Summary)
8398 @findex gnus-article-strip-banner
8399 @vindex gnus-article-banner-alist
8400 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8401 @cindex banner
8402 @cindex OneList
8403 @cindex stripping advertisements
8404 @cindex advertisements
8405 Strip the banner specified by the @code{banner} group parameter
8406 (@code{gnus-article-strip-banner}). This is mainly used to hide those
8407 annoying banners and/or signatures that some mailing lists and moderated
8408 groups adds to all the messages. The way to use this function is to add
8409 the @code{banner} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to the
8410 group you want banners stripped from. The parameter either be a string,
8411 which will be interpreted as a regular expression matching text to be
8412 removed, or the symbol @code{signature}, meaning that the (last)
8413 signature should be removed, or other symbol, meaning that the
8414 corresponding regular expression in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist} is
8415 used.
8416
8417 Regardless of a group, you can hide things like advertisements only when
8418 the sender of an article has a certain mail address specified in
8419 @code{gnus-article-address-banner-alist}.
8420
8421 @table @code
8422
8423 @item gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8424 @vindex gnus-article-address-banner-alist
8425 Alist of mail addresses and banners. Each element has the form
8426 @code{(@var{address} . @var{banner})}, where @var{address} is a regexp
8427 matching a mail address in the From header, @var{banner} is one of a
8428 symbol @code{signature}, an item in @code{gnus-article-banner-alist},
8429 a regexp and @code{nil}. If @var{address} matches author's mail
8430 address, it will remove things like advertisements. For example, if a
8431 sender has the mail address @samp{hail@@yoo-hoo.co.jp} and there is a
8432 banner something like @samp{Do You Yoo-hoo!?} in all articles he
8433 sends, you can use the following element to remove them:
8434
8435 @lisp
8436 ("@@yoo-hoo\\.co\\.jp\\'" .
8437 "\n_+\nDo You Yoo-hoo!\\?\n.*\n.*\n")
8438 @end lisp
8439
8440 @end table
8441
8442 @item W W c
8443 @kindex W W c (Summary)
8444 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation
8445 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation}). Some variables for
8446 customizing the hiding:
8447
8448 @table @code
8449
8450 @item gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8451 @itemx gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8452 @vindex gnus-cited-closed-text-button-line-format
8453 @vindex gnus-cited-opened-text-button-line-format
8454 Gnus adds buttons to show where the cited text has been hidden, and to
8455 allow toggle hiding the text. The format of the variable is specified
8456 by these format-like variable (@pxref{Formatting Variables}). These
8457 specs are valid:
8458
8459 @table @samp
8460 @item b
8461 Starting point of the hidden text.
8462 @item e
8463 Ending point of the hidden text.
8464 @item l
8465 Number of characters in the hidden region.
8466 @item n
8467 Number of lines of hidden text.
8468 @end table
8469
8470 @item gnus-cited-lines-visible
8471 @vindex gnus-cited-lines-visible
8472 The number of lines at the beginning of the cited text to leave
8473 shown. This can also be a cons cell with the number of lines at the top
8474 and bottom of the text, respectively, to remain visible.
8475
8476 @end table
8477
8478 @item W W C-c
8479 @kindex W W C-c (Summary)
8480 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe
8481
8482 Hide citation (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-maybe}) depending on the
8483 following two variables:
8484
8485 @table @code
8486 @item gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8487 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-percentage
8488 If the cited text is of a bigger percentage than this variable (default
8489 50), hide the cited text.
8490
8491 @item gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8492 @vindex gnus-cite-hide-absolute
8493 The cited text must have at least this length (default 10) before it
8494 is hidden.
8495 @end table
8496
8497 @item W W C
8498 @kindex W W C (Summary)
8499 @findex gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups
8500 Hide cited text in articles that aren't roots
8501 (@code{gnus-article-hide-citation-in-followups}). This isn't very
8502 useful as an interactive command, but might be a handy function to stick
8503 have happen automatically (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8504
8505 @end table
8506
8507 All these ``hiding'' commands are toggles, but if you give a negative
8508 prefix to these commands, they will show what they have previously
8509 hidden. If you give a positive prefix, they will always hide.
8510
8511 Also @pxref{Article Highlighting} for further variables for
8512 citation customization.
8513
8514 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to hide article elements
8515 automatically.
8516
8517
8518 @node Article Washing
8519 @subsection Article Washing
8520 @cindex washing
8521 @cindex article washing
8522
8523 We call this ``article washing'' for a really good reason. Namely, the
8524 @kbd{A} key was taken, so we had to use the @kbd{W} key instead.
8525
8526 @dfn{Washing} is defined by us as ``changing something from something to
8527 something else'', but normally results in something looking better.
8528 Cleaner, perhaps.
8529
8530 @xref{Customizing Articles}, if you want to change how Gnus displays
8531 articles by default.
8532
8533 @table @kbd
8534
8535 @item C-u g
8536 This is not really washing, it's sort of the opposite of washing. If
8537 you type this, you see the article exactly as it exists on disk or on
8538 the server.
8539
8540 @item g
8541 Force redisplaying of the current article
8542 (@code{gnus-summary-show-article}). This is also not really washing.
8543 If you type this, you see the article without any previously applied
8544 interactive Washing functions but with all default treatments
8545 (@pxref{Customizing Articles}).
8546
8547 @item W l
8548 @kindex W l (Summary)
8549 @findex gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking
8550 Remove page breaks from the current article
8551 (@code{gnus-summary-stop-page-breaking}). @xref{Misc Article}, for page
8552 delimiters.
8553
8554 @item W r
8555 @kindex W r (Summary)
8556 @findex gnus-summary-caesar-message
8557 @c @icon{gnus-summary-caesar-message}
8558 Do a Caesar rotate (rot13) on the article buffer
8559 (@code{gnus-summary-caesar-message}).
8560 Unreadable articles that tell you to read them with Caesar rotate or rot13.
8561 (Typically offensive jokes and such.)
8562
8563 It's commonly called ``rot13'' because each letter is rotated 13
8564 positions in the alphabet, e. g. @samp{B} (letter #2) -> @samp{O} (letter
8565 #15). It is sometimes referred to as ``Caesar rotate'' because Caesar
8566 is rumored to have employed this form of, uh, somewhat weak encryption.
8567
8568 @item W m
8569 @kindex W m (Summary)
8570 @findex gnus-summary-morse-message
8571 Morse decode the article buffer (@code{gnus-summary-morse-message}).
8572
8573 @item W t
8574 @item t
8575 @kindex W t (Summary)
8576 @kindex t (Summary)
8577 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-header
8578 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer
8579 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-header}).
8580
8581 @item W v
8582 @kindex W v (Summary)
8583 @findex gnus-summary-verbose-headers
8584 Toggle whether to display all headers in the article buffer permanently
8585 (@code{gnus-summary-verbose-headers}).
8586
8587 @item W o
8588 @kindex W o (Summary)
8589 @findex gnus-article-treat-overstrike
8590 Treat overstrike (@code{gnus-article-treat-overstrike}).
8591
8592 @item W d
8593 @kindex W d (Summary)
8594 @findex gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes
8595 @vindex gnus-article-dumbquotes-map
8596 @cindex Smartquotes
8597 @cindex M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s
8598 @cindex Latin 1
8599 Treat M****s*** sm*rtq**t*s according to
8600 @code{gnus-article-dumbquotes-map}
8601 (@code{gnus-article-treat-dumbquotes}). Note that this function guesses
8602 whether a character is a sm*rtq**t* or not, so it should only be used
8603 interactively.
8604
8605 Sm*rtq**t*s are M****s***'s unilateral extension to the character map in
8606 an attempt to provide more quoting characters. If you see something
8607 like @code{\222} or @code{\264} where you're expecting some kind of
8608 apostrophe or quotation mark, then try this wash.
8609
8610 @item W Y f
8611 @kindex W Y f (Summary)
8612 @findex gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article
8613 @cindex Outlook Express
8614 Full deuglify of broken Outlook (Express) articles: Treat dumbquotes,
8615 unwrap lines, repair attribution and rearrange citation.
8616 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}).
8617
8618 @item W Y u
8619 @kindex W Y u (Summary)
8620 @findex gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines
8621 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min
8622 @vindex gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max
8623 Unwrap lines that appear to be wrapped citation lines. You can control
8624 what lines will be unwrapped by frobbing
8625 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-min} and
8626 @code{gnus-outlook-deuglify-unwrap-max}, indicating the minimum and
8627 maximum length of an unwrapped citation line.
8628 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-unwrap-lines}).
8629
8630 @item W Y a
8631 @kindex W Y a (Summary)
8632 @findex gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution
8633 Repair a broken attribution line.@*
8634 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-repair-attribution}).
8635
8636 @item W Y c
8637 @kindex W Y c (Summary)
8638 @findex gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation
8639 Repair broken citations by rearranging the text.
8640 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-rearrange-citation}).
8641
8642 @item W w
8643 @kindex W w (Summary)
8644 @findex gnus-article-fill-cited-article
8645 Do word wrap (@code{gnus-article-fill-cited-article}).
8646
8647 You can give the command a numerical prefix to specify the width to use
8648 when filling.
8649
8650 @item W Q
8651 @kindex W Q (Summary)
8652 @findex gnus-article-fill-long-lines
8653 Fill long lines (@code{gnus-article-fill-long-lines}).
8654
8655 @item W C
8656 @kindex W C (Summary)
8657 @findex gnus-article-capitalize-sentences
8658 Capitalize the first word in each sentence
8659 (@code{gnus-article-capitalize-sentences}).
8660
8661 @item W c
8662 @kindex W c (Summary)
8663 @findex gnus-article-remove-cr
8664 Translate CRLF pairs (i. e., @samp{^M}s on the end of the lines) into LF
8665 (this takes care of DOS line endings), and then translate any remaining
8666 CRs into LF (this takes care of Mac line endings)
8667 (@code{gnus-article-remove-cr}).
8668
8669 @item W q
8670 @kindex W q (Summary)
8671 @findex gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable
8672 Treat quoted-printable (@code{gnus-article-de-quoted-unreadable}).
8673 Quoted-Printable is one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when
8674 sending non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. It typically
8675 makes strings like @samp{déjà vu} look like @samp{d=E9j=E0 vu}, which
8676 doesn't look very readable to me. Note that this is usually done
8677 automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8678 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8679 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8680
8681 @item W 6
8682 @kindex W 6 (Summary)
8683 @findex gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable
8684 Treat base64 (@code{gnus-article-de-base64-unreadable}). Base64 is
8685 one common @acronym{MIME} encoding employed when sending
8686 non-@acronym{ASCII} (i.e., 8-bit) articles. Note that this is
8687 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8688 @code{Content-Transfer-Encoding} header that says that this encoding
8689 has been done. If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for.
8690
8691 @item W Z
8692 @kindex W Z (Summary)
8693 @findex gnus-article-decode-HZ
8694 Treat HZ or HZP (@code{gnus-article-decode-HZ}). HZ (or HZP) is one
8695 common encoding employed when sending Chinese articles. It typically
8696 makes strings look like @samp{~@{<:Ky2;S@{#,NpJ)l6HK!#~@}}.
8697
8698 @item W u
8699 @kindex W u (Summary)
8700 @findex gnus-article-unsplit-urls
8701 Remove newlines from within URLs. Some mailers insert newlines into
8702 outgoing email messages to keep lines short. This reformatting can
8703 split long URLs onto multiple lines. Repair those URLs by removing
8704 the newlines (@code{gnus-article-unsplit-urls}).
8705
8706 @item W h
8707 @kindex W h (Summary)
8708 @findex gnus-article-wash-html
8709 Treat @acronym{HTML} (@code{gnus-article-wash-html}). Note that this is
8710 usually done automatically by Gnus if the message in question has a
8711 @code{Content-Type} header that says that the message is @acronym{HTML}.
8712
8713 If a prefix is given, a charset will be asked for. If it is a number,
8714 the charset defined in @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist}
8715 (@pxref{Paging the Article}) will be used.
8716
8717 @vindex gnus-article-wash-function
8718 The default is to use the function specified by
8719 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display
8720 Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) to convert the
8721 @acronym{HTML}, but this is controlled by the
8722 @code{gnus-article-wash-function} variable. Pre-defined functions you
8723 can use include:
8724
8725 @table @code
8726 @item w3
8727 Use Emacs/W3.
8728
8729 @item w3m
8730 Use @uref{http://emacs-w3m.namazu.org/, emacs-w3m}.
8731
8732 @item w3m-standalone
8733 Use @uref{http://w3m.sourceforge.net/, w3m}.
8734
8735 @item links
8736 Use @uref{http://links.sf.net/, Links}.
8737
8738 @item lynx
8739 Use @uref{http://lynx.isc.org/, Lynx}.
8740
8741 @item html2text
8742 Use html2text---a simple @acronym{HTML} converter included with Gnus.
8743
8744 @end table
8745
8746 @item W b
8747 @kindex W b (Summary)
8748 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons
8749 Add clickable buttons to the article (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons}).
8750 @xref{Article Buttons}.
8751
8752 @item W B
8753 @kindex W B (Summary)
8754 @findex gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head
8755 Add clickable buttons to the article headers
8756 (@code{gnus-article-add-buttons-to-head}).
8757
8758 @item W p
8759 @kindex W p (Summary)
8760 @findex gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig
8761 Verify a signed control message
8762 (@code{gnus-article-verify-x-pgp-sig}). Control messages such as
8763 @code{newgroup} and @code{checkgroups} are usually signed by the
8764 hierarchy maintainer. You need to add the @acronym{PGP} public key of
8765 the maintainer to your keyring to verify the
8766 message.@footnote{@acronym{PGP} keys for many hierarchies are
8767 available at @uref{ftp://ftp.isc.org/pub/pgpcontrol/README.html}}
8768
8769 @item W s
8770 @kindex W s (Summary)
8771 @findex gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt
8772 Verify a signed (@acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME} or
8773 @acronym{S/MIME}) message
8774 (@code{gnus-summary-force-verify-and-decrypt}). @xref{Security}.
8775
8776 @item W a
8777 @kindex W a (Summary)
8778 @findex gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body
8779 Strip headers like the @code{X-No-Archive} header from the beginning of
8780 article bodies (@code{gnus-article-strip-headers-in-body}).
8781
8782 @item W E l
8783 @kindex W E l (Summary)
8784 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines
8785 Remove all blank lines from the beginning of the article
8786 (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-blank-lines}).
8787
8788 @item W E m
8789 @kindex W E m (Summary)
8790 @findex gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines
8791 Replace all blank lines with empty lines and then all multiple empty
8792 lines with a single empty line.
8793 (@code{gnus-article-strip-multiple-blank-lines}).
8794
8795 @item W E t
8796 @kindex W E t (Summary)
8797 @findex gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines
8798 Remove all blank lines at the end of the article
8799 (@code{gnus-article-remove-trailing-blank-lines}).
8800
8801 @item W E a
8802 @kindex W E a (Summary)
8803 @findex gnus-article-strip-blank-lines
8804 Do all the three commands above
8805 (@code{gnus-article-strip-blank-lines}).
8806
8807 @item W E A
8808 @kindex W E A (Summary)
8809 @findex gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines
8810 Remove all blank lines
8811 (@code{gnus-article-strip-all-blank-lines}).
8812
8813 @item W E s
8814 @kindex W E s (Summary)
8815 @findex gnus-article-strip-leading-space
8816 Remove all white space from the beginning of all lines of the article
8817 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-leading-space}).
8818
8819 @item W E e
8820 @kindex W E e (Summary)
8821 @findex gnus-article-strip-trailing-space
8822 Remove all white space from the end of all lines of the article
8823 body (@code{gnus-article-strip-trailing-space}).
8824
8825 @end table
8826
8827 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to wash articles automatically.
8828
8829
8830 @node Article Header
8831 @subsection Article Header
8832
8833 These commands perform various transformations of article header.
8834
8835 @table @kbd
8836
8837 @item W G u
8838 @kindex W G u (Summary)
8839 @findex gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers
8840 Unfold folded header lines (@code{gnus-article-treat-unfold-headers}).
8841
8842 @item W G n
8843 @kindex W G n (Summary)
8844 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups
8845 Fold the @code{Newsgroups} and @code{Followup-To} headers
8846 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-newsgroups}).
8847
8848 @item W G f
8849 @kindex W G f (Summary)
8850 @findex gnus-article-treat-fold-headers
8851 Fold all the message headers
8852 (@code{gnus-article-treat-fold-headers}).
8853
8854 @item W E w
8855 @kindex W E w (Summary)
8856 @findex gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace
8857 Remove excessive whitespace from all headers
8858 (@code{gnus-article-remove-leading-whitespace}).
8859
8860 @end table
8861
8862
8863 @node Article Buttons
8864 @subsection Article Buttons
8865 @cindex buttons
8866
8867 People often include references to other stuff in articles, and it would
8868 be nice if Gnus could just fetch whatever it is that people talk about
8869 with the minimum of fuzz when you hit @kbd{RET} or use the middle mouse
8870 button on these references.
8871
8872 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8873 Gnus adds @dfn{buttons} to certain standard references by default:
8874 Well-formed URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man pages and
8875 Emacs or Gnus related references. This is controlled by two variables,
8876 one that handles article bodies and one that handles article heads:
8877
8878 @table @code
8879
8880 @item gnus-button-alist
8881 @vindex gnus-button-alist
8882 This is an alist where each entry has this form:
8883
8884 @lisp
8885 (@var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8886 @end lisp
8887
8888 @table @var
8889
8890 @item regexp
8891 All text that match this regular expression (case insensitive) will be
8892 considered an external reference. Here's a typical regexp that matches
8893 embedded URLs: @samp{<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>}. This can also be a
8894 variable containing a regexp, useful variables to use include
8895 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp} and @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp}.
8896
8897 @item button-par
8898 Gnus has to know which parts of the matches is to be highlighted. This
8899 is a number that says what sub-expression of the regexp is to be
8900 highlighted. If you want it all highlighted, you use 0 here.
8901
8902 @item use-p
8903 This form will be @code{eval}ed, and if the result is non-@code{nil},
8904 this is considered a match. This is useful if you want extra sifting to
8905 avoid false matches. Often variables named
8906 @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} are used here, @xref{Article Button
8907 Levels}, but any other form may be used too.
8908
8909 @c @code{use-p} is @code{eval}ed only if @code{regexp} matches.
8910
8911 @item function
8912 This function will be called when you click on this button.
8913
8914 @item data-par
8915 As with @var{button-par}, this is a sub-expression number, but this one
8916 says which part of the match is to be sent as data to @var{function}.
8917
8918 @end table
8919
8920 So the full entry for buttonizing URLs is then
8921
8922 @lisp
8923 ("<URL:\\([^\n\r>]*\\)>" 0 t gnus-button-url 1)
8924 @end lisp
8925
8926 @item gnus-header-button-alist
8927 @vindex gnus-header-button-alist
8928 This is just like the other alist, except that it is applied to the
8929 article head only, and that each entry has an additional element that is
8930 used to say what headers to apply the buttonize coding to:
8931
8932 @lisp
8933 (@var{header} @var{regexp} @var{button-par} @var{use-p} @var{function} @var{data-par})
8934 @end lisp
8935
8936 @var{header} is a regular expression.
8937 @end table
8938
8939 @subsubsection Related variables and functions
8940
8941 @table @code
8942 @item gnus-button-@var{*}-level
8943 @xref{Article Button Levels}.
8944
8945 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-browse-level
8946
8947 @item gnus-button-url-regexp
8948 @vindex gnus-button-url-regexp
8949 A regular expression that matches embedded URLs. It is used in the
8950 default values of the variables above.
8951
8952 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-man-level
8953
8954 @item gnus-button-man-handler
8955 @vindex gnus-button-man-handler
8956 The function to use for displaying man pages. It must take at least one
8957 argument with a string naming the man page.
8958
8959 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-message-level
8960
8961 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8962 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp
8963 Regular expression that matches a message ID or a mail address.
8964
8965 @item gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8966 @vindex gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail
8967 This variable determines what to do when the button on a string as
8968 @samp{foo123@@bar.invalid} is pushed. Strings like this can be either a
8969 message ID or a mail address. If it is one of the symbols @code{mid} or
8970 @code{mail}, Gnus will always assume that the string is a message ID or
8971 a mail address, respectively. If this variable is set to the symbol
8972 @code{ask}, always query the user what to do. If it is a function, this
8973 function will be called with the string as its only argument. The
8974 function must return @code{mid}, @code{mail}, @code{invalid} or
8975 @code{ask}. The default value is the function
8976 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8977
8978 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8979 @findex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic
8980 Function that guesses whether its argument is a message ID or a mail
8981 address. Returns @code{mid} if it's a message IDs, @code{mail} if
8982 it's a mail address, @code{ask} if unsure and @code{invalid} if the
8983 string is invalid.
8984
8985 @item gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8986 @vindex gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist
8987 An alist of @code{(RATE . REGEXP)} pairs used by the function
8988 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}.
8989
8990 @c Stuff related to gnus-button-tex-level
8991
8992 @item gnus-button-ctan-handler
8993 @findex gnus-button-ctan-handler
8994 The function to use for displaying CTAN links. It must take one
8995 argument, the string naming the URL.
8996
8997 @item gnus-ctan-url
8998 @vindex gnus-ctan-url
8999 Top directory of a CTAN (Comprehensive TeX Archive Network) archive used
9000 by @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler}.
9001
9002 @c Misc stuff
9003
9004 @item gnus-article-button-face
9005 @vindex gnus-article-button-face
9006 Face used on buttons.
9007
9008 @item gnus-article-mouse-face
9009 @vindex gnus-article-mouse-face
9010 Face used when the mouse cursor is over a button.
9011
9012 @end table
9013
9014 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to buttonize articles automatically.
9015
9016
9017 @node Article Button Levels
9018 @subsection Article button levels
9019 @cindex button levels
9020 The higher the value of the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level},
9021 the more buttons will appear. If the level is zero, no corresponding
9022 buttons are displayed. With the default value (which is 5) you should
9023 already see quite a lot of buttons. With higher levels, you will see
9024 more buttons, but you may also get more false positives. To avoid them,
9025 you can set the variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} local to
9026 specific groups (@pxref{Group Parameters}). Here's an example for the
9027 variable @code{gnus-parameters}:
9028
9029 @lisp
9030 ;; @r{increase @code{gnus-button-*-level} in some groups:}
9031 (setq gnus-parameters
9032 '(("\\<\\(emacs\\|gnus\\)\\>" (gnus-button-emacs-level 10))
9033 ("\\<unix\\>" (gnus-button-man-level 10))
9034 ("\\<tex\\>" (gnus-button-tex-level 10))))
9035 @end lisp
9036
9037 @table @code
9038
9039 @item gnus-button-browse-level
9040 @vindex gnus-button-browse-level
9041 Controls the display of references to message IDs, mail addresses and
9042 news URLs. Related variables and functions include
9043 @code{gnus-button-url-regexp}, @code{browse-url}, and
9044 @code{browse-url-browser-function}.
9045
9046 @item gnus-button-emacs-level
9047 @vindex gnus-button-emacs-level
9048 Controls the display of Emacs or Gnus references. Related functions are
9049 @code{gnus-button-handle-custom},
9050 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-function},
9051 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-variable},
9052 @code{gnus-button-handle-symbol},
9053 @code{gnus-button-handle-describe-key},
9054 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos},
9055 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-command},
9056 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-variable},
9057 @code{gnus-button-handle-apropos-documentation}, and
9058 @code{gnus-button-handle-library}.
9059
9060 @item gnus-button-man-level
9061 @vindex gnus-button-man-level
9062 Controls the display of references to (Unix) man pages.
9063 See @code{gnus-button-man-handler}.
9064
9065 @item gnus-button-message-level
9066 @vindex gnus-button-message-level
9067 Controls the display of message IDs, mail addresses and news URLs.
9068 Related variables and functions include
9069 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-regexp},
9070 @code{gnus-button-prefer-mid-or-mail},
9071 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic}, and
9072 @code{gnus-button-mid-or-mail-heuristic-alist}.
9073
9074 @item gnus-button-tex-level
9075 @vindex gnus-button-tex-level
9076 Controls the display of references to @TeX{} or LaTeX stuff, e.g. for CTAN
9077 URLs. See the variables @code{gnus-ctan-url},
9078 @code{gnus-button-ctan-handler},
9079 @code{gnus-button-ctan-directory-regexp}, and
9080 @code{gnus-button-handle-ctan-bogus-regexp}.
9081
9082 @end table
9083
9084
9085 @node Article Date
9086 @subsection Article Date
9087
9088 The date is most likely generated in some obscure timezone you've never
9089 heard of, so it's quite nice to be able to find out what the time was
9090 when the article was sent.
9091
9092 @table @kbd
9093
9094 @item W T u
9095 @kindex W T u (Summary)
9096 @findex gnus-article-date-ut
9097 Display the date in UT (aka. GMT, aka ZULU)
9098 (@code{gnus-article-date-ut}).
9099
9100 @item W T i
9101 @kindex W T i (Summary)
9102 @findex gnus-article-date-iso8601
9103 @cindex ISO 8601
9104 Display the date in international format, aka. ISO 8601
9105 (@code{gnus-article-date-iso8601}).
9106
9107 @item W T l
9108 @kindex W T l (Summary)
9109 @findex gnus-article-date-local
9110 Display the date in the local timezone (@code{gnus-article-date-local}).
9111
9112 @item W T p
9113 @kindex W T p (Summary)
9114 @findex gnus-article-date-english
9115 Display the date in a format that's easily pronounceable in English
9116 (@code{gnus-article-date-english}).
9117
9118 @item W T s
9119 @kindex W T s (Summary)
9120 @vindex gnus-article-time-format
9121 @findex gnus-article-date-user
9122 @findex format-time-string
9123 Display the date using a user-defined format
9124 (@code{gnus-article-date-user}). The format is specified by the
9125 @code{gnus-article-time-format} variable, and is a string that's passed
9126 to @code{format-time-string}. See the documentation of that variable
9127 for a list of possible format specs.
9128
9129 @item W T e
9130 @kindex W T e (Summary)
9131 @findex gnus-article-date-lapsed
9132 @findex gnus-start-date-timer
9133 @findex gnus-stop-date-timer
9134 Say how much time has elapsed between the article was posted and now
9135 (@code{gnus-article-date-lapsed}). It looks something like:
9136
9137 @example
9138 X-Sent: 6 weeks, 4 days, 1 hour, 3 minutes, 8 seconds ago
9139 @end example
9140
9141 @vindex gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header
9142 The value of @code{gnus-article-date-lapsed-new-header} determines
9143 whether this header will just be added below the old Date one, or will
9144 replace it.
9145
9146 An advantage of using Gnus to read mail is that it converts simple bugs
9147 into wonderful absurdities.
9148
9149 If you want to have this line updated continually, you can put
9150
9151 @lisp
9152 (gnus-start-date-timer)
9153 @end lisp
9154
9155 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, or you can run it off of some hook. If
9156 you want to stop the timer, you can use the @code{gnus-stop-date-timer}
9157 command.
9158
9159 @item W T o
9160 @kindex W T o (Summary)
9161 @findex gnus-article-date-original
9162 Display the original date (@code{gnus-article-date-original}). This can
9163 be useful if you normally use some other conversion function and are
9164 worried that it might be doing something totally wrong. Say, claiming
9165 that the article was posted in 1854. Although something like that is
9166 @emph{totally} impossible. Don't you trust me? *titter*
9167
9168 @end table
9169
9170 @xref{Customizing Articles}, for how to display the date in your
9171 preferred format automatically.
9172
9173
9174 @node Article Display
9175 @subsection Article Display
9176 @cindex picons
9177 @cindex x-face
9178 @cindex smileys
9179
9180 These commands add various frivolous display gimmicks to the article
9181 buffer in Emacs versions that support them.
9182
9183 @code{X-Face} headers are small black-and-white images supplied by the
9184 message headers (@pxref{X-Face}).
9185
9186 @code{Face} headers are small colored images supplied by the message
9187 headers (@pxref{Face}).
9188
9189 Smileys are those little @samp{:-)} symbols that people like to litter
9190 their messages with (@pxref{Smileys}).
9191
9192 Picons, on the other hand, reside on your own system, and Gnus will
9193 try to match the headers to what you have (@pxref{Picons}).
9194
9195 All these functions are toggles---if the elements already exist,
9196 they'll be removed.
9197
9198 @table @kbd
9199 @item W D x
9200 @kindex W D x (Summary)
9201 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
9202 Display an @code{X-Face} in the @code{From} header.
9203 (@code{gnus-article-display-x-face}).
9204
9205 @item W D d
9206 @kindex W D d (Summary)
9207 @findex gnus-article-display-face
9208 Display a @code{Face} in the @code{From} header.
9209 (@code{gnus-article-display-face}).
9210
9211 @item W D s
9212 @kindex W D s (Summary)
9213 @findex gnus-treat-smiley
9214 Display smileys (@code{gnus-treat-smiley}).
9215
9216 @item W D f
9217 @kindex W D f (Summary)
9218 @findex gnus-treat-from-picon
9219 Piconify the @code{From} header (@code{gnus-treat-from-picon}).
9220
9221 @item W D m
9222 @kindex W D m (Summary)
9223 @findex gnus-treat-mail-picon
9224 Piconify all mail headers (i. e., @code{Cc}, @code{To})
9225 (@code{gnus-treat-mail-picon}).
9226
9227 @item W D n
9228 @kindex W D n (Summary)
9229 @findex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
9230 Piconify all news headers (i. e., @code{Newsgroups} and
9231 @code{Followup-To}) (@code{gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon}).
9232
9233 @item W D D
9234 @kindex W D D (Summary)
9235 @findex gnus-article-remove-images
9236 Remove all images from the article buffer
9237 (@code{gnus-article-remove-images}).
9238
9239 @end table
9240
9241
9242
9243 @node Article Signature
9244 @subsection Article Signature
9245 @cindex signatures
9246 @cindex article signature
9247
9248 @vindex gnus-signature-separator
9249 Each article is divided into two parts---the head and the body. The
9250 body can be divided into a signature part and a text part. The variable
9251 that says what is to be considered a signature is
9252 @code{gnus-signature-separator}. This is normally the standard
9253 @samp{^-- $} as mandated by son-of-RFC 1036. However, many people use
9254 non-standard signature separators, so this variable can also be a list
9255 of regular expressions to be tested, one by one. (Searches are done
9256 from the end of the body towards the beginning.) One likely value is:
9257
9258 @lisp
9259 (setq gnus-signature-separator
9260 '("^-- $" ; @r{The standard}
9261 "^-- *$" ; @r{A common mangling}
9262 "^-------*$" ; @r{Many people just use a looong}
9263 ; @r{line of dashes. Shame!}
9264 "^ *--------*$" ; @r{Double-shame!}
9265 "^________*$" ; @r{Underscores are also popular}
9266 "^========*$")) ; @r{Pervert!}
9267 @end lisp
9268
9269 The more permissive you are, the more likely it is that you'll get false
9270 positives.
9271
9272 @vindex gnus-signature-limit
9273 @code{gnus-signature-limit} provides a limit to what is considered a
9274 signature when displaying articles.
9275
9276 @enumerate
9277 @item
9278 If it is an integer, no signature may be longer (in characters) than
9279 that integer.
9280 @item
9281 If it is a floating point number, no signature may be longer (in lines)
9282 than that number.
9283 @item
9284 If it is a function, the function will be called without any parameters,
9285 and if it returns @code{nil}, there is no signature in the buffer.
9286 @item
9287 If it is a string, it will be used as a regexp. If it matches, the text
9288 in question is not a signature.
9289 @end enumerate
9290
9291 This variable can also be a list where the elements may be of the types
9292 listed above. Here's an example:
9293
9294 @lisp
9295 (setq gnus-signature-limit
9296 '(200.0 "^---*Forwarded article"))
9297 @end lisp
9298
9299 This means that if there are more than 200 lines after the signature
9300 separator, or the text after the signature separator is matched by
9301 the regular expression @samp{^---*Forwarded article}, then it isn't a
9302 signature after all.
9303
9304
9305 @node Article Miscellanea
9306 @subsection Article Miscellanea
9307
9308 @table @kbd
9309 @item A t
9310 @kindex A t (Summary)
9311 @findex gnus-article-babel
9312 Translate the article from one language to another
9313 (@code{gnus-article-babel}).
9314
9315 @end table
9316
9317
9318 @node MIME Commands
9319 @section MIME Commands
9320 @cindex MIME decoding
9321 @cindex attachments
9322 @cindex viewing attachments
9323
9324 The following commands all understand the numerical prefix. For
9325 instance, @kbd{3 b} means ``view the third @acronym{MIME} part''.
9326
9327 @table @kbd
9328 @item b
9329 @itemx K v
9330 @kindex b (Summary)
9331 @kindex K v (Summary)
9332 View the @acronym{MIME} part.
9333
9334 @item K o
9335 @kindex K o (Summary)
9336 Save the @acronym{MIME} part.
9337
9338 @item K c
9339 @kindex K c (Summary)
9340 Copy the @acronym{MIME} part.
9341
9342 @item K e
9343 @kindex K e (Summary)
9344 View the @acronym{MIME} part externally.
9345
9346 @item K i
9347 @kindex K i (Summary)
9348 View the @acronym{MIME} part internally.
9349
9350 @item K |
9351 @kindex K | (Summary)
9352 Pipe the @acronym{MIME} part to an external command.
9353 @end table
9354
9355 The rest of these @acronym{MIME} commands do not use the numerical prefix in
9356 the same manner:
9357
9358 @table @kbd
9359 @item K b
9360 @kindex K b (Summary)
9361 Make all the @acronym{MIME} parts have buttons in front of them. This is
9362 mostly useful if you wish to save (or perform other actions) on inlined
9363 parts.
9364
9365 @item K m
9366 @kindex K m (Summary)
9367 @findex gnus-summary-repair-multipart
9368 Some multipart messages are transmitted with missing or faulty headers.
9369 This command will attempt to ``repair'' these messages so that they can
9370 be viewed in a more pleasant manner
9371 (@code{gnus-summary-repair-multipart}).
9372
9373 @item X m
9374 @kindex X m (Summary)
9375 @findex gnus-summary-save-parts
9376 Save all parts matching a @acronym{MIME} type to a directory
9377 (@code{gnus-summary-save-parts}). Understands the process/prefix
9378 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
9379
9380 @item M-t
9381 @kindex M-t (Summary)
9382 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized
9383 Toggle the buttonized display of the article buffer
9384 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-display-buttonized}).
9385
9386 @item W M w
9387 @kindex W M w (Summary)
9388 @findex gnus-article-decode-mime-words
9389 Decode RFC 2047-encoded words in the article headers
9390 (@code{gnus-article-decode-mime-words}).
9391
9392 @item W M c
9393 @kindex W M c (Summary)
9394 @findex gnus-article-decode-charset
9395 Decode encoded article bodies as well as charsets
9396 (@code{gnus-article-decode-charset}).
9397
9398 This command looks in the @code{Content-Type} header to determine the
9399 charset. If there is no such header in the article, you can give it a
9400 prefix, which will prompt for the charset to decode as. In regional
9401 groups where people post using some common encoding (but do not
9402 include @acronym{MIME} headers), you can set the @code{charset} group/topic
9403 parameter to the required charset (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
9404
9405 @item W M v
9406 @kindex W M v (Summary)
9407 @findex gnus-mime-view-all-parts
9408 View all the @acronym{MIME} parts in the current article
9409 (@code{gnus-mime-view-all-parts}).
9410
9411 @end table
9412
9413 Relevant variables:
9414
9415 @table @code
9416 @item gnus-ignored-mime-types
9417 @vindex gnus-ignored-mime-types
9418 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9419 this list will be completely ignored by Gnus. The default value is
9420 @code{nil}.
9421
9422 To have all Vcards be ignored, you'd say something like this:
9423
9424 @lisp
9425 (setq gnus-ignored-mime-types
9426 '("text/x-vcard"))
9427 @end lisp
9428
9429 @item gnus-article-loose-mime
9430 @vindex gnus-article-loose-mime
9431 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus won't require the @samp{MIME-Version} header
9432 before interpreting the message as a @acronym{MIME} message. This helps
9433 when reading messages from certain broken mail user agents. The
9434 default is @code{nil}.
9435
9436 @item gnus-article-emulate-mime
9437 @vindex gnus-article-emulate-mime
9438 @cindex uuencode
9439 @cindex yEnc
9440 There are other, non-@acronym{MIME} encoding methods used. The most common
9441 is @samp{uuencode}, but yEncode is also getting to be popular. If
9442 this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will look in message bodies to
9443 see if it finds these encodings, and if so, it'll run them through the
9444 Gnus @acronym{MIME} machinery. The default is @code{t}. Only
9445 single-part yEnc encoded attachments can be decoded. There's no support
9446 for encoding in Gnus.
9447
9448 @item gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9449 @vindex gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types
9450 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9451 this list won't have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9452 displayed or this variable is overridden by
9453 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types}. The default value is
9454 @code{(".*/.*")}. This variable is only used when
9455 @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing} is @code{nil}.
9456
9457 @item gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9458 @vindex gnus-buttonized-mime-types
9459 This is a list of regexps. @acronym{MIME} types that match a regexp from
9460 this list will have @acronym{MIME} buttons inserted unless they aren't
9461 displayed. This variable overrides
9462 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types}. The default value is @code{nil}.
9463 This variable is only used when @code{gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing}
9464 is @code{nil}.
9465
9466 To see e.g. security buttons but no other buttons, you could set this
9467 variable to @code{("multipart/signed")} and leave
9468 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} at the default value.
9469
9470 You could also add @code{"multipart/alternative"} to this list to
9471 display radio buttons that allow you to choose one of two media types
9472 those mails include. See also @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}
9473 (@pxref{Display Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The
9474 Emacs MIME Manual}).
9475
9476 @item gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9477 @vindex gnus-inhibit-mime-unbuttonizing
9478 If this is non-@code{nil}, then all @acronym{MIME} parts get buttons. The
9479 default value is @code{nil}.
9480
9481 @item gnus-article-mime-part-function
9482 @vindex gnus-article-mime-part-function
9483 For each @acronym{MIME} part, this function will be called with the @acronym{MIME}
9484 handle as the parameter. The function is meant to be used to allow
9485 users to gather information from the article (e. g., add Vcard info to
9486 the bbdb database) or to do actions based on parts (e. g., automatically
9487 save all jpegs into some directory).
9488
9489 Here's an example function the does the latter:
9490
9491 @lisp
9492 (defun my-save-all-jpeg-parts (handle)
9493 (when (equal (car (mm-handle-type handle)) "image/jpeg")
9494 (with-temp-buffer
9495 (insert (mm-get-part handle))
9496 (write-region (point-min) (point-max)
9497 (read-file-name "Save jpeg to: ")))))
9498 (setq gnus-article-mime-part-function
9499 'my-save-all-jpeg-parts)
9500 @end lisp
9501
9502 @vindex gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9503 @item gnus-mime-multipart-functions
9504 Alist of @acronym{MIME} multipart types and functions to handle them.
9505
9506 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9507 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed
9508 Display "multipart/alternative" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9509
9510 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9511 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed
9512 Display "multipart/related" parts as "multipart/mixed".
9513
9514 If displaying @samp{text/html} is discouraged, see
9515 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}, images or other material inside a
9516 "multipart/related" part might be overlooked when this variable is
9517 @code{nil}. @ref{Display Customization, Display Customization, ,
9518 emacs-mime, Emacs-Mime Manual}.
9519
9520 @vindex gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9521 @item gnus-mime-display-multipart-as-mixed
9522 Display "multipart" parts as "multipart/mixed". If @code{t}, it
9523 overrides @code{nil} values of
9524 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-alternative-as-mixed} and
9525 @code{gnus-mime-display-multipart-related-as-mixed}.
9526
9527 @vindex mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9528 @item mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9529 List of functions used for rewriting file names of @acronym{MIME} parts.
9530 Each function takes a file name as input and returns a file name.
9531
9532 Ready-made functions include@*
9533 @code{mm-file-name-delete-whitespace},
9534 @code{mm-file-name-trim-whitespace},
9535 @code{mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace}, and
9536 @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace}. The later uses the value of
9537 the variable @code{mm-file-name-replace-whitespace} to replace each
9538 whitespace character in a file name with that string; default value
9539 is @code{"_"} (a single underscore).
9540 @findex mm-file-name-delete-whitespace
9541 @findex mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9542 @findex mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9543 @findex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9544 @vindex mm-file-name-replace-whitespace
9545
9546 The standard functions @code{capitalize}, @code{downcase},
9547 @code{upcase}, and @code{upcase-initials} may be useful, too.
9548
9549 Everybody knows that whitespace characters in file names are evil,
9550 except those who don't know. If you receive lots of attachments from
9551 such unenlightened users, you can make live easier by adding
9552
9553 @lisp
9554 (setq mm-file-name-rewrite-functions
9555 '(mm-file-name-trim-whitespace
9556 mm-file-name-collapse-whitespace
9557 mm-file-name-replace-whitespace))
9558 @end lisp
9559
9560 @noindent
9561 to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
9562
9563 @end table
9564
9565
9566 @node Charsets
9567 @section Charsets
9568 @cindex charsets
9569
9570 People use different charsets, and we have @acronym{MIME} to let us know what
9571 charsets they use. Or rather, we wish we had. Many people use
9572 newsreaders and mailers that do not understand or use @acronym{MIME}, and
9573 just send out messages without saying what character sets they use. To
9574 help a bit with this, some local news hierarchies have policies that say
9575 what character set is the default. For instance, the @samp{fj}
9576 hierarchy uses @code{iso-2022-jp}.
9577
9578 @vindex gnus-group-charset-alist
9579 This knowledge is encoded in the @code{gnus-group-charset-alist}
9580 variable, which is an alist of regexps (use the first item to match full
9581 group names) and default charsets to be used when reading these groups.
9582
9583 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets
9584 In addition, some people do use soi-disant @acronym{MIME}-aware agents that
9585 aren't. These blithely mark messages as being in @code{iso-8859-1}
9586 even if they really are in @code{koi-8}. To help here, the
9587 @code{gnus-newsgroup-ignored-charsets} variable can be used. The
9588 charsets that are listed here will be ignored. The variable can be
9589 set on a group-by-group basis using the group parameters (@pxref{Group
9590 Parameters}). The default value is @code{(unknown-8bit x-unknown)},
9591 which includes values some agents insist on having in there.
9592
9593 @vindex gnus-group-posting-charset-alist
9594 When posting, @code{gnus-group-posting-charset-alist} is used to
9595 determine which charsets should not be encoded using the @acronym{MIME}
9596 encodings. For instance, some hierarchies discourage using
9597 quoted-printable header encoding.
9598
9599 This variable is an alist of regexps and permitted unencoded charsets
9600 for posting. Each element of the alist has the form @code{(}@var{test
9601 header body-list}@code{)}, where:
9602
9603 @table @var
9604 @item test
9605 is either a regular expression matching the newsgroup header or a
9606 variable to query,
9607 @item header
9608 is the charset which may be left unencoded in the header (@code{nil}
9609 means encode all charsets),
9610 @item body-list
9611 is a list of charsets which may be encoded using 8bit content-transfer
9612 encoding in the body, or one of the special values @code{nil} (always
9613 encode using quoted-printable) or @code{t} (always use 8bit).
9614 @end table
9615
9616 @cindex Russian
9617 @cindex koi8-r
9618 @cindex koi8-u
9619 @cindex iso-8859-5
9620 @cindex coding system aliases
9621 @cindex preferred charset
9622
9623 @xref{Encoding Customization, , Encoding Customization, emacs-mime,
9624 The Emacs MIME Manual}, for additional variables that control which
9625 MIME charsets are used when sending messages.
9626
9627 Other charset tricks that may be useful, although not Gnus-specific:
9628
9629 If there are several @acronym{MIME} charsets that encode the same Emacs
9630 charset, you can choose what charset to use by saying the following:
9631
9632 @lisp
9633 (put-charset-property 'cyrillic-iso8859-5
9634 'preferred-coding-system 'koi8-r)
9635 @end lisp
9636
9637 This means that Russian will be encoded using @code{koi8-r} instead of
9638 the default @code{iso-8859-5} @acronym{MIME} charset.
9639
9640 If you want to read messages in @code{koi8-u}, you can cheat and say
9641
9642 @lisp
9643 (define-coding-system-alias 'koi8-u 'koi8-r)
9644 @end lisp
9645
9646 This will almost do the right thing.
9647
9648 And finally, to read charsets like @code{windows-1251}, you can say
9649 something like
9650
9651 @lisp
9652 (codepage-setup 1251)
9653 (define-coding-system-alias 'windows-1251 'cp1251)
9654 @end lisp
9655
9656
9657 @node Article Commands
9658 @section Article Commands
9659
9660 @table @kbd
9661
9662 @item A P
9663 @cindex PostScript
9664 @cindex printing
9665 @kindex A P (Summary)
9666 @vindex gnus-ps-print-hook
9667 @findex gnus-summary-print-article
9668 Generate and print a PostScript image of the article buffer
9669 (@code{gnus-summary-print-article}). @code{gnus-ps-print-hook} will
9670 be run just before printing the buffer. An alternative way to print
9671 article is to use Muttprint (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
9672
9673 @end table
9674
9675
9676 @node Summary Sorting
9677 @section Summary Sorting
9678 @cindex summary sorting
9679
9680 You can have the summary buffer sorted in various ways, even though I
9681 can't really see why you'd want that.
9682
9683 @table @kbd
9684
9685 @item C-c C-s C-n
9686 @kindex C-c C-s C-n (Summary)
9687 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-number
9688 Sort by article number (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-number}).
9689
9690 @item C-c C-s C-a
9691 @kindex C-c C-s C-a (Summary)
9692 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-author
9693 Sort by author (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-author}).
9694
9695 @item C-c C-s C-s
9696 @kindex C-c C-s C-s (Summary)
9697 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-subject
9698 Sort by subject (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-subject}).
9699
9700 @item C-c C-s C-d
9701 @kindex C-c C-s C-d (Summary)
9702 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-date
9703 Sort by date (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-date}).
9704
9705 @item C-c C-s C-l
9706 @kindex C-c C-s C-l (Summary)
9707 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-lines
9708 Sort by lines (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-lines}).
9709
9710 @item C-c C-s C-c
9711 @kindex C-c C-s C-c (Summary)
9712 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-chars
9713 Sort by article length (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-chars}).
9714
9715 @item C-c C-s C-i
9716 @kindex C-c C-s C-i (Summary)
9717 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-score
9718 Sort by score (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-score}).
9719
9720 @item C-c C-s C-r
9721 @kindex C-c C-s C-r (Summary)
9722 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-random
9723 Randomize (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-random}).
9724
9725 @item C-c C-s C-o
9726 @kindex C-c C-s C-o (Summary)
9727 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-original
9728 Sort using the default sorting method
9729 (@code{gnus-summary-sort-by-original}).
9730 @end table
9731
9732 These functions will work both when you use threading and when you don't
9733 use threading. In the latter case, all summary lines will be sorted,
9734 line by line. In the former case, sorting will be done on a
9735 root-by-root basis, which might not be what you were looking for. To
9736 toggle whether to use threading, type @kbd{T T} (@pxref{Thread
9737 Commands}).
9738
9739
9740 @node Finding the Parent
9741 @section Finding the Parent
9742 @cindex parent articles
9743 @cindex referring articles
9744
9745 @table @kbd
9746 @item ^
9747 @kindex ^ (Summary)
9748 @findex gnus-summary-refer-parent-article
9749 If you'd like to read the parent of the current article, and it is not
9750 displayed in the summary buffer, you might still be able to. That is,
9751 if the current group is fetched by @acronym{NNTP}, the parent hasn't expired
9752 and the @code{References} in the current article are not mangled, you
9753 can just press @kbd{^} or @kbd{A r}
9754 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-parent-article}). If everything goes well,
9755 you'll get the parent. If the parent is already displayed in the
9756 summary buffer, point will just move to this article.
9757
9758 If given a positive numerical prefix, fetch that many articles back into
9759 the ancestry. If given a negative numerical prefix, fetch just that
9760 ancestor. So if you say @kbd{3 ^}, Gnus will fetch the parent, the
9761 grandparent and the grandgrandparent of the current article. If you say
9762 @kbd{-3 ^}, Gnus will only fetch the grandgrandparent of the current
9763 article.
9764
9765 @item A R (Summary)
9766 @findex gnus-summary-refer-references
9767 @kindex A R (Summary)
9768 Fetch all articles mentioned in the @code{References} header of the
9769 article (@code{gnus-summary-refer-references}).
9770
9771 @item A T (Summary)
9772 @findex gnus-summary-refer-thread
9773 @kindex A T (Summary)
9774 Display the full thread where the current article appears
9775 (@code{gnus-summary-refer-thread}). This command has to fetch all the
9776 headers in the current group to work, so it usually takes a while. If
9777 you do it often, you may consider setting @code{gnus-fetch-old-headers}
9778 to @code{invisible} (@pxref{Filling In Threads}). This won't have any
9779 visible effects normally, but it'll make this command work a whole lot
9780 faster. Of course, it'll make group entry somewhat slow.
9781
9782 @vindex gnus-refer-thread-limit
9783 The @code{gnus-refer-thread-limit} variable says how many old (i. e.,
9784 articles before the first displayed in the current group) headers to
9785 fetch when doing this command. The default is 200. If @code{t}, all
9786 the available headers will be fetched. This variable can be overridden
9787 by giving the @kbd{A T} command a numerical prefix.
9788
9789 @item M-^ (Summary)
9790 @findex gnus-summary-refer-article
9791 @kindex M-^ (Summary)
9792 @cindex Message-ID
9793 @cindex fetching by Message-ID
9794 You can also ask Gnus for an arbitrary article, no matter what group it
9795 belongs to. @kbd{M-^} (@code{gnus-summary-refer-article}) will ask you
9796 for a @code{Message-ID}, which is one of those long, hard-to-read
9797 thingies that look something like @samp{<38o6up$6f2@@hymir.ifi.uio.no>}.
9798 You have to get it all exactly right. No fuzzy searches, I'm afraid.
9799
9800 Gnus looks for the @code{Message-ID} in the headers that have already
9801 been fetched, but also tries all the select methods specified by
9802 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} if it is not found.
9803 @end table
9804
9805 @vindex gnus-refer-article-method
9806 If the group you are reading is located on a back end that does not
9807 support fetching by @code{Message-ID} very well (like @code{nnspool}),
9808 you can set @code{gnus-refer-article-method} to an @acronym{NNTP} method. It
9809 would, perhaps, be best if the @acronym{NNTP} server you consult is the one
9810 updating the spool you are reading from, but that's not really
9811 necessary.
9812
9813 It can also be a list of select methods, as well as the special symbol
9814 @code{current}, which means to use the current select method. If it
9815 is a list, Gnus will try all the methods in the list until it finds a
9816 match.
9817
9818 Here's an example setting that will first try the current method, and
9819 then ask Google if that fails:
9820
9821 @lisp
9822 (setq gnus-refer-article-method
9823 '(current
9824 (nnweb "google" (nnweb-type google))))
9825 @end lisp
9826
9827 Most of the mail back ends support fetching by @code{Message-ID}, but
9828 do not do a particularly excellent job at it. That is, @code{nnmbox},
9829 @code{nnbabyl}, @code{nnmaildir}, @code{nnml}, are able to locate
9830 articles from any groups, while @code{nnfolder}, and @code{nnimap} are
9831 only able to locate articles that have been posted to the current
9832 group. (Anything else would be too time consuming.) @code{nnmh} does
9833 not support this at all.
9834
9835
9836 @node Alternative Approaches
9837 @section Alternative Approaches
9838
9839 Different people like to read news using different methods. This being
9840 Gnus, we offer a small selection of minor modes for the summary buffers.
9841
9842 @menu
9843 * Pick and Read:: First mark articles and then read them.
9844 * Binary Groups:: Auto-decode all articles.
9845 @end menu
9846
9847
9848 @node Pick and Read
9849 @subsection Pick and Read
9850 @cindex pick and read
9851
9852 Some newsreaders (like @code{nn} and, uhm, @code{Netnews} on VM/CMS) use
9853 a two-phased reading interface. The user first marks in a summary
9854 buffer the articles she wants to read. Then she starts reading the
9855 articles with just an article buffer displayed.
9856
9857 @findex gnus-pick-mode
9858 @kindex M-x gnus-pick-mode
9859 Gnus provides a summary buffer minor mode that allows
9860 this---@code{gnus-pick-mode}. This basically means that a few process
9861 mark commands become one-keystroke commands to allow easy marking, and
9862 it provides one additional command for switching to the summary buffer.
9863
9864 Here are the available keystrokes when using pick mode:
9865
9866 @table @kbd
9867 @item .
9868 @kindex . (Pick)
9869 @findex gnus-pick-article-or-thread
9870 Pick the article or thread on the current line
9871 (@code{gnus-pick-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9872 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key selects the
9873 entire thread when used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise,
9874 it selects just the article. If given a numerical prefix, go to that
9875 thread or article and pick it. (The line number is normally displayed
9876 at the beginning of the summary pick lines.)
9877
9878 @item SPACE
9879 @kindex SPACE (Pick)
9880 @findex gnus-pick-next-page
9881 Scroll the summary buffer up one page (@code{gnus-pick-next-page}). If
9882 at the end of the buffer, start reading the picked articles.
9883
9884 @item u
9885 @kindex u (Pick)
9886 @findex gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread.
9887 Unpick the thread or article
9888 (@code{gnus-pick-unmark-article-or-thread}). If the variable
9889 @code{gnus-thread-hide-subtree} is true, then this key unpicks the
9890 thread if used at the first article of the thread. Otherwise it unpicks
9891 just the article. You can give this key a numerical prefix to unpick
9892 the thread or article at that line.
9893
9894 @item RET
9895 @kindex RET (Pick)
9896 @findex gnus-pick-start-reading
9897 @vindex gnus-pick-display-summary
9898 Start reading the picked articles (@code{gnus-pick-start-reading}). If
9899 given a prefix, mark all unpicked articles as read first. If
9900 @code{gnus-pick-display-summary} is non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer
9901 will still be visible when you are reading.
9902
9903 @end table
9904
9905 All the normal summary mode commands are still available in the
9906 pick-mode, with the exception of @kbd{u}. However @kbd{!} is available
9907 which is mapped to the same function
9908 @code{gnus-summary-tick-article-forward}.
9909
9910 If this sounds like a good idea to you, you could say:
9911
9912 @lisp
9913 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
9914 @end lisp
9915
9916 @vindex gnus-pick-mode-hook
9917 @code{gnus-pick-mode-hook} is run in pick minor mode buffers.
9918
9919 @vindex gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read
9920 If @code{gnus-mark-unpicked-articles-as-read} is non-@code{nil}, mark
9921 all unpicked articles as read. The default is @code{nil}.
9922
9923 @vindex gnus-summary-pick-line-format
9924 The summary line format in pick mode is slightly different from the
9925 standard format. At the beginning of each line the line number is
9926 displayed. The pick mode line format is controlled by the
9927 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format} variable (@pxref{Formatting
9928 Variables}). It accepts the same format specs that
9929 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} does (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}).
9930
9931
9932 @node Binary Groups
9933 @subsection Binary Groups
9934 @cindex binary groups
9935
9936 @findex gnus-binary-mode
9937 @kindex M-x gnus-binary-mode
9938 If you spend much time in binary groups, you may grow tired of hitting
9939 @kbd{X u}, @kbd{n}, @kbd{RET} all the time. @kbd{M-x gnus-binary-mode}
9940 is a minor mode for summary buffers that makes all ordinary Gnus article
9941 selection functions uudecode series of articles and display the result
9942 instead of just displaying the articles the normal way.
9943
9944 @kindex g (Binary)
9945 @findex gnus-binary-show-article
9946 The only way, in fact, to see the actual articles is the @kbd{g}
9947 command, when you have turned on this mode
9948 (@code{gnus-binary-show-article}).
9949
9950 @vindex gnus-binary-mode-hook
9951 @code{gnus-binary-mode-hook} is called in binary minor mode buffers.
9952
9953
9954 @node Tree Display
9955 @section Tree Display
9956 @cindex trees
9957
9958 @vindex gnus-use-trees
9959 If you don't like the normal Gnus summary display, you might try setting
9960 @code{gnus-use-trees} to @code{t}. This will create (by default) an
9961 additional @dfn{tree buffer}. You can execute all summary mode commands
9962 in the tree buffer.
9963
9964 There are a few variables to customize the tree display, of course:
9965
9966 @table @code
9967 @item gnus-tree-mode-hook
9968 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-hook
9969 A hook called in all tree mode buffers.
9970
9971 @item gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9972 @vindex gnus-tree-mode-line-format
9973 A format string for the mode bar in the tree mode buffers (@pxref{Mode
9974 Line Formatting}). The default is @samp{Gnus: %%b %S %Z}. For a list
9975 of valid specs, @pxref{Summary Buffer Mode Line}.
9976
9977 @item gnus-selected-tree-face
9978 @vindex gnus-selected-tree-face
9979 Face used for highlighting the selected article in the tree buffer. The
9980 default is @code{modeline}.
9981
9982 @item gnus-tree-line-format
9983 @vindex gnus-tree-line-format
9984 A format string for the tree nodes. The name is a bit of a misnomer,
9985 though---it doesn't define a line, but just the node. The default value
9986 is @samp{%(%[%3,3n%]%)}, which displays the first three characters of
9987 the name of the poster. It is vital that all nodes are of the same
9988 length, so you @emph{must} use @samp{%4,4n}-like specifiers.
9989
9990 Valid specs are:
9991
9992 @table @samp
9993 @item n
9994 The name of the poster.
9995 @item f
9996 The @code{From} header.
9997 @item N
9998 The number of the article.
9999 @item [
10000 The opening bracket.
10001 @item ]
10002 The closing bracket.
10003 @item s
10004 The subject.
10005 @end table
10006
10007 @xref{Formatting Variables}.
10008
10009 Variables related to the display are:
10010
10011 @table @code
10012 @item gnus-tree-brackets
10013 @vindex gnus-tree-brackets
10014 This is used for differentiating between ``real'' articles and
10015 ``sparse'' articles. The format is
10016 @example
10017 ((@var{real-open} . @var{real-close})
10018 (@var{sparse-open} . @var{sparse-close})
10019 (@var{dummy-open} . @var{dummy-close}))
10020 @end example
10021 and the default is @code{((?[ . ?]) (?( . ?)) (?@{ . ?@}) (?< . ?>))}.
10022
10023 @item gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10024 @vindex gnus-tree-parent-child-edges
10025 This is a list that contains the characters used for connecting parent
10026 nodes to their children. The default is @code{(?- ?\\ ?|)}.
10027
10028 @end table
10029
10030 @item gnus-tree-minimize-window
10031 @vindex gnus-tree-minimize-window
10032 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will try to keep the tree
10033 buffer as small as possible to allow more room for the other Gnus
10034 windows. If this variable is a number, the tree buffer will never be
10035 higher than that number. The default is @code{t}. Note that if you
10036 have several windows displayed side-by-side in a frame and the tree
10037 buffer is one of these, minimizing the tree window will also resize all
10038 other windows displayed next to it.
10039
10040 You may also wish to add the following hook to keep the window minimized
10041 at all times:
10042
10043 @lisp
10044 (add-hook 'gnus-configure-windows-hook
10045 'gnus-tree-perhaps-minimize)
10046 @end lisp
10047
10048 @item gnus-generate-tree-function
10049 @vindex gnus-generate-tree-function
10050 @findex gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10051 @findex gnus-generate-vertical-tree
10052 The function that actually generates the thread tree. Two predefined
10053 functions are available: @code{gnus-generate-horizontal-tree} and
10054 @code{gnus-generate-vertical-tree} (which is the default).
10055
10056 @end table
10057
10058 Here's an example from a horizontal tree buffer:
10059
10060 @example
10061 @{***@}-(***)-[odd]-[Gun]
10062 | \[Jan]
10063 | \[odd]-[Eri]
10064 | \(***)-[Eri]
10065 | \[odd]-[Paa]
10066 \[Bjo]
10067 \[Gun]
10068 \[Gun]-[Jor]
10069 @end example
10070
10071 Here's the same thread displayed in a vertical tree buffer:
10072
10073 @example
10074 @group
10075 @{***@}
10076 |--------------------------\-----\-----\
10077 (***) [Bjo] [Gun] [Gun]
10078 |--\-----\-----\ |
10079 [odd] [Jan] [odd] (***) [Jor]
10080 | | |--\
10081 [Gun] [Eri] [Eri] [odd]
10082 |
10083 [Paa]
10084 @end group
10085 @end example
10086
10087 If you're using horizontal trees, it might be nice to display the trees
10088 side-by-side with the summary buffer. You could add something like the
10089 following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
10090
10091 @lisp
10092 (setq gnus-use-trees t
10093 gnus-generate-tree-function 'gnus-generate-horizontal-tree
10094 gnus-tree-minimize-window nil)
10095 (gnus-add-configuration
10096 '(article
10097 (vertical 1.0
10098 (horizontal 0.25
10099 (summary 0.75 point)
10100 (tree 1.0))
10101 (article 1.0))))
10102 @end lisp
10103
10104 @xref{Window Layout}.
10105
10106
10107 @node Mail Group Commands
10108 @section Mail Group Commands
10109 @cindex mail group commands
10110
10111 Some commands only make sense in mail groups. If these commands are
10112 invalid in the current group, they will raise a hell and let you know.
10113
10114 All these commands (except the expiry and edit commands) use the
10115 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10116
10117 @table @kbd
10118
10119 @item B e
10120 @kindex B e (Summary)
10121 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles
10122 @cindex expiring mail
10123 Run all expirable articles in the current group through the expiry
10124 process (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles}). That is, delete all
10125 expirable articles in the group that have been around for a while.
10126 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
10127
10128 @item B C-M-e
10129 @kindex B C-M-e (Summary)
10130 @findex gnus-summary-expire-articles-now
10131 @cindex expiring mail
10132 Delete all the expirable articles in the group
10133 (@code{gnus-summary-expire-articles-now}). This means that @strong{all}
10134 articles eligible for expiry in the current group will
10135 disappear forever into that big @file{/dev/null} in the sky.
10136
10137 @item B DEL
10138 @kindex B DEL (Summary)
10139 @findex gnus-summary-delete-article
10140 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-delete}
10141 Delete the mail article. This is ``delete'' as in ``delete it from your
10142 disk forever and ever, never to return again.'' Use with caution.
10143 (@code{gnus-summary-delete-article}).
10144
10145 @item B m
10146 @kindex B m (Summary)
10147 @cindex move mail
10148 @findex gnus-summary-move-article
10149 @vindex gnus-preserve-marks
10150 Move the article from one mail group to another
10151 (@code{gnus-summary-move-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10152 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10153
10154 @item B c
10155 @kindex B c (Summary)
10156 @cindex copy mail
10157 @findex gnus-summary-copy-article
10158 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-copy}
10159 Copy the article from one group (mail group or not) to a mail group
10160 (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}). Marks will be preserved if
10161 @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil} (which is the default).
10162
10163 @item B B
10164 @kindex B B (Summary)
10165 @cindex crosspost mail
10166 @findex gnus-summary-crosspost-article
10167 Crosspost the current article to some other group
10168 (@code{gnus-summary-crosspost-article}). This will create a new copy of
10169 the article in the other group, and the Xref headers of the article will
10170 be properly updated.
10171
10172 @item B i
10173 @kindex B i (Summary)
10174 @findex gnus-summary-import-article
10175 Import an arbitrary file into the current mail newsgroup
10176 (@code{gnus-summary-import-article}). You will be prompted for a file
10177 name, a @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10178
10179 @item B I
10180 @kindex B I (Summary)
10181 @findex gnus-summary-create-article
10182 Create an empty article in the current mail newsgroups
10183 (@code{gnus-summary-create-article}). You will be prompted for a
10184 @code{From} header and a @code{Subject} header.
10185
10186 @item B r
10187 @kindex B r (Summary)
10188 @findex gnus-summary-respool-article
10189 @vindex gnus-summary-respool-default-method
10190 Respool the mail article (@code{gnus-summary-respool-article}).
10191 @code{gnus-summary-respool-default-method} will be used as the default
10192 select method when respooling. This variable is @code{nil} by default,
10193 which means that the current group select method will be used instead.
10194 Marks will be preserved if @code{gnus-preserve-marks} is non-@code{nil}
10195 (which is the default).
10196
10197 @item B w
10198 @itemx e
10199 @kindex B w (Summary)
10200 @kindex e (Summary)
10201 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article
10202 @kindex C-c C-c (Article)
10203 @findex gnus-summary-edit-article-done
10204 Edit the current article (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article}). To finish
10205 editing and make the changes permanent, type @kbd{C-c C-c}
10206 (@code{gnus-summary-edit-article-done}). If you give a prefix to the
10207 @kbd{C-c C-c} command, Gnus won't re-highlight the article.
10208
10209 @item B q
10210 @kindex B q (Summary)
10211 @findex gnus-summary-respool-query
10212 If you want to re-spool an article, you might be curious as to what group
10213 the article will end up in before you do the re-spooling. This command
10214 will tell you (@code{gnus-summary-respool-query}).
10215
10216 @item B t
10217 @kindex B t (Summary)
10218 @findex gnus-summary-respool-trace
10219 Similarly, this command will display all fancy splitting patterns used
10220 when respooling, if any (@code{gnus-summary-respool-trace}).
10221
10222 @item B p
10223 @kindex B p (Summary)
10224 @findex gnus-summary-article-posted-p
10225 Some people have a tendency to send you ``courtesy'' copies when they
10226 follow up to articles you have posted. These usually have a
10227 @code{Newsgroups} header in them, but not always. This command
10228 (@code{gnus-summary-article-posted-p}) will try to fetch the current
10229 article from your news server (or rather, from
10230 @code{gnus-refer-article-method} or @code{gnus-select-method}) and will
10231 report back whether it found the article or not. Even if it says that
10232 it didn't find the article, it may have been posted anyway---mail
10233 propagation is much faster than news propagation, and the news copy may
10234 just not have arrived yet.
10235
10236 @item K E
10237 @kindex K E (Summary)
10238 @findex gnus-article-encrypt-body
10239 @vindex gnus-article-encrypt-protocol
10240 Encrypt the body of an article (@code{gnus-article-encrypt-body}).
10241 The body is encrypted with the encryption protocol specified by the
10242 variable @code{gnus-article-encrypt-protocol}.
10243
10244 @end table
10245
10246 @vindex gnus-move-split-methods
10247 @cindex moving articles
10248 If you move (or copy) articles regularly, you might wish to have Gnus
10249 suggest where to put the articles. @code{gnus-move-split-methods} is a
10250 variable that uses the same syntax as @code{gnus-split-methods}
10251 (@pxref{Saving Articles}). You may customize that variable to create
10252 suggestions you find reasonable. (Note that
10253 @code{gnus-move-split-methods} uses group names where
10254 @code{gnus-split-methods} uses file names.)
10255
10256 @lisp
10257 (setq gnus-move-split-methods
10258 '(("^From:.*Lars Magne" "nnml:junk")
10259 ("^Subject:.*gnus" "nnfolder:important")
10260 (".*" "nnml:misc")))
10261 @end lisp
10262
10263
10264 @node Various Summary Stuff
10265 @section Various Summary Stuff
10266
10267 @menu
10268 * Summary Group Information:: Information oriented commands.
10269 * Searching for Articles:: Multiple article commands.
10270 * Summary Generation Commands::
10271 * Really Various Summary Commands:: Those pesky non-conformant commands.
10272 @end menu
10273
10274 @table @code
10275 @vindex gnus-summary-display-while-building
10276 @item gnus-summary-display-while-building
10277 If non-@code{nil}, show and update the summary buffer as it's being
10278 built. If @code{t}, update the buffer after every line is inserted.
10279 If the value is an integer, @var{n}, update the display every @var{n}
10280 lines. The default is @code{nil}.
10281
10282 @vindex gnus-summary-display-arrow
10283 @item gnus-summary-display-arrow
10284 If non-@code{nil}, display an arrow in the fringe to indicate the
10285 current article.
10286
10287 @vindex gnus-summary-mode-hook
10288 @item gnus-summary-mode-hook
10289 This hook is called when creating a summary mode buffer.
10290
10291 @vindex gnus-summary-generate-hook
10292 @item gnus-summary-generate-hook
10293 This is called as the last thing before doing the threading and the
10294 generation of the summary buffer. It's quite convenient for customizing
10295 the threading variables based on what data the newsgroup has. This hook
10296 is called from the summary buffer after most summary buffer variables
10297 have been set.
10298
10299 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10300 @item gnus-summary-prepare-hook
10301 It is called after the summary buffer has been generated. You might use
10302 it to, for instance, highlight lines or modify the look of the buffer in
10303 some other ungodly manner. I don't care.
10304
10305 @vindex gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10306 @item gnus-summary-prepared-hook
10307 A hook called as the very last thing after the summary buffer has been
10308 generated.
10309
10310 @vindex gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10311 @item gnus-summary-ignore-duplicates
10312 When Gnus discovers two articles that have the same @code{Message-ID},
10313 it has to do something drastic. No articles are allowed to have the
10314 same @code{Message-ID}, but this may happen when reading mail from some
10315 sources. Gnus allows you to customize what happens with this variable.
10316 If it is @code{nil} (which is the default), Gnus will rename the
10317 @code{Message-ID} (for display purposes only) and display the article as
10318 any other article. If this variable is @code{t}, it won't display the
10319 article---it'll be as if it never existed.
10320
10321 @vindex gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10322 @item gnus-alter-articles-to-read-function
10323 This function, which takes two parameters (the group name and the list
10324 of articles to be selected), is called to allow the user to alter the
10325 list of articles to be selected.
10326
10327 For instance, the following function adds the list of cached articles to
10328 the list in one particular group:
10329
10330 @lisp
10331 (defun my-add-cached-articles (group articles)
10332 (if (string= group "some.group")
10333 (append gnus-newsgroup-cached articles)
10334 articles))
10335 @end lisp
10336
10337 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-variables
10338 @item gnus-newsgroup-variables
10339 A list of newsgroup (summary buffer) local variables, or cons of
10340 variables and their default expressions to be evalled (when the default
10341 values are not @code{nil}), that should be made global while the summary
10342 buffer is active.
10343
10344 Note: The default expressions will be evaluated (using function
10345 @code{eval}) before assignment to the local variable rather than just
10346 assigned to it. If the default expression is the symbol @code{global},
10347 that symbol will not be evaluated but the global value of the local
10348 variable will be used instead.
10349
10350 These variables can be used to set variables in the group parameters
10351 while still allowing them to affect operations done in other
10352 buffers. For example:
10353
10354 @lisp
10355 (setq gnus-newsgroup-variables
10356 '(message-use-followup-to
10357 (gnus-visible-headers .
10358 "^From:\\|^Newsgroups:\\|^Subject:\\|^Date:\\|^To:")))
10359 @end lisp
10360
10361 Also @pxref{Group Parameters}.
10362 @end table
10363
10364
10365 @node Summary Group Information
10366 @subsection Summary Group Information
10367
10368 @table @kbd
10369
10370 @item H f
10371 @kindex H f (Summary)
10372 @findex gnus-summary-fetch-faq
10373 @vindex gnus-group-faq-directory
10374 Try to fetch the @acronym{FAQ} (list of frequently asked questions)
10375 for the current group (@code{gnus-summary-fetch-faq}). Gnus will try
10376 to get the @acronym{FAQ} from @code{gnus-group-faq-directory}, which
10377 is usually a directory on a remote machine. This variable can also be
10378 a list of directories. In that case, giving a prefix to this command
10379 will allow you to choose between the various sites. @code{ange-ftp}
10380 or @code{efs} will probably be used for fetching the file.
10381
10382 @item H d
10383 @kindex H d (Summary)
10384 @findex gnus-summary-describe-group
10385 Give a brief description of the current group
10386 (@code{gnus-summary-describe-group}). If given a prefix, force
10387 rereading the description from the server.
10388
10389 @item H h
10390 @kindex H h (Summary)
10391 @findex gnus-summary-describe-briefly
10392 Give an extremely brief description of the most important summary
10393 keystrokes (@code{gnus-summary-describe-briefly}).
10394
10395 @item H i
10396 @kindex H i (Summary)
10397 @findex gnus-info-find-node
10398 Go to the Gnus info node (@code{gnus-info-find-node}).
10399 @end table
10400
10401
10402 @node Searching for Articles
10403 @subsection Searching for Articles
10404
10405 @table @kbd
10406
10407 @item M-s
10408 @kindex M-s (Summary)
10409 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-forward
10410 Search through all subsequent (raw) articles for a regexp
10411 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-forward}).
10412
10413 @item M-r
10414 @kindex M-r (Summary)
10415 @findex gnus-summary-search-article-backward
10416 Search through all previous (raw) articles for a regexp
10417 (@code{gnus-summary-search-article-backward}).
10418
10419 @item &
10420 @kindex & (Summary)
10421 @findex gnus-summary-execute-command
10422 This command will prompt you for a header, a regular expression to match
10423 on this field, and a command to be executed if the match is made
10424 (@code{gnus-summary-execute-command}). If the header is an empty
10425 string, the match is done on the entire article. If given a prefix,
10426 search backward instead.
10427
10428 For instance, @kbd{& RET some.*string RET #} will put the process mark on
10429 all articles that have heads or bodies that match @samp{some.*string}.
10430
10431 @item M-&
10432 @kindex M-& (Summary)
10433 @findex gnus-summary-universal-argument
10434 Perform any operation on all articles that have been marked with
10435 the process mark (@code{gnus-summary-universal-argument}).
10436 @end table
10437
10438 @node Summary Generation Commands
10439 @subsection Summary Generation Commands
10440
10441 @table @kbd
10442
10443 @item Y g
10444 @kindex Y g (Summary)
10445 @findex gnus-summary-prepare
10446 Regenerate the current summary buffer (@code{gnus-summary-prepare}).
10447
10448 @item Y c
10449 @kindex Y c (Summary)
10450 @findex gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles
10451 Pull all cached articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10452 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}).
10453
10454 @item Y d
10455 @kindex Y d (Summary)
10456 @findex gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles
10457 Pull all dormant articles (for the current group) into the summary buffer
10458 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-dormant-articles}).
10459
10460 @end table
10461
10462
10463 @node Really Various Summary Commands
10464 @subsection Really Various Summary Commands
10465
10466 @table @kbd
10467
10468 @item A D
10469 @itemx C-d
10470 @kindex C-d (Summary)
10471 @kindex A D (Summary)
10472 @findex gnus-summary-enter-digest-group
10473 If the current article is a collection of other articles (for instance,
10474 a digest), you might use this command to enter a group based on the that
10475 article (@code{gnus-summary-enter-digest-group}). Gnus will try to
10476 guess what article type is currently displayed unless you give a prefix
10477 to this command, which forces a ``digest'' interpretation. Basically,
10478 whenever you see a message that is a collection of other messages of
10479 some format, you @kbd{C-d} and read these messages in a more convenient
10480 fashion.
10481
10482 @item C-M-d
10483 @kindex C-M-d (Summary)
10484 @findex gnus-summary-read-document
10485 This command is very similar to the one above, but lets you gather
10486 several documents into one biiig group
10487 (@code{gnus-summary-read-document}). It does this by opening several
10488 @code{nndoc} groups for each document, and then opening an
10489 @code{nnvirtual} group on top of these @code{nndoc} groups. This
10490 command understands the process/prefix convention
10491 (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
10492
10493 @item C-t
10494 @kindex C-t (Summary)
10495 @findex gnus-summary-toggle-truncation
10496 Toggle truncation of summary lines
10497 (@code{gnus-summary-toggle-truncation}). This will probably confuse the
10498 line centering function in the summary buffer, so it's not a good idea
10499 to have truncation switched off while reading articles.
10500
10501 @item =
10502 @kindex = (Summary)
10503 @findex gnus-summary-expand-window
10504 Expand the summary buffer window (@code{gnus-summary-expand-window}).
10505 If given a prefix, force an @code{article} window configuration.
10506
10507 @item C-M-e
10508 @kindex C-M-e (Summary)
10509 @findex gnus-summary-edit-parameters
10510 Edit the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10511 group (@code{gnus-summary-edit-parameters}).
10512
10513 @item C-M-a
10514 @kindex C-M-a (Summary)
10515 @findex gnus-summary-customize-parameters
10516 Customize the group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) of the current
10517 group (@code{gnus-summary-customize-parameters}).
10518
10519 @end table
10520
10521
10522 @node Exiting the Summary Buffer
10523 @section Exiting the Summary Buffer
10524 @cindex summary exit
10525 @cindex exiting groups
10526
10527 Exiting from the summary buffer will normally update all info on the
10528 group and return you to the group buffer.
10529
10530 @table @kbd
10531
10532 @item Z Z
10533 @itemx Z Q
10534 @itemx q
10535 @kindex Z Z (Summary)
10536 @kindex Z Q (Summary)
10537 @kindex q (Summary)
10538 @findex gnus-summary-exit
10539 @vindex gnus-summary-exit-hook
10540 @vindex gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook
10541 @vindex gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook
10542 @c @icon{gnus-summary-exit}
10543 Exit the current group and update all information on the group
10544 (@code{gnus-summary-exit}). @code{gnus-summary-prepare-exit-hook} is
10545 called before doing much of the exiting, which calls
10546 @code{gnus-summary-expire-articles} by default.
10547 @code{gnus-summary-exit-hook} is called after finishing the exit
10548 process. @code{gnus-group-no-more-groups-hook} is run when returning to
10549 group mode having no more (unread) groups.
10550
10551 @item Z E
10552 @itemx Q
10553 @kindex Z E (Summary)
10554 @kindex Q (Summary)
10555 @findex gnus-summary-exit-no-update
10556 Exit the current group without updating any information on the group
10557 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}).
10558
10559 @item Z c
10560 @itemx c
10561 @kindex Z c (Summary)
10562 @kindex c (Summary)
10563 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit
10564 @c @icon{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}
10565 Mark all unticked articles in the group as read and then exit
10566 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-exit}).
10567
10568 @item Z C
10569 @kindex Z C (Summary)
10570 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit
10571 Mark all articles, even the ticked ones, as read and then exit
10572 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-all-and-exit}).
10573
10574 @item Z n
10575 @kindex Z n (Summary)
10576 @findex gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group
10577 Mark all articles as read and go to the next group
10578 (@code{gnus-summary-catchup-and-goto-next-group}).
10579
10580 @item Z R
10581 @itemx C-x C-s
10582 @kindex Z R (Summary)
10583 @kindex C-x C-s (Summary)
10584 @findex gnus-summary-reselect-current-group
10585 Exit this group, and then enter it again
10586 (@code{gnus-summary-reselect-current-group}). If given a prefix, select
10587 all articles, both read and unread.
10588
10589 @item Z G
10590 @itemx M-g
10591 @kindex Z G (Summary)
10592 @kindex M-g (Summary)
10593 @findex gnus-summary-rescan-group
10594 @c @icon{gnus-summary-mail-get}
10595 Exit the group, check for new articles in the group, and select the
10596 group (@code{gnus-summary-rescan-group}). If given a prefix, select all
10597 articles, both read and unread.
10598
10599 @item Z N
10600 @kindex Z N (Summary)
10601 @findex gnus-summary-next-group
10602 Exit the group and go to the next group
10603 (@code{gnus-summary-next-group}).
10604
10605 @item Z P
10606 @kindex Z P (Summary)
10607 @findex gnus-summary-prev-group
10608 Exit the group and go to the previous group
10609 (@code{gnus-summary-prev-group}).
10610
10611 @item Z s
10612 @kindex Z s (Summary)
10613 @findex gnus-summary-save-newsrc
10614 Save the current number of read/marked articles in the dribble buffer
10615 and then save the dribble buffer (@code{gnus-summary-save-newsrc}). If
10616 given a prefix, also save the @file{.newsrc} file(s). Using this
10617 command will make exit without updating (the @kbd{Q} command) worthless.
10618 @end table
10619
10620 @vindex gnus-exit-group-hook
10621 @code{gnus-exit-group-hook} is called when you exit the current group
10622 with an ``updating'' exit. For instance @kbd{Q}
10623 (@code{gnus-summary-exit-no-update}) does not call this hook.
10624
10625 @findex gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead
10626 @findex gnus-dead-summary-mode
10627 @vindex gnus-kill-summary-on-exit
10628 If you're in the habit of exiting groups, and then changing your mind
10629 about it, you might set @code{gnus-kill-summary-on-exit} to @code{nil}.
10630 If you do that, Gnus won't kill the summary buffer when you exit it.
10631 (Quelle surprise!) Instead it will change the name of the buffer to
10632 something like @samp{*Dead Summary ... *} and install a minor mode
10633 called @code{gnus-dead-summary-mode}. Now, if you switch back to this
10634 buffer, you'll find that all keys are mapped to a function called
10635 @code{gnus-summary-wake-up-the-dead}. So tapping any keys in a dead
10636 summary buffer will result in a live, normal summary buffer.
10637
10638 There will never be more than one dead summary buffer at any one time.
10639
10640 @vindex gnus-use-cross-reference
10641 The data on the current group will be updated (which articles you have
10642 read, which articles you have replied to, etc.) when you exit the
10643 summary buffer. If the @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} variable is
10644 @code{t} (which is the default), articles that are cross-referenced to
10645 this group and are marked as read, will also be marked as read in the
10646 other subscribed groups they were cross-posted to. If this variable is
10647 neither @code{nil} nor @code{t}, the article will be marked as read in
10648 both subscribed and unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}).
10649
10650
10651 @node Crosspost Handling
10652 @section Crosspost Handling
10653
10654 @cindex velveeta
10655 @cindex spamming
10656 Marking cross-posted articles as read ensures that you'll never have to
10657 read the same article more than once. Unless, of course, somebody has
10658 posted it to several groups separately. Posting the same article to
10659 several groups (not cross-posting) is called @dfn{spamming}, and you are
10660 by law required to send nasty-grams to anyone who perpetrates such a
10661 heinous crime. You may want to try NoCeM handling to filter out spam
10662 (@pxref{NoCeM}).
10663
10664 Remember: Cross-posting is kinda ok, but posting the same article
10665 separately to several groups is not. Massive cross-posting (aka.
10666 @dfn{velveeta}) is to be avoided at all costs, and you can even use the
10667 @code{gnus-summary-mail-crosspost-complaint} command to complain about
10668 excessive crossposting (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
10669
10670 @cindex cross-posting
10671 @cindex Xref
10672 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
10673 One thing that may cause Gnus to not do the cross-posting thing
10674 correctly is if you use an @acronym{NNTP} server that supports @sc{xover}
10675 (which is very nice, because it speeds things up considerably) which
10676 does not include the @code{Xref} header in its @acronym{NOV} lines. This is
10677 Evil, but all too common, alas, alack. Gnus tries to Do The Right Thing
10678 even with @sc{xover} by registering the @code{Xref} lines of all
10679 articles you actually read, but if you kill the articles, or just mark
10680 them as read without reading them, Gnus will not get a chance to snoop
10681 the @code{Xref} lines out of these articles, and will be unable to use
10682 the cross reference mechanism.
10683
10684 @cindex LIST overview.fmt
10685 @cindex overview.fmt
10686 To check whether your @acronym{NNTP} server includes the @code{Xref} header
10687 in its overview files, try @samp{telnet your.nntp.server nntp},
10688 @samp{MODE READER} on @code{inn} servers, and then say @samp{LIST
10689 overview.fmt}. This may not work, but if it does, and the last line you
10690 get does not read @samp{Xref:full}, then you should shout and whine at
10691 your news admin until she includes the @code{Xref} header in the
10692 overview files.
10693
10694 If you want Gnus to get the @code{Xref}s right all the time, you have to
10695 set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to @code{t}, which slows things down
10696 considerably. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
10697
10698 C'est la vie.
10699
10700 For an alternative approach, @pxref{Duplicate Suppression}.
10701
10702
10703 @node Duplicate Suppression
10704 @section Duplicate Suppression
10705
10706 By default, Gnus tries to make sure that you don't have to read the same
10707 article more than once by utilizing the crossposting mechanism
10708 (@pxref{Crosspost Handling}). However, that simple and efficient
10709 approach may not work satisfactory for some users for various
10710 reasons.
10711
10712 @enumerate
10713 @item
10714 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to generate the @code{Xref} header. This
10715 is evil and not very common.
10716
10717 @item
10718 The @acronym{NNTP} server may fail to include the @code{Xref} header in the
10719 @file{.overview} data bases. This is evil and all too common, alas.
10720
10721 @item
10722 You may be reading the same group (or several related groups) from
10723 different @acronym{NNTP} servers.
10724
10725 @item
10726 You may be getting mail that duplicates articles posted to groups.
10727 @end enumerate
10728
10729 I'm sure there are other situations where @code{Xref} handling fails as
10730 well, but these four are the most common situations.
10731
10732 If, and only if, @code{Xref} handling fails for you, then you may
10733 consider switching on @dfn{duplicate suppression}. If you do so, Gnus
10734 will remember the @code{Message-ID}s of all articles you have read or
10735 otherwise marked as read, and then, as if by magic, mark them as read
10736 all subsequent times you see them---in @emph{all} groups. Using this
10737 mechanism is quite likely to be somewhat inefficient, but not overly
10738 so. It's certainly preferable to reading the same articles more than
10739 once.
10740
10741 Duplicate suppression is not a very subtle instrument. It's more like a
10742 sledge hammer than anything else. It works in a very simple
10743 fashion---if you have marked an article as read, it adds this Message-ID
10744 to a cache. The next time it sees this Message-ID, it will mark the
10745 article as read with the @samp{M} mark. It doesn't care what group it
10746 saw the article in.
10747
10748 @table @code
10749 @item gnus-suppress-duplicates
10750 @vindex gnus-suppress-duplicates
10751 If non-@code{nil}, suppress duplicates.
10752
10753 @item gnus-save-duplicate-list
10754 @vindex gnus-save-duplicate-list
10755 If non-@code{nil}, save the list of duplicates to a file. This will
10756 make startup and shutdown take longer, so the default is @code{nil}.
10757 However, this means that only duplicate articles read in a single Gnus
10758 session are suppressed.
10759
10760 @item gnus-duplicate-list-length
10761 @vindex gnus-duplicate-list-length
10762 This variable says how many @code{Message-ID}s to keep in the duplicate
10763 suppression list. The default is 10000.
10764
10765 @item gnus-duplicate-file
10766 @vindex gnus-duplicate-file
10767 The name of the file to store the duplicate suppression list in. The
10768 default is @file{~/News/suppression}.
10769 @end table
10770
10771 If you have a tendency to stop and start Gnus often, setting
10772 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{t} is probably a good idea. If
10773 you leave Gnus running for weeks on end, you may have it @code{nil}. On
10774 the other hand, saving the list makes startup and shutdown much slower,
10775 so that means that if you stop and start Gnus often, you should set
10776 @code{gnus-save-duplicate-list} to @code{nil}. Uhm. I'll leave this up
10777 to you to figure out, I think.
10778
10779 @node Security
10780 @section Security
10781
10782 Gnus is able to verify signed messages or decrypt encrypted messages.
10783 The formats that are supported are @acronym{PGP}, @acronym{PGP/MIME}
10784 and @acronym{S/MIME}, however you need some external programs to get
10785 things to work:
10786
10787 @enumerate
10788 @item
10789 To handle @acronym{PGP} and @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages, you have to
10790 install an OpenPGP implementation such as GnuPG. The Lisp interface
10791 to GnuPG included with Gnus is called PGG (@pxref{Top, ,PGG, pgg, PGG
10792 Manual}), but Mailcrypt and gpg.el are also supported.
10793
10794 @item
10795 To handle @acronym{S/MIME} message, you need to install OpenSSL. OpenSSL 0.9.6
10796 or newer is recommended.
10797
10798 @end enumerate
10799
10800 The variables that control security functionality on reading messages
10801 include:
10802
10803 @table @code
10804 @item mm-verify-option
10805 @vindex mm-verify-option
10806 Option of verifying signed parts. @code{never}, not verify;
10807 @code{always}, always verify; @code{known}, only verify known
10808 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10809
10810 @item mm-decrypt-option
10811 @vindex mm-decrypt-option
10812 Option of decrypting encrypted parts. @code{never}, no decryption;
10813 @code{always}, always decrypt; @code{known}, only decrypt known
10814 protocols. Otherwise, ask user.
10815
10816 @item mml1991-use
10817 @vindex mml1991-use
10818 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10819 @acronym{PGP} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10820 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10821 deprecated.
10822
10823 @item mml2015-use
10824 @vindex mml2015-use
10825 Symbol indicating elisp interface to OpenPGP implementation for
10826 @acronym{PGP/MIME} messages. The default is @code{pgg}, but
10827 @code{mailcrypt} and @code{gpg} are also supported although
10828 deprecated.
10829
10830 @end table
10831
10832 By default the buttons that display security information are not
10833 shown, because they clutter reading the actual e-mail. You can type
10834 @kbd{K b} manually to display the information. Use the
10835 @code{gnus-buttonized-mime-types} and
10836 @code{gnus-unbuttonized-mime-types} variables to control this
10837 permanently. @ref{MIME Commands} for further details, and hints on
10838 how to customize these variables to always display security
10839 information.
10840
10841 @cindex snarfing keys
10842 @cindex importing PGP keys
10843 @cindex PGP key ring import
10844 Snarfing OpenPGP keys (i.e., importing keys from articles into your
10845 key ring) is not supported explicitly through a menu item or command,
10846 rather Gnus do detect and label keys as @samp{application/pgp-keys},
10847 allowing you to specify whatever action you think is appropriate
10848 through the usual @acronym{MIME} infrastructure. You can use a
10849 @file{~/.mailcap} entry (@pxref{mailcap, , mailcap, emacs-mime, The
10850 Emacs MIME Manual}) such as the following to import keys using GNU
10851 Privacy Guard when you click on the @acronym{MIME} button
10852 (@pxref{Using MIME}).
10853
10854 @example
10855 application/pgp-keys; gpg --import --interactive --verbose; needsterminal
10856 @end example
10857 @noindent
10858 This happens to also be the default action defined in
10859 @code{mailcap-mime-data}.
10860
10861 More information on how to set things for sending outgoing signed and
10862 encrypted messages up can be found in the message manual
10863 (@pxref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}).
10864
10865 @node Mailing List
10866 @section Mailing List
10867 @cindex mailing list
10868 @cindex RFC 2396
10869
10870 @kindex A M (summary)
10871 @findex gnus-mailing-list-insinuate
10872 Gnus understands some mailing list fields of RFC 2369. To enable it,
10873 add a @code{to-list} group parameter (@pxref{Group Parameters}),
10874 possibly using @kbd{A M} (@code{gnus-mailing-list-insinuate}) in the
10875 summary buffer.
10876
10877 That enables the following commands to the summary buffer:
10878
10879 @table @kbd
10880
10881 @item C-c C-n h
10882 @kindex C-c C-n h (Summary)
10883 @findex gnus-mailing-list-help
10884 Send a message to fetch mailing list help, if List-Help field exists.
10885
10886 @item C-c C-n s
10887 @kindex C-c C-n s (Summary)
10888 @findex gnus-mailing-list-subscribe
10889 Send a message to subscribe the mailing list, if List-Subscribe field exists.
10890
10891 @item C-c C-n u
10892 @kindex C-c C-n u (Summary)
10893 @findex gnus-mailing-list-unsubscribe
10894 Send a message to unsubscribe the mailing list, if List-Unsubscribe
10895 field exists.
10896
10897 @item C-c C-n p
10898 @kindex C-c C-n p (Summary)
10899 @findex gnus-mailing-list-post
10900 Post to the mailing list, if List-Post field exists.
10901
10902 @item C-c C-n o
10903 @kindex C-c C-n o (Summary)
10904 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10905 Send a message to the mailing list owner, if List-Owner field exists.
10906
10907 @item C-c C-n a
10908 @kindex C-c C-n a (Summary)
10909 @findex gnus-mailing-list-owner
10910 Browse the mailing list archive, if List-Archive field exists.
10911
10912 @end table
10913
10914
10915 @node Article Buffer
10916 @chapter Article Buffer
10917 @cindex article buffer
10918
10919 The articles are displayed in the article buffer, of which there is only
10920 one. All the summary buffers share the same article buffer unless you
10921 tell Gnus otherwise.
10922
10923 @menu
10924 * Hiding Headers:: Deciding what headers should be displayed.
10925 * Using MIME:: Pushing articles through @acronym{MIME} before reading them.
10926 * Customizing Articles:: Tailoring the look of the articles.
10927 * Article Keymap:: Keystrokes available in the article buffer.
10928 * Misc Article:: Other stuff.
10929 @end menu
10930
10931
10932 @node Hiding Headers
10933 @section Hiding Headers
10934 @cindex hiding headers
10935 @cindex deleting headers
10936
10937 The top section of each article is the @dfn{head}. (The rest is the
10938 @dfn{body}, but you may have guessed that already.)
10939
10940 @vindex gnus-show-all-headers
10941 There is a lot of useful information in the head: the name of the person
10942 who wrote the article, the date it was written and the subject of the
10943 article. That's well and nice, but there's also lots of information
10944 most people do not want to see---what systems the article has passed
10945 through before reaching you, the @code{Message-ID}, the
10946 @code{References}, etc. ad nauseam---and you'll probably want to get rid
10947 of some of those lines. If you want to keep all those lines in the
10948 article buffer, you can set @code{gnus-show-all-headers} to @code{t}.
10949
10950 Gnus provides you with two variables for sifting headers:
10951
10952 @table @code
10953
10954 @item gnus-visible-headers
10955 @vindex gnus-visible-headers
10956 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it should be a regular expression
10957 that says what headers you wish to keep in the article buffer. All
10958 headers that do not match this variable will be hidden.
10959
10960 For instance, if you only want to see the name of the person who wrote
10961 the article and the subject, you'd say:
10962
10963 @lisp
10964 (setq gnus-visible-headers "^From:\\|^Subject:")
10965 @end lisp
10966
10967 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10968 remain visible.
10969
10970 @item gnus-ignored-headers
10971 @vindex gnus-ignored-headers
10972 This variable is the reverse of @code{gnus-visible-headers}. If this
10973 variable is set (and @code{gnus-visible-headers} is @code{nil}), it
10974 should be a regular expression that matches all lines that you want to
10975 hide. All lines that do not match this variable will remain visible.
10976
10977 For instance, if you just want to get rid of the @code{References} line
10978 and the @code{Xref} line, you might say:
10979
10980 @lisp
10981 (setq gnus-ignored-headers "^References:\\|^Xref:")
10982 @end lisp
10983
10984 This variable can also be a list of regexps to match headers to
10985 be removed.
10986
10987 Note that if @code{gnus-visible-headers} is non-@code{nil}, this
10988 variable will have no effect.
10989
10990 @end table
10991
10992 @vindex gnus-sorted-header-list
10993 Gnus can also sort the headers for you. (It does this by default.) You
10994 can control the sorting by setting the @code{gnus-sorted-header-list}
10995 variable. It is a list of regular expressions that says in what order
10996 the headers are to be displayed.
10997
10998 For instance, if you want the name of the author of the article first,
10999 and then the subject, you might say something like:
11000
11001 @lisp
11002 (setq gnus-sorted-header-list '("^From:" "^Subject:"))
11003 @end lisp
11004
11005 Any headers that are to remain visible, but are not listed in this
11006 variable, will be displayed in random order after all the headers listed in this variable.
11007
11008 @findex gnus-article-hide-boring-headers
11009 @vindex gnus-boring-article-headers
11010 You can hide further boring headers by setting
11011 @code{gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers} to @code{head}. What this function
11012 does depends on the @code{gnus-boring-article-headers} variable. It's a
11013 list, but this list doesn't actually contain header names. Instead it
11014 lists various @dfn{boring conditions} that Gnus can check and remove
11015 from sight.
11016
11017 These conditions are:
11018 @table @code
11019 @item empty
11020 Remove all empty headers.
11021 @item followup-to
11022 Remove the @code{Followup-To} header if it is identical to the
11023 @code{Newsgroups} header.
11024 @item reply-to
11025 Remove the @code{Reply-To} header if it lists the same addresses as
11026 the @code{From} header, or if the @code{broken-reply-to} group
11027 parameter is set.
11028 @item newsgroups
11029 Remove the @code{Newsgroups} header if it only contains the current group
11030 name.
11031 @item to-address
11032 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11033 the current group's @code{to-address} parameter.
11034 @item to-list
11035 Remove the @code{To} header if it only contains the address identical to
11036 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11037 @item cc-list
11038 Remove the @code{Cc} header if it only contains the address identical to
11039 the current group's @code{to-list} parameter.
11040 @item date
11041 Remove the @code{Date} header if the article is less than three days
11042 old.
11043 @item long-to
11044 Remove the @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} header if it is very long.
11045 @item many-to
11046 Remove all @code{To} and/or @code{Cc} headers if there are more than one.
11047 @end table
11048
11049 To include these three elements, you could say something like:
11050
11051 @lisp
11052 (setq gnus-boring-article-headers
11053 '(empty followup-to reply-to))
11054 @end lisp
11055
11056 This is also the default value for this variable.
11057
11058
11059 @node Using MIME
11060 @section Using MIME
11061 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11062
11063 Mime is a standard for waving your hands through the air, aimlessly,
11064 while people stand around yawning.
11065
11066 @acronym{MIME}, however, is a standard for encoding your articles, aimlessly,
11067 while all newsreaders die of fear.
11068
11069 @acronym{MIME} may specify what character set the article uses, the encoding
11070 of the characters, and it also makes it possible to embed pictures and
11071 other naughty stuff in innocent-looking articles.
11072
11073 @vindex gnus-display-mime-function
11074 @findex gnus-display-mime
11075 Gnus pushes @acronym{MIME} articles through @code{gnus-display-mime-function}
11076 to display the @acronym{MIME} parts. This is @code{gnus-display-mime} by
11077 default, which creates a bundle of clickable buttons that can be used to
11078 display, save and manipulate the @acronym{MIME} objects.
11079
11080 The following commands are available when you have placed point over a
11081 @acronym{MIME} button:
11082
11083 @table @kbd
11084 @findex gnus-article-press-button
11085 @item RET (Article)
11086 @kindex RET (Article)
11087 @itemx BUTTON-2 (Article)
11088 Toggle displaying of the @acronym{MIME} object
11089 (@code{gnus-article-press-button}). If built-in viewers can not display
11090 the object, Gnus resorts to external viewers in the @file{mailcap}
11091 files. If a viewer has the @samp{copiousoutput} specification, the
11092 object is displayed inline.
11093
11094 @findex gnus-mime-view-part
11095 @item M-RET (Article)
11096 @kindex M-RET (Article)
11097 @itemx v (Article)
11098 Prompt for a method, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11099 method (@code{gnus-mime-view-part}).
11100
11101 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-type
11102 @item t (Article)
11103 @kindex t (Article)
11104 View the @acronym{MIME} object as if it were a different @acronym{MIME} media type
11105 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-type}).
11106
11107 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset
11108 @item C (Article)
11109 @kindex C (Article)
11110 Prompt for a charset, and then view the @acronym{MIME} object using this
11111 charset (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-as-charset}).
11112
11113 @findex gnus-mime-save-part
11114 @item o (Article)
11115 @kindex o (Article)
11116 Prompt for a file name, and then save the @acronym{MIME} object
11117 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part}).
11118
11119 @findex gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip
11120 @item C-o (Article)
11121 @kindex C-o (Article)
11122 Prompt for a file name, then save the @acronym{MIME} object and strip it from
11123 the article. Then proceed to article editing, where a reasonable
11124 suggestion is being made on how the altered article should look
11125 like. The stripped @acronym{MIME} object will be referred via the
11126 message/external-body @acronym{MIME} type.
11127 (@code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip}).
11128
11129 @findex gnus-mime-delete-part
11130 @item d (Article)
11131 @kindex d (Article)
11132 Delete the @acronym{MIME} object from the article and replace it with some
11133 information about the removed @acronym{MIME} object
11134 (@code{gnus-mime-delete-part}).
11135
11136 @findex gnus-mime-copy-part
11137 @item c (Article)
11138 @kindex c (Article)
11139 Copy the @acronym{MIME} object to a fresh buffer and display this buffer
11140 (@code{gnus-mime-copy-part}). Compressed files like @file{.gz} and
11141 @file{.bz2} are automatically decompressed if
11142 @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled (@pxref{Compressed Files,,
11143 Accessing Compressed Files, emacs, The Emacs Editor}).
11144
11145 @findex gnus-mime-print-part
11146 @item p (Article)
11147 @kindex p (Article)
11148 Print the @acronym{MIME} object (@code{gnus-mime-print-part}). This
11149 command respects the @samp{print=} specifications in the
11150 @file{.mailcap} file.
11151
11152 @findex gnus-mime-inline-part
11153 @item i (Article)
11154 @kindex i (Article)
11155 Insert the contents of the @acronym{MIME} object into the buffer
11156 (@code{gnus-mime-inline-part}) as @samp{text/plain}. If given a prefix, insert
11157 the raw contents without decoding. If given a numerical prefix, you can
11158 do semi-manual charset stuff (see
11159 @code{gnus-summary-show-article-charset-alist} in @ref{Paging the
11160 Article}).
11161
11162 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-internally
11163 @item E (Article)
11164 @kindex E (Article)
11165 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an internal viewer. If no internal
11166 viewer is available, use an external viewer
11167 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-internally}).
11168
11169 @findex gnus-mime-view-part-externally
11170 @item e (Article)
11171 @kindex e (Article)
11172 View the @acronym{MIME} object with an external viewer.
11173 (@code{gnus-mime-view-part-externally}).
11174
11175 @findex gnus-mime-pipe-part
11176 @item | (Article)
11177 @kindex | (Article)
11178 Output the @acronym{MIME} object to a process (@code{gnus-mime-pipe-part}).
11179
11180 @findex gnus-mime-action-on-part
11181 @item . (Article)
11182 @kindex . (Article)
11183 Interactively run an action on the @acronym{MIME} object
11184 (@code{gnus-mime-action-on-part}).
11185
11186 @end table
11187
11188 Gnus will display some @acronym{MIME} objects automatically. The way Gnus
11189 determines which parts to do this with is described in the Emacs
11190 @acronym{MIME} manual.
11191
11192 It might be best to just use the toggling functions from the article
11193 buffer to avoid getting nasty surprises. (For instance, you enter the
11194 group @samp{alt.sing-a-long} and, before you know it, @acronym{MIME} has
11195 decoded the sound file in the article and some horrible sing-a-long song
11196 comes screaming out your speakers, and you can't find the volume button,
11197 because there isn't one, and people are starting to look at you, and you
11198 try to stop the program, but you can't, and you can't find the program
11199 to control the volume, and everybody else in the room suddenly decides
11200 to look at you disdainfully, and you'll feel rather stupid.)
11201
11202 Any similarity to real events and people is purely coincidental. Ahem.
11203
11204 Also @pxref{MIME Commands}.
11205
11206
11207 @node Customizing Articles
11208 @section Customizing Articles
11209 @cindex article customization
11210
11211 A slew of functions for customizing how the articles are to look like
11212 exist. You can call these functions interactively
11213 (@pxref{Article Washing}), or you can have them
11214 called automatically when you select the articles.
11215
11216 To have them called automatically, you should set the corresponding
11217 ``treatment'' variable. For instance, to have headers hidden, you'd set
11218 @code{gnus-treat-hide-headers}. Below is a list of variables that can
11219 be set, but first we discuss the values these variables can have.
11220
11221 Note: Some values, while valid, make little sense. Check the list below
11222 for sensible values.
11223
11224 @enumerate
11225 @item
11226 @code{nil}: Don't do this treatment.
11227
11228 @item
11229 @code{t}: Do this treatment on all body parts.
11230
11231 @item
11232 @code{head}: Do the treatment on the headers.
11233
11234 @item
11235 @code{last}: Do this treatment on the last part.
11236
11237 @item
11238 An integer: Do this treatment on all body parts that have a length less
11239 than this number.
11240
11241 @item
11242 A list of strings: Do this treatment on all body parts that are in
11243 articles that are read in groups that have names that match one of the
11244 regexps in the list.
11245
11246 @item
11247 A list where the first element is not a string:
11248
11249 The list is evaluated recursively. The first element of the list is a
11250 predicate. The following predicates are recognized: @code{or},
11251 @code{and}, @code{not} and @code{typep}. Here's an example:
11252
11253 @lisp
11254 (or last
11255 (typep "text/x-vcard"))
11256 @end lisp
11257
11258 @end enumerate
11259
11260 You may have noticed that the word @dfn{part} is used here. This refers
11261 to the fact that some messages are @acronym{MIME} multipart articles that may
11262 be divided into several parts. Articles that are not multiparts are
11263 considered to contain just a single part.
11264
11265 @vindex gnus-article-treat-types
11266 Are the treatments applied to all sorts of multipart parts? Yes, if you
11267 want to, but by default, only @samp{text/plain} parts are given the
11268 treatment. This is controlled by the @code{gnus-article-treat-types}
11269 variable, which is a list of regular expressions that are matched to the
11270 type of the part. This variable is ignored if the value of the
11271 controlling variable is a predicate list, as described above.
11272
11273 @ifinfo
11274 @c Avoid sort of redundant entries in the same section for the printed
11275 @c manual, but add them in info to allow `i gnus-treat-foo-bar RET' or
11276 @c `i foo-bar'.
11277 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize
11278 @vindex gnus-treat-buttonize-head
11279 @vindex gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences
11280 @vindex gnus-treat-overstrike
11281 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-cr
11282 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body
11283 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines
11284 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines
11285 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-pem
11286 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines
11287 @vindex gnus-treat-unsplit-urls
11288 @vindex gnus-treat-wash-html
11289 @vindex gnus-treat-date-english
11290 @vindex gnus-treat-date-iso8601
11291 @vindex gnus-treat-date-lapsed
11292 @vindex gnus-treat-date-local
11293 @vindex gnus-treat-date-original
11294 @vindex gnus-treat-date-user-defined
11295 @vindex gnus-treat-date-ut
11296 @vindex gnus-treat-from-picon
11297 @vindex gnus-treat-mail-picon
11298 @vindex gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon
11299 @vindex gnus-treat-display-smileys
11300 @vindex gnus-treat-body-boundary
11301 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11302 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11303 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11304 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11305 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11306 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11307 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11308 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11309 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11310 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11311 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11312 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11313 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11314 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11315 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11316 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11317 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
11318 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11319 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11320 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11321 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11322 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11323 @end ifinfo
11324
11325 The following treatment options are available. The easiest way to
11326 customize this is to examine the @code{gnus-article-treat} customization
11327 group. Values in parenthesis are suggested sensible values. Others are
11328 possible but those listed are probably sufficient for most people.
11329
11330 @table @code
11331 @item gnus-treat-buttonize (t, integer)
11332 @item gnus-treat-buttonize-head (head)
11333
11334 @xref{Article Buttons}.
11335
11336 @item gnus-treat-capitalize-sentences (t, integer)
11337 @item gnus-treat-overstrike (t, integer)
11338 @item gnus-treat-strip-cr (t, integer)
11339 @item gnus-treat-strip-headers-in-body (t, integer)
11340 @item gnus-treat-strip-leading-blank-lines (t, integer)
11341 @item gnus-treat-strip-multiple-blank-lines (t, integer)
11342 @item gnus-treat-strip-pem (t, last, integer)
11343 @item gnus-treat-strip-trailing-blank-lines (t, last, integer)
11344 @item gnus-treat-unsplit-urls (t, integer)
11345 @item gnus-treat-wash-html (t, integer)
11346
11347 @xref{Article Washing}.
11348
11349 @item gnus-treat-date-english (head)
11350 @item gnus-treat-date-iso8601 (head)
11351 @item gnus-treat-date-lapsed (head)
11352 @item gnus-treat-date-local (head)
11353 @item gnus-treat-date-original (head)
11354 @item gnus-treat-date-user-defined (head)
11355 @item gnus-treat-date-ut (head)
11356
11357 @xref{Article Date}.
11358
11359 @item gnus-treat-from-picon (head)
11360 @item gnus-treat-mail-picon (head)
11361 @item gnus-treat-newsgroups-picon (head)
11362
11363 @xref{Picons}.
11364
11365 @item gnus-treat-display-smileys (t, integer)
11366
11367 @item gnus-treat-body-boundary (head)
11368
11369 @vindex gnus-body-boundary-delimiter
11370 Adds a delimiter between header and body, the string used as delimiter
11371 is controlled by @code{gnus-body-boundary-delimiter}.
11372
11373 @xref{Smileys}.
11374
11375 @vindex gnus-treat-display-x-face
11376 @item gnus-treat-display-x-face (head)
11377
11378 @xref{X-Face}.
11379
11380 @vindex gnus-treat-display-face
11381 @item gnus-treat-display-face (head)
11382
11383 @xref{Face}.
11384
11385 @vindex gnus-treat-emphasize
11386 @item gnus-treat-emphasize (t, head, integer)
11387 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-article
11388 @item gnus-treat-fill-article (t, integer)
11389 @vindex gnus-treat-fill-long-lines
11390 @item gnus-treat-fill-long-lines (t, integer)
11391 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers
11392 @item gnus-treat-hide-boring-headers (head)
11393 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation
11394 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation (t, integer)
11395 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe
11396 @item gnus-treat-hide-citation-maybe (t, integer)
11397 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-headers
11398 @item gnus-treat-hide-headers (head)
11399 @vindex gnus-treat-hide-signature
11400 @item gnus-treat-hide-signature (t, last)
11401 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-banner
11402 @item gnus-treat-strip-banner (t, last)
11403 @vindex gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers
11404 @item gnus-treat-strip-list-identifiers (head)
11405
11406 @xref{Article Hiding}.
11407
11408 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-citation
11409 @item gnus-treat-highlight-citation (t, integer)
11410 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-headers
11411 @item gnus-treat-highlight-headers (head)
11412 @vindex gnus-treat-highlight-signature
11413 @item gnus-treat-highlight-signature (t, last, integer)
11414
11415 @xref{Article Highlighting}.
11416
11417 @vindex gnus-treat-play-sounds
11418 @item gnus-treat-play-sounds
11419 @vindex gnus-treat-translate
11420 @item gnus-treat-translate
11421 @vindex gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig
11422 @item gnus-treat-x-pgp-sig (head)
11423
11424 @vindex gnus-treat-unfold-headers
11425 @item gnus-treat-unfold-headers (head)
11426 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-headers
11427 @item gnus-treat-fold-headers (head)
11428 @vindex gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups
11429 @item gnus-treat-fold-newsgroups (head)
11430 @vindex gnus-treat-leading-whitespace
11431 @item gnus-treat-leading-whitespace (head)
11432
11433 @xref{Article Header}.
11434
11435
11436 @end table
11437
11438 @vindex gnus-part-display-hook
11439 You can, of course, write your own functions to be called from
11440 @code{gnus-part-display-hook}. The functions are called narrowed to the
11441 part, and you can do anything you like, pretty much. There is no
11442 information that you have to keep in the buffer---you can change
11443 everything.
11444
11445
11446 @node Article Keymap
11447 @section Article Keymap
11448
11449 Most of the keystrokes in the summary buffer can also be used in the
11450 article buffer. They should behave as if you typed them in the summary
11451 buffer, which means that you don't actually have to have a summary
11452 buffer displayed while reading. You can do it all from the article
11453 buffer.
11454
11455 @kindex v (Article)
11456 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Article)
11457 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
11458 command or better use it as a prefix key.
11459
11460 A few additional keystrokes are available:
11461
11462 @table @kbd
11463
11464 @item SPACE
11465 @kindex SPACE (Article)
11466 @findex gnus-article-next-page
11467 Scroll forwards one page (@code{gnus-article-next-page}).
11468 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h SPACE h}.
11469
11470 @item DEL
11471 @kindex DEL (Article)
11472 @findex gnus-article-prev-page
11473 Scroll backwards one page (@code{gnus-article-prev-page}).
11474 This is exactly the same as @kbd{h DEL h}.
11475
11476 @item C-c ^
11477 @kindex C-c ^ (Article)
11478 @findex gnus-article-refer-article
11479 If point is in the neighborhood of a @code{Message-ID} and you press
11480 @kbd{C-c ^}, Gnus will try to get that article from the server
11481 (@code{gnus-article-refer-article}).
11482
11483 @item C-c C-m
11484 @kindex C-c C-m (Article)
11485 @findex gnus-article-mail
11486 Send a reply to the address near point (@code{gnus-article-mail}). If
11487 given a prefix, include the mail.
11488
11489 @item s
11490 @kindex s (Article)
11491 @findex gnus-article-show-summary
11492 Reconfigure the buffers so that the summary buffer becomes visible
11493 (@code{gnus-article-show-summary}).
11494
11495 @item ?
11496 @kindex ? (Article)
11497 @findex gnus-article-describe-briefly
11498 Give a very brief description of the available keystrokes
11499 (@code{gnus-article-describe-briefly}).
11500
11501 @item TAB
11502 @kindex TAB (Article)
11503 @findex gnus-article-next-button
11504 Go to the next button, if any (@code{gnus-article-next-button}). This
11505 only makes sense if you have buttonizing turned on.
11506
11507 @item M-TAB
11508 @kindex M-TAB (Article)
11509 @findex gnus-article-prev-button
11510 Go to the previous button, if any (@code{gnus-article-prev-button}).
11511
11512 @item R
11513 @kindex R (Article)
11514 @findex gnus-article-reply-with-original
11515 Send a reply to the current article and yank the current article
11516 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}). If given a prefix, make a
11517 wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11518 region.
11519
11520 @item F
11521 @kindex F (Article)
11522 @findex gnus-article-followup-with-original
11523 Send a followup to the current article and yank the current article
11524 (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}). If given a prefix, make
11525 a wide reply. If the region is active, only yank the text in the
11526 region.
11527
11528
11529 @end table
11530
11531
11532 @node Misc Article
11533 @section Misc Article
11534
11535 @table @code
11536
11537 @item gnus-single-article-buffer
11538 @vindex gnus-single-article-buffer
11539 @cindex article buffers, several
11540 If non-@code{nil}, use the same article buffer for all the groups.
11541 (This is the default.) If @code{nil}, each group will have its own
11542 article buffer.
11543
11544 @vindex gnus-article-decode-hook
11545 @item gnus-article-decode-hook
11546 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
11547 Hook used to decode @acronym{MIME} articles. The default value is
11548 @code{(article-decode-charset article-decode-encoded-words)}
11549
11550 @vindex gnus-article-prepare-hook
11551 @item gnus-article-prepare-hook
11552 This hook is called right after the article has been inserted into the
11553 article buffer. It is mainly intended for functions that do something
11554 depending on the contents; it should probably not be used for changing
11555 the contents of the article buffer.
11556
11557 @item gnus-article-mode-hook
11558 @vindex gnus-article-mode-hook
11559 Hook called in article mode buffers.
11560
11561 @item gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11562 @vindex gnus-article-mode-syntax-table
11563 Syntax table used in article buffers. It is initialized from
11564 @code{text-mode-syntax-table}.
11565
11566 @vindex gnus-article-over-scroll
11567 @item gnus-article-over-scroll
11568 If non-@code{nil}, allow scrolling the article buffer even when there
11569 no more new text to scroll in. The default is @code{nil}.
11570
11571 @vindex gnus-article-mode-line-format
11572 @item gnus-article-mode-line-format
11573 This variable is a format string along the same lines as
11574 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format} (@pxref{Summary Buffer Mode
11575 Line}). It accepts the same format specifications as that variable,
11576 with two extensions:
11577
11578 @table @samp
11579
11580 @item w
11581 The @dfn{wash status} of the article. This is a short string with one
11582 character for each possible article wash operation that may have been
11583 performed. The characters and their meaning:
11584
11585 @table @samp
11586
11587 @item c
11588 Displayed when cited text may be hidden in the article buffer.
11589
11590 @item h
11591 Displayed when headers are hidden in the article buffer.
11592
11593 @item p
11594 Displayed when article is digitally signed or encrypted, and Gnus has
11595 hidden the security headers. (N.B. does not tell anything about
11596 security status, i.e. good or bad signature.)
11597
11598 @item s
11599 Displayed when the signature has been hidden in the Article buffer.
11600
11601 @item o
11602 Displayed when Gnus has treated overstrike characters in the article buffer.
11603
11604 @item e
11605 Displayed when Gnus has treated emphasised strings in the article buffer.
11606
11607 @end table
11608
11609 @item m
11610 The number of @acronym{MIME} parts in the article.
11611
11612 @end table
11613
11614 @vindex gnus-break-pages
11615
11616 @item gnus-break-pages
11617 Controls whether @dfn{page breaking} is to take place. If this variable
11618 is non-@code{nil}, the articles will be divided into pages whenever a
11619 page delimiter appears in the article. If this variable is @code{nil},
11620 paging will not be done.
11621
11622 @item gnus-page-delimiter
11623 @vindex gnus-page-delimiter
11624 This is the delimiter mentioned above. By default, it is @samp{^L}
11625 (formfeed).
11626
11627 @cindex IDNA
11628 @cindex internationalized domain names
11629 @vindex gnus-use-idna
11630 @item gnus-use-idna
11631 This variable controls whether Gnus performs IDNA decoding of
11632 internationalized domain names inside @samp{From}, @samp{To} and
11633 @samp{Cc} headers. This requires
11634 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/libidn/, GNU Libidn}, and this
11635 variable is only enabled if you have installed it.
11636
11637 @end table
11638
11639
11640 @node Composing Messages
11641 @chapter Composing Messages
11642 @cindex composing messages
11643 @cindex messages
11644 @cindex mail
11645 @cindex sending mail
11646 @cindex reply
11647 @cindex followup
11648 @cindex post
11649 @cindex using gpg
11650 @cindex using s/mime
11651 @cindex using smime
11652
11653 @kindex C-c C-c (Post)
11654 All commands for posting and mailing will put you in a message buffer
11655 where you can edit the article all you like, before you send the
11656 article by pressing @kbd{C-c C-c}. @xref{Top, , Overview, message,
11657 Message Manual}. Where the message will be posted/mailed to depends
11658 on your setup (@pxref{Posting Server}).
11659
11660 @menu
11661 * Mail:: Mailing and replying.
11662 * Posting Server:: What server should you post and mail via?
11663 * POP before SMTP:: You cannot send a mail unless you read a mail.
11664 * Mail and Post:: Mailing and posting at the same time.
11665 * Archived Messages:: Where Gnus stores the messages you've sent.
11666 * Posting Styles:: An easier way to specify who you are.
11667 * Drafts:: Postponing messages and rejected messages.
11668 * Rejected Articles:: What happens if the server doesn't like your article?
11669 * Signing and encrypting:: How to compose secure messages.
11670 @end menu
11671
11672 Also @pxref{Canceling and Superseding} for information on how to
11673 remove articles you shouldn't have posted.
11674
11675
11676 @node Mail
11677 @section Mail
11678
11679 Variables for customizing outgoing mail:
11680
11681 @table @code
11682 @item gnus-uu-digest-headers
11683 @vindex gnus-uu-digest-headers
11684 List of regexps to match headers included in digested messages. The
11685 headers will be included in the sequence they are matched. If
11686 @code{nil} include all headers.
11687
11688 @item gnus-add-to-list
11689 @vindex gnus-add-to-list
11690 If non-@code{nil}, add a @code{to-list} group parameter to mail groups
11691 that have none when you do a @kbd{a}.
11692
11693 @item gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11694 @vindex gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news
11695 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus will ask you for a confirmation when you are
11696 about to reply to news articles by mail. If it is @code{nil}, nothing
11697 interferes in what you want to do. This can also be a function
11698 receiving the group name as the only parameter which should return
11699 non-@code{nil} if a confirmation is needed, or a regular expression
11700 matching group names, where confirmation should be asked for.
11701
11702 If you find yourself never wanting to reply to mail, but occasionally
11703 press @kbd{R} anyway, this variable might be for you.
11704
11705 @item gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11706 @vindex gnus-confirm-treat-mail-like-news
11707 If non-@code{nil}, Gnus also requests confirmation according to
11708 @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} when replying to mail. This is
11709 useful for treating mailing lists like newsgroups.
11710
11711 @end table
11712
11713
11714 @node Posting Server
11715 @section Posting Server
11716
11717 When you press those magical @kbd{C-c C-c} keys to ship off your latest
11718 (extremely intelligent, of course) article, where does it go?
11719
11720 Thank you for asking. I hate you.
11721
11722 It can be quite complicated.
11723
11724 @vindex gnus-post-method
11725 When posting news, Message usually invokes @code{message-send-news}
11726 (@pxref{News Variables, , News Variables, message, Message Manual}).
11727 Normally, Gnus will post using the same select method as you're
11728 reading from (which might be convenient if you're reading lots of
11729 groups from different private servers). However. If the server
11730 you're reading from doesn't allow posting, just reading, you probably
11731 want to use some other server to post your (extremely intelligent and
11732 fabulously interesting) articles. You can then set the
11733 @code{gnus-post-method} to some other method:
11734
11735 @lisp
11736 (setq gnus-post-method '(nnspool ""))
11737 @end lisp
11738
11739 Now, if you've done this, and then this server rejects your article, or
11740 this server is down, what do you do then? To override this variable you
11741 can use a non-zero prefix to the @kbd{C-c C-c} command to force using
11742 the ``current'' server, to get back the default behavior, for posting.
11743
11744 If you give a zero prefix (i.e., @kbd{C-u 0 C-c C-c}) to that command,
11745 Gnus will prompt you for what method to use for posting.
11746
11747 You can also set @code{gnus-post-method} to a list of select methods.
11748 If that's the case, Gnus will always prompt you for what method to use
11749 for posting.
11750
11751 Finally, if you want to always post using the native select method,
11752 you can set this variable to @code{native}.
11753
11754 When sending mail, Message invokes @code{message-send-mail-function}.
11755 The default function, @code{message-send-mail-with-sendmail}, pipes
11756 your article to the @code{sendmail} binary for further queuing and
11757 sending. When your local system is not configured for sending mail
11758 using @code{sendmail}, and you have access to a remote @acronym{SMTP}
11759 server, you can set @code{message-send-mail-function} to
11760 @code{smtpmail-send-it} and make sure to setup the @code{smtpmail}
11761 package correctly. An example:
11762
11763 @lisp
11764 (setq message-send-mail-function 'smtpmail-send-it
11765 smtpmail-default-smtp-server "YOUR SMTP HOST")
11766 @end lisp
11767
11768 To the thing similar to this, there is
11769 @code{message-smtpmail-send-it}. It is useful if your @acronym{ISP}
11770 requires the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication.
11771 @xref{POP before SMTP}.
11772
11773 Other possible choices for @code{message-send-mail-function} includes
11774 @code{message-send-mail-with-mh}, @code{message-send-mail-with-qmail},
11775 and @code{feedmail-send-it}.
11776
11777 @node POP before SMTP
11778 @section POP before SMTP
11779 @cindex pop before smtp
11780 @findex message-smtpmail-send-it
11781 @findex mail-source-touch-pop
11782
11783 Does your @acronym{ISP} require the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP}
11784 authentication? It is whether you need to connect to the @acronym{POP}
11785 mail server within a certain time before sending mails. If so, there is
11786 a convenient way. To do that, put the following lines in your
11787 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
11788
11789 @lisp
11790 (setq message-send-mail-function 'message-smtpmail-send-it)
11791 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook 'mail-source-touch-pop)
11792 @end lisp
11793
11794 @noindent
11795 It means to let Gnus connect to the @acronym{POP} mail server in advance
11796 whenever you send a mail. The @code{mail-source-touch-pop} function
11797 does only a @acronym{POP} authentication according to the value of
11798 @code{mail-sources} without fetching mails, just before sending a mail.
11799 Note that you have to use @code{message-smtpmail-send-it} which runs
11800 @code{message-send-mail-hook} rather than @code{smtpmail-send-it} and
11801 set the value of @code{mail-sources} for a @acronym{POP} connection
11802 correctly. @xref{Mail Sources}.
11803
11804 If you have two or more @acronym{POP} mail servers set in
11805 @code{mail-sources}, you may want to specify one of them to
11806 @code{mail-source-primary-source} as the @acronym{POP} mail server to be
11807 used for the @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication. If it
11808 is your primary @acronym{POP} mail server (i.e., you are fetching mails
11809 mainly from that server), you can set it permanently as follows:
11810
11811 @lisp
11812 (setq mail-source-primary-source
11813 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11814 :password "secret"))
11815 @end lisp
11816
11817 @noindent
11818 Otherwise, bind it dynamically only when performing the
11819 @acronym{POP}-before-@acronym{SMTP} authentication as follows:
11820
11821 @lisp
11822 (add-hook 'message-send-mail-hook
11823 (lambda ()
11824 (let ((mail-source-primary-source
11825 '(pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
11826 :password "secret")))
11827 (mail-source-touch-pop))))
11828 @end lisp
11829
11830 @node Mail and Post
11831 @section Mail and Post
11832
11833 Here's a list of variables relevant to both mailing and
11834 posting:
11835
11836 @table @code
11837 @item gnus-mailing-list-groups
11838 @findex gnus-mailing-list-groups
11839 @cindex mailing lists
11840
11841 If your news server offers groups that are really mailing lists
11842 gatewayed to the @acronym{NNTP} server, you can read those groups without
11843 problems, but you can't post/followup to them without some difficulty.
11844 One solution is to add a @code{to-address} to the group parameters
11845 (@pxref{Group Parameters}). An easier thing to do is set the
11846 @code{gnus-mailing-list-groups} to a regexp that matches the groups that
11847 really are mailing lists. Then, at least, followups to the mailing
11848 lists will work most of the time. Posting to these groups (@kbd{a}) is
11849 still a pain, though.
11850
11851 @item gnus-user-agent
11852 @vindex gnus-user-agent
11853 @cindex User-Agent
11854
11855 This variable controls which information should be exposed in the
11856 User-Agent header. It can be a list of symbols or a string. Valid
11857 symbols are @code{gnus} (show Gnus version) and @code{emacs} (show Emacs
11858 version). In addition to the Emacs version, you can add @code{codename}
11859 (show (S)XEmacs codename) or either @code{config} (show system
11860 configuration) or @code{type} (show system type). If you set it to a
11861 string, be sure to use a valid format, see RFC 2616.
11862
11863 @end table
11864
11865 You may want to do spell-checking on messages that you send out. Or, if
11866 you don't want to spell-check by hand, you could add automatic
11867 spell-checking via the @code{ispell} package:
11868
11869 @cindex ispell
11870 @findex ispell-message
11871 @lisp
11872 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'ispell-message)
11873 @end lisp
11874
11875 If you want to change the @code{ispell} dictionary based on what group
11876 you're in, you could say something like the following:
11877
11878 @lisp
11879 (add-hook 'gnus-select-group-hook
11880 (lambda ()
11881 (cond
11882 ((string-match
11883 "^de\\." (gnus-group-real-name gnus-newsgroup-name))
11884 (ispell-change-dictionary "deutsch"))
11885 (t
11886 (ispell-change-dictionary "english")))))
11887 @end lisp
11888
11889 Modify to suit your needs.
11890
11891
11892 @node Archived Messages
11893 @section Archived Messages
11894 @cindex archived messages
11895 @cindex sent messages
11896
11897 Gnus provides a few different methods for storing the mail and news you
11898 send. The default method is to use the @dfn{archive virtual server} to
11899 store the messages. If you want to disable this completely, the
11900 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable should be @code{nil}, which
11901 is the default.
11902
11903 For archiving interesting messages in a group you read, see the
11904 @kbd{B c} (@code{gnus-summary-copy-article}) command (@pxref{Mail
11905 Group Commands}).
11906
11907 @vindex gnus-message-archive-method
11908 @code{gnus-message-archive-method} says what virtual server Gnus is to
11909 use to store sent messages. The default is:
11910
11911 @lisp
11912 (nnfolder "archive"
11913 (nnfolder-directory "~/Mail/archive")
11914 (nnfolder-active-file "~/Mail/archive/active")
11915 (nnfolder-get-new-mail nil)
11916 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t))
11917 @end lisp
11918
11919 You can, however, use any mail select method (@code{nnml},
11920 @code{nnmbox}, etc.). @code{nnfolder} is a quite likable select method
11921 for doing this sort of thing, though. If you don't like the default
11922 directory chosen, you could say something like:
11923
11924 @lisp
11925 (setq gnus-message-archive-method
11926 '(nnfolder "archive"
11927 (nnfolder-inhibit-expiry t)
11928 (nnfolder-active-file "~/News/sent-mail/active")
11929 (nnfolder-directory "~/News/sent-mail/")))
11930 @end lisp
11931
11932 @vindex gnus-message-archive-group
11933 @cindex Gcc
11934 Gnus will insert @code{Gcc} headers in all outgoing messages that point
11935 to one or more group(s) on that server. Which group to use is
11936 determined by the @code{gnus-message-archive-group} variable.
11937
11938 This variable can be used to do the following:
11939
11940 @table @asis
11941 @item a string
11942 Messages will be saved in that group.
11943
11944 Note that you can include a select method in the group name, then the
11945 message will not be stored in the select method given by
11946 @code{gnus-message-archive-method}, but in the select method specified
11947 by the group name, instead. Suppose @code{gnus-message-archive-method}
11948 has the default value shown above. Then setting
11949 @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{"foo"} means that outgoing
11950 messages are stored in @samp{nnfolder+archive:foo}, but if you use the
11951 value @code{"nnml:foo"}, then outgoing messages will be stored in
11952 @samp{nnml:foo}.
11953
11954 @item a list of strings
11955 Messages will be saved in all those groups.
11956
11957 @item an alist of regexps, functions and forms
11958 When a key ``matches'', the result is used.
11959
11960 @item @code{nil}
11961 No message archiving will take place. This is the default.
11962 @end table
11963
11964 Let's illustrate:
11965
11966 Just saving to a single group called @samp{MisK}:
11967 @lisp
11968 (setq gnus-message-archive-group "MisK")
11969 @end lisp
11970
11971 Saving to two groups, @samp{MisK} and @samp{safe}:
11972 @lisp
11973 (setq gnus-message-archive-group '("MisK" "safe"))
11974 @end lisp
11975
11976 Save to different groups based on what group you are in:
11977 @lisp
11978 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11979 '(("^alt" "sent-to-alt")
11980 ("mail" "sent-to-mail")
11981 (".*" "sent-to-misc")))
11982 @end lisp
11983
11984 More complex stuff:
11985 @lisp
11986 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11987 '((if (message-news-p)
11988 "misc-news"
11989 "misc-mail")))
11990 @end lisp
11991
11992 How about storing all news messages in one file, but storing all mail
11993 messages in one file per month:
11994
11995 @lisp
11996 (setq gnus-message-archive-group
11997 '((if (message-news-p)
11998 "misc-news"
11999 (concat "mail." (format-time-string "%Y-%m")))))
12000 @end lisp
12001
12002 @c (XEmacs 19.13 doesn't have @code{format-time-string}, so you'll have to
12003 @c use a different value for @code{gnus-message-archive-group} there.)
12004
12005 Now, when you send a message off, it will be stored in the appropriate
12006 group. (If you want to disable storing for just one particular message,
12007 you can just remove the @code{Gcc} header that has been inserted.) The
12008 archive group will appear in the group buffer the next time you start
12009 Gnus, or the next time you press @kbd{F} in the group buffer. You can
12010 enter it and read the articles in it just like you'd read any other
12011 group. If the group gets really big and annoying, you can simply rename
12012 if (using @kbd{G r} in the group buffer) to something
12013 nice---@samp{misc-mail-september-1995}, or whatever. New messages will
12014 continue to be stored in the old (now empty) group.
12015
12016 That's the default method of archiving sent messages. Gnus offers a
12017 different way for the people who don't like the default method. In that
12018 case you should set @code{gnus-message-archive-group} to @code{nil};
12019 this will disable archiving.
12020
12021 @table @code
12022 @item gnus-outgoing-message-group
12023 @vindex gnus-outgoing-message-group
12024 All outgoing messages will be put in this group. If you want to store
12025 all your outgoing mail and articles in the group @samp{nnml:archive},
12026 you set this variable to that value. This variable can also be a list of
12027 group names.
12028
12029 If you want to have greater control over what group to put each
12030 message in, you can set this variable to a function that checks the
12031 current newsgroup name and then returns a suitable group name (or list
12032 of names).
12033
12034 This variable can be used instead of @code{gnus-message-archive-group},
12035 but the latter is the preferred method.
12036
12037 @item gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12038 @vindex gnus-gcc-mark-as-read
12039 If non-@code{nil}, automatically mark @code{Gcc} articles as read.
12040
12041 @item gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12042 @vindex gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments
12043 If @code{nil}, attach files as normal parts in Gcc copies; if a regexp
12044 and matches the Gcc group name, attach files as external parts; if it is
12045 @code{all}, attach local files as external parts; if it is other
12046 non-@code{nil}, the behavior is the same as @code{all}, but it may be
12047 changed in the future.
12048
12049 @end table
12050
12051
12052 @node Posting Styles
12053 @section Posting Styles
12054 @cindex posting styles
12055 @cindex styles
12056
12057 All them variables, they make my head swim.
12058
12059 So what if you want a different @code{Organization} and signature based
12060 on what groups you post to? And you post both from your home machine
12061 and your work machine, and you want different @code{From} lines, and so
12062 on?
12063
12064 @vindex gnus-posting-styles
12065 One way to do stuff like that is to write clever hooks that change the
12066 variables you need to have changed. That's a bit boring, so somebody
12067 came up with the bright idea of letting the user specify these things in
12068 a handy alist. Here's an example of a @code{gnus-posting-styles}
12069 variable:
12070
12071 @lisp
12072 ((".*"
12073 (signature "Peace and happiness")
12074 (organization "What me?"))
12075 ("^comp"
12076 (signature "Death to everybody"))
12077 ("comp.emacs.i-love-it"
12078 (organization "Emacs is it")))
12079 @end lisp
12080
12081 As you might surmise from this example, this alist consists of several
12082 @dfn{styles}. Each style will be applicable if the first element
12083 ``matches'', in some form or other. The entire alist will be iterated
12084 over, from the beginning towards the end, and each match will be
12085 applied, which means that attributes in later styles that match override
12086 the same attributes in earlier matching styles. So
12087 @samp{comp.programming.literate} will have the @samp{Death to everybody}
12088 signature and the @samp{What me?} @code{Organization} header.
12089
12090 The first element in each style is called the @code{match}. If it's a
12091 string, then Gnus will try to regexp match it against the group name.
12092 If it is the form @code{(header @var{match} @var{regexp})}, then Gnus
12093 will look in the original article for a header whose name is
12094 @var{match} and compare that @var{regexp}. @var{match} and
12095 @var{regexp} are strings. (The original article is the one you are
12096 replying or following up to. If you are not composing a reply or a
12097 followup, then there is nothing to match against.) If the
12098 @code{match} is a function symbol, that function will be called with
12099 no arguments. If it's a variable symbol, then the variable will be
12100 referenced. If it's a list, then that list will be @code{eval}ed. In
12101 any case, if this returns a non-@code{nil} value, then the style is
12102 said to @dfn{match}.
12103
12104 Each style may contain an arbitrary amount of @dfn{attributes}. Each
12105 attribute consists of a @code{(@var{name} @var{value})} pair. In
12106 addition, you can also use the @code{(@var{name} :file @var{value})}
12107 form or the @code{(@var{name} :value @var{value})} form. Where
12108 @code{:file} signifies @var{value} represents a file name and its
12109 contents should be used as the attribute value, @code{:value} signifies
12110 @var{value} does not represent a file name explicitly. The attribute
12111 name can be one of:
12112
12113 @itemize @bullet
12114 @item @code{signature}
12115 @item @code{signature-file}
12116 @item @code{x-face-file}
12117 @item @code{address}, overriding @code{user-mail-address}
12118 @item @code{name}, overriding @code{(user-full-name)}
12119 @item @code{body}
12120 @end itemize
12121
12122 The attribute name can also be a string or a symbol. In that case,
12123 this will be used as a header name, and the value will be inserted in
12124 the headers of the article; if the value is @code{nil}, the header
12125 name will be removed. If the attribute name is @code{eval}, the form
12126 is evaluated, and the result is thrown away.
12127
12128 The attribute value can be a string (used verbatim), a function with
12129 zero arguments (the return value will be used), a variable (its value
12130 will be used) or a list (it will be @code{eval}ed and the return value
12131 will be used). The functions and sexps are called/@code{eval}ed in the
12132 message buffer that is being set up. The headers of the current article
12133 are available through the @code{message-reply-headers} variable, which
12134 is a vector of the following headers: number subject from date id
12135 references chars lines xref extra.
12136
12137 @vindex message-reply-headers
12138
12139 If you wish to check whether the message you are about to compose is
12140 meant to be a news article or a mail message, you can check the values
12141 of the @code{message-news-p} and @code{message-mail-p} functions.
12142
12143 @findex message-mail-p
12144 @findex message-news-p
12145
12146 So here's a new example:
12147
12148 @lisp
12149 (setq gnus-posting-styles
12150 '((".*"
12151 (signature-file "~/.signature")
12152 (name "User Name")
12153 (x-face-file "~/.xface")
12154 (x-url (getenv "WWW_HOME"))
12155 (organization "People's Front Against MWM"))
12156 ("^rec.humor"
12157 (signature my-funny-signature-randomizer))
12158 ((equal (system-name) "gnarly") ;; @r{A form}
12159 (signature my-quote-randomizer))
12160 (message-news-p ;; @r{A function symbol}
12161 (signature my-news-signature))
12162 (window-system ;; @r{A value symbol}
12163 ("X-Window-System" (format "%s" window-system)))
12164 ;; @r{If I'm replying to Larsi, set the Organization header.}
12165 ((header "from" "larsi.*org")
12166 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
12167 ((posting-from-work-p) ;; @r{A user defined function}
12168 (signature-file "~/.work-signature")
12169 (address "user@@bar.foo")
12170 (body "You are fired.\n\nSincerely, your boss.")
12171 (organization "Important Work, Inc"))
12172 ("nnml:.*"
12173 (From (save-excursion
12174 (set-buffer gnus-article-buffer)
12175 (message-fetch-field "to"))))
12176 ("^nn.+:"
12177 (signature-file "~/.mail-signature"))))
12178 @end lisp
12179
12180 The @samp{nnml:.*} rule means that you use the @code{To} address as the
12181 @code{From} address in all your outgoing replies, which might be handy
12182 if you fill many roles.
12183 You may also use @code{message-alternative-emails} instead.
12184 @xref{Message Headers, ,Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
12185
12186 @node Drafts
12187 @section Drafts
12188 @cindex drafts
12189
12190 If you are writing a message (mail or news) and suddenly remember that
12191 you have a steak in the oven (or some pesto in the food processor, you
12192 craaazy vegetarians), you'll probably wish there was a method to save
12193 the message you are writing so that you can continue editing it some
12194 other day, and send it when you feel its finished.
12195
12196 Well, don't worry about it. Whenever you start composing a message of
12197 some sort using the Gnus mail and post commands, the buffer you get will
12198 automatically associate to an article in a special @dfn{draft} group.
12199 If you save the buffer the normal way (@kbd{C-x C-s}, for instance), the
12200 article will be saved there. (Auto-save files also go to the draft
12201 group.)
12202
12203 @cindex nndraft
12204 @vindex nndraft-directory
12205 The draft group is a special group (which is implemented as an
12206 @code{nndraft} group, if you absolutely have to know) called
12207 @samp{nndraft:drafts}. The variable @code{nndraft-directory} says where
12208 @code{nndraft} is to store its files. What makes this group special is
12209 that you can't tick any articles in it or mark any articles as
12210 read---all articles in the group are permanently unread.
12211
12212 If the group doesn't exist, it will be created and you'll be subscribed
12213 to it. The only way to make it disappear from the Group buffer is to
12214 unsubscribe it. The special properties of the draft group comes from
12215 a group property (@pxref{Group Parameters}), and if lost the group
12216 behaves like any other group. This means the commands below will not
12217 be available. To restore the special properties of the group, the
12218 simplest way is to kill the group, using @kbd{C-k}, and restart
12219 Gnus. The group is automatically created again with the
12220 correct parameters. The content of the group is not lost.
12221
12222 @c @findex gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft
12223 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Mail)
12224 @c @kindex C-c M-d (Post)
12225 @c @findex gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft
12226 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Mail)
12227 @c @kindex C-c C-d (Post)
12228 @c If you're writing some super-secret message that you later want to
12229 @c encode with PGP before sending, you may wish to turn the auto-saving
12230 @c (and association with the draft group) off. You never know who might be
12231 @c interested in reading all your extremely valuable and terribly horrible
12232 @c and interesting secrets. The @kbd{C-c M-d}
12233 @c (@code{gnus-dissociate-buffer-from-draft}) command does that for you.
12234 @c If you change your mind and want to turn the auto-saving back on again,
12235 @c @kbd{C-c C-d} (@code{gnus-associate-buffer-with-draft} does that.
12236 @c
12237 @c @vindex gnus-use-draft
12238 @c To leave association with the draft group off by default, set
12239 @c @code{gnus-use-draft} to @code{nil}. It is @code{t} by default.
12240
12241 @findex gnus-draft-edit-message
12242 @kindex D e (Draft)
12243 When you want to continue editing the article, you simply enter the
12244 draft group and push @kbd{D e} (@code{gnus-draft-edit-message}) to do
12245 that. You will be placed in a buffer where you left off.
12246
12247 Rejected articles will also be put in this draft group (@pxref{Rejected
12248 Articles}).
12249
12250 @findex gnus-draft-send-all-messages
12251 @kindex D s (Draft)
12252 @findex gnus-draft-send-message
12253 @kindex D S (Draft)
12254 If you have lots of rejected messages you want to post (or mail) without
12255 doing further editing, you can use the @kbd{D s} command
12256 (@code{gnus-draft-send-message}). This command understands the
12257 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}). The @kbd{D S}
12258 command (@code{gnus-draft-send-all-messages}) will ship off all messages
12259 in the buffer.
12260
12261 @findex gnus-draft-toggle-sending
12262 @kindex D t (Draft)
12263 If you have some messages that you wish not to send, you can use the
12264 @kbd{D t} (@code{gnus-draft-toggle-sending}) command to mark the message
12265 as unsendable. This is a toggling command.
12266
12267
12268 @node Rejected Articles
12269 @section Rejected Articles
12270 @cindex rejected articles
12271
12272 Sometimes a news server will reject an article. Perhaps the server
12273 doesn't like your face. Perhaps it just feels miserable. Perhaps
12274 @emph{there be demons}. Perhaps you have included too much cited text.
12275 Perhaps the disk is full. Perhaps the server is down.
12276
12277 These situations are, of course, totally beyond the control of Gnus.
12278 (Gnus, of course, loves the way you look, always feels great, has angels
12279 fluttering around inside of it, doesn't care about how much cited text
12280 you include, never runs full and never goes down.) So Gnus saves these
12281 articles until some later time when the server feels better.
12282
12283 The rejected articles will automatically be put in a special draft group
12284 (@pxref{Drafts}). When the server comes back up again, you'd then
12285 typically enter that group and send all the articles off.
12286
12287 @node Signing and encrypting
12288 @section Signing and encrypting
12289 @cindex using gpg
12290 @cindex using s/mime
12291 @cindex using smime
12292
12293 Gnus can digitally sign and encrypt your messages, using vanilla
12294 @acronym{PGP} format or @acronym{PGP/MIME} or @acronym{S/MIME}. For
12295 decoding such messages, see the @code{mm-verify-option} and
12296 @code{mm-decrypt-option} options (@pxref{Security}).
12297
12298 @vindex gnus-message-replysign
12299 @vindex gnus-message-replyencrypt
12300 @vindex gnus-message-replysignencrypted
12301 Often, you would like to sign replies to people who send you signed
12302 messages. Even more often, you might want to encrypt messages which
12303 are in reply to encrypted messages. Gnus offers
12304 @code{gnus-message-replysign} to enable the former, and
12305 @code{gnus-message-replyencrypt} for the latter. In addition, setting
12306 @code{gnus-message-replysignencrypted} (on by default) will sign
12307 automatically encrypted messages.
12308
12309 Instructing @acronym{MML} to perform security operations on a
12310 @acronym{MIME} part is done using the @kbd{C-c C-m s} key map for
12311 signing and the @kbd{C-c C-m c} key map for encryption, as follows.
12312
12313 @table @kbd
12314
12315 @item C-c C-m s s
12316 @kindex C-c C-m s s (Message)
12317 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-smime
12318
12319 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12320
12321 @item C-c C-m s o
12322 @kindex C-c C-m s o (Message)
12323 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12324
12325 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12326
12327 @item C-c C-m s p
12328 @kindex C-c C-m s p (Message)
12329 @findex mml-secure-message-sign-pgp
12330
12331 Digitally sign current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12332
12333 @item C-c C-m c s
12334 @kindex C-c C-m c s (Message)
12335 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-smime
12336
12337 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{S/MIME}.
12338
12339 @item C-c C-m c o
12340 @kindex C-c C-m c o (Message)
12341 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgp
12342
12343 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP}.
12344
12345 @item C-c C-m c p
12346 @kindex C-c C-m c p (Message)
12347 @findex mml-secure-message-encrypt-pgpmime
12348
12349 Digitally encrypt current message using @acronym{PGP/MIME}.
12350
12351 @item C-c C-m C-n
12352 @kindex C-c C-m C-n (Message)
12353 @findex mml-unsecure-message
12354 Remove security related @acronym{MML} tags from message.
12355
12356 @end table
12357
12358 @xref{Security, ,Security, message, Message Manual}, for more information.
12359
12360 @node Select Methods
12361 @chapter Select Methods
12362 @cindex foreign groups
12363 @cindex select methods
12364
12365 A @dfn{foreign group} is a group not read by the usual (or
12366 default) means. It could be, for instance, a group from a different
12367 @acronym{NNTP} server, it could be a virtual group, or it could be your own
12368 personal mail group.
12369
12370 A foreign group (or any group, really) is specified by a @dfn{name} and
12371 a @dfn{select method}. To take the latter first, a select method is a
12372 list where the first element says what back end to use (e.g. @code{nntp},
12373 @code{nnspool}, @code{nnml}) and the second element is the @dfn{server
12374 name}. There may be additional elements in the select method, where the
12375 value may have special meaning for the back end in question.
12376
12377 One could say that a select method defines a @dfn{virtual server}---so
12378 we do just that (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
12379
12380 The @dfn{name} of the group is the name the back end will recognize the
12381 group as.
12382
12383 For instance, the group @samp{soc.motss} on the @acronym{NNTP} server
12384 @samp{some.where.edu} will have the name @samp{soc.motss} and select
12385 method @code{(nntp "some.where.edu")}. Gnus will call this group
12386 @samp{nntp+some.where.edu:soc.motss}, even though the @code{nntp}
12387 back end just knows this group as @samp{soc.motss}.
12388
12389 The different methods all have their peculiarities, of course.
12390
12391 @menu
12392 * Server Buffer:: Making and editing virtual servers.
12393 * Getting News:: Reading USENET news with Gnus.
12394 * Getting Mail:: Reading your personal mail with Gnus.
12395 * Browsing the Web:: Getting messages from a plethora of Web sources.
12396 * IMAP:: Using Gnus as a @acronym{IMAP} client.
12397 * Other Sources:: Reading directories, files, SOUP packets.
12398 * Combined Groups:: Combining groups into one group.
12399 * Email Based Diary:: Using mails to manage diary events in Gnus.
12400 * Gnus Unplugged:: Reading news and mail offline.
12401 @end menu
12402
12403
12404 @node Server Buffer
12405 @section Server Buffer
12406
12407 Traditionally, a @dfn{server} is a machine or a piece of software that
12408 one connects to, and then requests information from. Gnus does not
12409 connect directly to any real servers, but does all transactions through
12410 one back end or other. But that's just putting one layer more between
12411 the actual media and Gnus, so we might just as well say that each
12412 back end represents a virtual server.
12413
12414 For instance, the @code{nntp} back end may be used to connect to several
12415 different actual @acronym{NNTP} servers, or, perhaps, to many different ports
12416 on the same actual @acronym{NNTP} server. You tell Gnus which back end to
12417 use, and what parameters to set by specifying a @dfn{select method}.
12418
12419 These select method specifications can sometimes become quite
12420 complicated---say, for instance, that you want to read from the
12421 @acronym{NNTP} server @samp{news.funet.fi} on port number 13, which
12422 hangs if queried for @acronym{NOV} headers and has a buggy select. Ahem.
12423 Anyway, if you had to specify that for each group that used this
12424 server, that would be too much work, so Gnus offers a way of naming
12425 select methods, which is what you do in the server buffer.
12426
12427 To enter the server buffer, use the @kbd{^}
12428 (@code{gnus-group-enter-server-mode}) command in the group buffer.
12429
12430 @menu
12431 * Server Buffer Format:: You can customize the look of this buffer.
12432 * Server Commands:: Commands to manipulate servers.
12433 * Example Methods:: Examples server specifications.
12434 * Creating a Virtual Server:: An example session.
12435 * Server Variables:: Which variables to set.
12436 * Servers and Methods:: You can use server names as select methods.
12437 * Unavailable Servers:: Some servers you try to contact may be down.
12438 @end menu
12439
12440 @vindex gnus-server-mode-hook
12441 @code{gnus-server-mode-hook} is run when creating the server buffer.
12442
12443
12444 @node Server Buffer Format
12445 @subsection Server Buffer Format
12446 @cindex server buffer format
12447
12448 @vindex gnus-server-line-format
12449 You can change the look of the server buffer lines by changing the
12450 @code{gnus-server-line-format} variable. This is a @code{format}-like
12451 variable, with some simple extensions:
12452
12453 @table @samp
12454
12455 @item h
12456 How the news is fetched---the back end name.
12457
12458 @item n
12459 The name of this server.
12460
12461 @item w
12462 Where the news is to be fetched from---the address.
12463
12464 @item s
12465 The opened/closed/denied status of the server.
12466
12467 @item a
12468 Whether this server is agentized.
12469 @end table
12470
12471 @vindex gnus-server-mode-line-format
12472 The mode line can also be customized by using the
12473 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format} variable (@pxref{Mode Line
12474 Formatting}). The following specs are understood:
12475
12476 @table @samp
12477 @item S
12478 Server name.
12479
12480 @item M
12481 Server method.
12482 @end table
12483
12484 Also @pxref{Formatting Variables}.
12485
12486
12487 @node Server Commands
12488 @subsection Server Commands
12489 @cindex server commands
12490
12491 @table @kbd
12492
12493 @item v
12494 @kindex v (Server)
12495 @cindex keys, reserved for users (Server)
12496 The key @kbd{v} is reserved for users. You can bind it to some
12497 command or better use it as a prefix key.
12498
12499 @item a
12500 @kindex a (Server)
12501 @findex gnus-server-add-server
12502 Add a new server (@code{gnus-server-add-server}).
12503
12504 @item e
12505 @kindex e (Server)
12506 @findex gnus-server-edit-server
12507 Edit a server (@code{gnus-server-edit-server}).
12508
12509 @item SPACE
12510 @kindex SPACE (Server)
12511 @findex gnus-server-read-server
12512 Browse the current server (@code{gnus-server-read-server}).
12513
12514 @item q
12515 @kindex q (Server)
12516 @findex gnus-server-exit
12517 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-server-exit}).
12518
12519 @item k
12520 @kindex k (Server)
12521 @findex gnus-server-kill-server
12522 Kill the current server (@code{gnus-server-kill-server}).
12523
12524 @item y
12525 @kindex y (Server)
12526 @findex gnus-server-yank-server
12527 Yank the previously killed server (@code{gnus-server-yank-server}).
12528
12529 @item c
12530 @kindex c (Server)
12531 @findex gnus-server-copy-server
12532 Copy the current server (@code{gnus-server-copy-server}).
12533
12534 @item l
12535 @kindex l (Server)
12536 @findex gnus-server-list-servers
12537 List all servers (@code{gnus-server-list-servers}).
12538
12539 @item s
12540 @kindex s (Server)
12541 @findex gnus-server-scan-server
12542 Request that the server scan its sources for new articles
12543 (@code{gnus-server-scan-server}). This is mainly sensible with mail
12544 servers.
12545
12546 @item g
12547 @kindex g (Server)
12548 @findex gnus-server-regenerate-server
12549 Request that the server regenerate all its data structures
12550 (@code{gnus-server-regenerate-server}). This can be useful if you have
12551 a mail back end that has gotten out of sync.
12552
12553 @end table
12554
12555
12556 @node Example Methods
12557 @subsection Example Methods
12558
12559 Most select methods are pretty simple and self-explanatory:
12560
12561 @lisp
12562 (nntp "news.funet.fi")
12563 @end lisp
12564
12565 Reading directly from the spool is even simpler:
12566
12567 @lisp
12568 (nnspool "")
12569 @end lisp
12570
12571 As you can see, the first element in a select method is the name of the
12572 back end, and the second is the @dfn{address}, or @dfn{name}, if you
12573 will.
12574
12575 After these two elements, there may be an arbitrary number of
12576 @code{(@var{variable} @var{form})} pairs.
12577
12578 To go back to the first example---imagine that you want to read from
12579 port 15 on that machine. This is what the select method should
12580 look like then:
12581
12582 @lisp
12583 (nntp "news.funet.fi" (nntp-port-number 15))
12584 @end lisp
12585
12586 You should read the documentation to each back end to find out what
12587 variables are relevant, but here's an @code{nnmh} example:
12588
12589 @code{nnmh} is a mail back end that reads a spool-like structure. Say
12590 you have two structures that you wish to access: One is your private
12591 mail spool, and the other is a public one. Here's the possible spec for
12592 your private mail:
12593
12594 @lisp
12595 (nnmh "private" (nnmh-directory "~/private/mail/"))
12596 @end lisp
12597
12598 (This server is then called @samp{private}, but you may have guessed
12599 that.)
12600
12601 Here's the method for a public spool:
12602
12603 @lisp
12604 (nnmh "public"
12605 (nnmh-directory "/usr/information/spool/")
12606 (nnmh-get-new-mail nil))
12607 @end lisp
12608
12609 @cindex proxy
12610 @cindex firewall
12611
12612 If you are behind a firewall and only have access to the @acronym{NNTP}
12613 server from the firewall machine, you can instruct Gnus to @code{rlogin}
12614 on the firewall machine and telnet from there to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
12615 Doing this can be rather fiddly, but your virtual server definition
12616 should probably look something like this:
12617
12618 @lisp
12619 (nntp "firewall"
12620 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet)
12621 (nntp-via-address "the.firewall.machine")
12622 (nntp-address "the.real.nntp.host")
12623 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12624 @end lisp
12625
12626 If you want to use the wonderful @code{ssh} program to provide a
12627 compressed connection over the modem line, you could add the following
12628 configuration to the example above:
12629
12630 @lisp
12631 (nntp-via-rlogin-command "ssh")
12632 @end lisp
12633
12634 See also @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches}.
12635
12636 If you're behind a firewall, but have direct access to the outside world
12637 through a wrapper command like "runsocks", you could open a socksified
12638 telnet connection to the news server as follows:
12639
12640 @lisp
12641 (nntp "outside"
12642 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
12643 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-via-telnet)
12644 (nntp-address "the.news.server")
12645 (nntp-end-of-line "\n"))
12646 @end lisp
12647
12648 This means that you have to have set up @code{ssh-agent} correctly to
12649 provide automatic authorization, of course. And to get a compressed
12650 connection, you have to have the @samp{Compression} option in the
12651 @code{ssh} @file{config} file.
12652
12653
12654 @node Creating a Virtual Server
12655 @subsection Creating a Virtual Server
12656
12657 If you're saving lots of articles in the cache by using persistent
12658 articles, you may want to create a virtual server to read the cache.
12659
12660 First you need to add a new server. The @kbd{a} command does that. It
12661 would probably be best to use @code{nnml} to read the cache. You
12662 could also use @code{nnspool} or @code{nnmh}, though.
12663
12664 Type @kbd{a nnml RET cache RET}.
12665
12666 You should now have a brand new @code{nnml} virtual server called
12667 @samp{cache}. You now need to edit it to have the right definitions.
12668 Type @kbd{e} to edit the server. You'll be entered into a buffer that
12669 will contain the following:
12670
12671 @lisp
12672 (nnml "cache")
12673 @end lisp
12674
12675 Change that to:
12676
12677 @lisp
12678 (nnml "cache"
12679 (nnml-directory "~/News/cache/")
12680 (nnml-active-file "~/News/cache/active"))
12681 @end lisp
12682
12683 Type @kbd{C-c C-c} to return to the server buffer. If you now press
12684 @kbd{RET} over this virtual server, you should be entered into a browse
12685 buffer, and you should be able to enter any of the groups displayed.
12686
12687
12688 @node Server Variables
12689 @subsection Server Variables
12690 @cindex server variables
12691 @cindex server parameters
12692
12693 One sticky point when defining variables (both on back ends and in Emacs
12694 in general) is that some variables are typically initialized from other
12695 variables when the definition of the variables is being loaded. If you
12696 change the ``base'' variable after the variables have been loaded, you
12697 won't change the ``derived'' variables.
12698
12699 This typically affects directory and file variables. For instance,
12700 @code{nnml-directory} is @file{~/Mail/} by default, and all @code{nnml}
12701 directory variables are initialized from that variable, so
12702 @code{nnml-active-file} will be @file{~/Mail/active}. If you define a
12703 new virtual @code{nnml} server, it will @emph{not} suffice to set just
12704 @code{nnml-directory}---you have to explicitly set all the file
12705 variables to be what you want them to be. For a complete list of
12706 variables for each back end, see each back end's section later in this
12707 manual, but here's an example @code{nnml} definition:
12708
12709 @lisp
12710 (nnml "public"
12711 (nnml-directory "~/my-mail/")
12712 (nnml-active-file "~/my-mail/active")
12713 (nnml-newsgroups-file "~/my-mail/newsgroups"))
12714 @end lisp
12715
12716 Server variables are often called @dfn{server parameters}.
12717
12718 @node Servers and Methods
12719 @subsection Servers and Methods
12720
12721 Wherever you would normally use a select method
12722 (e.g. @code{gnus-secondary-select-method}, in the group select method,
12723 when browsing a foreign server) you can use a virtual server name
12724 instead. This could potentially save lots of typing. And it's nice all
12725 over.
12726
12727
12728 @node Unavailable Servers
12729 @subsection Unavailable Servers
12730
12731 If a server seems to be unreachable, Gnus will mark that server as
12732 @code{denied}. That means that any subsequent attempt to make contact
12733 with that server will just be ignored. ``It can't be opened,'' Gnus
12734 will tell you, without making the least effort to see whether that is
12735 actually the case or not.
12736
12737 That might seem quite naughty, but it does make sense most of the time.
12738 Let's say you have 10 groups subscribed to on server
12739 @samp{nephelococcygia.com}. This server is located somewhere quite far
12740 away from you and the machine is quite slow, so it takes 1 minute just
12741 to find out that it refuses connection to you today. If Gnus were to
12742 attempt to do that 10 times, you'd be quite annoyed, so Gnus won't
12743 attempt to do that. Once it has gotten a single ``connection refused'',
12744 it will regard that server as ``down''.
12745
12746 So, what happens if the machine was only feeling unwell temporarily?
12747 How do you test to see whether the machine has come up again?
12748
12749 You jump to the server buffer (@pxref{Server Buffer}) and poke it
12750 with the following commands:
12751
12752 @table @kbd
12753
12754 @item O
12755 @kindex O (Server)
12756 @findex gnus-server-open-server
12757 Try to establish connection to the server on the current line
12758 (@code{gnus-server-open-server}).
12759
12760 @item C
12761 @kindex C (Server)
12762 @findex gnus-server-close-server
12763 Close the connection (if any) to the server
12764 (@code{gnus-server-close-server}).
12765
12766 @item D
12767 @kindex D (Server)
12768 @findex gnus-server-deny-server
12769 Mark the current server as unreachable
12770 (@code{gnus-server-deny-server}).
12771
12772 @item M-o
12773 @kindex M-o (Server)
12774 @findex gnus-server-open-all-servers
12775 Open the connections to all servers in the buffer
12776 (@code{gnus-server-open-all-servers}).
12777
12778 @item M-c
12779 @kindex M-c (Server)
12780 @findex gnus-server-close-all-servers
12781 Close the connections to all servers in the buffer
12782 (@code{gnus-server-close-all-servers}).
12783
12784 @item R
12785 @kindex R (Server)
12786 @findex gnus-server-remove-denials
12787 Remove all marks to whether Gnus was denied connection from any servers
12788 (@code{gnus-server-remove-denials}).
12789
12790 @item L
12791 @kindex L (Server)
12792 @findex gnus-server-offline-server
12793 Set server status to offline (@code{gnus-server-offline-server}).
12794
12795 @end table
12796
12797
12798 @node Getting News
12799 @section Getting News
12800 @cindex reading news
12801 @cindex news back ends
12802
12803 A newsreader is normally used for reading news. Gnus currently provides
12804 only two methods of getting news---it can read from an @acronym{NNTP} server,
12805 or it can read from a local spool.
12806
12807 @menu
12808 * NNTP:: Reading news from an @acronym{NNTP} server.
12809 * News Spool:: Reading news from the local spool.
12810 @end menu
12811
12812
12813 @node NNTP
12814 @subsection NNTP
12815 @cindex nntp
12816
12817 Subscribing to a foreign group from an @acronym{NNTP} server is rather easy.
12818 You just specify @code{nntp} as method and the address of the @acronym{NNTP}
12819 server as the, uhm, address.
12820
12821 If the @acronym{NNTP} server is located at a non-standard port, setting the
12822 third element of the select method to this port number should allow you
12823 to connect to the right port. You'll have to edit the group info for
12824 that (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
12825
12826 The name of the foreign group can be the same as a native group. In
12827 fact, you can subscribe to the same group from as many different servers
12828 you feel like. There will be no name collisions.
12829
12830 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nntp}
12831 server:
12832
12833 @table @code
12834
12835 @item nntp-server-opened-hook
12836 @vindex nntp-server-opened-hook
12837 @cindex @sc{mode reader}
12838 @cindex authinfo
12839 @cindex authentication
12840 @cindex nntp authentication
12841 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12842 @findex nntp-send-mode-reader
12843 is run after a connection has been made. It can be used to send
12844 commands to the @acronym{NNTP} server after it has been contacted. By
12845 default it sends the command @code{MODE READER} to the server with the
12846 @code{nntp-send-mode-reader} function. This function should always be
12847 present in this hook.
12848
12849 @item nntp-authinfo-function
12850 @vindex nntp-authinfo-function
12851 @findex nntp-send-authinfo
12852 @vindex nntp-authinfo-file
12853 This function will be used to send @samp{AUTHINFO} to the @acronym{NNTP}
12854 server. The default function is @code{nntp-send-authinfo}, which looks
12855 through your @file{~/.authinfo} (or whatever you've set the
12856 @code{nntp-authinfo-file} variable to) for applicable entries. If none
12857 are found, it will prompt you for a login name and a password. The
12858 format of the @file{~/.authinfo} file is (almost) the same as the
12859 @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file, which is defined in the @code{ftp}
12860 manual page, but here are the salient facts:
12861
12862 @enumerate
12863 @item
12864 The file contains one or more line, each of which define one server.
12865
12866 @item
12867 Each line may contain an arbitrary number of token/value pairs.
12868
12869 The valid tokens include @samp{machine}, @samp{login}, @samp{password},
12870 @samp{default}. In addition Gnus introduces two new tokens, not present
12871 in the original @file{.netrc}/@code{ftp} syntax, namely @samp{port} and
12872 @samp{force}. (This is the only way the @file{.authinfo} file format
12873 deviates from the @file{.netrc} file format.) @samp{port} is used to
12874 indicate what port on the server the credentials apply to and
12875 @samp{force} is explained below.
12876
12877 @end enumerate
12878
12879 Here's an example file:
12880
12881 @example
12882 machine news.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis
12883 machine nntp.ifi.uio.no login larsi force yes
12884 @end example
12885
12886 The token/value pairs may appear in any order; @samp{machine} doesn't
12887 have to be first, for instance.
12888
12889 In this example, both login name and password have been supplied for the
12890 former server, while the latter has only the login name listed, and the
12891 user will be prompted for the password. The latter also has the
12892 @samp{force} tag, which means that the authinfo will be sent to the
12893 @var{nntp} server upon connection; the default (i.e., when there is not
12894 @samp{force} tag) is to not send authinfo to the @var{nntp} server
12895 until the @var{nntp} server asks for it.
12896
12897 You can also add @samp{default} lines that will apply to all servers
12898 that don't have matching @samp{machine} lines.
12899
12900 @example
12901 default force yes
12902 @end example
12903
12904 This will force sending @samp{AUTHINFO} commands to all servers not
12905 previously mentioned.
12906
12907 Remember to not leave the @file{~/.authinfo} file world-readable.
12908
12909 @item nntp-server-action-alist
12910 @vindex nntp-server-action-alist
12911 This is a list of regexps to match on server types and actions to be
12912 taken when matches are made. For instance, if you want Gnus to beep
12913 every time you connect to innd, you could say something like:
12914
12915 @lisp
12916 (setq nntp-server-action-alist
12917 '(("innd" (ding))))
12918 @end lisp
12919
12920 You probably don't want to do that, though.
12921
12922 The default value is
12923
12924 @lisp
12925 '(("nntpd 1\\.5\\.11t"
12926 (remove-hook 'nntp-server-opened-hook
12927 'nntp-send-mode-reader)))
12928 @end lisp
12929
12930 This ensures that Gnus doesn't send the @code{MODE READER} command to
12931 nntpd 1.5.11t, since that command chokes that server, I've been told.
12932
12933 @item nntp-maximum-request
12934 @vindex nntp-maximum-request
12935 If the @acronym{NNTP} server doesn't support @acronym{NOV} headers, this back end
12936 will collect headers by sending a series of @code{head} commands. To
12937 speed things up, the back end sends lots of these commands without
12938 waiting for reply, and then reads all the replies. This is controlled
12939 by the @code{nntp-maximum-request} variable, and is 400 by default. If
12940 your network is buggy, you should set this to 1.
12941
12942 @item nntp-connection-timeout
12943 @vindex nntp-connection-timeout
12944 If you have lots of foreign @code{nntp} groups that you connect to
12945 regularly, you're sure to have problems with @acronym{NNTP} servers not
12946 responding properly, or being too loaded to reply within reasonable
12947 time. This is can lead to awkward problems, which can be helped
12948 somewhat by setting @code{nntp-connection-timeout}. This is an integer
12949 that says how many seconds the @code{nntp} back end should wait for a
12950 connection before giving up. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default,
12951 no timeouts are done.
12952
12953 @item nntp-nov-is-evil
12954 @vindex nntp-nov-is-evil
12955 If the @acronym{NNTP} server does not support @acronym{NOV}, you could set this
12956 variable to @code{t}, but @code{nntp} usually checks automatically whether @acronym{NOV}
12957 can be used.
12958
12959 @item nntp-xover-commands
12960 @vindex nntp-xover-commands
12961 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
12962 @cindex XOVER
12963 List of strings used as commands to fetch @acronym{NOV} lines from a
12964 server. The default value of this variable is @code{("XOVER"
12965 "XOVERVIEW")}.
12966
12967 @item nntp-nov-gap
12968 @vindex nntp-nov-gap
12969 @code{nntp} normally sends just one big request for @acronym{NOV} lines to
12970 the server. The server responds with one huge list of lines. However,
12971 if you have read articles 2-5000 in the group, and only want to read
12972 article 1 and 5001, that means that @code{nntp} will fetch 4999 @acronym{NOV}
12973 lines that you will not need. This variable says how
12974 big a gap between two consecutive articles is allowed to be before the
12975 @code{XOVER} request is split into several request. Note that if your
12976 network is fast, setting this variable to a really small number means
12977 that fetching will probably be slower. If this variable is @code{nil},
12978 @code{nntp} will never split requests. The default is 5.
12979
12980 @item nntp-xref-number-is-evil
12981 @vindex nntp-xref-number-is-evil
12982 When Gnus refers to an article having the @code{Message-ID} that a user
12983 specifies or having the @code{Message-ID} of the parent article of the
12984 current one (@pxref{Finding the Parent}), Gnus sends a @code{HEAD}
12985 command to the @acronym{NNTP} server to know where it is, and the server
12986 returns the data containing the pairs of a group and an article number
12987 in the @code{Xref} header. Gnus normally uses the article number to
12988 refer to the article if the data shows that that article is in the
12989 current group, while it uses the @code{Message-ID} otherwise. However,
12990 some news servers, e.g., ones running Diablo, run multiple engines
12991 having the same articles but article numbers are not kept synchronized
12992 between them. In that case, the article number that appears in the
12993 @code{Xref} header varies by which engine is chosen, so you cannot refer
12994 to the parent article that is in the current group, for instance. If
12995 you connect to such a server, set this variable to a non-@code{nil}
12996 value, and Gnus never uses article numbers. For example:
12997
12998 @lisp
12999 (setq gnus-select-method
13000 '(nntp "newszilla"
13001 (nntp-address "newszilla.example.com")
13002 (nntp-xref-number-is-evil t)
13003 @dots{}))
13004 @end lisp
13005
13006 The default value of this server variable is @code{nil}.
13007
13008 @item nntp-prepare-server-hook
13009 @vindex nntp-prepare-server-hook
13010 A hook run before attempting to connect to an @acronym{NNTP} server.
13011
13012 @item nntp-record-commands
13013 @vindex nntp-record-commands
13014 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nntp} will log all commands it sends to the
13015 @acronym{NNTP} server (along with a timestamp) in the @samp{*nntp-log*}
13016 buffer. This is useful if you are debugging a Gnus/@acronym{NNTP} connection
13017 that doesn't seem to work.
13018
13019 @item nntp-open-connection-function
13020 @vindex nntp-open-connection-function
13021 It is possible to customize how the connection to the nntp server will
13022 be opened. If you specify an @code{nntp-open-connection-function}
13023 parameter, Gnus will use that function to establish the connection.
13024 Six pre-made functions are supplied. These functions can be grouped in
13025 two categories: direct connection functions (four pre-made), and
13026 indirect ones (two pre-made).
13027
13028 @item nntp-never-echoes-commands
13029 @vindex nntp-never-echoes-commands
13030 Non-@code{nil} means the nntp server never echoes commands. It is
13031 reported that some nntps server doesn't echo commands. So, you may want
13032 to set this to non-@code{nil} in the method for such a server setting
13033 @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream} for
13034 example. The default value is @code{nil}. Note that the
13035 @code{nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands} variable
13036 overrides the @code{nil} value of this variable.
13037
13038 @item nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13039 @vindex nntp-open-connection-functions-never-echo-commands
13040 List of functions that never echo commands. Add or set a function which
13041 you set to @code{nntp-open-connection-function} to this list if it does
13042 not echo commands. Note that a non-@code{nil} value of the
13043 @code{nntp-never-echoes-commands} variable overrides this variable. The
13044 default value is @code{(nntp-open-network-stream)}.
13045
13046 @item nntp-prepare-post-hook
13047 @vindex nntp-prepare-post-hook
13048 A hook run just before posting an article. If there is no
13049 @code{Message-ID} header in the article and the news server provides the
13050 recommended ID, it will be added to the article before running this
13051 hook. It is useful to make @code{Cancel-Lock} headers even if you
13052 inhibit Gnus to add a @code{Message-ID} header, you could say:
13053
13054 @lisp
13055 (add-hook 'nntp-prepare-post-hook 'canlock-insert-header)
13056 @end lisp
13057
13058 Note that not all servers support the recommended ID. This works for
13059 INN versions 2.3.0 and later, for instance.
13060
13061 @end table
13062
13063 @menu
13064 * Direct Functions:: Connecting directly to the server.
13065 * Indirect Functions:: Connecting indirectly to the server.
13066 * Common Variables:: Understood by several connection functions.
13067 @end menu
13068
13069
13070 @node Direct Functions
13071 @subsubsection Direct Functions
13072 @cindex direct connection functions
13073
13074 These functions are called direct because they open a direct connection
13075 between your machine and the @acronym{NNTP} server. The behavior of these
13076 functions is also affected by commonly understood variables
13077 (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13078
13079 @table @code
13080 @findex nntp-open-network-stream
13081 @item nntp-open-network-stream
13082 This is the default, and simply connects to some port or other on the
13083 remote system.
13084
13085 @findex nntp-open-tls-stream
13086 @item nntp-open-tls-stream
13087 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13088 this you must have @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/, GNUTLS}
13089 installed. You then define a server as follows:
13090
13091 @lisp
13092 ;; @r{"nntps" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13093 ;; @r{however, @samp{gnutls-cli -p} doesn't like named ports.}
13094 ;;
13095 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13096 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-tls-stream)
13097 (nntp-port-number )
13098 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13099 @end lisp
13100
13101 @findex nntp-open-ssl-stream
13102 @item nntp-open-ssl-stream
13103 Opens a connection to a server over a @dfn{secure} channel. To use
13104 this you must have @uref{http://www.openssl.org, OpenSSL} or
13105 @uref{ftp://ftp.psy.uq.oz.au/pub/Crypto/SSL, SSLeay} installed. You
13106 then define a server as follows:
13107
13108 @lisp
13109 ;; @r{"snews" is port 563 and is predefined in our @file{/etc/services}}
13110 ;; @r{however, @samp{openssl s_client -port} doesn't like named ports.}
13111 ;;
13112 (nntp "snews.bar.com"
13113 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-ssl-stream)
13114 (nntp-port-number 563)
13115 (nntp-address "snews.bar.com"))
13116 @end lisp
13117
13118 @findex nntp-open-telnet-stream
13119 @item nntp-open-telnet-stream
13120 Opens a connection to an @acronym{NNTP} server by simply @samp{telnet}'ing
13121 it. You might wonder why this function exists, since we have the
13122 default @code{nntp-open-network-stream} which would do the job. (One
13123 of) the reason(s) is that if you are behind a firewall but have direct
13124 connections to the outside world thanks to a command wrapper like
13125 @code{runsocks}, you can use it like this:
13126
13127 @lisp
13128 (nntp "socksified"
13129 (nntp-pre-command "runsocks")
13130 (nntp-open-connection-function nntp-open-telnet-stream)
13131 (nntp-address "the.news.server"))
13132 @end lisp
13133
13134 With the default method, you would need to wrap your whole Emacs
13135 session, which is not a good idea.
13136 @end table
13137
13138
13139 @node Indirect Functions
13140 @subsubsection Indirect Functions
13141 @cindex indirect connection functions
13142
13143 These functions are called indirect because they connect to an
13144 intermediate host before actually connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13145 All of these functions and related variables are also said to belong to
13146 the ``via'' family of connection: they're all prefixed with ``via'' to make
13147 things cleaner. The behavior of these functions is also affected by
13148 commonly understood variables (@pxref{Common Variables}).
13149
13150 @table @code
13151 @item nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13152 @findex nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet
13153 Does an @samp{rlogin} on a remote system, and then does a @samp{telnet}
13154 to the real @acronym{NNTP} server from there. This is useful for instance if
13155 you need to connect to a firewall machine first.
13156
13157 @code{nntp-open-via-rlogin-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13158
13159 @table @code
13160 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command
13161 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command
13162 Command used to log in on the intermediate host. The default is
13163 @samp{rsh}, but @samp{ssh} is a popular alternative.
13164
13165 @item nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13166 @vindex nntp-via-rlogin-command-switches
13167 List of strings to be used as the switches to
13168 @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}. The default is @code{nil}. If you use
13169 @samp{ssh} for @code{nntp-via-rlogin-command}, you may set this to
13170 @samp{("-C")} in order to compress all data connections, otherwise set
13171 this to @samp{("-t" "-e" "none")} or @samp{("-C" "-t" "-e" "none")} if
13172 the telnet command requires a pseudo-tty allocation on an intermediate
13173 host.
13174 @end table
13175
13176 @item nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13177 @findex nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet
13178 Does essentially the same, but uses @samp{telnet} instead of
13179 @samp{rlogin} to connect to the intermediate host.
13180
13181 @code{nntp-open-via-telnet-and-telnet}-specific variables:
13182
13183 @table @code
13184 @item nntp-via-telnet-command
13185 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-command
13186 Command used to @code{telnet} the intermediate host. The default is
13187 @samp{telnet}.
13188
13189 @item nntp-via-telnet-switches
13190 @vindex nntp-via-telnet-switches
13191 List of strings to be used as the switches to the
13192 @code{nntp-via-telnet-command} command. The default is @samp{("-8")}.
13193
13194 @item nntp-via-user-password
13195 @vindex nntp-via-user-password
13196 Password to use when logging in on the intermediate host.
13197
13198 @item nntp-via-envuser
13199 @vindex nntp-via-envuser
13200 If non-@code{nil}, the intermediate @code{telnet} session (client and
13201 server both) will support the @code{ENVIRON} option and not prompt for
13202 login name. This works for Solaris @code{telnet}, for instance.
13203
13204 @item nntp-via-shell-prompt
13205 @vindex nntp-via-shell-prompt
13206 Regexp matching the shell prompt on the intermediate host. The default
13207 is @samp{bash\\|\$ *\r?$\\|> *\r?}.
13208
13209 @end table
13210
13211 @end table
13212
13213
13214 Here are some additional variables that are understood by all the above
13215 functions:
13216
13217 @table @code
13218
13219 @item nntp-via-user-name
13220 @vindex nntp-via-user-name
13221 User name to use when connecting to the intermediate host.
13222
13223 @item nntp-via-address
13224 @vindex nntp-via-address
13225 Address of the intermediate host to connect to.
13226
13227 @end table
13228
13229
13230 @node Common Variables
13231 @subsubsection Common Variables
13232
13233 The following variables affect the behavior of all, or several of the
13234 pre-made connection functions. When not specified, all functions are
13235 affected (the values of the following variables will be used as the
13236 default if each virtual @code{nntp} server doesn't specify those server
13237 variables individually).
13238
13239 @table @code
13240
13241 @item nntp-pre-command
13242 @vindex nntp-pre-command
13243 A command wrapper to use when connecting through a non native
13244 connection function (all except @code{nntp-open-network-stream},
13245 @code{nntp-open-tls-stream}, and @code{nntp-open-ssl-stream}). This is
13246 where you would put a @samp{SOCKS} wrapper for instance.
13247
13248 @item nntp-address
13249 @vindex nntp-address
13250 The address of the @acronym{NNTP} server.
13251
13252 @item nntp-port-number
13253 @vindex nntp-port-number
13254 Port number to connect to the @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13255 @samp{nntp}. If you use @acronym{NNTP} over
13256 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you may want to use integer ports rather
13257 than named ports (i.e, use @samp{563} instead of @samp{snews} or
13258 @samp{nntps}), because external @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} tools may
13259 not work with named ports.
13260
13261 @item nntp-end-of-line
13262 @vindex nntp-end-of-line
13263 String to use as end-of-line marker when talking to the @acronym{NNTP}
13264 server. This is @samp{\r\n} by default, but should be @samp{\n} when
13265 using a non native connection function.
13266
13267 @item nntp-telnet-command
13268 @vindex nntp-telnet-command
13269 Command to use when connecting to the @acronym{NNTP} server through
13270 @samp{telnet}. This is @emph{not} for an intermediate host. This is
13271 just for the real @acronym{NNTP} server. The default is
13272 @samp{telnet}.
13273
13274 @item nntp-telnet-switches
13275 @vindex nntp-telnet-switches
13276 A list of switches to pass to @code{nntp-telnet-command}. The default
13277 is @samp{("-8")}.
13278
13279 @end table
13280
13281
13282 @node News Spool
13283 @subsection News Spool
13284 @cindex nnspool
13285 @cindex news spool
13286
13287 Subscribing to a foreign group from the local spool is extremely easy,
13288 and might be useful, for instance, to speed up reading groups that
13289 contain very big articles---@samp{alt.binaries.pictures.furniture}, for
13290 instance.
13291
13292 Anyway, you just specify @code{nnspool} as the method and @code{""} (or
13293 anything else) as the address.
13294
13295 If you have access to a local spool, you should probably use that as the
13296 native select method (@pxref{Finding the News}). It is normally faster
13297 than using an @code{nntp} select method, but might not be. It depends.
13298 You just have to try to find out what's best at your site.
13299
13300 @table @code
13301
13302 @item nnspool-inews-program
13303 @vindex nnspool-inews-program
13304 Program used to post an article.
13305
13306 @item nnspool-inews-switches
13307 @vindex nnspool-inews-switches
13308 Parameters given to the inews program when posting an article.
13309
13310 @item nnspool-spool-directory
13311 @vindex nnspool-spool-directory
13312 Where @code{nnspool} looks for the articles. This is normally
13313 @file{/usr/spool/news/}.
13314
13315 @item nnspool-nov-directory
13316 @vindex nnspool-nov-directory
13317 Where @code{nnspool} will look for @acronym{NOV} files. This is normally@*
13318 @file{/usr/spool/news/over.view/}.
13319
13320 @item nnspool-lib-dir
13321 @vindex nnspool-lib-dir
13322 Where the news lib dir is (@file{/usr/lib/news/} by default).
13323
13324 @item nnspool-active-file
13325 @vindex nnspool-active-file
13326 The name of the active file.
13327
13328 @item nnspool-newsgroups-file
13329 @vindex nnspool-newsgroups-file
13330 The name of the group descriptions file.
13331
13332 @item nnspool-history-file
13333 @vindex nnspool-history-file
13334 The name of the news history file.
13335
13336 @item nnspool-active-times-file
13337 @vindex nnspool-active-times-file
13338 The name of the active date file.
13339
13340 @item nnspool-nov-is-evil
13341 @vindex nnspool-nov-is-evil
13342 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnspool} won't try to use any @acronym{NOV} files
13343 that it finds.
13344
13345 @item nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13346 @vindex nnspool-sift-nov-with-sed
13347 @cindex sed
13348 If non-@code{nil}, which is the default, use @code{sed} to get the
13349 relevant portion from the overview file. If @code{nil},
13350 @code{nnspool} will load the entire file into a buffer and process it
13351 there.
13352
13353 @end table
13354
13355
13356 @node Getting Mail
13357 @section Getting Mail
13358 @cindex reading mail
13359 @cindex mail
13360
13361 Reading mail with a newsreader---isn't that just plain WeIrD? But of
13362 course.
13363
13364 @menu
13365 * Mail in a Newsreader:: Important introductory notes.
13366 * Getting Started Reading Mail:: A simple cookbook example.
13367 * Splitting Mail:: How to create mail groups.
13368 * Mail Sources:: How to tell Gnus where to get mail from.
13369 * Mail Back End Variables:: Variables for customizing mail handling.
13370 * Fancy Mail Splitting:: Gnus can do hairy splitting of incoming mail.
13371 * Group Mail Splitting:: Use group customize to drive mail splitting.
13372 * Incorporating Old Mail:: What about the old mail you have?
13373 * Expiring Mail:: Getting rid of unwanted mail.
13374 * Washing Mail:: Removing cruft from the mail you get.
13375 * Duplicates:: Dealing with duplicated mail.
13376 * Not Reading Mail:: Using mail back ends for reading other files.
13377 * Choosing a Mail Back End:: Gnus can read a variety of mail formats.
13378 @end menu
13379
13380
13381 @node Mail in a Newsreader
13382 @subsection Mail in a Newsreader
13383
13384 If you are used to traditional mail readers, but have decided to switch
13385 to reading mail with Gnus, you may find yourself experiencing something
13386 of a culture shock.
13387
13388 Gnus does not behave like traditional mail readers. If you want to make
13389 it behave that way, you can, but it's an uphill battle.
13390
13391 Gnus, by default, handles all its groups using the same approach. This
13392 approach is very newsreaderly---you enter a group, see the new/unread
13393 messages, and when you read the messages, they get marked as read, and
13394 you don't see them any more. (Unless you explicitly ask for them.)
13395
13396 In particular, you do not do anything explicitly to delete messages.
13397
13398 Does this mean that all the messages that have been marked as read are
13399 deleted? How awful!
13400
13401 But, no, it means that old messages are @dfn{expired} according to some
13402 scheme or other. For news messages, the expire process is controlled by
13403 the news administrator; for mail, the expire process is controlled by
13404 you. The expire process for mail is covered in depth in @ref{Expiring
13405 Mail}.
13406
13407 What many Gnus users find, after using it a while for both news and
13408 mail, is that the transport mechanism has very little to do with how
13409 they want to treat a message.
13410
13411 Many people subscribe to several mailing lists. These are transported
13412 via @acronym{SMTP}, and are therefore mail. But we might go for weeks without
13413 answering, or even reading these messages very carefully. We may not
13414 need to save them because if we should need to read one again, they are
13415 archived somewhere else.
13416
13417 Some people have local news groups which have only a handful of readers.
13418 These are transported via @acronym{NNTP}, and are therefore news. But we may need
13419 to read and answer a large fraction of the messages very carefully in
13420 order to do our work. And there may not be an archive, so we may need
13421 to save the interesting messages the same way we would personal mail.
13422
13423 The important distinction turns out to be not the transport mechanism,
13424 but other factors such as how interested we are in the subject matter,
13425 or how easy it is to retrieve the message if we need to read it again.
13426
13427 Gnus provides many options for sorting mail into ``groups'' which behave
13428 like newsgroups, and for treating each group (whether mail or news)
13429 differently.
13430
13431 Some users never get comfortable using the Gnus (ahem) paradigm and wish
13432 that Gnus should grow up and be a male, er, mail reader. It is possible
13433 to whip Gnus into a more mailreaderly being, but, as said before, it's
13434 not easy. People who prefer proper mail readers should try @sc{vm}
13435 instead, which is an excellent, and proper, mail reader.
13436
13437 I don't mean to scare anybody off, but I want to make it clear that you
13438 may be required to learn a new way of thinking about messages. After
13439 you've been subjected to The Gnus Way, you will come to love it. I can
13440 guarantee it. (At least the guy who sold me the Emacs Subliminal
13441 Brain-Washing Functions that I've put into Gnus did guarantee it. You
13442 Will Be Assimilated. You Love Gnus. You Love The Gnus Mail Way.
13443 You Do.)
13444
13445
13446 @node Getting Started Reading Mail
13447 @subsection Getting Started Reading Mail
13448
13449 It's quite easy to use Gnus to read your new mail. You just plonk the
13450 mail back end of your choice into @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods},
13451 and things will happen automatically.
13452
13453 For instance, if you want to use @code{nnml} (which is a ``one file per
13454 mail'' back end), you could put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
13455
13456 @lisp
13457 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
13458 @end lisp
13459
13460 Now, the next time you start Gnus, this back end will be queried for new
13461 articles, and it will move all the messages in your spool file to its
13462 directory, which is @file{~/Mail/} by default. The new group that will
13463 be created (@samp{mail.misc}) will be subscribed, and you can read it
13464 like any other group.
13465
13466 You will probably want to split the mail into several groups, though:
13467
13468 @lisp
13469 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13470 '(("junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13471 ("crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13472 ("other" "")))
13473 @end lisp
13474
13475 This will result in three new @code{nnml} mail groups being created:
13476 @samp{nnml:junk}, @samp{nnml:crazy}, and @samp{nnml:other}. All the
13477 mail that doesn't fit into the first two groups will be placed in the
13478 last group.
13479
13480 This should be sufficient for reading mail with Gnus. You might want to
13481 give the other sections in this part of the manual a perusal, though.
13482 Especially @pxref{Choosing a Mail Back End} and @pxref{Expiring Mail}.
13483
13484
13485 @node Splitting Mail
13486 @subsection Splitting Mail
13487 @cindex splitting mail
13488 @cindex mail splitting
13489 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
13490
13491 @vindex nnmail-split-methods
13492 The @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable says how the incoming mail is
13493 to be split into groups.
13494
13495 @lisp
13496 (setq nnmail-split-methods
13497 '(("mail.junk" "^From:.*Lars Ingebrigtsen")
13498 ("mail.crazy" "^Subject:.*die\\|^Organization:.*flabby")
13499 ("mail.other" "")))
13500 @end lisp
13501
13502 This variable is a list of lists, where the first element of each of
13503 these lists is the name of the mail group (they do not have to be called
13504 something beginning with @samp{mail}, by the way), and the second
13505 element is a regular expression used on the header of each mail to
13506 determine if it belongs in this mail group. The first string may
13507 contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by @code{replace-match} to
13508 insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For instance:
13509
13510 @lisp
13511 ("list.\\1" "From:.* \\(.*\\)-list@@majordomo.com")
13512 @end lisp
13513
13514 @noindent
13515 In that case, @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether
13516 the inserted text should be made lowercase. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
13517
13518 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
13519 called narrowed to the headers with the first element of the rule as the
13520 argument. It should return a non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the
13521 mail belongs in that group.
13522
13523 @cindex @samp{bogus} group
13524 The last of these groups should always be a general one, and the regular
13525 expression should @emph{always} be @samp{""} so that it matches any mails
13526 that haven't been matched by any of the other regexps. (These rules are
13527 processed from the beginning of the alist toward the end. The first rule
13528 to make a match will ``win'', unless you have crossposting enabled. In
13529 that case, all matching rules will ``win''.) If no rule matched, the mail
13530 will end up in the @samp{bogus} group. When new groups are created by
13531 splitting mail, you may want to run @code{gnus-group-find-new-groups} to
13532 see the new groups. This also applies to the @samp{bogus} group.
13533
13534 If you like to tinker with this yourself, you can set this variable to a
13535 function of your choice. This function will be called without any
13536 arguments in a buffer narrowed to the headers of an incoming mail
13537 message. The function should return a list of group names that it
13538 thinks should carry this mail message.
13539
13540 Note that the mail back ends are free to maul the poor, innocent,
13541 incoming headers all they want to. They all add @code{Lines} headers;
13542 some add @code{X-Gnus-Group} headers; most rename the Unix mbox
13543 @code{From<SPACE>} line to something else.
13544
13545 @vindex nnmail-crosspost
13546 The mail back ends all support cross-posting. If several regexps match,
13547 the mail will be ``cross-posted'' to all those groups.
13548 @code{nnmail-crosspost} says whether to use this mechanism or not. Note
13549 that no articles are crossposted to the general (@samp{""}) group.
13550
13551 @vindex nnmail-crosspost-link-function
13552 @cindex crosspost
13553 @cindex links
13554 @code{nnmh} and @code{nnml} makes crossposts by creating hard links to
13555 the crossposted articles. However, not all file systems support hard
13556 links. If that's the case for you, set
13557 @code{nnmail-crosspost-link-function} to @code{copy-file}. (This
13558 variable is @code{add-name-to-file} by default.)
13559
13560 @kindex M-x nnmail-split-history
13561 @findex nnmail-split-history
13562 If you wish to see where the previous mail split put the messages, you
13563 can use the @kbd{M-x nnmail-split-history} command. If you wish to see
13564 where re-spooling messages would put the messages, you can use
13565 @code{gnus-summary-respool-trace} and related commands (@pxref{Mail
13566 Group Commands}).
13567
13568 @vindex nnmail-split-header-length-limit
13569 Header lines longer than the value of
13570 @code{nnmail-split-header-length-limit} are excluded from the split
13571 function.
13572
13573 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes
13574 @vindex nnmail-mail-splitting-charset
13575 By default, splitting does not decode headers, so you can not match on
13576 non-@acronym{ASCII} strings. But it is useful if you want to match
13577 articles based on the raw header data. To enable it, set the
13578 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} variable to a non-@code{nil} value.
13579 In addition, the value of the @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-charset}
13580 variable is used for decoding non-@acronym{MIME} encoded string when
13581 @code{nnmail-mail-splitting-decodes} is non-@code{nil}. The default
13582 value is @code{nil} which means not to decode non-@acronym{MIME} encoded
13583 string. A suitable value for you will be @code{undecided} or be the
13584 charset used normally in mails you are interested in.
13585
13586 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13587 By default, splitting is performed on all incoming messages. If you
13588 specify a @code{directory} entry for the variable @code{mail-sources}
13589 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}), however, then splitting does
13590 @emph{not} happen by default. You can set the variable
13591 @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming} to a non-@code{nil} value to make
13592 splitting happen even in this case. (This variable has no effect on
13593 other kinds of entries.)
13594
13595 Gnus gives you all the opportunity you could possibly want for shooting
13596 yourself in the foot. Let's say you create a group that will contain
13597 all the mail you get from your boss. And then you accidentally
13598 unsubscribe from the group. Gnus will still put all the mail from your
13599 boss in the unsubscribed group, and so, when your boss mails you ``Have
13600 that report ready by Monday or you're fired!'', you'll never see it and,
13601 come Tuesday, you'll still believe that you're gainfully employed while
13602 you really should be out collecting empty bottles to save up for next
13603 month's rent money.
13604
13605
13606 @node Mail Sources
13607 @subsection Mail Sources
13608
13609 Mail can be gotten from many different sources---the mail spool, from
13610 a @acronym{POP} mail server, from a procmail directory, or from a
13611 maildir, for instance.
13612
13613 @menu
13614 * Mail Source Specifiers:: How to specify what a mail source is.
13615 * Mail Source Customization:: Some variables that influence things.
13616 * Fetching Mail:: Using the mail source specifiers.
13617 @end menu
13618
13619
13620 @node Mail Source Specifiers
13621 @subsubsection Mail Source Specifiers
13622 @cindex POP
13623 @cindex mail server
13624 @cindex procmail
13625 @cindex mail spool
13626 @cindex mail source
13627
13628 You tell Gnus how to fetch mail by setting @code{mail-sources}
13629 (@pxref{Fetching Mail}) to a @dfn{mail source specifier}.
13630
13631 Here's an example:
13632
13633 @lisp
13634 (pop :server "pop3.mailserver.com" :user "myname")
13635 @end lisp
13636
13637 As can be observed, a mail source specifier is a list where the first
13638 element is a @dfn{mail source type}, followed by an arbitrary number of
13639 @dfn{keywords}. Keywords that are not explicitly specified are given
13640 default values.
13641
13642 The following mail source types are available:
13643
13644 @table @code
13645 @item file
13646 Get mail from a single file; typically from the mail spool.
13647
13648 Keywords:
13649
13650 @table @code
13651 @item :path
13652 The file name. Defaults to the value of the @env{MAIL}
13653 environment variable or the value of @code{rmail-spool-directory}
13654 (usually something like @file{/usr/mail/spool/user-name}).
13655
13656 @item :prescript
13657 @itemx :postscript
13658 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13659 @end table
13660
13661 An example file mail source:
13662
13663 @lisp
13664 (file :path "/usr/spool/mail/user-name")
13665 @end lisp
13666
13667 Or using the default file name:
13668
13669 @lisp
13670 (file)
13671 @end lisp
13672
13673 If the mail spool file is not located on the local machine, it's best
13674 to use @acronym{POP} or @acronym{IMAP} or the like to fetch the mail.
13675 You can not use ange-ftp file names here---it has no way to lock the
13676 mail spool while moving the mail.
13677
13678 If it's impossible to set up a proper server, you can use ssh instead.
13679
13680 @lisp
13681 (setq mail-sources
13682 '((file :prescript "ssh host bin/getmail >%t")))
13683 @end lisp
13684
13685 The @samp{getmail} script would look something like the following:
13686
13687 @example
13688 #!/bin/sh
13689 # getmail - move mail from spool to stdout
13690 # flu@@iki.fi
13691
13692 MOVEMAIL=/usr/lib/emacs/20.3/i386-redhat-linux/movemail
13693 TMP=$HOME/Mail/tmp
13694 rm -f $TMP; $MOVEMAIL $MAIL $TMP >/dev/null && cat $TMP
13695 @end example
13696
13697 Alter this script to fit the @samp{movemail} and temporary
13698 file you want to use.
13699
13700
13701 @item directory
13702 @vindex nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once
13703 Get mail from several files in a directory. This is typically used
13704 when you have procmail split the incoming mail into several files.
13705 That is, there is a one-to-one correspondence between files in that
13706 directory and groups, so that mail from the file @file{foo.bar.spool}
13707 will be put in the group @code{foo.bar}. (You can change the suffix
13708 to be used instead of @code{.spool}.) Setting
13709 @code{nnmail-scan-directory-mail-source-once} to non-@code{nil} forces
13710 Gnus to scan the mail source only once. This is particularly useful
13711 if you want to scan mail groups at a specified level.
13712
13713 @vindex nnmail-resplit-incoming
13714 There is also the variable @code{nnmail-resplit-incoming}, if you set
13715 that to a non-@code{nil} value, then the normal splitting process is
13716 applied to all the files from the directory, @ref{Splitting Mail}.
13717
13718 Keywords:
13719
13720 @table @code
13721 @item :path
13722 The name of the directory where the files are. There is no default
13723 value.
13724
13725 @item :suffix
13726 Only files ending with this suffix are used. The default is
13727 @samp{.spool}.
13728
13729 @item :predicate
13730 Only files that have this predicate return non-@code{nil} are returned.
13731 The default is @code{identity}. This is used as an additional
13732 filter---only files that have the right suffix @emph{and} satisfy this
13733 predicate are considered.
13734
13735 @item :prescript
13736 @itemx :postscript
13737 Script run before/after fetching mail.
13738
13739 @end table
13740
13741 An example directory mail source:
13742
13743 @lisp
13744 (directory :path "/home/user-name/procmail-dir/"
13745 :suffix ".prcml")
13746 @end lisp
13747
13748 @item pop
13749 Get mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13750
13751 Keywords:
13752
13753 @table @code
13754 @item :server
13755 The name of the @acronym{POP} server. The default is taken from the
13756 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13757
13758 @item :port
13759 The port number of the @acronym{POP} server. This can be a number (eg,
13760 @samp{:port 1234}) or a string (eg, @samp{:port "pop3"}). If it is a
13761 string, it should be a service name as listed in @file{/etc/services} on
13762 Unix systems. The default is @samp{"pop3"}. On some systems you might
13763 need to specify it as @samp{"pop-3"} instead.
13764
13765 @item :user
13766 The user name to give to the @acronym{POP} server. The default is the login
13767 name.
13768
13769 @item :password
13770 The password to give to the @acronym{POP} server. If not specified,
13771 the user is prompted.
13772
13773 @item :program
13774 The program to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. This
13775 should be a @code{format}-like string. Here's an example:
13776
13777 @example
13778 fetchmail %u@@%s -P %p %t
13779 @end example
13780
13781 The valid format specifier characters are:
13782
13783 @table @samp
13784 @item t
13785 The name of the file the mail is to be moved to. This must always be
13786 included in this string.
13787
13788 @item s
13789 The name of the server.
13790
13791 @item P
13792 The port number of the server.
13793
13794 @item u
13795 The user name to use.
13796
13797 @item p
13798 The password to use.
13799 @end table
13800
13801 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13802 corresponding keywords.
13803
13804 @item :prescript
13805 A script to be run before fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13806 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13807
13808 @item :postscript
13809 A script to be run after fetching the mail. The syntax is the same as
13810 the @code{:program} keyword. This can also be a function to be run.
13811
13812 @item :function
13813 The function to use to fetch mail from the @acronym{POP} server. The
13814 function is called with one parameter---the name of the file where the
13815 mail should be moved to.
13816
13817 @item :authentication
13818 This can be either the symbol @code{password} or the symbol @code{apop}
13819 and says what authentication scheme to use. The default is
13820 @code{password}.
13821
13822 @end table
13823
13824 @vindex pop3-movemail
13825 @vindex pop3-leave-mail-on-server
13826 If the @code{:program} and @code{:function} keywords aren't specified,
13827 @code{pop3-movemail} will be used. If @code{pop3-leave-mail-on-server}
13828 is non-@code{nil} the mail is to be left on the @acronym{POP} server
13829 after fetching when using @code{pop3-movemail}. Note that POP servers
13830 maintain no state information between sessions, so what the client
13831 believes is there and what is actually there may not match up. If they
13832 do not, then you may get duplicate mails or the whole thing can fall
13833 apart and leave you with a corrupt mailbox.
13834
13835 Here are some examples for getting mail from a @acronym{POP} server.
13836 Fetch from the default @acronym{POP} server, using the default user
13837 name, and default fetcher:
13838
13839 @lisp
13840 (pop)
13841 @end lisp
13842
13843 Fetch from a named server with a named user and password:
13844
13845 @lisp
13846 (pop :server "my.pop.server"
13847 :user "user-name" :password "secret")
13848 @end lisp
13849
13850 Use @samp{movemail} to move the mail:
13851
13852 @lisp
13853 (pop :program "movemail po:%u %t %p")
13854 @end lisp
13855
13856 @item maildir
13857 Get mail from a maildir. This is a type of mailbox that is supported by
13858 at least qmail and postfix, where each file in a special directory
13859 contains exactly one mail.
13860
13861 Keywords:
13862
13863 @table @code
13864 @item :path
13865 The name of the directory where the mails are stored. The default is
13866 taken from the @env{MAILDIR} environment variable or
13867 @file{~/Maildir/}.
13868 @item :subdirs
13869 The subdirectories of the Maildir. The default is
13870 @samp{("new" "cur")}.
13871
13872 @c If you sometimes look at your mail through a pop3 daemon before fetching
13873 @c them with Gnus, you may also have to fetch your mails from the
13874 @c @code{cur} directory inside the maildir, like in the first example
13875 @c below.
13876
13877 You can also get mails from remote hosts (because maildirs don't suffer
13878 from locking problems).
13879
13880 @end table
13881
13882 Two example maildir mail sources:
13883
13884 @lisp
13885 (maildir :path "/home/user-name/Maildir/"
13886 :subdirs ("cur" "new"))
13887 @end lisp
13888
13889 @lisp
13890 (maildir :path "/user@@remotehost.org:~/Maildir/"
13891 :subdirs ("new"))
13892 @end lisp
13893
13894 @item imap
13895 Get mail from a @acronym{IMAP} server. If you don't want to use
13896 @acronym{IMAP} as intended, as a network mail reading protocol (ie
13897 with nnimap), for some reason or other, Gnus let you treat it similar
13898 to a @acronym{POP} server and fetches articles from a given
13899 @acronym{IMAP} mailbox. @xref{IMAP}, for more information.
13900
13901 Note that for the Kerberos, GSSAPI, @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} and STARTTLS support you
13902 may need external programs and libraries, @xref{IMAP}.
13903
13904 Keywords:
13905
13906 @table @code
13907 @item :server
13908 The name of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is taken from the
13909 @env{MAILHOST} environment variable.
13910
13911 @item :port
13912 The port number of the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is @samp{143}, or
13913 @samp{993} for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} connections.
13914
13915 @item :user
13916 The user name to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. The default is the login
13917 name.
13918
13919 @item :password
13920 The password to give to the @acronym{IMAP} server. If not specified, the user is
13921 prompted.
13922
13923 @item :stream
13924 What stream to use for connecting to the server, this is one of the
13925 symbols in @code{imap-stream-alist}. Right now, this means
13926 @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{starttls}, @samp{tls},
13927 @samp{ssl}, @samp{shell} or the default @samp{network}.
13928
13929 @item :authentication
13930 Which authenticator to use for authenticating to the server, this is
13931 one of the symbols in @code{imap-authenticator-alist}. Right now,
13932 this means @samp{gssapi}, @samp{kerberos4}, @samp{digest-md5},
13933 @samp{cram-md5}, @samp{anonymous} or the default @samp{login}.
13934
13935 @item :program
13936 When using the `shell' :stream, the contents of this variable is
13937 mapped into the @code{imap-shell-program} variable. This should be a
13938 @code{format}-like string (or list of strings). Here's an example:
13939
13940 @example
13941 ssh %s imapd
13942 @end example
13943
13944 The valid format specifier characters are:
13945
13946 @table @samp
13947 @item s
13948 The name of the server.
13949
13950 @item l
13951 User name from @code{imap-default-user}.
13952
13953 @item p
13954 The port number of the server.
13955 @end table
13956
13957 The values used for these specs are taken from the values you give the
13958 corresponding keywords.
13959
13960 @item :mailbox
13961 The name of the mailbox to get mail from. The default is @samp{INBOX}
13962 which normally is the mailbox which receives incoming mail.
13963
13964 @item :predicate
13965 The predicate used to find articles to fetch. The default, @samp{UNSEEN
13966 UNDELETED}, is probably the best choice for most people, but if you
13967 sometimes peek in your mailbox with a @acronym{IMAP} client and mark some
13968 articles as read (or; SEEN) you might want to set this to @samp{1:*}.
13969 Then all articles in the mailbox is fetched, no matter what. For a
13970 complete list of predicates, see RFC 2060 section 6.4.4.
13971
13972 @item :fetchflag
13973 How to flag fetched articles on the server, the default @samp{\Deleted}
13974 will mark them as deleted, an alternative would be @samp{\Seen} which
13975 would simply mark them as read. These are the two most likely choices,
13976 but more flags are defined in RFC 2060 section 2.3.2.
13977
13978 @item :dontexpunge
13979 If non-@code{nil}, don't remove all articles marked as deleted in the
13980 mailbox after finishing the fetch.
13981
13982 @end table
13983
13984 An example @acronym{IMAP} mail source:
13985
13986 @lisp
13987 (imap :server "mail.mycorp.com"
13988 :stream kerberos4
13989 :fetchflag "\\Seen")
13990 @end lisp
13991
13992 @item webmail
13993 Get mail from a webmail server, such as @uref{http://www.hotmail.com/},
13994 @uref{http://webmail.netscape.com/}, @uref{http://www.netaddress.com/},
13995 @uref{http://mail.yahoo.com/}.
13996
13997 NOTE: Webmail largely depends on cookies. A "one-line-cookie" patch is
13998 required for url "4.0pre.46".
13999
14000 WARNING: Mails may be lost. NO WARRANTY.
14001
14002 Keywords:
14003
14004 @table @code
14005 @item :subtype
14006 The type of the webmail server. The default is @code{hotmail}. The
14007 alternatives are @code{netscape}, @code{netaddress}, @code{my-deja}.
14008
14009 @item :user
14010 The user name to give to the webmail server. The default is the login
14011 name.
14012
14013 @item :password
14014 The password to give to the webmail server. If not specified, the user is
14015 prompted.
14016
14017 @item :dontexpunge
14018 If non-@code{nil}, only fetch unread articles and don't move them to
14019 trash folder after finishing the fetch.
14020
14021 @end table
14022
14023 An example webmail source:
14024
14025 @lisp
14026 (webmail :subtype 'hotmail
14027 :user "user-name"
14028 :password "secret")
14029 @end lisp
14030 @end table
14031
14032 @table @dfn
14033 @item Common Keywords
14034 Common keywords can be used in any type of mail source.
14035
14036 Keywords:
14037
14038 @table @code
14039 @item :plugged
14040 If non-@code{nil}, fetch the mail even when Gnus is unplugged. If you
14041 use directory source to get mail, you can specify it as in this
14042 example:
14043
14044 @lisp
14045 (setq mail-sources
14046 '((directory :path "/home/pavel/.Spool/"
14047 :suffix ""
14048 :plugged t)))
14049 @end lisp
14050
14051 Gnus will then fetch your mail even when you are unplugged. This is
14052 useful when you use local mail and news.
14053
14054 @end table
14055 @end table
14056
14057 @subsubsection Function Interface
14058
14059 Some of the above keywords specify a Lisp function to be executed.
14060 For each keyword @code{:foo}, the Lisp variable @code{foo} is bound to
14061 the value of the keyword while the function is executing. For example,
14062 consider the following mail-source setting:
14063
14064 @lisp
14065 (setq mail-sources '((pop :user "jrl"
14066 :server "pophost" :function fetchfunc)))
14067 @end lisp
14068
14069 While the function @code{fetchfunc} is executing, the symbol @code{user}
14070 is bound to @code{"jrl"}, and the symbol @code{server} is bound to
14071 @code{"pophost"}. The symbols @code{port}, @code{password},
14072 @code{program}, @code{prescript}, @code{postscript}, @code{function},
14073 and @code{authentication} are also bound (to their default values).
14074
14075 See above for a list of keywords for each type of mail source.
14076
14077
14078 @node Mail Source Customization
14079 @subsubsection Mail Source Customization
14080
14081 The following is a list of variables that influence how the mail is
14082 fetched. You would normally not need to set or change any of these
14083 variables.
14084
14085 @table @code
14086 @item mail-source-crash-box
14087 @vindex mail-source-crash-box
14088 File where mail will be stored while processing it. The default is@*
14089 @file{~/.emacs-mail-crash-box}.
14090
14091 @cindex Incoming*
14092 @item mail-source-delete-incoming
14093 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
14094 If non-@code{nil}, delete incoming files after handling them. If
14095 @code{t}, delete the files immediately, if @code{nil}, never delete any
14096 files. If a positive number, delete files older than number of days
14097 (the deletion will only happen when receiving new mail). You may also
14098 set @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} to @code{nil} and call
14099 @code{mail-source-delete-old-incoming} from a hook or interactively.
14100 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} defaults to @code{2} in alpha Gnusae
14101 and @code{10} in released Gnusae. @xref{Gnus Development}.
14102
14103 @item mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
14104 @vindex mail-source-delete-old-incoming-confirm
14105 If non-@code{nil}, ask for confirmation before deleting old incoming
14106 files. This variable only applies when
14107 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is a positive number.
14108
14109 @item mail-source-ignore-errors
14110 @vindex mail-source-ignore-errors
14111 If non-@code{nil}, ignore errors when reading mail from a mail source.
14112
14113 @item mail-source-directory
14114 @vindex mail-source-directory
14115 Directory where incoming mail source files (if any) will be stored. The
14116 default is @file{~/Mail/}. At present, the only thing this is used for
14117 is to say where the incoming files will be stored if the variable
14118 @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a number.
14119
14120 @item mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14121 @vindex mail-source-incoming-file-prefix
14122 Prefix for file name for storing incoming mail. The default is
14123 @file{Incoming}, in which case files will end up with names like
14124 @file{Incoming30630D_} or @file{Incoming298602ZD}. This is really only
14125 relevant if @code{mail-source-delete-incoming} is @code{nil} or a
14126 number.
14127
14128 @item mail-source-default-file-modes
14129 @vindex mail-source-default-file-modes
14130 All new mail files will get this file mode. The default is 384.
14131
14132 @item mail-source-movemail-program
14133 @vindex mail-source-movemail-program
14134 If non-@code{nil}, name of program for fetching new mail. If
14135 @code{nil}, @code{movemail} in @var{exec-directory}.
14136
14137 @end table
14138
14139
14140 @node Fetching Mail
14141 @subsubsection Fetching Mail
14142
14143 @vindex mail-sources
14144 The way to actually tell Gnus where to get new mail from is to set
14145 @code{mail-sources} to a list of mail source specifiers
14146 (@pxref{Mail Source Specifiers}).
14147
14148 If this variable is @code{nil}, the mail back ends will never attempt to
14149 fetch mail by themselves.
14150
14151 If you want to fetch mail both from your local spool as well as a
14152 @acronym{POP} mail server, you'd say something like:
14153
14154 @lisp
14155 (setq mail-sources
14156 '((file)
14157 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14158 :password "secret")))
14159 @end lisp
14160
14161 Or, if you don't want to use any of the keyword defaults:
14162
14163 @lisp
14164 (setq mail-sources
14165 '((file :path "/var/spool/mail/user-name")
14166 (pop :server "pop3.mail.server"
14167 :user "user-name"
14168 :port "pop3"
14169 :password "secret")))
14170 @end lisp
14171
14172
14173 When you use a mail back end, Gnus will slurp all your mail from your
14174 inbox and plonk it down in your home directory. Gnus doesn't move any
14175 mail if you're not using a mail back end---you have to do a lot of magic
14176 invocations first. At the time when you have finished drawing the
14177 pentagram, lightened the candles, and sacrificed the goat, you really
14178 shouldn't be too surprised when Gnus moves your mail.
14179
14180
14181
14182 @node Mail Back End Variables
14183 @subsection Mail Back End Variables
14184
14185 These variables are (for the most part) pertinent to all the various
14186 mail back ends.
14187
14188 @table @code
14189 @vindex nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14190 @item nnmail-read-incoming-hook
14191 The mail back ends all call this hook after reading new mail. You can
14192 use this hook to notify any mail watch programs, if you want to.
14193
14194 @vindex nnmail-split-hook
14195 @item nnmail-split-hook
14196 @findex gnus-article-decode-encoded-words
14197 @cindex RFC 1522 decoding
14198 @cindex RFC 2047 decoding
14199 Hook run in the buffer where the mail headers of each message is kept
14200 just before the splitting based on these headers is done. The hook is
14201 free to modify the buffer contents in any way it sees fit---the buffer
14202 is discarded after the splitting has been done, and no changes performed
14203 in the buffer will show up in any files.
14204 @code{gnus-article-decode-encoded-words} is one likely function to add
14205 to this hook.
14206
14207 @vindex nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14208 @vindex nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14209 @item nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14210 @itemx nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14211 These are two useful hooks executed when treating new incoming
14212 mail---@code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook} (is called just before
14213 starting to handle the new mail) and
14214 @code{nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook} (is called when the mail handling
14215 is done). Here's and example of using these two hooks to change the
14216 default file modes the new mail files get:
14217
14218 @lisp
14219 (add-hook 'nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook
14220 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 511)))
14221
14222 (add-hook 'nnmail-post-get-new-mail-hook
14223 (lambda () (set-default-file-modes 551)))
14224 @end lisp
14225
14226 @item nnmail-use-long-file-names
14227 @vindex nnmail-use-long-file-names
14228 If non-@code{nil}, the mail back ends will use long file and directory
14229 names. Groups like @samp{mail.misc} will end up in directories
14230 (assuming use of @code{nnml} back end) or files (assuming use of
14231 @code{nnfolder} back end) like @file{mail.misc}. If it is @code{nil},
14232 the same group will end up in @file{mail/misc}.
14233
14234 @item nnmail-delete-file-function
14235 @vindex nnmail-delete-file-function
14236 @findex delete-file
14237 Function called to delete files. It is @code{delete-file} by default.
14238
14239 @item nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14240 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14241 If non-@code{nil}, put the @code{Message-ID}s of articles imported into
14242 the back end (via @code{Gcc}, for instance) into the mail duplication
14243 discovery cache. The default is @code{nil}.
14244
14245 @item nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14246 @vindex nnmail-cache-ignore-groups
14247 This can be a regular expression or a list of regular expressions.
14248 Group names that match any of the regular expressions will never be
14249 recorded in the @code{Message-ID} cache.
14250
14251 This can be useful, for example, when using Fancy Splitting
14252 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}) together with the function
14253 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}.
14254
14255 @end table
14256
14257
14258 @node Fancy Mail Splitting
14259 @subsection Fancy Mail Splitting
14260 @cindex mail splitting
14261 @cindex fancy mail splitting
14262
14263 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy
14264 @findex nnmail-split-fancy
14265 If the rather simple, standard method for specifying how to split mail
14266 doesn't allow you to do what you want, you can set
14267 @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. Then you can
14268 play with the @code{nnmail-split-fancy} variable.
14269
14270 Let's look at an example value of this variable first:
14271
14272 @lisp
14273 ;; @r{Messages from the mailer daemon are not crossposted to any of}
14274 ;; @r{the ordinary groups. Warnings are put in a separate group}
14275 ;; @r{from real errors.}
14276 (| ("from" mail (| ("subject" "warn.*" "mail.warning")
14277 "mail.misc"))
14278 ;; @r{Non-error messages are crossposted to all relevant}
14279 ;; @r{groups, but we don't crosspost between the group for the}
14280 ;; @r{(ding) list and the group for other (ding) related mail.}
14281 (& (| (any "ding@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "ding.list")
14282 ("subject" "ding" "ding.misc"))
14283 ;; @r{Other mailing lists@dots{}}
14284 (any "procmail@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "procmail.list")
14285 (any "SmartList@@informatik\\.rwth-aachen\\.de" "SmartList.list")
14286 ;; @r{Both lists below have the same suffix, so prevent}
14287 ;; @r{cross-posting to mkpkg.list of messages posted only to}
14288 ;; @r{the bugs- list, but allow cross-posting when the}
14289 ;; @r{message was really cross-posted.}
14290 (any "bugs-mypackage@@somewhere" "mypkg.bugs")
14291 (any "mypackage@@somewhere" - "bugs-mypackage" "mypkg.list")
14292 ;; @r{People@dots{}}
14293 (any "larsi@@ifi\\.uio\\.no" "people.Lars_Magne_Ingebrigtsen"))
14294 ;; @r{Unmatched mail goes to the catch all group.}
14295 "misc.misc")
14296 @end lisp
14297
14298 This variable has the format of a @dfn{split}. A split is a
14299 (possibly) recursive structure where each split may contain other
14300 splits. Here are the possible split syntaxes:
14301
14302 @table @code
14303
14304 @item group
14305 If the split is a string, that will be taken as a group name. Normal
14306 regexp match expansion will be done. See below for examples.
14307
14308 @c Don't fold this line.
14309 @item (@var{field} @var{value} [- @var{restrict} [@dots{}] ] @var{split} [@var{invert-partial}])
14310 The split can be a list containing at least three elements. If the
14311 first element @var{field} (a regexp matching a header) contains
14312 @var{value} (also a regexp) then store the message as specified by
14313 @var{split}.
14314
14315 If @var{restrict} (yet another regexp) matches some string after
14316 @var{field} and before the end of the matched @var{value}, the
14317 @var{split} is ignored. If none of the @var{restrict} clauses match,
14318 @var{split} is processed.
14319
14320 The last element @var{invert-partial} is optional. If it is
14321 non-@code{nil}, the match-partial-words behavior controlled by the
14322 variable @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} (see below) is
14323 be inverted. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14324
14325 @item (| @var{split} @dots{})
14326 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{|} (vertical
14327 bar), then process each @var{split} until one of them matches. A
14328 @var{split} is said to match if it will cause the mail message to be
14329 stored in one or more groups.
14330
14331 @item (& @var{split} @dots{})
14332 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{&}, then
14333 process all @var{split}s in the list.
14334
14335 @item junk
14336 If the split is the symbol @code{junk}, then don't save (i.e., delete)
14337 this message. Use with extreme caution.
14338
14339 @item (: @var{function} @var{arg1} @var{arg2} @dots{})
14340 If the split is a list, and the first element is @samp{:}, then the
14341 second element will be called as a function with @var{args} given as
14342 arguments. The function should return a @var{split}.
14343
14344 @cindex body split
14345 For instance, the following function could be used to split based on the
14346 body of the messages:
14347
14348 @lisp
14349 (defun split-on-body ()
14350 (save-excursion
14351 (save-restriction
14352 (widen)
14353 (goto-char (point-min))
14354 (when (re-search-forward "Some.*string" nil t)
14355 "string.group"))))
14356 @end lisp
14357
14358 The buffer is narrowed to the header of the message in question when
14359 @var{function} is run. That's why @code{(widen)} needs to be called
14360 after @code{save-excursion} and @code{save-restriction} in the example
14361 above. Also note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will
14362 not be downloaded by default. You need to set
14363 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
14364 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
14365
14366 @item (! @var{func} @var{split})
14367 If the split is a list, and the first element is @code{!}, then
14368 @var{split} will be processed, and @var{func} will be called as a
14369 function with the result of @var{split} as argument. @var{func}
14370 should return a split.
14371
14372 @item nil
14373 If the split is @code{nil}, it is ignored.
14374
14375 @end table
14376
14377 In these splits, @var{field} must match a complete field name.
14378
14379 Normally, @var{value} in these splits must match a complete @emph{word}
14380 according to the fundamental mode syntax table. In other words, all
14381 @var{value}'s will be implicitly surrounded by @code{\<...\>} markers,
14382 which are word delimiters. Therefore, if you use the following split,
14383 for example,
14384
14385 @example
14386 (any "joe" "joemail")
14387 @end example
14388
14389 @noindent
14390 messages sent from @samp{joedavis@@foo.org} will normally not be filed
14391 in @samp{joemail}. If you want to alter this behavior, you can use any
14392 of the following three ways:
14393
14394 @enumerate
14395 @item
14396 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words
14397 You can set the @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} variable
14398 to non-@code{nil} in order to ignore word boundaries and instead the
14399 match becomes more like a grep. This variable controls whether partial
14400 words are matched during fancy splitting. The default value is
14401 @code{nil}.
14402
14403 Note that it influences all @var{value}'s in your split rules.
14404
14405 @item
14406 @var{value} beginning with @code{.*} ignores word boundaries in front of
14407 a word. Similarly, if @var{value} ends with @code{.*}, word boundaries
14408 in the rear of a word will be ignored. For example, the @var{value}
14409 @code{"@@example\\.com"} does not match @samp{foo@@example.com} but
14410 @code{".*@@example\\.com"} does.
14411
14412 @item
14413 You can set the @var{invert-partial} flag in your split rules of the
14414 @samp{(@var{field} @var{value} @dots{})} types, aforementioned in this
14415 section. If the flag is set, word boundaries on both sides of a word
14416 are ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14417 @code{nil}. Contrarily, if the flag is set, word boundaries are not
14418 ignored even if @code{nnmail-split-fancy-match-partial-words} is
14419 non-@code{nil}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
14420 @end enumerate
14421
14422 @vindex nnmail-split-abbrev-alist
14423 @var{field} and @var{value} can also be Lisp symbols, in that case
14424 they are expanded as specified by the variable
14425 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist}. This is an alist of cons cells,
14426 where the @sc{car} of a cell contains the key, and the @sc{cdr}
14427 contains the associated value. Predefined entries in
14428 @code{nnmail-split-abbrev-alist} include:
14429
14430 @table @code
14431 @item from
14432 Matches the @samp{From}, @samp{Sender} and @samp{Resent-From} fields.
14433 @item to
14434 Matches the @samp{To}, @samp{Cc}, @samp{Apparently-To},
14435 @samp{Resent-To} and @samp{Resent-Cc} fields.
14436 @item any
14437 Is the union of the @code{from} and @code{to} entries.
14438 @end table
14439
14440 @vindex nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table
14441 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-syntax-table} is the syntax table in effect
14442 when all this splitting is performed.
14443
14444 If you want to have Gnus create groups dynamically based on some
14445 information in the headers (i.e., do @code{replace-match}-like
14446 substitutions in the group names), you can say things like:
14447
14448 @example
14449 (any "debian-\\b\\(\\w+\\)@@lists.debian.org" "mail.debian.\\1")
14450 @end example
14451
14452 In this example, messages sent to @samp{debian-foo@@lists.debian.org}
14453 will be filed in @samp{mail.debian.foo}.
14454
14455 If the string contains the element @samp{\&}, then the previously
14456 matched string will be substituted. Similarly, the elements @samp{\\1}
14457 up to @samp{\\9} will be substituted with the text matched by the
14458 groupings 1 through 9.
14459
14460 @vindex nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded
14461 Where @code{nnmail-split-lowercase-expanded} controls whether the
14462 lowercase of the matched string should be used for the substitution.
14463 Setting it as non-@code{nil} is useful to avoid the creation of multiple
14464 groups when users send to an address using different case
14465 (i.e. mailing-list@@domain vs Mailing-List@@Domain). The default value
14466 is @code{t}.
14467
14468 @findex nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent
14469 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} is a function which allows you to
14470 split followups into the same groups their parents are in. Sometimes
14471 you can't make splitting rules for all your mail. For example, your
14472 boss might send you personal mail regarding different projects you are
14473 working on, and as you can't tell your boss to put a distinguishing
14474 string into the subject line, you have to resort to manually moving the
14475 messages into the right group. With this function, you only have to do
14476 it once per thread.
14477
14478 To use this feature, you have to set @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates}
14479 and @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} to a non-@code{nil}
14480 value. And then you can include @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent}
14481 using the colon feature, like so:
14482 @lisp
14483 (setq nnmail-treat-duplicates 'warn ; @r{or @code{delete}}
14484 nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids t
14485 nnmail-split-fancy
14486 '(| (: nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent)
14487 ;; @r{other splits go here}
14488 ))
14489 @end lisp
14490
14491 This feature works as follows: when @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} is
14492 non-@code{nil}, Gnus records the message id of every message it sees
14493 in the file specified by the variable
14494 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, together with the group it is in
14495 (the group is omitted for non-mail messages). When mail splitting is
14496 invoked, the function @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent} then looks
14497 at the References (and In-Reply-To) header of each message to split
14498 and searches the file specified by @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}
14499 for the message ids. When it has found a parent, it returns the
14500 corresponding group name unless the group name matches the regexp
14501 @code{nnmail-split-fancy-with-parent-ignore-groups}. It is
14502 recommended that you set @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length} to a
14503 somewhat higher number than the default so that the message ids are
14504 still in the cache. (A value of 5000 appears to create a file some
14505 300 kBytes in size.)
14506 @vindex nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids
14507 When @code{nnmail-cache-accepted-message-ids} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus
14508 also records the message ids of moved articles, so that the followup
14509 messages goes into the new group.
14510
14511 Also see the variable @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} if you don't
14512 want certain groups to be recorded in the cache. For example, if all
14513 outgoing messages are written to an ``outgoing'' group, you could set
14514 @code{nnmail-cache-ignore-groups} to match that group name.
14515 Otherwise, answers to all your messages would end up in the
14516 ``outgoing'' group.
14517
14518
14519 @node Group Mail Splitting
14520 @subsection Group Mail Splitting
14521 @cindex mail splitting
14522 @cindex group mail splitting
14523
14524 @findex gnus-group-split
14525 If you subscribe to dozens of mailing lists but you don't want to
14526 maintain mail splitting rules manually, group mail splitting is for you.
14527 You just have to set @code{to-list} and/or @code{to-address} in group
14528 parameters or group customization and set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to
14529 @code{gnus-group-split}. This splitting function will scan all groups
14530 for those parameters and split mail accordingly, i.e., messages posted
14531 from or to the addresses specified in the parameters @code{to-list} or
14532 @code{to-address} of a mail group will be stored in that group.
14533
14534 Sometimes, mailing lists have multiple addresses, and you may want mail
14535 splitting to recognize them all: just set the @code{extra-aliases} group
14536 parameter to the list of additional addresses and it's done. If you'd
14537 rather use a regular expression, set @code{split-regexp}.
14538
14539 All these parameters in a group will be used to create an
14540 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split, in which the @var{field} is @samp{any},
14541 the @var{value} is a single regular expression that matches
14542 @code{to-list}, @code{to-address}, all of @code{extra-aliases} and all
14543 matches of @code{split-regexp}, and the @var{split} is the name of the
14544 group. @var{restrict}s are also supported: just set the
14545 @code{split-exclude} parameter to a list of regular expressions.
14546
14547 If you can't get the right split to be generated using all these
14548 parameters, or you just need something fancier, you can set the
14549 parameter @code{split-spec} to an @code{nnmail-split-fancy} split. In
14550 this case, all other aforementioned parameters will be ignored by
14551 @code{gnus-group-split}. In particular, @code{split-spec} may be set to
14552 @code{nil}, in which case the group will be ignored by
14553 @code{gnus-group-split}.
14554
14555 @vindex gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group
14556 @code{gnus-group-split} will do cross-posting on all groups that match,
14557 by defining a single @code{&} fancy split containing one split for each
14558 group. If a message doesn't match any split, it will be stored in the
14559 group named in @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}, unless
14560 some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all}, in which case
14561 that group is used as the catch-all group. Even though this variable is
14562 often used just to name a group, it may also be set to an arbitrarily
14563 complex fancy split (after all, a group name is a fancy split), and this
14564 may be useful to split mail that doesn't go to any mailing list to
14565 personal mail folders. Note that this fancy split is added as the last
14566 element of a @code{|} split list that also contains a @code{&} split
14567 with the rules extracted from group parameters.
14568
14569 It's time for an example. Assume the following group parameters have
14570 been defined:
14571
14572 @example
14573 nnml:mail.bar:
14574 ((to-address . "bar@@femail.com")
14575 (split-regexp . ".*@@femail\\.com"))
14576 nnml:mail.foo:
14577 ((to-list . "foo@@nowhere.gov")
14578 (extra-aliases "foo@@localhost" "foo-redist@@home")
14579 (split-exclude "bugs-foo" "rambling-foo")
14580 (admin-address . "foo-request@@nowhere.gov"))
14581 nnml:mail.others:
14582 ((split-spec . catch-all))
14583 @end example
14584
14585 Setting @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{gnus-group-split} will
14586 behave as if @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been selected and variable
14587 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} had been set as follows:
14588
14589 @lisp
14590 (| (& (any "\\(bar@@femail\\.com\\|.*@@femail\\.com\\)" "mail.bar")
14591 (any "\\(foo@@nowhere\\.gov\\|foo@@localhost\\|foo-redist@@home\\)"
14592 - "bugs-foo" - "rambling-foo" "mail.foo"))
14593 "mail.others")
14594 @end lisp
14595
14596 @findex gnus-group-split-fancy
14597 If you'd rather not use group splitting for all your mail groups, you
14598 may use it for only some of them, by using @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
14599 splits like this:
14600
14601 @lisp
14602 (: gnus-group-split-fancy @var{groups} @var{no-crosspost} @var{catch-all})
14603 @end lisp
14604
14605 @var{groups} may be a regular expression or a list of group names whose
14606 parameters will be scanned to generate the output split.
14607 @var{no-crosspost} can be used to disable cross-posting; in this case, a
14608 single @code{|} split will be output. @var{catch-all} is the fall back
14609 fancy split, used like @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group}.
14610 If @var{catch-all} is @code{nil}, or if @code{split-regexp} matches the
14611 empty string in any selected group, no catch-all split will be issued.
14612 Otherwise, if some group has @code{split-spec} set to @code{catch-all},
14613 this group will override the value of the @var{catch-all} argument.
14614
14615 @findex gnus-group-split-setup
14616 Unfortunately, scanning all groups and their parameters can be quite
14617 slow, especially considering that it has to be done for every message.
14618 But don't despair! The function @code{gnus-group-split-setup} can be
14619 used to enable @code{gnus-group-split} in a much more efficient way. It
14620 sets @code{nnmail-split-methods} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy} and sets
14621 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} to the split produced by
14622 @code{gnus-group-split-fancy}. Thus, the group parameters are only
14623 scanned once, no matter how many messages are split.
14624
14625 @findex gnus-group-split-update
14626 However, if you change group parameters, you'd have to update
14627 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} manually. You can do it by running
14628 @code{gnus-group-split-update}. If you'd rather have it updated
14629 automatically, just tell @code{gnus-group-split-setup} to do it for
14630 you. For example, add to your @file{~/.gnus.el}:
14631
14632 @lisp
14633 (gnus-group-split-setup @var{auto-update} @var{catch-all})
14634 @end lisp
14635
14636 If @var{auto-update} is non-@code{nil}, @code{gnus-group-split-update}
14637 will be added to @code{nnmail-pre-get-new-mail-hook}, so you won't ever
14638 have to worry about updating @code{nnmail-split-fancy} again. If you
14639 don't omit @var{catch-all} (it's optional, equivalent to @code{nil}),
14640 @code{gnus-group-split-default-catch-all-group} will be set to its
14641 value.
14642
14643 @vindex gnus-group-split-updated-hook
14644 Because you may want to change @code{nnmail-split-fancy} after it is set
14645 by @code{gnus-group-split-update}, this function will run
14646 @code{gnus-group-split-updated-hook} just before finishing.
14647
14648 @node Incorporating Old Mail
14649 @subsection Incorporating Old Mail
14650 @cindex incorporating old mail
14651 @cindex import old mail
14652
14653 Most people have lots of old mail stored in various file formats. If
14654 you have set up Gnus to read mail using one of the spiffy Gnus mail
14655 back ends, you'll probably wish to have that old mail incorporated into
14656 your mail groups.
14657
14658 Doing so can be quite easy.
14659
14660 To take an example: You're reading mail using @code{nnml}
14661 (@pxref{Mail Spool}), and have set @code{nnmail-split-methods} to a
14662 satisfactory value (@pxref{Splitting Mail}). You have an old Unix mbox
14663 file filled with important, but old, mail. You want to move it into
14664 your @code{nnml} groups.
14665
14666 Here's how:
14667
14668 @enumerate
14669 @item
14670 Go to the group buffer.
14671
14672 @item
14673 Type @kbd{G f} and give the file name to the mbox file when prompted to create an
14674 @code{nndoc} group from the mbox file (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
14675
14676 @item
14677 Type @kbd{SPACE} to enter the newly created group.
14678
14679 @item
14680 Type @kbd{M P b} to process-mark all articles in this group's buffer
14681 (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
14682
14683 @item
14684 Type @kbd{B r} to respool all the process-marked articles, and answer
14685 @samp{nnml} when prompted (@pxref{Mail Group Commands}).
14686 @end enumerate
14687
14688 All the mail messages in the mbox file will now also be spread out over
14689 all your @code{nnml} groups. Try entering them and check whether things
14690 have gone without a glitch. If things look ok, you may consider
14691 deleting the mbox file, but I wouldn't do that unless I was absolutely
14692 sure that all the mail has ended up where it should be.
14693
14694 Respooling is also a handy thing to do if you're switching from one mail
14695 back end to another. Just respool all the mail in the old mail groups
14696 using the new mail back end.
14697
14698
14699 @node Expiring Mail
14700 @subsection Expiring Mail
14701 @cindex article expiry
14702 @cindex expiring mail
14703
14704 Traditional mail readers have a tendency to remove mail articles when
14705 you mark them as read, in some way. Gnus takes a fundamentally
14706 different approach to mail reading.
14707
14708 Gnus basically considers mail just to be news that has been received in
14709 a rather peculiar manner. It does not think that it has the power to
14710 actually change the mail, or delete any mail messages. If you enter a
14711 mail group, and mark articles as ``read'', or kill them in some other
14712 fashion, the mail articles will still exist on the system. I repeat:
14713 Gnus will not delete your old, read mail. Unless you ask it to, of
14714 course.
14715
14716 To make Gnus get rid of your unwanted mail, you have to mark the
14717 articles as @dfn{expirable}. (With the default key bindings, this means
14718 that you have to type @kbd{E}.) This does not mean that the articles
14719 will disappear right away, however. In general, a mail article will be
14720 deleted from your system if, 1) it is marked as expirable, AND 2) it is
14721 more than one week old. If you do not mark an article as expirable, it
14722 will remain on your system until hell freezes over. This bears
14723 repeating one more time, with some spurious capitalizations: IF you do
14724 NOT mark articles as EXPIRABLE, Gnus will NEVER delete those ARTICLES.
14725
14726 You do not have to mark articles as expirable by hand. Gnus provides
14727 two features, called ``auto-expire'' and ``total-expire'', that can help you
14728 with this. In a nutshell, ``auto-expire'' means that Gnus hits @kbd{E}
14729 for you when you select an article. And ``total-expire'' means that Gnus
14730 considers all articles as expirable that are read. So, in addition to
14731 the articles marked @samp{E}, also the articles marked @samp{r},
14732 @samp{R}, @samp{O}, @samp{K}, @samp{Y} and so on are considered
14733 expirable.
14734
14735 When should either auto-expire or total-expire be used? Most people
14736 who are subscribed to mailing lists split each list into its own group
14737 and then turn on auto-expire or total-expire for those groups.
14738 (@xref{Splitting Mail}, for more information on splitting each list
14739 into its own group.)
14740
14741 Which one is better, auto-expire or total-expire? It's not easy to
14742 answer. Generally speaking, auto-expire is probably faster. Another
14743 advantage of auto-expire is that you get more marks to work with: for
14744 the articles that are supposed to stick around, you can still choose
14745 between tick and dormant and read marks. But with total-expire, you
14746 only have dormant and ticked to choose from. The advantage of
14747 total-expire is that it works well with adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive
14748 Scoring}). Auto-expire works with normal scoring but not with adaptive
14749 scoring.
14750
14751 @vindex gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14752 Groups that match the regular expression
14753 @code{gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups} will have all articles that you
14754 read marked as expirable automatically. All articles marked as
14755 expirable have an @samp{E} in the first column in the summary buffer.
14756
14757 By default, if you have auto expiry switched on, Gnus will mark all the
14758 articles you read as expirable, no matter if they were read or unread
14759 before. To avoid having articles marked as read marked as expirable
14760 automatically, you can put something like the following in your
14761 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
14762
14763 @vindex gnus-mark-article-hook
14764 @lisp
14765 (remove-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook
14766 'gnus-summary-mark-read-and-unread-as-read)
14767 (add-hook 'gnus-mark-article-hook 'gnus-summary-mark-unread-as-read)
14768 @end lisp
14769
14770 Note that making a group auto-expirable doesn't mean that all read
14771 articles are expired---only the articles marked as expirable
14772 will be expired. Also note that using the @kbd{d} command won't make
14773 articles expirable---only semi-automatic marking of articles as read will
14774 mark the articles as expirable in auto-expirable groups.
14775
14776 Let's say you subscribe to a couple of mailing lists, and you want the
14777 articles you have read to disappear after a while:
14778
14779 @lisp
14780 (setq gnus-auto-expirable-newsgroups
14781 "mail.nonsense-list\\|mail.nice-list")
14782 @end lisp
14783
14784 Another way to have auto-expiry happen is to have the element
14785 @code{auto-expire} in the group parameters of the group.
14786
14787 If you use adaptive scoring (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}) and
14788 auto-expiring, you'll have problems. Auto-expiring and adaptive scoring
14789 don't really mix very well.
14790
14791 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait
14792 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable supplies the default time an
14793 expirable article has to live. Gnus starts counting days from when the
14794 message @emph{arrived}, not from when it was sent. The default is seven
14795 days.
14796
14797 Gnus also supplies a function that lets you fine-tune how long articles
14798 are to live, based on what group they are in. Let's say you want to
14799 have one month expiry period in the @samp{mail.private} group, a one day
14800 expiry period in the @samp{mail.junk} group, and a six day expiry period
14801 everywhere else:
14802
14803 @vindex nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14804 @lisp
14805 (setq nnmail-expiry-wait-function
14806 (lambda (group)
14807 (cond ((string= group "mail.private")
14808 31)
14809 ((string= group "mail.junk")
14810 1)
14811 ((string= group "important")
14812 'never)
14813 (t
14814 6))))
14815 @end lisp
14816
14817 The group names this function is fed are ``unadorned'' group
14818 names---no @samp{nnml:} prefixes and the like.
14819
14820 The @code{nnmail-expiry-wait} variable and
14821 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} function can either be a number (not
14822 necessarily an integer) or one of the symbols @code{immediate} or
14823 @code{never}.
14824
14825 You can also use the @code{expiry-wait} group parameter to selectively
14826 change the expiry period (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
14827
14828 @vindex nnmail-expiry-target
14829 The normal action taken when expiring articles is to delete them.
14830 However, in some circumstances it might make more sense to move them
14831 to other groups instead of deleting them. The variable
14832 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} (and the @code{expiry-target} group
14833 parameter) controls this. The variable supplies a default value for
14834 all groups, which can be overridden for specific groups by the group
14835 parameter. default value is @code{delete}, but this can also be a
14836 string (which should be the name of the group the message should be
14837 moved to), or a function (which will be called in a buffer narrowed to
14838 the message in question, and with the name of the group being moved
14839 from as its parameter) which should return a target---either a group
14840 name or @code{delete}.
14841
14842 Here's an example for specifying a group name:
14843 @lisp
14844 (setq nnmail-expiry-target "nnml:expired")
14845 @end lisp
14846
14847 @findex nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14848 @vindex nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14849 Gnus provides a function @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-target} which will
14850 expire mail to groups according to the variable
14851 @code{nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets}. Here's an example:
14852
14853 @lisp
14854 (setq nnmail-expiry-target 'nnmail-fancy-expiry-target
14855 nnmail-fancy-expiry-targets
14856 '((to-from "boss" "nnfolder:Work")
14857 ("subject" "IMPORTANT" "nnfolder:IMPORTANT.%Y.%b")
14858 ("from" ".*" "nnfolder:Archive-%Y")))
14859 @end lisp
14860
14861 With this setup, any mail that has @code{IMPORTANT} in its Subject
14862 header and was sent in the year @code{YYYY} and month @code{MMM}, will
14863 get expired to the group @code{nnfolder:IMPORTANT.YYYY.MMM}. If its
14864 From or To header contains the string @code{boss}, it will get expired
14865 to @code{nnfolder:Work}. All other mail will get expired to
14866 @code{nnfolder:Archive-YYYY}.
14867
14868 @vindex nnmail-keep-last-article
14869 If @code{nnmail-keep-last-article} is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will never
14870 expire the final article in a mail newsgroup. This is to make life
14871 easier for procmail users.
14872
14873 @vindex gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups
14874 By the way: That line up there, about Gnus never expiring non-expirable
14875 articles, is a lie. If you put @code{total-expire} in the group
14876 parameters, articles will not be marked as expirable, but all read
14877 articles will be put through the expiry process. Use with extreme
14878 caution. Even more dangerous is the
14879 @code{gnus-total-expirable-newsgroups} variable. All groups that match
14880 this regexp will have all read articles put through the expiry process,
14881 which means that @emph{all} old mail articles in the groups in question
14882 will be deleted after a while. Use with extreme caution, and don't come
14883 crying to me when you discover that the regexp you used matched the
14884 wrong group and all your important mail has disappeared. Be a
14885 @emph{man}! Or a @emph{woman}! Whatever you feel more comfortable
14886 with! So there!
14887
14888 Most people make most of their mail groups total-expirable, though.
14889
14890 @vindex gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire
14891 If @code{gnus-inhibit-user-auto-expire} is non-@code{nil}, user marking
14892 commands will not mark an article as expirable, even if the group has
14893 auto-expire turned on.
14894
14895
14896 @node Washing Mail
14897 @subsection Washing Mail
14898 @cindex mail washing
14899 @cindex list server brain damage
14900 @cindex incoming mail treatment
14901
14902 Mailers and list servers are notorious for doing all sorts of really,
14903 really stupid things with mail. ``Hey, RFC 822 doesn't explicitly
14904 prohibit us from adding the string @code{wE aRe ElItE!!!!!1!!} to the
14905 end of all lines passing through our server, so let's do that!!!!1!''
14906 Yes, but RFC 822 wasn't designed to be read by morons. Things that were
14907 considered to be self-evident were not discussed. So. Here we are.
14908
14909 Case in point: The German version of Microsoft Exchange adds @samp{AW:
14910 } to the subjects of replies instead of @samp{Re: }. I could pretend to
14911 be shocked and dismayed by this, but I haven't got the energy. It is to
14912 laugh.
14913
14914 Gnus provides a plethora of functions for washing articles while
14915 displaying them, but it might be nicer to do the filtering before
14916 storing the mail to disk. For that purpose, we have three hooks and
14917 various functions that can be put in these hooks.
14918
14919 @table @code
14920 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14921 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-hook
14922 This hook is called before doing anything with the mail and is meant for
14923 grand, sweeping gestures. It is called in a buffer that contains all
14924 the new, incoming mail. Functions to be used include:
14925
14926 @table @code
14927 @item nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14928 @findex nnheader-ms-strip-cr
14929 Remove trailing carriage returns from each line. This is default on
14930 Emacs running on MS machines.
14931
14932 @end table
14933
14934 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14935 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-header-hook
14936 This hook is called narrowed to each header. It can be used when
14937 cleaning up the headers. Functions that can be used include:
14938
14939 @table @code
14940 @item nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14941 @findex nnmail-remove-leading-whitespace
14942 Clear leading white space that ``helpful'' listservs have added to the
14943 headers to make them look nice. Aaah.
14944
14945 (Note that this function works on both the header on the body of all
14946 messages, so it is a potentially dangerous function to use (if a body
14947 of a message contains something that looks like a header line). So
14948 rather than fix the bug, it is of course the right solution to make it
14949 into a feature by documenting it.)
14950
14951 @item nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14952 @findex nnmail-remove-list-identifiers
14953 Some list servers add an identifier---for example, @samp{(idm)}---to the
14954 beginning of all @code{Subject} headers. I'm sure that's nice for
14955 people who use stone age mail readers. This function will remove
14956 strings that match the @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} regexp, which can
14957 also be a list of regexp. @code{nnmail-list-identifiers} may not contain
14958 @code{\\(..\\)}.
14959
14960 For instance, if you want to remove the @samp{(idm)} and the
14961 @samp{nagnagnag} identifiers:
14962
14963 @lisp
14964 (setq nnmail-list-identifiers
14965 '("(idm)" "nagnagnag"))
14966 @end lisp
14967
14968 This can also be done non-destructively with
14969 @code{gnus-list-identifiers}, @xref{Article Hiding}.
14970
14971 @item nnmail-remove-tabs
14972 @findex nnmail-remove-tabs
14973 Translate all @samp{TAB} characters into @samp{SPACE} characters.
14974
14975 @item nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14976 @findex nnmail-fix-eudora-headers
14977 @cindex Eudora
14978 Eudora produces broken @code{References} headers, but OK
14979 @code{In-Reply-To} headers. This function will get rid of the
14980 @code{References} headers.
14981
14982 @end table
14983
14984 @item nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14985 @vindex nnmail-prepare-incoming-message-hook
14986 This hook is called narrowed to each message. Functions to be used
14987 include:
14988
14989 @table @code
14990 @item article-de-quoted-unreadable
14991 @findex article-de-quoted-unreadable
14992 Decode Quoted Readable encoding.
14993
14994 @end table
14995 @end table
14996
14997
14998 @node Duplicates
14999 @subsection Duplicates
15000
15001 @vindex nnmail-treat-duplicates
15002 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-length
15003 @vindex nnmail-message-id-cache-file
15004 @cindex duplicate mails
15005 If you are a member of a couple of mailing lists, you will sometimes
15006 receive two copies of the same mail. This can be quite annoying, so
15007 @code{nnmail} checks for and treats any duplicates it might find. To do
15008 this, it keeps a cache of old @code{Message-ID}s---
15009 @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-file}, which is @file{~/.nnmail-cache} by
15010 default. The approximate maximum number of @code{Message-ID}s stored
15011 there is controlled by the @code{nnmail-message-id-cache-length}
15012 variable, which is 1000 by default. (So 1000 @code{Message-ID}s will be
15013 stored.) If all this sounds scary to you, you can set
15014 @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} to @code{warn} (which is what it is by
15015 default), and @code{nnmail} won't delete duplicate mails. Instead it
15016 will insert a warning into the head of the mail saying that it thinks
15017 that this is a duplicate of a different message.
15018
15019 This variable can also be a function. If that's the case, the function
15020 will be called from a buffer narrowed to the message in question with
15021 the @code{Message-ID} as a parameter. The function must return either
15022 @code{nil}, @code{warn}, or @code{delete}.
15023
15024 You can turn this feature off completely by setting the variable to
15025 @code{nil}.
15026
15027 If you want all the duplicate mails to be put into a special
15028 @dfn{duplicates} group, you could do that using the normal mail split
15029 methods:
15030
15031 @lisp
15032 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
15033 '(| ;; @r{Messages duplicates go to a separate group.}
15034 ("gnus-warning" "duplicat\\(e\\|ion\\) of message" "duplicate")
15035 ;; @r{Message from daemons, postmaster, and the like to another.}
15036 (any mail "mail.misc")
15037 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15038 [...] ))
15039 @end lisp
15040 @noindent
15041 Or something like:
15042 @lisp
15043 (setq nnmail-split-methods
15044 '(("duplicates" "^Gnus-Warning:.*duplicate")
15045 ;; @r{Other rules.}
15046 [...]))
15047 @end lisp
15048
15049 Here's a neat feature: If you know that the recipient reads her mail
15050 with Gnus, and that she has @code{nnmail-treat-duplicates} set to
15051 @code{delete}, you can send her as many insults as you like, just by
15052 using a @code{Message-ID} of a mail that you know that she's already
15053 received. Think of all the fun! She'll never see any of it! Whee!
15054
15055
15056 @node Not Reading Mail
15057 @subsection Not Reading Mail
15058
15059 If you start using any of the mail back ends, they have the annoying
15060 habit of assuming that you want to read mail with them. This might not
15061 be unreasonable, but it might not be what you want.
15062
15063 If you set @code{mail-sources} and @code{nnmail-spool-file} to
15064 @code{nil}, none of the back ends will ever attempt to read incoming
15065 mail, which should help.
15066
15067 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15068 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15069 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15070 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15071 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15072 This might be too much, if, for instance, you are reading mail quite
15073 happily with @code{nnml} and just want to peek at some old Rmail
15074 file you have stashed away with @code{nnbabyl}. All back ends have
15075 variables called back-end-@code{get-new-mail}. If you want to disable
15076 the @code{nnbabyl} mail reading, you edit the virtual server for the
15077 group to have a setting where @code{nnbabyl-get-new-mail} to @code{nil}.
15078
15079 All the mail back ends will call @code{nn}*@code{-prepare-save-mail-hook}
15080 narrowed to the article to be saved before saving it when reading
15081 incoming mail.
15082
15083
15084 @node Choosing a Mail Back End
15085 @subsection Choosing a Mail Back End
15086
15087 Gnus will read the mail spool when you activate a mail group. The mail
15088 file is first copied to your home directory. What happens after that
15089 depends on what format you want to store your mail in.
15090
15091 There are six different mail back ends in the standard Gnus, and more
15092 back ends are available separately. The mail back end most people use
15093 (because it is possibly the fastest) is @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
15094 Spool}).
15095
15096 @menu
15097 * Unix Mail Box:: Using the (quite) standard Un*x mbox.
15098 * Rmail Babyl:: Emacs programs use the Rmail Babyl format.
15099 * Mail Spool:: Store your mail in a private spool?
15100 * MH Spool:: An mhspool-like back end.
15101 * Maildir:: Another one-file-per-message format.
15102 * Mail Folders:: Having one file for each group.
15103 * Comparing Mail Back Ends:: An in-depth looks at pros and cons.
15104 @end menu
15105
15106
15107 @node Unix Mail Box
15108 @subsubsection Unix Mail Box
15109 @cindex nnmbox
15110 @cindex unix mail box
15111
15112 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
15113 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15114 The @dfn{nnmbox} back end will use the standard Un*x mbox file to store
15115 mail. @code{nnmbox} will add extra headers to each mail article to say
15116 which group it belongs in.
15117
15118 Virtual server settings:
15119
15120 @table @code
15121 @item nnmbox-mbox-file
15122 @vindex nnmbox-mbox-file
15123 The name of the mail box in the user's home directory. Default is
15124 @file{~/mbox}.
15125
15126 @item nnmbox-active-file
15127 @vindex nnmbox-active-file
15128 The name of the active file for the mail box. Default is
15129 @file{~/.mbox-active}.
15130
15131 @item nnmbox-get-new-mail
15132 @vindex nnmbox-get-new-mail
15133 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmbox} will read incoming mail and split it
15134 into groups. Default is @code{t}.
15135 @end table
15136
15137
15138 @node Rmail Babyl
15139 @subsubsection Rmail Babyl
15140 @cindex nnbabyl
15141 @cindex Rmail mbox
15142
15143 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15144 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15145 The @dfn{nnbabyl} back end will use a Babyl mail box (aka. @dfn{Rmail
15146 mbox}) to store mail. @code{nnbabyl} will add extra headers to each
15147 mail article to say which group it belongs in.
15148
15149 Virtual server settings:
15150
15151 @table @code
15152 @item nnbabyl-mbox-file
15153 @vindex nnbabyl-mbox-file
15154 The name of the Rmail mbox file. The default is @file{~/RMAIL}
15155
15156 @item nnbabyl-active-file
15157 @vindex nnbabyl-active-file
15158 The name of the active file for the rmail box. The default is
15159 @file{~/.rmail-active}
15160
15161 @item nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15162 @vindex nnbabyl-get-new-mail
15163 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnbabyl} will read incoming mail. Default is
15164 @code{t}
15165 @end table
15166
15167
15168 @node Mail Spool
15169 @subsubsection Mail Spool
15170 @cindex nnml
15171 @cindex mail @acronym{NOV} spool
15172
15173 The @dfn{nnml} spool mail format isn't compatible with any other known
15174 format. It should be used with some caution.
15175
15176 @vindex nnml-directory
15177 If you use this back end, Gnus will split all incoming mail into files,
15178 one file for each mail, and put the articles into the corresponding
15179 directories under the directory specified by the @code{nnml-directory}
15180 variable. The default value is @file{~/Mail/}.
15181
15182 You do not have to create any directories beforehand; Gnus will take
15183 care of all that.
15184
15185 If you have a strict limit as to how many files you are allowed to store
15186 in your account, you should not use this back end. As each mail gets its
15187 own file, you might very well occupy thousands of inodes within a few
15188 weeks. If this is no problem for you, and it isn't a problem for you
15189 having your friendly systems administrator walking around, madly,
15190 shouting ``Who is eating all my inodes?! Who? Who!?!'', then you should
15191 know that this is probably the fastest format to use. You do not have
15192 to trudge through a big mbox file just to read your new mail.
15193
15194 @code{nnml} is probably the slowest back end when it comes to article
15195 splitting. It has to create lots of files, and it also generates
15196 @acronym{NOV} databases for the incoming mails. This makes it possibly the
15197 fastest back end when it comes to reading mail.
15198
15199 @cindex self contained nnml servers
15200 @cindex marks
15201 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnml}
15202 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15203 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15204 proper @code{nnml} server) and have all your marks be preserved. Marks
15205 for a group is usually stored in the @code{.marks} file (but see
15206 @code{nnml-marks-file-name}) within each @code{nnml} group's directory.
15207 Individual @code{nnml} groups are also possible to backup, use @kbd{G m}
15208 to restore the group (after restoring the backup into the nnml
15209 directory).
15210
15211 If for some reason you believe your @file{.marks} files are screwed
15212 up, you can just delete them all. Gnus will then correctly regenerate
15213 them next time it starts.
15214
15215 Virtual server settings:
15216
15217 @table @code
15218 @item nnml-directory
15219 @vindex nnml-directory
15220 All @code{nnml} directories will be placed under this directory. The
15221 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default value
15222 is @file{~/Mail}).
15223
15224 @item nnml-active-file
15225 @vindex nnml-active-file
15226 The active file for the @code{nnml} server. The default is
15227 @file{~/Mail/active}.
15228
15229 @item nnml-newsgroups-file
15230 @vindex nnml-newsgroups-file
15231 The @code{nnml} group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15232 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}.
15233
15234 @item nnml-get-new-mail
15235 @vindex nnml-get-new-mail
15236 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will read incoming mail. The default is
15237 @code{t}.
15238
15239 @item nnml-nov-is-evil
15240 @vindex nnml-nov-is-evil
15241 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15242 default is @code{nil}.
15243
15244 @item nnml-nov-file-name
15245 @vindex nnml-nov-file-name
15246 The name of the @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.overview}.
15247
15248 @item nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15249 @vindex nnml-prepare-save-mail-hook
15250 Hook run narrowed to an article before saving.
15251
15252 @item nnml-marks-is-evil
15253 @vindex nnml-marks-is-evil
15254 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15255 default is @code{nil}.
15256
15257 @item nnml-marks-file-name
15258 @vindex nnml-marks-file-name
15259 The name of the @dfn{marks} files. The default is @file{.marks}.
15260
15261 @item nnml-use-compressed-files
15262 @vindex nnml-use-compressed-files
15263 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnml} will allow using compressed message
15264 files.
15265
15266 @end table
15267
15268 @findex nnml-generate-nov-databases
15269 If your @code{nnml} groups and @acronym{NOV} files get totally out of
15270 whack, you can do a complete update by typing @kbd{M-x
15271 nnml-generate-nov-databases}. This command will trawl through the
15272 entire @code{nnml} hierarchy, looking at each and every article, so it
15273 might take a while to complete. A better interface to this
15274 functionality can be found in the server buffer (@pxref{Server
15275 Commands}).
15276
15277
15278 @node MH Spool
15279 @subsubsection MH Spool
15280 @cindex nnmh
15281 @cindex mh-e mail spool
15282
15283 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, except that is doesn't generate
15284 @acronym{NOV} databases and it doesn't keep an active file or marks
15285 file. This makes @code{nnmh} a @emph{much} slower back end than
15286 @code{nnml}, but it also makes it easier to write procmail scripts
15287 for.
15288
15289 Virtual server settings:
15290
15291 @table @code
15292 @item nnmh-directory
15293 @vindex nnmh-directory
15294 All @code{nnmh} directories will be located under this directory. The
15295 default is the value of @code{message-directory} (whose default is
15296 @file{~/Mail})
15297
15298 @item nnmh-get-new-mail
15299 @vindex nnmh-get-new-mail
15300 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will read incoming mail. The default is
15301 @code{t}.
15302
15303 @item nnmh-be-safe
15304 @vindex nnmh-be-safe
15305 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmh} will go to ridiculous lengths to make
15306 sure that the articles in the folder are actually what Gnus thinks
15307 they are. It will check date stamps and stat everything in sight, so
15308 setting this to @code{t} will mean a serious slow-down. If you never
15309 use anything but Gnus to read the @code{nnmh} articles, you do not
15310 have to set this variable to @code{t}. The default is @code{nil}.
15311 @end table
15312
15313
15314 @node Maildir
15315 @subsubsection Maildir
15316 @cindex nnmaildir
15317 @cindex maildir
15318
15319 @code{nnmaildir} stores mail in the maildir format, with each maildir
15320 corresponding to a group in Gnus. This format is documented here:
15321 @uref{http://cr.yp.to/proto/maildir.html} and here:
15322 @uref{http://www.qmail.org/man/man5/maildir.html}. @code{nnmaildir}
15323 also stores extra information in the @file{.nnmaildir/} directory
15324 within a maildir.
15325
15326 Maildir format was designed to allow concurrent deliveries and
15327 reading, without needing locks. With other back ends, you would have
15328 your mail delivered to a spool of some kind, and then you would
15329 configure Gnus to split mail from that spool into your groups. You
15330 can still do that with @code{nnmaildir}, but the more common
15331 configuration is to have your mail delivered directly to the maildirs
15332 that appear as group in Gnus.
15333
15334 @code{nnmaildir} is designed to be perfectly reliable: @kbd{C-g} will
15335 never corrupt its data in memory, and @code{SIGKILL} will never
15336 corrupt its data in the filesystem.
15337
15338 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks and @acronym{NOV} data in each
15339 maildir. So you can copy a whole maildir from one Gnus setup to
15340 another, and you will keep your marks.
15341
15342 Virtual server settings:
15343
15344 @table @code
15345 @item directory
15346 For each of your @code{nnmaildir} servers (it's very unlikely that
15347 you'd need more than one), you need to create a directory and populate
15348 it with maildirs or symlinks to maildirs (and nothing else; do not
15349 choose a directory already used for other purposes). Each maildir
15350 will be represented in Gnus as a newsgroup on that server; the
15351 filename of the symlink will be the name of the group. Any filenames
15352 in the directory starting with @samp{.} are ignored. The directory is
15353 scanned when you first start Gnus, and each time you type @kbd{g} in
15354 the group buffer; if any maildirs have been removed or added,
15355 @code{nnmaildir} notices at these times.
15356
15357 The value of the @code{directory} parameter should be a Lisp form
15358 which is processed by @code{eval} and @code{expand-file-name} to get
15359 the path of the directory for this server. The form is @code{eval}ed
15360 only when the server is opened; the resulting string is used until the
15361 server is closed. (If you don't know about forms and @code{eval},
15362 don't worry---a simple string will work.) This parameter is not
15363 optional; you must specify it. I don't recommend using
15364 @code{"~/Mail"} or a subdirectory of it; several other parts of Gnus
15365 use that directory by default for various things, and may get confused
15366 if @code{nnmaildir} uses it too. @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} is a typical
15367 value.
15368
15369 @item target-prefix
15370 This should be a Lisp form which is processed by @code{eval} and
15371 @code{expand-file-name}. The form is @code{eval}ed only when the
15372 server is opened; the resulting string is used until the server is
15373 closed.
15374
15375 When you create a group on an @code{nnmaildir} server, the maildir is
15376 created with @code{target-prefix} prepended to its name, and a symlink
15377 pointing to that maildir is created, named with the plain group name.
15378 So if @code{directory} is @code{"~/.nnmaildir"} and
15379 @code{target-prefix} is @code{"../maildirs/"}, then when you create
15380 the group @code{foo}, @code{nnmaildir} will create
15381 @file{~/.nnmaildir/../maildirs/foo} as a maildir, and will create
15382 @file{~/.nnmaildir/foo} as a symlink pointing to
15383 @file{../maildirs/foo}.
15384
15385 You can set @code{target-prefix} to a string without any slashes to
15386 create both maildirs and symlinks in the same @code{directory}; in
15387 this case, any maildirs found in @code{directory} whose names start
15388 with @code{target-prefix} will not be listed as groups (but the
15389 symlinks pointing to them will be).
15390
15391 As a special case, if @code{target-prefix} is @code{""} (the default),
15392 then when you create a group, the maildir will be created in
15393 @code{directory} without a corresponding symlink. Beware that you
15394 cannot use @code{gnus-group-delete-group} on such groups without the
15395 @code{force} argument.
15396
15397 @item directory-files
15398 This should be a function with the same interface as
15399 @code{directory-files} (such as @code{directory-files} itself). It is
15400 used to scan the server's @code{directory} for maildirs. This
15401 parameter is optional; the default is
15402 @code{nnheader-directory-files-safe} if
15403 @code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is @code{nil}, and
15404 @code{directory-files} otherwise.
15405 (@code{nnheader-directory-files-is-safe} is checked only once when the
15406 server is opened; if you want to check it each time the directory is
15407 scanned, you'll have to provide your own function that does that.)
15408
15409 @item get-new-mail
15410 If non-@code{nil}, then after scanning for new mail in the group
15411 maildirs themselves as usual, this server will also incorporate mail
15412 the conventional Gnus way, from @code{mail-sources} according to
15413 @code{nnmail-split-methods} or @code{nnmail-split-fancy}. The default
15414 value is @code{nil}.
15415
15416 Do @emph{not} use the same maildir both in @code{mail-sources} and as
15417 an @code{nnmaildir} group. The results might happen to be useful, but
15418 that would be by chance, not by design, and the results might be
15419 different in the future. If your split rules create new groups,
15420 remember to supply a @code{create-directory} server parameter.
15421 @end table
15422
15423 @subsubsection Group parameters
15424
15425 @code{nnmaildir} uses several group parameters. It's safe to ignore
15426 all this; the default behavior for @code{nnmaildir} is the same as the
15427 default behavior for other mail back ends: articles are deleted after
15428 one week, etc. Except for the expiry parameters, all this
15429 functionality is unique to @code{nnmaildir}, so you can ignore it if
15430 you're just trying to duplicate the behavior you already have with
15431 another back end.
15432
15433 If the value of any of these parameters is a vector, the first element
15434 is evaluated as a Lisp form and the result is used, rather than the
15435 original value. If the value is not a vector, the value itself is
15436 evaluated as a Lisp form. (This is why these parameters use names
15437 different from those of other, similar parameters supported by other
15438 back ends: they have different, though similar, meanings.) (For
15439 numbers, strings, @code{nil}, and @code{t}, you can ignore the
15440 @code{eval} business again; for other values, remember to use an extra
15441 quote and wrap the value in a vector when appropriate.)
15442
15443 @table @code
15444 @item expire-age
15445 An integer specifying the minimum age, in seconds, of an article
15446 before it will be expired, or the symbol @code{never} to specify that
15447 articles should never be expired. If this parameter is not set,
15448 @code{nnmaildir} falls back to the usual
15449 @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}(@code{-function}) variables (the
15450 @code{expiry-wait} group parameter overrides @code{nnmail-expiry-wait}
15451 and makes @code{nnmail-expiry-wait-function} ineffective). If you
15452 wanted a value of 3 days, you could use something like @code{[(* 3 24
15453 60 60)]}; @code{nnmaildir} will evaluate the form and use the result.
15454 An article's age is measured starting from the article file's
15455 modification time. Normally, this is the same as the article's
15456 delivery time, but editing an article makes it younger. Moving an
15457 article (other than via expiry) may also make an article younger.
15458
15459 @item expire-group
15460 If this is set to a string such as a full Gnus group name, like
15461 @example
15462 "backend+server.address.string:group.name"
15463 @end example
15464 and if it is not the name of the same group that the parameter belongs
15465 to, then articles will be moved to the specified group during expiry
15466 before being deleted. @emph{If this is set to an @code{nnmaildir}
15467 group, the article will be just as old in the destination group as it
15468 was in the source group.} So be careful with @code{expire-age} in the
15469 destination group. If this is set to the name of the same group that
15470 the parameter belongs to, then the article is not expired at all. If
15471 you use the vector form, the first element is evaluated once for each
15472 article. So that form can refer to
15473 @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name}, etc., to decide where to put the
15474 article. @emph{Even if this parameter is not set, @code{nnmaildir}
15475 does not fall back to the @code{expiry-target} group parameter or the
15476 @code{nnmail-expiry-target} variable.}
15477
15478 @item read-only
15479 If this is set to @code{t}, @code{nnmaildir} will treat the articles
15480 in this maildir as read-only. This means: articles are not renamed
15481 from @file{new/} into @file{cur/}; articles are only found in
15482 @file{new/}, not @file{cur/}; articles are never deleted; articles
15483 cannot be edited. @file{new/} is expected to be a symlink to the
15484 @file{new/} directory of another maildir---e.g., a system-wide mailbox
15485 containing a mailing list of common interest. Everything in the
15486 maildir outside @file{new/} is @emph{not} treated as read-only, so for
15487 a shared mailbox, you do still need to set up your own maildir (or
15488 have write permission to the shared mailbox); your maildir just won't
15489 contain extra copies of the articles.
15490
15491 @item directory-files
15492 A function with the same interface as @code{directory-files}. It is
15493 used to scan the directories in the maildir corresponding to this
15494 group to find articles. The default is the function specified by the
15495 server's @code{directory-files} parameter.
15496
15497 @item distrust-Lines:
15498 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnmaildir} will always count the lines of an
15499 article, rather than use the @code{Lines:} header field. If
15500 @code{nil}, the header field will be used if present.
15501
15502 @item always-marks
15503 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(read expire)]}. Whenever
15504 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15505 say that all articles have these marks, regardless of whether the
15506 marks stored in the filesystem say so. This is a proof-of-concept
15507 feature that will probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done
15508 in Gnus proper, or abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15509
15510 @item never-marks
15511 A list of mark symbols, such as @code{['(tick expire)]}. Whenever
15512 Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for article marks, @code{nnmaildir} will
15513 say that no articles have these marks, regardless of whether the marks
15514 stored in the filesystem say so. @code{never-marks} overrides
15515 @code{always-marks}. This is a proof-of-concept feature that will
15516 probably be removed eventually; it ought to be done in Gnus proper, or
15517 abandoned if it's not worthwhile.
15518
15519 @item nov-cache-size
15520 An integer specifying the size of the @acronym{NOV} memory cache. To
15521 speed things up, @code{nnmaildir} keeps @acronym{NOV} data in memory
15522 for a limited number of articles in each group. (This is probably not
15523 worthwhile, and will probably be removed in the future.) This
15524 parameter's value is noticed only the first time a group is seen after
15525 the server is opened---i.e., when you first start Gnus, typically.
15526 The @acronym{NOV} cache is never resized until the server is closed
15527 and reopened. The default is an estimate of the number of articles
15528 that would be displayed in the summary buffer: a count of articles
15529 that are either marked with @code{tick} or not marked with
15530 @code{read}, plus a little extra.
15531 @end table
15532
15533 @subsubsection Article identification
15534 Articles are stored in the @file{cur/} subdirectory of each maildir.
15535 Each article file is named like @code{uniq:info}, where @code{uniq}
15536 contains no colons. @code{nnmaildir} ignores, but preserves, the
15537 @code{:info} part. (Other maildir readers typically use this part of
15538 the filename to store marks.) The @code{uniq} part uniquely
15539 identifies the article, and is used in various places in the
15540 @file{.nnmaildir/} subdirectory of the maildir to store information
15541 about the corresponding article. The full pathname of an article is
15542 available in the variable @code{nnmaildir-article-file-name} after you
15543 request the article in the summary buffer.
15544
15545 @subsubsection NOV data
15546 An article identified by @code{uniq} has its @acronym{NOV} data (used
15547 to generate lines in the summary buffer) stored in
15548 @code{.nnmaildir/nov/uniq}. There is no
15549 @code{nnmaildir-generate-nov-databases} function. (There isn't much
15550 need for it---an article's @acronym{NOV} data is updated automatically
15551 when the article or @code{nnmail-extra-headers} has changed.) You can
15552 force @code{nnmaildir} to regenerate the @acronym{NOV} data for a
15553 single article simply by deleting the corresponding @acronym{NOV}
15554 file, but @emph{beware}: this will also cause @code{nnmaildir} to
15555 assign a new article number for this article, which may cause trouble
15556 with @code{seen} marks, the Agent, and the cache.
15557
15558 @subsubsection Article marks
15559 An article identified by @code{uniq} is considered to have the mark
15560 @code{flag} when the file @file{.nnmaildir/marks/flag/uniq} exists.
15561 When Gnus asks @code{nnmaildir} for a group's marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15562 looks for such files and reports the set of marks it finds. When Gnus
15563 asks @code{nnmaildir} to store a new set of marks, @code{nnmaildir}
15564 creates and deletes the corresponding files as needed. (Actually,
15565 rather than create a new file for each mark, it just creates hard
15566 links to @file{.nnmaildir/markfile}, to save inodes.)
15567
15568 You can invent new marks by creating a new directory in
15569 @file{.nnmaildir/marks/}. You can tar up a maildir and remove it from
15570 your server, untar it later, and keep your marks. You can add and
15571 remove marks yourself by creating and deleting mark files. If you do
15572 this while Gnus is running and your @code{nnmaildir} server is open,
15573 it's best to exit all summary buffers for @code{nnmaildir} groups and
15574 type @kbd{s} in the group buffer first, and to type @kbd{g} or
15575 @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer afterwards. Otherwise, Gnus might not
15576 pick up the changes, and might undo them.
15577
15578
15579 @node Mail Folders
15580 @subsubsection Mail Folders
15581 @cindex nnfolder
15582 @cindex mbox folders
15583 @cindex mail folders
15584
15585 @code{nnfolder} is a back end for storing each mail group in a
15586 separate file. Each file is in the standard Un*x mbox format.
15587 @code{nnfolder} will add extra headers to keep track of article
15588 numbers and arrival dates.
15589
15590 @cindex self contained nnfolder servers
15591 @cindex marks
15592 When the marks file is used (which it is by default), @code{nnfolder}
15593 servers have the property that you may backup them using @code{tar} or
15594 similar, and later be able to restore them into Gnus (by adding the
15595 proper @code{nnfolder} server) and have all your marks be preserved.
15596 Marks for a group are usually stored in a file named as the mbox file
15597 with @code{.mrk} concatenated to it (but see
15598 @code{nnfolder-marks-file-suffix}) within the @code{nnfolder}
15599 directory. Individual @code{nnfolder} groups are also possible to
15600 backup, use @kbd{G m} to restore the group (after restoring the backup
15601 into the @code{nnfolder} directory).
15602
15603 Virtual server settings:
15604
15605 @table @code
15606 @item nnfolder-directory
15607 @vindex nnfolder-directory
15608 All the @code{nnfolder} mail boxes will be stored under this
15609 directory. The default is the value of @code{message-directory}
15610 (whose default is @file{~/Mail})
15611
15612 @item nnfolder-active-file
15613 @vindex nnfolder-active-file
15614 The name of the active file. The default is @file{~/Mail/active}.
15615
15616 @item nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15617 @vindex nnfolder-newsgroups-file
15618 The name of the group descriptions file. @xref{Newsgroups File
15619 Format}. The default is @file{~/Mail/newsgroups}
15620
15621 @item nnfolder-get-new-mail
15622 @vindex nnfolder-get-new-mail
15623 If non-@code{nil}, @code{nnfolder} will read incoming mail. The
15624 default is @code{t}
15625
15626 @item nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15627 @vindex nnfolder-save-buffer-hook
15628 @cindex backup files
15629 Hook run before saving the folders. Note that Emacs does the normal
15630 backup renaming of files even with the @code{nnfolder} buffers. If
15631 you wish to switch this off, you could say something like the
15632 following in your @file{.emacs} file:
15633
15634 @lisp
15635 (defun turn-off-backup ()
15636 (set (make-local-variable 'backup-inhibited) t))
15637
15638 (add-hook 'nnfolder-save-buffer-hook 'turn-off-backup)
15639 @end lisp
15640
15641 @item nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15642 @vindex nnfolder-delete-mail-hook
15643 Hook run in a buffer narrowed to the message that is to be deleted.
15644 This function can be used to copy the message to somewhere else, or to
15645 extract some information from it before removing it.
15646
15647 @item nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15648 @vindex nnfolder-nov-is-evil
15649 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @acronym{NOV} files. The
15650 default is @code{nil}.
15651
15652 @item nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15653 @vindex nnfolder-nov-file-suffix
15654 The extension for @acronym{NOV} files. The default is @file{.nov}.
15655
15656 @item nnfolder-nov-directory
15657 @vindex nnfolder-nov-directory
15658 The directory where the @acronym{NOV} files should be stored. If
15659 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15660
15661 @item nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15662 @vindex nnfolder-marks-is-evil
15663 If non-@code{nil}, this back end will ignore any @sc{marks} files. The
15664 default is @code{nil}.
15665
15666 @item nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15667 @vindex nnfolder-marks-file-suffix
15668 The extension for @sc{marks} files. The default is @file{.mrk}.
15669
15670 @item nnfolder-marks-directory
15671 @vindex nnfolder-marks-directory
15672 The directory where the @sc{marks} files should be stored. If
15673 @code{nil}, @code{nnfolder-directory} is used.
15674
15675 @end table
15676
15677
15678 @findex nnfolder-generate-active-file
15679 @kindex M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file
15680 If you have lots of @code{nnfolder}-like files you'd like to read with
15681 @code{nnfolder}, you can use the @kbd{M-x nnfolder-generate-active-file}
15682 command to make @code{nnfolder} aware of all likely files in
15683 @code{nnfolder-directory}. This only works if you use long file names,
15684 though.
15685
15686 @node Comparing Mail Back Ends
15687 @subsubsection Comparing Mail Back Ends
15688
15689 First, just for terminology, the @dfn{back end} is the common word for a
15690 low-level access method---a transport, if you will, by which something
15691 is acquired. The sense is that one's mail has to come from somewhere,
15692 and so selection of a suitable back end is required in order to get that
15693 mail within spitting distance of Gnus.
15694
15695 The same concept exists for Usenet itself: Though access to articles is
15696 typically done by @acronym{NNTP} these days, once upon a midnight dreary, everyone
15697 in the world got at Usenet by running a reader on the machine where the
15698 articles lay (the machine which today we call an @acronym{NNTP} server), and
15699 access was by the reader stepping into the articles' directory spool
15700 area directly. One can still select between either the @code{nntp} or
15701 @code{nnspool} back ends, to select between these methods, if one happens
15702 actually to live on the server (or can see its spool directly, anyway,
15703 via NFS).
15704
15705 The goal in selecting a mail back end is to pick one which
15706 simultaneously represents a suitable way of dealing with the original
15707 format plus leaving mail in a form that is convenient to use in the
15708 future. Here are some high and low points on each:
15709
15710 @table @code
15711 @item nnmbox
15712
15713 UNIX systems have historically had a single, very common, and well-
15714 defined format. All messages arrive in a single @dfn{spool file}, and
15715 they are delineated by a line whose regular expression matches
15716 @samp{^From_}. (My notational use of @samp{_} is to indicate a space,
15717 to make it clear in this instance that this is not the RFC-specified
15718 @samp{From:} header.) Because Emacs and therefore Gnus emanate
15719 historically from the Unix environment, it is simplest if one does not
15720 mess a great deal with the original mailbox format, so if one chooses
15721 this back end, Gnus' primary activity in getting mail from the real spool
15722 area to Gnus' preferred directory is simply to copy it, with no
15723 (appreciable) format change in the process. It is the ``dumbest'' way
15724 to move mail into availability in the Gnus environment. This makes it
15725 fast to move into place, but slow to parse, when Gnus has to look at
15726 what's where.
15727
15728 @item nnbabyl
15729
15730 Once upon a time, there was the DEC-10 and DEC-20, running operating
15731 systems called TOPS and related things, and the usual (only?) mail
15732 reading environment was a thing called Babyl. I don't know what format
15733 was used for mail landing on the system, but Babyl had its own internal
15734 format to which mail was converted, primarily involving creating a
15735 spool-file-like entity with a scheme for inserting Babyl-specific
15736 headers and status bits above the top of each message in the file.
15737 Rmail was Emacs' first mail reader, it was written by Richard Stallman,
15738 and Stallman came out of that TOPS/Babyl environment, so he wrote Rmail
15739 to understand the mail files folks already had in existence. Gnus (and
15740 VM, for that matter) continue to support this format because it's
15741 perceived as having some good qualities in those mailer-specific
15742 headers/status bits stuff. Rmail itself still exists as well, of
15743 course, and is still maintained by Stallman.
15744
15745 Both of the above forms leave your mail in a single file on your
15746 file system, and they must parse that entire file each time you take a
15747 look at your mail.
15748
15749 @item nnml
15750
15751 @code{nnml} is the back end which smells the most as though you were
15752 actually operating with an @code{nnspool}-accessed Usenet system. (In
15753 fact, I believe @code{nnml} actually derived from @code{nnspool} code,
15754 lo these years ago.) One's mail is taken from the original spool file,
15755 and is then cut up into individual message files, 1:1. It maintains a
15756 Usenet-style active file (analogous to what one finds in an INN- or
15757 CNews-based news system in (for instance) @file{/var/lib/news/active},
15758 or what is returned via the @samp{NNTP LIST} verb) and also creates
15759 @dfn{overview} files for efficient group entry, as has been defined for
15760 @acronym{NNTP} servers for some years now. It is slower in mail-splitting,
15761 due to the creation of lots of files, updates to the @code{nnml} active
15762 file, and additions to overview files on a per-message basis, but it is
15763 extremely fast on access because of what amounts to the indexing support
15764 provided by the active file and overviews.
15765
15766 @code{nnml} costs @dfn{inodes} in a big way; that is, it soaks up the
15767 resource which defines available places in the file system to put new
15768 files. Sysadmins take a dim view of heavy inode occupation within
15769 tight, shared file systems. But if you live on a personal machine where
15770 the file system is your own and space is not at a premium, @code{nnml}
15771 wins big.
15772
15773 It is also problematic using this back end if you are living in a
15774 FAT16-based Windows world, since much space will be wasted on all these
15775 tiny files.
15776
15777 @item nnmh
15778
15779 The Rand MH mail-reading system has been around UNIX systems for a very
15780 long time; it operates by splitting one's spool file of messages into
15781 individual files, but with little or no indexing support---@code{nnmh}
15782 is considered to be semantically equivalent to ``@code{nnml} without
15783 active file or overviews''. This is arguably the worst choice, because
15784 one gets the slowness of individual file creation married to the
15785 slowness of access parsing when learning what's new in one's groups.
15786
15787 @item nnfolder
15788
15789 Basically the effect of @code{nnfolder} is @code{nnmbox} (the first
15790 method described above) on a per-group basis. That is, @code{nnmbox}
15791 itself puts @emph{all} one's mail in one file; @code{nnfolder} provides a
15792 little bit of optimization to this so that each of one's mail groups has
15793 a Unix mail box file. It's faster than @code{nnmbox} because each group
15794 can be parsed separately, and still provides the simple Unix mail box
15795 format requiring minimal effort in moving the mail around. In addition,
15796 it maintains an ``active'' file making it much faster for Gnus to figure
15797 out how many messages there are in each separate group.
15798
15799 If you have groups that are expected to have a massive amount of
15800 messages, @code{nnfolder} is not the best choice, but if you receive
15801 only a moderate amount of mail, @code{nnfolder} is probably the most
15802 friendly mail back end all over.
15803
15804 @item nnmaildir
15805
15806 For configuring expiry and other things, @code{nnmaildir} uses
15807 incompatible group parameters, slightly different from those of other
15808 mail back ends.
15809
15810 @code{nnmaildir} is largely similar to @code{nnml}, with some notable
15811 differences. Each message is stored in a separate file, but the
15812 filename is unrelated to the article number in Gnus. @code{nnmaildir}
15813 also stores the equivalent of @code{nnml}'s overview files in one file
15814 per article, so it uses about twice as many inodes as @code{nnml}. (Use
15815 @code{df -i} to see how plentiful your inode supply is.) If this slows
15816 you down or takes up very much space, consider switching to
15817 @uref{http://www.namesys.com/, ReiserFS} or another non-block-structured
15818 file system.
15819
15820 Since maildirs don't require locking for delivery, the maildirs you use
15821 as groups can also be the maildirs your mail is directly delivered to.
15822 This means you can skip Gnus' mail splitting if your mail is already
15823 organized into different mailboxes during delivery. A @code{directory}
15824 entry in @code{mail-sources} would have a similar effect, but would
15825 require one set of mailboxes for spooling deliveries (in mbox format,
15826 thus damaging message bodies), and another set to be used as groups (in
15827 whatever format you like). A maildir has a built-in spool, in the
15828 @code{new/} subdirectory. Beware that currently, mail moved from
15829 @code{new/} to @code{cur/} instead of via mail splitting will not
15830 undergo treatment such as duplicate checking.
15831
15832 @code{nnmaildir} stores article marks for a given group in the
15833 corresponding maildir, in a way designed so that it's easy to manipulate
15834 them from outside Gnus. You can tar up a maildir, unpack it somewhere
15835 else, and still have your marks. @code{nnml} also stores marks, but
15836 it's not as easy to work with them from outside Gnus as with
15837 @code{nnmaildir}.
15838
15839 @code{nnmaildir} uses a significant amount of memory to speed things up.
15840 (It keeps in memory some of the things that @code{nnml} stores in files
15841 and that @code{nnmh} repeatedly parses out of message files.) If this
15842 is a problem for you, you can set the @code{nov-cache-size} group
15843 parameter to something small (0 would probably not work, but 1 probably
15844 would) to make it use less memory. This caching will probably be
15845 removed in the future.
15846
15847 Startup is likely to be slower with @code{nnmaildir} than with other
15848 back ends. Everything else is likely to be faster, depending in part
15849 on your file system.
15850
15851 @code{nnmaildir} does not use @code{nnoo}, so you cannot use @code{nnoo}
15852 to write an @code{nnmaildir}-derived back end.
15853
15854 @end table
15855
15856
15857 @node Browsing the Web
15858 @section Browsing the Web
15859 @cindex web
15860 @cindex browsing the web
15861 @cindex www
15862 @cindex http
15863
15864 Web-based discussion forums are getting more and more popular. On many
15865 subjects, the web-based forums have become the most important forums,
15866 eclipsing the importance of mailing lists and news groups. The reason
15867 is easy to understand---they are friendly to new users; you just point
15868 and click, and there's the discussion. With mailing lists, you have to
15869 go through a cumbersome subscription procedure, and most people don't
15870 even know what a news group is.
15871
15872 The problem with this scenario is that web browsers are not very good at
15873 being newsreaders. They do not keep track of what articles you've read;
15874 they do not allow you to score on subjects you're interested in; they do
15875 not allow off-line browsing; they require you to click around and drive
15876 you mad in the end.
15877
15878 So---if web browsers suck at reading discussion forums, why not use Gnus
15879 to do it instead?
15880
15881 Gnus has been getting a bit of a collection of back ends for providing
15882 interfaces to these sources.
15883
15884 @menu
15885 * Archiving Mail::
15886 * Web Searches:: Creating groups from articles that match a string.
15887 * Slashdot:: Reading the Slashdot comments.
15888 * Ultimate:: The Ultimate Bulletin Board systems.
15889 * Web Archive:: Reading mailing list archived on web.
15890 * RSS:: Reading RDF site summary.
15891 * Customizing W3:: Doing stuff to Emacs/W3 from Gnus.
15892 @end menu
15893
15894 All the web sources require Emacs/W3 and the url library or those
15895 alternatives to work.
15896
15897 The main caveat with all these web sources is that they probably won't
15898 work for a very long time. Gleaning information from the @acronym{HTML} data
15899 is guesswork at best, and when the layout is altered, the Gnus back end
15900 will fail. If you have reasonably new versions of these back ends,
15901 though, you should be ok.
15902
15903 One thing all these Web methods have in common is that the Web sources
15904 are often down, unavailable or just plain too slow to be fun. In those
15905 cases, it makes a lot of sense to let the Gnus Agent (@pxref{Gnus
15906 Unplugged}) handle downloading articles, and then you can read them at
15907 leisure from your local disk. No more World Wide Wait for you.
15908
15909 @node Archiving Mail
15910 @subsection Archiving Mail
15911 @cindex archiving mail
15912 @cindex backup of mail
15913
15914 Some of the back ends, notably @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, and
15915 @code{nnmaildir}, now actually store the article marks with each group.
15916 For these servers, archiving and restoring a group while preserving
15917 marks is fairly simple.
15918
15919 (Preserving the group level and group parameters as well still
15920 requires ritual dancing and sacrifices to the @file{.newsrc.eld} deity
15921 though.)
15922
15923 To archive an entire @code{nnml}, @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir}
15924 server, take a recursive copy of the server directory. There is no need
15925 to shut down Gnus, so archiving may be invoked by @code{cron} or
15926 similar. You restore the data by restoring the directory tree, and
15927 adding a server definition pointing to that directory in Gnus. The
15928 @ref{Article Backlog}, @ref{Asynchronous Fetching} and other things
15929 might interfere with overwriting data, so you may want to shut down Gnus
15930 before you restore the data.
15931
15932 It is also possible to archive individual @code{nnml},
15933 @code{nnfolder}, or @code{nnmaildir} groups, while preserving marks.
15934 For @code{nnml} or @code{nnmaildir}, you copy all files in the group's
15935 directory. For @code{nnfolder} you need to copy both the base folder
15936 file itself (@file{FOO}, say), and the marks file (@file{FOO.mrk} in
15937 this example). Restoring the group is done with @kbd{G m} from the Group
15938 buffer. The last step makes Gnus notice the new directory.
15939 @code{nnmaildir} notices the new directory automatically, so @kbd{G m}
15940 is unnecessary in that case.
15941
15942 @node Web Searches
15943 @subsection Web Searches
15944 @cindex nnweb
15945 @cindex Google
15946 @cindex dejanews
15947 @cindex gmane
15948 @cindex Usenet searches
15949 @cindex searching the Usenet
15950
15951 It's, like, too neat to search the Usenet for articles that match a
15952 string, but it, like, totally @emph{sucks}, like, totally, to use one of
15953 those, like, Web browsers, and you, like, have to, rilly, like, look at
15954 the commercials, so, like, with Gnus you can do @emph{rad}, rilly,
15955 searches without having to use a browser.
15956
15957 The @code{nnweb} back end allows an easy interface to the mighty search
15958 engine. You create an @code{nnweb} group, enter a search pattern, and
15959 then enter the group and read the articles like you would any normal
15960 group. The @kbd{G w} command in the group buffer (@pxref{Foreign
15961 Groups}) will do this in an easy-to-use fashion.
15962
15963 @code{nnweb} groups don't really lend themselves to being solid
15964 groups---they have a very fleeting idea of article numbers. In fact,
15965 each time you enter an @code{nnweb} group (not even changing the search
15966 pattern), you are likely to get the articles ordered in a different
15967 manner. Not even using duplicate suppression (@pxref{Duplicate
15968 Suppression}) will help, since @code{nnweb} doesn't even know the
15969 @code{Message-ID} of the articles before reading them using some search
15970 engines (Google, for instance). The only possible way to keep track
15971 of which articles you've read is by scoring on the @code{Date}
15972 header---mark all articles posted before the last date you read the
15973 group as read.
15974
15975 If the search engine changes its output substantially, @code{nnweb}
15976 won't be able to parse it and will fail. One could hardly fault the Web
15977 providers if they were to do this---their @emph{raison d'être} is to
15978 make money off of advertisements, not to provide services to the
15979 community. Since @code{nnweb} washes the ads off all the articles, one
15980 might think that the providers might be somewhat miffed. We'll see.
15981
15982 You must have the @code{url} and @code{W3} package or those alternatives
15983 (try @code{customize-group} on the @samp{mm-url} variable group)
15984 installed to be able to use @code{nnweb}.
15985
15986 Virtual server variables:
15987
15988 @table @code
15989 @item nnweb-type
15990 @vindex nnweb-type
15991 What search engine type is being used. The currently supported types
15992 are @code{google}, @code{dejanews}, and @code{gmane}. Note that
15993 @code{dejanews} is an alias to @code{google}.
15994
15995 @item nnweb-search
15996 @vindex nnweb-search
15997 The search string to feed to the search engine.
15998
15999 @item nnweb-max-hits
16000 @vindex nnweb-max-hits
16001 Advisory maximum number of hits per search to display. The default is
16002 999.
16003
16004 @item nnweb-type-definition
16005 @vindex nnweb-type-definition
16006 Type-to-definition alist. This alist says what @code{nnweb} should do
16007 with the various search engine types. The following elements must be
16008 present:
16009
16010 @table @code
16011 @item article
16012 Function to decode the article and provide something that Gnus
16013 understands.
16014
16015 @item map
16016 Function to create an article number to message header and URL alist.
16017
16018 @item search
16019 Function to send the search string to the search engine.
16020
16021 @item address
16022 The address the aforementioned function should send the search string
16023 to.
16024
16025 @item id
16026 Format string URL to fetch an article by @code{Message-ID}.
16027 @end table
16028
16029 @end table
16030
16031
16032 @node Slashdot
16033 @subsection Slashdot
16034 @cindex Slashdot
16035 @cindex nnslashdot
16036
16037 @uref{http://slashdot.org/, Slashdot} is a popular news site, with
16038 lively discussion following the news articles. @code{nnslashdot} will
16039 let you read this forum in a convenient manner.
16040
16041 The easiest way to read this source is to put something like the
16042 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
16043
16044 @lisp
16045 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16046 '((nnslashdot "")))
16047 @end lisp
16048
16049 This will make Gnus query the @code{nnslashdot} back end for new comments
16050 and groups. The @kbd{F} command will subscribe each new news article as
16051 a new Gnus group, and you can read the comments by entering these
16052 groups. (Note that the default subscription method is to subscribe new
16053 groups as zombies. Other methods are available (@pxref{Subscription
16054 Methods}).
16055
16056 If you want to remove an old @code{nnslashdot} group, the @kbd{G DEL}
16057 command is the most handy tool (@pxref{Foreign Groups}).
16058
16059 When following up to @code{nnslashdot} comments (or posting new
16060 comments), some light @acronym{HTML}izations will be performed. In
16061 particular, text quoted with @samp{> } will be quoted with
16062 @samp{blockquote} instead, and signatures will have @samp{br} added to
16063 the end of each line. Other than that, you can just write @acronym{HTML}
16064 directly into the message buffer. Note that Slashdot filters out some
16065 @acronym{HTML} forms.
16066
16067 The following variables can be altered to change its behavior:
16068
16069 @table @code
16070 @item nnslashdot-threaded
16071 Whether @code{nnslashdot} should display threaded groups or not. The
16072 default is @code{t}. To be able to display threads, @code{nnslashdot}
16073 has to retrieve absolutely all comments in a group upon entry. If a
16074 threaded display is not required, @code{nnslashdot} will only retrieve
16075 the comments that are actually wanted by the user. Threading is nicer,
16076 but much, much slower than unthreaded.
16077
16078 @item nnslashdot-login-name
16079 @vindex nnslashdot-login-name
16080 The login name to use when posting.
16081
16082 @item nnslashdot-password
16083 @vindex nnslashdot-password
16084 The password to use when posting.
16085
16086 @item nnslashdot-directory
16087 @vindex nnslashdot-directory
16088 Where @code{nnslashdot} will store its files. The default is
16089 @file{~/News/slashdot/}.
16090
16091 @item nnslashdot-active-url
16092 @vindex nnslashdot-active-url
16093 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the
16094 information on news articles and comments. The default is@*
16095 @samp{http://slashdot.org/search.pl?section=&min=%d}.
16096
16097 @item nnslashdot-comments-url
16098 @vindex nnslashdot-comments-url
16099 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch comments.
16100
16101 @item nnslashdot-article-url
16102 @vindex nnslashdot-article-url
16103 The @acronym{URL} format string that will be used to fetch the news
16104 article. The default is
16105 @samp{http://slashdot.org/article.pl?sid=%s&mode=nocomment}.
16106
16107 @item nnslashdot-threshold
16108 @vindex nnslashdot-threshold
16109 The score threshold. The default is -1.
16110
16111 @item nnslashdot-group-number
16112 @vindex nnslashdot-group-number
16113 The number of old groups, in addition to the ten latest, to keep
16114 updated. The default is 0.
16115
16116 @end table
16117
16118
16119
16120 @node Ultimate
16121 @subsection Ultimate
16122 @cindex nnultimate
16123 @cindex Ultimate Bulletin Board
16124
16125 @uref{http://www.ultimatebb.com/, The Ultimate Bulletin Board} is
16126 probably the most popular Web bulletin board system used. It has a
16127 quite regular and nice interface, and it's possible to get the
16128 information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16129
16130 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnultimate} is to say
16131 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnultimate RET
16132 http://www.tcj.com/messboard/ubbcgi/ RET}. (Substitute the @acronym{URL}
16133 (not including @samp{Ultimate.cgi} or the like at the end) for a forum
16134 you're interested in; there's quite a list of them on the Ultimate web
16135 site.) Then subscribe to the groups you're interested in from the
16136 server buffer, and read them from the group buffer.
16137
16138 The following @code{nnultimate} variables can be altered:
16139
16140 @table @code
16141 @item nnultimate-directory
16142 @vindex nnultimate-directory
16143 The directory where @code{nnultimate} stores its files. The default is@*
16144 @file{~/News/ultimate/}.
16145 @end table
16146
16147
16148 @node Web Archive
16149 @subsection Web Archive
16150 @cindex nnwarchive
16151 @cindex Web Archive
16152
16153 Some mailing lists only have archives on Web servers, such as
16154 @uref{http://www.egroups.com/} and
16155 @uref{http://www.mail-archive.com/}. It has a quite regular and nice
16156 interface, and it's possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep
16157 groups updated.
16158
16159 @findex gnus-group-make-warchive-group
16160 The easiest way to get started with @code{nnwarchive} is to say
16161 something like the following in the group buffer: @kbd{M-x
16162 gnus-group-make-warchive-group RET @var{an_egroup} RET egroups RET
16163 www.egroups.com RET @var{your@@email.address} RET}. (Substitute the
16164 @var{an_egroup} with the mailing list you subscribed, the
16165 @var{your@@email.address} with your email address.), or to browse the
16166 back end by @kbd{B nnwarchive RET mail-archive RET}.
16167
16168 The following @code{nnwarchive} variables can be altered:
16169
16170 @table @code
16171 @item nnwarchive-directory
16172 @vindex nnwarchive-directory
16173 The directory where @code{nnwarchive} stores its files. The default is@*
16174 @file{~/News/warchive/}.
16175
16176 @item nnwarchive-login
16177 @vindex nnwarchive-login
16178 The account name on the web server.
16179
16180 @item nnwarchive-passwd
16181 @vindex nnwarchive-passwd
16182 The password for your account on the web server.
16183 @end table
16184
16185 @node RSS
16186 @subsection RSS
16187 @cindex nnrss
16188 @cindex RSS
16189
16190 Some web sites have an RDF Site Summary (@acronym{RSS}).
16191 @acronym{RSS} is a format for summarizing headlines from news related
16192 sites (such as BBC or CNN). But basically anything list-like can be
16193 presented as an @acronym{RSS} feed: weblogs, changelogs or recent
16194 changes to a wiki (e.g. @url{http://cliki.net/recent-changes.rdf}).
16195
16196 @acronym{RSS} has a quite regular and nice interface, and it's
16197 possible to get the information Gnus needs to keep groups updated.
16198
16199 Note: you had better use Emacs which supports the @code{utf-8} coding
16200 system because @acronym{RSS} uses UTF-8 for encoding non-@acronym{ASCII}
16201 text by default. It is also used by default for non-@acronym{ASCII}
16202 group names.
16203
16204 @kindex G R (Group)
16205 Use @kbd{G R} from the group buffer to subscribe to a feed---you will be
16206 prompted for the location, the title and the description of the feed.
16207 The title, which allows any characters, will be used for the group name
16208 and the name of the group data file. The description can be omitted.
16209
16210 An easy way to get started with @code{nnrss} is to say something like
16211 the following in the group buffer: @kbd{B nnrss RET RET y}, then
16212 subscribe to groups.
16213
16214 The @code{nnrss} back end saves the group data file in
16215 @code{nnrss-directory} (see below) for each @code{nnrss} group. File
16216 names containing non-@acronym{ASCII} characters will be encoded by the
16217 coding system specified with the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system}
16218 variable. If it is @code{nil}, in Emacs the coding system defaults to
16219 the value of @code{default-file-name-coding-system}. If you are using
16220 XEmacs and want to use non-@acronym{ASCII} group names, you should set
16221 the value for the @code{nnmail-pathname-coding-system} variable properly.
16222
16223 The @code{nnrss} back end generates @samp{multipart/alternative}
16224 @acronym{MIME} articles in which each contains a @samp{text/plain} part
16225 and a @samp{text/html} part.
16226
16227 @cindex OPML
16228 You can also use the following commands to import and export your
16229 subscriptions from a file in @acronym{OPML} format (Outline Processor
16230 Markup Language).
16231
16232 @defun nnrss-opml-import file
16233 Prompt for an @acronym{OPML} file, and subscribe to each feed in the
16234 file.
16235 @end defun
16236
16237 @defun nnrss-opml-export
16238 Write your current @acronym{RSS} subscriptions to a buffer in
16239 @acronym{OPML} format.
16240 @end defun
16241
16242 The following @code{nnrss} variables can be altered:
16243
16244 @table @code
16245 @item nnrss-directory
16246 @vindex nnrss-directory
16247 The directory where @code{nnrss} stores its files. The default is
16248 @file{~/News/rss/}.
16249
16250 @item nnrss-file-coding-system
16251 @vindex nnrss-file-coding-system
16252 The coding system used when reading and writing the @code{nnrss} groups
16253 data files. The default is the value of
16254 @code{mm-universal-coding-system} (which defaults to @code{emacs-mule}
16255 in Emacs or @code{escape-quoted} in XEmacs).
16256
16257 @item nnrss-use-local
16258 @vindex nnrss-use-local
16259 @findex nnrss-generate-download-script
16260 If you set @code{nnrss-use-local} to @code{t}, @code{nnrss} will read
16261 the feeds from local files in @code{nnrss-directory}. You can use
16262 the command @code{nnrss-generate-download-script} to generate a
16263 download script using @command{wget}.
16264
16265 @item nnrss-wash-html-in-text-plain-parts
16266 Non-@code{nil} means that @code{nnrss} renders text in @samp{text/plain}
16267 parts as @acronym{HTML}. The function specified by the
16268 @code{mm-text-html-renderer} variable (@pxref{Display Customization,
16269 ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}) will be used
16270 to render text. If it is @code{nil}, which is the default, text will
16271 simply be folded. Leave it @code{nil} if you prefer to see
16272 @samp{text/html} parts.
16273 @end table
16274
16275 The following code may be helpful, if you want to show the description in
16276 the summary buffer.
16277
16278 @lisp
16279 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-description-field)
16280 (setq gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-15,15f%]%) %s%uX\n")
16281
16282 (defun gnus-user-format-function-X (header)
16283 (let ((descr
16284 (assq nnrss-description-field (mail-header-extra header))))
16285 (if descr (concat "\n\t" (cdr descr)) "")))
16286 @end lisp
16287
16288 The following code may be useful to open an nnrss url directly from the
16289 summary buffer.
16290
16291 @lisp
16292 (require 'browse-url)
16293
16294 (defun browse-nnrss-url( arg )
16295 (interactive "p")
16296 (let ((url (assq nnrss-url-field
16297 (mail-header-extra
16298 (gnus-data-header
16299 (assq (gnus-summary-article-number)
16300 gnus-newsgroup-data))))))
16301 (if url
16302 (progn
16303 (browse-url (cdr url))
16304 (gnus-summary-mark-as-read-forward 1))
16305 (gnus-summary-scroll-up arg))))
16306
16307 (eval-after-load "gnus"
16308 #'(define-key gnus-summary-mode-map
16309 (kbd "<RET>") 'browse-nnrss-url))
16310 (add-to-list 'nnmail-extra-headers nnrss-url-field)
16311 @end lisp
16312
16313 Even if you have added @samp{text/html} to the
16314 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} variable (@pxref{Display
16315 Customization, ,Display Customization, emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME
16316 Manual}) since you don't want to see @acronym{HTML} parts, it might be
16317 more useful especially in @code{nnrss} groups to display
16318 @samp{text/html} parts. Here's an example of setting
16319 @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives} as a group parameter (@pxref{Group
16320 Parameters}) in order to display @samp{text/html} parts only in
16321 @code{nnrss} groups:
16322
16323 @lisp
16324 ;; @r{Set the default value of @code{mm-discouraged-alternatives}.}
16325 (eval-after-load "gnus-sum"
16326 '(add-to-list
16327 'gnus-newsgroup-variables
16328 '(mm-discouraged-alternatives
16329 . '("text/html" "image/.*"))))
16330
16331 ;; @r{Display @samp{text/html} parts in @code{nnrss} groups.}
16332 (add-to-list
16333 'gnus-parameters
16334 '("\\`nnrss:" (mm-discouraged-alternatives nil)))
16335 @end lisp
16336
16337
16338 @node Customizing W3
16339 @subsection Customizing W3
16340 @cindex W3
16341 @cindex html
16342 @cindex url
16343 @cindex Netscape
16344
16345 Gnus uses the url library to fetch web pages and Emacs/W3 (or those
16346 alternatives) to display web pages. Emacs/W3 is documented in its own
16347 manual, but there are some things that may be more relevant for Gnus
16348 users.
16349
16350 For instance, a common question is how to make Emacs/W3 follow links
16351 using the @code{browse-url} functions (which will call some external web
16352 browser like Netscape). Here's one way:
16353
16354 @lisp
16355 (eval-after-load "w3"
16356 '(progn
16357 (fset 'w3-fetch-orig (symbol-function 'w3-fetch))
16358 (defun w3-fetch (&optional url target)
16359 (interactive (list (w3-read-url-with-default)))
16360 (if (eq major-mode 'gnus-article-mode)
16361 (browse-url url)
16362 (w3-fetch-orig url target)))))
16363 @end lisp
16364
16365 Put that in your @file{.emacs} file, and hitting links in W3-rendered
16366 @acronym{HTML} in the Gnus article buffers will use @code{browse-url} to
16367 follow the link.
16368
16369
16370 @node IMAP
16371 @section IMAP
16372 @cindex nnimap
16373 @cindex @acronym{IMAP}
16374
16375 @acronym{IMAP} is a network protocol for reading mail (or news, or @dots{}),
16376 think of it as a modernized @acronym{NNTP}. Connecting to a @acronym{IMAP}
16377 server is much similar to connecting to a news server, you just
16378 specify the network address of the server.
16379
16380 @acronym{IMAP} has two properties. First, @acronym{IMAP} can do
16381 everything that @acronym{POP} can, it can hence be viewed as a
16382 @acronym{POP++}. Secondly, @acronym{IMAP} is a mail storage protocol,
16383 similar to @acronym{NNTP} being a news storage protocol---however,
16384 @acronym{IMAP} offers more features than @acronym{NNTP} because news
16385 is more or less read-only whereas mail is read-write.
16386
16387 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a @acronym{POP++}, use an imap
16388 entry in @code{mail-sources}. With this, Gnus will fetch mails from
16389 the @acronym{IMAP} server and store them on the local disk. This is
16390 not the usage described in this section---@xref{Mail Sources}.
16391
16392 If you want to use @acronym{IMAP} as a mail storage protocol, use an nnimap
16393 entry in @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}. With this, Gnus will
16394 manipulate mails stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server. This is the kind of
16395 usage explained in this section.
16396
16397 A server configuration in @file{~/.gnus.el} with a few @acronym{IMAP}
16398 servers might look something like the following. (Note that for
16399 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}, you need external programs and libraries,
16400 see below.)
16401
16402 @lisp
16403 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods
16404 '((nnimap "simpleserver") ; @r{no special configuration}
16405 ; @r{perhaps a ssh port forwarded server:}
16406 (nnimap "dolk"
16407 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16408 (nnimap-server-port 1430))
16409 ; @r{a UW server running on localhost}
16410 (nnimap "barbar"
16411 (nnimap-server-port 143)
16412 (nnimap-address "localhost")
16413 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "mail/*")))
16414 ; @r{anonymous public cyrus server:}
16415 (nnimap "cyrus.andrew.cmu.edu"
16416 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous)
16417 (nnimap-list-pattern "archive.*")
16418 (nnimap-stream network))
16419 ; @r{a ssl server on a non-standard port:}
16420 (nnimap "vic20"
16421 (nnimap-address "vic20.somewhere.com")
16422 (nnimap-server-port 9930)
16423 (nnimap-stream ssl))))
16424 @end lisp
16425
16426 After defining the new server, you can subscribe to groups on the
16427 server using normal Gnus commands such as @kbd{U} in the Group Buffer
16428 (@pxref{Subscription Commands}) or via the Server Buffer
16429 (@pxref{Server Buffer}).
16430
16431 The following variables can be used to create a virtual @code{nnimap}
16432 server:
16433
16434 @table @code
16435
16436 @item nnimap-address
16437 @vindex nnimap-address
16438
16439 The address of the remote @acronym{IMAP} server. Defaults to the virtual
16440 server name if not specified.
16441
16442 @item nnimap-server-port
16443 @vindex nnimap-server-port
16444 Port on server to contact. Defaults to port 143, or 993 for @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}.
16445
16446 Note that this should be an integer, example server specification:
16447
16448 @lisp
16449 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16450 (nnimap-server-port 4711))
16451 @end lisp
16452
16453 @item nnimap-list-pattern
16454 @vindex nnimap-list-pattern
16455 String or list of strings of mailboxes to limit available groups to.
16456 This is used when the server has very many mailboxes and you're only
16457 interested in a few---some servers export your home directory via
16458 @acronym{IMAP}, you'll probably want to limit the mailboxes to those in
16459 @file{~/Mail/*} then.
16460
16461 The string can also be a cons of REFERENCE and the string as above, what
16462 REFERENCE is used for is server specific, but on the University of
16463 Washington server it's a directory that will be concatenated with the
16464 mailbox.
16465
16466 Example server specification:
16467
16468 @lisp
16469 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16470 (nnimap-list-pattern ("INBOX" "Mail/*" "alt.sex.*"
16471 ("~friend/Mail/" . "list/*"))))
16472 @end lisp
16473
16474 @item nnimap-stream
16475 @vindex nnimap-stream
16476 The type of stream used to connect to your server. By default, nnimap
16477 will detect and automatically use all of the below, with the exception
16478 of @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}. (@acronym{IMAP} over
16479 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is being replaced by STARTTLS, which can
16480 be automatically detected, but it's not widely deployed yet.)
16481
16482 Example server specification:
16483
16484 @lisp
16485 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16486 (nnimap-stream ssl))
16487 @end lisp
16488
16489 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-stream} is a symbol!
16490
16491 @itemize @bullet
16492 @item
16493 @dfn{gssapi:} Connect with GSSAPI (usually Kerberos 5). Requires the
16494 @samp{gsasl} or @samp{imtest} program.
16495 @item
16496 @dfn{kerberos4:} Connect with Kerberos 4. Requires the @samp{imtest} program.
16497 @item
16498 @dfn{starttls:} Connect via the STARTTLS extension (similar to
16499 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL}). Requires the external library @samp{starttls.el} and program
16500 @samp{starttls}.
16501 @item
16502 @dfn{tls:} Connect through @acronym{TLS}. Requires GNUTLS (the program
16503 @samp{gnutls-cli}).
16504 @item
16505 @dfn{ssl:} Connect through @acronym{SSL}. Requires OpenSSL (the program
16506 @samp{openssl}) or SSLeay (@samp{s_client}).
16507 @item
16508 @dfn{shell:} Use a shell command to start @acronym{IMAP} connection.
16509 @item
16510 @dfn{network:} Plain, TCP/IP network connection.
16511 @end itemize
16512
16513 @vindex imap-kerberos4-program
16514 The @samp{imtest} program is shipped with Cyrus IMAPD. If you're
16515 using @samp{imtest} from Cyrus IMAPD < 2.0.14 (which includes version
16516 1.5.x and 1.6.x) you need to frob @code{imap-process-connection-type}
16517 to make @code{imap.el} use a pty instead of a pipe when communicating
16518 with @samp{imtest}. You will then suffer from a line length
16519 restrictions on @acronym{IMAP} commands, which might make Gnus seem to hang
16520 indefinitely if you have many articles in a mailbox. The variable
16521 @code{imap-kerberos4-program} contain parameters to pass to the imtest
16522 program.
16523
16524 For @acronym{TLS} connection, the @code{gnutls-cli} program from GNUTLS is
16525 needed. It is available from
16526 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gnutls/}.
16527
16528 @vindex imap-gssapi-program
16529 This parameter specifies a list of command lines that invoke a GSSAPI
16530 authenticated @acronym{IMAP} stream in a subshell. They are tried
16531 sequentially until a connection is made, or the list has been
16532 exhausted. By default, @samp{gsasl} from GNU SASL, available from
16533 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gsasl/}, and the @samp{imtest}
16534 program from Cyrus IMAPD (see @code{imap-kerberos4-program}), are
16535 tried.
16536
16537 @vindex imap-ssl-program
16538 For @acronym{SSL} connections, the OpenSSL program is available from
16539 @uref{http://www.openssl.org/}. OpenSSL was formerly known as SSLeay,
16540 and nnimap support it too---although the most recent versions of
16541 SSLeay, 0.9.x, are known to have serious bugs making it
16542 useless. Earlier versions, especially 0.8.x, of SSLeay are known to
16543 work. The variable @code{imap-ssl-program} contain parameters to pass
16544 to OpenSSL/SSLeay.
16545
16546 @vindex imap-shell-program
16547 @vindex imap-shell-host
16548 For @acronym{IMAP} connections using the @code{shell} stream, the variable
16549 @code{imap-shell-program} specify what program to call.
16550
16551 @item nnimap-authenticator
16552 @vindex nnimap-authenticator
16553
16554 The authenticator used to connect to the server. By default, nnimap
16555 will use the most secure authenticator your server is capable of.
16556
16557 Example server specification:
16558
16559 @lisp
16560 (nnimap "mail.server.com"
16561 (nnimap-authenticator anonymous))
16562 @end lisp
16563
16564 Please note that the value of @code{nnimap-authenticator} is a symbol!
16565
16566 @itemize @bullet
16567 @item
16568 @dfn{gssapi:} GSSAPI (usually kerberos 5) authentication. Requires
16569 external program @code{gsasl} or @code{imtest}.
16570 @item
16571 @dfn{kerberos4:} Kerberos 4 authentication. Requires external program
16572 @code{imtest}.
16573 @item
16574 @dfn{digest-md5:} Encrypted username/password via DIGEST-MD5. Requires
16575 external library @code{digest-md5.el}.
16576 @item
16577 @dfn{cram-md5:} Encrypted username/password via CRAM-MD5.
16578 @item
16579 @dfn{login:} Plain-text username/password via LOGIN.
16580 @item
16581 @dfn{anonymous:} Login as ``anonymous'', supplying your email address as password.
16582 @end itemize
16583
16584 @item nnimap-expunge-on-close
16585 @cindex expunging
16586 @vindex nnimap-expunge-on-close
16587 Unlike Parmenides the @acronym{IMAP} designers have decided things that
16588 don't exist actually do exist. More specifically, @acronym{IMAP} has
16589 this concept of marking articles @code{Deleted} which doesn't actually
16590 delete them, and this (marking them @code{Deleted}, that is) is what
16591 nnimap does when you delete an article in Gnus (with @kbd{B DEL} or
16592 similar).
16593
16594 Since the articles aren't really removed when we mark them with the
16595 @code{Deleted} flag we'll need a way to actually delete them. Feel like
16596 running in circles yet?
16597
16598 Traditionally, nnimap has removed all articles marked as @code{Deleted}
16599 when closing a mailbox but this is now configurable by this server
16600 variable.
16601
16602 The possible options are:
16603
16604 @table @code
16605
16606 @item always
16607 The default behavior, delete all articles marked as ``Deleted'' when
16608 closing a mailbox.
16609 @item never
16610 Never actually delete articles. Currently there is no way of showing
16611 the articles marked for deletion in nnimap, but other @acronym{IMAP} clients
16612 may allow you to do this. If you ever want to run the EXPUNGE command
16613 manually, @xref{Expunging mailboxes}.
16614 @item ask
16615 When closing mailboxes, nnimap will ask if you wish to expunge deleted
16616 articles or not.
16617
16618 @end table
16619
16620 @item nnimap-importantize-dormant
16621 @vindex nnimap-importantize-dormant
16622
16623 If non-@code{nil} (the default), marks dormant articles as ticked (as
16624 well), for other @acronym{IMAP} clients. Within Gnus, dormant articles will
16625 naturally still (only) be marked as dormant. This is to make dormant
16626 articles stand out, just like ticked articles, in other @acronym{IMAP}
16627 clients. (In other words, Gnus has two ``Tick'' marks and @acronym{IMAP}
16628 has only one.)
16629
16630 Probably the only reason for frobbing this would be if you're trying
16631 enable per-user persistent dormant flags, using something like:
16632
16633 @lisp
16634 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-flag-alist)
16635 (format "gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16636 (setcdr (assq 'dormant nnimap-mark-to-predicate-alist)
16637 (format "KEYWORD gnus-dormant-%s" (user-login-name)))
16638 @end lisp
16639
16640 In this case, you would not want the per-user dormant flag showing up
16641 as ticked for other users.
16642
16643 @item nnimap-expunge-search-string
16644 @cindex expunging
16645 @vindex nnimap-expunge-search-string
16646 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16647
16648 This variable contain the @acronym{IMAP} search command sent to server when
16649 searching for articles eligible for expiring. The default is
16650 @code{"UID %s NOT SINCE %s"}, where the first @code{%s} is replaced by
16651 UID set and the second @code{%s} is replaced by a date.
16652
16653 Probably the only useful value to change this to is
16654 @code{"UID %s NOT SENTSINCE %s"}, which makes nnimap use the Date: in
16655 messages instead of the internal article date. See section 6.4.4 of
16656 RFC 2060 for more information on valid strings.
16657
16658 However, if @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}
16659 is true, this variable has no effect since the search logic
16660 is reversed, as described below.
16661
16662 @item nnimap-authinfo-file
16663 @vindex nnimap-authinfo-file
16664
16665 A file containing credentials used to log in on servers. The format is
16666 (almost) the same as the @code{ftp} @file{~/.netrc} file. See the
16667 variable @code{nntp-authinfo-file} for exact syntax; also see
16668 @ref{NNTP}. An example of an .authinfo line for an IMAP server, is:
16669
16670 @example
16671 machine students.uio.no login larsi password geheimnis port imap
16672 @end example
16673
16674 Note that it should be @code{port imap}, or @code{port 143}, if you
16675 use a @code{nnimap-stream} of @code{tls} or @code{ssl}, even if the
16676 actual port number used is port 993 for secured IMAP. For
16677 convenience, Gnus will accept @code{port imaps} as a synonym of
16678 @code{port imap}.
16679
16680 @item nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16681 @vindex nnimap-need-unselect-to-notice-new-mail
16682
16683 Unselect mailboxes before looking for new mail in them. Some servers
16684 seem to need this under some circumstances; it was reported that
16685 Courier 1.7.1 did.
16686
16687 @item nnimap-nov-is-evil
16688 @vindex nnimap-nov-is-evil
16689 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
16690 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
16691
16692 Never generate or use a local @acronym{NOV} database. Defaults to the
16693 value of @code{gnus-agent}.
16694
16695 Using a @acronym{NOV} database usually makes header fetching much
16696 faster, but it uses the @code{UID SEARCH UID} command, which is very
16697 slow on some servers (notably some versions of Courier). Since the Gnus
16698 Agent caches the information in the @acronym{NOV} database without using
16699 the slow command, this variable defaults to true if the Agent is in use,
16700 and false otherwise.
16701
16702 @item nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
16703 @vindex nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil
16704 @cindex Courier @acronym{IMAP} server
16705 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16706
16707 Avoid the @code{UID SEARCH UID @var{message numbers} NOT SINCE
16708 @var{date}} command, which is slow on some @acronym{IMAP} servers
16709 (notably, some versions of Courier). Instead, use @code{UID SEARCH SINCE
16710 @var{date}} and prune the list of expirable articles within Gnus.
16711
16712 When Gnus expires your mail (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), it starts with a
16713 list of expirable articles and asks the IMAP server questions like ``Of
16714 these articles, which ones are older than a week?'' While this seems
16715 like a perfectly reasonable question, some IMAP servers take a long time
16716 to answer it, since they seemingly go looking into every old article to
16717 see if it is one of the expirable ones. Curiously, the question ``Of
16718 @emph{all} articles, which ones are newer than a week?'' seems to be
16719 much faster to answer, so setting this variable causes Gnus to ask this
16720 question and figure out the answer to the real question itself.
16721
16722 This problem can really sneak up on you: when you first configure Gnus,
16723 everything works fine, but once you accumulate a couple thousand
16724 messages, you start cursing Gnus for being so slow. On the other hand,
16725 if you get a lot of email within a week, setting this variable will
16726 cause a lot of network traffic between Gnus and the IMAP server.
16727
16728 @end table
16729
16730 @menu
16731 * Splitting in IMAP:: Splitting mail with nnimap.
16732 * Expiring in IMAP:: Expiring mail with nnimap.
16733 * Editing IMAP ACLs:: Limiting/enabling other users access to a mailbox.
16734 * Expunging mailboxes:: Equivalent of a ``compress mailbox'' button.
16735 * A note on namespaces:: How to (not) use @acronym{IMAP} namespace in Gnus.
16736 * Debugging IMAP:: What to do when things don't work.
16737 @end menu
16738
16739
16740
16741 @node Splitting in IMAP
16742 @subsection Splitting in IMAP
16743 @cindex splitting imap mail
16744
16745 Splitting is something Gnus users have loved and used for years, and now
16746 the rest of the world is catching up. Yeah, dream on, not many
16747 @acronym{IMAP} servers have server side splitting and those that have
16748 splitting seem to use some non-standard protocol. This means that
16749 @acronym{IMAP} support for Gnus has to do its own splitting.
16750
16751 And it does.
16752
16753 (Incidentally, people seem to have been dreaming on, and Sieve has
16754 gaining a market share and is supported by several IMAP servers.
16755 Fortunately, Gnus support it too, @xref{Sieve Commands}.)
16756
16757 Here are the variables of interest:
16758
16759 @table @code
16760
16761 @item nnimap-split-crosspost
16762 @cindex splitting, crosspost
16763 @cindex crosspost
16764 @vindex nnimap-split-crosspost
16765
16766 If non-@code{nil}, do crossposting if several split methods match the
16767 mail. If @code{nil}, the first match in @code{nnimap-split-rule}
16768 found will be used.
16769
16770 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-crosspost}.
16771
16772 @item nnimap-split-inbox
16773 @cindex splitting, inbox
16774 @cindex inbox
16775 @vindex nnimap-split-inbox
16776
16777 A string or a list of strings that gives the name(s) of @acronym{IMAP}
16778 mailboxes to split from. Defaults to @code{nil}, which means that
16779 splitting is disabled!
16780
16781 @lisp
16782 (setq nnimap-split-inbox
16783 '("INBOX" ("~/friend/Mail" . "lists/*") "lists.imap"))
16784 @end lisp
16785
16786 No nnmail equivalent.
16787
16788 @item nnimap-split-rule
16789 @cindex splitting, rules
16790 @vindex nnimap-split-rule
16791
16792 New mail found in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be split according to
16793 this variable.
16794
16795 This variable contains a list of lists, where the first element in the
16796 sublist gives the name of the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox to move articles
16797 matching the regexp in the second element in the sublist. Got that?
16798 Neither did I, we need examples.
16799
16800 @lisp
16801 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16802 '(("INBOX.nnimap"
16803 "^Sender: owner-nnimap@@vic20.globalcom.se")
16804 ("INBOX.junk" "^Subject:.*MAKE MONEY")
16805 ("INBOX.private" "")))
16806 @end lisp
16807
16808 This will put all articles from the nnimap mailing list into mailbox
16809 INBOX.nnimap, all articles containing MAKE MONEY in the Subject: line
16810 into INBOX.junk and everything else in INBOX.private.
16811
16812 The first string may contain @samp{\\1} forms, like the ones used by
16813 replace-match to insert sub-expressions from the matched text. For
16814 instance:
16815
16816 @lisp
16817 ("INBOX.lists.\\1" "^Sender: owner-\\([a-z-]+\\)@@")
16818 @end lisp
16819
16820 The first element can also be the symbol @code{junk} to indicate that
16821 matching messages should simply be deleted. Use with care.
16822
16823 The second element can also be a function. In that case, it will be
16824 called with the first element of the rule as the argument, in a buffer
16825 containing the headers of the article. It should return a
16826 non-@code{nil} value if it thinks that the mail belongs in that group.
16827
16828 Nnmail users might recollect that the last regexp had to be empty to
16829 match all articles (like in the example above). This is not required in
16830 nnimap. Articles not matching any of the regexps will not be moved out
16831 of your inbox. (This might affect performance if you keep lots of
16832 unread articles in your inbox, since the splitting code would go over
16833 them every time you fetch new mail.)
16834
16835 These rules are processed from the beginning of the alist toward the
16836 end. The first rule to make a match will ``win'', unless you have
16837 crossposting enabled. In that case, all matching rules will ``win''.
16838
16839 This variable can also have a function as its value, the function will
16840 be called with the headers narrowed and should return a group where it
16841 thinks the article should be split to. See @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16842
16843 The splitting code tries to create mailboxes if it needs to.
16844
16845 To allow for different split rules on different virtual servers, and
16846 even different split rules in different inboxes on the same server,
16847 the syntax of this variable have been extended along the lines of:
16848
16849 @lisp
16850 (setq nnimap-split-rule
16851 '(("my1server" (".*" (("ding" "ding@@gnus.org")
16852 ("junk" "From:.*Simon"))))
16853 ("my2server" ("INBOX" nnimap-split-fancy))
16854 ("my[34]server" (".*" (("private" "To:.*Simon")
16855 ("junk" my-junk-func))))))
16856 @end lisp
16857
16858 The virtual server name is in fact a regexp, so that the same rules
16859 may apply to several servers. In the example, the servers
16860 @code{my3server} and @code{my4server} both use the same rules.
16861 Similarly, the inbox string is also a regexp. The actual splitting
16862 rules are as before, either a function, or a list with group/regexp or
16863 group/function elements.
16864
16865 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
16866
16867 @item nnimap-split-predicate
16868 @cindex splitting
16869 @vindex nnimap-split-predicate
16870
16871 Mail matching this predicate in @code{nnimap-split-inbox} will be
16872 split, it is a string and the default is @samp{UNSEEN UNDELETED}.
16873
16874 This might be useful if you use another @acronym{IMAP} client to read mail in
16875 your inbox but would like Gnus to split all articles in the inbox
16876 regardless of readedness. Then you might change this to
16877 @samp{UNDELETED}.
16878
16879 @item nnimap-split-fancy
16880 @cindex splitting, fancy
16881 @findex nnimap-split-fancy
16882 @vindex nnimap-split-fancy
16883
16884 It's possible to set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16885 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} if you want to use fancy
16886 splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}.
16887
16888 However, to be able to have different fancy split rules for nnmail and
16889 nnimap back ends you can set @code{nnimap-split-rule} to
16890 @code{nnimap-split-fancy} and define the nnimap specific fancy split
16891 rule in @code{nnimap-split-fancy}.
16892
16893 Example:
16894
16895 @lisp
16896 (setq nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
16897 nnimap-split-fancy ...)
16898 @end lisp
16899
16900 Nnmail equivalent: @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
16901
16902 @item nnimap-split-download-body
16903 @findex nnimap-split-download-body
16904 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
16905
16906 Set to non-@code{nil} to download entire articles during splitting.
16907 This is generally not required, and will slow things down
16908 considerably. You may need it if you want to use an advanced
16909 splitting function that analyzes the body to split the article.
16910
16911 @end table
16912
16913 @node Expiring in IMAP
16914 @subsection Expiring in IMAP
16915 @cindex expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail
16916
16917 Even though @code{nnimap} is not a proper @code{nnmail} derived back
16918 end, it supports most features in regular expiring (@pxref{Expiring
16919 Mail}). Unlike splitting in @acronym{IMAP} (@pxref{Splitting in
16920 IMAP}) it does not clone the @code{nnmail} variables (i.e., creating
16921 @var{nnimap-expiry-wait}) but reuse the @code{nnmail} variables. What
16922 follows below are the variables used by the @code{nnimap} expiry
16923 process.
16924
16925 A note on how the expire mark is stored on the @acronym{IMAP} server is
16926 appropriate here as well. The expire mark is translated into a
16927 @code{imap} client specific mark, @code{gnus-expire}, and stored on the
16928 message. This means that likely only Gnus will understand and treat
16929 the @code{gnus-expire} mark properly, although other clients may allow
16930 you to view client specific flags on the message. It also means that
16931 your server must support permanent storage of client specific flags on
16932 messages. Most do, fortunately.
16933
16934 If expiring @acronym{IMAP} mail seems very slow, try setting the server
16935 variable @code{nnimap-search-uids-not-since-is-evil}.
16936
16937 @table @code
16938
16939 @item nnmail-expiry-wait
16940 @item nnmail-expiry-wait-function
16941
16942 These variables are fully supported. The expire value can be a
16943 number, the symbol @code{immediate} or @code{never}.
16944
16945 @item nnmail-expiry-target
16946
16947 This variable is supported, and internally implemented by calling the
16948 @code{nnmail} functions that handle this. It contains an optimization
16949 that if the destination is a @acronym{IMAP} group on the same server, the
16950 article is copied instead of appended (that is, uploaded again).
16951
16952 @end table
16953
16954 @node Editing IMAP ACLs
16955 @subsection Editing IMAP ACLs
16956 @cindex editing imap acls
16957 @cindex Access Control Lists
16958 @cindex Editing @acronym{IMAP} ACLs
16959 @kindex G l (Group)
16960 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-edit-acl
16961
16962 ACL stands for Access Control List. ACLs are used in @acronym{IMAP} for
16963 limiting (or enabling) other users access to your mail boxes. Not all
16964 @acronym{IMAP} servers support this, this function will give an error if it
16965 doesn't.
16966
16967 To edit an ACL for a mailbox, type @kbd{G l}
16968 (@code{gnus-group-edit-nnimap-acl}) and you'll be presented with an ACL
16969 editing window with detailed instructions.
16970
16971 Some possible uses:
16972
16973 @itemize @bullet
16974 @item
16975 Giving ``anyone'' the ``lrs'' rights (lookup, read, keep seen/unseen flags)
16976 on your mailing list mailboxes enables other users on the same server to
16977 follow the list without subscribing to it.
16978 @item
16979 At least with the Cyrus server, you are required to give the user
16980 ``anyone'' posting ("p") capabilities to have ``plussing'' work (that is,
16981 mail sent to user+mailbox@@domain ending up in the @acronym{IMAP} mailbox
16982 INBOX.mailbox).
16983 @end itemize
16984
16985 @node Expunging mailboxes
16986 @subsection Expunging mailboxes
16987 @cindex expunging
16988
16989 @cindex expunge
16990 @cindex manual expunging
16991 @kindex G x (Group)
16992 @findex gnus-group-nnimap-expunge
16993
16994 If you're using the @code{never} setting of @code{nnimap-expunge-on-close},
16995 you may want the option of expunging all deleted articles in a mailbox
16996 manually. This is exactly what @kbd{G x} does.
16997
16998 Currently there is no way of showing deleted articles, you can just
16999 delete them.
17000
17001 @node A note on namespaces
17002 @subsection A note on namespaces
17003 @cindex IMAP namespace
17004 @cindex namespaces
17005
17006 The @acronym{IMAP} protocol has a concept called namespaces, described
17007 by the following text in the RFC2060:
17008
17009 @display
17010 5.1.2. Mailbox Namespace Naming Convention
17011
17012 By convention, the first hierarchical element of any mailbox name
17013 which begins with "#" identifies the "namespace" of the remainder of
17014 the name. This makes it possible to disambiguate between different
17015 types of mailbox stores, each of which have their own namespaces.
17016
17017 For example, implementations which offer access to USENET
17018 newsgroups MAY use the "#news" namespace to partition the USENET
17019 newsgroup namespace from that of other mailboxes. Thus, the
17020 comp.mail.misc newsgroup would have an mailbox name of
17021 "#news.comp.mail.misc", and the name "comp.mail.misc" could refer
17022 to a different object (e.g. a user's private mailbox).
17023 @end display
17024
17025 While there is nothing in this text that warrants concern for the
17026 @acronym{IMAP} implementation in Gnus, some servers use namespace
17027 prefixes in a way that does not work with how Gnus uses mailbox names.
17028
17029 Specifically, University of Washington's @acronym{IMAP} server uses
17030 mailbox names like @code{#driver.mbx/read-mail} which are valid only
17031 in the @sc{create} and @sc{append} commands. After the mailbox is
17032 created (or a messages is appended to a mailbox), it must be accessed
17033 without the namespace prefix, i.e. @code{read-mail}. Since Gnus do
17034 not make it possible for the user to guarantee that user entered
17035 mailbox names will only be used with the CREATE and APPEND commands,
17036 you should simply not use the namespace prefixed mailbox names in
17037 Gnus.
17038
17039 See the UoW IMAPD documentation for the @code{#driver.*/} prefix
17040 for more information on how to use the prefixes. They are a power
17041 tool and should be used only if you are sure what the effects are.
17042
17043 @node Debugging IMAP
17044 @subsection Debugging IMAP
17045 @cindex IMAP debugging
17046 @cindex protocol dump (IMAP)
17047
17048 @acronym{IMAP} is a complex protocol, more so than @acronym{NNTP} or
17049 @acronym{POP3}. Implementation bugs are not unlikely, and we do our
17050 best to fix them right away. If you encounter odd behavior, chances
17051 are that either the server or Gnus is buggy.
17052
17053 If you are familiar with network protocols in general, you will
17054 probably be able to extract some clues from the protocol dump of the
17055 exchanges between Gnus and the server. Even if you are not familiar
17056 with network protocols, when you include the protocol dump in
17057 @acronym{IMAP}-related bug reports you are helping us with data
17058 critical to solving the problem. Therefore, we strongly encourage you
17059 to include the protocol dump when reporting IMAP bugs in Gnus.
17060
17061
17062 @vindex imap-log
17063 Because the protocol dump, when enabled, generates lots of data, it is
17064 disabled by default. You can enable it by setting @code{imap-log} as
17065 follows:
17066
17067 @lisp
17068 (setq imap-log t)
17069 @end lisp
17070
17071 This instructs the @code{imap.el} package to log any exchanges with
17072 the server. The log is stored in the buffer @samp{*imap-log*}. Look
17073 for error messages, which sometimes are tagged with the keyword
17074 @code{BAD}---but when submitting a bug, make sure to include all the
17075 data.
17076
17077 @node Other Sources
17078 @section Other Sources
17079
17080 Gnus can do more than just read news or mail. The methods described
17081 below allow Gnus to view directories and files as if they were
17082 newsgroups.
17083
17084 @menu
17085 * Directory Groups:: You can read a directory as if it was a newsgroup.
17086 * Anything Groups:: Dired? Who needs dired?
17087 * Document Groups:: Single files can be the basis of a group.
17088 * SOUP:: Reading @sc{soup} packets ``offline''.
17089 * Mail-To-News Gateways:: Posting articles via mail-to-news gateways.
17090 @end menu
17091
17092
17093 @node Directory Groups
17094 @subsection Directory Groups
17095 @cindex nndir
17096 @cindex directory groups
17097
17098 If you have a directory that has lots of articles in separate files in
17099 it, you might treat it as a newsgroup. The files have to have numerical
17100 names, of course.
17101
17102 This might be an opportune moment to mention @code{ange-ftp} (and its
17103 successor @code{efs}), that most wonderful of all wonderful Emacs
17104 packages. When I wrote @code{nndir}, I didn't think much about it---a
17105 back end to read directories. Big deal.
17106
17107 @code{ange-ftp} changes that picture dramatically. For instance, if you
17108 enter the @code{ange-ftp} file name
17109 @file{/ftp.hpc.uh.edu:/pub/emacs/ding-list/} as the directory name,
17110 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs} will actually allow you to read this
17111 directory over at @samp{sina} as a newsgroup. Distributed news ahoy!
17112
17113 @code{nndir} will use @acronym{NOV} files if they are present.
17114
17115 @code{nndir} is a ``read-only'' back end---you can't delete or expire
17116 articles with this method. You can use @code{nnmh} or @code{nnml} for
17117 whatever you use @code{nndir} for, so you could switch to any of those
17118 methods if you feel the need to have a non-read-only @code{nndir}.
17119
17120
17121 @node Anything Groups
17122 @subsection Anything Groups
17123 @cindex nneething
17124
17125 From the @code{nndir} back end (which reads a single spool-like
17126 directory), it's just a hop and a skip to @code{nneething}, which
17127 pretends that any arbitrary directory is a newsgroup. Strange, but
17128 true.
17129
17130 When @code{nneething} is presented with a directory, it will scan this
17131 directory and assign article numbers to each file. When you enter such
17132 a group, @code{nneething} must create ``headers'' that Gnus can use.
17133 After all, Gnus is a newsreader, in case you're forgetting.
17134 @code{nneething} does this in a two-step process. First, it snoops each
17135 file in question. If the file looks like an article (i.e., the first
17136 few lines look like headers), it will use this as the head. If this is
17137 just some arbitrary file without a head (e.g. a C source file),
17138 @code{nneething} will cobble up a header out of thin air. It will use
17139 file ownership, name and date and do whatever it can with these
17140 elements.
17141
17142 All this should happen automatically for you, and you will be presented
17143 with something that looks very much like a newsgroup. Totally like a
17144 newsgroup, to be precise. If you select an article, it will be displayed
17145 in the article buffer, just as usual.
17146
17147 If you select a line that represents a directory, Gnus will pop you into
17148 a new summary buffer for this @code{nneething} group. And so on. You can
17149 traverse the entire disk this way, if you feel like, but remember that
17150 Gnus is not dired, really, and does not intend to be, either.
17151
17152 There are two overall modes to this action---ephemeral or solid. When
17153 doing the ephemeral thing (i.e., @kbd{G D} from the group buffer), Gnus
17154 will not store information on what files you have read, and what files
17155 are new, and so on. If you create a solid @code{nneething} group the
17156 normal way with @kbd{G m}, Gnus will store a mapping table between
17157 article numbers and file names, and you can treat this group like any
17158 other groups. When you activate a solid @code{nneething} group, you will
17159 be told how many unread articles it contains, etc., etc.
17160
17161 Some variables:
17162
17163 @table @code
17164 @item nneething-map-file-directory
17165 @vindex nneething-map-file-directory
17166 All the mapping files for solid @code{nneething} groups will be stored
17167 in this directory, which defaults to @file{~/.nneething/}.
17168
17169 @item nneething-exclude-files
17170 @vindex nneething-exclude-files
17171 All files that match this regexp will be ignored. Nice to use to exclude
17172 auto-save files and the like, which is what it does by default.
17173
17174 @item nneething-include-files
17175 @vindex nneething-include-files
17176 Regexp saying what files to include in the group. If this variable is
17177 non-@code{nil}, only files matching this regexp will be included.
17178
17179 @item nneething-map-file
17180 @vindex nneething-map-file
17181 Name of the map files.
17182 @end table
17183
17184
17185 @node Document Groups
17186 @subsection Document Groups
17187 @cindex nndoc
17188 @cindex documentation group
17189 @cindex help group
17190
17191 @code{nndoc} is a cute little thing that will let you read a single file
17192 as a newsgroup. Several files types are supported:
17193
17194 @table @code
17195 @cindex Babyl
17196 @cindex Rmail mbox
17197 @item babyl
17198 The Babyl (Rmail) mail box.
17199
17200 @cindex mbox
17201 @cindex Unix mbox
17202 @item mbox
17203 The standard Unix mbox file.
17204
17205 @cindex MMDF mail box
17206 @item mmdf
17207 The MMDF mail box format.
17208
17209 @item news
17210 Several news articles appended into a file.
17211
17212 @cindex rnews batch files
17213 @item rnews
17214 The rnews batch transport format.
17215
17216 @item nsmail
17217 Netscape mail boxes.
17218
17219 @item mime-parts
17220 @acronym{MIME} multipart messages.
17221
17222 @item standard-digest
17223 The standard (RFC 1153) digest format.
17224
17225 @item mime-digest
17226 A @acronym{MIME} digest of messages.
17227
17228 @item lanl-gov-announce
17229 Announcement messages from LANL Gov Announce.
17230
17231 @cindex forwarded messages
17232 @item rfc822-forward
17233 A message forwarded according to RFC822.
17234
17235 @item outlook
17236 The Outlook mail box.
17237
17238 @item oe-dbx
17239 The Outlook Express dbx mail box.
17240
17241 @item exim-bounce
17242 A bounce message from the Exim MTA.
17243
17244 @item forward
17245 A message forwarded according to informal rules.
17246
17247 @item rfc934
17248 An RFC934-forwarded message.
17249
17250 @item mailman
17251 A mailman digest.
17252
17253 @item clari-briefs
17254 A digest of Clarinet brief news items.
17255
17256 @item slack-digest
17257 Non-standard digest format---matches most things, but does it badly.
17258
17259 @item mail-in-mail
17260 The last resort.
17261 @end table
17262
17263 You can also use the special ``file type'' @code{guess}, which means
17264 that @code{nndoc} will try to guess what file type it is looking at.
17265 @code{digest} means that @code{nndoc} should guess what digest type the
17266 file is.
17267
17268 @code{nndoc} will not try to change the file or insert any extra headers into
17269 it---it will simply, like, let you use the file as the basis for a
17270 group. And that's it.
17271
17272 If you have some old archived articles that you want to insert into your
17273 new & spiffy Gnus mail back end, @code{nndoc} can probably help you with
17274 that. Say you have an old @file{RMAIL} file with mail that you now want
17275 to split into your new @code{nnml} groups. You look at that file using
17276 @code{nndoc} (using the @kbd{G f} command in the group buffer
17277 (@pxref{Foreign Groups})), set the process mark on all the articles in
17278 the buffer (@kbd{M P b}, for instance), and then re-spool (@kbd{B r})
17279 using @code{nnml}. If all goes well, all the mail in the @file{RMAIL}
17280 file is now also stored in lots of @code{nnml} directories, and you can
17281 delete that pesky @file{RMAIL} file. If you have the guts!
17282
17283 Virtual server variables:
17284
17285 @table @code
17286 @item nndoc-article-type
17287 @vindex nndoc-article-type
17288 This should be one of @code{mbox}, @code{babyl}, @code{digest},
17289 @code{news}, @code{rnews}, @code{mmdf}, @code{forward}, @code{rfc934},
17290 @code{rfc822-forward}, @code{mime-parts}, @code{standard-digest},
17291 @code{slack-digest}, @code{clari-briefs}, @code{nsmail}, @code{outlook},
17292 @code{oe-dbx}, @code{mailman}, and @code{mail-in-mail} or @code{guess}.
17293
17294 @item nndoc-post-type
17295 @vindex nndoc-post-type
17296 This variable says whether Gnus is to consider the group a news group or
17297 a mail group. There are two valid values: @code{mail} (the default)
17298 and @code{news}.
17299 @end table
17300
17301 @menu
17302 * Document Server Internals:: How to add your own document types.
17303 @end menu
17304
17305
17306 @node Document Server Internals
17307 @subsubsection Document Server Internals
17308
17309 Adding new document types to be recognized by @code{nndoc} isn't
17310 difficult. You just have to whip up a definition of what the document
17311 looks like, write a predicate function to recognize that document type,
17312 and then hook into @code{nndoc}.
17313
17314 First, here's an example document type definition:
17315
17316 @example
17317 (mmdf
17318 (article-begin . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n")
17319 (body-end . "^\^A\^A\^A\^A\n"))
17320 @end example
17321
17322 The definition is simply a unique @dfn{name} followed by a series of
17323 regexp pseudo-variable settings. Below are the possible
17324 variables---don't be daunted by the number of variables; most document
17325 types can be defined with very few settings:
17326
17327 @table @code
17328 @item first-article
17329 If present, @code{nndoc} will skip past all text until it finds
17330 something that match this regexp. All text before this will be
17331 totally ignored.
17332
17333 @item article-begin
17334 This setting has to be present in all document type definitions. It
17335 says what the beginning of each article looks like. To do more
17336 complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you can
17337 use @code{article-begin-function} instead of this.
17338
17339 @item article-begin-function
17340 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the beginning
17341 of each article. This setting overrides @code{article-begin}.
17342
17343 @item head-begin
17344 If present, this should be a regexp that matches the head of the
17345 article. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a
17346 simple regexp, you can use @code{head-begin-function} instead of this.
17347
17348 @item head-begin-function
17349 If present, this should be a function that moves point to the head of
17350 the article. This setting overrides @code{head-begin}.
17351
17352 @item head-end
17353 This should match the end of the head of the article. It defaults to
17354 @samp{^$}---the empty line.
17355
17356 @item body-begin
17357 This should match the beginning of the body of the article. It defaults
17358 to @samp{^\n}. To do more complicated things that cannot be dealt with
17359 a simple regexp, you can use @code{body-begin-function} instead of this.
17360
17361 @item body-begin-function
17362 If present, this function should move point to the beginning of the body
17363 of the article. This setting overrides @code{body-begin}.
17364
17365 @item body-end
17366 If present, this should match the end of the body of the article. To do
17367 more complicated things that cannot be dealt with a simple regexp, you
17368 can use @code{body-end-function} instead of this.
17369
17370 @item body-end-function
17371 If present, this function should move point to the end of the body of
17372 the article. This setting overrides @code{body-end}.
17373
17374 @item file-begin
17375 If present, this should match the beginning of the file. All text
17376 before this regexp will be totally ignored.
17377
17378 @item file-end
17379 If present, this should match the end of the file. All text after this
17380 regexp will be totally ignored.
17381
17382 @end table
17383
17384 So, using these variables @code{nndoc} is able to dissect a document
17385 file into a series of articles, each with a head and a body. However, a
17386 few more variables are needed since not all document types are all that
17387 news-like---variables needed to transform the head or the body into
17388 something that's palatable for Gnus:
17389
17390 @table @code
17391 @item prepare-body-function
17392 If present, this function will be called when requesting an article. It
17393 will be called with point at the start of the body, and is useful if the
17394 document has encoded some parts of its contents.
17395
17396 @item article-transform-function
17397 If present, this function is called when requesting an article. It's
17398 meant to be used for more wide-ranging transformation of both head and
17399 body of the article.
17400
17401 @item generate-head-function
17402 If present, this function is called to generate a head that Gnus can
17403 understand. It is called with the article number as a parameter, and is
17404 expected to generate a nice head for the article in question. It is
17405 called when requesting the headers of all articles.
17406
17407 @item generate-article-function
17408 If present, this function is called to generate an entire article that
17409 Gnus can understand. It is called with the article number as a
17410 parameter when requesting all articles.
17411
17412 @item dissection-function
17413 If present, this function is called to dissect a document by itself,
17414 overriding @code{first-article}, @code{article-begin},
17415 @code{article-begin-function}, @code{head-begin},
17416 @code{head-begin-function}, @code{head-end}, @code{body-begin},
17417 @code{body-begin-function}, @code{body-end}, @code{body-end-function},
17418 @code{file-begin}, and @code{file-end}.
17419
17420 @end table
17421
17422 Let's look at the most complicated example I can come up with---standard
17423 digests:
17424
17425 @example
17426 (standard-digest
17427 (first-article . ,(concat "^" (make-string 70 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17428 (article-begin . ,(concat "\n\n" (make-string 30 ?-) "\n\n+"))
17429 (prepare-body-function . nndoc-unquote-dashes)
17430 (body-end-function . nndoc-digest-body-end)
17431 (head-end . "^ ?$")
17432 (body-begin . "^ ?\n")
17433 (file-end . "^End of .*digest.*[0-9].*\n\\*\\*\\|^End of.*Digest *$")
17434 (subtype digest guess))
17435 @end example
17436
17437 We see that all text before a 70-width line of dashes is ignored; all
17438 text after a line that starts with that @samp{^End of} is also ignored;
17439 each article begins with a 30-width line of dashes; the line separating
17440 the head from the body may contain a single space; and that the body is
17441 run through @code{nndoc-unquote-dashes} before being delivered.
17442
17443 To hook your own document definition into @code{nndoc}, use the
17444 @code{nndoc-add-type} function. It takes two parameters---the first
17445 is the definition itself and the second (optional) parameter says
17446 where in the document type definition alist to put this definition.
17447 The alist is traversed sequentially, and
17448 @code{nndoc-@var{type}-type-p} is called for a given type @var{type}.
17449 So @code{nndoc-mmdf-type-p} is called to see whether a document is of
17450 @code{mmdf} type, and so on. These type predicates should return
17451 @code{nil} if the document is not of the correct type; @code{t} if it
17452 is of the correct type; and a number if the document might be of the
17453 correct type. A high number means high probability; a low number
17454 means low probability with @samp{0} being the lowest valid number.
17455
17456
17457 @node SOUP
17458 @subsection SOUP
17459 @cindex SOUP
17460 @cindex offline
17461
17462 In the PC world people often talk about ``offline'' newsreaders. These
17463 are thingies that are combined reader/news transport monstrosities.
17464 With built-in modem programs. Yecchh!
17465
17466 Of course, us Unix Weenie types of human beans use things like
17467 @code{uucp} and, like, @code{nntpd} and set up proper news and mail
17468 transport things like Ghod intended. And then we just use normal
17469 newsreaders.
17470
17471 However, it can sometimes be convenient to do something that's a bit
17472 easier on the brain if you have a very slow modem, and you're not really
17473 that interested in doing things properly.
17474
17475 A file format called @sc{soup} has been developed for transporting news
17476 and mail from servers to home machines and back again. It can be a bit
17477 fiddly.
17478
17479 First some terminology:
17480
17481 @table @dfn
17482
17483 @item server
17484 This is the machine that is connected to the outside world and where you
17485 get news and/or mail from.
17486
17487 @item home machine
17488 This is the machine that you want to do the actual reading and responding
17489 on. It is typically not connected to the rest of the world in any way.
17490
17491 @item packet
17492 Something that contains messages and/or commands. There are two kinds
17493 of packets:
17494
17495 @table @dfn
17496 @item message packets
17497 These are packets made at the server, and typically contain lots of
17498 messages for you to read. These are called @file{SoupoutX.tgz} by
17499 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17500
17501 @item response packets
17502 These are packets made at the home machine, and typically contains
17503 replies that you've written. These are called @file{SoupinX.tgz} by
17504 default, where @var{x} is a number.
17505
17506 @end table
17507
17508 @end table
17509
17510
17511 @enumerate
17512
17513 @item
17514 You log in on the server and create a @sc{soup} packet. You can either
17515 use a dedicated @sc{soup} thingie (like the @code{awk} program), or you
17516 can use Gnus to create the packet with its @sc{soup} commands (@kbd{O
17517 s} and/or @kbd{G s b}; and then @kbd{G s p}) (@pxref{SOUP Commands}).
17518
17519 @item
17520 You transfer the packet home. Rail, boat, car or modem will do fine.
17521
17522 @item
17523 You put the packet in your home directory.
17524
17525 @item
17526 You fire up Gnus on your home machine using the @code{nnsoup} back end as
17527 the native or secondary server.
17528
17529 @item
17530 You read articles and mail and answer and followup to the things you
17531 want (@pxref{SOUP Replies}).
17532
17533 @item
17534 You do the @kbd{G s r} command to pack these replies into a @sc{soup}
17535 packet.
17536
17537 @item
17538 You transfer this packet to the server.
17539
17540 @item
17541 You use Gnus to mail this packet out with the @kbd{G s s} command.
17542
17543 @item
17544 You then repeat until you die.
17545
17546 @end enumerate
17547
17548 So you basically have a bipartite system---you use @code{nnsoup} for
17549 reading and Gnus for packing/sending these @sc{soup} packets.
17550
17551 @menu
17552 * SOUP Commands:: Commands for creating and sending @sc{soup} packets
17553 * SOUP Groups:: A back end for reading @sc{soup} packets.
17554 * SOUP Replies:: How to enable @code{nnsoup} to take over mail and news.
17555 @end menu
17556
17557
17558 @node SOUP Commands
17559 @subsubsection SOUP Commands
17560
17561 These are commands for creating and manipulating @sc{soup} packets.
17562
17563 @table @kbd
17564 @item G s b
17565 @kindex G s b (Group)
17566 @findex gnus-group-brew-soup
17567 Pack all unread articles in the current group
17568 (@code{gnus-group-brew-soup}). This command understands the
17569 process/prefix convention.
17570
17571 @item G s w
17572 @kindex G s w (Group)
17573 @findex gnus-soup-save-areas
17574 Save all @sc{soup} data files (@code{gnus-soup-save-areas}).
17575
17576 @item G s s
17577 @kindex G s s (Group)
17578 @findex gnus-soup-send-replies
17579 Send all replies from the replies packet
17580 (@code{gnus-soup-send-replies}).
17581
17582 @item G s p
17583 @kindex G s p (Group)
17584 @findex gnus-soup-pack-packet
17585 Pack all files into a @sc{soup} packet (@code{gnus-soup-pack-packet}).
17586
17587 @item G s r
17588 @kindex G s r (Group)
17589 @findex nnsoup-pack-replies
17590 Pack all replies into a replies packet (@code{nnsoup-pack-replies}).
17591
17592 @item O s
17593 @kindex O s (Summary)
17594 @findex gnus-soup-add-article
17595 This summary-mode command adds the current article to a @sc{soup} packet
17596 (@code{gnus-soup-add-article}). It understands the process/prefix
17597 convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
17598
17599 @end table
17600
17601
17602 There are a few variables to customize where Gnus will put all these
17603 thingies:
17604
17605 @table @code
17606
17607 @item gnus-soup-directory
17608 @vindex gnus-soup-directory
17609 Directory where Gnus will save intermediate files while composing
17610 @sc{soup} packets. The default is @file{~/SoupBrew/}.
17611
17612 @item gnus-soup-replies-directory
17613 @vindex gnus-soup-replies-directory
17614 This is what Gnus will use as a temporary directory while sending our
17615 reply packets. @file{~/SoupBrew/SoupReplies/} is the default.
17616
17617 @item gnus-soup-prefix-file
17618 @vindex gnus-soup-prefix-file
17619 Name of the file where Gnus stores the last used prefix. The default is
17620 @samp{gnus-prefix}.
17621
17622 @item gnus-soup-packer
17623 @vindex gnus-soup-packer
17624 A format string command for packing a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17625 @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupout%d.tgz}.
17626
17627 @item gnus-soup-unpacker
17628 @vindex gnus-soup-unpacker
17629 Format string command for unpacking a @sc{soup} packet. The default is
17630 @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17631
17632 @item gnus-soup-packet-directory
17633 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-directory
17634 Where Gnus will look for reply packets. The default is @file{~/}.
17635
17636 @item gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17637 @vindex gnus-soup-packet-regexp
17638 Regular expression matching @sc{soup} reply packets in
17639 @code{gnus-soup-packet-directory}.
17640
17641 @end table
17642
17643
17644 @node SOUP Groups
17645 @subsubsection SOUP Groups
17646 @cindex nnsoup
17647
17648 @code{nnsoup} is the back end for reading @sc{soup} packets. It will
17649 read incoming packets, unpack them, and put them in a directory where
17650 you can read them at leisure.
17651
17652 These are the variables you can use to customize its behavior:
17653
17654 @table @code
17655
17656 @item nnsoup-tmp-directory
17657 @vindex nnsoup-tmp-directory
17658 When @code{nnsoup} unpacks a @sc{soup} packet, it does it in this
17659 directory. (@file{/tmp/} by default.)
17660
17661 @item nnsoup-directory
17662 @vindex nnsoup-directory
17663 @code{nnsoup} then moves each message and index file to this directory.
17664 The default is @file{~/SOUP/}.
17665
17666 @item nnsoup-replies-directory
17667 @vindex nnsoup-replies-directory
17668 All replies will be stored in this directory before being packed into a
17669 reply packet. The default is @file{~/SOUP/replies/}.
17670
17671 @item nnsoup-replies-format-type
17672 @vindex nnsoup-replies-format-type
17673 The @sc{soup} format of the replies packets. The default is @samp{?n}
17674 (rnews), and I don't think you should touch that variable. I probably
17675 shouldn't even have documented it. Drats! Too late!
17676
17677 @item nnsoup-replies-index-type
17678 @vindex nnsoup-replies-index-type
17679 The index type of the replies packet. The default is @samp{?n}, which
17680 means ``none''. Don't fiddle with this one either!
17681
17682 @item nnsoup-active-file
17683 @vindex nnsoup-active-file
17684 Where @code{nnsoup} stores lots of information. This is not an ``active
17685 file'' in the @code{nntp} sense; it's an Emacs Lisp file. If you lose
17686 this file or mess it up in any way, you're dead. The default is
17687 @file{~/SOUP/active}.
17688
17689 @item nnsoup-packer
17690 @vindex nnsoup-packer
17691 Format string command for packing a reply @sc{soup} packet. The default
17692 is @samp{tar cf - %s | gzip > $HOME/Soupin%d.tgz}.
17693
17694 @item nnsoup-unpacker
17695 @vindex nnsoup-unpacker
17696 Format string command for unpacking incoming @sc{soup} packets. The
17697 default is @samp{gunzip -c %s | tar xvf -}.
17698
17699 @item nnsoup-packet-directory
17700 @vindex nnsoup-packet-directory
17701 Where @code{nnsoup} will look for incoming packets. The default is
17702 @file{~/}.
17703
17704 @item nnsoup-packet-regexp
17705 @vindex nnsoup-packet-regexp
17706 Regular expression matching incoming @sc{soup} packets. The default is
17707 @samp{Soupout}.
17708
17709 @item nnsoup-always-save
17710 @vindex nnsoup-always-save
17711 If non-@code{nil}, save the replies buffer after each posted message.
17712
17713 @end table
17714
17715
17716 @node SOUP Replies
17717 @subsubsection SOUP Replies
17718
17719 Just using @code{nnsoup} won't mean that your postings and mailings end
17720 up in @sc{soup} reply packets automagically. You have to work a bit
17721 more for that to happen.
17722
17723 @findex nnsoup-set-variables
17724 The @code{nnsoup-set-variables} command will set the appropriate
17725 variables to ensure that all your followups and replies end up in the
17726 @sc{soup} system.
17727
17728 In specific, this is what it does:
17729
17730 @lisp
17731 (setq message-send-news-function 'nnsoup-request-post)
17732 (setq message-send-mail-function 'nnsoup-request-mail)
17733 @end lisp
17734
17735 And that's it, really. If you only want news to go into the @sc{soup}
17736 system you just use the first line. If you only want mail to be
17737 @sc{soup}ed you use the second.
17738
17739
17740 @node Mail-To-News Gateways
17741 @subsection Mail-To-News Gateways
17742 @cindex mail-to-news gateways
17743 @cindex gateways
17744
17745 If your local @code{nntp} server doesn't allow posting, for some reason
17746 or other, you can post using one of the numerous mail-to-news gateways.
17747 The @code{nngateway} back end provides the interface.
17748
17749 Note that you can't read anything from this back end---it can only be
17750 used to post with.
17751
17752 Server variables:
17753
17754 @table @code
17755 @item nngateway-address
17756 @vindex nngateway-address
17757 This is the address of the mail-to-news gateway.
17758
17759 @item nngateway-header-transformation
17760 @vindex nngateway-header-transformation
17761 News headers often have to be transformed in some odd way or other
17762 for the mail-to-news gateway to accept it. This variable says what
17763 transformation should be called, and defaults to
17764 @code{nngateway-simple-header-transformation}. The function is called
17765 narrowed to the headers to be transformed and with one parameter---the
17766 gateway address.
17767
17768 This default function just inserts a new @code{To} header based on the
17769 @code{Newsgroups} header and the gateway address.
17770 For instance, an article with this @code{Newsgroups} header:
17771
17772 @example
17773 Newsgroups: alt.religion.emacs
17774 @end example
17775
17776 will get this @code{To} header inserted:
17777
17778 @example
17779 To: alt-religion-emacs@@GATEWAY
17780 @end example
17781
17782 The following pre-defined functions exist:
17783
17784 @findex nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17785 @table @code
17786
17787 @item nngateway-simple-header-transformation
17788 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17789 @var{newsgroup}@@@code{nngateway-address}.
17790
17791 @findex nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17792
17793 @item nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation
17794 Creates a @code{To} header that looks like
17795 @code{nngateway-address}.
17796 @end table
17797
17798 @end table
17799
17800 Here's an example:
17801
17802 @lisp
17803 (setq gnus-post-method
17804 '(nngateway
17805 "mail2news@@replay.com"
17806 (nngateway-header-transformation
17807 nngateway-mail2news-header-transformation)))
17808 @end lisp
17809
17810 So, to use this, simply say something like:
17811
17812 @lisp
17813 (setq gnus-post-method '(nngateway "GATEWAY.ADDRESS"))
17814 @end lisp
17815
17816
17817
17818 @node Combined Groups
17819 @section Combined Groups
17820
17821 Gnus allows combining a mixture of all the other group types into bigger
17822 groups.
17823
17824 @menu
17825 * Virtual Groups:: Combining articles from many groups.
17826 * Kibozed Groups:: Looking through parts of the newsfeed for articles.
17827 @end menu
17828
17829
17830 @node Virtual Groups
17831 @subsection Virtual Groups
17832 @cindex nnvirtual
17833 @cindex virtual groups
17834 @cindex merging groups
17835
17836 An @dfn{nnvirtual group} is really nothing more than a collection of
17837 other groups.
17838
17839 For instance, if you are tired of reading many small groups, you can
17840 put them all in one big group, and then grow tired of reading one
17841 big, unwieldy group. The joys of computing!
17842
17843 You specify @code{nnvirtual} as the method. The address should be a
17844 regexp to match component groups.
17845
17846 All marks in the virtual group will stick to the articles in the
17847 component groups. So if you tick an article in a virtual group, the
17848 article will also be ticked in the component group from whence it
17849 came. (And vice versa---marks from the component groups will also be
17850 shown in the virtual group.). To create an empty virtual group, run
17851 @kbd{G V} (@code{gnus-group-make-empty-virtual}) in the group buffer
17852 and edit the method regexp with @kbd{M-e}
17853 (@code{gnus-group-edit-group-method})
17854
17855 Here's an example @code{nnvirtual} method that collects all Andrea Dworkin
17856 newsgroups into one, big, happy newsgroup:
17857
17858 @lisp
17859 (nnvirtual "^alt\\.fan\\.andrea-dworkin$\\|^rec\\.dworkin.*")
17860 @end lisp
17861
17862 The component groups can be native or foreign; everything should work
17863 smoothly, but if your computer explodes, it was probably my fault.
17864
17865 Collecting the same group from several servers might actually be a good
17866 idea if users have set the Distribution header to limit distribution.
17867 If you would like to read @samp{soc.motss} both from a server in Japan
17868 and a server in Norway, you could use the following as the group regexp:
17869
17870 @example
17871 "^nntp\\+server\\.jp:soc\\.motss$\\|^nntp\\+server\\.no:soc\\.motss$"
17872 @end example
17873
17874 (Remember, though, that if you're creating the group with @kbd{G m}, you
17875 shouldn't double the backslashes, and you should leave off the quote
17876 characters at the beginning and the end of the string.)
17877
17878 This should work kinda smoothly---all articles from both groups should
17879 end up in this one, and there should be no duplicates. Threading (and
17880 the rest) will still work as usual, but there might be problems with the
17881 sequence of articles. Sorting on date might be an option here
17882 (@pxref{Selecting a Group}).
17883
17884 One limitation, however---all groups included in a virtual
17885 group have to be alive (i.e., subscribed or unsubscribed). Killed or
17886 zombie groups can't be component groups for @code{nnvirtual} groups.
17887
17888 @vindex nnvirtual-always-rescan
17889 If the @code{nnvirtual-always-rescan} variable is non-@code{nil} (which
17890 is the default), @code{nnvirtual} will always scan groups for unread
17891 articles when entering a virtual group. If this variable is @code{nil}
17892 and you read articles in a component group after the virtual group has
17893 been activated, the read articles from the component group will show up
17894 when you enter the virtual group. You'll also see this effect if you
17895 have two virtual groups that have a component group in common. If
17896 that's the case, you should set this variable to @code{t}. Or you can
17897 just tap @code{M-g} on the virtual group every time before you enter
17898 it---it'll have much the same effect.
17899
17900 @code{nnvirtual} can have both mail and news groups as component groups.
17901 When responding to articles in @code{nnvirtual} groups, @code{nnvirtual}
17902 has to ask the back end of the component group the article comes from
17903 whether it is a news or mail back end. However, when you do a @kbd{^},
17904 there is typically no sure way for the component back end to know this,
17905 and in that case @code{nnvirtual} tells Gnus that the article came from a
17906 not-news back end. (Just to be on the safe side.)
17907
17908 @kbd{C-c C-n} in the message buffer will insert the @code{Newsgroups}
17909 line from the article you respond to in these cases.
17910
17911 @code{nnvirtual} groups do not inherit anything but articles and marks
17912 from component groups---group parameters, for instance, are not
17913 inherited.
17914
17915
17916 @node Kibozed Groups
17917 @subsection Kibozed Groups
17918 @cindex nnkiboze
17919 @cindex kibozing
17920
17921 @dfn{Kibozing} is defined by the @acronym{OED} as ``grepping through
17922 (parts of) the news feed''. @code{nnkiboze} is a back end that will
17923 do this for you. Oh joy! Now you can grind any @acronym{NNTP} server
17924 down to a halt with useless requests! Oh happiness!
17925
17926 @kindex G k (Group)
17927 To create a kibozed group, use the @kbd{G k} command in the group
17928 buffer.
17929
17930 The address field of the @code{nnkiboze} method is, as with
17931 @code{nnvirtual}, a regexp to match groups to be ``included'' in the
17932 @code{nnkiboze} group. That's where most similarities between
17933 @code{nnkiboze} and @code{nnvirtual} end.
17934
17935 In addition to this regexp detailing component groups, an
17936 @code{nnkiboze} group must have a score file to say what articles are
17937 to be included in the group (@pxref{Scoring}).
17938
17939 @kindex M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups
17940 @findex nnkiboze-generate-groups
17941 You must run @kbd{M-x nnkiboze-generate-groups} after creating the
17942 @code{nnkiboze} groups you want to have. This command will take time.
17943 Lots of time. Oodles and oodles of time. Gnus has to fetch the
17944 headers from all the articles in all the component groups and run them
17945 through the scoring process to determine if there are any articles in
17946 the groups that are to be part of the @code{nnkiboze} groups.
17947
17948 Please limit the number of component groups by using restrictive
17949 regexps. Otherwise your sysadmin may become annoyed with you, and the
17950 @acronym{NNTP} site may throw you off and never let you back in again.
17951 Stranger things have happened.
17952
17953 @code{nnkiboze} component groups do not have to be alive---they can be dead,
17954 and they can be foreign. No restrictions.
17955
17956 @vindex nnkiboze-directory
17957 The generation of an @code{nnkiboze} group means writing two files in
17958 @code{nnkiboze-directory}, which is @file{~/News/kiboze/} by default.
17959 One contains the @acronym{NOV} header lines for all the articles in
17960 the group, and the other is an additional @file{.newsrc} file to store
17961 information on what groups have been searched through to find
17962 component articles.
17963
17964 Articles marked as read in the @code{nnkiboze} group will have
17965 their @acronym{NOV} lines removed from the @acronym{NOV} file.
17966
17967
17968 @node Email Based Diary
17969 @section Email Based Diary
17970 @cindex diary
17971 @cindex email based diary
17972 @cindex calendar
17973
17974 This section describes a special mail back end called @code{nndiary},
17975 and its companion library @code{gnus-diary}. It is ``special'' in the
17976 sense that it is not meant to be one of the standard alternatives for
17977 reading mail with Gnus. See @ref{Choosing a Mail Back End} for that.
17978 Instead, it is used to treat @emph{some} of your mails in a special way,
17979 namely, as event reminders.
17980
17981 Here is a typical scenario:
17982
17983 @itemize @bullet
17984 @item
17985 You've got a date with Andy Mc Dowell or Bruce Willis (select according
17986 to your sexual preference) in one month. You don't want to forget it.
17987 @item
17988 So you send a ``reminder'' message (actually, a diary one) to yourself.
17989 @item
17990 You forget all about it and keep on getting and reading new mail, as usual.
17991 @item
17992 From time to time, as you type `g' in the group buffer and as the date
17993 is getting closer, the message will pop up again to remind you of your
17994 appointment, just as if it were new and unread.
17995 @item
17996 Read your ``new'' messages, this one included, and start dreaming again
17997 of the night you're gonna have.
17998 @item
17999 Once the date is over (you actually fell asleep just after dinner), the
18000 message will be automatically deleted if it is marked as expirable.
18001 @end itemize
18002
18003 The Gnus Diary back end has the ability to handle regular appointments
18004 (that wouldn't ever be deleted) as well as punctual ones, operates as a
18005 real mail back end and is configurable in many ways. All of this is
18006 explained in the sections below.
18007
18008 @menu
18009 * The NNDiary Back End:: Basic setup and usage.
18010 * The Gnus Diary Library:: Utility toolkit on top of nndiary.
18011 * Sending or Not Sending:: A final note on sending diary messages.
18012 @end menu
18013
18014
18015 @node The NNDiary Back End
18016 @subsection The NNDiary Back End
18017 @cindex nndiary
18018 @cindex the nndiary back end
18019
18020 @code{nndiary} is a back end very similar to @code{nnml} (@pxref{Mail
18021 Spool}). Actually, it could appear as a mix of @code{nnml} and
18022 @code{nndraft}. If you know @code{nnml}, you're already familiar with
18023 the message storing scheme of @code{nndiary}: one file per message, one
18024 directory per group.
18025
18026 Before anything, there is one requirement to be able to run
18027 @code{nndiary} properly: you @emph{must} use the group timestamp feature
18028 of Gnus. This adds a timestamp to each group's parameters. @ref{Group
18029 Timestamp} to see how it's done.
18030
18031 @menu
18032 * Diary Messages:: What makes a message valid for nndiary.
18033 * Running NNDiary:: NNDiary has two modes of operation.
18034 * Customizing NNDiary:: Bells and whistles.
18035 @end menu
18036
18037 @node Diary Messages
18038 @subsubsection Diary Messages
18039 @cindex nndiary messages
18040 @cindex nndiary mails
18041
18042 @code{nndiary} messages are just normal ones, except for the mandatory
18043 presence of 7 special headers. These headers are of the form
18044 @code{X-Diary-<something>}, @code{<something>} being one of
18045 @code{Minute}, @code{Hour}, @code{Dom}, @code{Month}, @code{Year},
18046 @code{Time-Zone} and @code{Dow}. @code{Dom} means ``Day of Month'', and
18047 @code{dow} means ``Day of Week''. These headers actually behave like
18048 crontab specifications and define the event date(s):
18049
18050 @itemize @bullet
18051 @item
18052 For all headers except the @code{Time-Zone} one, a header value is
18053 either a star (meaning all possible values), or a list of fields
18054 (separated by a comma).
18055 @item
18056 A field is either an integer, or a range.
18057 @item
18058 A range is two integers separated by a dash.
18059 @item
18060 Possible integer values are 0--59 for @code{Minute}, 0--23 for
18061 @code{Hour}, 1--31 for @code{Dom}, 1--12 for @code{Month}, above 1971
18062 for @code{Year} and 0--6 for @code{Dow} (0 meaning Sunday).
18063 @item
18064 As a special case, a star in either @code{Dom} or @code{Dow} doesn't
18065 mean ``all possible values'', but ``use only the other field''. Note
18066 that if both are star'ed, the use of either one gives the same result.
18067 @item
18068 The @code{Time-Zone} header is special in that it can only have one
18069 value (@code{GMT}, for instance). A star doesn't mean ``all possible
18070 values'' (because it makes no sense), but ``the current local time
18071 zone''. Most of the time, you'll be using a star here. However, for a
18072 list of available time zone values, see the variable
18073 @code{nndiary-headers}.
18074 @end itemize
18075
18076 As a concrete example, here are the diary headers to add to your message
18077 for specifying ``Each Monday and each 1st of month, at 12:00, 20:00,
18078 21:00, 22:00, 23:00 and 24:00, from 1999 to 2010'' (I'll let you find
18079 what to do then):
18080
18081 @example
18082 X-Diary-Minute: 0
18083 X-Diary-Hour: 12, 20-24
18084 X-Diary-Dom: 1
18085 X-Diary-Month: *
18086 X-Diary-Year: 1999-2010
18087 X-Diary-Dow: 1
18088 X-Diary-Time-Zone: *
18089 @end example
18090
18091 @node Running NNDiary
18092 @subsubsection Running NNDiary
18093 @cindex running nndiary
18094 @cindex nndiary operation modes
18095
18096 @code{nndiary} has two modes of operation: ``traditional'' (the default)
18097 and ``autonomous''. In traditional mode, @code{nndiary} does not get new
18098 mail by itself. You have to move (@kbd{B m}) or copy (@kbd{B c}) mails
18099 from your primary mail back end to nndiary groups in order to handle them
18100 as diary messages. In autonomous mode, @code{nndiary} retrieves its own
18101 mail and handles it independently from your primary mail back end.
18102
18103 One should note that Gnus is not inherently designed to allow several
18104 ``master'' mail back ends at the same time. However, this does make
18105 sense with @code{nndiary}: you really want to send and receive diary
18106 messages to your diary groups directly. So, @code{nndiary} supports
18107 being sort of a ``second primary mail back end'' (to my knowledge, it is
18108 the only back end offering this feature). However, there is a limitation
18109 (which I hope to fix some day): respooling doesn't work in autonomous
18110 mode.
18111
18112 In order to use @code{nndiary} in autonomous mode, you have several
18113 things to do:
18114
18115 @itemize @bullet
18116 @item
18117 Allow @code{nndiary} to retrieve new mail by itself. Put the following
18118 line in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
18119
18120 @lisp
18121 (setq nndiary-get-new-mail t)
18122 @end lisp
18123 @item
18124 You must arrange for diary messages (those containing @code{X-Diary-*}
18125 headers) to be split in a private folder @emph{before} Gnus treat them.
18126 Again, this is needed because Gnus cannot (yet ?) properly handle
18127 multiple primary mail back ends. Getting those messages from a separate
18128 source will compensate this misfeature to some extent.
18129
18130 As an example, here's my procmailrc entry to store diary files in
18131 @file{~/.nndiary} (the default @code{nndiary} mail source file):
18132
18133 @example
18134 :0 HD :
18135 * ^X-Diary
18136 .nndiary
18137 @end example
18138 @end itemize
18139
18140 Once this is done, you might want to customize the following two options
18141 that affect the diary mail retrieval and splitting processes:
18142
18143 @defvar nndiary-mail-sources
18144 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
18145 @code{mail-sources} variable. It obeys the same syntax, and defaults to
18146 @code{(file :path "~/.nndiary")}.
18147 @end defvar
18148
18149 @defvar nndiary-split-methods
18150 This is the diary-specific replacement for the standard
18151 @code{nnmail-split-methods} variable. It obeys the same syntax.
18152 @end defvar
18153
18154 Finally, you may add a permanent @code{nndiary} virtual server
18155 (something like @code{(nndiary "diary")} should do) to your
18156 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods}.
18157
18158 Hopefully, almost everything (see the TODO section in
18159 @file{nndiary.el}) will work as expected when you restart Gnus: in
18160 autonomous mode, typing @kbd{g} and @kbd{M-g} in the group buffer, will
18161 also get your new diary mails and split them according to your
18162 diary-specific rules, @kbd{F} will find your new diary groups etc.
18163
18164 @node Customizing NNDiary
18165 @subsubsection Customizing NNDiary
18166 @cindex customizing nndiary
18167 @cindex nndiary customization
18168
18169 Now that @code{nndiary} is up and running, it's time to customize it.
18170 The custom group is called @code{nndiary} (no, really ?!). You should
18171 browse it to figure out which options you'd like to tweak. The following
18172 two variables are probably the only ones you will want to change:
18173
18174 @defvar nndiary-reminders
18175 This is the list of times when you want to be reminded of your
18176 appointments (e.g. 3 weeks before, then 2 days before, then 1 hour
18177 before and that's it). Remember that ``being reminded'' means that the
18178 diary message will pop up as brand new and unread again when you get new
18179 mail.
18180 @end defvar
18181
18182 @defvar nndiary-week-starts-on-monday
18183 Rather self-explanatory. Otherwise, Sunday is assumed (this is the
18184 default).
18185 @end defvar
18186
18187
18188 @node The Gnus Diary Library
18189 @subsection The Gnus Diary Library
18190 @cindex gnus-diary
18191 @cindex the gnus diary library
18192
18193 Using @code{nndiary} manually (I mean, writing the headers by hand and
18194 so on) would be rather boring. Fortunately, there is a library called
18195 @code{gnus-diary} written on top of @code{nndiary}, that does many
18196 useful things for you.
18197
18198 In order to use it, add the following line to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
18199
18200 @lisp
18201 (require 'gnus-diary)
18202 @end lisp
18203
18204 Also, you shouldn't use any @code{gnus-user-format-function-[d|D]}
18205 (@pxref{Summary Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} provides both of these
18206 (sorry if you used them before).
18207
18208
18209 @menu
18210 * Diary Summary Line Format:: A nicer summary buffer line format.
18211 * Diary Articles Sorting:: A nicer way to sort messages.
18212 * Diary Headers Generation:: Not doing it manually.
18213 * Diary Group Parameters:: Not handling them manually.
18214 @end menu
18215
18216 @node Diary Summary Line Format
18217 @subsubsection Diary Summary Line Format
18218 @cindex diary summary buffer line
18219 @cindex diary summary line format
18220
18221 Displaying diary messages in standard summary line format (usually
18222 something like @samp{From Joe: Subject}) is pretty useless. Most of
18223 the time, you're the one who wrote the message, and you mostly want to
18224 see the event's date.
18225
18226 @code{gnus-diary} provides two supplemental user formats to be used in
18227 summary line formats. @code{D} corresponds to a formatted time string
18228 for the next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00''),
18229 while @code{d} corresponds to an approximative remaining time until the
18230 next occurrence of the event (e.g. ``in 6 months, 1 week'').
18231
18232 For example, here's how Joe's birthday is displayed in my
18233 @code{nndiary+diary:birthdays} summary buffer (note that the message is
18234 expirable, but will never be deleted, as it specifies a periodic event):
18235
18236 @example
18237 E Sat, Sep 22 01, 12:00: Joe's birthday (in 6 months, 1 week)
18238 @end example
18239
18240 In order to get something like the above, you would normally add the
18241 following line to your diary groups'parameters:
18242
18243 @lisp
18244 (gnus-summary-line-format "%U%R%z %uD: %(%s%) (%ud)\n")
18245 @end lisp
18246
18247 However, @code{gnus-diary} does it automatically (@pxref{Diary Group
18248 Parameters}). You can however customize the provided summary line format
18249 with the following user options:
18250
18251 @defvar gnus-diary-summary-line-format
18252 Defines the summary line format used for diary groups (@pxref{Summary
18253 Buffer Lines}). @code{gnus-diary} uses it to automatically update the
18254 diary groups'parameters.
18255 @end defvar
18256
18257 @defvar gnus-diary-time-format
18258 Defines the format to display dates in diary summary buffers. This is
18259 used by the @code{D} user format. See the docstring for details.
18260 @end defvar
18261
18262 @defvar gnus-diary-delay-format-function
18263 Defines the format function to use for displaying delays (remaining
18264 times) in diary summary buffers. This is used by the @code{d} user
18265 format. There are currently built-in functions for English and French;
18266 you can also define your own. See the docstring for details.
18267 @end defvar
18268
18269 @node Diary Articles Sorting
18270 @subsubsection Diary Articles Sorting
18271 @cindex diary articles sorting
18272 @cindex diary summary lines sorting
18273 @findex gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule
18274 @findex gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule
18275 @findex gnus-article-sort-by-schedule
18276
18277 @code{gnus-diary} provides new sorting functions (@pxref{Sorting the
18278 Summary Buffer} ) called @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule},
18279 @code{gnus-thread-sort-by-schedule} and
18280 @code{gnus-article-sort-by-schedule}. These functions let you organize
18281 your diary summary buffers from the closest event to the farthest one.
18282
18283 @code{gnus-diary} automatically installs
18284 @code{gnus-summary-sort-by-schedule} as a menu item in the summary
18285 buffer's ``sort'' menu, and the two others as the primary (hence
18286 default) sorting functions in the group parameters (@pxref{Diary Group
18287 Parameters}).
18288
18289 @node Diary Headers Generation
18290 @subsubsection Diary Headers Generation
18291 @cindex diary headers generation
18292 @findex gnus-diary-check-message
18293
18294 @code{gnus-diary} provides a function called
18295 @code{gnus-diary-check-message} to help you handle the @code{X-Diary-*}
18296 headers. This function ensures that the current message contains all the
18297 required diary headers, and prompts you for values or corrections if
18298 needed.
18299
18300 This function is hooked into the @code{nndiary} back end, so that
18301 moving or copying an article to a diary group will trigger it
18302 automatically. It is also bound to @kbd{C-c C-f d} in
18303 @code{message-mode} and @code{article-edit-mode} in order to ease the
18304 process of converting a usual mail to a diary one.
18305
18306 This function takes a prefix argument which will force prompting of
18307 all diary headers, regardless of their presence or validity. That way,
18308 you can very easily reschedule an already valid diary message, for
18309 instance.
18310
18311 @node Diary Group Parameters
18312 @subsubsection Diary Group Parameters
18313 @cindex diary group parameters
18314
18315 When you create a new diary group, or visit one, @code{gnus-diary}
18316 automatically checks your group parameters and if needed, sets the
18317 summary line format to the diary-specific value, installs the
18318 diary-specific sorting functions, and also adds the different
18319 @code{X-Diary-*} headers to the group's posting-style. It is then easier
18320 to send a diary message, because if you use @kbd{C-u a} or @kbd{C-u m}
18321 on a diary group to prepare a message, these headers will be inserted
18322 automatically (although not filled with proper values yet).
18323
18324 @node Sending or Not Sending
18325 @subsection Sending or Not Sending
18326
18327 Well, assuming you've read all of the above, here are two final notes on
18328 mail sending with @code{nndiary}:
18329
18330 @itemize @bullet
18331 @item
18332 @code{nndiary} is a @emph{real} mail back end. You really send real diary
18333 messsages for real. This means for instance that you can give
18334 appointments to anybody (provided they use Gnus and @code{nndiary}) by
18335 sending the diary message to them as well.
18336 @item
18337 However, since @code{nndiary} also has a @code{request-post} method, you
18338 can also use @kbd{C-u a} instead of @kbd{C-u m} on a diary group and the
18339 message won't actually be sent; just stored locally in the group. This
18340 comes in very handy for private appointments.
18341 @end itemize
18342
18343 @node Gnus Unplugged
18344 @section Gnus Unplugged
18345 @cindex offline
18346 @cindex unplugged
18347 @cindex agent
18348 @cindex Gnus agent
18349 @cindex Gnus unplugged
18350
18351 In olden times (ca. February '88), people used to run their newsreaders
18352 on big machines with permanent connections to the net. News transport
18353 was dealt with by news servers, and all the newsreaders had to do was to
18354 read news. Believe it or not.
18355
18356 Nowadays most people read news and mail at home, and use some sort of
18357 modem to connect to the net. To avoid running up huge phone bills, it
18358 would be nice to have a way to slurp down all the news and mail, hang up
18359 the phone, read for several hours, and then upload any responses you
18360 have to make. And then you repeat the procedure.
18361
18362 Of course, you can use news servers for doing this as well. I've used
18363 @code{inn} together with @code{slurp}, @code{pop} and @code{sendmail}
18364 for some years, but doing that's a bore. Moving the news server
18365 functionality up to the newsreader makes sense if you're the only person
18366 reading news on a machine.
18367
18368 Setting up Gnus as an ``offline'' newsreader is quite simple. In
18369 fact, you don't even have to configure anything.
18370
18371 Of course, to use it as such, you have to learn a few new commands.
18372
18373 @menu
18374 * Agent Basics:: How it all is supposed to work.
18375 * Agent Categories:: How to tell the Gnus Agent what to download.
18376 * Agent Commands:: New commands for all the buffers.
18377 * Agent Visuals:: Ways that the agent may effect your summary buffer.
18378 * Agent as Cache:: The Agent is a big cache too.
18379 * Agent Expiry:: How to make old articles go away.
18380 * Agent Regeneration:: How to recover from lost connections and other accidents.
18381 * Agent and IMAP:: How to use the Agent with @acronym{IMAP}.
18382 * Outgoing Messages:: What happens when you post/mail something?
18383 * Agent Variables:: Customizing is fun.
18384 * Example Setup:: An example @file{~/.gnus.el} file for offline people.
18385 * Batching Agents:: How to fetch news from a @code{cron} job.
18386 * Agent Caveats:: What you think it'll do and what it does.
18387 @end menu
18388
18389
18390 @node Agent Basics
18391 @subsection Agent Basics
18392
18393 First, let's get some terminology out of the way.
18394
18395 The Gnus Agent is said to be @dfn{unplugged} when you have severed the
18396 connection to the net (and notified the Agent that this is the case).
18397 When the connection to the net is up again (and Gnus knows this), the
18398 Agent is @dfn{plugged}.
18399
18400 The @dfn{local} machine is the one you're running on, and which isn't
18401 connected to the net continuously.
18402
18403 @dfn{Downloading} means fetching things from the net to your local
18404 machine. @dfn{Uploading} is doing the opposite.
18405
18406 You know that Gnus gives you all the opportunity you'd ever want for
18407 shooting yourself in the foot. Some people call it flexibility. Gnus
18408 is also customizable to a great extent, which means that the user has a
18409 say on how Gnus behaves. Other newsreaders might unconditionally shoot
18410 you in your foot, but with Gnus, you have a choice!
18411
18412 Gnus is never really in plugged or unplugged state. Rather, it applies
18413 that state to each server individually. This means that some servers
18414 can be plugged while others can be unplugged. Additionally, some
18415 servers can be ignored by the Agent altogether (which means that
18416 they're kinda like plugged always).
18417
18418 So when you unplug the Agent and then wonder why is Gnus opening a
18419 connection to the Net, the next step to do is to look whether all
18420 servers are agentized. If there is an unagentized server, you found
18421 the culprit.
18422
18423 Another thing is the @dfn{offline} state. Sometimes, servers aren't
18424 reachable. When Gnus notices this, it asks you whether you want the
18425 server to be switched to offline state. If you say yes, then the
18426 server will behave somewhat as if it was unplugged, except that Gnus
18427 will ask you whether you want to switch it back online again.
18428
18429 Let's take a typical Gnus session using the Agent.
18430
18431 @itemize @bullet
18432
18433 @item
18434 @findex gnus-unplugged
18435 You start Gnus with @code{gnus-unplugged}. This brings up the Gnus
18436 Agent in a disconnected state. You can read all the news that you have
18437 already fetched while in this mode.
18438
18439 @item
18440 You then decide to see whether any new news has arrived. You connect
18441 your machine to the net (using PPP or whatever), and then hit @kbd{J j}
18442 to make Gnus become @dfn{plugged} and use @kbd{g} to check for new mail
18443 as usual. To check for new mail in unplugged mode (@pxref{Mail
18444 Source Specifiers}).
18445
18446 @item
18447 You can then read the new news immediately, or you can download the
18448 news onto your local machine. If you want to do the latter, you press
18449 @kbd{g} to check if there are any new news and then @kbd{J s} to fetch
18450 all the eligible articles in all the groups. (To let Gnus know which
18451 articles you want to download, @pxref{Agent Categories}).
18452
18453 @item
18454 After fetching the articles, you press @kbd{J j} to make Gnus become
18455 unplugged again, and you shut down the PPP thing (or whatever). And
18456 then you read the news offline.
18457
18458 @item
18459 And then you go to step 2.
18460 @end itemize
18461
18462 Here are some things you should do the first time (or so) that you use
18463 the Agent.
18464
18465 @itemize @bullet
18466
18467 @item
18468 Decide which servers should be covered by the Agent. If you have a mail
18469 back end, it would probably be nonsensical to have it covered by the
18470 Agent. Go to the server buffer (@kbd{^} in the group buffer) and press
18471 @kbd{J a} on the server (or servers) that you wish to have covered by the
18472 Agent (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}), or @kbd{J r} on automatically
18473 added servers you do not wish to have covered by the Agent. By default,
18474 all @code{nntp} and @code{nnimap} servers in @code{gnus-select-method} and
18475 @code{gnus-secondary-select-methods} are agentized.
18476
18477 @item
18478 Decide on download policy. It's fairly simple once you decide whether
18479 you are going to use agent categories, topic parameters, and/or group
18480 parameters to implement your policy. If you're new to gnus, it
18481 is probably best to start with a category, @xref{Agent Categories}.
18482
18483 Both topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) and agent categories
18484 (@pxref{Agent Categories}) provide for setting a policy that applies
18485 to multiple groups. Which you use is entirely up to you. Topic
18486 parameters do override categories so, if you mix the two, you'll have
18487 to take that into account. If you have a few groups that deviate from
18488 your policy, you can use group parameters (@pxref{Group Parameters}) to
18489 configure them.
18490
18491 @item
18492 Uhm@dots{} that's it.
18493 @end itemize
18494
18495
18496 @node Agent Categories
18497 @subsection Agent Categories
18498
18499 One of the main reasons to integrate the news transport layer into the
18500 newsreader is to allow greater control over what articles to download.
18501 There's not much point in downloading huge amounts of articles, just to
18502 find out that you're not interested in reading any of them. It's better
18503 to be somewhat more conservative in choosing what to download, and then
18504 mark the articles for downloading manually if it should turn out that
18505 you're interested in the articles anyway.
18506
18507 One of the more effective methods for controlling what is to be
18508 downloaded is to create a @dfn{category} and then assign some (or all)
18509 groups to this category. Groups that do not belong in any other
18510 category belong to the @code{default} category. Gnus has its own
18511 buffer for creating and managing categories.
18512
18513 If you prefer, you can also use group parameters (@pxref{Group
18514 Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic Parameters}) for an
18515 alternative approach to controlling the agent. The only real
18516 difference is that categories are specific to the agent (so there is
18517 less to learn) while group and topic parameters include the kitchen
18518 sink.
18519
18520 Since you can set agent parameters in several different places we have
18521 a rule to decide which source to believe. This rule specifies that
18522 the parameter sources are checked in the following order: group
18523 parameters, topic parameters, agent category, and finally customizable
18524 variables. So you can mix all of these sources to produce a wide range
18525 of behavior, just don't blame me if you don't remember where you put
18526 your settings.
18527
18528 @menu
18529 * Category Syntax:: What a category looks like.
18530 * Category Buffer:: A buffer for maintaining categories.
18531 * Category Variables:: Customize'r'Us.
18532 @end menu
18533
18534
18535 @node Category Syntax
18536 @subsubsection Category Syntax
18537
18538 A category consists of a name, the list of groups belonging to the
18539 category, and a number of optional parameters that override the
18540 customizable variables. The complete list of agent parameters are
18541 listed below.
18542
18543 @cindex Agent Parameters
18544 @table @code
18545 @item gnus-agent-cat-name
18546 The name of the category.
18547
18548 @item gnus-agent-cat-groups
18549 The list of groups that are in this category.
18550
18551 @item gnus-agent-cat-predicate
18552 A predicate which (generally) gives a rough outline of which articles
18553 are eligible for downloading; and
18554
18555 @item gnus-agent-cat-score-file
18556 a score rule which (generally) gives you a finer granularity when
18557 deciding what articles to download. (Note that this @dfn{download
18558 score} is not necessarily related to normal scores.)
18559
18560 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-expiration
18561 a boolean indicating whether the agent should expire old articles in
18562 this group. Most groups should be expired to conserve disk space. In
18563 fact, its probably safe to say that the gnus.* hierarchy contains the
18564 only groups that should not be expired.
18565
18566 @item gnus-agent-cat-days-until-old
18567 an integer indicating the number of days that the agent should wait
18568 before deciding that a read article is safe to expire.
18569
18570 @item gnus-agent-cat-low-score
18571 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-low-score}.
18572
18573 @item gnus-agent-cat-high-score
18574 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-high-score}.
18575
18576 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-short
18577 an integer that overrides the value of
18578 @code{gnus-agent-short-article}.
18579
18580 @item gnus-agent-cat-length-when-long
18581 an integer that overrides the value of @code{gnus-agent-long-article}.
18582
18583 @c @item gnus-agent-cat-disable-undownloaded-faces
18584 @c a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should @emph{not} display
18585 @c undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
18586 @c faces. The symbol nil will enable the use of undownloaded faces while
18587 @c all other symbols disable them.
18588
18589 @item gnus-agent-cat-enable-undownloaded-faces
18590 a symbol indicating whether the summary buffer should display
18591 undownloaded articles using the gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face
18592 faces. The symbol nil will disable the use of undownloaded faces while
18593 all other symbols enable them.
18594 @end table
18595
18596 The name of a category can not be changed once the category has been
18597 created.
18598
18599 Each category maintains a list of groups that are exclusive members of
18600 that category. The exclusivity rule is automatically enforced, add a
18601 group to a new category and it is automatically removed from its old
18602 category.
18603
18604 A predicate in its simplest form can be a single predicate such as
18605 @code{true} or @code{false}. These two will download every available
18606 article or nothing respectively. In the case of these two special
18607 predicates an additional score rule is superfluous.
18608
18609 Predicates of @code{high} or @code{low} download articles in respect of
18610 their scores in relationship to @code{gnus-agent-high-score} and
18611 @code{gnus-agent-low-score} as described below.
18612
18613 To gain even finer control of what is to be regarded eligible for
18614 download a predicate can consist of a number of predicates with logical
18615 operators sprinkled in between.
18616
18617 Perhaps some examples are in order.
18618
18619 Here's a simple predicate. (It's the default predicate, in fact, used
18620 for all groups that don't belong to any other category.)
18621
18622 @lisp
18623 short
18624 @end lisp
18625
18626 Quite simple, eh? This predicate is true if and only if the article is
18627 short (for some value of ``short'').
18628
18629 Here's a more complex predicate:
18630
18631 @lisp
18632 (or high
18633 (and
18634 (not low)
18635 (not long)))
18636 @end lisp
18637
18638 This means that an article should be downloaded if it has a high score,
18639 or if the score is not low and the article is not long. You get the
18640 drift.
18641
18642 The available logical operators are @code{or}, @code{and} and
18643 @code{not}. (If you prefer, you can use the more ``C''-ish operators
18644 @samp{|}, @code{&} and @code{!} instead.)
18645
18646 The following predicates are pre-defined, but if none of these fit what
18647 you want to do, you can write your own.
18648
18649 When evaluating each of these predicates, the named constant will be
18650 bound to the value determined by calling
18651 @code{gnus-agent-find-parameter} on the appropriate parameter. For
18652 example, gnus-agent-short-article will be bound to
18653 @code{(gnus-agent-find-parameter group 'agent-short-article)}. This
18654 means that you can specify a predicate in your category then tune that
18655 predicate to individual groups.
18656
18657 @table @code
18658 @item short
18659 True if the article is shorter than @code{gnus-agent-short-article}
18660 lines; default 100.
18661
18662 @item long
18663 True if the article is longer than @code{gnus-agent-long-article}
18664 lines; default 200.
18665
18666 @item low
18667 True if the article has a download score less than
18668 @code{gnus-agent-low-score}; default 0.
18669
18670 @item high
18671 True if the article has a download score greater than
18672 @code{gnus-agent-high-score}; default 0.
18673
18674 @item spam
18675 True if the Gnus Agent guesses that the article is spam. The
18676 heuristics may change over time, but at present it just computes a
18677 checksum and sees whether articles match.
18678
18679 @item true
18680 Always true.
18681
18682 @item false
18683 Always false.
18684 @end table
18685
18686 If you want to create your own predicate function, here's what you have
18687 to know: The functions are called with no parameters, but the
18688 @code{gnus-headers} and @code{gnus-score} dynamic variables are bound to
18689 useful values.
18690
18691 For example, you could decide that you don't want to download articles
18692 that were posted more than a certain number of days ago (e.g. posted
18693 more than @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} ago) you might write a function
18694 something along the lines of the following:
18695
18696 @lisp
18697 (defun my-article-old-p ()
18698 "Say whether an article is old."
18699 (< (time-to-days (date-to-time (mail-header-date gnus-headers)))
18700 (- (time-to-days (current-time)) gnus-agent-expire-days)))
18701 @end lisp
18702
18703 with the predicate then defined as:
18704
18705 @lisp
18706 (not my-article-old-p)
18707 @end lisp
18708
18709 or you could append your predicate to the predefined
18710 @code{gnus-category-predicate-alist} in your @file{~/.gnus.el} or
18711 wherever.
18712
18713 @lisp
18714 (require 'gnus-agent)
18715 (setq gnus-category-predicate-alist
18716 (append gnus-category-predicate-alist
18717 '((old . my-article-old-p))))
18718 @end lisp
18719
18720 and simply specify your predicate as:
18721
18722 @lisp
18723 (not old)
18724 @end lisp
18725
18726 If/when using something like the above, be aware that there are many
18727 misconfigured systems/mailers out there and so an article's date is not
18728 always a reliable indication of when it was posted. Hell, some people
18729 just don't give a damn.
18730
18731 The above predicates apply to @emph{all} the groups which belong to the
18732 category. However, if you wish to have a specific predicate for an
18733 individual group within a category, or you're just too lazy to set up a
18734 new category, you can enter a group's individual predicate in its group
18735 parameters like so:
18736
18737 @lisp
18738 (agent-predicate . short)
18739 @end lisp
18740
18741 This is the group/topic parameter equivalent of the agent category default.
18742 Note that when specifying a single word predicate like this, the
18743 @code{agent-predicate} specification must be in dotted pair notation.
18744
18745 The equivalent of the longer example from above would be:
18746
18747 @lisp
18748 (agent-predicate or high (and (not low) (not long)))
18749 @end lisp
18750
18751 The outer parenthesis required in the category specification are not
18752 entered here as, not being in dotted pair notation, the value of the
18753 predicate is assumed to be a list.
18754
18755
18756 Now, the syntax of the download score is the same as the syntax of
18757 normal score files, except that all elements that require actually
18758 seeing the article itself are verboten. This means that only the
18759 following headers can be scored on: @code{Subject}, @code{From},
18760 @code{Date}, @code{Message-ID}, @code{References}, @code{Chars},
18761 @code{Lines}, and @code{Xref}.
18762
18763 As with predicates, the specification of the @code{download score rule}
18764 to use in respect of a group can be in either the category definition if
18765 it's to be applicable to all groups in therein, or a group's parameters
18766 if it's to be specific to that group.
18767
18768 In both of these places the @code{download score rule} can take one of
18769 three forms:
18770
18771 @enumerate
18772 @item
18773 Score rule
18774
18775 This has the same syntax as a normal Gnus score file except only a
18776 subset of scoring keywords are available as mentioned above.
18777
18778 example:
18779
18780 @itemize @bullet
18781 @item
18782 Category specification
18783
18784 @lisp
18785 (("from"
18786 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18787 ("lines"
18788 (500 -100 nil <)))
18789 @end lisp
18790
18791 @item
18792 Group/Topic Parameter specification
18793
18794 @lisp
18795 (agent-score ("from"
18796 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" 1000000 nil s))
18797 ("lines"
18798 (500 -100 nil <)))
18799 @end lisp
18800
18801 Again, note the omission of the outermost parenthesis here.
18802 @end itemize
18803
18804 @item
18805 Agent score file
18806
18807 These score files must @emph{only} contain the permitted scoring
18808 keywords stated above.
18809
18810 example:
18811
18812 @itemize @bullet
18813 @item
18814 Category specification
18815
18816 @lisp
18817 ("~/News/agent.SCORE")
18818 @end lisp
18819
18820 or perhaps
18821
18822 @lisp
18823 ("~/News/agent.SCORE" "~/News/agent.group.SCORE")
18824 @end lisp
18825
18826 @item
18827 Group Parameter specification
18828
18829 @lisp
18830 (agent-score "~/News/agent.SCORE")
18831 @end lisp
18832
18833 Additional score files can be specified as above. Need I say anything
18834 about parenthesis?
18835 @end itemize
18836
18837 @item
18838 Use @code{normal} score files
18839
18840 If you don't want to maintain two sets of scoring rules for a group, and
18841 your desired @code{downloading} criteria for a group are the same as your
18842 @code{reading} criteria then you can tell the agent to refer to your
18843 @code{normal} score files when deciding what to download.
18844
18845 These directives in either the category definition or a group's
18846 parameters will cause the agent to read in all the applicable score
18847 files for a group, @emph{filtering out} those sections that do not
18848 relate to one of the permitted subset of scoring keywords.
18849
18850 @itemize @bullet
18851 @item
18852 Category Specification
18853
18854 @lisp
18855 file
18856 @end lisp
18857
18858 @item
18859 Group Parameter specification
18860
18861 @lisp
18862 (agent-score . file)
18863 @end lisp
18864 @end itemize
18865 @end enumerate
18866
18867 @node Category Buffer
18868 @subsubsection Category Buffer
18869
18870 You'd normally do all category maintenance from the category buffer.
18871 When you enter it for the first time (with the @kbd{J c} command from
18872 the group buffer), you'll only see the @code{default} category.
18873
18874 The following commands are available in this buffer:
18875
18876 @table @kbd
18877 @item q
18878 @kindex q (Category)
18879 @findex gnus-category-exit
18880 Return to the group buffer (@code{gnus-category-exit}).
18881
18882 @item e
18883 @kindex e (Category)
18884 @findex gnus-category-customize-category
18885 Use a customization buffer to set all of the selected category's
18886 parameters at one time (@code{gnus-category-customize-category}).
18887
18888 @item k
18889 @kindex k (Category)
18890 @findex gnus-category-kill
18891 Kill the current category (@code{gnus-category-kill}).
18892
18893 @item c
18894 @kindex c (Category)
18895 @findex gnus-category-copy
18896 Copy the current category (@code{gnus-category-copy}).
18897
18898 @item a
18899 @kindex a (Category)
18900 @findex gnus-category-add
18901 Add a new category (@code{gnus-category-add}).
18902
18903 @item p
18904 @kindex p (Category)
18905 @findex gnus-category-edit-predicate
18906 Edit the predicate of the current category
18907 (@code{gnus-category-edit-predicate}).
18908
18909 @item g
18910 @kindex g (Category)
18911 @findex gnus-category-edit-groups
18912 Edit the list of groups belonging to the current category
18913 (@code{gnus-category-edit-groups}).
18914
18915 @item s
18916 @kindex s (Category)
18917 @findex gnus-category-edit-score
18918 Edit the download score rule of the current category
18919 (@code{gnus-category-edit-score}).
18920
18921 @item l
18922 @kindex l (Category)
18923 @findex gnus-category-list
18924 List all the categories (@code{gnus-category-list}).
18925 @end table
18926
18927
18928 @node Category Variables
18929 @subsubsection Category Variables
18930
18931 @table @code
18932 @item gnus-category-mode-hook
18933 @vindex gnus-category-mode-hook
18934 Hook run in category buffers.
18935
18936 @item gnus-category-line-format
18937 @vindex gnus-category-line-format
18938 Format of the lines in the category buffer (@pxref{Formatting
18939 Variables}). Valid elements are:
18940
18941 @table @samp
18942 @item c
18943 The name of the category.
18944
18945 @item g
18946 The number of groups in the category.
18947 @end table
18948
18949 @item gnus-category-mode-line-format
18950 @vindex gnus-category-mode-line-format
18951 Format of the category mode line (@pxref{Mode Line Formatting}).
18952
18953 @item gnus-agent-short-article
18954 @vindex gnus-agent-short-article
18955 Articles that have fewer lines than this are short. Default 100.
18956
18957 @item gnus-agent-long-article
18958 @vindex gnus-agent-long-article
18959 Articles that have more lines than this are long. Default 200.
18960
18961 @item gnus-agent-low-score
18962 @vindex gnus-agent-low-score
18963 Articles that have a score lower than this have a low score. Default
18964 0.
18965
18966 @item gnus-agent-high-score
18967 @vindex gnus-agent-high-score
18968 Articles that have a score higher than this have a high score. Default
18969 0.
18970
18971 @item gnus-agent-expire-days
18972 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
18973 The number of days that a @samp{read} article must stay in the agent's
18974 local disk before becoming eligible for expiration (While the name is
18975 the same, this doesn't mean expiring the article on the server. It
18976 just means deleting the local copy of the article). What is also
18977 important to understand is that the counter starts with the time the
18978 article was written to the local disk and not the time the article was
18979 read.
18980 Default 7.
18981
18982 @item gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18983 @vindex gnus-agent-enable-expiration
18984 Determines whether articles in a group are, by default, expired or
18985 retained indefinitely. The default is @code{ENABLE} which means that
18986 you'll have to disable expiration when desired. On the other hand,
18987 you could set this to @code{DISABLE}. In that case, you would then
18988 have to enable expiration in selected groups.
18989
18990 @end table
18991
18992
18993 @node Agent Commands
18994 @subsection Agent Commands
18995 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-plugged
18996 @kindex J j (Agent)
18997
18998 All the Gnus Agent commands are on the @kbd{J} submap. The @kbd{J j}
18999 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-plugged}) command works in all modes, and
19000 toggles the plugged/unplugged state of the Gnus Agent.
19001
19002
19003 @menu
19004 * Group Agent Commands:: Configure groups and fetch their contents.
19005 * Summary Agent Commands:: Manually select then fetch specific articles.
19006 * Server Agent Commands:: Select the servers that are supported by the agent.
19007 @end menu
19008
19009
19010
19011
19012 @node Group Agent Commands
19013 @subsubsection Group Agent Commands
19014
19015 @table @kbd
19016 @item J u
19017 @kindex J u (Agent Group)
19018 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-groups
19019 Fetch all eligible articles in the current group
19020 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-groups}).
19021
19022 @item J c
19023 @kindex J c (Agent Group)
19024 @findex gnus-enter-category-buffer
19025 Enter the Agent category buffer (@code{gnus-enter-category-buffer}).
19026
19027 @item J s
19028 @kindex J s (Agent Group)
19029 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-session
19030 Fetch all eligible articles in all groups
19031 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-session}).
19032
19033 @item J S
19034 @kindex J S (Agent Group)
19035 @findex gnus-group-send-queue
19036 Send all sendable messages in the queue group
19037 (@code{gnus-group-send-queue}). @xref{Drafts}.
19038
19039 @item J a
19040 @kindex J a (Agent Group)
19041 @findex gnus-agent-add-group
19042 Add the current group to an Agent category
19043 (@code{gnus-agent-add-group}). This command understands the
19044 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19045
19046 @item J r
19047 @kindex J r (Agent Group)
19048 @findex gnus-agent-remove-group
19049 Remove the current group from its category, if any
19050 (@code{gnus-agent-remove-group}). This command understands the
19051 process/prefix convention (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
19052
19053 @item J Y
19054 @kindex J Y (Agent Group)
19055 @findex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19056 Synchronize flags changed while unplugged with remote server, if any.
19057
19058
19059 @end table
19060
19061
19062 @node Summary Agent Commands
19063 @subsubsection Summary Agent Commands
19064
19065 @table @kbd
19066 @item J #
19067 @kindex J # (Agent Summary)
19068 @findex gnus-agent-mark-article
19069 Mark the article for downloading (@code{gnus-agent-mark-article}).
19070
19071 @item J M-#
19072 @kindex J M-# (Agent Summary)
19073 @findex gnus-agent-unmark-article
19074 Remove the downloading mark from the article
19075 (@code{gnus-agent-unmark-article}).
19076
19077 @cindex %
19078 @item @@
19079 @kindex @@ (Agent Summary)
19080 @findex gnus-agent-toggle-mark
19081 Toggle whether to download the article
19082 (@code{gnus-agent-toggle-mark}). The download mark is @samp{%} by
19083 default.
19084
19085 @item J c
19086 @kindex J c (Agent Summary)
19087 @findex gnus-agent-catchup
19088 Mark all articles as read (@code{gnus-agent-catchup}) that are neither cached, downloaded, nor downloadable.
19089
19090 @item J S
19091 @kindex J S (Agent Summary)
19092 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-group
19093 Download all eligible (@pxref{Agent Categories}) articles in this group.
19094 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-group}).
19095
19096 @item J s
19097 @kindex J s (Agent Summary)
19098 @findex gnus-agent-fetch-series
19099 Download all processable articles in this group.
19100 (@code{gnus-agent-fetch-series}).
19101
19102 @item J u
19103 @kindex J u (Agent Summary)
19104 @findex gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group
19105 Download all downloadable articles in the current group
19106 (@code{gnus-agent-summary-fetch-group}).
19107
19108 @end table
19109
19110
19111 @node Server Agent Commands
19112 @subsubsection Server Agent Commands
19113
19114 @table @kbd
19115 @item J a
19116 @kindex J a (Agent Server)
19117 @findex gnus-agent-add-server
19118 Add the current server to the list of servers covered by the Gnus Agent
19119 (@code{gnus-agent-add-server}).
19120
19121 @item J r
19122 @kindex J r (Agent Server)
19123 @findex gnus-agent-remove-server
19124 Remove the current server from the list of servers covered by the Gnus
19125 Agent (@code{gnus-agent-remove-server}).
19126
19127 @end table
19128
19129
19130 @node Agent Visuals
19131 @subsection Agent Visuals
19132
19133 If you open a summary while unplugged and, Gnus knows from the group's
19134 active range that there are more articles than the headers currently
19135 stored in the Agent, you may see some articles whose subject looks
19136 something like @samp{[Undownloaded article #####]}. These are
19137 placeholders for the missing headers. Aside from setting a mark,
19138 there is not much that can be done with one of these placeholders.
19139 When Gnus finally gets a chance to fetch the group's headers, the
19140 placeholders will automatically be replaced by the actual headers.
19141 You can configure the summary buffer's maneuvering to skip over the
19142 placeholders if you care (See @code{gnus-auto-goto-ignores}).
19143
19144 While it may be obvious to all, the only headers and articles
19145 available while unplugged are those headers and articles that were
19146 fetched into the Agent while previously plugged. To put it another
19147 way, ``If you forget to fetch something while plugged, you might have a
19148 less than satisfying unplugged session''. For this reason, the Agent
19149 adds two visual effects to your summary buffer. These effects display
19150 the download status of each article so that you always know which
19151 articles will be available when unplugged.
19152
19153 The first visual effect is the @samp{%O} spec. If you customize
19154 @code{gnus-summary-line-format} to include this specifier, you will add
19155 a single character field that indicates an article's download status.
19156 Articles that have been fetched into either the Agent or the Cache,
19157 will display @code{gnus-downloaded-mark} (defaults to @samp{+}). All
19158 other articles will display @code{gnus-undownloaded-mark} (defaults to
19159 @samp{-}). If you open a group that has not been agentized, a space
19160 (@samp{ }) will be displayed.
19161
19162 The second visual effect are the undownloaded faces. The faces, there
19163 are three indicating the article's score (low, normal, high), seem to
19164 result in a love/hate response from many Gnus users. The problem is
19165 that the face selection is controlled by a list of condition tests and
19166 face names (See @code{gnus-summary-highlight}). Each condition is
19167 tested in the order in which it appears in the list so early
19168 conditions have precedence over later conditions. All of this means
19169 that, if you tick an undownloaded article, the article will continue
19170 to be displayed in the undownloaded face rather than the ticked face.
19171
19172 If you use the Agent as a cache (to avoid downloading the same article
19173 each time you visit it or to minimize your connection time), the
19174 undownloaded face will probably seem like a good idea. The reason
19175 being that you do all of our work (marking, reading, deleting) with
19176 downloaded articles so the normal faces always appear.
19177
19178 For occasional Agent users, the undownloaded faces may appear to be an
19179 absolutely horrible idea. The issue being that, since most of their
19180 articles have not been fetched into the Agent, most of the normal
19181 faces will be obscured by the undownloaded faces. If this is your
19182 situation, you have two choices available. First, you can completely
19183 disable the undownload faces by customizing
19184 @code{gnus-summary-highlight} to delete the three cons-cells that
19185 refer to the @code{gnus-summary-*-undownloaded-face} faces. Second,
19186 if you prefer to take a more fine-grained approach, you may set the
19187 @code{agent-disable-undownloaded-faces} group parameter to @code{t}.
19188 This parameter, like all other agent parameters, may be set on an
19189 Agent Category (@pxref{Agent Categories}), a Group Topic (@pxref{Topic
19190 Parameters}), or an individual group (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
19191
19192 @node Agent as Cache
19193 @subsection Agent as Cache
19194
19195 When Gnus is plugged, it is not efficient to download headers or
19196 articles from the server again, if they are already stored in the
19197 Agent. So, Gnus normally only downloads headers once, and stores them
19198 in the Agent. These headers are later used when generating the summary
19199 buffer, regardless of whether you are plugged or unplugged. Articles
19200 are not cached in the Agent by default though (that would potentially
19201 consume lots of disk space), but if you have already downloaded an
19202 article into the Agent, Gnus will not download the article from the
19203 server again but use the locally stored copy instead.
19204
19205 If you so desire, you can configure the agent (see @code{gnus-agent-cache}
19206 @pxref{Agent Variables}) to always download headers and articles while
19207 plugged. Gnus will almost certainly be slower, but it will be kept
19208 synchronized with the server. That last point probably won't make any
19209 sense if you are using a nntp or nnimap back end.
19210
19211 @node Agent Expiry
19212 @subsection Agent Expiry
19213
19214 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-days
19215 @findex gnus-agent-expire
19216 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire
19217 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-expire-group
19218 @findex gnus-agent-expire-group
19219 @cindex agent expiry
19220 @cindex Gnus agent expiry
19221 @cindex expiry, in Gnus agent
19222
19223 The Agent back end, @code{nnagent}, doesn't handle expiry. Well, at
19224 least it doesn't handle it like other back ends. Instead, there are
19225 special @code{gnus-agent-expire} and @code{gnus-agent-expire-group}
19226 commands that will expire all read articles that are older than
19227 @code{gnus-agent-expire-days} days. They can be run whenever you feel
19228 that you're running out of space. Neither are particularly fast or
19229 efficient, and it's not a particularly good idea to interrupt them (with
19230 @kbd{C-g} or anything else) once you've started one of them.
19231
19232 Note that other functions, e.g. @code{gnus-request-expire-articles},
19233 might run @code{gnus-agent-expire} for you to keep the agent
19234 synchronized with the group.
19235
19236 The agent parameter @code{agent-enable-expiration} may be used to
19237 prevent expiration in selected groups.
19238
19239 @vindex gnus-agent-expire-all
19240 If @code{gnus-agent-expire-all} is non-@code{nil}, the agent
19241 expiration commands will expire all articles---unread, read, ticked
19242 and dormant. If @code{nil} (which is the default), only read articles
19243 are eligible for expiry, and unread, ticked and dormant articles will
19244 be kept indefinitely.
19245
19246 If you find that some articles eligible for expiry are never expired,
19247 perhaps some Gnus Agent files are corrupted. There's are special
19248 commands, @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} and
19249 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group}, to fix possible problems.
19250
19251 @node Agent Regeneration
19252 @subsection Agent Regeneration
19253
19254 @cindex agent regeneration
19255 @cindex Gnus agent regeneration
19256 @cindex regeneration
19257
19258 The local data structures used by @code{nnagent} may become corrupted
19259 due to certain exceptional conditions. When this happens,
19260 @code{nnagent} functionality may degrade or even fail. The solution
19261 to this problem is to repair the local data structures by removing all
19262 internal inconsistencies.
19263
19264 For example, if your connection to your server is lost while
19265 downloaded articles into the agent, the local data structures will not
19266 know about articles successfully downloaded prior to the connection
19267 failure. Running @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} or
19268 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} will update the data structures
19269 such that you don't need to download these articles a second time.
19270
19271 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate
19272 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate
19273 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} will perform
19274 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} on every agentized group. While
19275 you can run @code{gnus-agent-regenerate} in any buffer, it is strongly
19276 recommended that you first close all summary buffers.
19277
19278 @findex gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19279 @kindex M-x gnus-agent-regenerate-group
19280 The command @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} uses the local copies
19281 of individual articles to repair the local @acronym{NOV}(header) database. It
19282 then updates the internal data structures that document which articles
19283 are stored locally. An optional argument will mark articles in the
19284 agent as unread.
19285
19286 @node Agent and IMAP
19287 @subsection Agent and IMAP
19288
19289 The Agent works with any Gnus back end, including nnimap. However,
19290 since there are some conceptual differences between @acronym{NNTP} and
19291 @acronym{IMAP}, this section (should) provide you with some information to
19292 make Gnus Agent work smoother as a @acronym{IMAP} Disconnected Mode client.
19293
19294 The first thing to keep in mind is that all flags (read, ticked, etc)
19295 are kept on the @acronym{IMAP} server, rather than in @file{.newsrc} as is the
19296 case for nntp. Thus Gnus need to remember flag changes when
19297 disconnected, and synchronize these flags when you plug back in.
19298
19299 Gnus keeps track of flag changes when reading nnimap groups under the
19300 Agent. When you plug back in, Gnus will check if you have any changed
19301 any flags and ask if you wish to synchronize these with the server.
19302 The behavior is customizable by @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags}.
19303
19304 @vindex gnus-agent-synchronize-flags
19305 If @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} is @code{nil}, the Agent will
19306 never automatically synchronize flags. If it is @code{ask}, which is
19307 the default, the Agent will check if you made any changes and if so
19308 ask if you wish to synchronize these when you re-connect. If it has
19309 any other value, all flags will be synchronized automatically.
19310
19311 If you do not wish to synchronize flags automatically when you
19312 re-connect, you can do it manually with the
19313 @code{gnus-agent-synchronize-flags} command that is bound to @kbd{J Y}
19314 in the group buffer.
19315
19316 Some things are currently not implemented in the Agent that you'd might
19317 expect from a disconnected @acronym{IMAP} client, including:
19318
19319 @itemize @bullet
19320
19321 @item
19322 Copying/moving articles into nnimap groups when unplugged.
19323
19324 @item
19325 Creating/deleting nnimap groups when unplugged.
19326
19327 @end itemize
19328
19329 Technical note: the synchronization algorithm does not work by ``pushing''
19330 all local flags to the server, but rather incrementally update the
19331 server view of flags by changing only those flags that were changed by
19332 the user. Thus, if you set one flag on an article, quit the group and
19333 re-select the group and remove the flag; the flag will be set and
19334 removed from the server when you ``synchronize''. The queued flag
19335 operations can be found in the per-server @code{flags} file in the Agent
19336 directory. It's emptied when you synchronize flags.
19337
19338
19339 @node Outgoing Messages
19340 @subsection Outgoing Messages
19341
19342 When Gnus is unplugged, all outgoing messages (both mail and news) are
19343 stored in the draft group ``queue'' (@pxref{Drafts}). You can view
19344 them there after posting, and edit them at will.
19345
19346 When Gnus is plugged again, you can send the messages either from the
19347 draft group with the special commands available there, or you can use
19348 the @kbd{J S} command in the group buffer to send all the sendable
19349 messages in the draft group.
19350
19351
19352
19353 @node Agent Variables
19354 @subsection Agent Variables
19355
19356 @table @code
19357 @item gnus-agent-directory
19358 @vindex gnus-agent-directory
19359 Where the Gnus Agent will store its files. The default is
19360 @file{~/News/agent/}.
19361
19362 @item gnus-agent-handle-level
19363 @vindex gnus-agent-handle-level
19364 Groups on levels (@pxref{Group Levels}) higher than this variable will
19365 be ignored by the Agent. The default is @code{gnus-level-subscribed},
19366 which means that only subscribed group will be considered by the Agent
19367 by default.
19368
19369 @item gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19370 @vindex gnus-agent-plugged-hook
19371 Hook run when connecting to the network.
19372
19373 @item gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19374 @vindex gnus-agent-unplugged-hook
19375 Hook run when disconnecting from the network.
19376
19377 @item gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19378 @vindex gnus-agent-fetched-hook
19379 Hook run when finished fetching articles.
19380
19381 @item gnus-agent-cache
19382 @vindex gnus-agent-cache
19383 Variable to control whether use the locally stored @acronym{NOV} and
19384 articles when plugged, e.g. essentially using the Agent as a cache.
19385 The default is non-@code{nil}, which means to use the Agent as a cache.
19386
19387 @item gnus-agent-go-online
19388 @vindex gnus-agent-go-online
19389 If @code{gnus-agent-go-online} is @code{nil}, the Agent will never
19390 automatically switch offline servers into online status. If it is
19391 @code{ask}, the default, the Agent will ask if you wish to switch
19392 offline servers into online status when you re-connect. If it has any
19393 other value, all offline servers will be automatically switched into
19394 online status.
19395
19396 @item gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19397 @vindex gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded
19398 If @code{gnus-agent-mark-unread-after-downloaded} is non-@code{nil},
19399 mark articles as unread after downloading. This is usually a safe
19400 thing to do as the newly downloaded article has obviously not been
19401 read. The default is @code{t}.
19402
19403 @item gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19404 @vindex gnus-agent-consider-all-articles
19405 If @code{gnus-agent-consider-all-articles} is non-@code{nil}, the
19406 agent will let the agent predicate decide whether articles need to be
19407 downloaded or not, for all articles. When @code{nil}, the default,
19408 the agent will only let the predicate decide whether unread articles
19409 are downloaded or not. If you enable this, you may also want to look
19410 into the agent expiry settings (@pxref{Category Variables}), so that
19411 the agent doesn't download articles which the agent will later expire,
19412 over and over again.
19413
19414 @item gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19415 @vindex gnus-agent-max-fetch-size
19416 The agent fetches articles into a temporary buffer prior to parsing
19417 them into individual files. To avoid exceeding the max. buffer size,
19418 the agent alternates between fetching and parsing until all articles
19419 have been fetched. @code{gnus-agent-max-fetch-size} provides a size
19420 limit to control how often the cycling occurs. A large value improves
19421 performance. A small value minimizes the time lost should the
19422 connection be lost while fetching (You may need to run
19423 @code{gnus-agent-regenerate-group} to update the group's state.
19424 However, all articles parsed prior to loosing the connection will be
19425 available while unplugged). The default is 10M so it is unusual to
19426 see any cycling.
19427
19428 @item gnus-server-unopen-status
19429 @vindex gnus-server-unopen-status
19430 Perhaps not an Agent variable, but closely related to the Agent, this
19431 variable says what will happen if Gnus cannot open a server. If the
19432 Agent is enabled, the default, @code{nil}, makes Gnus ask the user
19433 whether to deny the server or whether to unplug the agent. If the
19434 Agent is disabled, Gnus always simply deny the server. Other choices
19435 for this variable include @code{denied} and @code{offline} the latter
19436 is only valid if the Agent is used.
19437
19438 @item gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19439 @vindex gnus-auto-goto-ignores
19440 Another variable that isn't an Agent variable, yet so closely related
19441 that most will look for it here, this variable tells the summary
19442 buffer how to maneuver around undownloaded (only headers stored in the
19443 agent) and unfetched (neither article nor headers stored) articles.
19444
19445 The valid values are @code{nil} (maneuver to any article),
19446 @code{undownloaded} (maneuvering while unplugged ignores articles that
19447 have not been fetched), @code{always-undownloaded} (maneuvering always
19448 ignores articles that have not been fetched), @code{unfetched}
19449 (maneuvering ignores articles whose headers have not been fetched).
19450
19451 @item gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19452 @vindex gnus-agent-auto-agentize-methods
19453 If you have never used the Agent before (or more technically, if
19454 @file{~/News/agent/lib/servers} does not exist), Gnus will
19455 automatically agentize a few servers for you. This variable control
19456 which backends should be auto-agentized. It is typically only useful
19457 to agentize remote backends. The auto-agentizing has the same effect
19458 as running @kbd{J a} on the servers (@pxref{Server Agent Commands}).
19459 If the file exist, you must manage the servers manually by adding or
19460 removing them, this variable is only applicable the first time you
19461 start Gnus. The default is @samp{(nntp nnimap)}.
19462
19463 @end table
19464
19465
19466 @node Example Setup
19467 @subsection Example Setup
19468
19469 If you don't want to read this manual, and you have a fairly standard
19470 setup, you may be able to use something like the following as your
19471 @file{~/.gnus.el} file to get started.
19472
19473 @lisp
19474 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to fetch news. We do this over @acronym{NNTP}}
19475 ;; @r{from your ISP's server.}
19476 (setq gnus-select-method '(nntp "news.your-isp.com"))
19477
19478 ;; @r{Define how Gnus is to read your mail. We read mail from}
19479 ;; @r{your ISP's @acronym{POP} server.}
19480 (setq mail-sources '((pop :server "pop.your-isp.com")))
19481
19482 ;; @r{Say how Gnus is to store the mail. We use nnml groups.}
19483 (setq gnus-secondary-select-methods '((nnml "")))
19484
19485 ;; @r{Make Gnus into an offline newsreader.}
19486 ;; (gnus-agentize) ; @r{The obsolete setting.}
19487 ;; (setq gnus-agent t) ; @r{Now the default.}
19488 @end lisp
19489
19490 That should be it, basically. Put that in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file,
19491 edit to suit your needs, start up PPP (or whatever), and type @kbd{M-x
19492 gnus}.
19493
19494 If this is the first time you've run Gnus, you will be subscribed
19495 automatically to a few default newsgroups. You'll probably want to
19496 subscribe to more groups, and to do that, you have to query the
19497 @acronym{NNTP} server for a complete list of groups with the @kbd{A A}
19498 command. This usually takes quite a while, but you only have to do it
19499 once.
19500
19501 After reading and parsing a while, you'll be presented with a list of
19502 groups. Subscribe to the ones you want to read with the @kbd{u}
19503 command. @kbd{l} to make all the killed groups disappear after you've
19504 subscribe to all the groups you want to read. (@kbd{A k} will bring
19505 back all the killed groups.)
19506
19507 You can now read the groups at once, or you can download the articles
19508 with the @kbd{J s} command. And then read the rest of this manual to
19509 find out which of the other gazillion things you want to customize.
19510
19511
19512 @node Batching Agents
19513 @subsection Batching Agents
19514 @findex gnus-agent-batch
19515
19516 Having the Gnus Agent fetch articles (and post whatever messages you've
19517 written) is quite easy once you've gotten things set up properly. The
19518 following shell script will do everything that is necessary:
19519
19520 You can run a complete batch command from the command line with the
19521 following incantation:
19522
19523 @example
19524 #!/bin/sh
19525 emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-agent-batch >/dev/null 2>&1
19526 @end example
19527
19528
19529 @node Agent Caveats
19530 @subsection Agent Caveats
19531
19532 The Gnus Agent doesn't seem to work like most other offline
19533 newsreaders. Here are some common questions that some imaginary people
19534 may ask:
19535
19536 @table @dfn
19537 @item If I read an article while plugged, do they get entered into the Agent?
19538
19539 @strong{No}. If you want this behavior, add
19540 @code{gnus-agent-fetch-selected-article} to
19541 @code{gnus-select-article-hook}.
19542
19543 @item If I read an article while plugged, and the article already exists in
19544 the Agent, will it get downloaded once more?
19545
19546 @strong{No}, unless @code{gnus-agent-cache} is @code{nil}.
19547
19548 @end table
19549
19550 In short, when Gnus is unplugged, it only looks into the locally stored
19551 articles; when it's plugged, it talks to your ISP and may also use the
19552 locally stored articles.
19553
19554
19555 @node Scoring
19556 @chapter Scoring
19557 @cindex scoring
19558
19559 Other people use @dfn{kill files}, but we here at Gnus Towers like
19560 scoring better than killing, so we'd rather switch than fight. They do
19561 something completely different as well, so sit up straight and pay
19562 attention!
19563
19564 @vindex gnus-summary-mark-below
19565 All articles have a default score (@code{gnus-summary-default-score}),
19566 which is 0 by default. This score may be raised or lowered either
19567 interactively or by score files. Articles that have a score lower than
19568 @code{gnus-summary-mark-below} are marked as read.
19569
19570 Gnus will read any @dfn{score files} that apply to the current group
19571 before generating the summary buffer.
19572
19573 There are several commands in the summary buffer that insert score
19574 entries based on the current article. You can, for instance, ask Gnus to
19575 lower or increase the score of all articles with a certain subject.
19576
19577 There are two sorts of scoring entries: Permanent and temporary.
19578 Temporary score entries are self-expiring entries. Any entries that are
19579 temporary and have not been used for, say, a week, will be removed
19580 silently to help keep the sizes of the score files down.
19581
19582 @menu
19583 * Summary Score Commands:: Adding score entries for the current group.
19584 * Group Score Commands:: General score commands.
19585 * Score Variables:: Customize your scoring. (My, what terminology).
19586 * Score File Format:: What a score file may contain.
19587 * Score File Editing:: You can edit score files by hand as well.
19588 * Adaptive Scoring:: Big Sister Gnus knows what you read.
19589 * Home Score File:: How to say where new score entries are to go.
19590 * Followups To Yourself:: Having Gnus notice when people answer you.
19591 * Scoring On Other Headers:: Scoring on non-standard headers.
19592 * Scoring Tips:: How to score effectively.
19593 * Reverse Scoring:: That problem child of old is not problem.
19594 * Global Score Files:: Earth-spanning, ear-splitting score files.
19595 * Kill Files:: They are still here, but they can be ignored.
19596 * Converting Kill Files:: Translating kill files to score files.
19597 * GroupLens:: Getting predictions on what you like to read.
19598 * Advanced Scoring:: Using logical expressions to build score rules.
19599 * Score Decays:: It can be useful to let scores wither away.
19600 @end menu
19601
19602
19603 @node Summary Score Commands
19604 @section Summary Score Commands
19605 @cindex score commands
19606
19607 The score commands that alter score entries do not actually modify real
19608 score files. That would be too inefficient. Gnus maintains a cache of
19609 previously loaded score files, one of which is considered the
19610 @dfn{current score file alist}. The score commands simply insert
19611 entries into this list, and upon group exit, this list is saved.
19612
19613 The current score file is by default the group's local score file, even
19614 if no such score file actually exists. To insert score commands into
19615 some other score file (e.g. @file{all.SCORE}), you must first make this
19616 score file the current one.
19617
19618 General score commands that don't actually change the score file:
19619
19620 @table @kbd
19621
19622 @item V s
19623 @kindex V s (Summary)
19624 @findex gnus-summary-set-score
19625 Set the score of the current article (@code{gnus-summary-set-score}).
19626
19627 @item V S
19628 @kindex V S (Summary)
19629 @findex gnus-summary-current-score
19630 Display the score of the current article
19631 (@code{gnus-summary-current-score}).
19632
19633 @item V t
19634 @kindex V t (Summary)
19635 @findex gnus-score-find-trace
19636 Display all score rules that have been used on the current article
19637 (@code{gnus-score-find-trace}). In the @code{*Score Trace*} buffer, you
19638 may type @kbd{e} to edit score file corresponding to the score rule on
19639 current line and @kbd{f} to format (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) the
19640 score file and edit it.
19641
19642 @item V w
19643 @kindex V w (Summary)
19644 @findex gnus-score-find-favourite-words
19645 List words used in scoring (@code{gnus-score-find-favourite-words}).
19646
19647 @item V R
19648 @kindex V R (Summary)
19649 @findex gnus-summary-rescore
19650 Run the current summary through the scoring process
19651 (@code{gnus-summary-rescore}). This might be useful if you're playing
19652 around with your score files behind Gnus' back and want to see the
19653 effect you're having.
19654
19655 @item V c
19656 @kindex V c (Summary)
19657 @findex gnus-score-change-score-file
19658 Make a different score file the current
19659 (@code{gnus-score-change-score-file}).
19660
19661 @item V e
19662 @kindex V e (Summary)
19663 @findex gnus-score-edit-current-scores
19664 Edit the current score file (@code{gnus-score-edit-current-scores}).
19665 You will be popped into a @code{gnus-score-mode} buffer (@pxref{Score
19666 File Editing}).
19667
19668 @item V f
19669 @kindex V f (Summary)
19670 @findex gnus-score-edit-file
19671 Edit a score file and make this score file the current one
19672 (@code{gnus-score-edit-file}).
19673
19674 @item V F
19675 @kindex V F (Summary)
19676 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19677 Flush the score cache (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}). This is useful
19678 after editing score files.
19679
19680 @item V C
19681 @kindex V C (Summary)
19682 @findex gnus-score-customize
19683 Customize a score file in a visually pleasing manner
19684 (@code{gnus-score-customize}).
19685
19686 @end table
19687
19688 The rest of these commands modify the local score file.
19689
19690 @table @kbd
19691
19692 @item V m
19693 @kindex V m (Summary)
19694 @findex gnus-score-set-mark-below
19695 Prompt for a score, and mark all articles with a score below this as
19696 read (@code{gnus-score-set-mark-below}).
19697
19698 @item V x
19699 @kindex V x (Summary)
19700 @findex gnus-score-set-expunge-below
19701 Prompt for a score, and add a score rule to the current score file to
19702 expunge all articles below this score
19703 (@code{gnus-score-set-expunge-below}).
19704 @end table
19705
19706 The keystrokes for actually making score entries follow a very regular
19707 pattern, so there's no need to list all the commands. (Hundreds of
19708 them.)
19709
19710 @findex gnus-summary-increase-score
19711 @findex gnus-summary-lower-score
19712
19713 @enumerate
19714 @item
19715 The first key is either @kbd{I} (upper case i) for increasing the score
19716 or @kbd{L} for lowering the score.
19717 @item
19718 The second key says what header you want to score on. The following
19719 keys are available:
19720 @table @kbd
19721
19722 @item a
19723 Score on the author name.
19724
19725 @item s
19726 Score on the subject line.
19727
19728 @item x
19729 Score on the @code{Xref} line---i.e., the cross-posting line.
19730
19731 @item r
19732 Score on the @code{References} line.
19733
19734 @item d
19735 Score on the date.
19736
19737 @item l
19738 Score on the number of lines.
19739
19740 @item i
19741 Score on the @code{Message-ID} header.
19742
19743 @item e
19744 Score on an ``extra'' header, that is, one of those in gnus-extra-headers,
19745 if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks additional header data in overviews.
19746
19747 @item f
19748 Score on followups---this matches the author name, and adds scores to
19749 the followups to this author. (Using this key leads to the creation of
19750 @file{ADAPT} files.)
19751
19752 @item b
19753 Score on the body.
19754
19755 @item h
19756 Score on the head.
19757
19758 @item t
19759 Score on thread. (Using this key leads to the creation of @file{ADAPT}
19760 files.)
19761
19762 @end table
19763
19764 @item
19765 The third key is the match type. Which match types are valid depends on
19766 what headers you are scoring on.
19767
19768 @table @code
19769
19770 @item strings
19771
19772 @table @kbd
19773
19774 @item e
19775 Exact matching.
19776
19777 @item s
19778 Substring matching.
19779
19780 @item f
19781 Fuzzy matching (@pxref{Fuzzy Matching}).
19782
19783 @item r
19784 Regexp matching
19785 @end table
19786
19787 @item date
19788 @table @kbd
19789
19790 @item b
19791 Before date.
19792
19793 @item a
19794 After date.
19795
19796 @item n
19797 This date.
19798 @end table
19799
19800 @item number
19801 @table @kbd
19802
19803 @item <
19804 Less than number.
19805
19806 @item =
19807 Equal to number.
19808
19809 @item >
19810 Greater than number.
19811 @end table
19812 @end table
19813
19814 @item
19815 The fourth and usually final key says whether this is a temporary (i.e.,
19816 expiring) score entry, or a permanent (i.e., non-expiring) score entry,
19817 or whether it is to be done immediately, without adding to the score
19818 file.
19819 @table @kbd
19820
19821 @item t
19822 Temporary score entry.
19823
19824 @item p
19825 Permanent score entry.
19826
19827 @item i
19828 Immediately scoring.
19829 @end table
19830
19831 @item
19832 If you are scoring on `e' (extra) headers, you will then be prompted for
19833 the header name on which you wish to score. This must be a header named
19834 in gnus-extra-headers, and @samp{TAB} completion is available.
19835
19836 @end enumerate
19837
19838 So, let's say you want to increase the score on the current author with
19839 exact matching permanently: @kbd{I a e p}. If you want to lower the
19840 score based on the subject line, using substring matching, and make a
19841 temporary score entry: @kbd{L s s t}. Pretty easy.
19842
19843 To make things a bit more complicated, there are shortcuts. If you use
19844 a capital letter on either the second or third keys, Gnus will use
19845 defaults for the remaining one or two keystrokes. The defaults are
19846 ``substring'' and ``temporary''. So @kbd{I A} is the same as @kbd{I a s
19847 t}, and @kbd{I a R} is the same as @kbd{I a r t}.
19848
19849 These functions take both the numerical prefix and the symbolic prefix
19850 (@pxref{Symbolic Prefixes}). A numerical prefix says how much to lower
19851 (or increase) the score of the article. A symbolic prefix of @code{a}
19852 says to use the @file{all.SCORE} file for the command instead of the
19853 current score file.
19854
19855 @vindex gnus-score-mimic-keymap
19856 The @code{gnus-score-mimic-keymap} says whether these commands will
19857 pretend they are keymaps or not.
19858
19859
19860 @node Group Score Commands
19861 @section Group Score Commands
19862 @cindex group score commands
19863
19864 There aren't many of these as yet, I'm afraid.
19865
19866 @table @kbd
19867
19868 @item W f
19869 @kindex W f (Group)
19870 @findex gnus-score-flush-cache
19871 Gnus maintains a cache of score alists to avoid having to reload them
19872 all the time. This command will flush the cache
19873 (@code{gnus-score-flush-cache}).
19874
19875 @end table
19876
19877 You can do scoring from the command line by saying something like:
19878
19879 @findex gnus-batch-score
19880 @cindex batch scoring
19881 @example
19882 $ emacs -batch -l ~/.emacs -l ~/.gnus.el -f gnus-batch-score
19883 @end example
19884
19885
19886 @node Score Variables
19887 @section Score Variables
19888 @cindex score variables
19889
19890 @table @code
19891
19892 @item gnus-use-scoring
19893 @vindex gnus-use-scoring
19894 If @code{nil}, Gnus will not check for score files, and will not, in
19895 general, do any score-related work. This is @code{t} by default.
19896
19897 @item gnus-kill-killed
19898 @vindex gnus-kill-killed
19899 If this variable is @code{nil}, Gnus will never apply score files to
19900 articles that have already been through the kill process. While this
19901 may save you lots of time, it also means that if you apply a kill file
19902 to a group, and then change the kill file and want to run it over you
19903 group again to kill more articles, it won't work. You have to set this
19904 variable to @code{t} to do that. (It is @code{t} by default.)
19905
19906 @item gnus-kill-files-directory
19907 @vindex gnus-kill-files-directory
19908 All kill and score files will be stored in this directory, which is
19909 initialized from the @env{SAVEDIR} environment variable by default.
19910 This is @file{~/News/} by default.
19911
19912 @item gnus-score-file-suffix
19913 @vindex gnus-score-file-suffix
19914 Suffix to add to the group name to arrive at the score file name
19915 (@file{SCORE} by default.)
19916
19917 @item gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19918 @vindex gnus-score-uncacheable-files
19919 @cindex score cache
19920 All score files are normally cached to avoid excessive re-loading of
19921 score files. However, this might make your Emacs grow big and
19922 bloated, so this regexp can be used to weed out score files unlikely
19923 to be needed again. It would be a bad idea to deny caching of
19924 @file{all.SCORE}, while it might be a good idea to not cache
19925 @file{comp.infosystems.www.authoring.misc.ADAPT}. In fact, this
19926 variable is @samp{ADAPT$} by default, so no adaptive score files will
19927 be cached.
19928
19929 @item gnus-save-score
19930 @vindex gnus-save-score
19931 If you have really complicated score files, and do lots of batch
19932 scoring, then you might set this variable to @code{t}. This will make
19933 Gnus save the scores into the @file{.newsrc.eld} file.
19934
19935 If you do not set this to @code{t}, then manual scores (like those set
19936 with @kbd{V s} (@code{gnus-summary-set-score})) will not be preserved
19937 across group visits.
19938
19939 @item gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19940 @vindex gnus-score-interactive-default-score
19941 Score used by all the interactive raise/lower commands to raise/lower
19942 score with. Default is 1000, which may seem excessive, but this is to
19943 ensure that the adaptive scoring scheme gets enough room to play with.
19944 We don't want the small changes from the adaptive scoring to overwrite
19945 manually entered data.
19946
19947 @item gnus-summary-default-score
19948 @vindex gnus-summary-default-score
19949 Default score of an article, which is 0 by default.
19950
19951 @item gnus-summary-expunge-below
19952 @vindex gnus-summary-expunge-below
19953 Don't display the summary lines of articles that have scores lower than
19954 this variable. This is @code{nil} by default, which means that no
19955 articles will be hidden. This variable is local to the summary buffers,
19956 and has to be set from @code{gnus-summary-mode-hook}.
19957
19958 @item gnus-score-over-mark
19959 @vindex gnus-score-over-mark
19960 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score over the
19961 default. Default is @samp{+}.
19962
19963 @item gnus-score-below-mark
19964 @vindex gnus-score-below-mark
19965 Mark (in the third column) used for articles with a score below the
19966 default. Default is @samp{-}.
19967
19968 @item gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19969 @vindex gnus-score-find-score-files-function
19970 Function used to find score files for the current group. This function
19971 is called with the name of the group as the argument.
19972
19973 Predefined functions available are:
19974 @table @code
19975
19976 @item gnus-score-find-single
19977 @findex gnus-score-find-single
19978 Only apply the group's own score file.
19979
19980 @item gnus-score-find-bnews
19981 @findex gnus-score-find-bnews
19982 Apply all score files that match, using bnews syntax. This is the
19983 default. If the current group is @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}, for instance,
19984 @file{all.emacs.all.SCORE}, @file{not.alt.all.SCORE} and
19985 @file{gnu.all.SCORE} would all apply. In short, the instances of
19986 @samp{all} in the score file names are translated into @samp{.*}, and
19987 then a regexp match is done.
19988
19989 This means that if you have some score entries that you want to apply to
19990 all groups, then you put those entries in the @file{all.SCORE} file.
19991
19992 The score files are applied in a semi-random order, although Gnus will
19993 try to apply the more general score files before the more specific score
19994 files. It does this by looking at the number of elements in the score
19995 file names---discarding the @samp{all} elements.
19996
19997 @item gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19998 @findex gnus-score-find-hierarchical
19999 Apply all score files from all the parent groups. This means that you
20000 can't have score files like @file{all.SCORE}, but you can have
20001 @file{SCORE}, @file{comp.SCORE} and @file{comp.emacs.SCORE} for each
20002 server.
20003
20004 @end table
20005 This variable can also be a list of functions. In that case, all
20006 these functions will be called with the group name as argument, and
20007 all the returned lists of score files will be applied. These
20008 functions can also return lists of lists of score alists directly. In
20009 that case, the functions that return these non-file score alists
20010 should probably be placed before the ``real'' score file functions, to
20011 ensure that the last score file returned is the local score file.
20012 Phu.
20013
20014 For example, to do hierarchical scoring but use a non-server-specific
20015 overall score file, you could use the value
20016 @example
20017 (list (lambda (group) ("all.SCORE"))
20018 'gnus-score-find-hierarchical)
20019 @end example
20020
20021 @item gnus-score-expiry-days
20022 @vindex gnus-score-expiry-days
20023 This variable says how many days should pass before an unused score file
20024 entry is expired. If this variable is @code{nil}, no score file entries
20025 are expired. It's 7 by default.
20026
20027 @item gnus-update-score-entry-dates
20028 @vindex gnus-update-score-entry-dates
20029 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, temporary score entries that have
20030 been triggered (matched) will have their dates updated. (This is how Gnus
20031 controls expiry---all non-matched-entries will become too old while
20032 matched entries will stay fresh and young.) However, if you set this
20033 variable to @code{nil}, even matched entries will grow old and will
20034 have to face that oh-so grim reaper.
20035
20036 @item gnus-score-after-write-file-function
20037 @vindex gnus-score-after-write-file-function
20038 Function called with the name of the score file just written.
20039
20040 @item gnus-score-thread-simplify
20041 @vindex gnus-score-thread-simplify
20042 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, article subjects will be
20043 simplified for subject scoring purposes in the same manner as with
20044 threading---according to the current value of
20045 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions}. If the scoring entry uses
20046 @code{substring} or @code{exact} matching, the match will also be
20047 simplified in this manner.
20048
20049 @end table
20050
20051
20052 @node Score File Format
20053 @section Score File Format
20054 @cindex score file format
20055
20056 A score file is an @code{emacs-lisp} file that normally contains just a
20057 single form. Casual users are not expected to edit these files;
20058 everything can be changed from the summary buffer.
20059
20060 Anyway, if you'd like to dig into it yourself, here's an example:
20061
20062 @lisp
20063 (("from"
20064 ("Lars Ingebrigtsen" -10000)
20065 ("Per Abrahamsen")
20066 ("larsi\\|lmi" -50000 nil R))
20067 ("subject"
20068 ("Ding is Badd" nil 728373))
20069 ("xref"
20070 ("alt.politics" -1000 728372 s))
20071 ("lines"
20072 (2 -100 nil <))
20073 (mark 0)
20074 (expunge -1000)
20075 (mark-and-expunge -10)
20076 (read-only nil)
20077 (orphan -10)
20078 (adapt t)
20079 (files "/hom/larsi/News/gnu.SCORE")
20080 (exclude-files "all.SCORE")
20081 (local (gnus-newsgroup-auto-expire t)
20082 (gnus-summary-make-false-root empty))
20083 (eval (ding)))
20084 @end lisp
20085
20086 This example demonstrates most score file elements. @xref{Advanced
20087 Scoring}, for a different approach.
20088
20089 Even though this looks much like Lisp code, nothing here is actually
20090 @code{eval}ed. The Lisp reader is used to read this form, though, so it
20091 has to be valid syntactically, if not semantically.
20092
20093 Six keys are supported by this alist:
20094
20095 @table @code
20096
20097 @item STRING
20098 If the key is a string, it is the name of the header to perform the
20099 match on. Scoring can only be performed on these eight headers:
20100 @code{From}, @code{Subject}, @code{References}, @code{Message-ID},
20101 @code{Xref}, @code{Lines}, @code{Chars} and @code{Date}. In addition to
20102 these headers, there are three strings to tell Gnus to fetch the entire
20103 article and do the match on larger parts of the article: @code{Body}
20104 will perform the match on the body of the article, @code{Head} will
20105 perform the match on the head of the article, and @code{All} will
20106 perform the match on the entire article. Note that using any of these
20107 last three keys will slow down group entry @emph{considerably}. The
20108 final ``header'' you can score on is @code{Followup}. These score
20109 entries will result in new score entries being added for all follow-ups
20110 to articles that matches these score entries.
20111
20112 Following this key is an arbitrary number of score entries, where each
20113 score entry has one to four elements.
20114 @enumerate
20115
20116 @item
20117 The first element is the @dfn{match element}. On most headers this will
20118 be a string, but on the Lines and Chars headers, this must be an
20119 integer.
20120
20121 @item
20122 If the second element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{score
20123 element}. This number should be an integer in the neginf to posinf
20124 interval. This number is added to the score of the article if the match
20125 is successful. If this element is not present, the
20126 @code{gnus-score-interactive-default-score} number will be used
20127 instead. This is 1000 by default.
20128
20129 @item
20130 If the third element is present, it should be a number---the @dfn{date
20131 element}. This date says when the last time this score entry matched,
20132 which provides a mechanism for expiring the score entries. It this
20133 element is not present, the score entry is permanent. The date is
20134 represented by the number of days since December 31, 1 BCE.
20135
20136 @item
20137 If the fourth element is present, it should be a symbol---the @dfn{type
20138 element}. This element specifies what function should be used to see
20139 whether this score entry matches the article. What match types that can
20140 be used depends on what header you wish to perform the match on.
20141 @table @dfn
20142
20143 @item From, Subject, References, Xref, Message-ID
20144 For most header types, there are the @code{r} and @code{R} (regexp), as
20145 well as @code{s} and @code{S} (substring) types, and @code{e} and
20146 @code{E} (exact match), and @code{w} (word match) types. If this
20147 element is not present, Gnus will assume that substring matching should
20148 be used. @code{R}, @code{S}, and @code{E} differ from the others in
20149 that the matches will be done in a case-sensitive manner. All these
20150 one-letter types are really just abbreviations for the @code{regexp},
20151 @code{string}, @code{exact}, and @code{word} types, which you can use
20152 instead, if you feel like.
20153
20154 @item Extra
20155 Just as for the standard string overview headers, if you are using
20156 gnus-extra-headers, you can score on these headers' values. In this
20157 case, there is a 5th element in the score entry, being the name of the
20158 header to be scored. The following entry is useful in your
20159 @file{all.SCORE} file in case of spam attacks from a single origin
20160 host, if your @acronym{NNTP} server tracks @samp{NNTP-Posting-Host} in
20161 overviews:
20162
20163 @lisp
20164 ("111.222.333.444" -1000 nil s
20165 "NNTP-Posting-Host")
20166 @end lisp
20167
20168 @item Lines, Chars
20169 These two headers use different match types: @code{<}, @code{>},
20170 @code{=}, @code{>=} and @code{<=}.
20171
20172 These predicates are true if
20173
20174 @example
20175 (PREDICATE HEADER MATCH)
20176 @end example
20177
20178 evaluates to non-@code{nil}. For instance, the advanced match
20179 @code{("lines" 4 <)} (@pxref{Advanced Scoring}) will result in the
20180 following form:
20181
20182 @lisp
20183 (< header-value 4)
20184 @end lisp
20185
20186 Or to put it another way: When using @code{<} on @code{Lines} with 4 as
20187 the match, we get the score added if the article has less than 4 lines.
20188 (It's easy to get confused and think it's the other way around. But
20189 it's not. I think.)
20190
20191 When matching on @code{Lines}, be careful because some back ends (like
20192 @code{nndir}) do not generate @code{Lines} header, so every article ends
20193 up being marked as having 0 lines. This can lead to strange results if
20194 you happen to lower score of the articles with few lines.
20195
20196 @item Date
20197 For the Date header we have three kinda silly match types:
20198 @code{before}, @code{at} and @code{after}. I can't really imagine this
20199 ever being useful, but, like, it would feel kinda silly not to provide
20200 this function. Just in case. You never know. Better safe than sorry.
20201 Once burnt, twice shy. Don't judge a book by its cover. Never not have
20202 sex on a first date. (I have been told that at least one person, and I
20203 quote, ``found this function indispensable'', however.)
20204
20205 @cindex ISO8601
20206 @cindex date
20207 A more useful match type is @code{regexp}. With it, you can match the
20208 date string using a regular expression. The date is normalized to
20209 ISO8601 compact format first---@var{YYYYMMDD}@code{T}@var{HHMMSS}. If
20210 you want to match all articles that have been posted on April 1st in
20211 every year, you could use @samp{....0401.........} as a match string,
20212 for instance. (Note that the date is kept in its original time zone, so
20213 this will match articles that were posted when it was April 1st where
20214 the article was posted from. Time zones are such wholesome fun for the
20215 whole family, eh?)
20216
20217 @item Head, Body, All
20218 These three match keys use the same match types as the @code{From} (etc)
20219 header uses.
20220
20221 @item Followup
20222 This match key is somewhat special, in that it will match the
20223 @code{From} header, and affect the score of not only the matching
20224 articles, but also all followups to the matching articles. This allows
20225 you e.g. increase the score of followups to your own articles, or
20226 decrease the score of followups to the articles of some known
20227 trouble-maker. Uses the same match types as the @code{From} header
20228 uses. (Using this match key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT}
20229 files.)
20230
20231 @item Thread
20232 This match key works along the same lines as the @code{Followup} match
20233 key. If you say that you want to score on a (sub-)thread started by an
20234 article with a @code{Message-ID} @var{x}, then you add a @samp{thread}
20235 match. This will add a new @samp{thread} match for each article that
20236 has @var{x} in its @code{References} header. (These new @samp{thread}
20237 matches will use the @code{Message-ID}s of these matching articles.)
20238 This will ensure that you can raise/lower the score of an entire thread,
20239 even though some articles in the thread may not have complete
20240 @code{References} headers. Note that using this may lead to
20241 undeterministic scores of the articles in the thread. (Using this match
20242 key will lead to creation of @file{ADAPT} files.)
20243 @end table
20244 @end enumerate
20245
20246 @cindex score file atoms
20247 @item mark
20248 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20249 lower than this number will be marked as read.
20250
20251 @item expunge
20252 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20253 lower than this number will be removed from the summary buffer.
20254
20255 @item mark-and-expunge
20256 The value of this entry should be a number. Any articles with a score
20257 lower than this number will be marked as read and removed from the
20258 summary buffer.
20259
20260 @item thread-mark-and-expunge
20261 The value of this entry should be a number. All articles that belong to
20262 a thread that has a total score below this number will be marked as read
20263 and removed from the summary buffer. @code{gnus-thread-score-function}
20264 says how to compute the total score for a thread.
20265
20266 @item files
20267 The value of this entry should be any number of file names. These files
20268 are assumed to be score files as well, and will be loaded the same way
20269 this one was.
20270
20271 @item exclude-files
20272 The clue of this entry should be any number of files. These files will
20273 not be loaded, even though they would normally be so, for some reason or
20274 other.
20275
20276 @item eval
20277 The value of this entry will be @code{eval}el. This element will be
20278 ignored when handling global score files.
20279
20280 @item read-only
20281 Read-only score files will not be updated or saved. Global score files
20282 should feature this atom (@pxref{Global Score Files}). (Note:
20283 @dfn{Global} here really means @dfn{global}; not your personal
20284 apply-to-all-groups score files.)
20285
20286 @item orphan
20287 The value of this entry should be a number. Articles that do not have
20288 parents will get this number added to their scores. Imagine you follow
20289 some high-volume newsgroup, like @samp{comp.lang.c}. Most likely you
20290 will only follow a few of the threads, also want to see any new threads.
20291
20292 You can do this with the following two score file entries:
20293
20294 @example
20295 (orphan -500)
20296 (mark-and-expunge -100)
20297 @end example
20298
20299 When you enter the group the first time, you will only see the new
20300 threads. You then raise the score of the threads that you find
20301 interesting (with @kbd{I T} or @kbd{I S}), and ignore (@kbd{C y}) the
20302 rest. Next time you enter the group, you will see new articles in the
20303 interesting threads, plus any new threads.
20304
20305 I.e.---the orphan score atom is for high-volume groups where a few
20306 interesting threads which can't be found automatically by ordinary
20307 scoring rules exist.
20308
20309 @item adapt
20310 This entry controls the adaptive scoring. If it is @code{t}, the
20311 default adaptive scoring rules will be used. If it is @code{ignore}, no
20312 adaptive scoring will be performed on this group. If it is a list, this
20313 list will be used as the adaptive scoring rules. If it isn't present,
20314 or is something other than @code{t} or @code{ignore}, the default
20315 adaptive scoring rules will be used. If you want to use adaptive
20316 scoring on most groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20317 @code{t}, and insert an @code{(adapt ignore)} in the groups where you do
20318 not want adaptive scoring. If you only want adaptive scoring in a few
20319 groups, you'd set @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to @code{nil}, and
20320 insert @code{(adapt t)} in the score files of the groups where you want
20321 it.
20322
20323 @item adapt-file
20324 All adaptive score entries will go to the file named by this entry. It
20325 will also be applied when entering the group. This atom might be handy
20326 if you want to adapt on several groups at once, using the same adaptive
20327 file for a number of groups.
20328
20329 @item local
20330 @cindex local variables
20331 The value of this entry should be a list of @code{(@var{var}
20332 @var{value})} pairs. Each @var{var} will be made buffer-local to the
20333 current summary buffer, and set to the value specified. This is a
20334 convenient, if somewhat strange, way of setting variables in some
20335 groups if you don't like hooks much. Note that the @var{value} won't
20336 be evaluated.
20337 @end table
20338
20339
20340 @node Score File Editing
20341 @section Score File Editing
20342
20343 You normally enter all scoring commands from the summary buffer, but you
20344 might feel the urge to edit them by hand as well, so we've supplied you
20345 with a mode for that.
20346
20347 It's simply a slightly customized @code{emacs-lisp} mode, with these
20348 additional commands:
20349
20350 @table @kbd
20351
20352 @item C-c C-c
20353 @kindex C-c C-c (Score)
20354 @findex gnus-score-edit-exit
20355 Save the changes you have made and return to the summary buffer
20356 (@code{gnus-score-edit-exit}).
20357
20358 @item C-c C-d
20359 @kindex C-c C-d (Score)
20360 @findex gnus-score-edit-insert-date
20361 Insert the current date in numerical format
20362 (@code{gnus-score-edit-insert-date}). This is really the day number, if
20363 you were wondering.
20364
20365 @item C-c C-p
20366 @kindex C-c C-p (Score)
20367 @findex gnus-score-pretty-print
20368 The adaptive score files are saved in an unformatted fashion. If you
20369 intend to read one of these files, you want to @dfn{pretty print} it
20370 first. This command (@code{gnus-score-pretty-print}) does that for
20371 you.
20372
20373 @end table
20374
20375 Type @kbd{M-x gnus-score-mode} to use this mode.
20376
20377 @vindex gnus-score-mode-hook
20378 @code{gnus-score-menu-hook} is run in score mode buffers.
20379
20380 In the summary buffer you can use commands like @kbd{V f}, @kbd{V e} and
20381 @kbd{V t} to begin editing score files.
20382
20383
20384 @node Adaptive Scoring
20385 @section Adaptive Scoring
20386 @cindex adaptive scoring
20387
20388 If all this scoring is getting you down, Gnus has a way of making it all
20389 happen automatically---as if by magic. Or rather, as if by artificial
20390 stupidity, to be precise.
20391
20392 @vindex gnus-use-adaptive-scoring
20393 When you read an article, or mark an article as read, or kill an
20394 article, you leave marks behind. On exit from the group, Gnus can sniff
20395 these marks and add score elements depending on what marks it finds.
20396 You turn on this ability by setting @code{gnus-use-adaptive-scoring} to
20397 @code{t} or @code{(line)}. If you want score adaptively on separate
20398 words appearing in the subjects, you should set this variable to
20399 @code{(word)}. If you want to use both adaptive methods, set this
20400 variable to @code{(word line)}.
20401
20402 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20403 To give you complete control over the scoring process, you can customize
20404 the @code{gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist} variable. For instance, it
20405 might look something like this:
20406
20407 @lisp
20408 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-score-alist
20409 '((gnus-unread-mark)
20410 (gnus-ticked-mark (from 4))
20411 (gnus-dormant-mark (from 5))
20412 (gnus-del-mark (from -4) (subject -1))
20413 (gnus-read-mark (from 4) (subject 2))
20414 (gnus-expirable-mark (from -1) (subject -1))
20415 (gnus-killed-mark (from -1) (subject -3))
20416 (gnus-kill-file-mark)
20417 (gnus-ancient-mark)
20418 (gnus-low-score-mark)
20419 (gnus-catchup-mark (from -1) (subject -1))))
20420 @end lisp
20421
20422 As you see, each element in this alist has a mark as a key (either a
20423 variable name or a ``real'' mark---a character). Following this key is
20424 a arbitrary number of header/score pairs. If there are no header/score
20425 pairs following the key, no adaptive scoring will be done on articles
20426 that have that key as the article mark. For instance, articles with
20427 @code{gnus-unread-mark} in the example above will not get adaptive score
20428 entries.
20429
20430 Each article can have only one mark, so just a single of these rules
20431 will be applied to each article.
20432
20433 To take @code{gnus-del-mark} as an example---this alist says that all
20434 articles that have that mark (i.e., are marked with @samp{e}) will have a
20435 score entry added to lower based on the @code{From} header by -4, and
20436 lowered by @code{Subject} by -1. Change this to fit your prejudices.
20437
20438 If you have marked 10 articles with the same subject with
20439 @code{gnus-del-mark}, the rule for that mark will be applied ten times.
20440 That means that that subject will get a score of ten times -1, which
20441 should be, unless I'm much mistaken, -10.
20442
20443 If you have auto-expirable (mail) groups (@pxref{Expiring Mail}), all
20444 the read articles will be marked with the @samp{E} mark. This'll
20445 probably make adaptive scoring slightly impossible, so auto-expiring and
20446 adaptive scoring doesn't really mix very well.
20447
20448 The headers you can score on are @code{from}, @code{subject},
20449 @code{message-id}, @code{references}, @code{xref}, @code{lines},
20450 @code{chars} and @code{date}. In addition, you can score on
20451 @code{followup}, which will create an adaptive score entry that matches
20452 on the @code{References} header using the @code{Message-ID} of the
20453 current article, thereby matching the following thread.
20454
20455 If you use this scheme, you should set the score file atom @code{mark}
20456 to something small---like -300, perhaps, to avoid having small random
20457 changes result in articles getting marked as read.
20458
20459 After using adaptive scoring for a week or so, Gnus should start to
20460 become properly trained and enhance the authors you like best, and kill
20461 the authors you like least, without you having to say so explicitly.
20462
20463 You can control what groups the adaptive scoring is to be performed on
20464 by using the score files (@pxref{Score File Format}). This will also
20465 let you use different rules in different groups.
20466
20467 @vindex gnus-adaptive-file-suffix
20468 The adaptive score entries will be put into a file where the name is the
20469 group name with @code{gnus-adaptive-file-suffix} appended. The default
20470 is @file{ADAPT}.
20471
20472 @vindex gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit
20473 When doing adaptive scoring, substring or fuzzy matching would probably
20474 give you the best results in most cases. However, if the header one
20475 matches is short, the possibility for false positives is great, so if
20476 the length of the match is less than
20477 @code{gnus-score-exact-adapt-limit}, exact matching will be used. If
20478 this variable is @code{nil}, exact matching will always be used to avoid
20479 this problem.
20480
20481 @vindex gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20482 As mentioned above, you can adapt either on individual words or entire
20483 headers. If you adapt on words, the
20484 @code{gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist} variable says what score
20485 each instance of a word should add given a mark.
20486
20487 @lisp
20488 (setq gnus-default-adaptive-word-score-alist
20489 `((,gnus-read-mark . 30)
20490 (,gnus-catchup-mark . -10)
20491 (,gnus-killed-mark . -20)
20492 (,gnus-del-mark . -15)))
20493 @end lisp
20494
20495 This is the default value. If you have adaption on words enabled, every
20496 word that appears in subjects of articles marked with
20497 @code{gnus-read-mark} will result in a score rule that increase the
20498 score with 30 points.
20499
20500 @vindex gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words
20501 @vindex gnus-ignored-adaptive-words
20502 Words that appear in the @code{gnus-default-ignored-adaptive-words} list
20503 will be ignored. If you wish to add more words to be ignored, use the
20504 @code{gnus-ignored-adaptive-words} list instead.
20505
20506 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit
20507 Some may feel that short words shouldn't count when doing adaptive
20508 scoring. If so, you may set @code{gnus-adaptive-word-length-limit} to
20509 an integer. Words shorter than this number will be ignored. This
20510 variable defaults to @code{nil}.
20511
20512 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table
20513 When the scoring is done, @code{gnus-adaptive-word-syntax-table} is the
20514 syntax table in effect. It is similar to the standard syntax table, but
20515 it considers numbers to be non-word-constituent characters.
20516
20517 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-minimum
20518 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} is set to a number, the adaptive
20519 word scoring process will never bring down the score of an article to
20520 below this number. The default is @code{nil}.
20521
20522 @vindex gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words
20523 If @code{gnus-adaptive-word-no-group-words} is set to @code{t}, gnus
20524 won't adaptively word score any of the words in the group name. Useful
20525 for groups like @samp{comp.editors.emacs}, where most of the subject
20526 lines contain the word @samp{emacs}.
20527
20528 After using this scheme for a while, it might be nice to write a
20529 @code{gnus-psychoanalyze-user} command to go through the rules and see
20530 what words you like and what words you don't like. Or perhaps not.
20531
20532 Note that the adaptive word scoring thing is highly experimental and is
20533 likely to change in the future. Initial impressions seem to indicate
20534 that it's totally useless as it stands. Some more work (involving more
20535 rigorous statistical methods) will have to be done to make this useful.
20536
20537
20538 @node Home Score File
20539 @section Home Score File
20540
20541 The score file where new score file entries will go is called the
20542 @dfn{home score file}. This is normally (and by default) the score file
20543 for the group itself. For instance, the home score file for
20544 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} is @file{gnu.emacs.gnus.SCORE}.
20545
20546 However, this may not be what you want. It is often convenient to share
20547 a common home score file among many groups---all @samp{emacs} groups
20548 could perhaps use the same home score file.
20549
20550 @vindex gnus-home-score-file
20551 The variable that controls this is @code{gnus-home-score-file}. It can
20552 be:
20553
20554 @enumerate
20555 @item
20556 A string. Then this file will be used as the home score file for all
20557 groups.
20558
20559 @item
20560 A function. The result of this function will be used as the home score
20561 file. The function will be called with the name of the group as the
20562 parameter.
20563
20564 @item
20565 A list. The elements in this list can be:
20566
20567 @enumerate
20568 @item
20569 @code{(@var{regexp} @var{file-name})}. If the @var{regexp} matches the
20570 group name, the @var{file-name} will be used as the home score file.
20571
20572 @item
20573 A function. If the function returns non-@code{nil}, the result will
20574 be used as the home score file. The function will be called with the
20575 name of the group as the parameter.
20576
20577 @item
20578 A string. Use the string as the home score file.
20579 @end enumerate
20580
20581 The list will be traversed from the beginning towards the end looking
20582 for matches.
20583
20584 @end enumerate
20585
20586 So, if you want to use just a single score file, you could say:
20587
20588 @lisp
20589 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20590 "my-total-score-file.SCORE")
20591 @end lisp
20592
20593 If you want to use @file{gnu.SCORE} for all @samp{gnu} groups and
20594 @file{rec.SCORE} for all @samp{rec} groups (and so on), you can say:
20595
20596 @findex gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file
20597 @lisp
20598 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20599 'gnus-hierarchial-home-score-file)
20600 @end lisp
20601
20602 This is a ready-made function provided for your convenience.
20603 Other functions include
20604
20605 @table @code
20606 @item gnus-current-home-score-file
20607 @findex gnus-current-home-score-file
20608 Return the ``current'' regular score file. This will make scoring
20609 commands add entry to the ``innermost'' matching score file.
20610
20611 @end table
20612
20613 If you want to have one score file for the @samp{emacs} groups and
20614 another for the @samp{comp} groups, while letting all other groups use
20615 their own home score files:
20616
20617 @lisp
20618 (setq gnus-home-score-file
20619 ;; @r{All groups that match the regexp @code{"\\.emacs"}}
20620 '(("\\.emacs" "emacs.SCORE")
20621 ;; @r{All the comp groups in one score file}
20622 ("^comp" "comp.SCORE")))
20623 @end lisp
20624
20625 @vindex gnus-home-adapt-file
20626 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file} works exactly the same way as
20627 @code{gnus-home-score-file}, but says what the home adaptive score file
20628 is instead. All new adaptive file entries will go into the file
20629 specified by this variable, and the same syntax is allowed.
20630
20631 In addition to using @code{gnus-home-score-file} and
20632 @code{gnus-home-adapt-file}, you can also use group parameters
20633 (@pxref{Group Parameters}) and topic parameters (@pxref{Topic
20634 Parameters}) to achieve much the same. Group and topic parameters take
20635 precedence over this variable.
20636
20637
20638 @node Followups To Yourself
20639 @section Followups To Yourself
20640
20641 Gnus offers two commands for picking out the @code{Message-ID} header in
20642 the current buffer. Gnus will then add a score rule that scores using
20643 this @code{Message-ID} on the @code{References} header of other
20644 articles. This will, in effect, increase the score of all articles that
20645 respond to the article in the current buffer. Quite useful if you want
20646 to easily note when people answer what you've said.
20647
20648 @table @code
20649
20650 @item gnus-score-followup-article
20651 @findex gnus-score-followup-article
20652 This will add a score to articles that directly follow up your own
20653 article.
20654
20655 @item gnus-score-followup-thread
20656 @findex gnus-score-followup-thread
20657 This will add a score to all articles that appear in a thread ``below''
20658 your own article.
20659 @end table
20660
20661 @vindex message-sent-hook
20662 These two functions are both primarily meant to be used in hooks like
20663 @code{message-sent-hook}, like this:
20664 @lisp
20665 (add-hook 'message-sent-hook 'gnus-score-followup-thread)
20666 @end lisp
20667
20668
20669 If you look closely at your own @code{Message-ID}, you'll notice that
20670 the first two or three characters are always the same. Here's two of
20671 mine:
20672
20673 @example
20674 <x6u3u47icf.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20675 <x6sp9o7ibw.fsf@@eyesore.no>
20676 @end example
20677
20678 So ``my'' ident on this machine is @samp{x6}. This can be
20679 exploited---the following rule will raise the score on all followups to
20680 myself:
20681
20682 @lisp
20683 ("references"
20684 ("<x6[0-9a-z]+\\.fsf\\(_-_\\)?@@.*eyesore\\.no>"
20685 1000 nil r))
20686 @end lisp
20687
20688 Whether it's the first two or first three characters that are ``yours''
20689 is system-dependent.
20690
20691
20692 @node Scoring On Other Headers
20693 @section Scoring On Other Headers
20694 @cindex scoring on other headers
20695
20696 Gnus is quite fast when scoring the ``traditional''
20697 headers---@samp{From}, @samp{Subject} and so on. However, scoring
20698 other headers requires writing a @code{head} scoring rule, which means
20699 that Gnus has to request every single article from the back end to find
20700 matches. This takes a long time in big groups.
20701
20702 Now, there's not much you can do about this for news groups, but for
20703 mail groups, you have greater control. In @ref{To From Newsgroups},
20704 it's explained in greater detail what this mechanism does, but here's
20705 a cookbook example for @code{nnml} on how to allow scoring on the
20706 @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} headers.
20707
20708 Put the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
20709
20710 @lisp
20711 (setq gnus-extra-headers '(To Cc Newsgroups Keywords)
20712 nnmail-extra-headers gnus-extra-headers)
20713 @end lisp
20714
20715 Restart Gnus and rebuild your @code{nnml} overview files with the
20716 @kbd{M-x nnml-generate-nov-databases} command. This will take a long
20717 time if you have much mail.
20718
20719 Now you can score on @samp{To} and @samp{Cc} as ``extra headers'' like
20720 so: @kbd{I e s p To RET <your name> RET}.
20721
20722 See? Simple.
20723
20724
20725 @node Scoring Tips
20726 @section Scoring Tips
20727 @cindex scoring tips
20728
20729 @table @dfn
20730
20731 @item Crossposts
20732 @cindex crossposts
20733 @cindex scoring crossposts
20734 If you want to lower the score of crossposts, the line to match on is
20735 the @code{Xref} header.
20736 @lisp
20737 ("xref" (" talk.politics.misc:" -1000))
20738 @end lisp
20739
20740 @item Multiple crossposts
20741 If you want to lower the score of articles that have been crossposted to
20742 more than, say, 3 groups:
20743 @lisp
20744 ("xref"
20745 ("[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+ +[^:\n]+:[0-9]+"
20746 -1000 nil r))
20747 @end lisp
20748
20749 @item Matching on the body
20750 This is generally not a very good idea---it takes a very long time.
20751 Gnus actually has to fetch each individual article from the server. But
20752 you might want to anyway, I guess. Even though there are three match
20753 keys (@code{Head}, @code{Body} and @code{All}), you should choose one
20754 and stick with it in each score file. If you use any two, each article
20755 will be fetched @emph{twice}. If you want to match a bit on the
20756 @code{Head} and a bit on the @code{Body}, just use @code{All} for all
20757 the matches.
20758
20759 @item Marking as read
20760 You will probably want to mark articles that have scores below a certain
20761 number as read. This is most easily achieved by putting the following
20762 in your @file{all.SCORE} file:
20763 @lisp
20764 ((mark -100))
20765 @end lisp
20766 You may also consider doing something similar with @code{expunge}.
20767
20768 @item Negated character classes
20769 If you say stuff like @code{[^abcd]*}, you may get unexpected results.
20770 That will match newlines, which might lead to, well, The Unknown. Say
20771 @code{[^abcd\n]*} instead.
20772 @end table
20773
20774
20775 @node Reverse Scoring
20776 @section Reverse Scoring
20777 @cindex reverse scoring
20778
20779 If you want to keep just articles that have @samp{Sex with Emacs} in the
20780 subject header, and expunge all other articles, you could put something
20781 like this in your score file:
20782
20783 @lisp
20784 (("subject"
20785 ("Sex with Emacs" 2))
20786 (mark 1)
20787 (expunge 1))
20788 @end lisp
20789
20790 So, you raise all articles that match @samp{Sex with Emacs} and mark the
20791 rest as read, and expunge them to boot.
20792
20793
20794 @node Global Score Files
20795 @section Global Score Files
20796 @cindex global score files
20797
20798 Sure, other newsreaders have ``global kill files''. These are usually
20799 nothing more than a single kill file that applies to all groups, stored
20800 in the user's home directory. Bah! Puny, weak newsreaders!
20801
20802 What I'm talking about here are Global Score Files. Score files from
20803 all over the world, from users everywhere, uniting all nations in one
20804 big, happy score file union! Ange-score! New and untested!
20805
20806 @vindex gnus-global-score-files
20807 All you have to do to use other people's score files is to set the
20808 @code{gnus-global-score-files} variable. One entry for each score file,
20809 or each score file directory. Gnus will decide by itself what score
20810 files are applicable to which group.
20811
20812 To use the score file
20813 @file{/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE} and
20814 all score files in the @file{/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score} directory,
20815 say this:
20816
20817 @lisp
20818 (setq gnus-global-score-files
20819 '("/ftp@@ftp.gnus.org:/pub/larsi/ding/score/soc.motss.SCORE"
20820 "/ftp@@ftp.some-where:/pub/score/"))
20821 @end lisp
20822
20823 @findex gnus-score-search-global-directories
20824 @noindent
20825 Simple, eh? Directory names must end with a @samp{/}. These
20826 directories are typically scanned only once during each Gnus session.
20827 If you feel the need to manually re-scan the remote directories, you can
20828 use the @code{gnus-score-search-global-directories} command.
20829
20830 Note that, at present, using this option will slow down group entry
20831 somewhat. (That is---a lot.)
20832
20833 If you want to start maintaining score files for other people to use,
20834 just put your score file up for anonymous ftp and announce it to the
20835 world. Become a retro-moderator! Participate in the retro-moderator
20836 wars sure to ensue, where retro-moderators battle it out for the
20837 sympathy of the people, luring them to use their score files on false
20838 premises! Yay! The net is saved!
20839
20840 Here are some tips for the would-be retro-moderator, off the top of my
20841 head:
20842
20843 @itemize @bullet
20844
20845 @item
20846 Articles heavily crossposted are probably junk.
20847 @item
20848 To lower a single inappropriate article, lower by @code{Message-ID}.
20849 @item
20850 Particularly brilliant authors can be raised on a permanent basis.
20851 @item
20852 Authors that repeatedly post off-charter for the group can safely be
20853 lowered out of existence.
20854 @item
20855 Set the @code{mark} and @code{expunge} atoms to obliterate the nastiest
20856 articles completely.
20857
20858 @item
20859 Use expiring score entries to keep the size of the file down. You
20860 should probably have a long expiry period, though, as some sites keep
20861 old articles for a long time.
20862 @end itemize
20863
20864 @dots{} I wonder whether other newsreaders will support global score files
20865 in the future. @emph{Snicker}. Yup, any day now, newsreaders like Blue
20866 Wave, xrn and 1stReader are bound to implement scoring. Should we start
20867 holding our breath yet?
20868
20869
20870 @node Kill Files
20871 @section Kill Files
20872 @cindex kill files
20873
20874 Gnus still supports those pesky old kill files. In fact, the kill file
20875 entries can now be expiring, which is something I wrote before Daniel
20876 Quinlan thought of doing score files, so I've left the code in there.
20877
20878 In short, kill processing is a lot slower (and I do mean @emph{a lot})
20879 than score processing, so it might be a good idea to rewrite your kill
20880 files into score files.
20881
20882 Anyway, a kill file is a normal @code{emacs-lisp} file. You can put any
20883 forms into this file, which means that you can use kill files as some
20884 sort of primitive hook function to be run on group entry, even though
20885 that isn't a very good idea.
20886
20887 Normal kill files look like this:
20888
20889 @lisp
20890 (gnus-kill "From" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
20891 (gnus-kill "Subject" "ding")
20892 (gnus-expunge "X")
20893 @end lisp
20894
20895 This will mark every article written by me as read, and remove the
20896 marked articles from the summary buffer. Very useful, you'll agree.
20897
20898 Other programs use a totally different kill file syntax. If Gnus
20899 encounters what looks like a @code{rn} kill file, it will take a stab at
20900 interpreting it.
20901
20902 Two summary functions for editing a @sc{gnus} kill file:
20903
20904 @table @kbd
20905
20906 @item M-k
20907 @kindex M-k (Summary)
20908 @findex gnus-summary-edit-local-kill
20909 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-local-kill}).
20910
20911 @item M-K
20912 @kindex M-K (Summary)
20913 @findex gnus-summary-edit-global-kill
20914 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-summary-edit-global-kill}).
20915 @end table
20916
20917 Two group mode functions for editing the kill files:
20918
20919 @table @kbd
20920
20921 @item M-k
20922 @kindex M-k (Group)
20923 @findex gnus-group-edit-local-kill
20924 Edit this group's kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-local-kill}).
20925
20926 @item M-K
20927 @kindex M-K (Group)
20928 @findex gnus-group-edit-global-kill
20929 Edit the general kill file (@code{gnus-group-edit-global-kill}).
20930 @end table
20931
20932 Kill file variables:
20933
20934 @table @code
20935 @item gnus-kill-file-name
20936 @vindex gnus-kill-file-name
20937 A kill file for the group @samp{soc.motss} is normally called
20938 @file{soc.motss.KILL}. The suffix appended to the group name to get
20939 this file name is detailed by the @code{gnus-kill-file-name} variable.
20940 The ``global'' kill file (not in the score file sense of ``global'', of
20941 course) is just called @file{KILL}.
20942
20943 @vindex gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20944 @item gnus-kill-save-kill-file
20945 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, Gnus will save the
20946 kill file after processing, which is necessary if you use expiring
20947 kills.
20948
20949 @item gnus-apply-kill-hook
20950 @vindex gnus-apply-kill-hook
20951 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored
20952 @findex gnus-apply-kill-file
20953 A hook called to apply kill files to a group. It is
20954 @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file)} by default. If you want to ignore the
20955 kill file if you have a score file for the same group, you can set this
20956 hook to @code{(gnus-apply-kill-file-unless-scored)}. If you don't want
20957 kill files to be processed, you should set this variable to @code{nil}.
20958
20959 @item gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20960 @vindex gnus-kill-file-mode-hook
20961 A hook called in kill-file mode buffers.
20962
20963 @end table
20964
20965
20966 @node Converting Kill Files
20967 @section Converting Kill Files
20968 @cindex kill files
20969 @cindex converting kill files
20970
20971 If you have loads of old kill files, you may want to convert them into
20972 score files. If they are ``regular'', you can use
20973 the @file{gnus-kill-to-score.el} package; if not, you'll have to do it
20974 by hand.
20975
20976 The kill to score conversion package isn't included in Gnus by default.
20977 You can fetch it from
20978 @uref{http://www.stud.ifi.uio.no/~larsi/ding-various/gnus-kill-to-score.el}.
20979
20980 If your old kill files are very complex---if they contain more
20981 non-@code{gnus-kill} forms than not, you'll have to convert them by
20982 hand. Or just let them be as they are. Gnus will still use them as
20983 before.
20984
20985
20986 @node GroupLens
20987 @section GroupLens
20988 @cindex GroupLens
20989
20990 @sc{Note:} Unfortunately the GroupLens system seems to have shut down,
20991 so this section is mostly of historical interest.
20992
20993 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/, GroupLens} is a
20994 collaborative filtering system that helps you work together with other
20995 people to find the quality news articles out of the huge volume of
20996 news articles generated every day.
20997
20998 To accomplish this the GroupLens system combines your opinions about
20999 articles you have already read with the opinions of others who have done
21000 likewise and gives you a personalized prediction for each unread news
21001 article. Think of GroupLens as a matchmaker. GroupLens watches how you
21002 rate articles, and finds other people that rate articles the same way.
21003 Once it has found some people you agree with it tells you, in the form
21004 of a prediction, what they thought of the article. You can use this
21005 prediction to help you decide whether or not you want to read the
21006 article.
21007
21008 @menu
21009 * Using GroupLens:: How to make Gnus use GroupLens.
21010 * Rating Articles:: Letting GroupLens know how you rate articles.
21011 * Displaying Predictions:: Displaying predictions given by GroupLens.
21012 * GroupLens Variables:: Customizing GroupLens.
21013 @end menu
21014
21015
21016 @node Using GroupLens
21017 @subsection Using GroupLens
21018
21019 To use GroupLens you must register a pseudonym with your local
21020 @uref{http://www.cs.umn.edu/Research/GroupLens/bbb.html, Better Bit
21021 Bureau (BBB)} is the only better bit in town at the moment.
21022
21023 Once you have registered you'll need to set a couple of variables.
21024
21025 @table @code
21026
21027 @item gnus-use-grouplens
21028 @vindex gnus-use-grouplens
21029 Setting this variable to a non-@code{nil} value will make Gnus hook into
21030 all the relevant GroupLens functions.
21031
21032 @item grouplens-pseudonym
21033 @vindex grouplens-pseudonym
21034 This variable should be set to the pseudonym you got when registering
21035 with the Better Bit Bureau.
21036
21037 @item grouplens-newsgroups
21038 @vindex grouplens-newsgroups
21039 A list of groups that you want to get GroupLens predictions for.
21040
21041 @end table
21042
21043 That's the minimum of what you need to get up and running with GroupLens.
21044 Once you've registered, GroupLens will start giving you scores for
21045 articles based on the average of what other people think. But, to get
21046 the real benefit of GroupLens you need to start rating articles
21047 yourself. Then the scores GroupLens gives you will be personalized for
21048 you, based on how the people you usually agree with have already rated.
21049
21050
21051 @node Rating Articles
21052 @subsection Rating Articles
21053
21054 In GroupLens, an article is rated on a scale from 1 to 5, inclusive.
21055 Where 1 means something like this article is a waste of bandwidth and 5
21056 means that the article was really good. The basic question to ask
21057 yourself is, ``on a scale from 1 to 5 would I like to see more articles
21058 like this one?''
21059
21060 There are four ways to enter a rating for an article in GroupLens.
21061
21062 @table @kbd
21063
21064 @item r
21065 @kindex r (GroupLens)
21066 @findex bbb-summary-rate-article
21067 This function will prompt you for a rating on a scale of one to five.
21068
21069 @item k
21070 @kindex k (GroupLens)
21071 @findex grouplens-score-thread
21072 This function will prompt you for a rating, and rate all the articles in
21073 the thread. This is really useful for some of those long running giant
21074 threads in rec.humor.
21075
21076 @end table
21077
21078 The next two commands, @kbd{n} and @kbd{,} take a numerical prefix to be
21079 the score of the article you're reading.
21080
21081 @table @kbd
21082
21083 @item 1-5 n
21084 @kindex n (GroupLens)
21085 @findex grouplens-next-unread-article
21086 Rate the article and go to the next unread article.
21087
21088 @item 1-5 ,
21089 @kindex , (GroupLens)
21090 @findex grouplens-best-unread-article
21091 Rate the article and go to the next unread article with the highest score.
21092
21093 @end table
21094
21095 If you want to give the current article a score of 4 and then go to the
21096 next article, just type @kbd{4 n}.
21097
21098
21099 @node Displaying Predictions
21100 @subsection Displaying Predictions
21101
21102 GroupLens makes a prediction for you about how much you will like a
21103 news article. The predictions from GroupLens are on a scale from 1 to
21104 5, where 1 is the worst and 5 is the best. You can use the predictions
21105 from GroupLens in one of three ways controlled by the variable
21106 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring}.
21107
21108 @vindex gnus-grouplens-override-scoring
21109 There are three ways to display predictions in grouplens. You may
21110 choose to have the GroupLens scores contribute to, or override the
21111 regular Gnus scoring mechanism. override is the default; however, some
21112 people prefer to see the Gnus scores plus the grouplens scores. To get
21113 the separate scoring behavior you need to set
21114 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'separate}. To have the
21115 GroupLens predictions combined with the grouplens scores set it to
21116 @code{'override} and to combine the scores set
21117 @code{gnus-grouplens-override-scoring} to @code{'combine}. When you use
21118 the combine option you will also want to set the values for
21119 @code{grouplens-prediction-offset} and
21120 @code{grouplens-score-scale-factor}.
21121
21122 @vindex grouplens-prediction-display
21123 In either case, GroupLens gives you a few choices for how you would like
21124 to see your predictions displayed. The display of predictions is
21125 controlled by the @code{grouplens-prediction-display} variable.
21126
21127 The following are valid values for that variable.
21128
21129 @table @code
21130 @item prediction-spot
21131 The higher the prediction, the further to the right an @samp{*} is
21132 displayed.
21133
21134 @item confidence-interval
21135 A numeric confidence interval.
21136
21137 @item prediction-bar
21138 The higher the prediction, the longer the bar.
21139
21140 @item confidence-bar
21141 Numerical confidence.
21142
21143 @item confidence-spot
21144 The spot gets bigger with more confidence.
21145
21146 @item prediction-num
21147 Plain-old numeric value.
21148
21149 @item confidence-plus-minus
21150 Prediction +/- confidence.
21151
21152 @end table
21153
21154
21155 @node GroupLens Variables
21156 @subsection GroupLens Variables
21157
21158 @table @code
21159
21160 @item gnus-summary-grouplens-line-format
21161 The summary line format used in GroupLens-enhanced summary buffers. It
21162 accepts the same specs as the normal summary line format (@pxref{Summary
21163 Buffer Lines}). The default is @samp{%U%R%z%l%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23n%]%)
21164 %s\n}.
21165
21166 @item grouplens-bbb-host
21167 Host running the bbbd server. @samp{grouplens.cs.umn.edu} is the
21168 default.
21169
21170 @item grouplens-bbb-port
21171 Port of the host running the bbbd server. The default is 9000.
21172
21173 @item grouplens-score-offset
21174 Offset the prediction by this value. In other words, subtract the
21175 prediction value by this number to arrive at the effective score. The
21176 default is 0.
21177
21178 @item grouplens-score-scale-factor
21179 This variable allows the user to magnify the effect of GroupLens scores.
21180 The scale factor is applied after the offset. The default is 1.
21181
21182 @end table
21183
21184
21185 @node Advanced Scoring
21186 @section Advanced Scoring
21187
21188 Scoring on Subjects and From headers is nice enough, but what if you're
21189 really interested in what a person has to say only when she's talking
21190 about a particular subject? Or what if you really don't want to
21191 read what person A has to say when she's following up to person B, but
21192 want to read what she says when she's following up to person C?
21193
21194 By using advanced scoring rules you may create arbitrarily complex
21195 scoring patterns.
21196
21197 @menu
21198 * Advanced Scoring Syntax:: A definition.
21199 * Advanced Scoring Examples:: What they look like.
21200 * Advanced Scoring Tips:: Getting the most out of it.
21201 @end menu
21202
21203
21204 @node Advanced Scoring Syntax
21205 @subsection Advanced Scoring Syntax
21206
21207 Ordinary scoring rules have a string as the first element in the rule.
21208 Advanced scoring rules have a list as the first element. The second
21209 element is the score to be applied if the first element evaluated to a
21210 non-@code{nil} value.
21211
21212 These lists may consist of three logical operators, one redirection
21213 operator, and various match operators.
21214
21215 Logical operators:
21216
21217 @table @code
21218 @item &
21219 @itemx and
21220 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
21221 one that evaluates to @code{false}, and then it'll stop. If all arguments
21222 evaluate to @code{true} values, then this operator will return
21223 @code{true}.
21224
21225 @item |
21226 @itemx or
21227 This logical operator will evaluate each of its arguments until it finds
21228 one that evaluates to @code{true}. If no arguments are @code{true},
21229 then this operator will return @code{false}.
21230
21231 @item !
21232 @itemx not
21233 @itemx ¬
21234 This logical operator only takes a single argument. It returns the
21235 logical negation of the value of its argument.
21236
21237 @end table
21238
21239 There is an @dfn{indirection operator} that will make its arguments
21240 apply to the ancestors of the current article being scored. For
21241 instance, @code{1-} will make score rules apply to the parent of the
21242 current article. @code{2-} will make score rules apply to the
21243 grandparent of the current article. Alternatively, you can write
21244 @code{^^}, where the number of @code{^}s (carets) says how far back into
21245 the ancestry you want to go.
21246
21247 Finally, we have the match operators. These are the ones that do the
21248 real work. Match operators are header name strings followed by a match
21249 and a match type. A typical match operator looks like @samp{("from"
21250 "Lars Ingebrigtsen" s)}. The header names are the same as when using
21251 simple scoring, and the match types are also the same.
21252
21253
21254 @node Advanced Scoring Examples
21255 @subsection Advanced Scoring Examples
21256
21257 Please note that the following examples are score file rules. To
21258 make a complete score file from them, surround them with another pair
21259 of parentheses.
21260
21261 Let's say you want to increase the score of articles written by Lars
21262 when he's talking about Gnus:
21263
21264 @example
21265 @group
21266 ((&
21267 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21268 ("subject" "Gnus"))
21269 1000)
21270 @end group
21271 @end example
21272
21273 Quite simple, huh?
21274
21275 When he writes long articles, he sometimes has something nice to say:
21276
21277 @example
21278 ((&
21279 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21280 (|
21281 ("subject" "Gnus")
21282 ("lines" 100 >)))
21283 1000)
21284 @end example
21285
21286 However, when he responds to things written by Reig Eigil Logge, you
21287 really don't want to read what he's written:
21288
21289 @example
21290 ((&
21291 ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen")
21292 (1- ("from" "Reig Eigil Logge")))
21293 -100000)
21294 @end example
21295
21296 Everybody that follows up Redmondo when he writes about disappearing
21297 socks should have their scores raised, but only when they talk about
21298 white socks. However, when Lars talks about socks, it's usually not
21299 very interesting:
21300
21301 @example
21302 ((&
21303 (1-
21304 (&
21305 ("from" "redmondo@@.*no" r)
21306 ("body" "disappearing.*socks" t)))
21307 (! ("from" "Lars Ingebrigtsen"))
21308 ("body" "white.*socks"))
21309 1000)
21310 @end example
21311
21312 Suppose you're reading a high volume group and you're only interested
21313 in replies. The plan is to score down all articles that don't have
21314 subject that begin with "Re:", "Fw:" or "Fwd:" and then score up all
21315 parents of articles that have subjects that begin with reply marks.
21316
21317 @example
21318 ((! ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
21319 -200)
21320 ((1- ("subject" "re:\\|fwd?:" r))
21321 200)
21322 @end example
21323
21324 The possibilities are endless.
21325
21326 @node Advanced Scoring Tips
21327 @subsection Advanced Scoring Tips
21328
21329 The @code{&} and @code{|} logical operators do short-circuit logic.
21330 That is, they stop processing their arguments when it's clear what the
21331 result of the operation will be. For instance, if one of the arguments
21332 of an @code{&} evaluates to @code{false}, there's no point in evaluating
21333 the rest of the arguments. This means that you should put slow matches
21334 (@samp{body}, @samp{header}) last and quick matches (@samp{from},
21335 @samp{subject}) first.
21336
21337 The indirection arguments (@code{1-} and so on) will make their
21338 arguments work on previous generations of the thread. If you say
21339 something like:
21340
21341 @example
21342 ...
21343 (1-
21344 (1-
21345 ("from" "lars")))
21346 ...
21347 @end example
21348
21349 Then that means ``score on the from header of the grandparent of the
21350 current article''. An indirection is quite fast, but it's better to say:
21351
21352 @example
21353 (1-
21354 (&
21355 ("from" "Lars")
21356 ("subject" "Gnus")))
21357 @end example
21358
21359 than it is to say:
21360
21361 @example
21362 (&
21363 (1- ("from" "Lars"))
21364 (1- ("subject" "Gnus")))
21365 @end example
21366
21367
21368 @node Score Decays
21369 @section Score Decays
21370 @cindex score decays
21371 @cindex decays
21372
21373 You may find that your scores have a tendency to grow without
21374 bounds, especially if you're using adaptive scoring. If scores get too
21375 big, they lose all meaning---they simply max out and it's difficult to
21376 use them in any sensible way.
21377
21378 @vindex gnus-decay-scores
21379 @findex gnus-decay-score
21380 @vindex gnus-decay-score-function
21381 Gnus provides a mechanism for decaying scores to help with this problem.
21382 When score files are loaded and @code{gnus-decay-scores} is
21383 non-@code{nil}, Gnus will run the score files through the decaying
21384 mechanism thereby lowering the scores of all non-permanent score rules.
21385 The decay itself if performed by the @code{gnus-decay-score-function}
21386 function, which is @code{gnus-decay-score} by default. Here's the
21387 definition of that function:
21388
21389 @lisp
21390 (defun gnus-decay-score (score)
21391 "Decay SCORE according to `gnus-score-decay-constant'
21392 and `gnus-score-decay-scale'."
21393 (let ((n (- score
21394 (* (if (< score 0) -1 1)
21395 (min (abs score)
21396 (max gnus-score-decay-constant
21397 (* (abs score)
21398 gnus-score-decay-scale)))))))
21399 (if (and (featurep 'xemacs)
21400 ;; XEmacs' floor can handle only the floating point
21401 ;; number below the half of the maximum integer.
21402 (> (abs n) (lsh -1 -2)))
21403 (string-to-number
21404 (car (split-string (number-to-string n) "\\.")))
21405 (floor n))))
21406 @end lisp
21407
21408 @vindex gnus-score-decay-scale
21409 @vindex gnus-score-decay-constant
21410 @code{gnus-score-decay-constant} is 3 by default and
21411 @code{gnus-score-decay-scale} is 0.05. This should cause the following:
21412
21413 @enumerate
21414 @item
21415 Scores between -3 and 3 will be set to 0 when this function is called.
21416
21417 @item
21418 Scores with magnitudes between 3 and 60 will be shrunk by 3.
21419
21420 @item
21421 Scores with magnitudes greater than 60 will be shrunk by 5% of the
21422 score.
21423 @end enumerate
21424
21425 If you don't like this decay function, write your own. It is called
21426 with the score to be decayed as its only parameter, and it should return
21427 the new score, which should be an integer.
21428
21429 Gnus will try to decay scores once a day. If you haven't run Gnus for
21430 four days, Gnus will decay the scores four times, for instance.
21431
21432 @iftex
21433 @iflatex
21434 @chapter Message
21435 @include message.texi
21436 @chapter Emacs MIME
21437 @include emacs-mime.texi
21438 @chapter Sieve
21439 @include sieve.texi
21440 @chapter PGG
21441 @include pgg.texi
21442 @end iflatex
21443 @end iftex
21444
21445 @node Various
21446 @chapter Various
21447
21448 @menu
21449 * Process/Prefix:: A convention used by many treatment commands.
21450 * Interactive:: Making Gnus ask you many questions.
21451 * Symbolic Prefixes:: How to supply some Gnus functions with options.
21452 * Formatting Variables:: You can specify what buffers should look like.
21453 * Window Layout:: Configuring the Gnus buffer windows.
21454 * Faces and Fonts:: How to change how faces look.
21455 * Compilation:: How to speed Gnus up.
21456 * Mode Lines:: Displaying information in the mode lines.
21457 * Highlighting and Menus:: Making buffers look all nice and cozy.
21458 * Buttons:: Get tendinitis in ten easy steps!
21459 * Daemons:: Gnus can do things behind your back.
21460 * NoCeM:: How to avoid spam and other fatty foods.
21461 * Undo:: Some actions can be undone.
21462 * Predicate Specifiers:: Specifying predicates.
21463 * Moderation:: What to do if you're a moderator.
21464 * Fetching a Group:: Starting Gnus just to read a group.
21465 * Image Enhancements:: Modern versions of Emacs/XEmacs can display images.
21466 * Fuzzy Matching:: What's the big fuzz?
21467 * Thwarting Email Spam:: Simple ways to avoid unsolicited commercial email.
21468 * Spam Package:: A package for filtering and processing spam.
21469 * Other modes:: Interaction with other modes.
21470 * Various Various:: Things that are really various.
21471 @end menu
21472
21473
21474 @node Process/Prefix
21475 @section Process/Prefix
21476 @cindex process/prefix convention
21477
21478 Many functions, among them functions for moving, decoding and saving
21479 articles, use what is known as the @dfn{Process/Prefix convention}.
21480
21481 This is a method for figuring out what articles the user wants the
21482 command to be performed on.
21483
21484 It goes like this:
21485
21486 If the numeric prefix is N, perform the operation on the next N
21487 articles, starting with the current one. If the numeric prefix is
21488 negative, perform the operation on the previous N articles, starting
21489 with the current one.
21490
21491 @vindex transient-mark-mode
21492 If @code{transient-mark-mode} in non-@code{nil} and the region is
21493 active, all articles in the region will be worked upon.
21494
21495 If there is no numeric prefix, but some articles are marked with the
21496 process mark, perform the operation on the articles marked with
21497 the process mark.
21498
21499 If there is neither a numeric prefix nor any articles marked with the
21500 process mark, just perform the operation on the current article.
21501
21502 Quite simple, really, but it needs to be made clear so that surprises
21503 are avoided.
21504
21505 Commands that react to the process mark will push the current list of
21506 process marked articles onto a stack and will then clear all process
21507 marked articles. You can restore the previous configuration with the
21508 @kbd{M P y} command (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
21509
21510 @vindex gnus-summary-goto-unread
21511 One thing that seems to shock & horrify lots of people is that, for
21512 instance, @kbd{3 d} does exactly the same as @kbd{d} @kbd{d} @kbd{d}.
21513 Since each @kbd{d} (which marks the current article as read) by default
21514 goes to the next unread article after marking, this means that @kbd{3 d}
21515 will mark the next three unread articles as read, no matter what the
21516 summary buffer looks like. Set @code{gnus-summary-goto-unread} to
21517 @code{nil} for a more straightforward action.
21518
21519 Many commands do not use the process/prefix convention. All commands
21520 that do explicitly say so in this manual. To apply the process/prefix
21521 convention to commands that do not use it, you can use the @kbd{M-&}
21522 command. For instance, to mark all the articles in the group as
21523 expirable, you could say @kbd{M P b M-& E}.
21524
21525
21526 @node Interactive
21527 @section Interactive
21528 @cindex interaction
21529
21530 @table @code
21531
21532 @item gnus-novice-user
21533 @vindex gnus-novice-user
21534 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you are either a newcomer to the
21535 World of Usenet, or you are very cautious, which is a nice thing to be,
21536 really. You will be given questions of the type ``Are you sure you want
21537 to do this?'' before doing anything dangerous. This is @code{t} by
21538 default.
21539
21540 @item gnus-expert-user
21541 @vindex gnus-expert-user
21542 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, you will seldom be asked any
21543 questions by Gnus. It will simply assume you know what you're doing, no
21544 matter how strange.
21545
21546 @item gnus-interactive-catchup
21547 @vindex gnus-interactive-catchup
21548 Require confirmation before catching up a group if non-@code{nil}. It
21549 is @code{t} by default.
21550
21551 @item gnus-interactive-exit
21552 @vindex gnus-interactive-exit
21553 Require confirmation before exiting Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
21554 default.
21555 @end table
21556
21557
21558 @node Symbolic Prefixes
21559 @section Symbolic Prefixes
21560 @cindex symbolic prefixes
21561
21562 Quite a lot of Emacs commands react to the (numeric) prefix. For
21563 instance, @kbd{C-u 4 C-f} moves point four characters forward, and
21564 @kbd{C-u 9 0 0 I s s p} adds a permanent @code{Subject} substring score
21565 rule of 900 to the current article.
21566
21567 This is all nice and well, but what if you want to give a command some
21568 additional information? Well, what most commands do is interpret the
21569 ``raw'' prefix in some special way. @kbd{C-u 0 C-x C-s} means that one
21570 doesn't want a backup file to be created when saving the current buffer,
21571 for instance. But what if you want to save without making a backup
21572 file, and you want Emacs to flash lights and play a nice tune at the
21573 same time? You can't, and you're probably perfectly happy that way.
21574
21575 @kindex M-i (Summary)
21576 @findex gnus-symbolic-argument
21577 I'm not, so I've added a second prefix---the @dfn{symbolic prefix}. The
21578 prefix key is @kbd{M-i} (@code{gnus-symbolic-argument}), and the next
21579 character typed in is the value. You can stack as many @kbd{M-i}
21580 prefixes as you want. @kbd{M-i a C-M-u} means ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u}
21581 command the symbolic prefix @code{a}''. @kbd{M-i a M-i b C-M-u} means
21582 ``feed the @kbd{C-M-u} command the symbolic prefixes @code{a} and
21583 @code{b}''. You get the drift.
21584
21585 Typing in symbolic prefixes to commands that don't accept them doesn't
21586 hurt, but it doesn't do any good either. Currently not many Gnus
21587 functions make use of the symbolic prefix.
21588
21589 If you're interested in how Gnus implements this, @pxref{Extended
21590 Interactive}.
21591
21592
21593 @node Formatting Variables
21594 @section Formatting Variables
21595 @cindex formatting variables
21596
21597 Throughout this manual you've probably noticed lots of variables called
21598 things like @code{gnus-group-line-format} and
21599 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}. These control how Gnus is to
21600 output lines in the various buffers. There's quite a lot of them.
21601 Fortunately, they all use the same syntax, so there's not that much to
21602 be annoyed by.
21603
21604 Here's an example format spec (from the group buffer): @samp{%M%S%5y:
21605 %(%g%)\n}. We see that it is indeed extremely ugly, and that there are
21606 lots of percentages everywhere.
21607
21608 @menu
21609 * Formatting Basics:: A formatting variable is basically a format string.
21610 * Mode Line Formatting:: Some rules about mode line formatting variables.
21611 * Advanced Formatting:: Modifying output in various ways.
21612 * User-Defined Specs:: Having Gnus call your own functions.
21613 * Formatting Fonts:: Making the formatting look colorful and nice.
21614 * Positioning Point:: Moving point to a position after an operation.
21615 * Tabulation:: Tabulating your output.
21616 * Wide Characters:: Dealing with wide characters.
21617 @end menu
21618
21619 Currently Gnus uses the following formatting variables:
21620 @code{gnus-group-line-format}, @code{gnus-summary-line-format},
21621 @code{gnus-server-line-format}, @code{gnus-topic-line-format},
21622 @code{gnus-group-mode-line-format},
21623 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format},
21624 @code{gnus-article-mode-line-format},
21625 @code{gnus-server-mode-line-format}, and
21626 @code{gnus-summary-pick-line-format}.
21627
21628 All these format variables can also be arbitrary elisp forms. In that
21629 case, they will be @code{eval}ed to insert the required lines.
21630
21631 @kindex M-x gnus-update-format
21632 @findex gnus-update-format
21633 Gnus includes a command to help you while creating your own format
21634 specs. @kbd{M-x gnus-update-format} will @code{eval} the current form,
21635 update the spec in question and pop you to a buffer where you can
21636 examine the resulting Lisp code to be run to generate the line.
21637
21638
21639
21640 @node Formatting Basics
21641 @subsection Formatting Basics
21642
21643 Each @samp{%} element will be replaced by some string or other when the
21644 buffer in question is generated. @samp{%5y} means ``insert the @samp{y}
21645 spec, and pad with spaces to get a 5-character field''.
21646
21647 As with normal C and Emacs Lisp formatting strings, the numerical
21648 modifier between the @samp{%} and the formatting type character will
21649 @dfn{pad} the output so that it is always at least that long.
21650 @samp{%5y} will make the field always (at least) five characters wide by
21651 padding with spaces to the left. If you say @samp{%-5y}, it will pad to
21652 the right instead.
21653
21654 You may also wish to limit the length of the field to protect against
21655 particularly wide values. For that you can say @samp{%4,6y}, which
21656 means that the field will never be more than 6 characters wide and never
21657 less than 4 characters wide.
21658
21659 Also Gnus supports some extended format specifications, such as
21660 @samp{%&user-date;}.
21661
21662
21663 @node Mode Line Formatting
21664 @subsection Mode Line Formatting
21665
21666 Mode line formatting variables (e.g.,
21667 @code{gnus-summary-mode-line-format}) follow the same rules as other,
21668 buffer line oriented formatting variables (@pxref{Formatting Basics})
21669 with the following two differences:
21670
21671 @enumerate
21672
21673 @item
21674 There must be no newline (@samp{\n}) at the end.
21675
21676 @item
21677 The special @samp{%%b} spec can be used to display the buffer name.
21678 Well, it's no spec at all, really---@samp{%%} is just a way to quote
21679 @samp{%} to allow it to pass through the formatting machinery unmangled,
21680 so that Emacs receives @samp{%b}, which is something the Emacs mode line
21681 display interprets to mean ``show the buffer name''. For a full list of
21682 mode line specs Emacs understands, see the documentation of the
21683 @code{mode-line-format} variable.
21684
21685 @end enumerate
21686
21687
21688 @node Advanced Formatting
21689 @subsection Advanced Formatting
21690
21691 It is frequently useful to post-process the fields in some way.
21692 Padding, limiting, cutting off parts and suppressing certain values can
21693 be achieved by using @dfn{tilde modifiers}. A typical tilde spec might
21694 look like @samp{%~(cut 3)~(ignore "0")y}.
21695
21696 These are the valid modifiers:
21697
21698 @table @code
21699 @item pad
21700 @itemx pad-left
21701 Pad the field to the left with spaces until it reaches the required
21702 length.
21703
21704 @item pad-right
21705 Pad the field to the right with spaces until it reaches the required
21706 length.
21707
21708 @item max
21709 @itemx max-left
21710 Cut off characters from the left until it reaches the specified length.
21711
21712 @item max-right
21713 Cut off characters from the right until it reaches the specified
21714 length.
21715
21716 @item cut
21717 @itemx cut-left
21718 Cut off the specified number of characters from the left.
21719
21720 @item cut-right
21721 Cut off the specified number of characters from the right.
21722
21723 @item ignore
21724 Return an empty string if the field is equal to the specified value.
21725
21726 @item form
21727 Use the specified form as the field value when the @samp{@@} spec is
21728 used.
21729
21730 Here's an example:
21731
21732 @lisp
21733 "~(form (current-time-string))@@"
21734 @end lisp
21735
21736 @end table
21737
21738 Let's take an example. The @samp{%o} spec in the summary mode lines
21739 will return a date in compact ISO8601 format---@samp{19960809T230410}.
21740 This is quite a mouthful, so we want to shave off the century number and
21741 the time, leaving us with a six-character date. That would be
21742 @samp{%~(cut-left 2)~(max-right 6)~(pad 6)o}. (Cutting is done before
21743 maxing, and we need the padding to ensure that the date is never less
21744 than 6 characters to make it look nice in columns.)
21745
21746 Ignoring is done first; then cutting; then maxing; and then as the very
21747 last operation, padding.
21748
21749 If you use lots of these advanced thingies, you'll find that Gnus gets
21750 quite slow. This can be helped enormously by running @kbd{M-x
21751 gnus-compile} when you are satisfied with the look of your lines.
21752 @xref{Compilation}.
21753
21754
21755 @node User-Defined Specs
21756 @subsection User-Defined Specs
21757
21758 All the specs allow for inserting user defined specifiers---@samp{u}.
21759 The next character in the format string should be a letter. Gnus
21760 will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{X}, where
21761 @samp{X} is the letter following @samp{%u}. The function will be passed
21762 a single parameter---what the parameter means depends on what buffer
21763 it's being called from. The function should return a string, which will
21764 be inserted into the buffer just like information from any other
21765 specifier. This function may also be called with dummy values, so it
21766 should protect against that.
21767
21768 Also Gnus supports extended user-defined specs, such as @samp{%u&foo;}.
21769 Gnus will call the function @code{gnus-user-format-function-}@samp{foo}.
21770
21771 You can also use tilde modifiers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting} to achieve
21772 much the same without defining new functions. Here's an example:
21773 @samp{%~(form (count-lines (point-min) (point)))@@}. The form
21774 given here will be evaluated to yield the current line number, and then
21775 inserted.
21776
21777
21778 @node Formatting Fonts
21779 @subsection Formatting Fonts
21780
21781 @cindex %(, %)
21782 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
21783 There are specs for highlighting, and these are shared by all the format
21784 variables. Text inside the @samp{%(} and @samp{%)} specifiers will get
21785 the special @code{mouse-face} property set, which means that it will be
21786 highlighted (with @code{gnus-mouse-face}) when you put the mouse pointer
21787 over it.
21788
21789 @cindex %@{, %@}
21790 @vindex gnus-face-0
21791 Text inside the @samp{%@{} and @samp{%@}} specifiers will have their
21792 normal faces set using @code{gnus-face-0}, which is @code{bold} by
21793 default. If you say @samp{%1@{}, you'll get @code{gnus-face-1} instead,
21794 and so on. Create as many faces as you wish. The same goes for the
21795 @code{mouse-face} specs---you can say @samp{%3(hello%)} to have
21796 @samp{hello} mouse-highlighted with @code{gnus-mouse-face-3}.
21797
21798 @cindex %<<, %>>, guillemets
21799 @c @cindex %<<, %>>, %«, %», guillemets
21800 @vindex gnus-balloon-face-0
21801 Text inside the @samp{%<<} and @samp{%>>} specifiers will get the
21802 special @code{balloon-help} property set to
21803 @code{gnus-balloon-face-0}. If you say @samp{%1<<}, you'll get
21804 @code{gnus-balloon-face-1} and so on. The @code{gnus-balloon-face-*}
21805 variables should be either strings or symbols naming functions that
21806 return a string. When the mouse passes over text with this property
21807 set, a balloon window will appear and display the string. Please
21808 refer to @ref{Tooltips, ,Tooltips, emacs, The Emacs Manual},
21809 (in GNU Emacs) or the doc string of @code{balloon-help-mode} (in
21810 XEmacs) for more information on this. (For technical reasons, the
21811 guillemets have been approximated as @samp{<<} and @samp{>>} in this
21812 paragraph.)
21813
21814 Here's an alternative recipe for the group buffer:
21815
21816 @lisp
21817 ;; @r{Create three face types.}
21818 (setq gnus-face-1 'bold)
21819 (setq gnus-face-3 'italic)
21820
21821 ;; @r{We want the article count to be in}
21822 ;; @r{a bold and green face. So we create}
21823 ;; @r{a new face called @code{my-green-bold}.}
21824 (copy-face 'bold 'my-green-bold)
21825 ;; @r{Set the color.}
21826 (set-face-foreground 'my-green-bold "ForestGreen")
21827 (setq gnus-face-2 'my-green-bold)
21828
21829 ;; @r{Set the new & fancy format.}
21830 (setq gnus-group-line-format
21831 "%M%S%3@{%5y%@}%2[:%] %(%1@{%g%@}%)\n")
21832 @end lisp
21833
21834 I'm sure you'll be able to use this scheme to create totally unreadable
21835 and extremely vulgar displays. Have fun!
21836
21837 Note that the @samp{%(} specs (and friends) do not make any sense on the
21838 mode-line variables.
21839
21840 @node Positioning Point
21841 @subsection Positioning Point
21842
21843 Gnus usually moves point to a pre-defined place on each line in most
21844 buffers. By default, point move to the first colon character on the
21845 line. You can customize this behavior in three different ways.
21846
21847 You can move the colon character to somewhere else on the line.
21848
21849 @findex gnus-goto-colon
21850 You can redefine the function that moves the point to the colon. The
21851 function is called @code{gnus-goto-colon}.
21852
21853 But perhaps the most convenient way to deal with this, if you don't want
21854 to have a colon in your line, is to use the @samp{%*} specifier. If you
21855 put a @samp{%*} somewhere in your format line definition, Gnus will
21856 place point there.
21857
21858
21859 @node Tabulation
21860 @subsection Tabulation
21861
21862 You can usually line up your displays by padding and cutting your
21863 strings. However, when combining various strings of different size, it
21864 can often be more convenient to just output the strings, and then worry
21865 about lining up the following text afterwards.
21866
21867 To do that, Gnus supplies tabulator specs---@samp{%=}. There are two
21868 different types---@dfn{hard tabulators} and @dfn{soft tabulators}.
21869
21870 @samp{%50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21871 50. If the text is already past column 50, nothing will be inserted.
21872 This is the soft tabulator.
21873
21874 @samp{%-50=} will insert space characters to pad the line up to column
21875 50. If the text is already past column 50, the excess text past column
21876 50 will be removed. This is the hard tabulator.
21877
21878
21879 @node Wide Characters
21880 @subsection Wide Characters
21881
21882 Fixed width fonts in most countries have characters of the same width.
21883 Some countries, however, use Latin characters mixed with wider
21884 characters---most notable East Asian countries.
21885
21886 The problem is that when formatting, Gnus assumes that if a string is 10
21887 characters wide, it'll be 10 Latin characters wide on the screen. In
21888 these countries, that's not true.
21889
21890 @vindex gnus-use-correct-string-widths
21891 To help fix this, you can set @code{gnus-use-correct-string-widths} to
21892 @code{t}. This makes buffer generation slower, but the results will be
21893 prettier. The default value under XEmacs is @code{t} but @code{nil}
21894 for Emacs.
21895
21896
21897 @node Window Layout
21898 @section Window Layout
21899 @cindex window layout
21900
21901 No, there's nothing here about X, so be quiet.
21902
21903 @vindex gnus-use-full-window
21904 If @code{gnus-use-full-window} non-@code{nil}, Gnus will delete all
21905 other windows and occupy the entire Emacs screen by itself. It is
21906 @code{t} by default.
21907
21908 Setting this variable to @code{nil} kinda works, but there are
21909 glitches. Use at your own peril.
21910
21911 @vindex gnus-buffer-configuration
21912 @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} describes how much space each Gnus
21913 buffer should be given. Here's an excerpt of this variable:
21914
21915 @lisp
21916 ((group (vertical 1.0 (group 1.0 point)
21917 (if gnus-carpal (group-carpal 4))))
21918 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21919 (article 1.0))))
21920 @end lisp
21921
21922 This is an alist. The @dfn{key} is a symbol that names some action or
21923 other. For instance, when displaying the group buffer, the window
21924 configuration function will use @code{group} as the key. A full list of
21925 possible names is listed below.
21926
21927 The @dfn{value} (i.e., the @dfn{split}) says how much space each buffer
21928 should occupy. To take the @code{article} split as an example -
21929
21930 @lisp
21931 (article (vertical 1.0 (summary 0.25 point)
21932 (article 1.0)))
21933 @end lisp
21934
21935 This @dfn{split} says that the summary buffer should occupy 25% of upper
21936 half of the screen, and that it is placed over the article buffer. As
21937 you may have noticed, 100% + 25% is actually 125% (yup, I saw y'all
21938 reaching for that calculator there). However, the special number
21939 @code{1.0} is used to signal that this buffer should soak up all the
21940 rest of the space available after the rest of the buffers have taken
21941 whatever they need. There should be only one buffer with the @code{1.0}
21942 size spec per split.
21943
21944 Point will be put in the buffer that has the optional third element
21945 @code{point}. In a @code{frame} split, the last subsplit having a leaf
21946 split where the tag @code{frame-focus} is a member (i.e. is the third or
21947 fourth element in the list, depending on whether the @code{point} tag is
21948 present) gets focus.
21949
21950 Here's a more complicated example:
21951
21952 @lisp
21953 (article (vertical 1.0 (group 4)
21954 (summary 0.25 point)
21955 (if gnus-carpal (summary-carpal 4))
21956 (article 1.0)))
21957 @end lisp
21958
21959 If the size spec is an integer instead of a floating point number,
21960 then that number will be used to say how many lines a buffer should
21961 occupy, not a percentage.
21962
21963 If the @dfn{split} looks like something that can be @code{eval}ed (to be
21964 precise---if the @code{car} of the split is a function or a subr), this
21965 split will be @code{eval}ed. If the result is non-@code{nil}, it will
21966 be used as a split. This means that there will be three buffers if
21967 @code{gnus-carpal} is @code{nil}, and four buffers if @code{gnus-carpal}
21968 is non-@code{nil}.
21969
21970 Not complicated enough for you? Well, try this on for size:
21971
21972 @lisp
21973 (article (horizontal 1.0
21974 (vertical 0.5
21975 (group 1.0)
21976 (gnus-carpal 4))
21977 (vertical 1.0
21978 (summary 0.25 point)
21979 (summary-carpal 4)
21980 (article 1.0))))
21981 @end lisp
21982
21983 Whoops. Two buffers with the mystery 100% tag. And what's that
21984 @code{horizontal} thingie?
21985
21986 If the first element in one of the split is @code{horizontal}, Gnus will
21987 split the window horizontally, giving you two windows side-by-side.
21988 Inside each of these strips you may carry on all you like in the normal
21989 fashion. The number following @code{horizontal} says what percentage of
21990 the screen is to be given to this strip.
21991
21992 For each split, there @emph{must} be one element that has the 100% tag.
21993 The splitting is never accurate, and this buffer will eat any leftover
21994 lines from the splits.
21995
21996 To be slightly more formal, here's a definition of what a valid split
21997 may look like:
21998
21999 @example
22000 @group
22001 split = frame | horizontal | vertical | buffer | form
22002 frame = "(frame " size *split ")"
22003 horizontal = "(horizontal " size *split ")"
22004 vertical = "(vertical " size *split ")"
22005 buffer = "(" buf-name " " size *[ "point" ] *[ "frame-focus"] ")"
22006 size = number | frame-params
22007 buf-name = group | article | summary ...
22008 @end group
22009 @end example
22010
22011 The limitations are that the @code{frame} split can only appear as the
22012 top-level split. @var{form} should be an Emacs Lisp form that should
22013 return a valid split. We see that each split is fully recursive, and
22014 may contain any number of @code{vertical} and @code{horizontal} splits.
22015
22016 @vindex gnus-window-min-width
22017 @vindex gnus-window-min-height
22018 @cindex window height
22019 @cindex window width
22020 Finding the right sizes can be a bit complicated. No window may be less
22021 than @code{gnus-window-min-height} (default 1) characters high, and all
22022 windows must be at least @code{gnus-window-min-width} (default 1)
22023 characters wide. Gnus will try to enforce this before applying the
22024 splits. If you want to use the normal Emacs window width/height limit,
22025 you can just set these two variables to @code{nil}.
22026
22027 If you're not familiar with Emacs terminology, @code{horizontal} and
22028 @code{vertical} splits may work the opposite way of what you'd expect.
22029 Windows inside a @code{horizontal} split are shown side-by-side, and
22030 windows within a @code{vertical} split are shown above each other.
22031
22032 @findex gnus-configure-frame
22033 If you want to experiment with window placement, a good tip is to call
22034 @code{gnus-configure-frame} directly with a split. This is the function
22035 that does all the real work when splitting buffers. Below is a pretty
22036 nonsensical configuration with 5 windows; two for the group buffer and
22037 three for the article buffer. (I said it was nonsensical.) If you
22038 @code{eval} the statement below, you can get an idea of how that would
22039 look straight away, without going through the normal Gnus channels.
22040 Play with it until you're satisfied, and then use
22041 @code{gnus-add-configuration} to add your new creation to the buffer
22042 configuration list.
22043
22044 @lisp
22045 (gnus-configure-frame
22046 '(horizontal 1.0
22047 (vertical 10
22048 (group 1.0)
22049 (article 0.3 point))
22050 (vertical 1.0
22051 (article 1.0)
22052 (horizontal 4
22053 (group 1.0)
22054 (article 10)))))
22055 @end lisp
22056
22057 You might want to have several frames as well. No prob---just use the
22058 @code{frame} split:
22059
22060 @lisp
22061 (gnus-configure-frame
22062 '(frame 1.0
22063 (vertical 1.0
22064 (summary 0.25 point frame-focus)
22065 (article 1.0))
22066 (vertical ((height . 5) (width . 15)
22067 (user-position . t)
22068 (left . -1) (top . 1))
22069 (picon 1.0))))
22070
22071 @end lisp
22072
22073 This split will result in the familiar summary/article window
22074 configuration in the first (or ``main'') frame, while a small additional
22075 frame will be created where picons will be shown. As you can see,
22076 instead of the normal @code{1.0} top-level spec, each additional split
22077 should have a frame parameter alist as the size spec.
22078 @xref{Frame Parameters, , Frame Parameters, elisp, The GNU Emacs Lisp
22079 Reference Manual}. Under XEmacs, a frame property list will be
22080 accepted, too---for instance, @code{(height 5 width 15 left -1 top 1)}
22081 is such a plist.
22082 The list of all possible keys for @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} can
22083 be found in its default value.
22084
22085 Note that the @code{message} key is used for both
22086 @code{gnus-group-mail} and @code{gnus-summary-mail-other-window}. If
22087 it is desirable to distinguish between the two, something like this
22088 might be used:
22089
22090 @lisp
22091 (message (horizontal 1.0
22092 (vertical 1.0 (message 1.0 point))
22093 (vertical 0.24
22094 (if (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer)
22095 '(summary 0.5))
22096 (group 1.0))))
22097 @end lisp
22098
22099 One common desire for a multiple frame split is to have a separate frame
22100 for composing mail and news while leaving the original frame intact. To
22101 accomplish that, something like the following can be done:
22102
22103 @lisp
22104 (message
22105 (frame 1.0
22106 (if (not (buffer-live-p gnus-summary-buffer))
22107 (car (cdr (assoc 'group gnus-buffer-configuration)))
22108 (car (cdr (assoc 'summary gnus-buffer-configuration))))
22109 (vertical ((user-position . t) (top . 1) (left . 1)
22110 (name . "Message"))
22111 (message 1.0 point))))
22112 @end lisp
22113
22114 @findex gnus-add-configuration
22115 Since the @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} variable is so long and
22116 complicated, there's a function you can use to ease changing the config
22117 of a single setting: @code{gnus-add-configuration}. If, for instance,
22118 you want to change the @code{article} setting, you could say:
22119
22120 @lisp
22121 (gnus-add-configuration
22122 '(article (vertical 1.0
22123 (group 4)
22124 (summary .25 point)
22125 (article 1.0))))
22126 @end lisp
22127
22128 You'd typically stick these @code{gnus-add-configuration} calls in your
22129 @file{~/.gnus.el} file or in some startup hook---they should be run after
22130 Gnus has been loaded.
22131
22132 @vindex gnus-always-force-window-configuration
22133 If all windows mentioned in the configuration are already visible, Gnus
22134 won't change the window configuration. If you always want to force the
22135 ``right'' window configuration, you can set
22136 @code{gnus-always-force-window-configuration} to non-@code{nil}.
22137
22138 If you're using tree displays (@pxref{Tree Display}), and the tree
22139 window is displayed vertically next to another window, you may also want
22140 to fiddle with @code{gnus-tree-minimize-window} to avoid having the
22141 windows resized.
22142
22143 @subsection Example Window Configurations
22144
22145 @itemize @bullet
22146 @item
22147 Narrow left hand side occupied by group buffer. Right hand side split
22148 between summary buffer (top one-sixth) and article buffer (bottom).
22149
22150 @ifinfo
22151 @example
22152 +---+---------+
22153 | G | Summary |
22154 | r +---------+
22155 | o | |
22156 | u | Article |
22157 | p | |
22158 +---+---------+
22159 @end example
22160 @end ifinfo
22161
22162 @lisp
22163 (gnus-add-configuration
22164 '(article
22165 (horizontal 1.0
22166 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22167 (vertical 1.0
22168 (summary 0.16 point)
22169 (article 1.0)))))
22170
22171 (gnus-add-configuration
22172 '(summary
22173 (horizontal 1.0
22174 (vertical 25 (group 1.0))
22175 (vertical 1.0 (summary 1.0 point)))))
22176 @end lisp
22177
22178 @end itemize
22179
22180
22181 @node Faces and Fonts
22182 @section Faces and Fonts
22183 @cindex faces
22184 @cindex fonts
22185 @cindex colors
22186
22187 Fiddling with fonts and faces used to be very difficult, but these days
22188 it is very simple. You simply say @kbd{M-x customize-face}, pick out
22189 the face you want to alter, and alter it via the standard Customize
22190 interface.
22191
22192
22193 @node Compilation
22194 @section Compilation
22195 @cindex compilation
22196 @cindex byte-compilation
22197
22198 @findex gnus-compile
22199
22200 Remember all those line format specification variables?
22201 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}, @code{gnus-group-line-format}, and so
22202 on. Now, Gnus will of course heed whatever these variables are, but,
22203 unfortunately, changing them will mean a quite significant slow-down.
22204 (The default values of these variables have byte-compiled functions
22205 associated with them, while the user-generated versions do not, of
22206 course.)
22207
22208 To help with this, you can run @kbd{M-x gnus-compile} after you've
22209 fiddled around with the variables and feel that you're (kind of)
22210 satisfied. This will result in the new specs being byte-compiled, and
22211 you'll get top speed again. Gnus will save these compiled specs in the
22212 @file{.newsrc.eld} file. (User-defined functions aren't compiled by
22213 this function, though---you should compile them yourself by sticking
22214 them into the @file{~/.gnus.el} file and byte-compiling that file.)
22215
22216
22217 @node Mode Lines
22218 @section Mode Lines
22219 @cindex mode lines
22220
22221 @vindex gnus-updated-mode-lines
22222 @code{gnus-updated-mode-lines} says what buffers should keep their mode
22223 lines updated. It is a list of symbols. Supported symbols include
22224 @code{group}, @code{article}, @code{summary}, @code{server},
22225 @code{browse}, and @code{tree}. If the corresponding symbol is present,
22226 Gnus will keep that mode line updated with information that may be
22227 pertinent. If this variable is @code{nil}, screen refresh may be
22228 quicker.
22229
22230 @cindex display-time
22231
22232 @vindex gnus-mode-non-string-length
22233 By default, Gnus displays information on the current article in the mode
22234 lines of the summary and article buffers. The information Gnus wishes
22235 to display (e.g. the subject of the article) is often longer than the
22236 mode lines, and therefore have to be cut off at some point. The
22237 @code{gnus-mode-non-string-length} variable says how long the other
22238 elements on the line is (i.e., the non-info part). If you put
22239 additional elements on the mode line (e.g. a clock), you should modify
22240 this variable:
22241
22242 @c Hook written by Francesco Potorti` <pot@cnuce.cnr.it>
22243 @lisp
22244 (add-hook 'display-time-hook
22245 (lambda () (setq gnus-mode-non-string-length
22246 (+ 21
22247 (if line-number-mode 5 0)
22248 (if column-number-mode 4 0)
22249 (length display-time-string)))))
22250 @end lisp
22251
22252 If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the default), the mode line
22253 strings won't be chopped off, and they won't be padded either. Note
22254 that the default is unlikely to be desirable, as even the percentage
22255 complete in the buffer may be crowded off the mode line; the user should
22256 configure this variable appropriately for her configuration.
22257
22258
22259 @node Highlighting and Menus
22260 @section Highlighting and Menus
22261 @cindex visual
22262 @cindex highlighting
22263 @cindex menus
22264
22265 @vindex gnus-visual
22266 The @code{gnus-visual} variable controls most of the Gnus-prettifying
22267 aspects. If @code{nil}, Gnus won't attempt to create menus or use fancy
22268 colors or fonts. This will also inhibit loading the @file{gnus-vis.el}
22269 file.
22270
22271 This variable can be a list of visual properties that are enabled. The
22272 following elements are valid, and are all included by default:
22273
22274 @table @code
22275 @item group-highlight
22276 Do highlights in the group buffer.
22277 @item summary-highlight
22278 Do highlights in the summary buffer.
22279 @item article-highlight
22280 Do highlights in the article buffer.
22281 @item highlight
22282 Turn on highlighting in all buffers.
22283 @item group-menu
22284 Create menus in the group buffer.
22285 @item summary-menu
22286 Create menus in the summary buffers.
22287 @item article-menu
22288 Create menus in the article buffer.
22289 @item browse-menu
22290 Create menus in the browse buffer.
22291 @item server-menu
22292 Create menus in the server buffer.
22293 @item score-menu
22294 Create menus in the score buffers.
22295 @item menu
22296 Create menus in all buffers.
22297 @end table
22298
22299 So if you only want highlighting in the article buffer and menus in all
22300 buffers, you could say something like:
22301
22302 @lisp
22303 (setq gnus-visual '(article-highlight menu))
22304 @end lisp
22305
22306 If you want highlighting only and no menus whatsoever, you'd say:
22307
22308 @lisp
22309 (setq gnus-visual '(highlight))
22310 @end lisp
22311
22312 If @code{gnus-visual} is @code{t}, highlighting and menus will be used
22313 in all Gnus buffers.
22314
22315 Other general variables that influence the look of all buffers include:
22316
22317 @table @code
22318 @item gnus-mouse-face
22319 @vindex gnus-mouse-face
22320 This is the face (i.e., font) used for mouse highlighting in Gnus. No
22321 mouse highlights will be done if @code{gnus-visual} is @code{nil}.
22322
22323 @end table
22324
22325 There are hooks associated with the creation of all the different menus:
22326
22327 @table @code
22328
22329 @item gnus-article-menu-hook
22330 @vindex gnus-article-menu-hook
22331 Hook called after creating the article mode menu.
22332
22333 @item gnus-group-menu-hook
22334 @vindex gnus-group-menu-hook
22335 Hook called after creating the group mode menu.
22336
22337 @item gnus-summary-menu-hook
22338 @vindex gnus-summary-menu-hook
22339 Hook called after creating the summary mode menu.
22340
22341 @item gnus-server-menu-hook
22342 @vindex gnus-server-menu-hook
22343 Hook called after creating the server mode menu.
22344
22345 @item gnus-browse-menu-hook
22346 @vindex gnus-browse-menu-hook
22347 Hook called after creating the browse mode menu.
22348
22349 @item gnus-score-menu-hook
22350 @vindex gnus-score-menu-hook
22351 Hook called after creating the score mode menu.
22352
22353 @end table
22354
22355
22356 @node Buttons
22357 @section Buttons
22358 @cindex buttons
22359 @cindex mouse
22360 @cindex click
22361
22362 Those new-fangled @dfn{mouse} contraptions is very popular with the
22363 young, hep kids who don't want to learn the proper way to do things
22364 these days. Why, I remember way back in the summer of '89, when I was
22365 using Emacs on a Tops 20 system. Three hundred users on one single
22366 machine, and every user was running Simula compilers. Bah!
22367
22368 Right.
22369
22370 @vindex gnus-carpal
22371 Well, you can make Gnus display bufferfuls of buttons you can click to
22372 do anything by setting @code{gnus-carpal} to @code{t}. Pretty simple,
22373 really. Tell the chiropractor I sent you.
22374
22375
22376 @table @code
22377
22378 @item gnus-carpal-mode-hook
22379 @vindex gnus-carpal-mode-hook
22380 Hook run in all carpal mode buffers.
22381
22382 @item gnus-carpal-button-face
22383 @vindex gnus-carpal-button-face
22384 Face used on buttons.
22385
22386 @item gnus-carpal-header-face
22387 @vindex gnus-carpal-header-face
22388 Face used on carpal buffer headers.
22389
22390 @item gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
22391 @vindex gnus-carpal-group-buffer-buttons
22392 Buttons in the group buffer.
22393
22394 @item gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
22395 @vindex gnus-carpal-summary-buffer-buttons
22396 Buttons in the summary buffer.
22397
22398 @item gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
22399 @vindex gnus-carpal-server-buffer-buttons
22400 Buttons in the server buffer.
22401
22402 @item gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
22403 @vindex gnus-carpal-browse-buffer-buttons
22404 Buttons in the browse buffer.
22405 @end table
22406
22407 All the @code{buttons} variables are lists. The elements in these list
22408 are either cons cells where the @code{car} contains a text to be displayed and
22409 the @code{cdr} contains a function symbol, or a simple string.
22410
22411
22412 @node Daemons
22413 @section Daemons
22414 @cindex demons
22415 @cindex daemons
22416
22417 Gnus, being larger than any program ever written (allegedly), does lots
22418 of strange stuff that you may wish to have done while you're not
22419 present. For instance, you may want it to check for new mail once in a
22420 while. Or you may want it to close down all connections to all servers
22421 when you leave Emacs idle. And stuff like that.
22422
22423 Gnus will let you do stuff like that by defining various
22424 @dfn{handlers}. Each handler consists of three elements: A
22425 @var{function}, a @var{time}, and an @var{idle} parameter.
22426
22427 Here's an example of a handler that closes connections when Emacs has
22428 been idle for thirty minutes:
22429
22430 @lisp
22431 (gnus-demon-close-connections nil 30)
22432 @end lisp
22433
22434 Here's a handler that scans for @acronym{PGP} headers every hour when
22435 Emacs is idle:
22436
22437 @lisp
22438 (gnus-demon-scan-pgp 60 t)
22439 @end lisp
22440
22441 This @var{time} parameter and that @var{idle} parameter work together
22442 in a strange, but wonderful fashion. Basically, if @var{idle} is
22443 @code{nil}, then the function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
22444
22445 If @var{idle} is @code{t}, then the function will be called after
22446 @var{time} minutes only if Emacs is idle. So if Emacs is never idle,
22447 the function will never be called. But once Emacs goes idle, the
22448 function will be called every @var{time} minutes.
22449
22450 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is a number, the function will
22451 be called every @var{time} minutes only when Emacs has been idle for
22452 @var{idle} minutes.
22453
22454 If @var{idle} is a number and @var{time} is @code{nil}, the function
22455 will be called once every time Emacs has been idle for @var{idle}
22456 minutes.
22457
22458 And if @var{time} is a string, it should look like @samp{07:31}, and
22459 the function will then be called once every day somewhere near that
22460 time. Modified by the @var{idle} parameter, of course.
22461
22462 @vindex gnus-demon-timestep
22463 (When I say ``minute'' here, I really mean @code{gnus-demon-timestep}
22464 seconds. This is 60 by default. If you change that variable,
22465 all the timings in the handlers will be affected.)
22466
22467 So, if you want to add a handler, you could put something like this in
22468 your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22469
22470 @findex gnus-demon-add-handler
22471 @lisp
22472 (gnus-demon-add-handler 'gnus-demon-close-connections 30 t)
22473 @end lisp
22474
22475 @findex gnus-demon-add-nocem
22476 @findex gnus-demon-add-scanmail
22477 @findex gnus-demon-add-rescan
22478 @findex gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps
22479 @findex gnus-demon-add-disconnection
22480 Some ready-made functions to do this have been created:
22481 @code{gnus-demon-add-nocem}, @code{gnus-demon-add-disconnection},
22482 @code{gnus-demon-add-nntp-close-connection},
22483 @code{gnus-demon-add-scan-timestamps}, @code{gnus-demon-add-rescan}, and
22484 @code{gnus-demon-add-scanmail}. Just put those functions in your
22485 @file{~/.gnus.el} if you want those abilities.
22486
22487 @findex gnus-demon-init
22488 @findex gnus-demon-cancel
22489 @vindex gnus-demon-handlers
22490 If you add handlers to @code{gnus-demon-handlers} directly, you should
22491 run @code{gnus-demon-init} to make the changes take hold. To cancel all
22492 daemons, you can use the @code{gnus-demon-cancel} function.
22493
22494 Note that adding daemons can be pretty naughty if you over do it. Adding
22495 functions that scan all news and mail from all servers every two seconds
22496 is a sure-fire way of getting booted off any respectable system. So
22497 behave.
22498
22499
22500 @node NoCeM
22501 @section NoCeM
22502 @cindex nocem
22503 @cindex spam
22504
22505 @dfn{Spamming} is posting the same article lots and lots of times.
22506 Spamming is bad. Spamming is evil.
22507
22508 Spamming is usually canceled within a day or so by various anti-spamming
22509 agencies. These agencies usually also send out @dfn{NoCeM} messages.
22510 NoCeM is pronounced ``no see-'em'', and means what the name
22511 implies---these are messages that make the offending articles, like, go
22512 away.
22513
22514 What use are these NoCeM messages if the articles are canceled anyway?
22515 Some sites do not honor cancel messages and some sites just honor cancels
22516 from a select few people. Then you may wish to make use of the NoCeM
22517 messages, which are distributed in the @samp{alt.nocem.misc} newsgroup.
22518
22519 Gnus can read and parse the messages in this group automatically, and
22520 this will make spam disappear.
22521
22522 There are some variables to customize, of course:
22523
22524 @table @code
22525 @item gnus-use-nocem
22526 @vindex gnus-use-nocem
22527 Set this variable to @code{t} to set the ball rolling. It is @code{nil}
22528 by default.
22529
22530 You can also set this variable to a positive number as a group level.
22531 In that case, Gnus scans NoCeM messages when checking new news if this
22532 value is not exceeding a group level that you specify as the prefix
22533 argument to some commands, e.g. @code{gnus},
22534 @code{gnus-group-get-new-news}, etc. Otherwise, Gnus does not scan
22535 NoCeM messages if you specify a group level to those commands. For
22536 example, if you use 1 or 2 on the mail groups and the levels on the news
22537 groups remain the default, 3 is the best choice.
22538
22539 @item gnus-nocem-groups
22540 @vindex gnus-nocem-groups
22541 Gnus will look for NoCeM messages in the groups in this list. The
22542 default is
22543 @lisp
22544 ("news.lists.filters" "news.admin.net-abuse.bulletins"
22545 "alt.nocem.misc" "news.admin.net-abuse.announce")
22546 @end lisp
22547
22548 @item gnus-nocem-issuers
22549 @vindex gnus-nocem-issuers
22550 There are many people issuing NoCeM messages. This list says what
22551 people you want to listen to. The default is
22552 @lisp
22553 ("Automoose-1" "clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca"
22554 "cosmo.roadkill" "SpamHippo" "hweede@@snafu.de")
22555 @end lisp
22556 fine, upstanding citizens all of them.
22557
22558 Known despammers that you can put in this list are listed at@*
22559 @uref{http://www.xs4all.nl/~rosalind/nocemreg/nocemreg.html}.
22560
22561 You do not have to heed NoCeM messages from all these people---just the
22562 ones you want to listen to. You also don't have to accept all NoCeM
22563 messages from the people you like. Each NoCeM message has a @dfn{type}
22564 header that gives the message a (more or less, usually less) rigorous
22565 definition. Common types are @samp{spam}, @samp{spew}, @samp{mmf},
22566 @samp{binary}, and @samp{troll}. To specify this, you have to use
22567 @code{(@var{issuer} @var{conditions} @dots{})} elements in the list.
22568 Each condition is either a string (which is a regexp that matches types
22569 you want to use) or a list on the form @code{(not @var{string})}, where
22570 @var{string} is a regexp that matches types you don't want to use.
22571
22572 For instance, if you want all NoCeM messages from Chris Lewis except his
22573 @samp{troll} messages, you'd say:
22574
22575 @lisp
22576 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" ".*" (not "troll"))
22577 @end lisp
22578
22579 On the other hand, if you just want nothing but his @samp{spam} and
22580 @samp{spew} messages, you'd say:
22581
22582 @lisp
22583 ("clewis@@ferret.ocunix.on.ca" (not ".*") "spew" "spam")
22584 @end lisp
22585
22586 The specs are applied left-to-right.
22587
22588
22589 @item gnus-nocem-verifyer
22590 @vindex gnus-nocem-verifyer
22591 @findex pgg-verify
22592 This should be a function for verifying that the NoCeM issuer is who she
22593 says she is. The default is @code{pgg-verify}, which returns
22594 non-@code{nil} if the verification is successful, otherwise (including
22595 the case the NoCeM message was not signed) returns @code{nil}. If this
22596 is too slow and you don't care for verification (which may be dangerous),
22597 you can set this variable to @code{nil}.
22598
22599 Formerly the default was @code{mc-verify}, which is a Mailcrypt
22600 function. While you can still use it, you can change it into
22601 @code{pgg-verify} running with GnuPG if you are willing to add the
22602 @acronym{PGP} public keys to GnuPG's keyring.
22603
22604 @item gnus-nocem-directory
22605 @vindex gnus-nocem-directory
22606 This is where Gnus will store its NoCeM cache files. The default is@*
22607 @file{~/News/NoCeM/}.
22608
22609 @item gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
22610 @vindex gnus-nocem-expiry-wait
22611 The number of days before removing old NoCeM entries from the cache.
22612 The default is 15. If you make it shorter Gnus will be faster, but you
22613 might then see old spam.
22614
22615 @item gnus-nocem-check-from
22616 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-from
22617 Non-@code{nil} means check for valid issuers in message bodies.
22618 Otherwise don't bother fetching articles unless their author matches a
22619 valid issuer; that is much faster if you are selective about the
22620 issuers.
22621
22622 @item gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22623 @vindex gnus-nocem-check-article-limit
22624 If non-@code{nil}, the maximum number of articles to check in any NoCeM
22625 group. NoCeM groups can be huge and very slow to process.
22626
22627 @end table
22628
22629 Using NoCeM could potentially be a memory hog. If you have many living
22630 (i. e., subscribed or unsubscribed groups), your Emacs process will grow
22631 big. If this is a problem, you should kill off all (or most) of your
22632 unsubscribed groups (@pxref{Subscription Commands}).
22633
22634
22635 @node Undo
22636 @section Undo
22637 @cindex undo
22638
22639 It is very useful to be able to undo actions one has done. In normal
22640 Emacs buffers, it's easy enough---you just push the @code{undo} button.
22641 In Gnus buffers, however, it isn't that simple.
22642
22643 The things Gnus displays in its buffer is of no value whatsoever to
22644 Gnus---it's all just data designed to look nice to the user.
22645 Killing a group in the group buffer with @kbd{C-k} makes the line
22646 disappear, but that's just a side-effect of the real action---the
22647 removal of the group in question from the internal Gnus structures.
22648 Undoing something like that can't be done by the normal Emacs
22649 @code{undo} function.
22650
22651 Gnus tries to remedy this somewhat by keeping track of what the user
22652 does and coming up with actions that would reverse the actions the user
22653 takes. When the user then presses the @code{undo} key, Gnus will run
22654 the code to reverse the previous action, or the previous actions.
22655 However, not all actions are easily reversible, so Gnus currently offers
22656 a few key functions to be undoable. These include killing groups,
22657 yanking groups, and changing the list of read articles of groups.
22658 That's it, really. More functions may be added in the future, but each
22659 added function means an increase in data to be stored, so Gnus will
22660 never be totally undoable.
22661
22662 @findex gnus-undo-mode
22663 @vindex gnus-use-undo
22664 @findex gnus-undo
22665 The undoability is provided by the @code{gnus-undo-mode} minor mode. It
22666 is used if @code{gnus-use-undo} is non-@code{nil}, which is the
22667 default. The @kbd{C-M-_} key performs the @code{gnus-undo}
22668 command, which should feel kinda like the normal Emacs @code{undo}
22669 command.
22670
22671
22672 @node Predicate Specifiers
22673 @section Predicate Specifiers
22674 @cindex predicate specifiers
22675
22676 Some Gnus variables are @dfn{predicate specifiers}. This is a special
22677 form that allows flexible specification of predicates without having
22678 to type all that much.
22679
22680 These specifiers are lists consisting of functions, symbols and lists.
22681
22682 Here's an example:
22683
22684 @lisp
22685 (or gnus-article-unseen-p
22686 gnus-article-unread-p)
22687 @end lisp
22688
22689 The available symbols are @code{or}, @code{and} and @code{not}. The
22690 functions all take one parameter.
22691
22692 @findex gnus-make-predicate
22693 Internally, Gnus calls @code{gnus-make-predicate} on these specifiers
22694 to create a function that can be called. This input parameter to this
22695 function will be passed along to all the functions in the predicate
22696 specifier.
22697
22698
22699 @node Moderation
22700 @section Moderation
22701 @cindex moderation
22702
22703 If you are a moderator, you can use the @file{gnus-mdrtn.el} package.
22704 It is not included in the standard Gnus package. Write a mail to
22705 @samp{larsi@@gnus.org} and state what group you moderate, and you'll
22706 get a copy.
22707
22708 The moderation package is implemented as a minor mode for summary
22709 buffers. Put
22710
22711 @lisp
22712 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-moderate)
22713 @end lisp
22714
22715 in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file.
22716
22717 If you are the moderator of @samp{rec.zoofle}, this is how it's
22718 supposed to work:
22719
22720 @enumerate
22721 @item
22722 You split your incoming mail by matching on
22723 @samp{Newsgroups:.*rec.zoofle}, which will put all the to-be-posted
22724 articles in some mail group---for instance, @samp{nnml:rec.zoofle}.
22725
22726 @item
22727 You enter that group once in a while and post articles using the @kbd{e}
22728 (edit-and-post) or @kbd{s} (just send unedited) commands.
22729
22730 @item
22731 If, while reading the @samp{rec.zoofle} newsgroup, you happen upon some
22732 articles that weren't approved by you, you can cancel them with the
22733 @kbd{c} command.
22734 @end enumerate
22735
22736 To use moderation mode in these two groups, say:
22737
22738 @lisp
22739 (setq gnus-moderated-list
22740 "^nnml:rec.zoofle$\\|^rec.zoofle$")
22741 @end lisp
22742
22743
22744 @node Fetching a Group
22745 @section Fetching a Group
22746 @cindex fetching a group
22747
22748 @findex gnus-fetch-group
22749 It is sometimes convenient to be able to just say ``I want to read this
22750 group and I don't care whether Gnus has been started or not''. This is
22751 perhaps more useful for people who write code than for users, but the
22752 command @code{gnus-fetch-group} provides this functionality in any case.
22753 It takes the group name as a parameter.
22754
22755
22756 @node Image Enhancements
22757 @section Image Enhancements
22758
22759 XEmacs, as well as Emacs 21@footnote{Emacs 21 on MS Windows doesn't
22760 support images, Emacs 22 does.} and up, are able to display pictures and
22761 stuff, so Gnus has taken advantage of that.
22762
22763 @menu
22764 * X-Face:: Display a funky, teensy black-and-white image.
22765 * Face:: Display a funkier, teensier colored image.
22766 * Smileys:: Show all those happy faces the way they were meant to be shown.
22767 * Picons:: How to display pictures of what you're reading.
22768 * XVarious:: Other XEmacsy Gnusey variables.
22769 @end menu
22770
22771
22772 @node X-Face
22773 @subsection X-Face
22774 @cindex x-face
22775
22776 @code{X-Face} headers describe a 48x48 pixel black-and-white (1 bit
22777 depth) image that's supposed to represent the author of the message.
22778 It seems to be supported by an ever-growing number of mail and news
22779 readers.
22780
22781 @cindex x-face
22782 @findex gnus-article-display-x-face
22783 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-command
22784 @vindex gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly
22785 @iftex
22786 @iflatex
22787 \include{xface}
22788 @end iflatex
22789 @end iftex
22790 @c @anchor{X-Face}
22791
22792 Viewing an @code{X-Face} header either requires an Emacs that has
22793 @samp{compface} support (which most XEmacs versions have), or that you
22794 have suitable conversion or display programs installed. If your Emacs
22795 has image support the default action is to display the face before the
22796 @code{From} header. If there's no native @code{X-Face} support, Gnus
22797 will try to convert the @code{X-Face} header using external programs
22798 from the @code{pbmplus} package and friends, see below. For XEmacs it's
22799 faster if XEmacs has been compiled with @code{X-Face} support. The
22800 default action under Emacs without image support is to fork off the
22801 @code{display} program.
22802
22803 On a GNU/Linux system, the @code{display} program is included in the
22804 ImageMagick package. For external conversion programs look for packages
22805 with names like @code{netpbm}, @code{libgr-progs} and @code{compface}.
22806 On Windows, you may use the packages @code{netpbm} and @code{compface}
22807 from @url{http://gnuwin32.sourceforge.net}. You need to add the
22808 @code{bin} directory to your @code{PATH} environment variable.
22809 @c In fact only the following DLLs and binaries seem to be required:
22810 @c compface1.dll uncompface.exe libnetpbm10.dll icontopbm.exe
22811
22812 The variable @code{gnus-article-x-face-command} controls which programs
22813 are used to display the @code{X-Face} header. If this variable is a
22814 string, this string will be executed in a sub-shell. If it is a
22815 function, this function will be called with the face as the argument.
22816 If @code{gnus-article-x-face-too-ugly} (which is a regexp) matches the
22817 @code{From} header, the face will not be shown.
22818
22819 (Note: @code{x-face} is used in the variable/function names, not
22820 @code{xface}).
22821
22822 @noindent
22823 Face and variable:
22824
22825 @table @code
22826 @item gnus-x-face
22827 @vindex gnus-x-face
22828 Face to show X-Face. The colors from this face are used as the
22829 foreground and background colors of the displayed X-Faces. The
22830 default colors are black and white.
22831 @end table
22832
22833 If you use posting styles, you can use an @code{x-face-file} entry in
22834 @code{gnus-posting-styles}, @xref{Posting Styles}. If you don't, Gnus
22835 provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow easier
22836 insertion of X-Face headers in outgoing messages. You also need the
22837 above mentioned ImageMagick, netpbm or other image conversion packages
22838 (depending the values of the variables below) for these functions.
22839
22840 @findex gnus-random-x-face
22841 @vindex gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command
22842 @vindex gnus-x-face-directory
22843 @code{gnus-random-x-face} goes through all the @samp{pbm} files in
22844 @code{gnus-x-face-directory} and picks one at random, and then
22845 converts it to the X-Face format by using the
22846 @code{gnus-convert-pbm-to-x-face-command} shell command. The
22847 @samp{pbm} files should be 48x48 pixels big. It returns the X-Face
22848 header data as a string.
22849
22850 @findex gnus-insert-random-x-face-header
22851 @code{gnus-insert-random-x-face-header} calls
22852 @code{gnus-random-x-face} and inserts a @samp{X-Face} header with the
22853 randomly generated data.
22854
22855 @findex gnus-x-face-from-file
22856 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command
22857 @code{gnus-x-face-from-file} takes a GIF file as the parameter, and then
22858 converts the file to X-Face format by using the
22859 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-x-face-command} shell command.
22860
22861 Here's how you would typically use the first function. Put something
22862 like the following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22863
22864 @lisp
22865 (setq message-required-news-headers
22866 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22867 (list '(X-Face . gnus-random-x-face))))
22868 @end lisp
22869
22870 Using the last function would be something like this:
22871
22872 @lisp
22873 (setq message-required-news-headers
22874 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22875 (list '(X-Face . (lambda ()
22876 (gnus-x-face-from-file
22877 "~/My-face.gif"))))))
22878 @end lisp
22879
22880
22881 @node Face
22882 @subsection Face
22883 @cindex face
22884
22885 @c #### FIXME: faces and x-faces' implementations should really be harmonized.
22886
22887 @code{Face} headers are essentially a funkier version of @code{X-Face}
22888 ones. They describe a 48x48 pixel colored image that's supposed to
22889 represent the author of the message.
22890
22891 @cindex face
22892 @findex gnus-article-display-face
22893 The contents of a @code{Face} header must be a base64 encoded PNG image.
22894 See @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/circus/face/} for the precise
22895 specifications.
22896
22897 Viewing an @code{Face} header requires an Emacs that is able to display
22898 PNG images.
22899 @c Maybe add this:
22900 @c (if (featurep 'xemacs)
22901 @c (featurep 'png)
22902 @c (image-type-available-p 'png))
22903
22904 Gnus provides a few convenience functions and variables to allow
22905 easier insertion of Face headers in outgoing messages.
22906
22907 @findex gnus-convert-png-to-face
22908 @code{gnus-convert-png-to-face} takes a 48x48 PNG image, no longer than
22909 726 bytes long, and converts it to a face.
22910
22911 @findex gnus-face-from-file
22912 @vindex gnus-convert-image-to-face-command
22913 @code{gnus-face-from-file} takes a JPEG file as the parameter, and then
22914 converts the file to Face format by using the
22915 @code{gnus-convert-image-to-face-command} shell command.
22916
22917 Here's how you would typically use this function. Put something like the
22918 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22919
22920 @lisp
22921 (setq message-required-news-headers
22922 (nconc message-required-news-headers
22923 (list '(Face . (lambda ()
22924 (gnus-face-from-file "~/face.jpg"))))))
22925 @end lisp
22926
22927
22928 @node Smileys
22929 @subsection Smileys
22930 @cindex smileys
22931
22932 @iftex
22933 @iflatex
22934 \gnusfig{-3cm}{0.5cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/BigFace,height=20cm}}
22935 \input{smiley}
22936 @end iflatex
22937 @end iftex
22938
22939 @dfn{Smiley} is a package separate from Gnus, but since Gnus is
22940 currently the only package that uses Smiley, it is documented here.
22941
22942 In short---to use Smiley in Gnus, put the following in your
22943 @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
22944
22945 @lisp
22946 (setq gnus-treat-display-smileys t)
22947 @end lisp
22948
22949 Smiley maps text smiley faces---@samp{:-)}, @samp{8-)}, @samp{:-(} and
22950 the like---to pictures and displays those instead of the text smiley
22951 faces. The conversion is controlled by a list of regexps that matches
22952 text and maps that to file names.
22953
22954 @vindex smiley-regexp-alist
22955 The alist used is specified by the @code{smiley-regexp-alist}
22956 variable. The first item in each element is the regexp to be matched;
22957 the second element is the regexp match group that is to be replaced by
22958 the picture; and the third element is the name of the file to be
22959 displayed.
22960
22961 The following variables customize where Smiley will look for these
22962 files:
22963
22964 @table @code
22965
22966 @item smiley-data-directory
22967 @vindex smiley-data-directory
22968 Where Smiley will look for smiley faces files.
22969
22970 @item gnus-smiley-file-types
22971 @vindex gnus-smiley-file-types
22972 List of suffixes on smiley file names to try.
22973
22974 @end table
22975
22976
22977 @node Picons
22978 @subsection Picons
22979
22980 @iftex
22981 @iflatex
22982 \include{picons}
22983 @end iflatex
22984 @end iftex
22985
22986 So@dots{} You want to slow down your news reader even more! This is a
22987 good way to do so. It's also a great way to impress people staring
22988 over your shoulder as you read news.
22989
22990 What are Picons? To quote directly from the Picons Web site:
22991
22992 @iftex
22993 @iflatex
22994 \margindex{}
22995 @end iflatex
22996 @end iftex
22997
22998 @quotation
22999 @dfn{Picons} is short for ``personal icons''. They're small,
23000 constrained images used to represent users and domains on the net,
23001 organized into databases so that the appropriate image for a given
23002 e-mail address can be found. Besides users and domains, there are picon
23003 databases for Usenet newsgroups and weather forecasts. The picons are
23004 in either monochrome @code{XBM} format or color @code{XPM} and
23005 @code{GIF} formats.
23006 @end quotation
23007
23008 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23009 For instructions on obtaining and installing the picons databases,
23010 point your Web browser at
23011 @uref{http://www.cs.indiana.edu/picons/ftp/index.html}.
23012
23013 If you are using Debian GNU/Linux, saying @samp{apt-get install
23014 picons.*} will install the picons where Gnus can find them.
23015
23016 To enable displaying picons, simply make sure that
23017 @code{gnus-picon-databases} points to the directory containing the
23018 Picons databases.
23019
23020 The following variables offer control over where things are located.
23021
23022 @table @code
23023
23024 @item gnus-picon-databases
23025 @vindex gnus-picon-databases
23026 The location of the picons database. This is a list of directories
23027 containing the @file{news}, @file{domains}, @file{users} (and so on)
23028 subdirectories. Defaults to @code{("/usr/lib/picon"
23029 "/usr/local/faces")}.
23030
23031 @item gnus-picon-news-directories
23032 @vindex gnus-picon-news-directories
23033 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23034 newsgroups faces. @code{("news")} is the default.
23035
23036 @item gnus-picon-user-directories
23037 @vindex gnus-picon-user-directories
23038 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for user
23039 faces. @code{("users" "usenix" "local" "misc")} is the default.
23040
23041 @item gnus-picon-domain-directories
23042 @vindex gnus-picon-domain-directories
23043 List of subdirectories to search in @code{gnus-picon-databases} for
23044 domain name faces. Defaults to @code{("domains")}. Some people may
23045 want to add @samp{"unknown"} to this list.
23046
23047 @item gnus-picon-file-types
23048 @vindex gnus-picon-file-types
23049 Ordered list of suffixes on picon file names to try. Defaults to
23050 @code{("xpm" "gif" "xbm")} minus those not built-in your Emacs.
23051
23052 @end table
23053
23054
23055 @node XVarious
23056 @subsection Various XEmacs Variables
23057
23058 @table @code
23059 @item gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23060 @vindex gnus-xmas-glyph-directory
23061 This is where Gnus will look for pictures. Gnus will normally
23062 auto-detect this directory, but you may set it manually if you have an
23063 unusual directory structure.
23064
23065 @item gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23066 @vindex gnus-xmas-modeline-glyph
23067 A glyph displayed in all Gnus mode lines. It is a tiny gnu head by
23068 default.
23069
23070 @end table
23071
23072 @subsubsection Toolbar
23073
23074 @table @code
23075
23076 @item gnus-use-toolbar
23077 @vindex gnus-use-toolbar
23078 This variable specifies the position to display the toolbar. If
23079 @code{nil}, don't display toolbars. If it is non-@code{nil}, it should
23080 be one of the symbols @code{default}, @code{top}, @code{bottom},
23081 @code{right}, and @code{left}. @code{default} means to use the default
23082 toolbar, the rest mean to display the toolbar on the place which those
23083 names show. The default is @code{default}.
23084
23085 @item gnus-toolbar-thickness
23086 @vindex gnus-toolbar-thickness
23087 Cons of the height and the width specifying the thickness of a toolbar.
23088 The height is used for the toolbar displayed on the top or the bottom,
23089 the width is used for the toolbar displayed on the right or the left.
23090 The default is that of the default toolbar.
23091
23092 @item gnus-group-toolbar
23093 @vindex gnus-group-toolbar
23094 The toolbar in the group buffer.
23095
23096 @item gnus-summary-toolbar
23097 @vindex gnus-summary-toolbar
23098 The toolbar in the summary buffer.
23099
23100 @item gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23101 @vindex gnus-summary-mail-toolbar
23102 The toolbar in the summary buffer of mail groups.
23103
23104 @end table
23105
23106 @iftex
23107 @iflatex
23108 \margindex{}
23109 @end iflatex
23110 @end iftex
23111
23112
23113 @node Fuzzy Matching
23114 @section Fuzzy Matching
23115 @cindex fuzzy matching
23116
23117 Gnus provides @dfn{fuzzy matching} of @code{Subject} lines when doing
23118 things like scoring, thread gathering and thread comparison.
23119
23120 As opposed to regular expression matching, fuzzy matching is very fuzzy.
23121 It's so fuzzy that there's not even a definition of what @dfn{fuzziness}
23122 means, and the implementation has changed over time.
23123
23124 Basically, it tries to remove all noise from lines before comparing.
23125 @samp{Re: }, parenthetical remarks, white space, and so on, are filtered
23126 out of the strings before comparing the results. This often leads to
23127 adequate results---even when faced with strings generated by text
23128 manglers masquerading as newsreaders.
23129
23130
23131 @node Thwarting Email Spam
23132 @section Thwarting Email Spam
23133 @cindex email spam
23134 @cindex spam
23135 @cindex UCE
23136 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23137
23138 In these last days of the Usenet, commercial vultures are hanging about
23139 and grepping through news like crazy to find email addresses they can
23140 foist off their scams and products to. As a reaction to this, many
23141 people have started putting nonsense addresses into their @code{From}
23142 lines. I think this is counterproductive---it makes it difficult for
23143 people to send you legitimate mail in response to things you write, as
23144 well as making it difficult to see who wrote what. This rewriting may
23145 perhaps be a bigger menace than the unsolicited commercial email itself
23146 in the end.
23147
23148 The biggest problem I have with email spam is that it comes in under
23149 false pretenses. I press @kbd{g} and Gnus merrily informs me that I
23150 have 10 new emails. I say ``Golly gee! Happy is me!'' and select the
23151 mail group, only to find two pyramid schemes, seven advertisements
23152 (``New! Miracle tonic for growing full, lustrous hair on your toes!'')
23153 and one mail asking me to repent and find some god.
23154
23155 This is annoying. Here's what you can do about it.
23156
23157 @menu
23158 * The problem of spam:: Some background, and some solutions
23159 * Anti-Spam Basics:: Simple steps to reduce the amount of spam.
23160 * SpamAssassin:: How to use external anti-spam tools.
23161 * Hashcash:: Reduce spam by burning CPU time.
23162 @end menu
23163
23164 @node The problem of spam
23165 @subsection The problem of spam
23166 @cindex email spam
23167 @cindex spam filtering approaches
23168 @cindex filtering approaches, spam
23169 @cindex UCE
23170 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23171
23172 First, some background on spam.
23173
23174 If you have access to e-mail, you are familiar with spam (technically
23175 termed @acronym{UCE}, Unsolicited Commercial E-mail). Simply put, it
23176 exists because e-mail delivery is very cheap compared to paper mail,
23177 so only a very small percentage of people need to respond to an UCE to
23178 make it worthwhile to the advertiser. Ironically, one of the most
23179 common spams is the one offering a database of e-mail addresses for
23180 further spamming. Senders of spam are usually called @emph{spammers},
23181 but terms like @emph{vermin}, @emph{scum}, @emph{sociopaths}, and
23182 @emph{morons} are in common use as well.
23183
23184 Spam comes from a wide variety of sources. It is simply impossible to
23185 dispose of all spam without discarding useful messages. A good
23186 example is the TMDA system, which requires senders
23187 unknown to you to confirm themselves as legitimate senders before
23188 their e-mail can reach you. Without getting into the technical side
23189 of TMDA, a downside is clearly that e-mail from legitimate sources may
23190 be discarded if those sources can't or won't confirm themselves
23191 through the TMDA system. Another problem with TMDA is that it
23192 requires its users to have a basic understanding of e-mail delivery
23193 and processing.
23194
23195 The simplest approach to filtering spam is filtering, at the mail
23196 server or when you sort through incoming mail. If you get 200 spam
23197 messages per day from @samp{random-address@@vmadmin.com}, you block
23198 @samp{vmadmin.com}. If you get 200 messages about @samp{VIAGRA}, you
23199 discard all messages with @samp{VIAGRA} in the message. If you get
23200 lots of spam from Bulgaria, for example, you try to filter all mail
23201 from Bulgarian IPs.
23202
23203 This, unfortunately, is a great way to discard legitimate e-mail. The
23204 risks of blocking a whole country (Bulgaria, Norway, Nigeria, China,
23205 etc.) or even a continent (Asia, Africa, Europe, etc.) from contacting
23206 you should be obvious, so don't do it if you have the choice.
23207
23208 In another instance, the very informative and useful RISKS digest has
23209 been blocked by overzealous mail filters because it @strong{contained}
23210 words that were common in spam messages. Nevertheless, in isolated
23211 cases, with great care, direct filtering of mail can be useful.
23212
23213 Another approach to filtering e-mail is the distributed spam
23214 processing, for instance DCC implements such a system. In essence,
23215 @var{N} systems around the world agree that a machine @var{X} in
23216 Ghana, Estonia, or California is sending out spam e-mail, and these
23217 @var{N} systems enter @var{X} or the spam e-mail from @var{X} into a
23218 database. The criteria for spam detection vary---it may be the number
23219 of messages sent, the content of the messages, and so on. When a user
23220 of the distributed processing system wants to find out if a message is
23221 spam, he consults one of those @var{N} systems.
23222
23223 Distributed spam processing works very well against spammers that send
23224 a large number of messages at once, but it requires the user to set up
23225 fairly complicated checks. There are commercial and free distributed
23226 spam processing systems. Distributed spam processing has its risks as
23227 well. For instance legitimate e-mail senders have been accused of
23228 sending spam, and their web sites and mailing lists have been shut
23229 down for some time because of the incident.
23230
23231 The statistical approach to spam filtering is also popular. It is
23232 based on a statistical analysis of previous spam messages. Usually
23233 the analysis is a simple word frequency count, with perhaps pairs of
23234 words or 3-word combinations thrown into the mix. Statistical
23235 analysis of spam works very well in most of the cases, but it can
23236 classify legitimate e-mail as spam in some cases. It takes time to
23237 run the analysis, the full message must be analyzed, and the user has
23238 to store the database of spam analysis. Statistical analysis on the
23239 server is gaining popularity. This has the advantage of letting the
23240 user Just Read Mail, but has the disadvantage that it's harder to tell
23241 the server that it has misclassified mail.
23242
23243 Fighting spam is not easy, no matter what anyone says. There is no
23244 magic switch that will distinguish Viagra ads from Mom's e-mails.
23245 Even people are having a hard time telling spam apart from non-spam,
23246 because spammers are actively looking to fool us into thinking they
23247 are Mom, essentially. Spamming is irritating, irresponsible, and
23248 idiotic behavior from a bunch of people who think the world owes them
23249 a favor. We hope the following sections will help you in fighting the
23250 spam plague.
23251
23252 @node Anti-Spam Basics
23253 @subsection Anti-Spam Basics
23254 @cindex email spam
23255 @cindex spam
23256 @cindex UCE
23257 @cindex unsolicited commercial email
23258
23259 One way of dealing with spam is having Gnus split out all spam into a
23260 @samp{spam} mail group (@pxref{Splitting Mail}).
23261
23262 First, pick one (1) valid mail address that you can be reached at, and
23263 put it in your @code{From} header of all your news articles. (I've
23264 chosen @samp{larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no}, but for many addresses on the form
23265 @samp{larsi+usenet@@ifi.uio.no} will be a better choice. Ask your
23266 sysadmin whether your sendmail installation accepts keywords in the local
23267 part of the mail address.)
23268
23269 @lisp
23270 (setq message-default-news-headers
23271 "From: Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen <larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no>\n")
23272 @end lisp
23273
23274 Then put the following split rule in @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
23275 (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23276
23277 @lisp
23278 (...
23279 (to "larsi@@trym.ifi.uio.no"
23280 (| ("subject" "re:.*" "misc")
23281 ("references" ".*@@.*" "misc")
23282 "spam"))
23283 ...)
23284 @end lisp
23285
23286 This says that all mail to this address is suspect, but if it has a
23287 @code{Subject} that starts with a @samp{Re:} or has a @code{References}
23288 header, it's probably ok. All the rest goes to the @samp{spam} group.
23289 (This idea probably comes from Tim Pierce.)
23290
23291 In addition, many mail spammers talk directly to your @acronym{SMTP} server
23292 and do not include your email address explicitly in the @code{To}
23293 header. Why they do this is unknown---perhaps it's to thwart this
23294 thwarting scheme? In any case, this is trivial to deal with---you just
23295 put anything not addressed to you in the @samp{spam} group by ending
23296 your fancy split rule in this way:
23297
23298 @lisp
23299 (
23300 ...
23301 (to "larsi" "misc")
23302 "spam")
23303 @end lisp
23304
23305 In my experience, this will sort virtually everything into the right
23306 group. You still have to check the @samp{spam} group from time to time to
23307 check for legitimate mail, though. If you feel like being a good net
23308 citizen, you can even send off complaints to the proper authorities on
23309 each unsolicited commercial email---at your leisure.
23310
23311 This works for me. It allows people an easy way to contact me (they can
23312 just press @kbd{r} in the usual way), and I'm not bothered at all with
23313 spam. It's a win-win situation. Forging @code{From} headers to point
23314 to non-existent domains is yucky, in my opinion.
23315
23316 Be careful with this approach. Spammers are wise to it.
23317
23318
23319 @node SpamAssassin
23320 @subsection SpamAssassin, Vipul's Razor, DCC, etc
23321 @cindex SpamAssassin
23322 @cindex Vipul's Razor
23323 @cindex DCC
23324
23325 The days where the hints in the previous section were sufficient in
23326 avoiding spam are coming to an end. There are many tools out there
23327 that claim to reduce the amount of spam you get. This section could
23328 easily become outdated fast, as new products replace old, but
23329 fortunately most of these tools seem to have similar interfaces. Even
23330 though this section will use SpamAssassin as an example, it should be
23331 easy to adapt it to most other tools.
23332
23333 Note that this section does not involve the @code{spam.el} package,
23334 which is discussed in the next section. If you don't care for all
23335 the features of @code{spam.el}, you can make do with these simple
23336 recipes.
23337
23338 If the tool you are using is not installed on the mail server, you
23339 need to invoke it yourself. Ideas on how to use the
23340 @code{:postscript} mail source parameter (@pxref{Mail Source
23341 Specifiers}) follow.
23342
23343 @lisp
23344 (setq mail-sources
23345 '((file :prescript "formail -bs spamassassin < /var/mail/%u")
23346 (pop :user "jrl"
23347 :server "pophost"
23348 :postscript
23349 "mv %t /tmp/foo; formail -bs spamc < /tmp/foo > %t")))
23350 @end lisp
23351
23352 Once you manage to process your incoming spool somehow, thus making
23353 the mail contain e.g.@: a header indicating it is spam, you are ready to
23354 filter it out. Using normal split methods (@pxref{Splitting Mail}):
23355
23356 @lisp
23357 (setq nnmail-split-methods '(("spam" "^X-Spam-Flag: YES")
23358 ...))
23359 @end lisp
23360
23361 Or using fancy split methods (@pxref{Fancy Mail Splitting}):
23362
23363 @lisp
23364 (setq nnmail-split-methods 'nnmail-split-fancy
23365 nnmail-split-fancy '(| ("X-Spam-Flag" "YES" "spam")
23366 ...))
23367 @end lisp
23368
23369 Some people might not like the idea of piping the mail through various
23370 programs using a @code{:prescript} (if some program is buggy, you
23371 might lose all mail). If you are one of them, another solution is to
23372 call the external tools during splitting. Example fancy split method:
23373
23374 @lisp
23375 (setq nnmail-split-fancy '(| (: kevin-spamassassin)
23376 ...))
23377 (defun kevin-spamassassin ()
23378 (save-excursion
23379 (save-restriction
23380 (widen)
23381 (if (eq 1 (call-process-region (point-min) (point-max)
23382 "spamc" nil nil nil "-c"))
23383 "spam"))))
23384 @end lisp
23385
23386 Note that with the nnimap backend, message bodies will not be
23387 downloaded by default. You need to set
23388 @code{nnimap-split-download-body} to @code{t} to do that
23389 (@pxref{Splitting in IMAP}).
23390
23391 That is about it. As some spam is likely to get through anyway, you
23392 might want to have a nifty function to call when you happen to read
23393 spam. And here is the nifty function:
23394
23395 @lisp
23396 (defun my-gnus-raze-spam ()
23397 "Submit SPAM to Vipul's Razor, then mark it as expirable."
23398 (interactive)
23399 (gnus-summary-show-raw-article)
23400 (gnus-summary-save-in-pipe "razor-report -f -d")
23401 (gnus-summary-mark-as-expirable 1))
23402 @end lisp
23403
23404 @node Hashcash
23405 @subsection Hashcash
23406 @cindex hashcash
23407
23408 A novel technique to fight spam is to require senders to do something
23409 costly for each message they send. This has the obvious drawback that
23410 you cannot rely on everyone in the world using this technique,
23411 since it is not part of the Internet standards, but it may be useful
23412 in smaller communities.
23413
23414 While the tools in the previous section work well in practice, they
23415 work only because the tools are constantly maintained and updated as
23416 new form of spam appears. This means that a small percentage of spam
23417 will always get through. It also means that somewhere, someone needs
23418 to read lots of spam to update these tools. Hashcash avoids that, but
23419 instead prefers that everyone you contact through e-mail supports the
23420 scheme. You can view the two approaches as pragmatic vs dogmatic.
23421 The approaches have their own advantages and disadvantages, but as
23422 often in the real world, a combination of them is stronger than either
23423 one of them separately.
23424
23425 @cindex X-Hashcash
23426 The ``something costly'' is to burn CPU time, more specifically to
23427 compute a hash collision up to a certain number of bits. The
23428 resulting hashcash cookie is inserted in a @samp{X-Hashcash:}
23429 header. For more details, and for the external application
23430 @code{hashcash} you need to install to use this feature, see
23431 @uref{http://www.cypherspace.org/~adam/hashcash/}. Even more
23432 information can be found at @uref{http://www.camram.org/}.
23433
23434 If you wish to call hashcash for each message you send, say something
23435 like:
23436
23437 @lisp
23438 (require 'hashcash)
23439 (add-hook 'message-send-hook 'mail-add-payment)
23440 @end lisp
23441
23442 The @file{hashcash.el} library can be found in the Gnus development
23443 contrib directory or at
23444 @uref{http://users.actrix.gen.nz/mycroft/hashcash.el}.
23445
23446 You will need to set up some additional variables as well:
23447
23448 @table @code
23449
23450 @item hashcash-default-payment
23451 @vindex hashcash-default-payment
23452 This variable indicates the default number of bits the hash collision
23453 should consist of. By default this is 0, meaning nothing will be
23454 done. Suggested useful values include 17 to 29.
23455
23456 @item hashcash-payment-alist
23457 @vindex hashcash-payment-alist
23458 Some receivers may require you to spend burn more CPU time than the
23459 default. This variable contains a list of @samp{(@var{addr}
23460 @var{amount})} cells, where @var{addr} is the receiver (email address
23461 or newsgroup) and @var{amount} is the number of bits in the collision
23462 that is needed. It can also contain @samp{(@var{addr} @var{string}
23463 @var{amount})} cells, where the @var{string} is the string to use
23464 (normally the email address or newsgroup name is used).
23465
23466 @item hashcash
23467 @vindex hashcash
23468 Where the @code{hashcash} binary is installed.
23469
23470 @end table
23471
23472 Currently there is no built in functionality in Gnus to verify
23473 hashcash cookies, it is expected that this is performed by your hand
23474 customized mail filtering scripts. Improvements in this area would be
23475 a useful contribution, however.
23476
23477 @node Spam Package
23478 @section Spam Package
23479 @cindex spam filtering
23480 @cindex spam
23481
23482 The Spam package provides Gnus with a centralized mechanism for
23483 detecting and filtering spam. It filters new mail, and processes
23484 messages according to whether they are spam or ham. (@dfn{Ham} is the
23485 name used throughout this manual to indicate non-spam messages.)
23486
23487 @menu
23488 * Spam Package Introduction::
23489 * Filtering Incoming Mail::
23490 * Detecting Spam in Groups::
23491 * Spam and Ham Processors::
23492 * Spam Package Configuration Examples::
23493 * Spam Back Ends::
23494 * Extending the Spam package::
23495 * Spam Statistics Package::
23496 @end menu
23497
23498 @node Spam Package Introduction
23499 @subsection Spam Package Introduction
23500 @cindex spam filtering
23501 @cindex spam filtering sequence of events
23502 @cindex spam
23503
23504 You must read this section to understand how the Spam package works.
23505 Do not skip, speed-read, or glance through this section.
23506
23507 @cindex spam-initialize
23508 @vindex spam-use-stat
23509 To use the Spam package, you @strong{must} first run the function
23510 @code{spam-initialize}:
23511
23512 @example
23513 (spam-initialize)
23514 @end example
23515
23516 This autoloads @code{spam.el} and installs the various hooks necessary
23517 to let the Spam package do its job. In order to make use of the Spam
23518 package, you have to set up certain group parameters and variables,
23519 which we will describe below. All of the variables controlling the
23520 Spam package can be found in the @samp{spam} customization group.
23521
23522 There are two ``contact points'' between the Spam package and the rest
23523 of Gnus: checking new mail for spam, and leaving a group.
23524
23525 Checking new mail for spam is done in one of two ways: while splitting
23526 incoming mail, or when you enter a group.
23527
23528 The first way, checking for spam while splitting incoming mail, is
23529 suited to mail back ends such as @code{nnml} or @code{nnimap}, where
23530 new mail appears in a single spool file. The Spam package processes
23531 incoming mail, and sends mail considered to be spam to a designated
23532 ``spam'' group. @xref{Filtering Incoming Mail}.
23533
23534 The second way is suited to back ends such as @code{nntp}, which have
23535 no incoming mail spool, or back ends where the server is in charge of
23536 splitting incoming mail. In this case, when you enter a Gnus group,
23537 the unseen or unread messages in that group are checked for spam.
23538 Detected spam messages are marked as spam. @xref{Detecting Spam in
23539 Groups}.
23540
23541 @cindex spam back ends
23542 In either case, you have to tell the Spam package what method to use
23543 to detect spam messages. There are several methods, or @dfn{spam back
23544 ends} (not to be confused with Gnus back ends!) to choose from: spam
23545 ``blacklists'' and ``whitelists'', dictionary-based filters, and so
23546 forth. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23547
23548 In the Gnus summary buffer, messages that have been identified as spam
23549 always appear with a @samp{$} symbol.
23550
23551 The Spam package divides Gnus groups into three categories: ham
23552 groups, spam groups, and unclassified groups. You should mark each of
23553 the groups you subscribe to as either a ham group or a spam group,
23554 using the @code{spam-contents} group parameter (@pxref{Group
23555 Parameters}). Spam groups have a special property: when you enter a
23556 spam group, all unseen articles are marked as spam. Thus, mail split
23557 into a spam group is automatically marked as spam.
23558
23559 Identifying spam messages is only half of the Spam package's job. The
23560 second half comes into play whenever you exit a group buffer. At this
23561 point, the Spam package does several things:
23562
23563 First, it calls @dfn{spam and ham processors} to process the articles
23564 according to whether they are spam or ham. There is a pair of spam
23565 and ham processors associated with each spam back end, and what the
23566 processors do depends on the back end. At present, the main role of
23567 spam and ham processors is for dictionary-based spam filters: they add
23568 the contents of the messages in the group to the filter's dictionary,
23569 to improve its ability to detect future spam. The @code{spam-process}
23570 group parameter specifies what spam processors to use. @xref{Spam and
23571 Ham Processors}.
23572
23573 If the spam filter failed to mark a spam message, you can mark it
23574 yourself, so that the message is processed as spam when you exit the
23575 group:
23576
23577 @table @kbd
23578 @item M-d
23579 @itemx M s x
23580 @itemx S x
23581 @kindex M-d
23582 @kindex S x
23583 @kindex M s x
23584 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
23585 @findex gnus-summary-mark-as-spam
23586 Mark current article as spam, showing it with the @samp{$} mark
23587 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}).
23588 @end table
23589
23590 @noindent
23591 Similarly, you can unmark an article if it has been erroneously marked
23592 as spam. @xref{Setting Marks}.
23593
23594 Normally, a ham message found in a non-ham group is not processed as
23595 ham---the rationale is that it should be moved into a ham group for
23596 further processing (see below). However, you can force these articles
23597 to be processed as ham by setting
23598 @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} and
23599 @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups}.
23600
23601 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23602 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23603 The second thing that the Spam package does when you exit a group is
23604 to move ham articles out of spam groups, and spam articles out of ham
23605 groups. Ham in a spam group is moved to the group specified by the
23606 variable @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}, or the group parameter
23607 @code{ham-process-destination}. Spam in a ham group is moved to the
23608 group specified by the variable @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations},
23609 or the group parameter @code{spam-process-destination}. If these
23610 variables are not set, the articles are left in their current group.
23611 If an article cannot be moved (e.g., with a read-only backend such
23612 as @acronym{NNTP}), it is copied.
23613
23614 If an article is moved to another group, it is processed again when
23615 you visit the new group. Normally, this is not a problem, but if you
23616 want each article to be processed only once, load the
23617 @code{gnus-registry.el} package and set the variable
23618 @code{spam-log-to-registry} to @code{t}. @xref{Spam Package
23619 Configuration Examples}.
23620
23621 Normally, spam groups ignore @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations}.
23622 However, if you set @code{spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only} to
23623 @code{nil}, spam will also be moved out of spam groups, depending on
23624 the @code{spam-process-destination} parameter.
23625
23626 The final thing the Spam package does is to mark spam articles as
23627 expired, which is usually the right thing to do.
23628
23629 If all this seems confusing, don't worry. Soon it will be as natural
23630 as typing Lisp one-liners on a neural interface@dots{} err, sorry, that's
23631 50 years in the future yet. Just trust us, it's not so bad.
23632
23633 @node Filtering Incoming Mail
23634 @subsection Filtering Incoming Mail
23635 @cindex spam filtering
23636 @cindex spam filtering incoming mail
23637 @cindex spam
23638
23639 To use the Spam package to filter incoming mail, you must first set up
23640 fancy mail splitting. @xref{Fancy Mail Splitting}. The Spam package
23641 defines a special splitting function that you can add to your fancy
23642 split variable (either @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or
23643 @code{nnimap-split-fancy}, depending on your mail back end):
23644
23645 @example
23646 (: spam-split)
23647 @end example
23648
23649 @vindex spam-split-group
23650 @noindent
23651 The @code{spam-split} function scans incoming mail according to your
23652 chosen spam back end(s), and sends messages identified as spam to a
23653 spam group. By default, the spam group is a group named @samp{spam},
23654 but you can change this by customizing @code{spam-split-group}. Make
23655 sure the contents of @code{spam-split-group} are an unqualified group
23656 name. For instance, in an @code{nnimap} server @samp{your-server},
23657 the value @samp{spam} means @samp{nnimap+your-server:spam}. The value
23658 @samp{nnimap+server:spam} is therefore wrong---it gives the group
23659 @samp{nnimap+your-server:nnimap+server:spam}.
23660
23661 @code{spam-split} does not modify the contents of messages in any way.
23662
23663 @vindex nnimap-split-download-body
23664 Note for IMAP users: if you use the @code{spam-check-bogofilter},
23665 @code{spam-check-ifile}, and @code{spam-check-stat} spam back ends,
23666 you should also set set the variable @code{nnimap-split-download-body}
23667 to @code{t}. These spam back ends are most useful when they can
23668 ``scan'' the full message body. By default, the nnimap back end only
23669 retrieves the message headers; @code{nnimap-split-download-body} tells
23670 it to retrieve the message bodies as well. We don't set this by
23671 default because it will slow @acronym{IMAP} down, and that is not an
23672 appropriate decision to make on behalf of the user. @xref{Splitting
23673 in IMAP}.
23674
23675 You have to specify one or more spam back ends for @code{spam-split}
23676 to use, by setting the @code{spam-use-*} variables. @xref{Spam Back
23677 Ends}. Normally, @code{spam-split} simply uses all the spam back ends
23678 you enabled in this way. However, you can tell @code{spam-split} to
23679 use only some of them. Why this is useful? Suppose you are using the
23680 @code{spam-use-regex-headers} and @code{spam-use-blackholes} spam back
23681 ends, and the following split rule:
23682
23683 @example
23684 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23685 (any "ding" "ding")
23686 (: spam-split)
23687 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23688 "mail")
23689 @end example
23690
23691 @noindent
23692 The problem is that you want all ding messages to make it to the ding
23693 folder. But that will let obvious spam (for example, spam detected by
23694 SpamAssassin, and @code{spam-use-regex-headers}) through, when it's
23695 sent to the ding list. On the other hand, some messages to the ding
23696 list are from a mail server in the blackhole list, so the invocation
23697 of @code{spam-split} can't be before the ding rule.
23698
23699 The solution is to let SpamAssassin headers supersede ding rules, and
23700 perform the other @code{spam-split} rules (including a second
23701 invocation of the regex-headers check) after the ding rule. This is
23702 done by passing a parameter to @code{spam-split}:
23703
23704 @example
23705 nnimap-split-fancy
23706 '(|
23707 ;; @r{spam detected by @code{spam-use-regex-headers} goes to @samp{regex-spam}}
23708 (: spam-split "regex-spam" 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23709 (any "ding" "ding")
23710 ;; @r{all other spam detected by spam-split goes to @code{spam-split-group}}
23711 (: spam-split)
23712 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23713 "mail")
23714 @end example
23715
23716 @noindent
23717 This lets you invoke specific @code{spam-split} checks depending on
23718 your particular needs, and target the results of those checks to a
23719 particular spam group. You don't have to throw all mail into all the
23720 spam tests. Another reason why this is nice is that messages to
23721 mailing lists you have rules for don't have to have resource-intensive
23722 blackhole checks performed on them. You could also specify different
23723 spam checks for your nnmail split vs. your nnimap split. Go crazy.
23724
23725 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23726 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23727 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23728 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set. @xref{Spam Back Ends}.
23729
23730 @c @emph{TODO: spam.el needs to provide a uniform way of training all the
23731 @c statistical databases. Some have that functionality built-in, others
23732 @c don't.}
23733
23734 @node Detecting Spam in Groups
23735 @subsection Detecting Spam in Groups
23736
23737 To detect spam when visiting a group, set the group's
23738 @code{spam-autodetect} and @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group
23739 parameters. These are accessible with @kbd{G c} or @kbd{G p}, as
23740 usual (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
23741
23742 You should set the @code{spam-use-*} variables for whatever spam back
23743 ends you intend to use. The reason is that when loading
23744 @file{spam.el}, some conditional loading is done depending on what
23745 @code{spam-use-xyz} variables you have set.
23746
23747 By default, only unseen articles are processed for spam. You can
23748 force Gnus to recheck all messages in the group by setting the
23749 variable @code{spam-autodetect-recheck-messages} to @code{t}.
23750
23751 If you use the @code{spam-autodetect} method of checking for spam, you
23752 can specify different spam detection methods for different groups.
23753 For instance, the @samp{ding} group may have @code{spam-use-BBDB} as
23754 the autodetection method, while the @samp{suspect} group may have the
23755 @code{spam-use-blacklist} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter} methods
23756 enabled. Unlike with @code{spam-split}, you don't have any control
23757 over the @emph{sequence} of checks, but this is probably unimportant.
23758
23759 @node Spam and Ham Processors
23760 @subsection Spam and Ham Processors
23761 @cindex spam filtering
23762 @cindex spam filtering variables
23763 @cindex spam variables
23764 @cindex spam
23765
23766 @vindex gnus-spam-process-newsgroups
23767 Spam and ham processors specify special actions to take when you exit
23768 a group buffer. Spam processors act on spam messages, and ham
23769 processors on ham messages. At present, the main role of these
23770 processors is to update the dictionaries of dictionary-based spam back
23771 ends such as Bogofilter (@pxref{Bogofilter}) and the Spam Statistics
23772 package (@pxref{Spam Statistics Filtering}).
23773
23774 The spam and ham processors that apply to each group are determined by
23775 the group's@code{spam-process} group parameter. If this group
23776 parameter is not defined, they are determined by the variable
23777 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups}.
23778
23779 @vindex gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23780 Gnus learns from the spam you get. You have to collect your spam in
23781 one or more spam groups, and set or customize the variable
23782 @code{spam-junk-mailgroups} as appropriate. You can also declare
23783 groups to contain spam by setting their group parameter
23784 @code{spam-contents} to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam}, or
23785 by customizing the corresponding variable
23786 @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}. The @code{spam-contents} group
23787 parameter and the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} variable can
23788 also be used to declare groups as @emph{ham} groups if you set their
23789 classification to @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-ham}. If
23790 groups are not classified by means of @code{spam-junk-mailgroups},
23791 @code{spam-contents}, or @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents}, they are
23792 considered @emph{unclassified}. All groups are unclassified by
23793 default.
23794
23795 @vindex gnus-spam-mark
23796 @cindex $
23797 In spam groups, all messages are considered to be spam by default:
23798 they get the @samp{$} mark (@code{gnus-spam-mark}) when you enter the
23799 group. If you have seen a message, had it marked as spam, then
23800 unmarked it, it won't be marked as spam when you enter the group
23801 thereafter. You can disable that behavior, so all unread messages
23802 will get the @samp{$} mark, if you set the
23803 @code{spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam} parameter to @code{nil}. You
23804 should remove the @samp{$} mark when you are in the group summary
23805 buffer for every message that is not spam after all. To remove the
23806 @samp{$} mark, you can use @kbd{M-u} to ``unread'' the article, or
23807 @kbd{d} for declaring it read the non-spam way. When you leave a
23808 group, all spam-marked (@samp{$}) articles are sent to a spam
23809 processor which will study them as spam samples.
23810
23811 Messages may also be deleted in various other ways, and unless
23812 @code{ham-marks} group parameter gets overridden below, marks @samp{R}
23813 and @samp{r} for default read or explicit delete, marks @samp{X} and
23814 @samp{K} for automatic or explicit kills, as well as mark @samp{Y} for
23815 low scores, are all considered to be associated with articles which
23816 are not spam. This assumption might be false, in particular if you
23817 use kill files or score files as means for detecting genuine spam, you
23818 should then adjust the @code{ham-marks} group parameter.
23819
23820 @defvar ham-marks
23821 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23822 marks you want to consider ham. By default, the list contains the
23823 deleted, read, killed, kill-filed, and low-score marks (the idea is
23824 that these articles have been read, but are not spam). It can be
23825 useful to also include the tick mark in the ham marks. It is not
23826 recommended to make the unread mark a ham mark, because it normally
23827 indicates a lack of classification. But you can do it, and we'll be
23828 happy for you.
23829 @end defvar
23830
23831 @defvar spam-marks
23832 You can customize this group or topic parameter to be the list of
23833 marks you want to consider spam. By default, the list contains only
23834 the spam mark. It is not recommended to change that, but you can if
23835 you really want to.
23836 @end defvar
23837
23838 When you leave @emph{any} group, regardless of its
23839 @code{spam-contents} classification, all spam-marked articles are sent
23840 to a spam processor, which will study these as spam samples. If you
23841 explicit kill a lot, you might sometimes end up with articles marked
23842 @samp{K} which you never saw, and which might accidentally contain
23843 spam. Best is to make sure that real spam is marked with @samp{$},
23844 and nothing else.
23845
23846 @vindex gnus-ham-process-destinations
23847 When you leave a @emph{spam} group, all spam-marked articles are
23848 marked as expired after processing with the spam processor. This is
23849 not done for @emph{unclassified} or @emph{ham} groups. Also, any
23850 @strong{ham} articles in a spam group will be moved to a location
23851 determined by either the @code{ham-process-destination} group
23852 parameter or a match in the @code{gnus-ham-process-destinations}
23853 variable, which is a list of regular expressions matched with group
23854 names (it's easiest to customize this variable with @kbd{M-x
23855 customize-variable @key{RET} gnus-ham-process-destinations}). Each
23856 group name list is a standard Lisp list, if you prefer to customize
23857 the variable manually. If the @code{ham-process-destination}
23858 parameter is not set, ham articles are left in place. If the
23859 @code{spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group} parameter is
23860 set, the ham articles are marked as unread before being moved.
23861
23862 If ham can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23863 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23864
23865 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23866 expression! This enables you to send your ham to a regular mail
23867 group and to a @emph{ham training} group.
23868
23869 When you leave a @emph{ham} group, all ham-marked articles are sent to
23870 a ham processor, which will study these as non-spam samples.
23871
23872 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups
23873 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-spam-groups} is
23874 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in spam groups
23875 to be processed. Normally this is not done, you are expected instead
23876 to send your ham to a ham group and process it there.
23877
23878 @vindex spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups
23879 By default the variable @code{spam-process-ham-in-nonham-groups} is
23880 @code{nil}. Set it to @code{t} if you want ham found in non-ham (spam
23881 or unclassified) groups to be processed. Normally this is not done,
23882 you are expected instead to send your ham to a ham group and process
23883 it there.
23884
23885 @vindex gnus-spam-process-destinations
23886 When you leave a @emph{ham} or @emph{unclassified} group, all
23887 @strong{spam} articles are moved to a location determined by either
23888 the @code{spam-process-destination} group parameter or a match in the
23889 @code{gnus-spam-process-destinations} variable, which is a list of
23890 regular expressions matched with group names (it's easiest to
23891 customize this variable with @kbd{M-x customize-variable @key{RET}
23892 gnus-spam-process-destinations}). Each group name list is a standard
23893 Lisp list, if you prefer to customize the variable manually. If the
23894 @code{spam-process-destination} parameter is not set, the spam
23895 articles are only expired. The group name is fully qualified, meaning
23896 that if you see @samp{nntp:servername} before the group name in the
23897 group buffer then you need it here as well.
23898
23899 If spam can not be moved---because of a read-only backend such as
23900 @acronym{NNTP}, for example, it will be copied.
23901
23902 Note that you can use multiples destinations per group or regular
23903 expression! This enables you to send your spam to multiple @emph{spam
23904 training} groups.
23905
23906 @vindex spam-log-to-registry
23907 The problem with processing ham and spam is that Gnus doesn't track
23908 this processing by default. Enable the @code{spam-log-to-registry}
23909 variable so @code{spam.el} will use @code{gnus-registry.el} to track
23910 what articles have been processed, and avoid processing articles
23911 multiple times. Keep in mind that if you limit the number of registry
23912 entries, this won't work as well as it does without a limit.
23913
23914 @vindex spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam
23915 Set this variable if you want only unseen articles in spam groups to
23916 be marked as spam. By default, it is set. If you set it to
23917 @code{nil}, unread articles will also be marked as spam.
23918
23919 @vindex spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group
23920 Set this variable if you want ham to be unmarked before it is moved
23921 out of the spam group. This is very useful when you use something
23922 like the tick mark @samp{!} to mark ham---the article will be placed
23923 in your @code{ham-process-destination}, unmarked as if it came fresh
23924 from the mail server.
23925
23926 @vindex spam-autodetect-recheck-messages
23927 When autodetecting spam, this variable tells @code{spam.el} whether
23928 only unseen articles or all unread articles should be checked for
23929 spam. It is recommended that you leave it off.
23930
23931 @node Spam Package Configuration Examples
23932 @subsection Spam Package Configuration Examples
23933 @cindex spam filtering
23934 @cindex spam filtering configuration examples
23935 @cindex spam configuration examples
23936 @cindex spam
23937
23938 @subsubheading Ted's setup
23939
23940 From Ted Zlatanov <tzz@@lifelogs.com>.
23941 @example
23942 ;; @r{for @code{gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent} and spam autodetection}
23943 ;; @r{see @file{gnus-registry.el} for more information}
23944 (gnus-registry-initialize)
23945 (spam-initialize)
23946
23947 (setq
23948 spam-log-to-registry t ; @r{for spam autodetection}
23949 spam-use-BBDB t
23950 spam-use-regex-headers t ; @r{catch X-Spam-Flag (SpamAssassin)}
23951 ;; @r{all groups with @samp{spam} in the name contain spam}
23952 gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents
23953 '(("spam" gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
23954 ;; @r{see documentation for these}
23955 spam-move-spam-nonspam-groups-only nil
23956 spam-mark-only-unseen-as-spam t
23957 spam-mark-ham-unread-before-move-from-spam-group t
23958 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
23959 ;; @r{understand what this does before you copy it to your own setup!}
23960 nnimap-split-fancy '(|
23961 ;; @r{trace references to parents and put in their group}
23962 (: gnus-registry-split-fancy-with-parent)
23963 ;; @r{this will catch server-side SpamAssassin tags}
23964 (: spam-split 'spam-use-regex-headers)
23965 (any "ding" "ding")
23966 ;; @r{note that spam by default will go to @samp{spam}}
23967 (: spam-split)
23968 ;; @r{default mailbox}
23969 "mail"))
23970
23971 ;; @r{my parameters, set with @kbd{G p}}
23972
23973 ;; @r{all nnml groups, and all nnimap groups except}
23974 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} and}
23975 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam}: any spam goes to nnimap training,}
23976 ;; @r{because it must have been detected manually}
23977
23978 ((spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23979
23980 ;; @r{all @acronym{NNTP} groups}
23981 ;; @r{autodetect spam with the blacklist and ham with the BBDB}
23982 ((spam-autodetect-methods spam-use-blacklist spam-use-BBDB)
23983 ;; @r{send all spam to the training group}
23984 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train"))
23985
23986 ;; @r{only some @acronym{NNTP} groups, where I want to autodetect spam}
23987 ((spam-autodetect . t))
23988
23989 ;; @r{my nnimap @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:spam} group}
23990
23991 ;; @r{this is a spam group}
23992 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam)
23993
23994 ;; @r{any spam (which happens when I enter for all unseen messages,}
23995 ;; @r{because of the @code{gnus-spam-newsgroup-contents} setting above), goes to}
23996 ;; @r{@samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train} unless I mark it as ham}
23997
23998 (spam-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:train")
23999
24000 ;; @r{any ham goes to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail} folder, but}
24001 ;; @r{also to my @samp{nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham} folder for training}
24002
24003 (ham-process-destination "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:mail"
24004 "nnimap+mail.lifelogs.com:trainham")
24005 ;; @r{in this group, only @samp{!} marks are ham}
24006 (ham-marks
24007 (gnus-ticked-mark))
24008 ;; @r{remembers senders in the blacklist on the way out---this is}
24009 ;; @r{definitely not needed, it just makes me feel better}
24010 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist)))
24011
24012 ;; @r{Later, on the @acronym{IMAP} server I use the @samp{train} group for training}
24013 ;; @r{SpamAssassin to recognize spam, and the @samp{trainham} group fora}
24014 ;; @r{recognizing ham---but Gnus has nothing to do with it.}
24015
24016 @end example
24017
24018 @subsubheading Using @file{spam.el} on an IMAP server with a statistical filter on the server
24019 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24020
24021 My provider has set up bogofilter (in combination with @acronym{DCC}) on
24022 the mail server (@acronym{IMAP}). Recognized spam goes to
24023 @samp{spam.detected}, the rest goes through the normal filter rules,
24024 i.e. to @samp{some.folder} or to @samp{INBOX}. Training on false
24025 positives or negatives is done by copying or moving the article to
24026 @samp{training.ham} or @samp{training.spam} respectively. A cron job on
24027 the server feeds those to bogofilter with the suitable ham or spam
24028 options and deletes them from the @samp{training.ham} and
24029 @samp{training.spam} folders.
24030
24031 With the following entries in @code{gnus-parameters}, @code{spam.el}
24032 does most of the job for me:
24033
24034 @lisp
24035 ("nnimap:spam\\.detected"
24036 (gnus-article-sort-functions '(gnus-article-sort-by-chars))
24037 (ham-process-destination "nnimap:INBOX" "nnimap:training.ham")
24038 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-spam))
24039 ("nnimap:\\(INBOX\\|other-folders\\)"
24040 (spam-process-destination . "nnimap:training.spam")
24041 (spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham))
24042 @end lisp
24043
24044 @itemize
24045
24046 @item @b{The Spam folder:}
24047
24048 In the folder @samp{spam.detected}, I have to check for false positives
24049 (i.e. legitimate mails, that were wrongly judged as spam by
24050 bogofilter or DCC).
24051
24052 Because of the @code{gnus-group-spam-classification-spam} entry, all
24053 messages are marked as spam (with @code{$}). When I find a false
24054 positive, I mark the message with some other ham mark
24055 (@code{ham-marks}, @ref{Spam and Ham Processors}). On group exit,
24056 those messages are copied to both groups, @samp{INBOX} (where I want
24057 to have the article) and @samp{training.ham} (for training bogofilter)
24058 and deleted from the @samp{spam.detected} folder.
24059
24060 The @code{gnus-article-sort-by-chars} entry simplifies detection of
24061 false positives for me. I receive lots of worms (sweN, @dots{}), that all
24062 have a similar size. Grouping them by size (i.e. chars) makes finding
24063 other false positives easier. (Of course worms aren't @i{spam}
24064 (@acronym{UCE}, @acronym{UBE}) strictly speaking. Anyhow, bogofilter is
24065 an excellent tool for filtering those unwanted mails for me.)
24066
24067 @item @b{Ham folders:}
24068
24069 In my ham folders, I just hit @kbd{S x}
24070 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) whenever I see an unrecognized spam
24071 mail (false negative). On group exit, those messages are moved to
24072 @samp{training.ham}.
24073 @end itemize
24074
24075 @subsubheading Reporting spam articles in Gmane groups with @code{spam-report.el}
24076
24077 From Reiner Steib <reiner.steib@@gmx.de>.
24078
24079 With following entry in @code{gnus-parameters}, @kbd{S x}
24080 (@code{gnus-summary-mark-as-spam}) marks articles in @code{gmane.*}
24081 groups as spam and reports the to Gmane at group exit:
24082
24083 @lisp
24084 ("^gmane\\."
24085 (spam-process (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane)))
24086 @end lisp
24087
24088 Additionally, I use @code{(setq spam-report-gmane-use-article-number nil)}
24089 because I don't read the groups directly from news.gmane.org, but
24090 through my local news server (leafnode). I.e. the article numbers are
24091 not the same as on news.gmane.org, thus @code{spam-report.el} has to check
24092 the @code{X-Report-Spam} header to find the correct number.
24093
24094 @node Spam Back Ends
24095 @subsection Spam Back Ends
24096 @cindex spam back ends
24097
24098 The spam package offers a variety of back ends for detecting spam.
24099 Each back end defines a set of methods for detecting spam
24100 (@pxref{Filtering Incoming Mail}, @pxref{Detecting Spam in Groups}),
24101 and a pair of spam and ham processors (@pxref{Spam and Ham
24102 Processors}).
24103
24104 @menu
24105 * Blacklists and Whitelists::
24106 * BBDB Whitelists::
24107 * Gmane Spam Reporting::
24108 * Anti-spam Hashcash Payments::
24109 * Blackholes::
24110 * Regular Expressions Header Matching::
24111 * Bogofilter::
24112 * ifile spam filtering::
24113 * Spam Statistics Filtering::
24114 * SpamOracle::
24115 @end menu
24116
24117 @node Blacklists and Whitelists
24118 @subsubsection Blacklists and Whitelists
24119 @cindex spam filtering
24120 @cindex whitelists, spam filtering
24121 @cindex blacklists, spam filtering
24122 @cindex spam
24123
24124 @defvar spam-use-blacklist
24125
24126 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use blacklists when
24127 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are in the blacklist
24128 will be sent to the @code{spam-split-group}. This is an explicit
24129 filter, meaning that it acts only on mail senders @emph{declared} to
24130 be spammers.
24131
24132 @end defvar
24133
24134 @defvar spam-use-whitelist
24135
24136 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists when
24137 splitting incoming mail. Messages whose senders are not in the
24138 whitelist will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24139 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the whitelist, their
24140 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24141
24142 @end defvar
24143
24144 @defvar spam-use-whitelist-exclusive
24145
24146 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use whitelists as an
24147 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24148 unless the sender is in the whitelist. Use with care.
24149
24150 @end defvar
24151
24152 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist
24153
24154 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24155 customizing the group parameters or the
24156 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24157 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24158 spam-marked articles will be added to the blacklist.
24159
24160 @emph{WARNING}
24161
24162 Instead of the obsolete
24163 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blacklist}, it is recommended
24164 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-blacklist)}. Everything will work
24165 the same way, we promise.
24166
24167 @end defvar
24168
24169 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist
24170
24171 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24172 customizing the group parameters or the
24173 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24174 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24175 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24176 whitelist. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
24177 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24178
24179 @emph{WARNING}
24180
24181 Instead of the obsolete
24182 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-whitelist}, it is recommended
24183 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-whitelist)}. Everything will work
24184 the same way, we promise.
24185
24186 @end defvar
24187
24188 Blacklists are lists of regular expressions matching addresses you
24189 consider to be spam senders. For instance, to block mail from any
24190 sender at @samp{vmadmin.com}, you can put @samp{vmadmin.com} in your
24191 blacklist. You start out with an empty blacklist. Blacklist entries
24192 use the Emacs regular expression syntax.
24193
24194 Conversely, whitelists tell Gnus what addresses are considered
24195 legitimate. All messages from whitelisted addresses are considered
24196 non-spam. Also see @ref{BBDB Whitelists}. Whitelist entries use the
24197 Emacs regular expression syntax.
24198
24199 The blacklist and whitelist file locations can be customized with the
24200 @code{spam-directory} variable (@file{~/News/spam} by default), or
24201 the @code{spam-whitelist} and @code{spam-blacklist} variables
24202 directly. The whitelist and blacklist files will by default be in the
24203 @code{spam-directory} directory, named @file{whitelist} and
24204 @file{blacklist} respectively.
24205
24206 @node BBDB Whitelists
24207 @subsubsection BBDB Whitelists
24208 @cindex spam filtering
24209 @cindex BBDB whitelists, spam filtering
24210 @cindex BBDB, spam filtering
24211 @cindex spam
24212
24213 @defvar spam-use-BBDB
24214
24215 Analogous to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24216 Whitelists}), but uses the BBDB as the source of whitelisted
24217 addresses, without regular expressions. You must have the BBDB loaded
24218 for @code{spam-use-BBDB} to work properly. Messages whose senders are
24219 not in the BBDB will be sent to the next spam-split rule. This is an
24220 explicit filter, meaning that unless someone is in the BBDB, their
24221 messages are not assumed to be spam or ham.
24222
24223 @end defvar
24224
24225 @defvar spam-use-BBDB-exclusive
24226
24227 Set this variable to @code{t} if you want to use the BBDB as an
24228 implicit filter, meaning that every message will be considered spam
24229 unless the sender is in the BBDB. Use with care. Only sender
24230 addresses in the BBDB will be allowed through; all others will be
24231 classified as spammers.
24232
24233 @end defvar
24234
24235 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB
24236
24237 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24238 customizing the group parameters or the
24239 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24240 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the senders of
24241 ham-marked articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the
24242 BBDB. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam}
24243 or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24244
24245 @emph{WARNING}
24246
24247 Instead of the obsolete
24248 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-BBDB}, it is recommended
24249 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-BBDB)}. Everything will work
24250 the same way, we promise.
24251
24252 @end defvar
24253
24254 @node Gmane Spam Reporting
24255 @subsubsection Gmane Spam Reporting
24256 @cindex spam reporting
24257 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24258 @cindex Gmane, spam reporting
24259 @cindex spam
24260
24261 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane
24262
24263 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24264 customizing the group parameters or the
24265 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24266 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24267 articles groups will be reported to the Gmane administrators via a
24268 HTTP request.
24269
24270 Gmane can be found at @uref{http://gmane.org}.
24271
24272 @emph{WARNING}
24273
24274 Instead of the obsolete
24275 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-report-gmane}, it is recommended
24276 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-gmane)}. Everything will work the
24277 same way, we promise.
24278
24279 @end defvar
24280
24281 @defvar spam-report-gmane-use-article-number
24282
24283 This variable is @code{t} by default. Set it to @code{nil} if you are
24284 running your own news server, for instance, and the local article
24285 numbers don't correspond to the Gmane article numbers. When
24286 @code{spam-report-gmane-use-article-number} is @code{nil},
24287 @code{spam-report.el} will use the @code{X-Report-Spam} header that
24288 Gmane provides.
24289
24290 @end defvar
24291
24292 @node Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24293 @subsubsection Anti-spam Hashcash Payments
24294 @cindex spam filtering
24295 @cindex hashcash, spam filtering
24296 @cindex spam
24297
24298 @defvar spam-use-hashcash
24299
24300 Similar to @code{spam-use-whitelist} (@pxref{Blacklists and
24301 Whitelists}), but uses hashcash tokens for whitelisting messages
24302 instead of the sender address. You must have the @code{hashcash.el}
24303 package loaded for @code{spam-use-hashcash} to work properly.
24304 Messages without a hashcash payment token will be sent to the next
24305 spam-split rule. This is an explicit filter, meaning that unless a
24306 hashcash token is found, the messages are not assumed to be spam or
24307 ham.
24308
24309 @end defvar
24310
24311 @node Blackholes
24312 @subsubsection Blackholes
24313 @cindex spam filtering
24314 @cindex blackholes, spam filtering
24315 @cindex spam
24316
24317 @defvar spam-use-blackholes
24318
24319 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus consult the
24320 blackhole-type distributed spam processing systems (DCC, for instance)
24321 when you set this option. The variable @code{spam-blackhole-servers}
24322 holds the list of blackhole servers Gnus will consult. The current
24323 list is fairly comprehensive, but make sure to let us know if it
24324 contains outdated servers.
24325
24326 The blackhole check uses the @code{dig.el} package, but you can tell
24327 @file{spam.el} to use @code{dns.el} instead for better performance if
24328 you set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil}. It is not recommended at
24329 this time to set @code{spam-use-dig} to @code{nil} despite the
24330 possible performance improvements, because some users may be unable to
24331 use it, but you can try it and see if it works for you.
24332
24333 @end defvar
24334
24335 @defvar spam-blackhole-servers
24336
24337 The list of servers to consult for blackhole checks.
24338
24339 @end defvar
24340
24341 @defvar spam-blackhole-good-server-regex
24342
24343 A regular expression for IPs that should not be checked against the
24344 blackhole server list. When set to @code{nil}, it has no effect.
24345
24346 @end defvar
24347
24348 @defvar spam-use-dig
24349
24350 Use the @code{dig.el} package instead of the @code{dns.el} package.
24351 The default setting of @code{t} is recommended.
24352
24353 @end defvar
24354
24355 Blackhole checks are done only on incoming mail. There is no spam or
24356 ham processor for blackholes.
24357
24358 @node Regular Expressions Header Matching
24359 @subsubsection Regular Expressions Header Matching
24360 @cindex spam filtering
24361 @cindex regular expressions header matching, spam filtering
24362 @cindex spam
24363
24364 @defvar spam-use-regex-headers
24365
24366 This option is disabled by default. You can let Gnus check the
24367 message headers against lists of regular expressions when you set this
24368 option. The variables @code{spam-regex-headers-spam} and
24369 @code{spam-regex-headers-ham} hold the list of regular expressions.
24370 Gnus will check against the message headers to determine if the
24371 message is spam or ham, respectively.
24372
24373 @end defvar
24374
24375 @defvar spam-regex-headers-spam
24376
24377 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24378 the message, positively identify it as spam.
24379
24380 @end defvar
24381
24382 @defvar spam-regex-headers-ham
24383
24384 The list of regular expressions that, when matched in the headers of
24385 the message, positively identify it as ham.
24386
24387 @end defvar
24388
24389 Regular expression header checks are done only on incoming mail.
24390 There is no specific spam or ham processor for regular expressions.
24391
24392 @node Bogofilter
24393 @subsubsection Bogofilter
24394 @cindex spam filtering
24395 @cindex bogofilter, spam filtering
24396 @cindex spam
24397
24398 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter
24399
24400 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
24401 speedy Bogofilter.
24402
24403 With a minimum of care for associating the @samp{$} mark for spam
24404 articles only, Bogofilter training all gets fairly automatic. You
24405 should do this until you get a few hundreds of articles in each
24406 category, spam or not. The command @kbd{S t} in summary mode, either
24407 for debugging or for curiosity, shows the @emph{spamicity} score of
24408 the current article (between 0.0 and 1.0).
24409
24410 Bogofilter determines if a message is spam based on a specific
24411 threshold. That threshold can be customized, consult the Bogofilter
24412 documentation.
24413
24414 If the @code{bogofilter} executable is not in your path, Bogofilter
24415 processing will be turned off.
24416
24417 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}.
24418
24419 @end defvar
24420
24421 @table @kbd
24422 @item M s t
24423 @itemx S t
24424 @kindex M s t
24425 @kindex S t
24426 @findex spam-bogofilter-score
24427 Get the Bogofilter spamicity score (@code{spam-bogofilter-score}).
24428 @end table
24429
24430 @defvar spam-use-bogofilter-headers
24431
24432 Set this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use Eric Raymond's
24433 speedy Bogofilter, looking only at the message headers. It works
24434 similarly to @code{spam-use-bogofilter}, but the @code{X-Bogosity} header
24435 must be in the message already. Normally you would do this with a
24436 procmail recipe or something similar; consult the Bogofilter
24437 installation documents for details.
24438
24439 You should not enable this if you use @code{spam-use-bogofilter}.
24440
24441 @end defvar
24442
24443 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter
24444 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24445 customizing the group parameters or the
24446 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24447 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles
24448 will be added to the Bogofilter spam database.
24449
24450 @emph{WARNING}
24451
24452 Instead of the obsolete
24453 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
24454 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
24455 the same way, we promise.
24456 @end defvar
24457
24458 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter
24459 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24460 customizing the group parameters or the
24461 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24462 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
24463 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the Bogofilter database
24464 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
24465 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24466
24467 @emph{WARNING}
24468
24469 Instead of the obsolete
24470 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-bogofilter}, it is recommended
24471 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-bogofilter)}. Everything will work
24472 the same way, we promise.
24473 @end defvar
24474
24475 @defvar spam-bogofilter-database-directory
24476
24477 This is the directory where Bogofilter will store its databases. It
24478 is not specified by default, so Bogofilter will use its own default
24479 database directory.
24480
24481 @end defvar
24482
24483 The Bogofilter mail classifier is similar to @command{ifile} in intent and
24484 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
24485 @code{spam-use-bogofilter} and @code{spam-use-bogofilter-headers}
24486 variables to indicate to spam-split that Bogofilter should either be
24487 used, or has already been used on the article. The 0.9.2.1 version of
24488 Bogofilter was used to test this functionality.
24489
24490 @node ifile spam filtering
24491 @subsubsection ifile spam filtering
24492 @cindex spam filtering
24493 @cindex ifile, spam filtering
24494 @cindex spam
24495
24496 @defvar spam-use-ifile
24497
24498 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-split} to use @command{ifile}, a
24499 statistical analyzer similar to Bogofilter.
24500
24501 @end defvar
24502
24503 @defvar spam-ifile-all-categories
24504
24505 Enable this variable if you want @code{spam-use-ifile} to give you all
24506 the ifile categories, not just spam/non-spam. If you use this, make
24507 sure you train ifile as described in its documentation.
24508
24509 @end defvar
24510
24511 @defvar spam-ifile-spam-category
24512
24513 This is the category of spam messages as far as ifile is concerned.
24514 The actual string used is irrelevant, but you probably want to leave
24515 the default value of @samp{spam}.
24516 @end defvar
24517
24518 @defvar spam-ifile-database
24519
24520 This is the filename for the ifile database. It is not specified by
24521 default, so ifile will use its own default database name.
24522
24523 @end defvar
24524
24525 The ifile mail classifier is similar to Bogofilter in intent and
24526 purpose. A ham and a spam processor are provided, plus the
24527 @code{spam-use-ifile} variable to indicate to spam-split that ifile
24528 should be used. The 1.2.1 version of ifile was used to test this
24529 functionality.
24530
24531 @node Spam Statistics Filtering
24532 @subsubsection Spam Statistics Filtering
24533 @cindex spam filtering
24534 @cindex spam-stat, spam filtering
24535 @cindex spam-stat
24536 @cindex spam
24537
24538 This back end uses the Spam Statistics Emacs Lisp package to perform
24539 statistics-based filtering (@pxref{Spam Statistics Package}). Before
24540 using this, you may want to perform some additional steps to
24541 initialize your Spam Statistics dictionary. @xref{Creating a
24542 spam-stat dictionary}.
24543
24544 @defvar spam-use-stat
24545
24546 @end defvar
24547
24548 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat
24549 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24550 customizing the group parameters or the
24551 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24552 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the spam-marked
24553 articles will be added to the spam-stat database of spam messages.
24554
24555 @emph{WARNING}
24556
24557 Instead of the obsolete
24558 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
24559 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
24560 the same way, we promise.
24561 @end defvar
24562
24563 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat
24564 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24565 customizing the group parameters or the
24566 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is
24567 added to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked
24568 articles in @emph{ham} groups will be added to the spam-stat database
24569 of non-spam messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in
24570 @emph{spam} or @emph{unclassified} groups.
24571
24572 @emph{WARNING}
24573
24574 Instead of the obsolete
24575 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-stat}, it is recommended
24576 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-stat)}. Everything will work
24577 the same way, we promise.
24578 @end defvar
24579
24580 This enables @file{spam.el} to cooperate with @file{spam-stat.el}.
24581 @file{spam-stat.el} provides an internal (Lisp-only) spam database,
24582 which unlike ifile or Bogofilter does not require external programs.
24583 A spam and a ham processor, and the @code{spam-use-stat} variable for
24584 @code{spam-split} are provided.
24585
24586 @node SpamOracle
24587 @subsubsection Using SpamOracle with Gnus
24588 @cindex spam filtering
24589 @cindex SpamOracle
24590 @cindex spam
24591
24592 An easy way to filter out spam is to use SpamOracle. SpamOracle is an
24593 statistical mail filtering tool written by Xavier Leroy and needs to be
24594 installed separately.
24595
24596 There are several ways to use SpamOracle with Gnus. In all cases, your
24597 mail is piped through SpamOracle in its @emph{mark} mode. SpamOracle will
24598 then enter an @samp{X-Spam} header indicating whether it regards the
24599 mail as a spam mail or not.
24600
24601 One possibility is to run SpamOracle as a @code{:prescript} from the
24602 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}, (@pxref{SpamAssassin}). This method has
24603 the advantage that the user can see the @emph{X-Spam} headers.
24604
24605 The easiest method is to make @file{spam.el} (@pxref{Spam Package})
24606 call SpamOracle.
24607
24608 @vindex spam-use-spamoracle
24609 To enable SpamOracle usage by @file{spam.el}, set the variable
24610 @code{spam-use-spamoracle} to @code{t} and configure the
24611 @code{nnmail-split-fancy} or @code{nnimap-split-fancy}. @xref{Spam
24612 Package}. In this example the @samp{INBOX} of an nnimap server is
24613 filtered using SpamOracle. Mails recognized as spam mails will be
24614 moved to @code{spam-split-group}, @samp{Junk} in this case. Ham
24615 messages stay in @samp{INBOX}:
24616
24617 @example
24618 (setq spam-use-spamoracle t
24619 spam-split-group "Junk"
24620 nnimap-split-inbox '("INBOX")
24621 nnimap-split-rule 'nnimap-split-fancy
24622 nnimap-split-fancy '(| (: spam-split) "INBOX"))
24623 @end example
24624
24625 @defvar spam-use-spamoracle
24626 Set to @code{t} if you want Gnus to enable spam filtering using
24627 SpamOracle.
24628 @end defvar
24629
24630 @defvar spam-spamoracle-binary
24631 Gnus uses the SpamOracle binary called @file{spamoracle} found in the
24632 user's PATH. Using the variable @code{spam-spamoracle-binary}, this
24633 can be customized.
24634 @end defvar
24635
24636 @defvar spam-spamoracle-database
24637 By default, SpamOracle uses the file @file{~/.spamoracle.db} as a database to
24638 store its analysis. This is controlled by the variable
24639 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} which defaults to @code{nil}. That means
24640 the default SpamOracle database will be used. In case you want your
24641 database to live somewhere special, set
24642 @code{spam-spamoracle-database} to this path.
24643 @end defvar
24644
24645 SpamOracle employs a statistical algorithm to determine whether a
24646 message is spam or ham. In order to get good results, meaning few
24647 false hits or misses, SpamOracle needs training. SpamOracle learns
24648 the characteristics of your spam mails. Using the @emph{add} mode
24649 (training mode) one has to feed good (ham) and spam mails to
24650 SpamOracle. This can be done by pressing @kbd{|} in the Summary
24651 buffer and pipe the mail to a SpamOracle process or using
24652 @file{spam.el}'s spam- and ham-processors, which is much more
24653 convenient. For a detailed description of spam- and ham-processors,
24654 @xref{Spam Package}.
24655
24656 @defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle
24657 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24658 customizing the group parameter or the
24659 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24660 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, spam-marked articles will be
24661 sent to SpamOracle as spam samples.
24662
24663 @emph{WARNING}
24664
24665 Instead of the obsolete
24666 @code{gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24667 that you use @code{'(spam spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24668 the same way, we promise.
24669 @end defvar
24670
24671 @defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle
24672 Add this symbol to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter by
24673 customizing the group parameter or the
24674 @code{gnus-spam-process-newsgroups} variable. When this symbol is added
24675 to a group's @code{spam-process} parameter, the ham-marked articles in
24676 @emph{ham} groups will be sent to the SpamOracle as samples of ham
24677 messages. Note that this ham processor has no effect in @emph{spam} or
24678 @emph{unclassified} groups.
24679
24680 @emph{WARNING}
24681
24682 Instead of the obsolete
24683 @code{gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-spamoracle}, it is recommended
24684 that you use @code{'(ham spam-use-spamoracle)}. Everything will work
24685 the same way, we promise.
24686 @end defvar
24687
24688 @emph{Example:} These are the Group Parameters of a group that has been
24689 classified as a ham group, meaning that it should only contain ham
24690 messages.
24691 @example
24692 ((spam-contents gnus-group-spam-classification-ham)
24693 (spam-process ((ham spam-use-spamoracle)
24694 (spam spam-use-spamoracle))))
24695 @end example
24696 For this group the @code{spam-use-spamoracle} is installed for both
24697 ham and spam processing. If the group contains spam message
24698 (e.g. because SpamOracle has not had enough sample messages yet) and
24699 the user marks some messages as spam messages, these messages will be
24700 processed by SpamOracle. The processor sends the messages to
24701 SpamOracle as new samples for spam.
24702
24703 @node Extending the Spam package
24704 @subsection Extending the Spam package
24705 @cindex spam filtering
24706 @cindex spam elisp package, extending
24707 @cindex extending the spam elisp package
24708
24709 Say you want to add a new back end called blackbox. For filtering
24710 incoming mail, provide the following:
24711
24712 @enumerate
24713
24714 @item
24715 Code
24716
24717 @lisp
24718 (defvar spam-use-blackbox nil
24719 "True if blackbox should be used.")
24720 @end lisp
24721
24722 Add
24723 @lisp
24724 (spam-use-blackbox . spam-check-blackbox)
24725 @end lisp
24726 to @code{spam-list-of-checks}.
24727
24728 Add
24729 @lisp
24730 (gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox ham spam-use-blackbox)
24731 (gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox spam spam-use-blackbox)
24732 @end lisp
24733
24734 to @code{spam-list-of-processors}.
24735
24736 Add
24737 @lisp
24738 (spam-use-blackbox spam-blackbox-register-routine
24739 nil
24740 spam-blackbox-unregister-routine
24741 nil)
24742 @end lisp
24743
24744 to @code{spam-registration-functions}. Write the register/unregister
24745 routines using the bogofilter register/unregister routines as a
24746 start, or other register/unregister routines more appropriate to
24747 Blackbox.
24748
24749 @item
24750 Functionality
24751
24752 Write the @code{spam-check-blackbox} function. It should return
24753 @samp{nil} or @code{spam-split-group}, observing the other
24754 conventions. See the existing @code{spam-check-*} functions for
24755 examples of what you can do, and stick to the template unless you
24756 fully understand the reasons why you aren't.
24757
24758 Make sure to add @code{spam-use-blackbox} to
24759 @code{spam-list-of-statistical-checks} if Blackbox is a statistical
24760 mail analyzer that needs the full message body to operate.
24761
24762 @end enumerate
24763
24764 For processing spam and ham messages, provide the following:
24765
24766 @enumerate
24767
24768 @item
24769 Code
24770
24771 Note you don't have to provide a spam or a ham processor. Only
24772 provide them if Blackbox supports spam or ham processing.
24773
24774 Also, ham and spam processors are being phased out as single
24775 variables. Instead the form @code{'(spam spam-use-blackbox)} or
24776 @code{'(ham spam-use-blackbox)} is favored. For now, spam/ham
24777 processor variables are still around but they won't be for long.
24778
24779 @lisp
24780 (defvar gnus-group-spam-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-spam"
24781 "The Blackbox summary exit spam processor.
24782 Only applicable to spam groups.")
24783
24784 (defvar gnus-group-ham-exit-processor-blackbox "blackbox-ham"
24785 "The whitelist summary exit ham processor.
24786 Only applicable to non-spam (unclassified and ham) groups.")
24787
24788 @end lisp
24789
24790 @item
24791 Gnus parameters
24792
24793 Add
24794 @lisp
24795 (const :tag "Spam: Blackbox" (spam spam-use-blackbox))
24796 (const :tag "Ham: Blackbox" (ham spam-use-blackbox))
24797 @end lisp
24798 to the @code{spam-process} group parameter in @code{gnus.el}. Make
24799 sure you do it twice, once for the parameter and once for the
24800 variable customization.
24801
24802 Add
24803 @lisp
24804 (variable-item spam-use-blackbox)
24805 @end lisp
24806 to the @code{spam-autodetect-methods} group parameter in
24807 @code{gnus.el}.
24808
24809 @end enumerate
24810
24811 @node Spam Statistics Package
24812 @subsection Spam Statistics Package
24813 @cindex Paul Graham
24814 @cindex Graham, Paul
24815 @cindex naive Bayesian spam filtering
24816 @cindex Bayesian spam filtering, naive
24817 @cindex spam filtering, naive Bayesian
24818
24819 Paul Graham has written an excellent essay about spam filtering using
24820 statistics: @uref{http://www.paulgraham.com/spam.html,A Plan for
24821 Spam}. In it he describes the inherent deficiency of rule-based
24822 filtering as used by SpamAssassin, for example: Somebody has to write
24823 the rules, and everybody else has to install these rules. You are
24824 always late. It would be much better, he argues, to filter mail based
24825 on whether it somehow resembles spam or non-spam. One way to measure
24826 this is word distribution. He then goes on to describe a solution
24827 that checks whether a new mail resembles any of your other spam mails
24828 or not.
24829
24830 The basic idea is this: Create a two collections of your mail, one
24831 with spam, one with non-spam. Count how often each word appears in
24832 either collection, weight this by the total number of mails in the
24833 collections, and store this information in a dictionary. For every
24834 word in a new mail, determine its probability to belong to a spam or a
24835 non-spam mail. Use the 15 most conspicuous words, compute the total
24836 probability of the mail being spam. If this probability is higher
24837 than a certain threshold, the mail is considered to be spam.
24838
24839 The Spam Statistics package adds support to Gnus for this kind of
24840 filtering. It can be used as one of the back ends of the Spam package
24841 (@pxref{Spam Package}), or by itself.
24842
24843 Before using the Spam Statistics package, you need to set it up.
24844 First, you need two collections of your mail, one with spam, one with
24845 non-spam. Then you need to create a dictionary using these two
24846 collections, and save it. And last but not least, you need to use
24847 this dictionary in your fancy mail splitting rules.
24848
24849 @menu
24850 * Creating a spam-stat dictionary::
24851 * Splitting mail using spam-stat::
24852 * Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary::
24853 @end menu
24854
24855 @node Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24856 @subsubsection Creating a spam-stat dictionary
24857
24858 Before you can begin to filter spam based on statistics, you must
24859 create these statistics based on two mail collections, one with spam,
24860 one with non-spam. These statistics are then stored in a dictionary
24861 for later use. In order for these statistics to be meaningful, you
24862 need several hundred emails in both collections.
24863
24864 Gnus currently supports only the nnml back end for automated dictionary
24865 creation. The nnml back end stores all mails in a directory, one file
24866 per mail. Use the following:
24867
24868 @defun spam-stat-process-spam-directory
24869 Create spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every file
24870 is treated as one spam mail.
24871 @end defun
24872
24873 @defun spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory
24874 Create non-spam statistics for every file in this directory. Every
24875 file is treated as one non-spam mail.
24876 @end defun
24877
24878 Usually you would call @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory} on a
24879 directory such as @file{~/Mail/mail/spam} (this usually corresponds to
24880 the group @samp{nnml:mail.spam}), and you would call
24881 @code{spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory} on a directory such as
24882 @file{~/Mail/mail/misc} (this usually corresponds to the group
24883 @samp{nnml:mail.misc}).
24884
24885 When you are using @acronym{IMAP}, you won't have the mails available
24886 locally, so that will not work. One solution is to use the Gnus Agent
24887 to cache the articles. Then you can use directories such as
24888 @file{"~/News/agent/nnimap/mail.yourisp.com/personal_spam"} for
24889 @code{spam-stat-process-spam-directory}. @xref{Agent as Cache}.
24890
24891 @defvar spam-stat
24892 This variable holds the hash-table with all the statistics---the
24893 dictionary we have been talking about. For every word in either
24894 collection, this hash-table stores a vector describing how often the
24895 word appeared in spam and often it appeared in non-spam mails.
24896 @end defvar
24897
24898 If you want to regenerate the statistics from scratch, you need to
24899 reset the dictionary.
24900
24901 @defun spam-stat-reset
24902 Reset the @code{spam-stat} hash-table, deleting all the statistics.
24903 @end defun
24904
24905 When you are done, you must save the dictionary. The dictionary may
24906 be rather large. If you will not update the dictionary incrementally
24907 (instead, you will recreate it once a month, for example), then you
24908 can reduce the size of the dictionary by deleting all words that did
24909 not appear often enough or that do not clearly belong to only spam or
24910 only non-spam mails.
24911
24912 @defun spam-stat-reduce-size
24913 Reduce the size of the dictionary. Use this only if you do not want
24914 to update the dictionary incrementally.
24915 @end defun
24916
24917 @defun spam-stat-save
24918 Save the dictionary.
24919 @end defun
24920
24921 @defvar spam-stat-file
24922 The filename used to store the dictionary. This defaults to
24923 @file{~/.spam-stat.el}.
24924 @end defvar
24925
24926 @node Splitting mail using spam-stat
24927 @subsubsection Splitting mail using spam-stat
24928
24929 This section describes how to use the Spam statistics
24930 @emph{independently} of the @xref{Spam Package}.
24931
24932 First, add the following to your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
24933
24934 @lisp
24935 (require 'spam-stat)
24936 (spam-stat-load)
24937 @end lisp
24938
24939 This will load the necessary Gnus code, and the dictionary you
24940 created.
24941
24942 Next, you need to adapt your fancy splitting rules: You need to
24943 determine how to use @code{spam-stat}. The following examples are for
24944 the nnml back end. Using the nnimap back end works just as well. Just
24945 use @code{nnimap-split-fancy} instead of @code{nnmail-split-fancy}.
24946
24947 In the simplest case, you only have two groups, @samp{mail.misc} and
24948 @samp{mail.spam}. The following expression says that mail is either
24949 spam or it should go into @samp{mail.misc}. If it is spam, then
24950 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will return @samp{mail.spam}.
24951
24952 @lisp
24953 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24954 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24955 "mail.misc"))
24956 @end lisp
24957
24958 @defvar spam-stat-split-fancy-spam-group
24959 The group to use for spam. Default is @samp{mail.spam}.
24960 @end defvar
24961
24962 If you also filter mail with specific subjects into other groups, use
24963 the following expression. Only mails not matching the regular
24964 expression are considered potential spam.
24965
24966 @lisp
24967 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24968 `(| ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24969 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24970 "mail.misc"))
24971 @end lisp
24972
24973 If you want to filter for spam first, then you must be careful when
24974 creating the dictionary. Note that @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} must
24975 consider both mails in @samp{mail.emacs} and in @samp{mail.misc} as
24976 non-spam, therefore both should be in your collection of non-spam
24977 mails, when creating the dictionary!
24978
24979 @lisp
24980 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24981 `(| (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24982 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24983 "mail.misc"))
24984 @end lisp
24985
24986 You can combine this with traditional filtering. Here, we move all
24987 HTML-only mails into the @samp{mail.spam.filtered} group. Note that since
24988 @code{spam-stat-split-fancy} will never see them, the mails in
24989 @samp{mail.spam.filtered} should be neither in your collection of spam mails,
24990 nor in your collection of non-spam mails, when creating the
24991 dictionary!
24992
24993 @lisp
24994 (setq nnmail-split-fancy
24995 `(| ("Content-Type" "text/html" "mail.spam.filtered")
24996 (: spam-stat-split-fancy)
24997 ("Subject" "\\bspam-stat\\b" "mail.emacs")
24998 "mail.misc"))
24999 @end lisp
25000
25001
25002 @node Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25003 @subsubsection Low-level interface to the spam-stat dictionary
25004
25005 The main interface to using @code{spam-stat}, are the following functions:
25006
25007 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-spam
25008 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new spam mail.
25009 Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25010 @end defun
25011
25012 @defun spam-stat-buffer-is-no-spam
25013 Called in a buffer, that buffer is considered to be a new non-spam
25014 mail. Use this for new mail that has not been processed before.
25015 @end defun
25016
25017 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-spam
25018 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be normal
25019 mail but spam. Use this to change the status of a mail that has
25020 already been processed as non-spam.
25021 @end defun
25022
25023 @defun spam-stat-buffer-change-to-non-spam
25024 Called in a buffer, that buffer is no longer considered to be spam but
25025 normal mail. Use this to change the status of a mail that has already
25026 been processed as spam.
25027 @end defun
25028
25029 @defun spam-stat-save
25030 Save the hash table to the file. The filename used is stored in the
25031 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25032 @end defun
25033
25034 @defun spam-stat-load
25035 Load the hash table from a file. The filename used is stored in the
25036 variable @code{spam-stat-file}.
25037 @end defun
25038
25039 @defun spam-stat-score-word
25040 Return the spam score for a word.
25041 @end defun
25042
25043 @defun spam-stat-score-buffer
25044 Return the spam score for a buffer.
25045 @end defun
25046
25047 @defun spam-stat-split-fancy
25048 Use this function for fancy mail splitting. Add the rule @samp{(:
25049 spam-stat-split-fancy)} to @code{nnmail-split-fancy}
25050 @end defun
25051
25052 Make sure you load the dictionary before using it. This requires the
25053 following in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file:
25054
25055 @lisp
25056 (require 'spam-stat)
25057 (spam-stat-load)
25058 @end lisp
25059
25060 Typical test will involve calls to the following functions:
25061
25062 @smallexample
25063 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25064 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25065 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25066 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25067 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25068 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25069 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25070 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25071 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25072 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25073 File size: (nth 7 (file-attributes spam-stat-file))
25074 Number of words: (hash-table-count spam-stat)
25075 Test spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25076 Test non-spam: (spam-stat-test-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25077 @end smallexample
25078
25079 Here is how you would create your dictionary:
25080
25081 @smallexample
25082 Reset: (setq spam-stat (make-hash-table :test 'equal))
25083 Learn spam: (spam-stat-process-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/spam")
25084 Learn non-spam: (spam-stat-process-non-spam-directory "~/Mail/mail/misc")
25085 Repeat for any other non-spam group you need...
25086 Reduce table size: (spam-stat-reduce-size)
25087 Save table: (spam-stat-save)
25088 @end smallexample
25089
25090 @node Other modes
25091 @section Interaction with other modes
25092
25093 @subsection Dired
25094 @cindex dired
25095
25096 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} provides some useful functions for dired
25097 buffers. It is enabled with
25098 @lisp
25099 (add-hook 'dired-mode-hook 'turn-on-gnus-dired-mode)
25100 @end lisp
25101
25102 @table @kbd
25103 @item C-c C-m C-a
25104 @findex gnus-dired-attach
25105 @cindex attachments, selection via dired
25106 Send dired's marked files as an attachment (@code{gnus-dired-attach}).
25107 You will be prompted for a message buffer.
25108
25109 @item C-c C-m C-l
25110 @findex gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap
25111 Visit a file according to the appropriate mailcap entry
25112 (@code{gnus-dired-find-file-mailcap}). With prefix, open file in a new
25113 buffer.
25114
25115 @item C-c C-m C-p
25116 @findex gnus-dired-print
25117 Print file according to the mailcap entry (@code{gnus-dired-print}). If
25118 there is no print command, print in a PostScript image.
25119 @end table
25120
25121 @node Various Various
25122 @section Various Various
25123 @cindex mode lines
25124 @cindex highlights
25125
25126 @table @code
25127
25128 @item gnus-home-directory
25129 @vindex gnus-home-directory
25130 All Gnus file and directory variables will be initialized from this
25131 variable, which defaults to @file{~/}.
25132
25133 @item gnus-directory
25134 @vindex gnus-directory
25135 Most Gnus storage file and directory variables will be initialized from
25136 this variable, which defaults to the @env{SAVEDIR} environment
25137 variable, or @file{~/News/} if that variable isn't set.
25138
25139 Note that Gnus is mostly loaded when the @file{~/.gnus.el} file is read.
25140 This means that other directory variables that are initialized from this
25141 variable won't be set properly if you set this variable in
25142 @file{~/.gnus.el}. Set this variable in @file{.emacs} instead.
25143
25144 @item gnus-default-directory
25145 @vindex gnus-default-directory
25146 Not related to the above variable at all---this variable says what the
25147 default directory of all Gnus buffers should be. If you issue commands
25148 like @kbd{C-x C-f}, the prompt you'll get starts in the current buffer's
25149 default directory. If this variable is @code{nil} (which is the
25150 default), the default directory will be the default directory of the
25151 buffer you were in when you started Gnus.
25152
25153 @item gnus-verbose
25154 @vindex gnus-verbose
25155 This variable is an integer between zero and ten. The higher the value,
25156 the more messages will be displayed. If this variable is zero, Gnus
25157 will never flash any messages, if it is seven (which is the default),
25158 most important messages will be shown, and if it is ten, Gnus won't ever
25159 shut up, but will flash so many messages it will make your head swim.
25160
25161 @item gnus-verbose-backends
25162 @vindex gnus-verbose-backends
25163 This variable works the same way as @code{gnus-verbose}, but it applies
25164 to the Gnus back ends instead of Gnus proper.
25165
25166 @item nnheader-max-head-length
25167 @vindex nnheader-max-head-length
25168 When the back ends read straight heads of articles, they all try to read
25169 as little as possible. This variable (default 8192) specifies
25170 the absolute max length the back ends will try to read before giving up
25171 on finding a separator line between the head and the body. If this
25172 variable is @code{nil}, there is no upper read bound. If it is
25173 @code{t}, the back ends won't try to read the articles piece by piece,
25174 but read the entire articles. This makes sense with some versions of
25175 @code{ange-ftp} or @code{efs}.
25176
25177 @item nnheader-head-chop-length
25178 @vindex nnheader-head-chop-length
25179 This variable (default 2048) says how big a piece of each article to
25180 read when doing the operation described above.
25181
25182 @item nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25183 @vindex nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25184 @cindex file names
25185 @cindex invalid characters in file names
25186 @cindex characters in file names
25187 This is an alist that says how to translate characters in file names.
25188 For instance, if @samp{:} is invalid as a file character in file names
25189 on your system (you OS/2 user you), you could say something like:
25190
25191 @lisp
25192 @group
25193 (setq nnheader-file-name-translation-alist
25194 '((?: . ?_)))
25195 @end group
25196 @end lisp
25197
25198 In fact, this is the default value for this variable on OS/2 and MS
25199 Windows (phooey) systems.
25200
25201 @item gnus-hidden-properties
25202 @vindex gnus-hidden-properties
25203 This is a list of properties to use to hide ``invisible'' text. It is
25204 @code{(invisible t intangible t)} by default on most systems, which
25205 makes invisible text invisible and intangible.
25206
25207 @item gnus-parse-headers-hook
25208 @vindex gnus-parse-headers-hook
25209 A hook called before parsing headers. It can be used, for instance, to
25210 gather statistics on the headers fetched, or perhaps you'd like to prune
25211 some headers. I don't see why you'd want that, though.
25212
25213 @item gnus-shell-command-separator
25214 @vindex gnus-shell-command-separator
25215 String used to separate two shell commands. The default is @samp{;}.
25216
25217 @item gnus-invalid-group-regexp
25218 @vindex gnus-invalid-group-regexp
25219
25220 Regexp to match ``invalid'' group names when querying user for a group
25221 name. The default value catches some @strong{really} invalid group
25222 names who could possibly mess up Gnus internally (like allowing
25223 @samp{:} in a group name, which is normally used to delimit method and
25224 group).
25225
25226 @acronym{IMAP} users might want to allow @samp{/} in group names though.
25227
25228
25229 @end table
25230
25231 @node The End
25232 @chapter The End
25233
25234 Well, that's the manual---you can get on with your life now. Keep in
25235 touch. Say hello to your cats from me.
25236
25237 My @strong{ghod}---I just can't stand goodbyes. Sniffle.
25238
25239 Ol' Charles Reznikoff said it pretty well, so I leave the floor to him:
25240
25241 @quotation
25242 @strong{Te Deum}
25243
25244 @sp 1
25245 Not because of victories @*
25246 I sing,@*
25247 having none,@*
25248 but for the common sunshine,@*
25249 the breeze,@*
25250 the largess of the spring.
25251
25252 @sp 1
25253 Not for victory@*
25254 but for the day's work done@*
25255 as well as I was able;@*
25256 not for a seat upon the dais@*
25257 but at the common table.@*
25258 @end quotation
25259
25260
25261 @node Appendices
25262 @chapter Appendices
25263
25264 @menu
25265 * XEmacs:: Requirements for installing under XEmacs.
25266 * History:: How Gnus got where it is today.
25267 * On Writing Manuals:: Why this is not a beginner's guide.
25268 * Terminology:: We use really difficult, like, words here.
25269 * Customization:: Tailoring Gnus to your needs.
25270 * Troubleshooting:: What you might try if things do not work.
25271 * Gnus Reference Guide:: Rilly, rilly technical stuff.
25272 * Emacs for Heathens:: A short introduction to Emacsian terms.
25273 * Frequently Asked Questions:: The Gnus FAQ
25274 @end menu
25275
25276
25277 @node XEmacs
25278 @section XEmacs
25279 @cindex XEmacs
25280 @cindex installing under XEmacs
25281
25282 XEmacs is distributed as a collection of packages. You should install
25283 whatever packages the Gnus XEmacs package requires. The current
25284 requirements are @samp{gnus}, @samp{mail-lib}, @samp{xemacs-base},
25285 @samp{eterm}, @samp{sh-script}, @samp{net-utils}, @samp{os-utils},
25286 @samp{dired}, @samp{mh-e}, @samp{sieve}, @samp{ps-print}, @samp{W3},
25287 @samp{pgg}, @samp{mailcrypt}, @samp{ecrypto}, and @samp{sasl}.
25288
25289
25290 @node History
25291 @section History
25292
25293 @cindex history
25294 @sc{gnus} was written by Masanobu @sc{Umeda}. When autumn crept up in
25295 '94, Lars Magne Ingebrigtsen grew bored and decided to rewrite Gnus.
25296
25297 If you want to investigate the person responsible for this outrage,
25298 you can point your (feh!) web browser to
25299 @uref{http://quimby.gnus.org/}. This is also the primary
25300 distribution point for the new and spiffy versions of Gnus, and is
25301 known as The Site That Destroys Newsrcs And Drives People Mad.
25302
25303 During the first extended alpha period of development, the new Gnus was
25304 called ``(ding) Gnus''. @dfn{(ding)} is, of course, short for
25305 @dfn{ding is not Gnus}, which is a total and utter lie, but who cares?
25306 (Besides, the ``Gnus'' in this abbreviation should probably be
25307 pronounced ``news'' as @sc{Umeda} intended, which makes it a more
25308 appropriate name, don't you think?)
25309
25310 In any case, after spending all that energy on coming up with a new and
25311 spunky name, we decided that the name was @emph{too} spunky, so we
25312 renamed it back again to ``Gnus''. But in mixed case. ``Gnus'' vs.
25313 ``@sc{gnus}''. New vs. old.
25314
25315 @menu
25316 * Gnus Versions:: What Gnus versions have been released.
25317 * Other Gnus Versions:: Other Gnus versions that also have been released.
25318 * Why?:: What's the point of Gnus?
25319 * Compatibility:: Just how compatible is Gnus with @sc{gnus}?
25320 * Conformity:: Gnus tries to conform to all standards.
25321 * Emacsen:: Gnus can be run on a few modern Emacsen.
25322 * Gnus Development:: How Gnus is developed.
25323 * Contributors:: Oodles of people.
25324 * New Features:: Pointers to some of the new stuff in Gnus.
25325 @end menu
25326
25327
25328 @node Gnus Versions
25329 @subsection Gnus Versions
25330 @cindex ding Gnus
25331 @cindex September Gnus
25332 @cindex Red Gnus
25333 @cindex Quassia Gnus
25334 @cindex Pterodactyl Gnus
25335 @cindex Oort Gnus
25336 @cindex No Gnus
25337 @cindex Gnus versions
25338
25339 The first ``proper'' release of Gnus 5 was done in November 1995 when it
25340 was included in the Emacs 19.30 distribution (132 (ding) Gnus releases
25341 plus 15 Gnus 5.0 releases).
25342
25343 In May 1996 the next Gnus generation (aka. ``September Gnus'' (after 99
25344 releases)) was released under the name ``Gnus 5.2'' (40 releases).
25345
25346 On July 28th 1996 work on Red Gnus was begun, and it was released on
25347 January 25th 1997 (after 84 releases) as ``Gnus 5.4'' (67 releases).
25348
25349 On September 13th 1997, Quassia Gnus was started and lasted 37 releases.
25350 It was released as ``Gnus 5.6'' on March 8th 1998 (46 releases).
25351
25352 Gnus 5.6 begat Pterodactyl Gnus on August 29th 1998 and was released as
25353 ``Gnus 5.8'' (after 99 releases and a CVS repository) on December 3rd
25354 1999.
25355
25356 On the 26th of October 2000, Oort Gnus was begun and was released as
25357 Gnus 5.10 on May 1st 2003 (24 releases).
25358
25359 On the January 4th 2004, No Gnus was begun.
25360
25361 If you happen upon a version of Gnus that has a prefixed name --
25362 ``(ding) Gnus'', ``September Gnus'', ``Red Gnus'', ``Quassia Gnus'',
25363 ``Pterodactyl Gnus'', ``Oort Gnus'', ``No Gnus'' -- don't panic.
25364 Don't let it know that you're frightened. Back away. Slowly. Whatever
25365 you do, don't run. Walk away, calmly, until you're out of its reach.
25366 Find a proper released version of Gnus and snuggle up to that instead.
25367
25368
25369 @node Other Gnus Versions
25370 @subsection Other Gnus Versions
25371 @cindex Semi-gnus
25372
25373 In addition to the versions of Gnus which have had their releases
25374 coordinated by Lars, one major development has been Semi-gnus from
25375 Japan. It's based on a library called @acronym{SEMI}, which provides
25376 @acronym{MIME} capabilities.
25377
25378 These Gnusae are based mainly on Gnus 5.6 and Pterodactyl Gnus.
25379 Collectively, they are called ``Semi-gnus'', and different strains are
25380 called T-gnus, ET-gnus, Nana-gnus and Chaos. These provide powerful
25381 @acronym{MIME} and multilingualization things, especially important for
25382 Japanese users.
25383
25384
25385 @node Why?
25386 @subsection Why?
25387
25388 What's the point of Gnus?
25389
25390 I want to provide a ``rad'', ``happening'', ``way cool'' and ``hep''
25391 newsreader, that lets you do anything you can think of. That was my
25392 original motivation, but while working on Gnus, it has become clear to
25393 me that this generation of newsreaders really belong in the stone age.
25394 Newsreaders haven't developed much since the infancy of the net. If the
25395 volume continues to rise with the current rate of increase, all current
25396 newsreaders will be pretty much useless. How do you deal with
25397 newsgroups that have thousands of new articles each day? How do you
25398 keep track of millions of people who post?
25399
25400 Gnus offers no real solutions to these questions, but I would very much
25401 like to see Gnus being used as a testing ground for new methods of
25402 reading and fetching news. Expanding on @sc{Umeda}-san's wise decision
25403 to separate the newsreader from the back ends, Gnus now offers a simple
25404 interface for anybody who wants to write new back ends for fetching mail
25405 and news from different sources. I have added hooks for customizations
25406 everywhere I could imagine it being useful. By doing so, I'm inviting
25407 every one of you to explore and invent.
25408
25409 May Gnus never be complete. @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-emacs} and
25410 @kbd{C-u 100 M-x all-hail-xemacs}.
25411
25412
25413 @node Compatibility
25414 @subsection Compatibility
25415
25416 @cindex compatibility
25417 Gnus was designed to be fully compatible with @sc{gnus}. Almost all key
25418 bindings have been kept. More key bindings have been added, of course,
25419 but only in one or two obscure cases have old bindings been changed.
25420
25421 Our motto is:
25422 @quotation
25423 @cartouche
25424 @center In a cloud bones of steel.
25425 @end cartouche
25426 @end quotation
25427
25428 All commands have kept their names. Some internal functions have changed
25429 their names.
25430
25431 The @code{gnus-uu} package has changed drastically. @xref{Decoding
25432 Articles}.
25433
25434 One major compatibility question is the presence of several summary
25435 buffers. All variables relevant while reading a group are
25436 buffer-local to the summary buffer they belong in. Although many
25437 important variables have their values copied into their global
25438 counterparts whenever a command is executed in the summary buffer, this
25439 change might lead to incorrect values being used unless you are careful.
25440
25441 All code that relies on knowledge of @sc{gnus} internals will probably
25442 fail. To take two examples: Sorting @code{gnus-newsrc-alist} (or
25443 changing it in any way, as a matter of fact) is strictly verboten. Gnus
25444 maintains a hash table that points to the entries in this alist (which
25445 speeds up many functions), and changing the alist directly will lead to
25446 peculiar results.
25447
25448 @cindex hilit19
25449 @cindex highlighting
25450 Old hilit19 code does not work at all. In fact, you should probably
25451 remove all hilit code from all Gnus hooks
25452 (@code{gnus-group-prepare-hook} and @code{gnus-summary-prepare-hook}).
25453 Gnus provides various integrated functions for highlighting. These are
25454 faster and more accurate. To make life easier for everybody, Gnus will
25455 by default remove all hilit calls from all hilit hooks. Uncleanliness!
25456 Away!
25457
25458 Packages like @code{expire-kill} will no longer work. As a matter of
25459 fact, you should probably remove all old @sc{gnus} packages (and other
25460 code) when you start using Gnus. More likely than not, Gnus already
25461 does what you have written code to make @sc{gnus} do. (Snicker.)
25462
25463 Even though old methods of doing things are still supported, only the
25464 new methods are documented in this manual. If you detect a new method of
25465 doing something while reading this manual, that does not mean you have
25466 to stop doing it the old way.
25467
25468 Gnus understands all @sc{gnus} startup files.
25469
25470 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
25471 @findex gnus-bug
25472 @cindex reporting bugs
25473 @cindex bugs
25474 Overall, a casual user who hasn't written much code that depends on
25475 @sc{gnus} internals should suffer no problems. If problems occur,
25476 please let me know by issuing that magic command @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}.
25477
25478 @vindex gnus-bug-create-help-buffer
25479 If you are in the habit of sending bug reports @emph{very} often, you
25480 may find the helpful help buffer annoying after a while. If so, set
25481 @code{gnus-bug-create-help-buffer} to @code{nil} to avoid having it pop
25482 up at you.
25483
25484
25485 @node Conformity
25486 @subsection Conformity
25487
25488 No rebels without a clue here, ma'am. We conform to all standards known
25489 to (wo)man. Except for those standards and/or conventions we disagree
25490 with, of course.
25491
25492 @table @strong
25493
25494 @item RFC (2)822
25495 @cindex RFC 822
25496 @cindex RFC 2822
25497 There are no known breaches of this standard.
25498
25499 @item RFC 1036
25500 @cindex RFC 1036
25501 There are no known breaches of this standard, either.
25502
25503 @item Son-of-RFC 1036
25504 @cindex Son-of-RFC 1036
25505 We do have some breaches to this one.
25506
25507 @table @emph
25508
25509 @item X-Newsreader
25510 @itemx User-Agent
25511 These are considered to be ``vanity headers'', while I consider them
25512 to be consumer information. After seeing so many badly formatted
25513 articles coming from @code{tin} and @code{Netscape} I know not to use
25514 either of those for posting articles. I would not have known that if
25515 it wasn't for the @code{X-Newsreader} header.
25516 @end table
25517
25518 @item USEFOR
25519 @cindex USEFOR
25520 USEFOR is an IETF working group writing a successor to RFC 1036, based
25521 on Son-of-RFC 1036. They have produced a number of drafts proposing
25522 various changes to the format of news articles. The Gnus towers will
25523 look into implementing the changes when the draft is accepted as an RFC.
25524
25525 @item MIME - RFC 2045-2049 etc
25526 @cindex @acronym{MIME}
25527 All the various @acronym{MIME} RFCs are supported.
25528
25529 @item Disposition Notifications - RFC 2298
25530 Message Mode is able to request notifications from the receiver.
25531
25532 @item PGP - RFC 1991 and RFC 2440
25533 @cindex RFC 1991
25534 @cindex RFC 2440
25535 RFC 1991 is the original @acronym{PGP} message specification,
25536 published as an informational RFC. RFC 2440 was the follow-up, now
25537 called Open PGP, and put on the Standards Track. Both document a
25538 non-@acronym{MIME} aware @acronym{PGP} format. Gnus supports both
25539 encoding (signing and encryption) and decoding (verification and
25540 decryption).
25541
25542 @item PGP/MIME - RFC 2015/3156
25543 RFC 2015 (superseded by 3156 which references RFC 2440 instead of RFC
25544 1991) describes the @acronym{MIME}-wrapping around the RFC 1991/2440 format.
25545 Gnus supports both encoding and decoding.
25546
25547 @item S/MIME - RFC 2633
25548 RFC 2633 describes the @acronym{S/MIME} format.
25549
25550 @item IMAP - RFC 1730/2060, RFC 2195, RFC 2086, RFC 2359, RFC 2595, RFC 1731
25551 RFC 1730 is @acronym{IMAP} version 4, updated somewhat by RFC 2060
25552 (@acronym{IMAP} 4 revision 1). RFC 2195 describes CRAM-MD5
25553 authentication for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2086 describes access control
25554 lists (ACLs) for @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 2359 describes a @acronym{IMAP}
25555 protocol enhancement. RFC 2595 describes the proper @acronym{TLS}
25556 integration (STARTTLS) with @acronym{IMAP}. RFC 1731 describes the
25557 GSSAPI/Kerberos4 mechanisms for @acronym{IMAP}.
25558
25559 @end table
25560
25561 If you ever notice Gnus acting non-compliant with regards to the texts
25562 mentioned above, don't hesitate to drop a note to Gnus Towers and let us
25563 know.
25564
25565
25566 @node Emacsen
25567 @subsection Emacsen
25568 @cindex Emacsen
25569 @cindex XEmacs
25570 @cindex Mule
25571 @cindex Emacs
25572
25573 This Gnus version should work on:
25574
25575 @itemize @bullet
25576
25577 @item
25578 Emacs 21.1 and up.
25579
25580 @item
25581 XEmacs 21.4 and up.
25582
25583 @end itemize
25584
25585 This Gnus version will absolutely not work on any Emacsen older than
25586 that. Not reliably, at least. Older versions of Gnus may work on older
25587 Emacs versions. Particularly, Gnus 5.10.8 should also work on Emacs
25588 20.7 and XEmacs 21.1.
25589
25590
25591 @node Gnus Development
25592 @subsection Gnus Development
25593
25594 Gnus is developed in a two-phased cycle. The first phase involves much
25595 discussion on the development mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}, where people
25596 propose changes and new features, post patches and new back ends. This
25597 phase is called the @dfn{alpha} phase, since the Gnusae released in this
25598 phase are @dfn{alpha releases}, or (perhaps more commonly in other
25599 circles) @dfn{snapshots}. During this phase, Gnus is assumed to be
25600 unstable and should not be used by casual users. Gnus alpha releases
25601 have names like ``Oort Gnus'' and ``No Gnus''. @xref{Gnus Versions}.
25602
25603 After futzing around for 10-100 alpha releases, Gnus is declared
25604 @dfn{frozen}, and only bug fixes are applied. Gnus loses the prefix,
25605 and is called things like ``Gnus 5.10.1'' instead. Normal people are
25606 supposed to be able to use these, and these are mostly discussed on the
25607 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus} newsgroup. This newgroup is mirrored to the
25608 mailing list @samp{info-gnus-english@@gnu.org} which is carried on Gmane
25609 as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.user}. These releases are finally integrated
25610 in Emacs.
25611
25612 The division of discussion between the ding mailing list and the Gnus
25613 newsgroup is not purely based on publicity concerns. It's true that
25614 having people write about the horrible things that an alpha Gnus release
25615 can do (sometimes) in a public forum may scare people off, but more
25616 importantly, talking about new experimental features that have been
25617 introduced may confuse casual users. New features are frequently
25618 introduced, fiddled with, and judged to be found wanting, and then
25619 either discarded or totally rewritten. People reading the mailing list
25620 usually keep up with these rapid changes, while people on the newsgroup
25621 can't be assumed to do so.
25622
25623 So if you have problems with or questions about the alpha versions,
25624 direct those to the ding mailing list @samp{ding@@gnus.org}. This list
25625 is also available on Gmane as @samp{gmane.emacs.gnus.general}.
25626
25627 @cindex Incoming*
25628 @vindex mail-source-delete-incoming
25629 Some variable defaults differ between alpha Gnusae and released Gnusae,
25630 in particular, @code{mail-source-delete-incoming}. This is to prevent
25631 lossage of mail if an alpha release hiccups while handling the mail.
25632 @xref{Mail Source Customization}.
25633
25634 @node Contributors
25635 @subsection Contributors
25636 @cindex contributors
25637
25638 The new Gnus version couldn't have been done without the help of all the
25639 people on the (ding) mailing list. Every day for over a year I have
25640 gotten billions of nice bug reports from them, filling me with joy,
25641 every single one of them. Smooches. The people on the list have been
25642 tried beyond endurance, what with my ``oh, that's a neat idea <type
25643 type>, yup, I'll release it right away <ship off> no wait, that doesn't
25644 work at all <type type>, yup, I'll ship that one off right away <ship
25645 off> no, wait, that absolutely does not work'' policy for releases.
25646 Micro$oft---bah. Amateurs. I'm @emph{much} worse. (Or is that
25647 ``worser''? ``much worser''? ``worsest''?)
25648
25649 I would like to take this opportunity to thank the Academy for@dots{} oops,
25650 wrong show.
25651
25652 @itemize @bullet
25653
25654 @item
25655 Masanobu @sc{Umeda}---the writer of the original @sc{gnus}.
25656
25657 @item
25658 Shenghuo Zhu---uudecode.el, mm-uu.el, rfc1843.el, webmail.el,
25659 nnwarchive and many, many other things connected with @acronym{MIME} and
25660 other types of en/decoding, as well as general bug fixing, new
25661 functionality and stuff.
25662
25663 @item
25664 Per Abrahamsen---custom, scoring, highlighting and @sc{soup} code (as
25665 well as numerous other things).
25666
25667 @item
25668 Luis Fernandes---design and graphics.
25669
25670 @item
25671 Joe Reiss---creator of the smiley faces.
25672
25673 @item
25674 Justin Sheehy---the @acronym{FAQ} maintainer.
25675
25676 @item
25677 Erik Naggum---help, ideas, support, code and stuff.
25678
25679 @item
25680 Wes Hardaker---@file{gnus-picon.el} and the manual section on
25681 @dfn{picons} (@pxref{Picons}).
25682
25683 @item
25684 Kim-Minh Kaplan---further work on the picon code.
25685
25686 @item
25687 Brad Miller---@file{gnus-gl.el} and the GroupLens manual section
25688 (@pxref{GroupLens}).
25689
25690 @item
25691 Sudish Joseph---innumerable bug fixes.
25692
25693 @item
25694 Ilja Weis---@file{gnus-topic.el}.
25695
25696 @item
25697 Steven L. Baur---lots and lots and lots of bugs detections and fixes.
25698
25699 @item
25700 Vladimir Alexiev---the refcard and reference booklets.
25701
25702 @item
25703 Felix Lee & Jamie Zawinski---I stole some pieces from the XGnus
25704 distribution by Felix Lee and JWZ.
25705
25706 @item
25707 Scott Byer---@file{nnfolder.el} enhancements & rewrite.
25708
25709 @item
25710 Peter Mutsaers---orphan article scoring code.
25711
25712 @item
25713 Ken Raeburn---POP mail support.
25714
25715 @item
25716 Hallvard B Furuseth---various bits and pieces, especially dealing with
25717 .newsrc files.
25718
25719 @item
25720 Brian Edmonds---@file{gnus-bbdb.el}.
25721
25722 @item
25723 David Moore---rewrite of @file{nnvirtual.el} and many other things.
25724
25725 @item
25726 Kevin Davidson---came up with the name @dfn{ding}, so blame him.
25727
25728 @item
25729 François Pinard---many, many interesting and thorough bug reports, as
25730 well as autoconf support.
25731
25732 @end itemize
25733
25734 This manual was proof-read by Adrian Aichner, with Ricardo Nassif, Mark
25735 Borges, and Jost Krieger proof-reading parts of the manual.
25736
25737 The following people have contributed many patches and suggestions:
25738
25739 Christopher Davis,
25740 Andrew Eskilsson,
25741 Kai Grossjohann,
25742 Kevin Greiner,
25743 Jesper Harder,
25744 Paul Jarc,
25745 Simon Josefsson,
25746 David KÃ¥gedal,
25747 Richard Pieri,
25748 Fabrice Popineau,
25749 Daniel Quinlan,
25750 Michael Shields,
25751 Reiner Steib,
25752 Jason L. Tibbitts, III,
25753 Jack Vinson,
25754 Katsumi Yamaoka, @c Yamaoka
25755 and
25756 Teodor Zlatanov.
25757
25758 Also thanks to the following for patches and stuff:
25759
25760 Jari Aalto,
25761 Adrian Aichner,
25762 Vladimir Alexiev,
25763 Russ Allbery,
25764 Peter Arius,
25765 Matt Armstrong,
25766 Marc Auslander,
25767 Miles Bader,
25768 Alexei V. Barantsev,
25769 Frank Bennett,
25770 Robert Bihlmeyer,
25771 Chris Bone,
25772 Mark Borges,
25773 Mark Boyns,
25774 Lance A. Brown,
25775 Rob Browning,
25776 Kees de Bruin,
25777 Martin Buchholz,
25778 Joe Buehler,
25779 Kevin Buhr,
25780 Alastair Burt,
25781 Joao Cachopo,
25782 Zlatko Calusic,
25783 Massimo Campostrini,
25784 Castor,
25785 David Charlap,
25786 Dan Christensen,
25787 Kevin Christian,
25788 Jae-you Chung, @c ?
25789 James H. Cloos, Jr.,
25790 Laura Conrad,
25791 Michael R. Cook,
25792 Glenn Coombs,
25793 Andrew J. Cosgriff,
25794 Neil Crellin,
25795 Frank D. Cringle,
25796 Geoffrey T. Dairiki,
25797 Andre Deparade,
25798 Ulrik Dickow,
25799 Dave Disser,
25800 Rui-Tao Dong, @c ?
25801 Joev Dubach,
25802 Michael Welsh Duggan,
25803 Dave Edmondson,
25804 Paul Eggert,
25805 Mark W. Eichin,
25806 Karl Eichwalder,
25807 Enami Tsugutomo, @c Enami
25808 Michael Ernst,
25809 Luc Van Eycken,
25810 Sam Falkner,
25811 Nelson Jose dos Santos Ferreira,
25812 Sigbjorn Finne,
25813 Sven Fischer,
25814 Paul Fisher,
25815 Decklin Foster,
25816 Gary D. Foster,
25817 Paul Franklin,
25818 Guy Geens,
25819 Arne Georg Gleditsch,
25820 David S. Goldberg,
25821 Michelangelo Grigni,
25822 Dale Hagglund,
25823 D. Hall,
25824 Magnus Hammerin,
25825 Kenichi Handa, @c Handa
25826 Raja R. Harinath,
25827 Yoshiki Hayashi, @c Hayashi
25828 P. E. Jareth Hein,
25829 Hisashige Kenji, @c Hisashige
25830 Scott Hofmann,
25831 Marc Horowitz,
25832 Gunnar Horrigmo,
25833 Richard Hoskins,
25834 Brad Howes,
25835 Miguel de Icaza,
25836 François Felix Ingrand,
25837 Tatsuya Ichikawa, @c Ichikawa
25838 Ishikawa Ichiro, @c Ishikawa
25839 Lee Iverson,
25840 Iwamuro Motonori, @c Iwamuro
25841 Rajappa Iyer,
25842 Andreas Jaeger,
25843 Adam P. Jenkins,
25844 Randell Jesup,
25845 Fred Johansen,
25846 Gareth Jones,
25847 Greg Klanderman,
25848 Karl Kleinpaste,
25849 Michael Klingbeil,
25850 Peter Skov Knudsen,
25851 Shuhei Kobayashi, @c Kobayashi
25852 Petr Konecny,
25853 Koseki Yoshinori, @c Koseki
25854 Thor Kristoffersen,
25855 Jens Lautenbacher,
25856 Martin Larose,
25857 Seokchan Lee, @c Lee
25858 Joerg Lenneis,
25859 Carsten Leonhardt,
25860 James LewisMoss,
25861 Christian Limpach,
25862 Markus Linnala,
25863 Dave Love,
25864 Mike McEwan,
25865 Tonny Madsen,
25866 Shlomo Mahlab,
25867 Nat Makarevitch,
25868 Istvan Marko,
25869 David Martin,
25870 Jason R. Mastaler,
25871 Gordon Matzigkeit,
25872 Timo Metzemakers,
25873 Richard Mlynarik,
25874 Lantz Moore,
25875 Morioka Tomohiko, @c Morioka
25876 Erik Toubro Nielsen,
25877 Hrvoje Niksic,
25878 Andy Norman,
25879 Fred Oberhauser,
25880 C. R. Oldham,
25881 Alexandre Oliva,
25882 Ken Olstad,
25883 Masaharu Onishi, @c Onishi
25884 Hideki Ono, @c Ono
25885 Ettore Perazzoli,
25886 William Perry,
25887 Stephen Peters,
25888 Jens-Ulrik Holger Petersen,
25889 Ulrich Pfeifer,
25890 Matt Pharr,
25891 Andy Piper,
25892 John McClary Prevost,
25893 Bill Pringlemeir,
25894 Mike Pullen,
25895 Jim Radford,
25896 Colin Rafferty,
25897 Lasse Rasinen,
25898 Lars Balker Rasmussen,
25899 Joe Reiss,
25900 Renaud Rioboo,
25901 Roland B. Roberts,
25902 Bart Robinson,
25903 Christian von Roques,
25904 Markus Rost,
25905 Jason Rumney,
25906 Wolfgang Rupprecht,
25907 Jay Sachs,
25908 Dewey M. Sasser,
25909 Conrad Sauerwald,
25910 Loren Schall,
25911 Dan Schmidt,
25912 Ralph Schleicher,
25913 Philippe Schnoebelen,
25914 Andreas Schwab,
25915 Randal L. Schwartz,
25916 Danny Siu,
25917 Matt Simmons,
25918 Paul D. Smith,
25919 Jeff Sparkes,
25920 Toby Speight,
25921 Michael Sperber,
25922 Darren Stalder,
25923 Richard Stallman,
25924 Greg Stark,
25925 Sam Steingold,
25926 Paul Stevenson,
25927 Jonas Steverud,
25928 Paul Stodghill,
25929 Kiyokazu Suto, @c Suto
25930 Kurt Swanson,
25931 Samuel Tardieu,
25932 Teddy,
25933 Chuck Thompson,
25934 Tozawa Akihiko, @c Tozawa
25935 Philippe Troin,
25936 James Troup,
25937 Trung Tran-Duc,
25938 Jack Twilley,
25939 Aaron M. Ucko,
25940 Aki Vehtari,
25941 Didier Verna,
25942 Vladimir Volovich,
25943 Jan Vroonhof,
25944 Stefan Waldherr,
25945 Pete Ware,
25946 Barry A. Warsaw,
25947 Christoph Wedler,
25948 Joe Wells,
25949 Lee Willis,
25950 and
25951 Lloyd Zusman.
25952
25953
25954 For a full overview of what each person has done, the ChangeLogs
25955 included in the Gnus alpha distributions should give ample reading
25956 (550kB and counting).
25957
25958 Apologies to everybody that I've forgotten, of which there are many, I'm
25959 sure.
25960
25961 Gee, that's quite a list of people. I guess that must mean that there
25962 actually are people who are using Gnus. Who'd'a thunk it!
25963
25964
25965 @node New Features
25966 @subsection New Features
25967 @cindex new features
25968
25969 @menu
25970 * ding Gnus:: New things in Gnus 5.0/5.1, the first new Gnus.
25971 * September Gnus:: The Thing Formally Known As Gnus 5.2/5.3.
25972 * Red Gnus:: Third time best---Gnus 5.4/5.5.
25973 * Quassia Gnus:: Two times two is four, or Gnus 5.6/5.7.
25974 * Pterodactyl Gnus:: Pentad also starts with P, AKA Gnus 5.8/5.9.
25975 * Oort Gnus:: It's big. It's far out. Gnus 5.10/5.11.
25976 @end menu
25977
25978 These lists are, of course, just @emph{short} overviews of the
25979 @emph{most} important new features. No, really. There are tons more.
25980 Yes, we have feeping creaturism in full effect.
25981
25982 @node ding Gnus
25983 @subsubsection (ding) Gnus
25984
25985 New features in Gnus 5.0/5.1:
25986
25987 @itemize @bullet
25988
25989 @item
25990 The look of all buffers can be changed by setting format-like variables
25991 (@pxref{Group Buffer Format} and @pxref{Summary Buffer Format}).
25992
25993 @item
25994 Local spool and several @acronym{NNTP} servers can be used at once
25995 (@pxref{Select Methods}).
25996
25997 @item
25998 You can combine groups into virtual groups (@pxref{Virtual Groups}).
25999
26000 @item
26001 You can read a number of different mail formats (@pxref{Getting Mail}).
26002 All the mail back ends implement a convenient mail expiry scheme
26003 (@pxref{Expiring Mail}).
26004
26005 @item
26006 Gnus can use various strategies for gathering threads that have lost
26007 their roots (thereby gathering loose sub-threads into one thread) or it
26008 can go back and retrieve enough headers to build a complete thread
26009 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26010
26011 @item
26012 Killed groups can be displayed in the group buffer, and you can read
26013 them as well (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26014
26015 @item
26016 Gnus can do partial group updates---you do not have to retrieve the
26017 entire active file just to check for new articles in a few groups
26018 (@pxref{The Active File}).
26019
26020 @item
26021 Gnus implements a sliding scale of subscribedness to groups
26022 (@pxref{Group Levels}).
26023
26024 @item
26025 You can score articles according to any number of criteria
26026 (@pxref{Scoring}). You can even get Gnus to find out how to score
26027 articles for you (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
26028
26029 @item
26030 Gnus maintains a dribble buffer that is auto-saved the normal Emacs
26031 manner, so it should be difficult to lose much data on what you have
26032 read if your machine should go down (@pxref{Auto Save}).
26033
26034 @item
26035 Gnus now has its own startup file (@file{~/.gnus.el}) to avoid
26036 cluttering up the @file{.emacs} file.
26037
26038 @item
26039 You can set the process mark on both groups and articles and perform
26040 operations on all the marked items (@pxref{Process/Prefix}).
26041
26042 @item
26043 You can grep through a subset of groups and create a group from the
26044 results (@pxref{Kibozed Groups}).
26045
26046 @item
26047 You can list subsets of groups according to, well, anything
26048 (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26049
26050 @item
26051 You can browse foreign servers and subscribe to groups from those
26052 servers (@pxref{Browse Foreign Server}).
26053
26054 @item
26055 Gnus can fetch articles, asynchronously, on a second connection to the
26056 server (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
26057
26058 @item
26059 You can cache articles locally (@pxref{Article Caching}).
26060
26061 @item
26062 The uudecode functions have been expanded and generalized
26063 (@pxref{Decoding Articles}).
26064
26065 @item
26066 You can still post uuencoded articles, which was a little-known feature
26067 of @sc{gnus}' past (@pxref{Uuencoding and Posting}).
26068
26069 @item
26070 Fetching parents (and other articles) now actually works without
26071 glitches (@pxref{Finding the Parent}).
26072
26073 @item
26074 Gnus can fetch @acronym{FAQ}s and group descriptions (@pxref{Group Information}).
26075
26076 @item
26077 Digests (and other files) can be used as the basis for groups
26078 (@pxref{Document Groups}).
26079
26080 @item
26081 Articles can be highlighted and customized (@pxref{Customizing
26082 Articles}).
26083
26084 @item
26085 URLs and other external references can be buttonized (@pxref{Article
26086 Buttons}).
26087
26088 @item
26089 You can do lots of strange stuff with the Gnus window & frame
26090 configuration (@pxref{Window Layout}).
26091
26092 @item
26093 You can click on buttons instead of using the keyboard
26094 (@pxref{Buttons}).
26095
26096 @end itemize
26097
26098
26099 @node September Gnus
26100 @subsubsection September Gnus
26101
26102 @iftex
26103 @iflatex
26104 \gnusfig{-28cm}{0cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/september,height=20cm}}
26105 @end iflatex
26106 @end iftex
26107
26108 New features in Gnus 5.2/5.3:
26109
26110 @itemize @bullet
26111
26112 @item
26113 A new message composition mode is used. All old customization variables
26114 for @code{mail-mode}, @code{rnews-reply-mode} and @code{gnus-msg} are
26115 now obsolete.
26116
26117 @item
26118 Gnus is now able to generate @dfn{sparse} threads---threads where
26119 missing articles are represented by empty nodes (@pxref{Customizing
26120 Threading}).
26121
26122 @lisp
26123 (setq gnus-build-sparse-threads 'some)
26124 @end lisp
26125
26126 @item
26127 Outgoing articles are stored on a special archive server
26128 (@pxref{Archived Messages}).
26129
26130 @item
26131 Partial thread regeneration now happens when articles are
26132 referred.
26133
26134 @item
26135 Gnus can make use of GroupLens predictions (@pxref{GroupLens}).
26136
26137 @item
26138 Picons (personal icons) can be displayed under XEmacs (@pxref{Picons}).
26139
26140 @item
26141 A @code{trn}-like tree buffer can be displayed (@pxref{Tree Display}).
26142
26143 @lisp
26144 (setq gnus-use-trees t)
26145 @end lisp
26146
26147 @item
26148 An @code{nn}-like pick-and-read minor mode is available for the summary
26149 buffers (@pxref{Pick and Read}).
26150
26151 @lisp
26152 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-mode-hook 'gnus-pick-mode)
26153 @end lisp
26154
26155 @item
26156 In binary groups you can use a special binary minor mode (@pxref{Binary
26157 Groups}).
26158
26159 @item
26160 Groups can be grouped in a folding topic hierarchy (@pxref{Group
26161 Topics}).
26162
26163 @lisp
26164 (add-hook 'gnus-group-mode-hook 'gnus-topic-mode)
26165 @end lisp
26166
26167 @item
26168 Gnus can re-send and bounce mail (@pxref{Summary Mail Commands}).
26169
26170 @item
26171 Groups can now have a score, and bubbling based on entry frequency
26172 is possible (@pxref{Group Score}).
26173
26174 @lisp
26175 (add-hook 'gnus-summary-exit-hook 'gnus-summary-bubble-group)
26176 @end lisp
26177
26178 @item
26179 Groups can be process-marked, and commands can be performed on
26180 groups of groups (@pxref{Marking Groups}).
26181
26182 @item
26183 Caching is possible in virtual groups.
26184
26185 @item
26186 @code{nndoc} now understands all kinds of digests, mail boxes, rnews
26187 news batches, ClariNet briefs collections, and just about everything
26188 else (@pxref{Document Groups}).
26189
26190 @item
26191 Gnus has a new back end (@code{nnsoup}) to create/read SOUP packets
26192 (@pxref{SOUP}).
26193
26194 @item
26195 The Gnus cache is much faster.
26196
26197 @item
26198 Groups can be sorted according to many criteria (@pxref{Sorting
26199 Groups}).
26200
26201 @item
26202 New group parameters have been introduced to set list-addresses and
26203 expiry times (@pxref{Group Parameters}).
26204
26205 @item
26206 All formatting specs allow specifying faces to be used
26207 (@pxref{Formatting Fonts}).
26208
26209 @item
26210 There are several more commands for setting/removing/acting on process
26211 marked articles on the @kbd{M P} submap (@pxref{Setting Process Marks}).
26212
26213 @item
26214 The summary buffer can be limited to show parts of the available
26215 articles based on a wide range of criteria. These commands have been
26216 bound to keys on the @kbd{/} submap (@pxref{Limiting}).
26217
26218 @item
26219 Articles can be made persistent with the @kbd{*} command
26220 (@pxref{Persistent Articles}).
26221
26222 @item
26223 All functions for hiding article elements are now toggles.
26224
26225 @item
26226 Article headers can be buttonized (@pxref{Article Washing}).
26227
26228 @item
26229 All mail back ends support fetching articles by @code{Message-ID}.
26230
26231 @item
26232 Duplicate mail can now be treated properly (@pxref{Duplicates}).
26233
26234 @item
26235 All summary mode commands are available directly from the article
26236 buffer (@pxref{Article Keymap}).
26237
26238 @item
26239 Frames can be part of @code{gnus-buffer-configuration} (@pxref{Window
26240 Layout}).
26241
26242 @item
26243 Mail can be re-scanned by a daemonic process (@pxref{Daemons}).
26244 @iftex
26245 @iflatex
26246 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fseptember,height=5cm}}
26247 @end iflatex
26248 @end iftex
26249
26250 @item
26251 Gnus can make use of NoCeM files to weed out spam (@pxref{NoCeM}).
26252
26253 @lisp
26254 (setq gnus-use-nocem t)
26255 @end lisp
26256
26257 @item
26258 Groups can be made permanently visible (@pxref{Listing Groups}).
26259
26260 @lisp
26261 (setq gnus-permanently-visible-groups "^nnml:")
26262 @end lisp
26263
26264 @item
26265 Many new hooks have been introduced to make customizing easier.
26266
26267 @item
26268 Gnus respects the @code{Mail-Copies-To} header.
26269
26270 @item
26271 Threads can be gathered by looking at the @code{References} header
26272 (@pxref{Customizing Threading}).
26273
26274 @lisp
26275 (setq gnus-summary-thread-gathering-function
26276 'gnus-gather-threads-by-references)
26277 @end lisp
26278
26279 @item
26280 Read articles can be stored in a special backlog buffer to avoid
26281 refetching (@pxref{Article Backlog}).
26282
26283 @lisp
26284 (setq gnus-keep-backlog 50)
26285 @end lisp
26286
26287 @item
26288 A clean copy of the current article is always stored in a separate
26289 buffer to allow easier treatment.
26290
26291 @item
26292 Gnus can suggest where to save articles (@pxref{Saving Articles}).
26293
26294 @item
26295 Gnus doesn't have to do as much prompting when saving (@pxref{Saving
26296 Articles}).
26297
26298 @lisp
26299 (setq gnus-prompt-before-saving t)
26300 @end lisp
26301
26302 @item
26303 @code{gnus-uu} can view decoded files asynchronously while fetching
26304 articles (@pxref{Other Decode Variables}).
26305
26306 @lisp
26307 (setq gnus-uu-grabbed-file-functions 'gnus-uu-grab-view)
26308 @end lisp
26309
26310 @item
26311 Filling in the article buffer now works properly on cited text
26312 (@pxref{Article Washing}).
26313
26314 @item
26315 Hiding cited text adds buttons to toggle hiding, and how much
26316 cited text to hide is now customizable (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
26317
26318 @lisp
26319 (setq gnus-cited-lines-visible 2)
26320 @end lisp
26321
26322 @item
26323 Boring headers can be hidden (@pxref{Article Hiding}).
26324
26325 @item
26326 Default scoring values can now be set from the menu bar.
26327
26328 @item
26329 Further syntax checking of outgoing articles have been added.
26330
26331 @end itemize
26332
26333
26334 @node Red Gnus
26335 @subsubsection Red Gnus
26336
26337 New features in Gnus 5.4/5.5:
26338
26339 @iftex
26340 @iflatex
26341 \gnusfig{-5.5cm}{-4cm}{\epsfig{figure=ps/red,height=20cm}}
26342 @end iflatex
26343 @end iftex
26344
26345 @itemize @bullet
26346
26347 @item
26348 @file{nntp.el} has been totally rewritten in an asynchronous fashion.
26349
26350 @item
26351 Article prefetching functionality has been moved up into
26352 Gnus (@pxref{Asynchronous Fetching}).
26353
26354 @item
26355 Scoring can now be performed with logical operators like @code{and},
26356 @code{or}, @code{not}, and parent redirection (@pxref{Advanced
26357 Scoring}).
26358
26359 @item
26360 Article washing status can be displayed in the
26361 article mode line (@pxref{Misc Article}).
26362
26363 @item
26364 @file{gnus.el} has been split into many smaller files.
26365
26366 @item
26367 Suppression of duplicate articles based on Message-ID can be done
26368 (@pxref{Duplicate Suppression}).
26369
26370 @lisp
26371 (setq gnus-suppress-duplicates t)
26372 @end lisp
26373
26374 @item
26375 New variables for specifying what score and adapt files are to be
26376 considered home score and adapt files (@pxref{Home Score File}) have
26377 been added.
26378
26379 @item
26380 @code{nndoc} was rewritten to be easily extendable (@pxref{Document
26381 Server Internals}).
26382
26383 @item
26384 Groups can inherit group parameters from parent topics (@pxref{Topic
26385 Parameters}).
26386
26387 @item
26388 Article editing has been revamped and is now actually usable.
26389
26390 @item
26391 Signatures can be recognized in more intelligent fashions
26392 (@pxref{Article Signature}).
26393
26394 @item
26395 Summary pick mode has been made to look more @code{nn}-like. Line
26396 numbers are displayed and the @kbd{.} command can be used to pick
26397 articles (@code{Pick and Read}).
26398
26399 @item
26400 Commands for moving the @file{.newsrc.eld} from one server to
26401 another have been added (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
26402
26403 @item
26404 There's a way now to specify that ``uninteresting'' fields be suppressed
26405 when generating lines in buffers (@pxref{Advanced Formatting}).
26406
26407 @item
26408 Several commands in the group buffer can be undone with @kbd{C-M-_}
26409 (@pxref{Undo}).
26410
26411 @item
26412 Scoring can be done on words using the new score type @code{w}
26413 (@pxref{Score File Format}).
26414
26415 @item
26416 Adaptive scoring can be done on a Subject word-by-word basis
26417 (@pxref{Adaptive Scoring}).
26418
26419 @lisp
26420 (setq gnus-use-adaptive-scoring '(word))
26421 @end lisp
26422
26423 @item
26424 Scores can be decayed (@pxref{Score Decays}).
26425
26426 @lisp
26427 (setq gnus-decay-scores t)
26428 @end lisp
26429
26430 @item
26431 Scoring can be performed using a regexp on the Date header. The Date is
26432 normalized to compact ISO 8601 format first (@pxref{Score File Format}).
26433
26434 @item
26435 A new command has been added to remove all data on articles from
26436 the native server (@pxref{Changing Servers}).
26437
26438 @item
26439 A new command for reading collections of documents
26440 (@code{nndoc} with @code{nnvirtual} on top) has been added---@kbd{C-M-d}
26441 (@pxref{Really Various Summary Commands}).
26442
26443 @item
26444 Process mark sets can be pushed and popped (@pxref{Setting Process
26445 Marks}).
26446
26447 @item
26448 A new mail-to-news back end makes it possible to post even when the @acronym{NNTP}
26449 server doesn't allow posting (@pxref{Mail-To-News Gateways}).
26450
26451 @item
26452 A new back end for reading searches from Web search engines
26453 (@dfn{DejaNews}, @dfn{Alta Vista}, @dfn{InReference}) has been added
26454 (@pxref{Web Searches}).
26455
26456 @item
26457 Groups inside topics can now be sorted using the standard sorting
26458 functions, and each topic can be sorted independently (@pxref{Topic
26459 Sorting}).
26460
26461 @item
26462 Subsets of the groups can be sorted independently (@code{Sorting
26463 Groups}).
26464
26465 @item
26466 Cached articles can be pulled into the groups (@pxref{Summary Generation
26467 Commands}).
26468 @iftex
26469 @iflatex
26470 \marginpar[\mbox{}\hfill\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}]{\epsfig{figure=ps/fred,width=3cm}}
26471 @end iflatex
26472 @end iftex
26473
26474 @item
26475 Score files are now applied in a more reliable order (@pxref{Score
26476 Variables}).
26477
26478 @item
26479 Reports on where mail messages end up can be generated (@pxref{Splitting
26480 Mail}).
26481
26482 @item
26483 More hooks and functions have been added to remove junk from incoming
26484 mail before saving the mail (@pxref{Washing Mail}).
26485
26486 @item
26487 Emphasized text can be properly fontisized:
26488
26489 @end itemize
26490
26491
26492 @node Quassia Gnus
26493 @subsubsection Quassia Gnus
26494
26495 New features in Gnus 5.6:
26496
26497 @itemize @bullet
26498
26499 @item
26500 New functionality for using Gnus as an offline newsreader has been
26501 added. A plethora of new commands and modes have been added.
26502 @xref{Gnus Unplugged}, for the full story.
26503
26504 @item
26505 The @code{nndraft} back end has returned, but works differently than
26506 before. All Message buffers are now also articles in the @code{nndraft}
26507 group, which is created automatically.
26508
26509 @item
26510 @code{gnus-alter-header-function} can now be used to alter header
26511 values.
26512
26513 @item
26514 @code{gnus-summary-goto-article} now accept Message-ID's.
26515
26516 @item
26517 A new Message command for deleting text in the body of a message
26518 outside the region: @kbd{C-c C-v}.
26519
26520 @item
26521 You can now post to component group in @code{nnvirtual} groups with
26522 @kbd{C-u C-c C-c}.
26523
26524 @item
26525 @code{nntp-rlogin-program}---new variable to ease customization.
26526
26527 @item
26528 @code{C-u C-c C-c} in @code{gnus-article-edit-mode} will now inhibit
26529 re-highlighting of the article buffer.
26530
26531 @item
26532 New element in @code{gnus-boring-article-headers}---@code{long-to}.
26533
26534 @item
26535 @kbd{M-i} symbolic prefix command. @xref{Symbolic Prefixes}, for
26536 details.
26537
26538 @item
26539 @kbd{L} and @kbd{I} in the summary buffer now take the symbolic prefix
26540 @kbd{a} to add the score rule to the @file{all.SCORE} file.
26541
26542 @item
26543 @code{gnus-simplify-subject-functions} variable to allow greater
26544 control over simplification.
26545
26546 @item
26547 @kbd{A T}---new command for fetching the current thread.
26548
26549 @item
26550 @kbd{/ T}---new command for including the current thread in the
26551 limit.
26552
26553 @item
26554 @kbd{M-RET} is a new Message command for breaking cited text.
26555
26556 @item
26557 @samp{\\1}-expressions are now valid in @code{nnmail-split-methods}.
26558
26559 @item
26560 The @code{custom-face-lookup} function has been removed.
26561 If you used this function in your initialization files, you must
26562 rewrite them to use @code{face-spec-set} instead.
26563
26564 @item
26565 Canceling now uses the current select method. Symbolic prefix
26566 @kbd{a} forces normal posting method.
26567
26568 @item
26569 New command to translate M******** sm*rtq**t*s into proper
26570 text---@kbd{W d}.
26571
26572 @item
26573 For easier debugging of @code{nntp}, you can set
26574 @code{nntp-record-commands} to a non-@code{nil} value.
26575
26576 @item
26577 @code{nntp} now uses @file{~/.authinfo}, a @file{.netrc}-like file, for
26578 controlling where and how to send @sc{authinfo} to @acronym{NNTP} servers.
26579
26580 @item
26581 A command for editing group parameters from the summary buffer
26582 has been added.
26583
26584 @item
26585 A history of where mails have been split is available.
26586
26587 @item
26588 A new article date command has been added---@code{article-date-iso8601}.
26589
26590 @item
26591 Subjects can be simplified when threading by setting
26592 @code{gnus-score-thread-simplify}.
26593
26594 @item
26595 A new function for citing in Message has been
26596 added---@code{message-cite-original-without-signature}.
26597
26598 @item
26599 @code{article-strip-all-blank-lines}---new article command.
26600
26601 @item
26602 A new Message command to kill to the end of the article has
26603 been added.
26604
26605 @item
26606 A minimum adaptive score can be specified by using the
26607 @code{gnus-adaptive-word-minimum} variable.
26608
26609 @item
26610 The ``lapsed date'' article header can be kept continually
26611 updated by the @code{gnus-start-date-timer} command.
26612
26613 @item
26614 Web listserv archives can be read with the @code{nnlistserv} back end.
26615
26616 @item
26617 Old dejanews archives can now be read by @code{nnweb}.
26618
26619 @end itemize
26620
26621 @node Pterodactyl Gnus
26622 @subsubsection Pterodactyl Gnus
26623
26624 New features in Gnus 5.8:
26625
26626 @itemize @bullet
26627
26628 @item
26629 The mail-fetching functions have changed. See the manual for the
26630 many details. In particular, all procmail fetching variables are gone.
26631
26632 If you used procmail like in
26633
26634 @lisp
26635 (setq nnmail-use-procmail t)
26636 (setq nnmail-spool-file 'procmail)
26637 (setq nnmail-procmail-directory "~/mail/incoming/")
26638 (setq nnmail-procmail-suffix "\\.in")
26639 @end lisp
26640
26641 this now has changed to
26642
26643 @lisp
26644 (setq mail-sources
26645 '((directory :path "~/mail/incoming/"
26646 :suffix ".in")))
26647 @end lisp
26648
26649 @xref{Mail Source Specifiers}.
26650
26651 @item
26652 Gnus is now a @acronym{MIME}-capable reader. This affects many parts of
26653 Gnus, and adds a slew of new commands. See the manual for details.
26654
26655 @item
26656 Gnus has also been multilingualized. This also affects too
26657 many parts of Gnus to summarize here, and adds many new variables.
26658
26659 @item
26660 @code{gnus-auto-select-first} can now be a function to be
26661 called to position point.
26662
26663 @item
26664 The user can now decide which extra headers should be included in
26665 summary buffers and @acronym{NOV} files.
26666
26667 @item
26668 @code{gnus-article-display-hook} has been removed. Instead, a number
26669 of variables starting with @code{gnus-treat-} have been added.
26670
26671 @item
26672 The Gnus posting styles have been redone again and now works in a
26673 subtly different manner.
26674
26675 @item
26676 New web-based back ends have been added: @code{nnslashdot},
26677 @code{nnwarchive} and @code{nnultimate}. nnweb has been revamped,
26678 again, to keep up with ever-changing layouts.
26679
26680 @item
26681 Gnus can now read @acronym{IMAP} mail via @code{nnimap}.
26682
26683 @end itemize
26684
26685 @node Oort Gnus
26686 @subsubsection Oort Gnus
26687 @cindex Oort Gnus
26688
26689 New features in Gnus 5.10:
26690
26691 @itemize @bullet
26692
26693 @item Installation changes
26694 @c ***********************
26695
26696 @itemize @bullet
26697 @item
26698 Upgrading from previous (stable) version if you have used Oort.
26699
26700 If you have tried Oort (the unstable Gnus branch leading to this
26701 release) but went back to a stable version, be careful when upgrading to
26702 this version. In particular, you will probably want to remove all
26703 @file{.marks} (nnml) and @file{.mrk} (nnfolder) files, so that flags are
26704 read from your @file{.newsrc.eld} instead of from the
26705 @file{.marks}/@file{.mrk} file where this release store flags. See a
26706 later entry for more information about marks. Note that downgrading
26707 isn't save in general.
26708
26709 @item
26710 Lisp files are now installed in @file{.../site-lisp/gnus/} by default.
26711 It defaulted to @file{.../site-lisp/} formerly. In addition to this,
26712 the new installer issues a warning if other Gnus installations which
26713 will shadow the latest one are detected. You can then remove those
26714 shadows manually or remove them using @code{make
26715 remove-installed-shadows}.
26716
26717 @item
26718 New @file{make.bat} for compiling and installing Gnus under MS Windows
26719
26720 Use @file{make.bat} if you want to install Gnus under MS Windows, the
26721 first argument to the batch-program should be the directory where
26722 @file{xemacs.exe} respectively @file{emacs.exe} is located, if you want
26723 to install Gnus after compiling it, give @file{make.bat} @code{/copy} as
26724 the second parameter.
26725
26726 @file{make.bat} has been rewritten from scratch, it now features
26727 automatic recognition of XEmacs and GNU Emacs, generates
26728 @file{gnus-load.el}, checks if errors occur while compilation and
26729 generation of info files and reports them at the end of the build
26730 process. It now uses @code{makeinfo} if it is available and falls
26731 back to @file{infohack.el} otherwise. @file{make.bat} should now
26732 install all files which are necessary to run Gnus and be generally a
26733 complete replacement for the @code{configure; make; make install}
26734 cycle used under Unix systems.
26735
26736 The new @file{make.bat} makes @file{make-x.bat} and @file{xemacs.mak}
26737 superfluous, so they have been removed.
26738
26739 @item
26740 @file{~/News/overview/} not used.
26741
26742 As a result of the following change, the @file{~/News/overview/}
26743 directory is not used any more. You can safely delete the entire
26744 hierarchy.
26745
26746 @c FIXME: `gnus-load' is mentioned in README, which is not included in
26747 @c CVS. We should find a better place for this item.
26748 @item
26749 @code{(require 'gnus-load)}
26750
26751 If you use a stand-alone Gnus distribution, you'd better add
26752 @code{(require 'gnus-load)} into your @file{~/.emacs} after adding the Gnus
26753 lisp directory into load-path.
26754
26755 File @file{gnus-load.el} contains autoload commands, functions and variables,
26756 some of which may not be included in distributions of Emacsen.
26757
26758 @end itemize
26759
26760 @item New packages and libraries within Gnus
26761 @c *****************************************
26762
26763 @itemize @bullet
26764
26765 @item
26766 The revised Gnus @acronym{FAQ} is included in the manual,
26767 @xref{Frequently Asked Questions}.
26768
26769 @item
26770 @acronym{TLS} wrapper shipped with Gnus
26771
26772 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} is now supported in @acronym{IMAP} and
26773 @acronym{NNTP} via @file{tls.el} and GNUTLS. The old
26774 @acronym{TLS}/@acronym{SSL} support via (external third party)
26775 @file{ssl.el} and OpenSSL still works.
26776
26777 @item
26778 Improved anti-spam features.
26779
26780 Gnus is now able to take out spam from your mail and news streams
26781 using a wide variety of programs and filter rules. Among the supported
26782 methods are RBL blocklists, bogofilter and white/blacklists. Hooks
26783 for easy use of external packages such as SpamAssassin and Hashcash
26784 are also new. @xref{Thwarting Email Spam}.
26785 @c FIXME: @xref{Spam Package}?. Should this be under Misc?
26786
26787 @item
26788 Gnus supports server-side mail filtering using Sieve.
26789
26790 Sieve rules can be added as Group Parameters for groups, and the
26791 complete Sieve script is generated using @kbd{D g} from the Group
26792 buffer, and then uploaded to the server using @kbd{C-c C-l} in the
26793 generated Sieve buffer. @xref{Sieve Commands}, and the new Sieve
26794 manual @ref{Top, , Top, sieve, Emacs Sieve}.
26795
26796 @end itemize
26797
26798 @item Changes in group mode
26799 @c ************************
26800
26801 @itemize @bullet
26802
26803 @item
26804 @code{gnus-group-read-ephemeral-group} can be called interactively,
26805 using @kbd{G M}.
26806
26807 @item
26808 Retrieval of charters and control messages
26809
26810 There are new commands for fetching newsgroup charters (@kbd{H c}) and
26811 control messages (@kbd{H C}).
26812
26813 @item
26814 The new variable @code{gnus-parameters} can be used to set group parameters.
26815
26816 Earlier this was done only via @kbd{G p} (or @kbd{G c}), which stored
26817 the parameters in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, but via this variable you can
26818 enjoy the powers of customize, and simplified backups since you set the
26819 variable in @file{~/.gnus.el} instead of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. The
26820 variable maps regular expressions matching group names to group
26821 parameters, a'la:
26822 @lisp
26823 (setq gnus-parameters
26824 '(("mail\\..*"
26825 (gnus-show-threads nil)
26826 (gnus-use-scoring nil))
26827 ("^nnimap:\\(foo.bar\\)$"
26828 (to-group . "\\1"))))
26829 @end lisp
26830
26831 @item
26832 Unread count correct in nnimap groups.
26833
26834 The estimated number of unread articles in the group buffer should now
26835 be correct for nnimap groups. This is achieved by calling
26836 @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} from the
26837 @code{gnus-setup-news-hook} (called on startup) and
26838 @code{gnus-after-getting-new-news-hook}. (called after getting new
26839 mail). If you have modified those variables from the default, you may
26840 want to add @code{nnimap-fixup-unread-after-getting-new-news} again. If
26841 you were happy with the estimate and want to save some (minimal) time
26842 when getting new mail, remove the function.
26843
26844 @item
26845 Group names are treated as UTF-8 by default.
26846
26847 This is supposedly what USEFOR wanted to migrate to. See
26848 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-group-alist} and
26849 @code{gnus-group-name-charset-method-alist} for customization.
26850
26851 @item
26852 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} and
26853 @code{gnus-group-ignored-charsets-alist}.
26854
26855 The regexps in these variables are compared with full group names
26856 instead of real group names in 5.8. Users who customize these
26857 variables should change those regexps accordingly. For example:
26858 @lisp
26859 ("^han\\>" euc-kr) -> ("\\(^\\|:\\)han\\>" euc-kr)
26860 @end lisp
26861
26862 @item
26863 Old intermediate incoming mail files (@file{Incoming*}) are deleted
26864 after a couple of days, not immediately. @xref{Mail Source
26865 Customization}. (New in Gnus 5.10.10 / Emacs 22.2)
26866
26867 @end itemize
26868
26869 @item Changes in summary and article mode
26870 @c **************************************
26871
26872 @itemize @bullet
26873
26874 @item
26875 @kbd{F} (@code{gnus-article-followup-with-original}) and @kbd{R}
26876 (@code{gnus-article-reply-with-original}) only yank the text in the
26877 region if the region is active.
26878
26879 @item
26880 In draft groups, @kbd{e} is now bound to @code{gnus-draft-edit-message}.
26881 Use @kbd{B w} for @code{gnus-summary-edit-article} instead.
26882
26883 @item
26884 Article Buttons
26885
26886 More buttons for URLs, mail addresses, Message-IDs, Info links, man
26887 pages and Emacs or Gnus related references. @xref{Article Buttons}. The
26888 variables @code{gnus-button-@var{*}-level} can be used to control the
26889 appearance of all article buttons. @xref{Article Button Levels}.
26890
26891 @item
26892 Single-part yenc encoded attachments can be decoded.
26893
26894 @item
26895 Picons
26896
26897 The picons code has been reimplemented to work in GNU Emacs---some of
26898 the previous options have been removed or renamed.
26899
26900 Picons are small ``personal icons'' representing users, domain and
26901 newsgroups, which can be displayed in the Article buffer.
26902 @xref{Picons}.
26903
26904 @item
26905 If the new option @code{gnus-treat-body-boundary} is non-@code{nil}, a
26906 boundary line is drawn at the end of the headers.
26907
26908 @item
26909 Signed article headers (X-PGP-Sig) can be verified with @kbd{W p}.
26910
26911 @item
26912 The Summary Buffer uses an arrow in the fringe to indicate the current
26913 article. Use @code{(setq gnus-summary-display-arrow nil)} to disable it.
26914
26915 @item
26916 Warn about email replies to news
26917
26918 Do you often find yourself replying to news by email by mistake? Then
26919 the new option @code{gnus-confirm-mail-reply-to-news} is just the thing for
26920 you.
26921
26922 @item
26923 If the new option @code{gnus-summary-display-while-building} is
26924 non-@code{nil}, the summary buffer is shown and updated as it's being
26925 built.
26926
26927 @item
26928 The new @code{recent} mark @samp{.} indicates newly arrived messages (as
26929 opposed to old but unread messages).
26930
26931 @item
26932 Gnus supports RFC 2369 mailing list headers, and adds a number of
26933 related commands in mailing list groups. @xref{Mailing List}.
26934
26935 @item
26936 The Date header can be displayed in a format that can be read aloud
26937 in English. @xref{Article Date}.
26938
26939 @item
26940 diffs are automatically highlighted in groups matching
26941 @code{mm-uu-diff-groups-regexp}
26942
26943 @item
26944 Better handling of Microsoft citation styles
26945
26946 Gnus now tries to recognize the mangled header block that some Microsoft
26947 mailers use to indicate that the rest of the message is a citation, even
26948 though it is not quoted in any way. The variable
26949 @code{gnus-cite-unsightly-citation-regexp} matches the start of these
26950 citations.
26951
26952 The new command @kbd{W Y f}
26953 (@code{gnus-article-outlook-deuglify-article}) allows deuglifying broken
26954 Outlook (Express) articles.
26955
26956 @item
26957 @code{gnus-article-skip-boring}
26958
26959 If you set @code{gnus-article-skip-boring} to @code{t}, then Gnus will
26960 not scroll down to show you a page that contains only boring text,
26961 which by default means cited text and signature. You can customize
26962 what is skippable using @code{gnus-article-boring-faces}.
26963
26964 This feature is especially useful if you read many articles that
26965 consist of a little new content at the top with a long, untrimmed
26966 message cited below.
26967
26968 @item
26969 Smileys (@samp{:-)}, @samp{;-)} etc) are now displayed graphically in
26970 Emacs too.
26971
26972 Put @code{(setq gnus-treat-display-smileys nil)} in @file{~/.gnus.el} to
26973 disable it.
26974
26975 @item
26976 Face headers handling. @xref{Face}.
26977
26978 @item
26979 In the summary buffer, the new command @kbd{/ N} inserts new messages
26980 and @kbd{/ o} inserts old messages.
26981
26982 @item
26983 Gnus decodes morse encoded messages if you press @kbd{W m}.
26984
26985 @item
26986 @code{gnus-summary-line-format}
26987
26988 The default value changed to @samp{%U%R%z%I%(%[%4L: %-23,23f%]%)
26989 %s\n}. Moreover @code{gnus-extra-headers},
26990 @code{nnmail-extra-headers} and @code{gnus-ignored-from-addresses}
26991 changed their default so that the users name will be replaced by the
26992 recipient's name or the group name posting to for @acronym{NNTP}
26993 groups.
26994
26995 @item
26996 Deleting of attachments.
26997
26998 The command @code{gnus-mime-save-part-and-strip} (bound to @kbd{C-o}
26999 on @acronym{MIME} buttons) saves a part and replaces the part with an
27000 external one. @code{gnus-mime-delete-part} (bound to @kbd{d} on
27001 @acronym{MIME} buttons) removes a part. It works only on back ends
27002 that support editing.
27003
27004 @item
27005 @code{gnus-default-charset}
27006
27007 The default value is determined from the
27008 @code{current-language-environment} variable, instead of
27009 @code{iso-8859-1}. Also the @samp{.*} item in
27010 @code{gnus-group-charset-alist} is removed.
27011
27012 @item
27013 Printing capabilities are enhanced.
27014
27015 Gnus supports Muttprint natively with @kbd{O P} from the Summary and
27016 Article buffers. Also, each individual @acronym{MIME} part can be
27017 printed using @kbd{p} on the @acronym{MIME} button.
27018
27019 @item
27020 Extended format specs.
27021
27022 Format spec @samp{%&user-date;} is added into
27023 @code{gnus-summary-line-format-alist}. Also, user defined extended
27024 format specs are supported. The extended format specs look like
27025 @samp{%u&foo;}, which invokes function
27026 @code{gnus-user-format-function-@var{foo}}. Because @samp{&} is used as the
27027 escape character, old user defined format @samp{%u&} is no longer supported.
27028
27029 @item
27030 @kbd{/ *} (@code{gnus-summary-limit-include-cached}) is rewritten.
27031 @c FIXME: Was this a user-visible change?
27032
27033 It was aliased to @kbd{Y c}
27034 (@code{gnus-summary-insert-cached-articles}). The new function filters
27035 out other articles.
27036
27037 @item
27038 Some limiting commands accept a @kbd{C-u} prefix to negate the match.
27039
27040 If @kbd{C-u} is used on subject, author or extra headers, i.e., @kbd{/
27041 s}, @kbd{/ a}, and @kbd{/ x}
27042 (@code{gnus-summary-limit-to-@{subject,author,extra@}}) respectively, the
27043 result will be to display all articles that do not match the expression.
27044
27045 @item
27046 Gnus inlines external parts (message/external).
27047
27048 @end itemize
27049
27050 @item Changes in Message mode and related Gnus features
27051 @c ****************************************************
27052
27053 @itemize @bullet
27054
27055 @item
27056 Delayed articles
27057
27058 You can delay the sending of a message with @kbd{C-c C-j} in the Message
27059 buffer. The messages are delivered at specified time. This is useful
27060 for sending yourself reminders. @xref{Delayed Articles}.
27061
27062 @item
27063 If the new option @code{nnml-use-compressed-files} is non-@code{nil},
27064 the nnml back end allows compressed message files.
27065
27066 @item
27067 The new option @code{gnus-gcc-mark-as-read} automatically marks
27068 Gcc articles as read.
27069
27070 @item
27071 Externalizing of attachments
27072
27073 If @code{gnus-gcc-externalize-attachments} or
27074 @code{message-fcc-externalize-attachments} is non-@code{nil}, attach
27075 local files as external parts.
27076
27077 @item
27078 The envelope sender address can be customized when using Sendmail.
27079 @xref{Mail Variables, Mail Variables,, message, Message Manual}.
27080
27081 @item
27082 Gnus no longer generate the Sender: header automatically.
27083
27084 Earlier it was generated when the user configurable email address was
27085 different from the Gnus guessed default user address. As the guessing
27086 algorithm is rarely correct these days, and (more controversially) the
27087 only use of the Sender: header was to check if you are entitled to
27088 cancel/supersede news (which is now solved by Cancel Locks instead,
27089 see another entry), generation of the header has been disabled by
27090 default. See the variables @code{message-required-headers},
27091 @code{message-required-news-headers}, and
27092 @code{message-required-mail-headers}.
27093
27094 @item
27095 Features from third party @file{message-utils.el} added to @file{message.el}.
27096
27097 Message now asks if you wish to remove @samp{(was: <old subject>)} from
27098 subject lines (see @code{message-subject-trailing-was-query}). @kbd{C-c
27099 M-m} and @kbd{C-c M-f} inserts markers indicating included text.
27100 @kbd{C-c C-f a} adds a X-No-Archive: header. @kbd{C-c C-f x} inserts
27101 appropriate headers and a note in the body for cross-postings and
27102 followups (see the variables @code{message-cross-post-@var{*}}).
27103
27104 @item
27105 References and X-Draft-From headers are no longer generated when you
27106 start composing messages and @code{message-generate-headers-first} is
27107 @code{nil}.
27108
27109 @item
27110 Easy inclusion of X-Faces headers. @xref{X-Face}.
27111
27112 @item
27113 Group Carbon Copy (GCC) quoting
27114
27115 To support groups that contains SPC and other weird characters, groups
27116 are quoted before they are placed in the Gcc: header. This means
27117 variables such as @code{gnus-message-archive-group} should no longer
27118 contain quote characters to make groups containing SPC work. Also, if
27119 you are using the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar} (indicating Gcc
27120 into two groups) you must change it to return the list
27121 @code{("nnml:foo" "nnml:bar")}, otherwise the Gcc: line will be quoted
27122 incorrectly. Note that returning the string @samp{nnml:foo, nnml:bar}
27123 was incorrect earlier, it just didn't generate any problems since it
27124 was inserted directly.
27125
27126 @item
27127 @code{message-insinuate-rmail}
27128
27129 Adding @code{(message-insinuate-rmail)} and @code{(setq
27130 mail-user-agent 'gnus-user-agent)} in @file{.emacs} convinces Rmail to
27131 compose, reply and forward messages in message-mode, where you can
27132 enjoy the power of @acronym{MML}.
27133
27134 @item
27135 @code{message-minibuffer-local-map}
27136
27137 The line below enables BBDB in resending a message:
27138 @lisp
27139 (define-key message-minibuffer-local-map [(tab)]
27140 'bbdb-complete-name)
27141 @end lisp
27142
27143 @item
27144 @code{gnus-posting-styles}
27145
27146 Add a new format of match like
27147 @lisp
27148 ((header "to" "larsi.*org")
27149 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
27150 @end lisp
27151 The old format like the lines below is obsolete, but still accepted.
27152 @lisp
27153 (header "to" "larsi.*org"
27154 (Organization "Somewhere, Inc."))
27155 @end lisp
27156
27157 @item
27158 @code{message-ignored-news-headers} and @code{message-ignored-mail-headers}
27159
27160 @samp{X-Draft-From} and @samp{X-Gnus-Agent-Meta-Information} have been
27161 added into these two variables. If you customized those, perhaps you
27162 need add those two headers too.
27163
27164 @item
27165 Gnus supports the ``format=flowed'' (RFC 2646) parameter. On
27166 composing messages, it is enabled by @code{use-hard-newlines}.
27167 Decoding format=flowed was present but not documented in earlier
27168 versions.
27169
27170 @item
27171 The option @code{mm-fill-flowed} can be used to disable treatment of
27172 ``format=flowed'' messages. Also, flowed text is disabled when sending
27173 inline PGP signed messages. @xref{Flowed text, , Flowed text,
27174 emacs-mime, The Emacs MIME Manual}. (New in Gnus 5.10.7)
27175 @c This entry is also present in the node "No Gnus".
27176
27177 @item
27178 Gnus supports the generation of RFC 2298 Disposition Notification requests.
27179
27180 This is invoked with the @kbd{C-c M-n} key binding from message mode.
27181
27182 @item
27183 Message supports the Importance: (RFC 2156) header.
27184
27185 In the message buffer, @kbd{C-c C-f C-i} or @kbd{C-c C-u} cycles through
27186 the valid values.
27187
27188 @item
27189 Gnus supports Cancel Locks in News.
27190
27191 This means a header @samp{Cancel-Lock} is inserted in news posting. It is
27192 used to determine if you wrote an article or not (for canceling and
27193 superseding). Gnus generates a random password string the first time
27194 you post a message, and saves it in your @file{~/.emacs} using the Custom
27195 system. While the variable is called @code{canlock-password}, it is not
27196 security sensitive data. Publishing your canlock string on the web
27197 will not allow anyone to be able to anything she could not already do.
27198 The behavior can be changed by customizing @code{message-insert-canlock}.
27199
27200 @item
27201 Gnus supports @acronym{PGP} (RFC 1991/2440), @acronym{PGP/MIME} (RFC
27202 2015/3156) and @acronym{S/MIME} (RFC 2630-2633).
27203
27204 It needs an external @acronym{S/MIME} and OpenPGP implementation, but no
27205 additional Lisp libraries. This add several menu items to the
27206 Attachments menu, and @kbd{C-c RET} key bindings, when composing
27207 messages. This also obsoletes @code{gnus-article-hide-pgp-hook}.
27208
27209 @item
27210 @acronym{MML} (Mime compose) prefix changed from @kbd{M-m} to @kbd{C-c
27211 C-m}.
27212
27213 This change was made to avoid conflict with the standard binding of
27214 @code{back-to-indentation}, which is also useful in message mode.
27215
27216 @item
27217 The default for @code{message-forward-show-mml} changed to the symbol
27218 @code{best}.
27219
27220 The behavior for the @code{best} value is to show @acronym{MML} (i.e.,
27221 convert to @acronym{MIME}) when appropriate. @acronym{MML} will not be
27222 used when forwarding signed or encrypted messages, as the conversion
27223 invalidate the digital signature.
27224
27225 @item
27226 If @code{auto-compression-mode} is enabled, attachments are automatically
27227 decompressed when activated.
27228 @c FIXME: Does this affect article or message mode?
27229
27230 @item
27231 Support for non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names
27232
27233 Message supports non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To: and
27234 Cc: and will query you whether to perform encoding when you try to
27235 send a message. The variable @code{message-use-idna} controls this.
27236 Gnus will also decode non-@acronym{ASCII} domain names in From:, To:
27237 and Cc: when you view a message. The variable @code{gnus-use-idna}
27238 controls this.
27239
27240 @item You can now drag and drop attachments to the Message buffer.
27241 See @code{mml-dnd-protocol-alist} and @code{mml-dnd-attach-options}.
27242 @xref{MIME, ,MIME, message, Message Manual}.
27243 @c New in 5.10.9 / 5.11 (Emacs 21.1)
27244
27245 @item @code{auto-fill-mode} is enabled by default in Message mode.
27246 See @code{message-fill-column}. @xref{Various Message Variables, ,
27247 Message Headers, message, Message Manual}.
27248 @c New in Gnus 5.10.12 / 5.11 (Emacs 22.3)
27249
27250 @end itemize
27251
27252 @item Changes in back ends
27253 @c ***********************
27254
27255 @itemize @bullet
27256 @item
27257 Gnus can display RSS newsfeeds as a newsgroup. @xref{RSS}.
27258
27259 @item
27260 The nndoc back end now supports mailman digests and exim bounces.
27261
27262 @item
27263 Gnus supports Maildir groups.
27264
27265 Gnus includes a new back end @file{nnmaildir.el}. @xref{Maildir}.
27266
27267 @item
27268 The nnml and nnfolder back ends store marks for each groups.
27269
27270 This makes it possible to take backup of nnml/nnfolder servers/groups
27271 separately of @file{~/.newsrc.eld}, while preserving marks. It also
27272 makes it possible to share articles and marks between users (without
27273 sharing the @file{~/.newsrc.eld} file) within e.g. a department. It
27274 works by storing the marks stored in @file{~/.newsrc.eld} in a per-group
27275 file @file{.marks} (for nnml) and @file{@var{groupname}.mrk} (for
27276 nnfolder, named @var{groupname}). If the nnml/nnfolder is moved to
27277 another machine, Gnus will automatically use the @file{.marks} or
27278 @file{.mrk} file instead of the information in @file{~/.newsrc.eld}.
27279 The new server variables @code{nnml-marks-is-evil} and
27280 @code{nnfolder-marks-is-evil} can be used to disable this feature.
27281
27282 @end itemize
27283
27284 @item Appearance
27285 @c *************
27286
27287 @itemize @bullet
27288
27289 @item
27290 The menu bar item (in Group and Summary buffer) named ``Misc'' has
27291 been renamed to ``Gnus''.
27292
27293 @item
27294 The menu bar item (in Message mode) named ``@acronym{MML}'' has been
27295 renamed to ``Attachments''. Note that this menu also contains security
27296 related stuff, like signing and encryption (@pxref{Security, Security,,
27297 message, Message Manual}).
27298
27299 @item
27300 The tool bars have been updated to use GNOME icons in Group, Summary and
27301 Message mode. You can also customize the tool bars: @kbd{M-x
27302 customize-apropos RET -tool-bar$} should get you started. This is a new
27303 feature in Gnus 5.10.10. (Only for Emacs, not in XEmacs.)
27304
27305 @item The tool bar icons are now (de)activated correctly
27306 in the group buffer, see the variable @code{gnus-group-update-tool-bar}.
27307 Its default value depends on your Emacs version. This is a new feature
27308 in Gnus 5.10.9.
27309 @end itemize
27310
27311
27312 @item Miscellaneous changes
27313 @c ************************
27314
27315 @itemize @bullet
27316
27317 @item
27318 @code{gnus-agent}
27319
27320 The Gnus Agent has seen a major updated and is now enabled by default,
27321 and all nntp and nnimap servers from @code{gnus-select-method} and
27322 @code{gnus-secondary-select-method} are agentized by default. Earlier
27323 only the server in @code{gnus-select-method} was agentized by the
27324 default, and the agent was disabled by default. When the agent is
27325 enabled, headers are now also retrieved from the Agent cache instead
27326 of the back ends when possible. Earlier this only happened in the
27327 unplugged state. You can enroll or remove servers with @kbd{J a} and
27328 @kbd{J r} in the server buffer. Gnus will not download articles into
27329 the Agent cache, unless you instruct it to do so, though, by using
27330 @kbd{J u} or @kbd{J s} from the Group buffer. You revert to the old
27331 behavior of having the Agent disabled with @code{(setq gnus-agent
27332 nil)}. Note that putting @code{(gnus-agentize)} in @file{~/.gnus.el}
27333 is not needed any more.
27334
27335 @item
27336 Gnus reads the @acronym{NOV} and articles in the Agent if plugged.
27337
27338 If one reads an article while plugged, and the article already exists
27339 in the Agent, it won't get downloaded once more. @code{(setq
27340 gnus-agent-cache nil)} reverts to the old behavior.
27341
27342 @item
27343 Dired integration
27344
27345 @code{gnus-dired-minor-mode} (see @ref{Other modes}) installs key
27346 bindings in dired buffers to send a file as an attachment, open a file
27347 using the appropriate mailcap entry, and print a file using the mailcap
27348 entry.
27349
27350 @item
27351 The format spec @code{%C} for positioning point has changed to @code{%*}.
27352
27353 @item
27354 @code{gnus-slave-unplugged}
27355
27356 A new command which starts Gnus offline in slave mode.
27357
27358 @end itemize
27359
27360 @end itemize
27361
27362 @iftex
27363
27364 @page
27365 @node The Manual
27366 @section The Manual
27367 @cindex colophon
27368 @cindex manual
27369
27370 This manual was generated from a TeXinfo file and then run through
27371 either @code{texi2dvi}
27372 @iflatex
27373 or my own home-brewed TeXinfo to \LaTeX\ transformer,
27374 and then run through @code{latex} and @code{dvips}
27375 @end iflatex
27376 to get what you hold in your hands now.
27377
27378 The following conventions have been used:
27379
27380 @enumerate
27381
27382 @item
27383 This is a @samp{string}
27384
27385 @item
27386 This is a @kbd{keystroke}
27387
27388 @item
27389 This is a @file{file}
27390
27391 @item
27392 This is a @code{symbol}
27393
27394 @end enumerate
27395
27396 So if I were to say ``set @code{flargnoze} to @samp{yes}'', that would
27397 mean:
27398
27399 @lisp
27400 (setq flargnoze "yes")
27401 @end lisp
27402
27403 If I say ``set @code{flumphel} to @code{yes}'', that would mean:
27404
27405 @lisp
27406 (setq flumphel 'yes)
27407 @end lisp
27408
27409 @samp{yes} and @code{yes} are two @emph{very} different things---don't
27410 ever get them confused.
27411
27412 @iflatex
27413 @c @head
27414 Of course, everything in this manual is of vital interest, so you should
27415 read it all. Several times. However, if you feel like skimming the
27416 manual, look for that gnu head you should see in the margin over
27417 there---it means that what's being discussed is of more importance than
27418 the rest of the stuff. (On the other hand, if everything is infinitely
27419 important, how can anything be more important than that? Just one more
27420 of the mysteries of this world, I guess.)
27421 @end iflatex
27422
27423 @end iftex
27424
27425
27426 @node On Writing Manuals
27427 @section On Writing Manuals
27428
27429 I guess most manuals are written after-the-fact; documenting a program
27430 that's already there. This is not how this manual is written. When
27431 implementing something, I write the manual entry for that something
27432 straight away. I then see that it's difficult to explain the
27433 functionality, so I write how it's supposed to be, and then I change the
27434 implementation. Writing the documentation and writing the code go hand
27435 in hand.
27436
27437 This, of course, means that this manual has no, or little, flow. It
27438 documents absolutely everything in Gnus, but often not where you're
27439 looking for it. It is a reference manual, and not a guide to how to get
27440 started with Gnus.
27441
27442 That would be a totally different book, that should be written using the
27443 reference manual as source material. It would look quite different.
27444
27445
27446 @page
27447 @node Terminology
27448 @section Terminology
27449
27450 @cindex terminology
27451 @table @dfn
27452
27453 @item news
27454 @cindex news
27455 This is what you are supposed to use this thing for---reading news.
27456 News is generally fetched from a nearby @acronym{NNTP} server, and is
27457 generally publicly available to everybody. If you post news, the entire
27458 world is likely to read just what you have written, and they'll all
27459 snigger mischievously. Behind your back.
27460
27461 @item mail
27462 @cindex mail
27463 Everything that's delivered to you personally is mail. Some news/mail
27464 readers (like Gnus) blur the distinction between mail and news, but
27465 there is a difference. Mail is private. News is public. Mailing is
27466 not posting, and replying is not following up.
27467
27468 @item reply
27469 @cindex reply
27470 Send a mail to the person who has written what you are reading.
27471
27472 @item follow up
27473 @cindex follow up
27474 Post an article to the current newsgroup responding to the article you
27475 are reading.
27476
27477 @item back end
27478 @cindex back end
27479 Gnus considers mail and news to be mostly the same, really. The only
27480 difference is how to access the actual articles. News articles are
27481 commonly fetched via the protocol @acronym{NNTP}, whereas mail
27482 messages could be read from a file on the local disk. The internal
27483 architecture of Gnus thus comprises a ``front end'' and a number of
27484 ``back ends''. Internally, when you enter a group (by hitting
27485 @key{RET}, say), you thereby invoke a function in the front end in
27486 Gnus. The front end then ``talks'' to a back end and says things like
27487 ``Give me the list of articles in the foo group'' or ``Show me article
27488 number 4711''.
27489
27490 So a back end mainly defines either a protocol (the @code{nntp} back
27491 end accesses news via @acronym{NNTP}, the @code{nnimap} back end
27492 accesses mail via @acronym{IMAP}) or a file format and directory
27493 layout (the @code{nnspool} back end accesses news via the common
27494 ``spool directory'' format, the @code{nnml} back end access mail via a
27495 file format and directory layout that's quite similar).
27496
27497 Gnus does not handle the underlying media, so to speak---this is all
27498 done by the back ends. A back end is a collection of functions to
27499 access the articles.
27500
27501 However, sometimes the term ``back end'' is also used where ``server''
27502 would have been more appropriate. And then there is the term ``select
27503 method'' which can mean either. The Gnus terminology can be quite
27504 confusing.
27505
27506 @item native
27507 @cindex native
27508 Gnus will always use one method (and back end) as the @dfn{native}, or
27509 default, way of getting news.
27510
27511 @item foreign
27512 @cindex foreign
27513 You can also have any number of foreign groups active at the same time.
27514 These are groups that use non-native non-secondary back ends for getting
27515 news.
27516
27517 @item secondary
27518 @cindex secondary
27519 Secondary back ends are somewhere half-way between being native and being
27520 foreign, but they mostly act like they are native.
27521
27522 @item article
27523 @cindex article
27524 A message that has been posted as news.
27525
27526 @item mail message
27527 @cindex mail message
27528 A message that has been mailed.
27529
27530 @item message
27531 @cindex message
27532 A mail message or news article
27533
27534 @item head
27535 @cindex head
27536 The top part of a message, where administrative information (etc.) is
27537 put.
27538
27539 @item body
27540 @cindex body
27541 The rest of an article. Everything not in the head is in the
27542 body.
27543
27544 @item header
27545 @cindex header
27546 A line from the head of an article.
27547
27548 @item headers
27549 @cindex headers
27550 A collection of such lines, or a collection of heads. Or even a
27551 collection of @acronym{NOV} lines.
27552
27553 @item @acronym{NOV}
27554 @cindex @acronym{NOV}
27555 @acronym{NOV} stands for News OverView, which is a type of news server
27556 header which provide datas containing the condensed header information
27557 of articles. They are produced by the server itself; in the @code{nntp}
27558 back end Gnus uses the ones that the @acronym{NNTP} server makes, but
27559 Gnus makes them by itself for some backends (in particular, @code{nnml}).
27560
27561 When Gnus enters a group, it asks the back end for the headers of all
27562 unread articles in the group. Most servers support the News OverView
27563 format, which is more compact and much faster to read and parse than the
27564 normal @sc{head} format.
27565
27566 The @acronym{NOV} data consist of one or more text lines (@pxref{Text
27567 Lines, ,Motion by Text Lines, elisp, The Emacs Lisp Reference Manual})
27568 where each line has the header information of one article. The header
27569 information is a tab-separated series of the header's contents including
27570 an article number, a subject, an author, a date, a message-id,
27571 references, etc.
27572
27573 Those data enable Gnus to generate summary lines quickly. However, if
27574 the server does not support @acronym{NOV} or you disable it purposely or
27575 for some reason, Gnus will try to generate the header information by
27576 parsing each article's headers one by one. It will take time.
27577 Therefore, it is not usually a good idea to set nn*-nov-is-evil
27578 (@pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}) to a non-@code{nil} value unless you
27579 know that the server makes wrong @acronym{NOV} data.
27580
27581 @item level
27582 @cindex levels
27583 Each group is subscribed at some @dfn{level} or other (1-9). The ones
27584 that have a lower level are ``more'' subscribed than the groups with a
27585 higher level. In fact, groups on levels 1-5 are considered
27586 @dfn{subscribed}; 6-7 are @dfn{unsubscribed}; 8 are @dfn{zombies}; and 9
27587 are @dfn{killed}. Commands for listing groups and scanning for new
27588 articles will all use the numeric prefix as @dfn{working level}.
27589
27590 @item killed groups
27591 @cindex killed groups
27592 No information on killed groups is stored or updated, which makes killed
27593 groups much easier to handle than subscribed groups.
27594
27595 @item zombie groups
27596 @cindex zombie groups
27597 Just like killed groups, only slightly less dead.
27598
27599 @item active file
27600 @cindex active file
27601 The news server has to keep track of what articles it carries, and what
27602 groups exist. All this information in stored in the active file, which
27603 is rather large, as you might surmise.
27604
27605 @item bogus groups
27606 @cindex bogus groups
27607 A group that exists in the @file{.newsrc} file, but isn't known to the
27608 server (i.e., it isn't in the active file), is a @emph{bogus group}.
27609 This means that the group probably doesn't exist (any more).
27610
27611 @item activating
27612 @cindex activating groups
27613 The act of asking the server for info on a group and computing the
27614 number of unread articles is called @dfn{activating the group}.
27615 Un-activated groups are listed with @samp{*} in the group buffer.
27616
27617 @item spool
27618 @cindex spool
27619 News servers store their articles locally in one fashion or other.
27620 One old-fashioned storage method is to have just one file per
27621 article. That's called a ``traditional spool''.
27622
27623 @item server
27624 @cindex server
27625 A machine one can connect to and get news (or mail) from.
27626
27627 @item select method
27628 @cindex select method
27629 A structure that specifies the back end, the server and the virtual
27630 server settings.
27631
27632 @item virtual server
27633 @cindex virtual server
27634 A named select method. Since a select method defines all there is to
27635 know about connecting to a (physical) server, taking the thing as a
27636 whole is a virtual server.
27637
27638 @item washing
27639 @cindex washing
27640 Taking a buffer and running it through a filter of some sort. The
27641 result will (more often than not) be cleaner and more pleasing than the
27642 original.
27643
27644 @item ephemeral groups
27645 @cindex ephemeral groups
27646 @cindex temporary groups
27647 Most groups store data on what articles you have read. @dfn{Ephemeral}
27648 groups are groups that will have no data stored---when you exit the
27649 group, it'll disappear into the aether.
27650
27651 @item solid groups
27652 @cindex solid groups
27653 This is the opposite of ephemeral groups. All groups listed in the
27654 group buffer are solid groups.
27655
27656 @item sparse articles
27657 @cindex sparse articles
27658 These are article placeholders shown in the summary buffer when
27659 @code{gnus-build-sparse-threads} has been switched on.
27660
27661 @item threading
27662 @cindex threading
27663 To put responses to articles directly after the articles they respond
27664 to---in a hierarchical fashion.
27665
27666 @item root
27667 @cindex root
27668 @cindex thread root
27669 The first article in a thread is the root. It is the ancestor of all
27670 articles in the thread.
27671
27672 @item parent
27673 @cindex parent
27674 An article that has responses.
27675
27676 @item child
27677 @cindex child
27678 An article that responds to a different article---its parent.
27679
27680 @item digest
27681 @cindex digest
27682 A collection of messages in one file. The most common digest format is
27683 specified by RFC 1153.
27684
27685 @item splitting
27686 @cindex splitting, terminology
27687 @cindex mail sorting
27688 @cindex mail filtering (splitting)
27689 The action of sorting your emails according to certain rules. Sometimes
27690 incorrectly called mail filtering.
27691
27692 @end table
27693
27694
27695 @page
27696 @node Customization
27697 @section Customization
27698 @cindex general customization
27699
27700 All variables are properly documented elsewhere in this manual. This
27701 section is designed to give general pointers on how to customize Gnus
27702 for some quite common situations.
27703
27704 @menu
27705 * Slow/Expensive Connection:: You run a local Emacs and get the news elsewhere.
27706 * Slow Terminal Connection:: You run a remote Emacs.
27707 * Little Disk Space:: You feel that having large setup files is icky.
27708 * Slow Machine:: You feel like buying a faster machine.
27709 @end menu
27710
27711
27712 @node Slow/Expensive Connection
27713 @subsection Slow/Expensive Connection
27714
27715 If you run Emacs on a machine locally, and get your news from a machine
27716 over some very thin strings, you want to cut down on the amount of data
27717 Gnus has to get from the server.
27718
27719 @table @code
27720
27721 @item gnus-read-active-file
27722 Set this to @code{nil}, which will inhibit Gnus from requesting the
27723 entire active file from the server. This file is often very large. You
27724 also have to set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27725 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make sure that Gnus
27726 doesn't suddenly decide to fetch the active file anyway.
27727
27728 @item gnus-nov-is-evil
27729 @vindex gnus-nov-is-evil
27730 Usually this one must @emph{always} be @code{nil} (which is the
27731 default). If, for example, you wish to not use @acronym{NOV}
27732 (@pxref{Terminology}) with the @code{nntp} back end (@pxref{Crosspost
27733 Handling}), set @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} to a non-@code{nil} value
27734 instead of setting this. But you normally do not need to set
27735 @code{nntp-nov-is-evil} since Gnus by itself will detect whether the
27736 @acronym{NNTP} server supports @acronym{NOV}. Anyway, grabbing article
27737 headers from the @acronym{NNTP} server will not be very fast if you tell
27738 Gnus not to use @acronym{NOV}.
27739
27740 As the variables for the other back ends, there are
27741 @code{nndiary-nov-is-evil}, @code{nndir-nov-is-evil},
27742 @code{nnfolder-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnimap-nov-is-evil},
27743 @code{nnml-nov-is-evil}, @code{nnspool-nov-is-evil}, and
27744 @code{nnwarchive-nov-is-evil}. Note that a non-@code{nil} value for
27745 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} overrides all those variables.@footnote{Although
27746 the back ends @code{nnkiboze}, @code{nnslashdot}, @code{nnultimate}, and
27747 @code{nnwfm} don't have their own nn*-nov-is-evil.}
27748 @end table
27749
27750
27751 @node Slow Terminal Connection
27752 @subsection Slow Terminal Connection
27753
27754 Let's say you use your home computer for dialing up the system that runs
27755 Emacs and Gnus. If your modem is slow, you want to reduce (as much as
27756 possible) the amount of data sent over the wires.
27757
27758 @table @code
27759
27760 @item gnus-auto-center-summary
27761 Set this to @code{nil} to inhibit Gnus from re-centering the summary
27762 buffer all the time. If it is @code{vertical}, do only vertical
27763 re-centering. If it is neither @code{nil} nor @code{vertical}, do both
27764 horizontal and vertical recentering.
27765
27766 @item gnus-visible-headers
27767 Cut down on the headers included in the articles to the
27768 minimum. You can, in fact, make do without them altogether---most of the
27769 useful data is in the summary buffer, anyway. Set this variable to
27770 @samp{^NEVVVVER} or @samp{From:}, or whatever you feel you need.
27771
27772 Use the following to enable all the available hiding features:
27773 @lisp
27774 (setq gnus-treat-hide-headers 'head
27775 gnus-treat-hide-signature t
27776 gnus-treat-hide-citation t)
27777 @end lisp
27778
27779 @item gnus-use-full-window
27780 By setting this to @code{nil}, you can make all the windows smaller.
27781 While this doesn't really cut down much generally, it means that you
27782 have to see smaller portions of articles before deciding that you didn't
27783 want to read them anyway.
27784
27785 @item gnus-thread-hide-subtree
27786 If this is non-@code{nil}, all threads in the summary buffer will be
27787 hidden initially.
27788
27789
27790 @item gnus-updated-mode-lines
27791 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not put information in the buffer mode
27792 lines, which might save some time.
27793 @end table
27794
27795
27796 @node Little Disk Space
27797 @subsection Little Disk Space
27798 @cindex disk space
27799
27800 The startup files can get rather large, so you may want to cut their
27801 sizes a bit if you are running out of space.
27802
27803 @table @code
27804
27805 @item gnus-save-newsrc-file
27806 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never save @file{.newsrc}---it will
27807 only save @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27808 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27809 default.
27810
27811 @item gnus-read-newsrc-file
27812 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will never read @file{.newsrc}---it will
27813 only read @file{.newsrc.eld}. This means that you will not be able to
27814 use any other newsreaders than Gnus. This variable is @code{t} by
27815 default.
27816
27817 @item gnus-save-killed-list
27818 If this is @code{nil}, Gnus will not save the list of dead groups. You
27819 should also set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} to @code{ask-server}
27820 and @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} if you set this
27821 variable to @code{nil}. This variable is @code{t} by default.
27822
27823 @end table
27824
27825
27826 @node Slow Machine
27827 @subsection Slow Machine
27828 @cindex slow machine
27829
27830 If you have a slow machine, or are just really impatient, there are a
27831 few things you can do to make Gnus run faster.
27832
27833 Set @code{gnus-check-new-newsgroups} and
27834 @code{gnus-check-bogus-newsgroups} to @code{nil} to make startup faster.
27835
27836 Set @code{gnus-show-threads}, @code{gnus-use-cross-reference} and
27837 @code{gnus-nov-is-evil} to @code{nil} to make entering and exiting the
27838 summary buffer faster. Also @pxref{Slow/Expensive Connection}.
27839
27840
27841 @page
27842 @node Troubleshooting
27843 @section Troubleshooting
27844 @cindex troubleshooting
27845
27846 Gnus works @emph{so} well straight out of the box---I can't imagine any
27847 problems, really.
27848
27849 Ahem.
27850
27851 @enumerate
27852
27853 @item
27854 Make sure your computer is switched on.
27855
27856 @item
27857 Make sure that you really load the current Gnus version. If you have
27858 been running @sc{gnus}, you need to exit Emacs and start it up again before
27859 Gnus will work.
27860
27861 @item
27862 Try doing an @kbd{M-x gnus-version}. If you get something that looks
27863 like @c
27864 @samp{Gnus v5.10.8} @c Adjust ../Makefile.in if you change this line!
27865 @c
27866 you have the right files loaded. Otherwise you have some old @file{.el}
27867 files lying around. Delete these.
27868
27869 @item
27870 Read the help group (@kbd{G h} in the group buffer) for a
27871 @acronym{FAQ} and a how-to.
27872
27873 @item
27874 @vindex max-lisp-eval-depth
27875 Gnus works on many recursive structures, and in some extreme (and very
27876 rare) cases Gnus may recurse down ``too deeply'' and Emacs will beep at
27877 you. If this happens to you, set @code{max-lisp-eval-depth} to 500 or
27878 something like that.
27879 @end enumerate
27880
27881 If all else fails, report the problem as a bug.
27882
27883 @cindex bugs
27884 @cindex reporting bugs
27885
27886 @kindex M-x gnus-bug
27887 @findex gnus-bug
27888 If you find a bug in Gnus, you can report it with the @kbd{M-x gnus-bug}
27889 command. @kbd{M-x set-variable RET debug-on-error RET t RET}, and send
27890 me the backtrace. I will fix bugs, but I can only fix them if you send
27891 me a precise description as to how to reproduce the bug.
27892
27893 You really can never be too detailed in a bug report. Always use the
27894 @kbd{M-x gnus-bug} command when you make bug reports, even if it creates
27895 a 10Kb mail each time you use it, and even if you have sent me your
27896 environment 500 times before. I don't care. I want the full info each
27897 time.
27898
27899 It is also important to remember that I have no memory whatsoever. If
27900 you send a bug report, and I send you a reply, and then you just send
27901 back ``No, it's not! Moron!'', I will have no idea what you are
27902 insulting me about. Always over-explain everything. It's much easier
27903 for all of us---if I don't have all the information I need, I will just
27904 mail you and ask for more info, and everything takes more time.
27905
27906 If the problem you're seeing is very visual, and you can't quite explain
27907 it, copy the Emacs window to a file (with @code{xwd}, for instance), put
27908 it somewhere it can be reached, and include the URL of the picture in
27909 the bug report.
27910
27911 @cindex patches
27912 If you would like to contribute a patch to fix bugs or make
27913 improvements, please produce the patch using @samp{diff -u}.
27914
27915 @cindex edebug
27916 If you want to debug your problem further before reporting, possibly
27917 in order to solve the problem yourself and send a patch, you can use
27918 edebug. Debugging Lisp code is documented in the Elisp manual
27919 (@pxref{Debugging, , Debugging Lisp Programs, elisp, The GNU Emacs
27920 Lisp Reference Manual}). To get you started with edebug, consider if
27921 you discover some weird behavior when pressing @kbd{c}, the first
27922 step is to do @kbd{C-h k c} and click on the hyperlink (Emacs only) in
27923 the documentation buffer that leads you to the function definition,
27924 then press @kbd{M-x edebug-defun RET} with point inside that function,
27925 return to Gnus and press @kbd{c} to invoke the code. You will be
27926 placed in the lisp buffer and can single step using @kbd{SPC} and
27927 evaluate expressions using @kbd{M-:} or inspect variables using
27928 @kbd{C-h v}, abort execution with @kbd{q}, and resume execution with
27929 @kbd{c} or @kbd{g}.
27930
27931 @cindex elp
27932 @cindex profile
27933 @cindex slow
27934 Sometimes, a problem do not directly generate an elisp error but
27935 manifests itself by causing Gnus to be very slow. In these cases, you
27936 can use @kbd{M-x toggle-debug-on-quit} and press @kbd{C-g} when things are
27937 slow, and then try to analyze the backtrace (repeating the procedure
27938 helps isolating the real problem areas).
27939
27940 A fancier approach is to use the elisp profiler, ELP. The profiler is
27941 (or should be) fully documented elsewhere, but to get you started
27942 there are a few steps that need to be followed. First, instrument the
27943 part of Gnus you are interested in for profiling, e.g. @kbd{M-x
27944 elp-instrument-package RET gnus} or @kbd{M-x elp-instrument-package
27945 RET message}. Then perform the operation that is slow and press
27946 @kbd{M-x elp-results}. You will then see which operations that takes
27947 time, and can debug them further. If the entire operation takes much
27948 longer than the time spent in the slowest function in the profiler
27949 output, you probably profiled the wrong part of Gnus. To reset
27950 profiling statistics, use @kbd{M-x elp-reset-all}. @kbd{M-x
27951 elp-restore-all} is supposed to remove profiling, but given the
27952 complexities and dynamic code generation in Gnus, it might not always
27953 work perfectly.
27954
27955 @cindex gnu.emacs.gnus
27956 @cindex ding mailing list
27957 If you just need help, you are better off asking on
27958 @samp{gnu.emacs.gnus}. I'm not very helpful. You can also ask on
27959 @email{ding@@gnus.org, the ding mailing list}. Write to
27960 @email{ding-request@@gnus.org} to subscribe.
27961
27962
27963 @page
27964 @node Gnus Reference Guide
27965 @section Gnus Reference Guide
27966
27967 It is my hope that other people will figure out smart stuff that Gnus
27968 can do, and that other people will write those smart things as well. To
27969 facilitate that I thought it would be a good idea to describe the inner
27970 workings of Gnus. And some of the not-so-inner workings, while I'm at
27971 it.
27972
27973 You can never expect the internals of a program not to change, but I
27974 will be defining (in some details) the interface between Gnus and its
27975 back ends (this is written in stone), the format of the score files
27976 (ditto), data structures (some are less likely to change than others)
27977 and general methods of operation.
27978
27979 @menu
27980 * Gnus Utility Functions:: Common functions and variable to use.
27981 * Back End Interface:: How Gnus communicates with the servers.
27982 * Score File Syntax:: A BNF definition of the score file standard.
27983 * Headers:: How Gnus stores headers internally.
27984 * Ranges:: A handy format for storing mucho numbers.
27985 * Group Info:: The group info format.
27986 * Extended Interactive:: Symbolic prefixes and stuff.
27987 * Emacs/XEmacs Code:: Gnus can be run under all modern Emacsen.
27988 * Various File Formats:: Formats of files that Gnus use.
27989 @end menu
27990
27991
27992 @node Gnus Utility Functions
27993 @subsection Gnus Utility Functions
27994 @cindex Gnus utility functions
27995 @cindex utility functions
27996 @cindex functions
27997 @cindex internal variables
27998
27999 When writing small functions to be run from hooks (and stuff), it's
28000 vital to have access to the Gnus internal functions and variables.
28001 Below is a list of the most common ones.
28002
28003 @table @code
28004
28005 @item gnus-newsgroup-name
28006 @vindex gnus-newsgroup-name
28007 This variable holds the name of the current newsgroup.
28008
28009 @item gnus-find-method-for-group
28010 @findex gnus-find-method-for-group
28011 A function that returns the select method for @var{group}.
28012
28013 @item gnus-group-real-name
28014 @findex gnus-group-real-name
28015 Takes a full (prefixed) Gnus group name, and returns the unprefixed
28016 name.
28017
28018 @item gnus-group-prefixed-name
28019 @findex gnus-group-prefixed-name
28020 Takes an unprefixed group name and a select method, and returns the full
28021 (prefixed) Gnus group name.
28022
28023 @item gnus-get-info
28024 @findex gnus-get-info
28025 Returns the group info list for @var{group}.
28026
28027 @item gnus-group-unread
28028 @findex gnus-group-unread
28029 The number of unread articles in @var{group}, or @code{t} if that is
28030 unknown.
28031
28032 @item gnus-active
28033 @findex gnus-active
28034 The active entry for @var{group}.
28035
28036 @item gnus-set-active
28037 @findex gnus-set-active
28038 Set the active entry for @var{group}.
28039
28040 @item gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
28041 @findex gnus-add-current-to-buffer-list
28042 Adds the current buffer to the list of buffers to be killed on Gnus
28043 exit.
28044
28045 @item gnus-continuum-version
28046 @findex gnus-continuum-version
28047 Takes a Gnus version string as a parameter and returns a floating point
28048 number. Earlier versions will always get a lower number than later
28049 versions.
28050
28051 @item gnus-group-read-only-p
28052 @findex gnus-group-read-only-p
28053 Says whether @var{group} is read-only or not.
28054
28055 @item gnus-news-group-p
28056 @findex gnus-news-group-p
28057 Says whether @var{group} came from a news back end.
28058
28059 @item gnus-ephemeral-group-p
28060 @findex gnus-ephemeral-group-p
28061 Says whether @var{group} is ephemeral or not.
28062
28063 @item gnus-server-to-method
28064 @findex gnus-server-to-method
28065 Returns the select method corresponding to @var{server}.
28066
28067 @item gnus-server-equal
28068 @findex gnus-server-equal
28069 Says whether two virtual servers are equal.
28070
28071 @item gnus-group-native-p
28072 @findex gnus-group-native-p
28073 Says whether @var{group} is native or not.
28074
28075 @item gnus-group-secondary-p
28076 @findex gnus-group-secondary-p
28077 Says whether @var{group} is secondary or not.
28078
28079 @item gnus-group-foreign-p
28080 @findex gnus-group-foreign-p
28081 Says whether @var{group} is foreign or not.
28082
28083 @item gnus-group-find-parameter
28084 @findex gnus-group-find-parameter
28085 Returns the parameter list of @var{group}. If given a second parameter,
28086 returns the value of that parameter for @var{group}.
28087
28088 @item gnus-group-set-parameter
28089 @findex gnus-group-set-parameter
28090 Takes three parameters; @var{group}, @var{parameter} and @var{value}.
28091
28092 @item gnus-narrow-to-body
28093 @findex gnus-narrow-to-body
28094 Narrows the current buffer to the body of the article.
28095
28096 @item gnus-check-backend-function
28097 @findex gnus-check-backend-function
28098 Takes two parameters, @var{function} and @var{group}. If the back end
28099 @var{group} comes from supports @var{function}, return non-@code{nil}.
28100
28101 @lisp
28102 (gnus-check-backend-function "request-scan" "nnml:misc")
28103 @result{} t
28104 @end lisp
28105
28106 @item gnus-read-method
28107 @findex gnus-read-method
28108 Prompts the user for a select method.
28109
28110 @end table
28111
28112
28113 @node Back End Interface
28114 @subsection Back End Interface
28115
28116 Gnus doesn't know anything about @acronym{NNTP}, spools, mail or virtual
28117 groups. It only knows how to talk to @dfn{virtual servers}. A virtual
28118 server is a @dfn{back end} and some @dfn{back end variables}. As examples
28119 of the first, we have @code{nntp}, @code{nnspool} and @code{nnmbox}. As
28120 examples of the latter we have @code{nntp-port-number} and
28121 @code{nnmbox-directory}.
28122
28123 When Gnus asks for information from a back end---say @code{nntp}---on
28124 something, it will normally include a virtual server name in the
28125 function parameters. (If not, the back end should use the ``current''
28126 virtual server.) For instance, @code{nntp-request-list} takes a virtual
28127 server as its only (optional) parameter. If this virtual server hasn't
28128 been opened, the function should fail.
28129
28130 Note that a virtual server name has no relation to some physical server
28131 name. Take this example:
28132
28133 @lisp
28134 (nntp "odd-one"
28135 (nntp-address "ifi.uio.no")
28136 (nntp-port-number 4324))
28137 @end lisp
28138
28139 Here the virtual server name is @samp{odd-one} while the name of
28140 the physical server is @samp{ifi.uio.no}.
28141
28142 The back ends should be able to switch between several virtual servers.
28143 The standard back ends implement this by keeping an alist of virtual
28144 server environments that they pull down/push up when needed.
28145
28146 There are two groups of interface functions: @dfn{required functions},
28147 which must be present, and @dfn{optional functions}, which Gnus will
28148 always check for presence before attempting to call 'em.
28149
28150 All these functions are expected to return data in the buffer
28151 @code{nntp-server-buffer} (@samp{ *nntpd*}), which is somewhat
28152 unfortunately named, but we'll have to live with it. When I talk about
28153 @dfn{resulting data}, I always refer to the data in that buffer. When I
28154 talk about @dfn{return value}, I talk about the function value returned by
28155 the function call. Functions that fail should return @code{nil} as the
28156 return value.
28157
28158 Some back ends could be said to be @dfn{server-forming} back ends, and
28159 some might be said not to be. The latter are back ends that generally
28160 only operate on one group at a time, and have no concept of ``server''
28161 ---they have a group, and they deliver info on that group and nothing
28162 more.
28163
28164 Gnus identifies each message by way of group name and article number. A
28165 few remarks about these article numbers might be useful. First of all,
28166 the numbers are positive integers. Secondly, it is normally not
28167 possible for later articles to ``re-use'' older article numbers without
28168 confusing Gnus. That is, if a group has ever contained a message
28169 numbered 42, then no other message may get that number, or Gnus will get
28170 mightily confused.@footnote{See the function
28171 @code{nnchoke-request-update-info}, @ref{Optional Back End Functions}.}
28172 Third, article numbers must be assigned in order of arrival in the
28173 group; this is not necessarily the same as the date of the message.
28174
28175 The previous paragraph already mentions all the ``hard'' restrictions that
28176 article numbers must fulfill. But it seems that it might be useful to
28177 assign @emph{consecutive} article numbers, for Gnus gets quite confused
28178 if there are holes in the article numbering sequence. However, due to
28179 the ``no-reuse'' restriction, holes cannot be avoided altogether. It's
28180 also useful for the article numbers to start at 1 to avoid running out
28181 of numbers as long as possible.
28182
28183 Note that by convention, back ends are named @code{nnsomething}, but
28184 Gnus also comes with some @code{nnnotbackends}, such as
28185 @file{nnheader.el}, @file{nnmail.el} and @file{nnoo.el}.
28186
28187 In the examples and definitions I will refer to the imaginary back end
28188 @code{nnchoke}.
28189
28190 @cindex @code{nnchoke}
28191
28192 @menu
28193 * Required Back End Functions:: Functions that must be implemented.
28194 * Optional Back End Functions:: Functions that need not be implemented.
28195 * Error Messaging:: How to get messages and report errors.
28196 * Writing New Back Ends:: Extending old back ends.
28197 * Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus:: What has to be done on the Gnus end.
28198 * Mail-like Back Ends:: Some tips on mail back ends.
28199 @end menu
28200
28201
28202 @node Required Back End Functions
28203 @subsubsection Required Back End Functions
28204
28205 @table @code
28206
28207 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-headers ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FETCH-OLD)
28208
28209 @var{articles} is either a range of article numbers or a list of
28210 @code{Message-ID}s. Current back ends do not fully support either---only
28211 sequences (lists) of article numbers, and most back ends do not support
28212 retrieval of @code{Message-ID}s. But they should try for both.
28213
28214 The result data should either be HEADs or @acronym{NOV} lines, and the result
28215 value should either be @code{headers} or @code{nov} to reflect this.
28216 This might later be expanded to @code{various}, which will be a mixture
28217 of HEADs and @acronym{NOV} lines, but this is currently not supported by Gnus.
28218
28219 If @var{fetch-old} is non-@code{nil} it says to try fetching ``extra
28220 headers'', in some meaning of the word. This is generally done by
28221 fetching (at most) @var{fetch-old} extra headers less than the smallest
28222 article number in @code{articles}, and filling the gaps as well. The
28223 presence of this parameter can be ignored if the back end finds it
28224 cumbersome to follow the request. If this is non-@code{nil} and not a
28225 number, do maximum fetches.
28226
28227 Here's an example HEAD:
28228
28229 @example
28230 221 1056 Article retrieved.
28231 Path: ifi.uio.no!sturles
28232 From: sturles@@ifi.uio.no (Sturle Sunde)
28233 Newsgroups: ifi.discussion
28234 Subject: Re: Something very droll
28235 Date: 27 Oct 1994 14:02:57 +0100
28236 Organization: Dept. of Informatics, University of Oslo, Norway
28237 Lines: 26
28238 Message-ID: <38o8e1$a0o@@holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no>
28239 References: <38jdmq$4qu@@visbur.ifi.uio.no>
28240 NNTP-Posting-Host: holmenkollen.ifi.uio.no
28241 .
28242 @end example
28243
28244 So a @code{headers} return value would imply that there's a number of
28245 these in the data buffer.
28246
28247 Here's a BNF definition of such a buffer:
28248
28249 @example
28250 headers = *head
28251 head = error / valid-head
28252 error-message = [ "4" / "5" ] 2number " " <error message> eol
28253 valid-head = valid-message *header "." eol
28254 valid-message = "221 " <number> " Article retrieved." eol
28255 header = <text> eol
28256 @end example
28257
28258 @cindex BNF
28259 (The version of BNF used here is the one used in RFC822.)
28260
28261 If the return value is @code{nov}, the data buffer should contain
28262 @dfn{network overview database} lines. These are basically fields
28263 separated by tabs.
28264
28265 @example
28266 nov-buffer = *nov-line
28267 nov-line = field 7*8[ <TAB> field ] eol
28268 field = <text except TAB>
28269 @end example
28270
28271 For a closer look at what should be in those fields,
28272 @pxref{Headers}.
28273
28274
28275 @item (nnchoke-open-server SERVER &optional DEFINITIONS)
28276
28277 @var{server} is here the virtual server name. @var{definitions} is a
28278 list of @code{(VARIABLE VALUE)} pairs that define this virtual server.
28279
28280 If the server can't be opened, no error should be signaled. The back end
28281 may then choose to refuse further attempts at connecting to this
28282 server. In fact, it should do so.
28283
28284 If the server is opened already, this function should return a
28285 non-@code{nil} value. There should be no data returned.
28286
28287
28288 @item (nnchoke-close-server &optional SERVER)
28289
28290 Close connection to @var{server} and free all resources connected
28291 to it. Return @code{nil} if the server couldn't be closed for some
28292 reason.
28293
28294 There should be no data returned.
28295
28296
28297 @item (nnchoke-request-close)
28298
28299 Close connection to all servers and free all resources that the back end
28300 have reserved. All buffers that have been created by that back end
28301 should be killed. (Not the @code{nntp-server-buffer}, though.) This
28302 function is generally only called when Gnus is shutting down.
28303
28304 There should be no data returned.
28305
28306
28307 @item (nnchoke-server-opened &optional SERVER)
28308
28309 If @var{server} is the current virtual server, and the connection to the
28310 physical server is alive, then this function should return a
28311 non-@code{nil} value. This function should under no circumstances
28312 attempt to reconnect to a server we have lost connection to.
28313
28314 There should be no data returned.
28315
28316
28317 @item (nnchoke-status-message &optional SERVER)
28318
28319 This function should return the last error message from @var{server}.
28320
28321 There should be no data returned.
28322
28323
28324 @item (nnchoke-request-article ARTICLE &optional GROUP SERVER TO-BUFFER)
28325
28326 The result data from this function should be the article specified by
28327 @var{article}. This might either be a @code{Message-ID} or a number.
28328 It is optional whether to implement retrieval by @code{Message-ID}, but
28329 it would be nice if that were possible.
28330
28331 If @var{to-buffer} is non-@code{nil}, the result data should be returned
28332 in this buffer instead of the normal data buffer. This is to make it
28333 possible to avoid copying large amounts of data from one buffer to
28334 another, while Gnus mainly requests articles to be inserted directly
28335 into its article buffer.
28336
28337 If it is at all possible, this function should return a cons cell where
28338 the @code{car} is the group name the article was fetched from, and the @code{cdr} is
28339 the article number. This will enable Gnus to find out what the real
28340 group and article numbers are when fetching articles by
28341 @code{Message-ID}. If this isn't possible, @code{t} should be returned
28342 on successful article retrieval.
28343
28344
28345 @item (nnchoke-request-group GROUP &optional SERVER FAST)
28346
28347 Get data on @var{group}. This function also has the side effect of
28348 making @var{group} the current group.
28349
28350 If @var{fast}, don't bother to return useful data, just make @var{group}
28351 the current group.
28352
28353 Here's an example of some result data and a definition of the same:
28354
28355 @example
28356 211 56 1000 1059 ifi.discussion
28357 @end example
28358
28359 The first number is the status, which should be 211. Next is the
28360 total number of articles in the group, the lowest article number, the
28361 highest article number, and finally the group name. Note that the total
28362 number of articles may be less than one might think while just
28363 considering the highest and lowest article numbers, but some articles
28364 may have been canceled. Gnus just discards the total-number, so
28365 whether one should take the bother to generate it properly (if that is a
28366 problem) is left as an exercise to the reader. If the group contains no
28367 articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1 and the
28368 highest as 0.
28369
28370 @example
28371 group-status = [ error / info ] eol
28372 error = [ "4" / "5" ] 2<number> " " <Error message>
28373 info = "211 " 3* [ <number> " " ] <string>
28374 @end example
28375
28376
28377 @item (nnchoke-close-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
28378
28379 Close @var{group} and free any resources connected to it. This will be
28380 a no-op on most back ends.
28381
28382 There should be no data returned.
28383
28384
28385 @item (nnchoke-request-list &optional SERVER)
28386
28387 Return a list of all groups available on @var{server}. And that means
28388 @emph{all}.
28389
28390 Here's an example from a server that only carries two groups:
28391
28392 @example
28393 ifi.test 0000002200 0000002000 y
28394 ifi.discussion 3324 3300 n
28395 @end example
28396
28397 On each line we have a group name, then the highest article number in
28398 that group, the lowest article number, and finally a flag. If the group
28399 contains no articles, the lowest article number should be reported as 1
28400 and the highest as 0.
28401
28402 @example
28403 active-file = *active-line
28404 active-line = name " " <number> " " <number> " " flags eol
28405 name = <string>
28406 flags = "n" / "y" / "m" / "x" / "j" / "=" name
28407 @end example
28408
28409 The flag says whether the group is read-only (@samp{n}), is moderated
28410 (@samp{m}), is dead (@samp{x}), is aliased to some other group
28411 (@samp{=other-group}) or none of the above (@samp{y}).
28412
28413
28414 @item (nnchoke-request-post &optional SERVER)
28415
28416 This function should post the current buffer. It might return whether
28417 the posting was successful or not, but that's not required. If, for
28418 instance, the posting is done asynchronously, it has generally not been
28419 completed by the time this function concludes. In that case, this
28420 function should set up some kind of sentinel to beep the user loud and
28421 clear if the posting could not be completed.
28422
28423 There should be no result data from this function.
28424
28425 @end table
28426
28427
28428 @node Optional Back End Functions
28429 @subsubsection Optional Back End Functions
28430
28431 @table @code
28432
28433 @item (nnchoke-retrieve-groups GROUPS &optional SERVER)
28434
28435 @var{groups} is a list of groups, and this function should request data
28436 on all those groups. How it does it is of no concern to Gnus, but it
28437 should attempt to do this in a speedy fashion.
28438
28439 The return value of this function can be either @code{active} or
28440 @code{group}, which says what the format of the result data is. The
28441 former is in the same format as the data from
28442 @code{nnchoke-request-list}, while the latter is a buffer full of lines
28443 in the same format as @code{nnchoke-request-group} gives.
28444
28445 @example
28446 group-buffer = *active-line / *group-status
28447 @end example
28448
28449
28450 @item (nnchoke-request-update-info GROUP INFO &optional SERVER)
28451
28452 A Gnus group info (@pxref{Group Info}) is handed to the back end for
28453 alterations. This comes in handy if the back end really carries all
28454 the information (as is the case with virtual and imap groups). This
28455 function should destructively alter the info to suit its needs, and
28456 should return a non-@code{nil} value.
28457
28458 There should be no result data from this function.
28459
28460
28461 @item (nnchoke-request-type GROUP &optional ARTICLE)
28462
28463 When the user issues commands for ``sending news'' (@kbd{F} in the
28464 summary buffer, for instance), Gnus has to know whether the article the
28465 user is following up on is news or mail. This function should return
28466 @code{news} if @var{article} in @var{group} is news, @code{mail} if it
28467 is mail and @code{unknown} if the type can't be decided. (The
28468 @var{article} parameter is necessary in @code{nnvirtual} groups which
28469 might very well combine mail groups and news groups.) Both @var{group}
28470 and @var{article} may be @code{nil}.
28471
28472 There should be no result data from this function.
28473
28474
28475 @item (nnchoke-request-set-mark GROUP ACTION &optional SERVER)
28476
28477 Set/remove/add marks on articles. Normally Gnus handles the article
28478 marks (such as read, ticked, expired etc) internally, and store them in
28479 @file{~/.newsrc.eld}. Some back ends (such as @acronym{IMAP}) however carry
28480 all information about the articles on the server, so Gnus need to
28481 propagate the mark information to the server.
28482
28483 @var{action} is a list of mark setting requests, having this format:
28484
28485 @example
28486 (RANGE ACTION MARK)
28487 @end example
28488
28489 @var{range} is a range of articles you wish to update marks on.
28490 @var{action} is @code{add} or @code{del}, used to add marks or remove
28491 marks (preserving all marks not mentioned). @var{mark} is a list of
28492 marks; where each mark is a symbol. Currently used marks are
28493 @code{read}, @code{tick}, @code{reply}, @code{expire}, @code{killed},
28494 @code{dormant}, @code{save}, @code{download}, @code{unsend},
28495 @code{forward} and @code{recent}, but your back end should, if
28496 possible, not limit itself to these.
28497
28498 Given contradictory actions, the last action in the list should be the
28499 effective one. That is, if your action contains a request to add the
28500 @code{tick} mark on article 1 and, later in the list, a request to
28501 remove the mark on the same article, the mark should in fact be removed.
28502
28503 An example action list:
28504
28505 @example
28506 (((5 12 30) 'del '(tick))
28507 ((10 . 90) 'add '(read expire))
28508 ((92 94) 'del '(read)))
28509 @end example
28510
28511 The function should return a range of articles it wasn't able to set the
28512 mark on (currently not used for anything).
28513
28514 There should be no result data from this function.
28515
28516 @item (nnchoke-request-update-mark GROUP ARTICLE MARK)
28517
28518 If the user tries to set a mark that the back end doesn't like, this
28519 function may change the mark. Gnus will use whatever this function
28520 returns as the mark for @var{article} instead of the original
28521 @var{mark}. If the back end doesn't care, it must return the original
28522 @var{mark}, and not @code{nil} or any other type of garbage.
28523
28524 The only use for this I can see is what @code{nnvirtual} does with
28525 it---if a component group is auto-expirable, marking an article as read
28526 in the virtual group should result in the article being marked as
28527 expirable.
28528
28529 There should be no result data from this function.
28530
28531
28532 @item (nnchoke-request-scan &optional GROUP SERVER)
28533
28534 This function may be called at any time (by Gnus or anything else) to
28535 request that the back end check for incoming articles, in one way or
28536 another. A mail back end will typically read the spool file or query
28537 the @acronym{POP} server when this function is invoked. The
28538 @var{group} doesn't have to be heeded---if the back end decides that
28539 it is too much work just scanning for a single group, it may do a
28540 total scan of all groups. It would be nice, however, to keep things
28541 local if that's practical.
28542
28543 There should be no result data from this function.
28544
28545
28546 @item (nnchoke-request-group-description GROUP &optional SERVER)
28547
28548 The result data from this function should be a description of
28549 @var{group}.
28550
28551 @example
28552 description-line = name <TAB> description eol
28553 name = <string>
28554 description = <text>
28555 @end example
28556
28557 @item (nnchoke-request-list-newsgroups &optional SERVER)
28558
28559 The result data from this function should be the description of all
28560 groups available on the server.
28561
28562 @example
28563 description-buffer = *description-line
28564 @end example
28565
28566
28567 @item (nnchoke-request-newgroups DATE &optional SERVER)
28568
28569 The result data from this function should be all groups that were
28570 created after @samp{date}, which is in normal human-readable date format
28571 (i.e., the date format used in mail and news headers, and returned by
28572 the function @code{message-make-date} by default). The data should be
28573 in the active buffer format.
28574
28575 It is okay for this function to return ``too many'' groups; some back ends
28576 might find it cheaper to return the full list of groups, rather than
28577 just the new groups. But don't do this for back ends with many groups.
28578 Normally, if the user creates the groups herself, there won't be too
28579 many groups, so @code{nnml} and the like are probably safe. But for
28580 back ends like @code{nntp}, where the groups have been created by the
28581 server, it is quite likely that there can be many groups.
28582
28583
28584 @item (nnchoke-request-create-group GROUP &optional SERVER)
28585
28586 This function should create an empty group with name @var{group}.
28587
28588 There should be no return data.
28589
28590
28591 @item (nnchoke-request-expire-articles ARTICLES &optional GROUP SERVER FORCE)
28592
28593 This function should run the expiry process on all articles in the
28594 @var{articles} range (which is currently a simple list of article
28595 numbers.) It is left up to the back end to decide how old articles
28596 should be before they are removed by this function. If @var{force} is
28597 non-@code{nil}, all @var{articles} should be deleted, no matter how new
28598 they are.
28599
28600 This function should return a list of articles that it did not/was not
28601 able to delete.
28602
28603 There should be no result data returned.
28604
28605
28606 @item (nnchoke-request-move-article ARTICLE GROUP SERVER ACCEPT-FORM &optional LAST)
28607
28608 This function should move @var{article} (which is a number) from
28609 @var{group} by calling @var{accept-form}.
28610
28611 This function should ready the article in question for moving by
28612 removing any header lines it has added to the article, and generally
28613 should ``tidy up'' the article. Then it should @code{eval}
28614 @var{accept-form} in the buffer where the ``tidy'' article is. This
28615 will do the actual copying. If this @code{eval} returns a
28616 non-@code{nil} value, the article should be removed.
28617
28618 If @var{last} is @code{nil}, that means that there is a high likelihood
28619 that there will be more requests issued shortly, so that allows some
28620 optimizations.
28621
28622 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
28623 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
28624
28625 There should be no data returned.
28626
28627
28628 @item (nnchoke-request-accept-article GROUP &optional SERVER LAST)
28629
28630 This function takes the current buffer and inserts it into @var{group}.
28631 If @var{last} in @code{nil}, that means that there will be more calls to
28632 this function in short order.
28633
28634 The function should return a cons where the @code{car} is the group name and
28635 the @code{cdr} is the article number that the article was entered as.
28636
28637 The group should exist before the back end is asked to accept the
28638 article for that group.
28639
28640 There should be no data returned.
28641
28642
28643 @item (nnchoke-request-replace-article ARTICLE GROUP BUFFER)
28644
28645 This function should remove @var{article} (which is a number) from
28646 @var{group} and insert @var{buffer} there instead.
28647
28648 There should be no data returned.
28649
28650
28651 @item (nnchoke-request-delete-group GROUP FORCE &optional SERVER)
28652
28653 This function should delete @var{group}. If @var{force}, it should
28654 really delete all the articles in the group, and then delete the group
28655 itself. (If there is such a thing as ``the group itself''.)
28656
28657 There should be no data returned.
28658
28659
28660 @item (nnchoke-request-rename-group GROUP NEW-NAME &optional SERVER)
28661
28662 This function should rename @var{group} into @var{new-name}. All
28663 articles in @var{group} should move to @var{new-name}.
28664
28665 There should be no data returned.
28666
28667 @end table
28668
28669
28670 @node Error Messaging
28671 @subsubsection Error Messaging
28672
28673 @findex nnheader-report
28674 @findex nnheader-get-report
28675 The back ends should use the function @code{nnheader-report} to report
28676 error conditions---they should not raise errors when they aren't able to
28677 perform a request. The first argument to this function is the back end
28678 symbol, and the rest are interpreted as arguments to @code{format} if
28679 there are multiple of them, or just a string if there is one of them.
28680 This function must always returns @code{nil}.
28681
28682 @lisp
28683 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "You did something totally bogus")
28684
28685 (nnheader-report 'nnchoke "Could not request group %s" group)
28686 @end lisp
28687
28688 Gnus, in turn, will call @code{nnheader-get-report} when it gets a
28689 @code{nil} back from a server, and this function returns the most
28690 recently reported message for the back end in question. This function
28691 takes one argument---the server symbol.
28692
28693 Internally, these functions access @var{back-end}@code{-status-string},
28694 so the @code{nnchoke} back end will have its error message stored in
28695 @code{nnchoke-status-string}.
28696
28697
28698 @node Writing New Back Ends
28699 @subsubsection Writing New Back Ends
28700
28701 Many back ends are quite similar. @code{nnml} is just like
28702 @code{nnspool}, but it allows you to edit the articles on the server.
28703 @code{nnmh} is just like @code{nnml}, but it doesn't use an active file,
28704 and it doesn't maintain overview databases. @code{nndir} is just like
28705 @code{nnml}, but it has no concept of ``groups'', and it doesn't allow
28706 editing articles.
28707
28708 It would make sense if it were possible to ``inherit'' functions from
28709 back ends when writing new back ends. And, indeed, you can do that if you
28710 want to. (You don't have to if you don't want to, of course.)
28711
28712 All the back ends declare their public variables and functions by using a
28713 package called @code{nnoo}.
28714
28715 To inherit functions from other back ends (and allow other back ends to
28716 inherit functions from the current back end), you should use the
28717 following macros:
28718
28719 @table @code
28720
28721 @item nnoo-declare
28722 This macro declares the first parameter to be a child of the subsequent
28723 parameters. For instance:
28724
28725 @lisp
28726 (nnoo-declare nndir
28727 nnml nnmh)
28728 @end lisp
28729
28730 @code{nndir} has declared here that it intends to inherit functions from
28731 both @code{nnml} and @code{nnmh}.
28732
28733 @item defvoo
28734 This macro is equivalent to @code{defvar}, but registers the variable as
28735 a public server variable. Most state-oriented variables should be
28736 declared with @code{defvoo} instead of @code{defvar}.
28737
28738 In addition to the normal @code{defvar} parameters, it takes a list of
28739 variables in the parent back ends to map the variable to when executing
28740 a function in those back ends.
28741
28742 @lisp
28743 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28744 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28745 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28746 @end lisp
28747
28748 This means that @code{nnml-current-directory} will be set to
28749 @code{nndir-directory} when an @code{nnml} function is called on behalf
28750 of @code{nndir}. (The same with @code{nnmh}.)
28751
28752 @item nnoo-define-basics
28753 This macro defines some common functions that almost all back ends should
28754 have.
28755
28756 @lisp
28757 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28758 @end lisp
28759
28760 @item deffoo
28761 This macro is just like @code{defun} and takes the same parameters. In
28762 addition to doing the normal @code{defun} things, it registers the
28763 function as being public so that other back ends can inherit it.
28764
28765 @item nnoo-map-functions
28766 This macro allows mapping of functions from the current back end to
28767 functions from the parent back ends.
28768
28769 @lisp
28770 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28771 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28772 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0))
28773 @end lisp
28774
28775 This means that when @code{nndir-retrieve-headers} is called, the first,
28776 third, and fourth parameters will be passed on to
28777 @code{nnml-retrieve-headers}, while the second parameter is set to the
28778 value of @code{nndir-current-group}.
28779
28780 @item nnoo-import
28781 This macro allows importing functions from back ends. It should be the
28782 last thing in the source file, since it will only define functions that
28783 haven't already been defined.
28784
28785 @lisp
28786 (nnoo-import nndir
28787 (nnmh
28788 nnmh-request-list
28789 nnmh-request-newgroups)
28790 (nnml))
28791 @end lisp
28792
28793 This means that calls to @code{nndir-request-list} should just be passed
28794 on to @code{nnmh-request-list}, while all public functions from
28795 @code{nnml} that haven't been defined in @code{nndir} yet should be
28796 defined now.
28797
28798 @end table
28799
28800 Below is a slightly shortened version of the @code{nndir} back end.
28801
28802 @lisp
28803 ;;; @r{nndir.el --- single directory newsgroup access for Gnus}
28804 ;; @r{Copyright (C) 1995,96 Free Software Foundation, Inc.}
28805
28806 ;;; @r{Code:}
28807
28808 (require 'nnheader)
28809 (require 'nnmh)
28810 (require 'nnml)
28811 (require 'nnoo)
28812 (eval-when-compile (require 'cl))
28813
28814 (nnoo-declare nndir
28815 nnml nnmh)
28816
28817 (defvoo nndir-directory nil
28818 "Where nndir will look for groups."
28819 nnml-current-directory nnmh-current-directory)
28820
28821 (defvoo nndir-nov-is-evil nil
28822 "*Non-nil means that nndir will never retrieve NOV headers."
28823 nnml-nov-is-evil)
28824
28825 (defvoo nndir-current-group ""
28826 nil
28827 nnml-current-group nnmh-current-group)
28828 (defvoo nndir-top-directory nil nil nnml-directory nnmh-directory)
28829 (defvoo nndir-get-new-mail nil nil nnml-get-new-mail nnmh-get-new-mail)
28830
28831 (defvoo nndir-status-string "" nil nnmh-status-string)
28832 (defconst nndir-version "nndir 1.0")
28833
28834 ;;; @r{Interface functions.}
28835
28836 (nnoo-define-basics nndir)
28837
28838 (deffoo nndir-open-server (server &optional defs)
28839 (setq nndir-directory
28840 (or (cadr (assq 'nndir-directory defs))
28841 server))
28842 (unless (assq 'nndir-directory defs)
28843 (push `(nndir-directory ,server) defs))
28844 (push `(nndir-current-group
28845 ,(file-name-nondirectory
28846 (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28847 defs)
28848 (push `(nndir-top-directory
28849 ,(file-name-directory (directory-file-name nndir-directory)))
28850 defs)
28851 (nnoo-change-server 'nndir server defs))
28852
28853 (nnoo-map-functions nndir
28854 (nnml-retrieve-headers 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28855 (nnmh-request-article 0 nndir-current-group 0 0)
28856 (nnmh-request-group nndir-current-group 0 0)
28857 (nnmh-close-group nndir-current-group 0))
28858
28859 (nnoo-import nndir
28860 (nnmh
28861 nnmh-status-message
28862 nnmh-request-list
28863 nnmh-request-newgroups))
28864
28865 (provide 'nndir)
28866 @end lisp
28867
28868
28869 @node Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28870 @subsubsection Hooking New Back Ends Into Gnus
28871
28872 @vindex gnus-valid-select-methods
28873 @findex gnus-declare-backend
28874 Having Gnus start using your new back end is rather easy---you just
28875 declare it with the @code{gnus-declare-backend} functions. This will
28876 enter the back end into the @code{gnus-valid-select-methods} variable.
28877
28878 @code{gnus-declare-backend} takes two parameters---the back end name and
28879 an arbitrary number of @dfn{abilities}.
28880
28881 Here's an example:
28882
28883 @lisp
28884 (gnus-declare-backend "nnchoke" 'mail 'respool 'address)
28885 @end lisp
28886
28887 The above line would then go in the @file{nnchoke.el} file.
28888
28889 The abilities can be:
28890
28891 @table @code
28892 @item mail
28893 This is a mailish back end---followups should (probably) go via mail.
28894 @item post
28895 This is a newsish back end---followups should (probably) go via news.
28896 @item post-mail
28897 This back end supports both mail and news.
28898 @item none
28899 This is neither a post nor mail back end---it's something completely
28900 different.
28901 @item respool
28902 It supports respooling---or rather, it is able to modify its source
28903 articles and groups.
28904 @item address
28905 The name of the server should be in the virtual server name. This is
28906 true for almost all back ends.
28907 @item prompt-address
28908 The user should be prompted for an address when doing commands like
28909 @kbd{B} in the group buffer. This is true for back ends like
28910 @code{nntp}, but not @code{nnmbox}, for instance.
28911 @end table
28912
28913
28914 @node Mail-like Back Ends
28915 @subsubsection Mail-like Back Ends
28916
28917 One of the things that separate the mail back ends from the rest of the
28918 back ends is the heavy dependence by most of the mail back ends on
28919 common functions in @file{nnmail.el}. For instance, here's the
28920 definition of @code{nnml-request-scan}:
28921
28922 @lisp
28923 (deffoo nnml-request-scan (&optional group server)
28924 (setq nnml-article-file-alist nil)
28925 (nnmail-get-new-mail 'nnml 'nnml-save-nov nnml-directory group))
28926 @end lisp
28927
28928 It simply calls @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} with a few parameters,
28929 and @code{nnmail} takes care of all the moving and splitting of the
28930 mail.
28931
28932 This function takes four parameters.
28933
28934 @table @var
28935 @item method
28936 This should be a symbol to designate which back end is responsible for
28937 the call.
28938
28939 @item exit-function
28940 This function should be called after the splitting has been performed.
28941
28942 @item temp-directory
28943 Where the temporary files should be stored.
28944
28945 @item group
28946 This optional argument should be a group name if the splitting is to be
28947 performed for one group only.
28948 @end table
28949
28950 @code{nnmail-get-new-mail} will call @var{back-end}@code{-save-mail} to
28951 save each article. @var{back-end}@code{-active-number} will be called to
28952 find the article number assigned to this article.
28953
28954 The function also uses the following variables:
28955 @var{back-end}@code{-get-new-mail} (to see whether to get new mail for
28956 this back end); and @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} and
28957 @var{back-end}@code{-active-file} to generate the new active file.
28958 @var{back-end}@code{-group-alist} should be a group-active alist, like
28959 this:
28960
28961 @example
28962 (("a-group" (1 . 10))
28963 ("some-group" (34 . 39)))
28964 @end example
28965
28966
28967 @node Score File Syntax
28968 @subsection Score File Syntax
28969
28970 Score files are meant to be easily parseable, but yet extremely
28971 mallable. It was decided that something that had the same read syntax
28972 as an Emacs Lisp list would fit that spec.
28973
28974 Here's a typical score file:
28975
28976 @lisp
28977 (("summary"
28978 ("win95" -10000 nil s)
28979 ("Gnus"))
28980 ("from"
28981 ("Lars" -1000))
28982 (mark -100))
28983 @end lisp
28984
28985 BNF definition of a score file:
28986
28987 @example
28988 score-file = "" / "(" *element ")"
28989 element = rule / atom
28990 rule = string-rule / number-rule / date-rule
28991 string-rule = "(" quote string-header quote space *string-match ")"
28992 number-rule = "(" quote number-header quote space *number-match ")"
28993 date-rule = "(" quote date-header quote space *date-match ")"
28994 quote = <ascii 34>
28995 string-header = "subject" / "from" / "references" / "message-id" /
28996 "xref" / "body" / "head" / "all" / "followup"
28997 number-header = "lines" / "chars"
28998 date-header = "date"
28999 string-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29000 space date [ "" / [ space string-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29001 score = "nil" / <integer>
29002 date = "nil" / <natural number>
29003 string-match-t = "nil" / "s" / "substring" / "S" / "Substring" /
29004 "r" / "regex" / "R" / "Regex" /
29005 "e" / "exact" / "E" / "Exact" /
29006 "f" / "fuzzy" / "F" / "Fuzzy"
29007 number-match = "(" <integer> [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29008 space date [ "" / [ space number-match-t ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29009 number-match-t = "nil" / "=" / "<" / ">" / ">=" / "<="
29010 date-match = "(" quote <string> quote [ "" / [ space score [ "" /
29011 space date [ "" / [ space date-match-t ] ] ] ] ")"
29012 date-match-t = "nil" / "at" / "before" / "after"
29013 atom = "(" [ required-atom / optional-atom ] ")"
29014 required-atom = mark / expunge / mark-and-expunge / files /
29015 exclude-files / read-only / touched
29016 optional-atom = adapt / local / eval
29017 mark = "mark" space nil-or-number
29018 nil-or-number = "nil" / <integer>
29019 expunge = "expunge" space nil-or-number
29020 mark-and-expunge = "mark-and-expunge" space nil-or-number
29021 files = "files" *[ space <string> ]
29022 exclude-files = "exclude-files" *[ space <string> ]
29023 read-only = "read-only" [ space "nil" / space "t" ]
29024 adapt = "adapt" [ space "ignore" / space "t" / space adapt-rule ]
29025 adapt-rule = "(" *[ <string> *[ "(" <string> <integer> ")" ] ")"
29026 local = "local" *[ space "(" <string> space <form> ")" ]
29027 eval = "eval" space <form>
29028 space = *[ " " / <TAB> / <NEWLINE> ]
29029 @end example
29030
29031 Any unrecognized elements in a score file should be ignored, but not
29032 discarded.
29033
29034 As you can see, white space is needed, but the type and amount of white
29035 space is irrelevant. This means that formatting of the score file is
29036 left up to the programmer---if it's simpler to just spew it all out on
29037 one looong line, then that's ok.
29038
29039 The meaning of the various atoms are explained elsewhere in this
29040 manual (@pxref{Score File Format}).
29041
29042
29043 @node Headers
29044 @subsection Headers
29045
29046 Internally Gnus uses a format for storing article headers that
29047 corresponds to the @acronym{NOV} format in a mysterious fashion. One could
29048 almost suspect that the author looked at the @acronym{NOV} specification and
29049 just shamelessly @emph{stole} the entire thing, and one would be right.
29050
29051 @dfn{Header} is a severely overloaded term. ``Header'' is used in
29052 RFC 1036 to talk about lines in the head of an article (e.g.,
29053 @code{From}). It is used by many people as a synonym for
29054 ``head''---``the header and the body''. (That should be avoided, in my
29055 opinion.) And Gnus uses a format internally that it calls ``header'',
29056 which is what I'm talking about here. This is a 9-element vector,
29057 basically, with each header (ouch) having one slot.
29058
29059 These slots are, in order: @code{number}, @code{subject}, @code{from},
29060 @code{date}, @code{id}, @code{references}, @code{chars}, @code{lines},
29061 @code{xref}, and @code{extra}. There are macros for accessing and
29062 setting these slots---they all have predictable names beginning with
29063 @code{mail-header-} and @code{mail-header-set-}, respectively.
29064
29065 All these slots contain strings, except the @code{extra} slot, which
29066 contains an alist of header/value pairs (@pxref{To From Newsgroups}).
29067
29068
29069 @node Ranges
29070 @subsection Ranges
29071
29072 @sc{gnus} introduced a concept that I found so useful that I've started
29073 using it a lot and have elaborated on it greatly.
29074
29075 The question is simple: If you have a large amount of objects that are
29076 identified by numbers (say, articles, to take a @emph{wild} example)
29077 that you want to qualify as being ``included'', a normal sequence isn't
29078 very useful. (A 200,000 length sequence is a bit long-winded.)
29079
29080 The solution is as simple as the question: You just collapse the
29081 sequence.
29082
29083 @example
29084 (1 2 3 4 5 6 10 11 12)
29085 @end example
29086
29087 is transformed into
29088
29089 @example
29090 ((1 . 6) (10 . 12))
29091 @end example
29092
29093 To avoid having those nasty @samp{(13 . 13)} elements to denote a
29094 lonesome object, a @samp{13} is a valid element:
29095
29096 @example
29097 ((1 . 6) 7 (10 . 12))
29098 @end example
29099
29100 This means that comparing two ranges to find out whether they are equal
29101 is slightly tricky:
29102
29103 @example
29104 ((1 . 5) 7 8 (10 . 12))
29105 @end example
29106
29107 and
29108
29109 @example
29110 ((1 . 5) (7 . 8) (10 . 12))
29111 @end example
29112
29113 are equal. In fact, any non-descending list is a range:
29114
29115 @example
29116 (1 2 3 4 5)
29117 @end example
29118
29119 is a perfectly valid range, although a pretty long-winded one. This is
29120 also valid:
29121
29122 @example
29123 (1 . 5)
29124 @end example
29125
29126 and is equal to the previous range.
29127
29128 Here's a BNF definition of ranges. Of course, one must remember the
29129 semantic requirement that the numbers are non-descending. (Any number
29130 of repetition of the same number is allowed, but apt to disappear in
29131 range handling.)
29132
29133 @example
29134 range = simple-range / normal-range
29135 simple-range = "(" number " . " number ")"
29136 normal-range = "(" start-contents ")"
29137 contents = "" / simple-range *[ " " contents ] /
29138 number *[ " " contents ]
29139 @end example
29140
29141 Gnus currently uses ranges to keep track of read articles and article
29142 marks. I plan on implementing a number of range operators in C if The
29143 Powers That Be are willing to let me. (I haven't asked yet, because I
29144 need to do some more thinking on what operators I need to make life
29145 totally range-based without ever having to convert back to normal
29146 sequences.)
29147
29148
29149 @node Group Info
29150 @subsection Group Info
29151
29152 Gnus stores all permanent info on groups in a @dfn{group info} list.
29153 This list is from three to six elements (or more) long and exhaustively
29154 describes the group.
29155
29156 Here are two example group infos; one is a very simple group while the
29157 second is a more complex one:
29158
29159 @example
29160 ("no.group" 5 ((1 . 54324)))
29161
29162 ("nnml:my.mail" 3 ((1 . 5) 9 (20 . 55))
29163 ((tick (15 . 19)) (replied 3 6 (19 . 3)))
29164 (nnml "")
29165 ((auto-expire . t) (to-address . "ding@@gnus.org")))
29166 @end example
29167
29168 The first element is the @dfn{group name}---as Gnus knows the group,
29169 anyway. The second element is the @dfn{subscription level}, which
29170 normally is a small integer. (It can also be the @dfn{rank}, which is a
29171 cons cell where the @code{car} is the level and the @code{cdr} is the
29172 score.) The third element is a list of ranges of read articles. The
29173 fourth element is a list of lists of article marks of various kinds.
29174 The fifth element is the select method (or virtual server, if you like).
29175 The sixth element is a list of @dfn{group parameters}, which is what
29176 this section is about.
29177
29178 Any of the last three elements may be missing if they are not required.
29179 In fact, the vast majority of groups will normally only have the first
29180 three elements, which saves quite a lot of cons cells.
29181
29182 Here's a BNF definition of the group info format:
29183
29184 @example
29185 info = "(" group space ralevel space read
29186 [ "" / [ space marks-list [ "" / [ space method [ "" /
29187 space parameters ] ] ] ] ] ")"
29188 group = quote <string> quote
29189 ralevel = rank / level
29190 level = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
29191 rank = "(" level "." score ")"
29192 score = <integer in the range of 1 to inf>
29193 read = range
29194 marks-lists = nil / "(" *marks ")"
29195 marks = "(" <string> range ")"
29196 method = "(" <string> *elisp-forms ")"
29197 parameters = "(" *elisp-forms ")"
29198 @end example
29199
29200 Actually that @samp{marks} rule is a fib. A @samp{marks} is a
29201 @samp{<string>} consed on to a @samp{range}, but that's a bitch to say
29202 in pseudo-BNF.
29203
29204 If you have a Gnus info and want to access the elements, Gnus offers a
29205 series of macros for getting/setting these elements.
29206
29207 @table @code
29208 @item gnus-info-group
29209 @itemx gnus-info-set-group
29210 @findex gnus-info-group
29211 @findex gnus-info-set-group
29212 Get/set the group name.
29213
29214 @item gnus-info-rank
29215 @itemx gnus-info-set-rank
29216 @findex gnus-info-rank
29217 @findex gnus-info-set-rank
29218 Get/set the group rank (@pxref{Group Score}).
29219
29220 @item gnus-info-level
29221 @itemx gnus-info-set-level
29222 @findex gnus-info-level
29223 @findex gnus-info-set-level
29224 Get/set the group level.
29225
29226 @item gnus-info-score
29227 @itemx gnus-info-set-score
29228 @findex gnus-info-score
29229 @findex gnus-info-set-score
29230 Get/set the group score (@pxref{Group Score}).
29231
29232 @item gnus-info-read
29233 @itemx gnus-info-set-read
29234 @findex gnus-info-read
29235 @findex gnus-info-set-read
29236 Get/set the ranges of read articles.
29237
29238 @item gnus-info-marks
29239 @itemx gnus-info-set-marks
29240 @findex gnus-info-marks
29241 @findex gnus-info-set-marks
29242 Get/set the lists of ranges of marked articles.
29243
29244 @item gnus-info-method
29245 @itemx gnus-info-set-method
29246 @findex gnus-info-method
29247 @findex gnus-info-set-method
29248 Get/set the group select method.
29249
29250 @item gnus-info-params
29251 @itemx gnus-info-set-params
29252 @findex gnus-info-params
29253 @findex gnus-info-set-params
29254 Get/set the group parameters.
29255 @end table
29256
29257 All the getter functions take one parameter---the info list. The setter
29258 functions take two parameters---the info list and the new value.
29259
29260 The last three elements in the group info aren't mandatory, so it may be
29261 necessary to extend the group info before setting the element. If this
29262 is necessary, you can just pass on a non-@code{nil} third parameter to
29263 the three final setter functions to have this happen automatically.
29264
29265
29266 @node Extended Interactive
29267 @subsection Extended Interactive
29268 @cindex interactive
29269 @findex gnus-interactive
29270
29271 Gnus extends the standard Emacs @code{interactive} specification
29272 slightly to allow easy use of the symbolic prefix (@pxref{Symbolic
29273 Prefixes}). Here's an example of how this is used:
29274
29275 @lisp
29276 (defun gnus-summary-increase-score (&optional score symp)
29277 (interactive (gnus-interactive "P\ny"))
29278 ...
29279 )
29280 @end lisp
29281
29282 The best thing to do would have been to implement
29283 @code{gnus-interactive} as a macro which would have returned an
29284 @code{interactive} form, but this isn't possible since Emacs checks
29285 whether a function is interactive or not by simply doing an @code{assq}
29286 on the lambda form. So, instead we have @code{gnus-interactive}
29287 function that takes a string and returns values that are usable to
29288 @code{interactive}.
29289
29290 This function accepts (almost) all normal @code{interactive} specs, but
29291 adds a few more.
29292
29293 @table @samp
29294 @item y
29295 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbol
29296 The current symbolic prefix---the @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol}
29297 variable.
29298
29299 @item Y
29300 @vindex gnus-current-prefix-symbols
29301 A list of the current symbolic prefixes---the
29302 @code{gnus-current-prefix-symbol} variable.
29303
29304 @item A
29305 The current article number---the @code{gnus-summary-article-number}
29306 function.
29307
29308 @item H
29309 The current article header---the @code{gnus-summary-article-header}
29310 function.
29311
29312 @item g
29313 The current group name---the @code{gnus-group-group-name}
29314 function.
29315
29316 @end table
29317
29318
29319 @node Emacs/XEmacs Code
29320 @subsection Emacs/XEmacs Code
29321 @cindex XEmacs
29322 @cindex Emacsen
29323
29324 While Gnus runs under Emacs, XEmacs and Mule, I decided that one of the
29325 platforms must be the primary one. I chose Emacs. Not because I don't
29326 like XEmacs or Mule, but because it comes first alphabetically.
29327
29328 This means that Gnus will byte-compile under Emacs with nary a warning,
29329 while XEmacs will pump out gigabytes of warnings while byte-compiling.
29330 As I use byte-compilation warnings to help me root out trivial errors in
29331 Gnus, that's very useful.
29332
29333 I've also consistently used Emacs function interfaces, but have used
29334 Gnusey aliases for the functions. To take an example: Emacs defines a
29335 @code{run-at-time} function while XEmacs defines a @code{start-itimer}
29336 function. I then define a function called @code{gnus-run-at-time} that
29337 takes the same parameters as the Emacs @code{run-at-time}. When running
29338 Gnus under Emacs, the former function is just an alias for the latter.
29339 However, when running under XEmacs, the former is an alias for the
29340 following function:
29341
29342 @lisp
29343 (defun gnus-xmas-run-at-time (time repeat function &rest args)
29344 (start-itimer
29345 "gnus-run-at-time"
29346 `(lambda ()
29347 (,function ,@@args))
29348 time repeat))
29349 @end lisp
29350
29351 This sort of thing has been done for bunches of functions. Gnus does
29352 not redefine any native Emacs functions while running under XEmacs---it
29353 does this @code{defalias} thing with Gnus equivalents instead. Cleaner
29354 all over.
29355
29356 In the cases where the XEmacs function interface was obviously cleaner,
29357 I used it instead. For example @code{gnus-region-active-p} is an alias
29358 for @code{region-active-p} in XEmacs, whereas in Emacs it is a function.
29359
29360 Of course, I could have chosen XEmacs as my native platform and done
29361 mapping functions the other way around. But I didn't. The performance
29362 hit these indirections impose on Gnus under XEmacs should be slight.
29363
29364
29365 @node Various File Formats
29366 @subsection Various File Formats
29367
29368 @menu
29369 * Active File Format:: Information on articles and groups available.
29370 * Newsgroups File Format:: Group descriptions.
29371 @end menu
29372
29373
29374 @node Active File Format
29375 @subsubsection Active File Format
29376
29377 The active file lists all groups available on the server in
29378 question. It also lists the highest and lowest current article numbers
29379 in each group.
29380
29381 Here's an excerpt from a typical active file:
29382
29383 @example
29384 soc.motss 296030 293865 y
29385 alt.binaries.pictures.fractals 3922 3913 n
29386 comp.sources.unix 1605 1593 m
29387 comp.binaries.ibm.pc 5097 5089 y
29388 no.general 1000 900 y
29389 @end example
29390
29391 Here's a pseudo-BNF definition of this file:
29392
29393 @example
29394 active = *group-line
29395 group-line = group spc high-number spc low-number spc flag <NEWLINE>
29396 group = <non-white-space string>
29397 spc = " "
29398 high-number = <non-negative integer>
29399 low-number = <positive integer>
29400 flag = "y" / "n" / "m" / "j" / "x" / "=" group
29401 @end example
29402
29403 For a full description of this file, see the manual pages for
29404 @samp{innd}, in particular @samp{active(5)}.
29405
29406
29407 @node Newsgroups File Format
29408 @subsubsection Newsgroups File Format
29409
29410 The newsgroups file lists groups along with their descriptions. Not all
29411 groups on the server have to be listed, and not all groups in the file
29412 have to exist on the server. The file is meant purely as information to
29413 the user.
29414
29415 The format is quite simple; a group name, a tab, and the description.
29416 Here's the definition:
29417
29418 @example
29419 newsgroups = *line
29420 line = group tab description <NEWLINE>
29421 group = <non-white-space string>
29422 tab = <TAB>
29423 description = <string>
29424 @end example
29425
29426
29427 @page
29428 @node Emacs for Heathens
29429 @section Emacs for Heathens
29430
29431 Believe it or not, but some people who use Gnus haven't really used
29432 Emacs much before they embarked on their journey on the Gnus Love Boat.
29433 If you are one of those unfortunates whom ``@kbd{C-M-a}'', ``kill the
29434 region'', and ``set @code{gnus-flargblossen} to an alist where the key
29435 is a regexp that is used for matching on the group name'' are magical
29436 phrases with little or no meaning, then this appendix is for you. If
29437 you are already familiar with Emacs, just ignore this and go fondle your
29438 cat instead.
29439
29440 @menu
29441 * Keystrokes:: Entering text and executing commands.
29442 * Emacs Lisp:: The built-in Emacs programming language.
29443 @end menu
29444
29445
29446 @node Keystrokes
29447 @subsection Keystrokes
29448
29449 @itemize @bullet
29450 @item
29451 Q: What is an experienced Emacs user?
29452
29453 @item
29454 A: A person who wishes that the terminal had pedals.
29455 @end itemize
29456
29457 Yes, when you use Emacs, you are apt to use the control key, the shift
29458 key and the meta key a lot. This is very annoying to some people
29459 (notably @code{vi}le users), and the rest of us just love the hell out
29460 of it. Just give up and submit. Emacs really does stand for
29461 ``Escape-Meta-Alt-Control-Shift'', and not ``Editing Macros'', as you
29462 may have heard from other disreputable sources (like the Emacs author).
29463
29464 The shift keys are normally located near your pinky fingers, and are
29465 normally used to get capital letters and stuff. You probably use it all
29466 the time. The control key is normally marked ``CTRL'' or something like
29467 that. The meta key is, funnily enough, never marked as such on any
29468 keyboard. The one I'm currently at has a key that's marked ``Alt'',
29469 which is the meta key on this keyboard. It's usually located somewhere
29470 to the left hand side of the keyboard, usually on the bottom row.
29471
29472 Now, us Emacs people don't say ``press the meta-control-m key'',
29473 because that's just too inconvenient. We say ``press the @kbd{C-M-m}
29474 key''. @kbd{M-} is the prefix that means ``meta'' and ``C-'' is the
29475 prefix that means ``control''. So ``press @kbd{C-k}'' means ``press
29476 down the control key, and hold it down while you press @kbd{k}''.
29477 ``Press @kbd{C-M-k}'' means ``press down and hold down the meta key and
29478 the control key and then press @kbd{k}''. Simple, ay?
29479
29480 This is somewhat complicated by the fact that not all keyboards have a
29481 meta key. In that case you can use the ``escape'' key. Then @kbd{M-k}
29482 means ``press escape, release escape, press @kbd{k}''. That's much more
29483 work than if you have a meta key, so if that's the case, I respectfully
29484 suggest you get a real keyboard with a meta key. You can't live without
29485 it.
29486
29487
29488
29489 @node Emacs Lisp
29490 @subsection Emacs Lisp
29491
29492 Emacs is the King of Editors because it's really a Lisp interpreter.
29493 Each and every key you tap runs some Emacs Lisp code snippet, and since
29494 Emacs Lisp is an interpreted language, that means that you can configure
29495 any key to run any arbitrary code. You just, like, do it.
29496
29497 Gnus is written in Emacs Lisp, and is run as a bunch of interpreted
29498 functions. (These are byte-compiled for speed, but it's still
29499 interpreted.) If you decide that you don't like the way Gnus does
29500 certain things, it's trivial to have it do something a different way.
29501 (Well, at least if you know how to write Lisp code.) However, that's
29502 beyond the scope of this manual, so we are simply going to talk about
29503 some common constructs that you normally use in your @file{~/.gnus.el}
29504 file to customize Gnus. (You can also use the @file{~/.emacs} file, but
29505 in order to set things of Gnus up, it is much better to use the
29506 @file{~/.gnus.el} file, @xref{Startup Files}.)
29507
29508 If you want to set the variable @code{gnus-florgbnize} to four (4), you
29509 write the following:
29510
29511 @lisp
29512 (setq gnus-florgbnize 4)
29513 @end lisp
29514
29515 This function (really ``special form'') @code{setq} is the one that can
29516 set a variable to some value. This is really all you need to know. Now
29517 you can go and fill your @file{~/.gnus.el} file with lots of these to
29518 change how Gnus works.
29519
29520 If you have put that thing in your @file{~/.gnus.el} file, it will be
29521 read and @code{eval}ed (which is Lisp-ese for ``run'') the next time you
29522 start Gnus. If you want to change the variable right away, simply say
29523 @kbd{C-x C-e} after the closing parenthesis. That will @code{eval} the
29524 previous ``form'', which is a simple @code{setq} statement here.
29525
29526 Go ahead---just try it, if you're located at your Emacs. After you
29527 @kbd{C-x C-e}, you will see @samp{4} appear in the echo area, which
29528 is the return value of the form you @code{eval}ed.
29529
29530 Some pitfalls:
29531
29532 If the manual says ``set @code{gnus-read-active-file} to @code{some}'',
29533 that means:
29534
29535 @lisp
29536 (setq gnus-read-active-file 'some)
29537 @end lisp
29538
29539 On the other hand, if the manual says ``set @code{gnus-nntp-server} to
29540 @samp{nntp.ifi.uio.no}'', that means:
29541
29542 @lisp
29543 (setq gnus-nntp-server "nntp.ifi.uio.no")
29544 @end lisp
29545
29546 So be careful not to mix up strings (the latter) with symbols (the
29547 former). The manual is unambiguous, but it can be confusing.
29548
29549 @page
29550 @include gnus-faq.texi
29551
29552 @node GNU Free Documentation License
29553 @chapter GNU Free Documentation License
29554 @include doclicense.texi
29555
29556 @node Index
29557 @chapter Index
29558 @printindex cp
29559
29560 @node Key Index
29561 @chapter Key Index
29562 @printindex ky
29563
29564 @summarycontents
29565 @contents
29566 @bye
29567
29568 @iftex
29569 @iflatex
29570 \end{document}
29571 @end iflatex
29572 @end iftex
29573
29574 @c Local Variables:
29575 @c mode: texinfo
29576 @c coding: iso-8859-1
29577 @c End:
29578
29579 @ignore
29580 arch-tag: c9fa47e7-78ca-4681-bda9-9fef45d1c819
29581 @end ignore